Интенсивная эксплуатация спецтехники марки Bobcat невозможна без поломок и сбоев в работе. Основные дефекты связаны с выходом из строев узлов и агрегатов вследствие больших нагрузок и длительного использования. При наличии большого опыта и знаний оператор или механик может выявить истинную причину поломки по внешним признакам. Во многих случаях разобраться со сложной техникой помогут коды ошибок Бобкэт на панели управления.
При возникновении ошибок на панели управления погрузчиков марки Bobcat обращение в компанию АнгараГрупп – отличный вариант для своевременной диагностики и ремонта техники.
При появлении соответствующей индикации на панели приборов, водитель должен немедленно прекратить работу, обратиться к механику или сразу в сервисный центр. Квалифицированные инженеры помогут быстро и качественно устранить дефект с минимальными затратами.
нейтральном положении
замкнут на землю
замкнут на землю
замкнут на батарею
замкнут на батарею
землю
землю
батарею
батарею
механизма подъема ACS (AHC)
механизма наклона ACS (AHC)
механизма подъема ACS (AHC)
механизма наклона ACS (AHC)
батарею
допустимых пределов
пределов
работы
(AHC)
землю
батарею
допустимых пределов
(AHC)
управления, ACS (AHC)
положении
положении
положении
Идентификация ошибок Бобкэт S530 позволяет быстро выявить проблемы с исполнительными механизмами, провести техническое обслуживание и ремонт агрегатов. Подобные мероприятия помогают оперативно устранить дефекты и продлить срок эксплуатации погрузчиков. Стандартными ошибками погрузчиков данной модели являются:
Актуальные коды ошибок Bobcat S175 приведены в руководстве по эксплуатации техники. На панель приборов выведены цифровые индикаторы предупреждения о внештатных ситуациях в работе погрузчика. Наиболее частыми являются следующие ошибки Бобкэт 175:
Указанные ошибки Бобкэт S175 не являются единственными. В инструкции по эксплуатации приведены все возможные индикации и предупреждения. Для собственника техники или водителя знание основных ошибок облегчает диагностику, помогает принять решение о дальнейших действиях в плане техобслуживания и ремонта.
Инженеры сервисного центра обладают большим опытом и высокой квалификацией, быстро найдут корневую причину проблемы и предложат варианты ее решения.
Для владельцев погрузчиков данной марки обращение к нам – это возможность отремонтировать агрегаты погрузчиков оперативно и с предоставлением гарантии, в том числе с выездом специалистов сервисного центра на площадку клиента.
Коды ошибок мини погрузчиков Bobcat помогут вам идентифицировать неисправный исполнительный механизм и быстрее произвести ремонт отказавшего механизма как ДВС, так и гидравлической системы
Расшифровка кодов ошибок Bobcat
КОД | ОПИСАНИЕ |
01-16 | Не подсоединен воздушный фильтр |
01-17 | Засорен воздушный фильтр |
02-16 | Не подсоединен гидравлический нагнетательный фильтр |
02-17 | Засорен гидравлический нагнетательный фильтр |
03-09 | Низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-10 | Высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-11 | Предельно высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-14 | Предельно низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-22 | Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи ниже предельно допустимого |
04-09 | Низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе |
04-14 | Предельно низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе |
04-15 | Давление масла в двигателе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
04-21 | Давление масла в двигателе выше предельно допустимого |
04-22 | Давление масла в двигателе ниже предельно допустимого |
05-09 | Низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе |
05-14 | Предельно низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе |
05-15 | Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
05-21 | Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимого |
05-22 | Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимого |
06-10 | Высокие обороты двигателя |
06-11 | Предельно высокие обороты двигателя |
06-13 | Отсутствует сигнал оборотов двигателя |
06-15 | Обороты двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
06-18 | Обороты двигателя вне допустимых пределов |
07-10 | Высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе |
07-11 | Предельно высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе |
07-15 | Температура масла в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
07-21 | Температура масла в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимой |
07-22 | Температура масла в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимой |
08-10 | Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя |
08-11 | Предельно высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя |
08-15 | Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
08-21 | Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя выше предельно допустимой |
08-22 | Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя ниже предельно допустимой |
09-09 | Низкий уровень топлива |
09-21 | Уровень топлива выше предельно допустимого |
09-22 | Уровень топлива ниже предельно допустимого |
11-05 | Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на батарею |
11-06 | Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на массу |
12-21 | Сигнал ШИМ-контроллера передней доп. гидравлики за верхней границей диапазона |
12-22 | ШИМ-контроллер передней доп. гидравлики за нижней границей диапазона |
12-23 | ШИМ-контроллер передней доп. гидравлики не в нейтральном положении |
13-05 | Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на батарею |
13-06 | Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на массу |
13-07 | Разрыв цепи соленоида отсечки топлива |
14-02 | Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное включение |
14-03 | Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное выключение |
15-02 | Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное включение |
15-03 | Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное выключение |
16-05 | Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на батарею |
16-06 | Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на массу |
16-07 | Разрыв цепи удерживающего соленоида блокировки тяги |
17-05 | Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на батарею |
17-06 | Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на массу |
17-07 | Разрыв цепи соленоида гидравлического запорного клапана |
18-05 | Соленоид золотника замкнут на батарею |
18-06 | Соленоид золотника замкнут на массу |
18-07 | Разрыв цепи соленоида золотника |
19-02 | Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное включение |
19-03 | Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное выключение |
20-02 | Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное включение |
20-03 | Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное выключение |
21-02 | Свечи накаливания, ошибочное включение |
21-03 | Свечи накаливания, ошибочное выключение |
22-02 | Стартер, ошибочное включение |
22-03 | Стартер, ошибочное выключение |
23-02 | Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное включение |
23-03 | Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное выключение |
24-02 | Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное включение |
24-03 | Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное выключение |
25-02 | Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное включение |
25-03 | Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное выключение |
26-02 | Ошибочное включение переднего базового соленоида |
26-03 | Ошибочное выключение переднего базового соленоида |
27-02 | Ошибочное включение переднего штокового соленоида |
27-03 | Ошибочное выключение переднего штокового соленоида |
28-02 | Ошибочное включение соленоида дивертера |
28-03 | Ошибочное выключение соленоида дивертера |
29-02 | Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное включение |
29-03 | Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное выключение |
30-28 | Отказ памяти контроллера |
31-28 | Неисправность режима восстановления |
32-04 | Расширенное управление (ACS) не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat |
32-23 | Расширенное управление ACS не откалибровано |
32-31 | Отказ исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-32 | Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-33 | Неисправность электропроводки рукоятки наклона ковша |
32-34 | Исполнительный механизм наклона не в нейтральном положении |
32-35 | Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша не в нейтральном положении |
32-36 | Отказ исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-37 | Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-38 | Неисправность электропроводки рукоятки подъема стрелы |
32-39 | Исполнительный механизм подъема не в нейтральном положении |
32-40 | Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы не в нейтральном положении |
32-41 | Нет связи |
32-49 | Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на массу |
32-50 | Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на массу |
32-51 | Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на батарею |
32-52 | Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на батарею |
32-53 | Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на массу |
32-54 | Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша замкнута на массу |
32-55 | Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на батарею |
32-56 | Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша замкнута на батарею |
32-57 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-58 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-59 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-60 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-61 | Блокиратор рукояток замкнут на массу |
32-62 | Блокиратор рукояток замкнут на батарею |
32-63 | Цепь блокиратора педалей замкнута на массу |
32-64 | Цепь блокиратора педалей замкнута на батарею |
32-65 | Напряжение питания датчика вне допустимых пределов |
32-66 | Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи вне допустимых пределов |
32-67 | Переключатель переключился во время работы |
32-68 | Информационная ошибка рукоятки подъема стрелы |
32-69 | Переключатель режимов управления переключился во время работы |
32-70 | Цепь правой рукоятки движения замкнута на массу |
32-71 | Цепь правой рукоятки движения замкнута на батарею |
33-23 | Главный контроллер (контроллер Bobcat) не запрограммирован |
34-04 | Панель с кнопочным запуском не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat |
35-02 | Двухскоростной переключатель вентилятора, ошибочное включение |
35-03 | Двухскоростной переключатель вентилятора, ошибочное выключение |
36-48 | Подключено несколько контроллеров ACD |
37-02 | Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное включение |
37-03 | Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное выключение |
38-04 | Нет связи с контроллером джойстика |
38-05 | Ось Х левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-06 | Ось X правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-07 | Ось Y левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-08 | Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-09 | Переключатель режимов управления — замыкание на батарею или на массу |
38-11 | Исполнительный механизм подъема не в нейтральном положении |
38-12 | Исполнительный механизм наклона не в нейтральном положении |
38-13 | Отказ исполнительного механизма подъема |
38-14 | Отказ исполнительного механизма наклона |
38-15 | Неисправность проводки управления скоростью правого колеса |
38-16 | Неисправность проводки для скорости левого колеса |
38-17 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона |
38-18 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема |
38-19 | Ось X левого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона |
38-20 | Ось X правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-21 | Ось Y левого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона |
38-22 | Ось Y правого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона |
38-23 | Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-24 | Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-25 | Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-26 | Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-27 | Сигнал исполнительного механизма подъема за верхней границей диапазона |
38-28 | Сигнал исполнительного механизма наклона за верхней границей диапазона |
38-29 | Ось X левого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-30 | Ось X правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-31 | Ось Y левого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-32 | Ось Y правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-33 | Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-34 | Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-35 | Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-36 | Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-37 | Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-38 | Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-39 | Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на массу / за нижней границей диапазона |
38-40 | Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на массу / сигнал за нижней границей диапазона |
38-41 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма наклона |
38-42 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема |
38-43 | Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное включение |
38-44 | Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение |
38-45 | Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное включение |
38-46 | Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение |
38-47 | Передний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-48 | Передний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-49 | Задний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-50 | Задний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-51 | Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное включение |
38-52 | Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное включение |
38-53 | Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-54 | Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-55 | Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-56 | Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-57 | Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-58 | Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-59 | Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-60 | Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-61 | Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-62 | Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-63 | Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-64 | Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-65 | Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное выключение |
38-66 | Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное выключение |
38-67 | Нет сообщений от контроллера Bobcat |
38-68 | Углы установки колес (выравнивание) не откалиброваны |
38-69 | Исполнительные механизмы подъема и наклона не откалиброваны |
38-70 | Отключение питания |
38-71 | Напряжение батареи вне допустимых пределов |
38-72 | Насос привода не откалиброван |
38-73 | Переключатель режима управления/режима движения переключился во время работы |
38-74 | Скорость неуправляемого правого колеса, ошибочное включение |
38-75 | Скорость неуправляемого левого колеса, ошибочное включение |
38-76 | Соленоид давления системы управления — недостаточный ток |
38-77 | Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-78 | Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-79 | Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-80 | Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-81 | Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-82 | Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-83 | Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-84 | Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-85 | Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона |
38-86 | Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона |
38-87 | Блокировка правого переднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления) |
38-88 | Блокировка левого переднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления) |
38-89 | Блокировка правого заднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления) |
38-90 | Ошибка заднего левого управления |
38-91 | Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости правого колеса |
38-92 | Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости левого колеса |
38-93 | Датчик скорости правого колеса не отвечает |
38-94 | Датчик скорости левого колеса не отвечает |
38-98 | Контроллер в режиме калибровки привода |
38-99 | Контроллер в режиме калибровки положения колеса |
45-03 | Правый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение |
46-02 | Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное включение |
46-03 | Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение |
47-21 | Питание 8-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона |
47-22 | Питание 8-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона |
48-02 | Реле переднего света, ошибочное включение |
48-03 | Реле переднего света, ошибочное выключение |
49-02 | Реле заднего света, ошибочное включение |
49-03 | Реле заднего света, ошибочное выключение |
60-21 | Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за верхней границей диапазона |
60-22 | Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за нижней границей диапазона |
60-23 | Рычаг управления задней доп. гидравликой не возвращается в нейтральное положение |
64-02 | Ошибочное включение реле мощности |
64-03 | Ошибочное выключение реле мощности |
74-72 | Сбой загрузочного кода контроллера Bobcat |
74-73 | Левая панель, ошибка приемного устройства |
80-02 | ACD, выход «A», ошибочное включение |
80-03 | ACD, выход «A», ошибочное выключение |
81-02 | ACD, выход «B», ошибочное включение |
81-03 | ACD, выход «B», ошибочное выключение |
82-02 | ACD, выход «C», ошибочное включение |
82-03 | ACD, выход «C», ошибочное выключение |
83-02 | ACD, выход «D», ошибочное включение |
83-03 | ACD, выход «D», ошибочное выключение |
84-02 | ACD, выход «E», ошибочное включение |
84-03 | ACD, выход «E», ошибочное выключение |
90-02 | Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное включение |
90-03 | Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное выключение |
91-02 | Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное включение |
91-03 | Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное выключение |
92-02 | Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное включение |
92-03 | Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное выключение |
93-02 | Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное включение |
93-03 | Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное выключение |
ПЕРЕЧЕНЬ СЛУЖЕБНЫХ КОДОВ
Служебные коды могут представлять собой слово (3) (см. рисунок) или число (4).
REPLY (ОТВЕТ) Отсутствует связь между одной или обеими приборными панелями и контроллером.
INPUT (ВВОД) Отсутствует связь между контроллером и левой приборной панелью.
CODE (КОД) Контроллер запрашивает пароль (только для панели с кнопочным запуском).
ERROR (ОШИБКА) Введен неправильный пароль (только для панели с кнопочным запуском).
01-16 Не подсоединен воздушный фильтр
01-17 Засорен воздушный фильтр
02-16 Фильтр гидравлической / гидростатической системы не подсоединен
02-17 Фильтр гидравлической / гидростатической системы подсоединен
03-09 Низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-10 Высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-11 Предельно высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-14 Предельно низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-22 Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи ниже предельно допустимого
04-09 Низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе
04-14 Предельно низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе
04-15 Давление масла в двигателе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
04-21 Давление масла в двигателе выше предельно допустимого
04-22 Давление масла в двигателе ниже предельно допустимого
05-09 Низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе
05-10 Высокое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе
05-11 Предельно высокое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе
05-14 Предельно низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе
05-15 Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
05-21 Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимого
05-22 Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимого
06-10 Высокие обороты двигателя
06-11 Предельно высокие обороты двигателя
06-13 Отсутствует сигнал оборотов двигателя
06-15 Обороты двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
06-18 Обороты двигателя вне допустимых пределов
07-10 Высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе
07-11 Предельно высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе
07-15 Температура масла в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
07-21 Температура масла в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимой
07-22 Температура масла в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимой
08-10 Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
08-11 Предельно высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
08-15 Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
08-21 Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя выше предельно допустимой
08-22 Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя ниже предельно допустимой
09-09 Низкий уровень топлива
09-21 Уровень топлива выше предельно допустимого
09-22 Уровень топлива ниже предельно допустимого
10-17 Засорен гидравлический нагнетательный фильтр
11-05 Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на батарею
11-06 Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на заземление
12-21 Сигнал ШИМконтроллера передней доп. гидравлики за верхней границей диапазона
12-22 ШИМконтроллер передней доп. гидравлики за нижней границей диапазона
12-23 ШИМконтроллер передней доп. гидравлики не в нейтральном диапазона
13-05 Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на батарею
13-06 Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на заземление
13-07 Разрыв цепи соленоида отсечки топлива
14-02 Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное включение
14-03 Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное выключение
15-02 Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное включение
15-03 Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное выключение
16-05 Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на батарею
16-06 Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на заземление
16-07 Разрыв цепи удерживающего соленоида блокировки тяги
17-05 Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на батарею
17-06 Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на заземление
17-07 Разрыв цепи соленоида гидравлического запорного клапана
18-05 Соленоид золотника замкнут на батарею
18-06 Соленоид золотника замкнут на заземление
18-07 Разрыв цепи соленоида золотника
19-02 Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное включение
19-03 Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное выключение
20-02 Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное включение
20-03 Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное выключение
21-02 Свечи накаливания, ошибочное включение
21-03 Свечи накаливания, ошибочное выключение
22-02 Стартер, ошибочное включение
22-03 Стартер, ошибочное выключение
23-02 Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное включение
23-03 Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное выключение
24-02 Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное включение
24-03 Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное выключение
25-02 Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное включение
25-03 Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное выключение
26-02 Ошибочное включение переднего базового соленоида
26-03 Ошибочное выключение переднего базового соленоида
27-02 Ошибочное включение переднего штокового соленоида
27-03 Ошибочное выключение переднего штокового соленоида
28-02 Соленоид перепускного клапана, ошибочное включение
28-03 Соленоид перепускного клапана, ошибочное выключение
29-02 Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное включение
29-03 Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное выключение
30-28 Отказ памяти контроллера
31-28 Неисправность режима восстановления (появляется также после обновления программного обеспечения)
32-04 Расширенное управление (ACS) не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat
32-23 Требуется калибровка ACS
32-24 Выполнена калибровка ACS
32-31 Неисправность исполнительного механизма наклона ACS
32-32 Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма наклона ACS
32-33 Неисправность электропроводки ручки наклона ACS
32-34 Исполнительный механизм наклона ACS не в нейтральном положении
32-35 Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша ACS не в нейтральном положении
32-36 Неисправность исполнительного механизма подъема ACS
32-37 Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма подъема ACS
32-38 Неисправность электропроводки рукоятки подъема ACS
32-39 Исполнительный механизм подъема ACS не в нейтральном положении
32-40 Рукоятка / педаль подъема ковша ACS не в нейтральном положении
32-41 ACS: нет связи
32-49 Исполнительный механизм подъема AСS замкнут на заземление
32-50 Исполнительный механизм наклона AСS замкнут на заземление
32-51 Исполнительный механизм подъема AСS замкнут на батарею
32-52 Исполнительный механизм наклона AСS замкнут на батарею
32-53 Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на заземление, AСS
32-54 Рукоятка / педаль наклона стрелы замкнута на заземление, AСS
32-55 Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на батарею, ACS
32-56 Рукоятка / педаль наклона стрелы замкнута на батарею, ACS
32-57 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема ACS
32-58 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона ACS
32-59 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема ACS
32-60 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема ACS
32-61 Цепь блокиратора рукоятки ACS замкнута на заземление
32-62 Цепь блокиратора рукоятки ACS замкнута на батарею
32-63 Цепь блокиратора педалей ACS замкнута на заземление
32-64 Цепь блокиратора педалей ACS замкнута на батарею
32-65 Напряжение питания датчика ACS вне допустимых пределов
32-66 Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи ACS ниже предельно допустимого
32-67 Переключатель ACS переключился во время работы
32-68 Информационная ошибка рукоятки подъема стрелы, ACS
32-70 Цепь правой рукоятки движения ACS замкнута на заземление
32-71 Цепь правой рукоятки движения ACS замкнута на батарею
32-74 Ось X левого джойстика ACS вне допустимых пределов
32-75 Отключение питания неотключаемого оборудования ACS
32-76 Информационная ошибка джойстика CAN, ACS
32-77 Информационная ошибка дистанционного управления, ACS
33-23 Главный контроллер (контроллер Bobcat) не запрограммирован
34-04 Панель с кнопочным запуском не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat
35-02 Ошибочное включение вентилятора гидравлики
35-03 Ошибочное выключение вентилятора гидравлики
36-48 Подключено несколько контроллеров ACD
37-02 Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное включение
37-03 Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное включение
38-01 Информационная ошибка джойстика CAN
38-02 Информационная ошибка дистанционного управления
38-04 Нет связи с контроллером джойстика
38-05 Ось Х левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-06 Ось X правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-07 Ось Y левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-08 Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-09 Переключатель режимов управления замыкание на батарею или на заземление
38-10 Выполнена калибровка исполнительного механизма
38-11 Исполнительный механизм подъема не в нейтральном положении
38-12 Исполнительный механизм наклона не в нейтральном положении
38-13 Отказ исполнительного механизма подъема
38-14 Отказ исполнительного механизма наклона
38-15 Неисправность проводки управления скоростью правого колеса
38-16 Неисправность проводки для скорости левого колеса
38-17 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона
38-18 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема
38-19 Ось X левого джойстика за верхней границей диапазона
38-20 Ось X правого джойстика за верхней границей диапазона
38-21 Ось Y левого джойстика за верхней границей диапазона
38-22 Ось Y правого джойстика за верхней границей диапазона
38-23 Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-24 Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-25 Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-26 Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-27 Сигнал исполнительного механизма подъема за верхней границей диапазона
38-28 Сигнал исполнительного механизма наклона за верхней границей диапазона
38-29 Ось X левого джойстика за нижней границей диапазона
38-30 Ось X правого джойстика за нижней границей диапазона
38-31 Ось Y левого джойстика за нижней границей диапазона
38-32 Ось Y правого джойстика за нижней границей диапазона
38-33 Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-34 Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-35 Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-36 Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-37 Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-38 Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-39 Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на заземление / за нижней границей диапазона
38-40 Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на заземление / сигнал за нижней границей диапазона
38-41 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма наклона
38-42 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема
38-43 Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное включение
38-44 Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение
38-45 Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное включение
38-46 Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение
38-47 Передний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение
38-48 Передний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение
38-49 Задний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение
38-50 Задний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное выключение
38-51 Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное включение
38-52 Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное включение
38-53 Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение
38-54 Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение
38-55 Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение
38-56 Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение
38-57 Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-58 Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-59 Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-60 Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-61 Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-62 Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-63 Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-64 Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-65 Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное выключение
38-66 Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное выключение
38-67 Нет сообщений от контроллера Bobcat
38-68 Углы установки колес (выравнивание) не откалиброваны
38-69 Неисправность калибровки исполнительных механизмов подъема и наклона
38-70 Неисправность режима восстановления диапазона
38-71 Напряжение батареи вне допустимых пределов
38-72 Насос привода не откалиброван
38-73 Переключатель режима управления переключился во время работы
38-74 Неуправляемая скорость вращения правого колеса
38-75 Неуправляемая скорость вращения левого колеса
38-76 Соленоид давления системы управления недостаточный ток
38-77 Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением недостаточный ток
38-78 Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием недостаточный ток
38-79 Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением недостаточный ток
38-80 Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием недостаточный ток
38-81 Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением недостаточный ток
38-82 Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием недостаточный ток
38-83 Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением недостаточный ток
38-84 Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием недостаточный ток
38-85 Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
38-86 Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
38-87 Неисправность переднего правого рулевого устройства за нижней границей диапазона
38-88 Неисправность переднего левого рулевого устройства
38-89 Неисправность заднего правого рулевого устройства
38-90 Ошибка заднего левого управления
38-91 Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости правого колеса
38-92 Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости левого колеса
38-93 Датчик скорости правого колеса не отвечает
38-94 Датчик скорости левого колеса не отвечает
38-95 Изменение направления в датчике скорости левого колеса
38-96 Изменение направления в датчике скорости правого колеса
38-98 Контроллер в режиме калибровки привода
38-99 Контроллер в режиме калибровки положения колеса
39-04 Левый джойстик не имеет связи с контроллером Bobcat
39-05 Ось Х не в нейтральном положении
39-07 Ось Y не в нейтральном положении
39-12 Манипулятор переключатель левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
39-13 Не подсоединена ручка левого джойстика выключение
39-16 Не подсоединен левый джойстик выключение
39-28 Внутренняя неисправность левого джойстика
39-48 Левый джойстик, многорежимный
40-04 Правый джойстик не имеет связи с контроллером Bobcat
40-05 Ось X правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
40-07 Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
40-12 Манипулятор переключатель правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
40-13 Не подсоединена ручка правого джойстика
40-16 Не подсоединен правый джойстик
40-28 Внутренняя неисправность правого джойстика
40-48 Правый джойстик, многорежимный
41-09 Низкое напряжение генератора
41-10 Высокое напряжение генератора
41-11 Предельно высокое напряжение генератора
44-02 Звуковой сигнал, ошибочное включение
44-03 Звуковой сигнал, ошибочное выключение
45-02 Правый указатель поворота, ошибочное включение
45-03 Правый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение
46-02 Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное включение
46-03 Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение
47-21 Питание 8вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
47-22 Питание 8вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
48-02 Реле переднего света, ошибочное включение
48-03 Реле переднего света, ошибочное выключение
49-02 Реле заднего света, ошибочное включение
49-03 Реле заднего света, ошибочное выключение
60-21 Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за верхней границей диапазона
60-22 Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за нижней границей диапазона
60-23 Рычаг управления задней доп. гидравликой не в нейтральном положении
64-02 Ошибочное включение реле мощности
64-03 Ошибочное выключение реле мощности
73-04 Неисправность дистанционного управления
73-13 Дистанционное управление отсутствует сигнал
74-72 Сбой загрузочного кода контроллера Bobcat
75-01 Информационная ошибка джойстика CAN
75-04 Нет связи с контроллером привода
75-05 Ось Х левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
75-07 Ось Y левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
75-08 Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
75-09 Переключатель режимов ISO / H замыкание на батарею или на заземление
75-13 Заклинило датчик угла правого переднего колеса
75-14 Заклинило датчик угла левого переднего колеса
75-15 Заклинило датчик угла правого заднего колеса
75-16 Заклинило датчик угла левого заднего колеса
75-17 Левая наклонная пластина не в нейтральном положении
75-18 Правая наклонная пластина не в нейтральном положении
75-19 Ось X левого джойстика за верхней границей диапазона
75-21 Ось Y левого джойстика за верхней границей диапазона
75-22 Ось Y правого джойстика за верхней границей диапазона
75-23 Сигнал датчика угла правого переднего колеса за верхней границей диапазона
75-24 Сигнал датчика угла левого переднего колеса за верхней границей диапазона
75-25 Сигнал датчика угла правого заднего колеса за верхней границей диапазона
75-26 Сигнал датчика угла левого заднего колеса за верхней границей диапазона
75-27 Смещение левой наклонной пластины
75-28 Смещение правой наклонной пластины
75-29 Ось X левого джойстика за нижней границей диапазона
75-31 Ось Y левого джойстика за нижней границей диапазона
75-32 Ось Y правого джойстика за нижней границей диапазона
75-33 Сигнал датчика угла правого переднего колеса за нижней границей диапазона
75-34 Сигнал датчика угла левого переднего колеса за нижней границей диапазона
75-35 Сигнал датчика угла правого заднего колеса за нижней границей диапазона
75-36 Сигнал датчика угла левого заднего колеса за нижней границей диапазона
75-37 Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
75-38 Питание датчика 2 за нижней границей диапазона
75-39 Сигнал датчика левой наклонной пластины за верхней границей диапазона
75-40 Сигнал датчика левой наклонной пластины за нижней границей диапазона
75-41 Сигнал датчика правой наклонной пластины за верхней границей диапазона
75-42 Сигнал датчика правой наклонной пластины за нижней границей диапазона
75-43 Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное включение
75-44 Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение
75-45 Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное включение
75-46 Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение
75-47 Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на батарею
75-48 Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на батарею
75-49 Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на батарею
75-50 Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на батарею
75-51 Соленоид давления системы управления замкнут на батарею
75-52 Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное включение
75-53 Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение
75-54 Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение
75-55 Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение
75-56 Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение
75-57 Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на заземление
75-58 Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на заземление
75-59 Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на заземление
75-60 Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на заземление
75-61 Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на заземление
75-62 Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на заземление
75-63 Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением замкнут на заземление
75-64 Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на заземление
75-65 Соленоид давления системы управления замкнут на заземление
75-66 Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное выключение
75-67 Нет сообщений от контроллера Bobcat
75-68 Датчики угла не откалиброваны
75-69 Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи выше предельно допустимого
75-70 Неисправность режима восстановления (появляется также после обновления программного обеспечения)
75-71 Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи ниже предельно допустимого
75-72 Насос привода не откалиброван
75-73 Переключатель режимов ISO / H переключился во время работы
75-74 Неуправляемая скорость вращения правого колеса
75-75 Неуправляемая скорость вращения левого колеса
75-76 Нет сообщений от контроллера ACS
75-77 Сигнал датчика скорости левого колеса за верхней границей диапазона
75-78 Сигнал датчика скорости правого колеса за верхней границе диапазона
75-79 Сигнал датчика скорости левого колеса за нижней границей диапазона
75-80 Сигнал датчика скорости правого колеса за нижней границе диапазона
75-81 Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на батарею
75-82 Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на батарею
75-83 Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на батарею
75-84 Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием замкнут на батарею
75-85 Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
75-86 Питание датчика 2 за верхней границей диапазона
75-88 Контроллер в режиме программирования
75-91 Изменение полярности датчика левой наклонной пластины
75-92 Изменение полярности датчика правой наклонной пластины
75-93 Датчик скорости правого колеса не отвечает
75-94 Датчик скорости левого колеса не отвечает
75-95 Изменение направления в датчике скорости левого колеса
75-96 Изменение направления в датчике скорости правого колеса
75-98 Контроллер в режиме калибровки
76-73 Левая панель, ошибка приемного устройства
77-48 Замок зажигания, многорежимный
78-74 Дверной / блокировочный замок открыт / включен
80-02 ACD, выход «A», ошибочное включение
80-03 ACD, выход «A», ошибочное выключение
81-02 ACD, выход «B», ошибочное включение
81-03 ACD, выход «B», ошибочное выключение
82-02 ACD, выход «C», ошибочное включение
82-03 ACD, выход «C», ошибочное выключение
83-02 ACD, выход «D», ошибочное включение
83-03 ACD, выход «D», ошибочное выключение
84-02 ACD, выход «E», ошибочное включение
84-03 ACD, выход «E», ошибочное выключение
85-02 ACD (устройство управления навесным оборудованием), выход «F», ошибочное включение
85-03 ACD, выход «F», ошибочное выключение
86-02 ACD, выход «G», ошибочное включение
86-03 ACD, выход «G», ошибочное выключение
87-02 ACD, выход «H», ошибочное включение
87-03 ACD, выход «H», ошибочное выключение
90-02 Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное включение
90-03 Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное выключение колеса
91-02 Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное включение
91-03 Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное выключение
92-02 Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное включение
92-03 Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное выключение
93-02 Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное включение
93-03 Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное выключение
1-1 S650 Service Manual MAINTENANCE SAFETY Never service the Bobcat Skid- Steer Loader without instructions. Have good ventilation when welding or grinding painted parts. Wear dust mask when grinding painted parts. Toxic dust and gas can be produced. Avoid exhaust fume leaks which can kill without warning. Exhaust system must be tightly sealed. Stop, cool and clean engine of flammable materials before checking fluids. Never service or adjust loader with the engine running unless instructed to do so in the manual. Avoid contact with leaking hydraulic fluid or diesel fuel under pressure. It can penetrate the skin or eyes. Never fill fuel tank with engine running, while smoking or when near open flame. Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. Do not go under lift arms when raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support device. Replace it if damaged. Keep body, jewelry and clothing away from moving parts, electrical contact, hot parts and exhaust. Wear eye protection to guard from battery acid, compressed springs, fluids under pressure and flying debris when engines are running or tools are used. Use eye protection approved for type of welding. Keep rear door closed except for service. Close and latch door before operating the loader. Never work on loader with lift arms up unless lift arms are held by an approved lift arm support device. Replace if damaged. Never modify equipment or add attachments not approved by Bobcat Company. Lead-acid batteries produce flammable and explosive gases. Keep arcs, sparks, flames and lighted tobacco away from batteries. Batteries contain acid which burns eyes or skin on contact. Wear protective clothing. If acid contacts body, flush well with water. For eye contact flush well and get immediate medical attention. Use the correct procedure to lift or lower operator cab. Cleaning and maintenance are required daily. MSW35-0409 WRONG B-6589 P-90216 CORRECT NA1204 CORREC T NA1193 CORRECT NA1206 WRONGWRONG NA1205 WRONG NA1192 NA1200 WRONG WRONG NA1191 WARNING Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Operator’s Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-0807 Maintenance procedures which are given in the Operation & Maintenance Manual can be performed by the owner/ operator without any specific technical training. Maintenance procedures which are not in the Operation & Maintenance Manual must be performed ONLY BY QUALIFIED BOBCAT SERVICE PERSONNEL. Always use genuine Bobcat replacement parts. The Service Safety Training Course is available from your Bobcat dealer. Safety Alert Symbol: This symbol with a warning statement, means: “Warning, be alert! Your safety is involved!” Carefully read the message that follows. 1-2 S650 Service Manual 1-3 S650 Service Manual CONTENTS SAFETY & MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-01 HYDRAULIC SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-01 HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-01 DRIVE SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-01 MAINFRAME . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-01 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM & ANALYSIS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-01 ENGINE SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-01 HEATING, VENTILATION, AIR CONDITIONING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-01 SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPEC-01 ALPHABETICAL INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .INDEX-01 1-4 S650 Service Manual 1-5 S650 Service Manual FOREWORD FOREWORD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 FIRE PREVENTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Electrical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Hydraulic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Fueling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Spark Arrestor Exhaust System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 Welding And Grinding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13 Fire Extinguishers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13 SERIAL NUMBER LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14 Loader Serial Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14 Engine Serial Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14 DELIVERY REPORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 LOADER IDENTIFICATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 1-6 S650 Service Manual 1-7 S650 Service Manual FOREWORD This manual is for the Bobcat loader mechanic. It provides necessary servicing and adjustment procedures for the Bobcat loader and its component parts and systems. Refer to the Operation & Maintenance Manual for operating instructions, starting procedure, daily checks, etc. A general inspection of the following items must be made after the loader has had service or repair: FW SSL-1008 SM 1. Check that the ROPS/FOPS (Including side screens) is in good condition and is not modified. 9. The parking brake must function correctly. 2. Check that ROPS mounting hardware is tightened and is Bobcat approved. 10. Enclosure door latches must open and close freely. 3. The seat belt must be correctly installed, functional and in good condition. 11. Bob-Tach wedges and linkages must function correctly and be in good condition. 4. The seat bar must be correctly adjusted, clean and lubricated. 12. Safety treads must be in good condition. 5. Check lift arm support device, replace if damaged. 13. Check for correct function of indicator lamps. 6. Machine signs (decals) must be legible and in the correct location. 14. Check hydraulic fluid level, engine oil level and fuel supply. 7. Steering levers, hand controls and foot pedals must return to neutral (as applicable). 15. Inspect for fuel, oil or hydraulic fluid leaks. 8. Check for correct function of the work lights. 16. Lubricate the loader. SAFETY & ENGINE HYDRAULIC 1-8 S650 Service Manual FW SSL-1008 SM 17. Check the condition of the battery and cables. 23. Operate the machine and check all functions. 18. Inspect the air cleaner for damage or leaks. Check the condition of the element. 24. Check for correct function of the Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS™) before the machine is returned to the customer. 19. Check the electrical charging system. 25. Check for proper function of front horn and back-up alarm (if equipped). 20. Check tires for wear and pressure. Check tracks for wear and tension. Use only approved tires or tracks. 26. Check function or condition of all equipped options and accessories (examples: fire extinguisher, rotating beacon, lift kits, etc.). 21. Inspect for loose or broken parts or connections. 27. Recommend to the owner that all necessary corrections be made before the machine is returned to service. 22. Check for any field modification not completed. CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING Diesel engine exhaust and some of its constituents are known to the state of California to cause cancer, birth defects and other reproductive harm. 1-9 S650 Service Manual FW SSL-1008 SM 1-10 S650 Service Manual SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS WARNING Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Operator’s Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-0903 IMPORTANT This notice identifies procedures which must be followed to avoid damage to the machine. I-2019-0284 DANGER The signal word DANGER on the machine and in the manuals indicates a hazardous situation which, if not avoided, will result in death or serious injury. D-1002-1107 WARNING The signal word WARNING on the machine and in the manuals indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided, could result in death or serious injury. W-2044-1107 The following publications provide information on the safe use and maintenance of the Bobcat machine and attachments: • The Delivery Report is used to assure that complete instructions have been given to the new owner and that the machine is in safe operating condition. • The Operation & Maintenance Manual delivered with the machine or attachment contains operating information as well as routine maintenance and service procedures. It is a part of the machine and can be stored in a container provided on the machine. Replacement Operation & Maintenance Manuals can be ordered from your Bobcat dealer. • Machine signs (decals) instruct on the safe operation and care of your Bobcat machine or attachment. The signs and their locations are shown in the Operation & Maintenance Manual. Replacement signs are available from your Bobcat dealer. • An Operator’s Handbook fastened to the operator cab. It’s brief instructions are convenient to the operator. The handbook is available from your dealer in an English edition or one of many other languages. See your Bobcat dealer for more information on translated versions. • The AEM Safety Manual delivered with the machine gives general safety information. • The Service Manual and Parts Manual are available from your dealer for use by mechanics to do shop- type service and repair work. • The Skid-Steer Loader Operator Training Course is available through your local dealer or at www.training.bobcat.com or www.bobcat.com. This course is intended to provide rules and practices of correct operation of the Skid-Steer Loader. The course is available in English and Spanish versions. • Service Safety Training Courses are available from your Bobcat dealer or at www.training.bobcat.com or www.bobcat.com. They provide information for safe and correct service procedures. • The Skid-Steer Loader Safety Video is available from your Bobcat dealer or at www.training.bobcat.com or www.bobcat.com. SI SSL-1008 SM This symbol with a warning statement means: “Warning, be alert! Your safety is involved!” Carefully read the message that follows. Safety Alert Symbol 1-11 S650 Service Manual SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS (CONT’D) The dealer and owner / operator review the recommended uses of the product when delivered. If the owner / operator will be using the machine for a different application(s) he or she must ask the dealer for recommendations on the new use. Call Before You Dig Dial 811 (USA Only) 1-888-258-0808 (USA & Canada) When you call, you will be directed to a location in your state / province, or city for information about buried lines (telephone, cable TV, water, sewer, gas, etc.). Cutting or drilling concrete containing sand or rock containing quartz may result in exposure to silica dust. Do not exceed Permissible Exposure Limits (PEL) to silica dust as determined by OSHA or other job site Rules and Regulations. Use a respirator, water spray or other means to control dust. Silica dust can cause lung disease and is known to the state of California to cause cancer. SI SSL-1008 SM 1-12 S650 Service Manual FIRE PREVENTION Maintenance The machine and some attachments have components that are at high temperatures under normal operating conditions. The primary source of high temperatures is the engine and exhaust system. The electrical system, if damaged or incorrectly maintained, can be a source of arcs or sparks. Flammable debris (leaves, straw, etc.) must be removed regularly. If flammable debris is allowed to accumulate, it can cause a fire hazard. Clean often to avoid this accumulation. Flammable debris in the engine compartment is a potential fire hazard. The operator’s area, engine compartment and engine cooling system must be inspected every day and cleaned if necessary to prevent fire hazards and overheating. All fuels, most lubricants and some coolants mixtures are flammable. Flammable fluids that are leaking or spilled onto hot surfaces or onto electrical components can cause a fire. Operation Do not use the machine where exhaust, arcs, sparks or hot components can contact flammable material, explosive dust or gases. Electrical Check all electrical wiring and connections for damage. Keep the battery terminals clean and tight. Repair or replace any damaged part or wires that are loose or frayed. Battery gas can explode and cause serious injury. Use the procedure in the Operation & Maintenance Manual for connecting the battery and for jump starting. Do not jump start or charge a frozen or damaged battery. Keep any open flames or sparks away from batteries. Do not smoke in battery charging area. Hydraulic System Check hydraulic tubes, hoses and fittings for damage and leakage. Never use open flame or bare skin to check for leaks. Hydraulic tubes and hoses must be properly routed and have adequate support and secure clamps. Tighten or replace any parts that show leakage. Always clean fluid spills. Do not use gasoline or diesel fuel for cleaning parts. Use commercial nonflammable solvents. Fueling Stop the engine and let it cool before adding fuel. No smoking! Do not refuel a machine near open flames or sparks. Fill the fuel tank outdoors. Starting Do not use ether or starting fluids on any engine that has glow plugs or air intake heater. These starting aids can cause explosion and injure you or bystanders. Use the procedure in the Operation & Maintenance Manual for connecting the battery and for jump starting. Spark Arrestor Exhaust System The spark arrestor exhaust system is designed to control the emission of hot particles from the engine and exhaust system, but the muffler and the exhaust gases are still hot. Check the spark arrestor exhaust system regularly to make sure it is maintained and working properly. Use the procedure in the Operation & Maintenance Manual for cleaning the spark arrestor muffler (if equipped). SI SSL-1008 SM 1-13 S650 Service Manual FIRE PREVENTION (CONT’D) Welding And Grinding Always clean the machine and attachment, disconnect the battery, and disconnect the wiring from the Bobcat controllers before welding. Cover rubber hoses, battery and all other flammable parts. Keep a fire extinguisher near the machine when welding. Have good ventilation when grinding or welding painted parts. Wear dust mask when grinding painted parts. Toxic dust or gas can be produced. Dust generated from repairing nonmetallic parts such as hoods, fenders or covers can be flammable or explosive. Repair such components in a well ventilated area away from open flames or sparks. Fire Extinguishers Know where fire extinguishers and first aid kits are located and how to use them. Inspect the fire extinguisher and service the fire extinguisher regularly. Obey the recommendations on the instructions plate. SI SSL-1008 SM 1-14 S650 Service Manual SERIAL NUMBER LOCATIONS Always use the serial number of the loader when requesting service information or when ordering parts. Early or later models (identification made by serial number) may use different parts, or it may be necessary to use a different procedure in doing a specific service operation. Loader Serial Number Figure 1 The loader serial number plate (Item 1) [Figure 1] is located on the outside of the loader frame. Figure 2 Explanation of loader Serial Number [Figure 2]: 1. The four digit Model / Engine Combination Module number identifies the model number and engine combination. 2. The five digit Production Sequence Number identifies the order which the loader is produced. Engine Serial Number Figure 3 The engine serial number is located on the side of the engine (Item 1) [Figure 3] behind the alternator. P-90537 1 P-90175 Module 2 - Production Sequence (Series) Module 1 - Model / Engine Combination P-90466 1 1-15 S650 Service Manual DELIVERY REPORT Figure 4 The delivery report [Figure 4] must be completed by the dealer and signed by the owner or operator when the Bobcat loader is delivered. An explanation of the form must be given to the owner. B-16315 1-16 S650 Service Manual LOADER IDENTIFICATION [1] Optional or Field Accessory. (Not Standard Equipment). [2] BUCKETS - Several different buckets and other attachments are available for the Bobcat loader. [3] ROPS, FOPS - Roll Over Protective Structure, per ISO 3471, and Falling Object Protective Structure per ISO 3449, Level I. Level II is available. The Bobcat loader is base-equipped with a standard operator cab as shown. Extra insulated cab is available as an option (Reduced noise level). [4] TIRES - Standard tires are shown. Several different tire styles and sizes are available for the Bobcat loader. FRONT LIGHTS GRAB HANDLES OPERATOR SEAT with SEAT BELT AND SEAT BAR TILT CYLINDERS [2] BUCKET STEP [1] REAR AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS LIFT ARM [4] TIRES REAR GRILLE BUCKET STEPS FRONT AUXILIARY QUICK COUPLERS TAIL LIGHT REAR DOOR REAR LIGHT [3] OPERATOR CAB (ROPS AND FOPS) NA1667 NA1668 LIFT CYLINDER LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE OPERATION & MAINTENANCE MANUAL AND OPERATOR’S HANDBOOK BACK-UP ALARM 10-01 S650 Service Manual SAFETY & MAINTENANCE LIFTING AND BLOCKING THE LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10-1 Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10-1 LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20-1 Installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20-1 Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-20-2 OPERATOR CAB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-1 Raising . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-2 Lowering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-3 Cab Door Sensor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-4 Special Applications Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-4 Special Applications Kit Inspection And Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-4 TRANSPORTING LOADER ON A TRAILER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40-1 Loading And Unloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40-1 Fastening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40-1 TOWING THE LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-50-1 Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-50-1 REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60-1 Remote Start Tool - MEL1563 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60-1 Service Tool Harness Control - MEL1565 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60-2 Service Tool Harness Communicator - MEL1566 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60-3 Remote Start Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-60-3 REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61-1 Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) - 7003030 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61-2 Loader Service Tool Harness - 6689747 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61-3 Computer Service Tool Harness - 6689746 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61-4 Remote Start Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61-5 SERVICE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70-1 Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70-1 AIR CLEANER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-80-1 Replacing Filter Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-80-1 ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90-1 Maintenance Platform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90-1 Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90-1 Checking Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90-3 Removing And Replacing Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-90-3 10-02 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100-1 Fuel Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100-1 Biodiesel Blend Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100-1 Filling The Fuel Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100-2 Fuel Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100-3 Removing Air From The Fuel System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-100-3 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-110-1 Checking And Adding Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-110-1 Engine Oil Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-110-1 Removing And Replacing Oil And Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-110-2 HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-120-1 Checking And Adding Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-120-1 Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Fluid Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-120-1 Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-120-2 Removing And Replacing Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-120-4 Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Charge Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-120-6 Breather Cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-120-7 FINAL DRIVE TRANSMISSION (CHAINCASE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-130-1 Checking And Adding Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-130-1 Removing And Replacing Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-130-1 BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-140-1 Inspection And Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-140-1 BOB-TACH (POWER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-141-1 Inspection And Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-141-1 LUBRICATING THE LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-150-1 Lubrication Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-150-1 TIRE MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-160-1 Wheel Nuts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-160-1 Rotating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-160-1 Mounting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-160-1 SPARK ARRESTOR MUFFLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-170-1 Cleaning Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-170-1 PIVOT PINS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-180-1 Inspection And Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-180-1 LOADER STORAGE AND RETURN TO SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-190-1 Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-190-1 Return To Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-190-1 STOPPING THE ENGINE AND LEAVING THE LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-200-1 Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-200-1 10-03 S650 Service Manual EMERGENCY EXIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-210-1 External Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-210-1 Rear Window . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-210-1 Front Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-210-1 SEAT BELT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-220-1 Inspection And Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-220-1 10-04 S650 Service Manual 10-10-1 S650 Service Manual LIFTING AND BLOCKING THE LOADER Procedure Figure 10-10-1 WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Operator’s Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-0807 Always park the loader on a level surface. WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Figure 10-10-2 Lift the front of the loader and put jack stands under the axle tubes [Figure 10-10-2]. NOTE: Make sure the jackstands do not touch the tires. Make sure tires clear floor or any obstacles. Figure 10-10-3 Lift the rear of the loader and install jack stands [Figure 10-10-3]. B-7023A P-85985 P-90556 P-85425 10-10-2 S650 Service Manual 10-20-1 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE Installing WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. Service lift arm support device if damaged or if parts are missing. Using a damaged lift arm support or with missing parts can cause lift arms to drop causing injury or death. W-2572-0407 DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 Remove attachment from the loader. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-40-1.) OR (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-41-1.) Figure 10-20-1 Put jackstands under the rear corners of the loader frame (Inset) [Figure 10-20-1]. Remove the lift arm support device (Item 1) [Figure 10- 20-1] from the storage position. The operator must stay in the operator seat with the seat belt fastened and the seat bar lowered until the lift arm support device is installed. Start the engine and raise the lift arms all the way up. Figure 10-20-2 Have a second person install the lift arm support device over the rod of one of the lift cylinders [Figure 10-20-2]. The lift arm support device must be tight against the cylinder rod. P-90566 P-85463A 1 P-90567 10-20-2 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE (CONT’D) Installing (Cont’d) Figure 10-20-3 Lower the lift arms slowly until the lift arm support device is held between the lift arms and the lift cylinder [Figure 10-20-3]. The tabs of the lift arm support device must go past the end of the cylinder (Inset) [Figure 10-20-3]. Removing The operator must be in the operator’s seat, with the seat belt fastened and seat bar lowered, until the lift arm support device is removed and the lift arms are lowered all the way. Start the engine and raise the lift arms all the way up. Have a second person remove the lift arm support device. Lower the lift arms all the way and stop the engine. Return the lift arm support device to the storage position and secure with clamping knobs. Remove the jackstands. P100005 P100005A 10-30-1 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR CAB Description The Bobcat loader has an operator cab (ROPS and FOPS) as standard equipment to protect the operator from rollover and falling objects. The seat belt must be worn for rollover protection. Check the ROPS / FOPS cab, mounting and hardware for damage. Never modify the ROPS / FOPS cab. Replace the cab and hardware if damaged. See your Bobcat dealer for parts. ROPS / FOPS - Roll Over Protective Structure per ISO 3471, and Falling Object Protective Structure per ISO 3449, Level I. Level II is available. Level I Protection from falling bricks, small concrete blocks, and hand tools encountered in operations such as highway maintenance, landscaping, and other construction sites. Level II Protection from falling trees, rocks: for machines involved in site clearing, overhead demolition or forestry. WARNING Never modify operator cab by welding, grinding, drilling holes or adding attachments unless instructed to do so by Bobcat Company. Changes to the cab can cause loss of operator protection from rollover and falling objects, and result in injury or death. W-2069-0200 10-30-2 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR CAB (CONT'D) Raising Always stop the engine before raising or lowering the operator cab. Stop the loader on a level surface. Lower the lift arms. If the lift arms must be up while raising the operator cab, install the lift arm support device. (See LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE on Page 10-20-1.) Figure 10-30-1 Install jackstands under the rear of the loader frame [Figure 10-30-1]. Figure 10-30-2 Remove the nuts and washers [Figure 10-30-2] (both sides) at the front corners of the operator cab. WARNING UNEXPECTED LOADER, LIFT ARM OR ATTACHMENT MOVEMENT CAUSED BY CAB CONTACT WITH CONTROLS CAN CAUSE SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH • STOP ENGINE before raising or lowering cab. W-2758-0908 NOTE: On some machines, the operator cab frame could contact the steering levers while raising or lowering the operator cab. The engine MUST be stopped before raising or lowering the operator cab. Figure 10-30-3 Lift on the grab handles and bottom of the operator cab [Figure 10-30-3] slowly until the operator cab is all the way up and the latching mechanism engages. P-85463A Hardware Removed P-90511A P-90512A Hardware Installed P-90564A 10-30-3 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR CAB (CONT'D) Lowering Always stop the engine before raising or lowering the operator cab. NOTE: Always use the grab handles to lower the operator cab. Figure 10-30-4 Pull down on the bottom of the operator cab until it stops at the latching mechanism [Figure 10-30-4]. NOTE: The weight of the operator cab increases when equipped with options and accessories such as cab door, heater, air conditioning, etc. In these cases, the operator cab may need to be raised slightly from the latch to be able to release the latch. WARNING UNEXPECTED LOADER, LIFT ARM OR ATTACHMENT MOVEMENT CAUSED BY CAB CONTACT WITH CONTROLS CAN CAUSE SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH • STOP ENGINE before raising or lowering cab. W-2758-0908 NOTE: On some machines, the operator cab frame could contact the steering levers while raising or lowering the operator cab. The engine MUST be stopped before raising or lowering the operator cab. Support the operator cab and release the latching mechanism (Inset) [Figure 10-30-4]. Remove your hand from the latch mechanism when the operator cab is past the latch stop. Use both hands to lower the operator cab all the way down. WARNING PINCH POINT CAN CAUSE INJURY Remove your hand from the latching mechanism when the cab is past the latch stop. W-2469-0803 Figure 10-30-5 Install the washers and nuts (both sides) [Figure 10-30- 5]. Tighten the nuts to 54 - 61 N•m (40 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90565A N-20120 Hardware Installed P-90512A P-90511A Hardware Removed 10-30-4 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR CAB (CONT’D) Cab Door Sensor This machine may be equipped with a Cab Door Sensor. Figure 10-30-6 The cab door has a sensor (Item 1) [Figure 10-30-6] installed which deactivates the lift and tilt valves when the door is open. A decal is located on the latch mechanism (Item 2) [Figure 10-30-6]. The LIFT & TILT VALVE light (Item 3) [Figure 10-30-6] will be OFF when the door is closed, the key switch is turned to RUN or the RUN button is pressed, the seat bar is lowered and the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button is pressed. Figure 10-30-7 The LIFT & TILT VALVE light (Item 3) [Figure 10-30-6] will be ON when the door is open, the key switch is turned to RUN or the RUN button is pressed, the seat bar is lowered and the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button is pressed. [DOOR] will appear in the data display [Figure 10-30-7]. Special Applications Kit WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Some attachment applications can cause flying debris or objects to enter front, top or rear cab openings. Install the Special Applications Kit to provide added operator protection in these applications. W-2737-0508 Figure 10-30-8 Available for special applications to restrict material from entering cab openings. Kit includes 1/2 inch thick polycarbonate front door and polycarbonate rear window [Figure 10-30-8]. Polycarbonate top window (standard item) must be installed for special applications to restrict material from entering cab openings. See your Bobcat dealer for availability. Special Applications Kit Inspection And Maintenance • Inspect for cracks or damage. Replace if required. • Pre-rinse with water to remove gritty materials. • Wash with a mild household detergent and warm water. • Use a sponge or soft cloth. Rinse well with water and dry with a clean soft cloth or rubber squeegee. • Do not use abrasive or highly alkaline cleaners. • Do not clean with metal blades or scrapers. 3 P-68116 P-68115 2 1 S3999A NA1026 10-40-1 S650 Service Manual TRANSPORTING LOADER ON A TRAILER Loading And Unloading WARNING AVOID SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH Adequately designed ramps of sufficient strength are needed to support the weight of the machine when loading onto a transport vehicle. Wood ramps can break and cause personal injury. W-2058-0807 Be sure the transport and towing vehicles are of adequate size and capacity for weight of loader. (See Performance on Page SPEC-10-2.) Figure 10-40-1 A loader with an empty bucket or no attachment must be loaded backward onto the transport vehicle [Figure 10- 40-1]. The rear of the trailer must be blocked or supported (Item 1) [Figure 10-40-1] when loading or unloading the loader to prevent the front end of the trailer from raising up. Fastening Figure 10-40-2 Use the following procedure to fasten the Bobcat loader to the transport vehicle to prevent the loader from moving during sudden stops or when going up or down slopes [Figure 10-40-2]. 1. Lower the bucket or attachment to the floor. 2. Stop the engine. 3. Engage the parking brake. 4. Install chains at the front and rear loader tie down positions [Figure 10-40-2]. (Lift arms shown raised for clarity.) 5. Fasten each end of the chain to the transport vehicle. 6. Use chain binders to tighten the chains. P-90560A 1 P-90561A P-85615A Rear Tie Down P-85616A Front Tie Down P-85466 P-85717A Alternate Rear Tie Down P-85599A Alternate Front Tie Down 10-40-2 S650 Service Manual 10-50-1 S650 Service Manual TOWING THE LOADER Procedure Because of the design of the loader, there is not a recommended towing procedure. • The loader can be lifted onto a transport vehicle. • The loader can be skidded a short distance to move for service (EXAMPLE: Move onto a transport vehicle.) without damage to the hydrostatic system. (The tires will not turn.) There might be slight wear to the tires when the loader is skidded. The towing chain (or cable) must be rated at 1.5 times the weight of the loader. (See Performance on Page SPEC- 10-2.) 10-50-2 S650 Service Manual 10-60-1 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 Remote Start Tool - MEL1563 Tools that will be needed to complete the following steps are: MEL1563 - Remote Start Tool MEL1565 - Service Tool Harness Control MEL1566 - Service Tool Harness Communicator (Computer Interface) Figure 10-60-1 The remote start tool (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-1] is required when the service technician is checking the hydraulic / hydrostatic system, adjusting the steering linkage, and electrical diagnostics. Figure 10-60-2 The traction lock switch (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-2] is used to turn traction lock ON or OFF. Push the switch to the override position. The switch will illuminate to indicate traction lock OVERRIDE, in this position the wheels are able to turn. The maximum flow / variable flow switch (Item 2) [Figure 10-60-2] is used to activate the auxiliary hydraulics. Pressing the switch will activate variable flow. The switch will illuminate to indicate the flow rate is active. Pressing the switch again will turn the flow OFF. The switch is used when checking pressures and flow rate. NOTE: With the engine running; pushing and holding the pressure release switch (Item 3) [Figure 10-60-2] will cause the engine to stop. P16114 1 P16117 1 2 3 10-60-2 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL-MEL1563 (CONT'D) Service Tool Harness Control - MEL1565 Figure 10-60-3 The service tool harness control (Item 1) is used to connect the remote start tool (Item 2) [Figure 10-60-3] to the electrical system on the loader. Figure 10-60-4 Remove the cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-4] from the loader harness connector. Connect the service tool harness control to the loader harness connector. Figure 10-60-5 Loaders equipped with an attachment harness (Item 1) must disconnect the attachment harness from the loader harness (Item 2) [Figure 10-60-5]. Connect the service tool harness to the ACD connector and the loader harness connector. NOTE: To monitor, diagnose or load new software the Service PC must be connected to the Remote Start Tool. P16114 2 1 P-85729 1 P-85728 1 2 10-60-3 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL-MEL1563 (CONT'D) Service Tool Harness Communicator - MEL1566 Figure 10-60-6 The service tool harness communicator (Item 1) is required to connect remote start tool to the Service PC (Item 2) [Figure 10-60-6]. Remote Start Procedure The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1563: Remote Start Tool Kit Figure 10-60-7 The remote start tool (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-7] is required when the operator cab is in the raised position for service and the service technician needs to turn the key switch on or start the engine. Example: adjusting the steering linkage. Lift and block the loader. Raise the lift arms (if required by the procedure) and install an approved lift arm support device. Raise the operator cab (if required by the procedure). Open the rear door of the loader. P16119 1 2 P16115 1 10-60-4 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 (CONT’D) Remote Start Procedure (Cont'd) Figure 10-60-8 Figure 10-60-9 Remove the cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-8]. OR Disconnect the attachment control harness (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-9] (If equipped). Figure 10-60-10 Figure 10-60-11 Connect the remote start tool to the engine harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-10]. OR Connect the remote start tool to the engine harness connector (Item 1) and to the attachment control harness (Item 2) [Figure 10-60-11] (If equipped). NOTE: The key switch on the right-hand side operator panel must be in the off position or the Remote Start Tool Kit will not operate. P-85729 1 P-85728 1 P-85728 1 P-85726 1 2 10-60-5 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 (CONT'D) Remote Start Procedure (Cont'd) WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH With the 7-pin connector plugged into the loader and Remote Start Key Switch in the OFF position, the loader can still be started from the operator panel inside the cab. Placing the key switch of the remote start tool in the run position disconnects the operator panel key switch from the start circuit. If the service technician will be working the engine area it is important to remove the operator panel keys. W-2357-0899 Figure 10-60-12 The remote start tool (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-12] has three rocker switches. Figure 10-60-13 The traction lock switch (Item 1) [Figure 10-60-13] is used to turn traction lock ON or OFF. Push the switch to the override position. The switch will illuminate to indicate traction lock OVERRIDE, in this position the wheels are able to turn. The maximum flow / variable flow switch (Item 2) [Figure 10-60-13] is used to activate the auxiliary hydraulics. Pressing the switch will activate variable flow. The switch will illuminate to indicate the flow rate is active. Pressing the switch again will turn the flow OFF. The switch is used when checking pressures and flow rate. NOTE: With the engine running; pushing and holding the pressure release switch (Item 3) [Figure 10-60-13] will cause the engine to stop. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH • Use traction lock override switch for service work with seat bar raised. • Traction lock is engaged when light is OFF. • Lift and block the loader. Check that wheels are clear. • Traction lock is disengaged when light is ON. • See Service Manual for more instruction. W-2785-0209 P16116 1 P16118 3 2 1 10-60-6 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 (CONT'D) Remote Start Procedure (Cont'd) Figure 10-60-14 Push the couplers on the front auxiliary block toward the block and hold for five seconds to release the front auxiliary pressure [Figure 10-60-14]. P-85311 10-61-1 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 Description The Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) Kit is a replacement tool for MEL 1563 Remote Start Tool and MEL 1400B - BOSS® Diagnostic Tool. The Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) Kit, P/N 7003031, can be used to service newer loaders using the supplied harness P/N 6689747. A computer can be connected to the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) for diagnostics and software updates using the computer harness P/N 6689746 in conjunction with the loader harness. 10-61-2 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 (CONT'D) Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) - 7003030 Tools that will be needed to complete the following steps are: Order from Bobcat Parts P/N: 7003031 - Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) Kit Kit Includes: 7003030 - Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) 6689747 - Loader Service Tool Harness 6689746 - Computer Service Tool Harness 6689745 - BOSS® Service Tool Harness Figure 10-61-1 The remote start tool (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-1] is required when the service technician is checking the hydraulic / hydrostatic system, adjusting the steering linkage, and electrical diagnostics. Figure 10-61-2 The Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) (Item 1) [Figure 10- 61-2] has five buttons. The STOP button (Item 2) [Figure 10-61-2] is used to stop the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) from communicating and stop the loader engine. The RUN button (Item 3) [Figure 10-61-2] is used to turn the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) on and activates the loader ignition power. The button will illuminate to indicate the service tool is active. The START button (Item 4) [Figure 10-61-2] is used to start the loader engine. The traction lock button (Item 5) [Figure 10-61-2] is used to turn traction lock ON or OFF. Push the button and the button will illuminate indicating the traction lock is disabled in which the wheels or tracks are able to turn. The auxiliary button (Item 6) [Figure 10-61-2] is used to activate the auxiliary hydraulics. The button will illuminate to indicate the auxiliary hydraulics are active. Pressing the button a second time will turn the flow OFF. The button is used when checking pressures and flow rate. P-76678 1 P-76439 2 5 6 4 3 1 10-61-3 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 (CONT'D) Loader Service Tool Harness - 6689747 Figure 10-61-3 The loader service tool harness (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-3] is used to connect the remote start tool (service tool) (Item 2) [Figure 10-61-3] to the electrical system on the loader. Figure 10-61-4 Loaders without an attachment control harness, remove the loader harness cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-4] and connect the Loader Service Tool Harness from the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool). Figure 10-61-5 Loaders with an attachment control harness (7 pin or 14 pin), the attachment harness (Item 1) must be disconnected from the loader harness (Item 2) [Figure 10-61-5]. When the remote start procedure is completed, replace the loader connector cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-4] or reconnect the attachment control harness to the loader harness [Figure 10-61-5]. P-76678 2 1 P-85729 1 P-85725 1 2 10-61-4 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 (CONT'D) Loader Service Tool Harness - 6689747 (Cont’d) Figure 10-61-6 NOTE: The Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) connection harness has two connectors (Item 1) and (Item 3). The main connector (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-6] is always used for connection to the loader harness. The second connector (Item 3) [Figure 10-61- 6] is used for attachment ACD upgrades or attachment operational diagnostics only. This connector has a cap attached to it to prevent damage or corrosion when not in use. Connect the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) connector (Item 1) to the loader harness connector (Item 2) and the other Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) connector to the ACD harness connector (Item 3) [Figure 10-61-6]. NOTE: The key switch must be in the off position or the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) will not operate. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH • Lift and block the machine. • Check that wheels or tracks are clear. • Cab ignition must be in the “STOP” position to start the engine with the Service Tool (if applicable). • See machine Service Manual for more instructions. W-2792-0409 Computer Service Tool Harness - 6689746 Figure 10-61-7 The computer service tool harness (Item 1) [Figure 10- 61-7] is required to connect remote start tool (service tool) to the Service PC (Item 2) [Figure 10-61-7]. P-85726 1 2 3 P-76450 1 2 10-61-5 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 (CONT'D) Remote Start Procedure WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH With the 7-pin connector plugged into the loader and Remote Start Key Switch in the OFF position, the loader can still be started from the operator panel inside the cab. Placing the key switch of the remote start tool in the run position disconnects the operator panel key switch from the start circuit. If the service technician will be working the engine area it is important to remove the operator panel keys. W-2357-0899 The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: 7003031: Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) Kit Figure 10-61-8 The Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) (Item 1) [Figure 10- 61-8] is required when the operator cab is in the raised position for service and the service technician needs to turn on the loader or start the engine. Example: adjusting the steering linkage. Lift and block the loader. Raise the lift arms (if required by the procedure) and install an approved lift arm support device. Raise the operator cab (if required by the procedure). Open the rear door of the loader. Figure 10-61-9 Loaders without an attachment control harness, remove the loader harness cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-9] and connect the Loader Service Tool Harness from the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool). NOTE: When using a Remote Start Tool (Service tool) harness on loaders not equipped with an attachment control device, the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) harness attachment control device connector must be capped. Figure 10-61-10 Loaders with an attachment control harness (7 pin or 14 pin), the attachment harness (Item 1) must be disconnected from the loader harness (Item 2) [Figure 10-61-10]. When the remote start procedure is completed, replace the loader connector cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-10] or reconnect the attachment control harness to the loader harness. P-76450 1 P-85729 1 P-85725 1 2 10-61-6 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 (CONT'D) Remote Start Procedure (Cont'd) Figure 10-61-11 NOTE: The Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) connection harness has two connectors (Item 1) and (Item 3). The main connector (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-11] is always used for connection to the loader harness. The second connector (Item 3) [Figure 10-61- 11] is used for attachment ACD upgrades or attachment operational diagnostics only. This connector has a cap attached to it to prevent damage or corrosion when not in use. Connect the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) connector (Item 1) to the loader harness connector (Item 2) and the other Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) connector to the ACD harness connector (Item 3) [Figure 10-61-11]. NOTE: The key switch must be in the off position or the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) will not operate. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH • Lift and block the machine. • Check that wheels or tracks are clear. • Cab ignition must be in the “STOP” position to start the engine with the Service Tool (if applicable). • See machine Service Manual for more instructions. W-2792-0409 Figure 10-61-12 The Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) (Item 1) [Figure 10- 61-12] has five buttons. The STOP button (Item 2) [Figure 10-61-12] is used to stop the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) from communicating and stop the loader engine. The RUN button (Item 3) [Figure 10-61-12] is used to turn the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) on and activates the loader ignition power. The button will illuminate to indicate the service tool is active. The START button (Item 4) [Figure 10-61-12] is used to start the loader engine. The traction lock button (Item 5) [Figure 10-61-12] is used to turn traction lock ON or OFF. Push the button and the button will illuminate indicating the traction lock is disabled in which the wheels or tracks are able to turn. The auxiliary button (Item 6) [Figure 10-61-12] is used to activate the auxiliary hydraulics. The button will illuminate to indicate the auxiliary hydraulics are active. Pressing the button a second time will turn the flow OFF. The button is used when checking pressures and flow rate. P-85726 1 2 3 P-76439 2 5 6 4 3 1 10-61-7 S650 Service Manual REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 (CONT'D) Remote Start Procedure (Cont'd) Figure 10-61-13 The gear icon with the left facing arrows (Item 1) [Figure 10-61-13] will illuminate and blink when the RUN key is pressed and the loader is communicating with the service tool. The computer icon with the right facing arrows (Item 2) [Figure 10-61-13] will illuminate and blink when the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) is transmitting data to and from the computer. NOTE: To relieve the pressure at the rear or secondary front auxiliary, (if equipped) press the RUN button on the remote start tool. Then press the auxiliary (AUX) hydraulics button on the remote start tool and move the AUXILIARY Hydraulic Switch to the right and left several times. Figure 10-61-14 Push the couplers on the front auxiliary block toward the block and hold for five seconds to release the front auxiliary pressure [Figure 10-61-14]. P-76441 1 2 P-85311 10-61-8 S650 Service Manual 10-70-1 S650 Service Manual SERVICE SCHEDULE Chart Maintenance work must be done at regular intervals. Failure to do so will result in excessive wear and early failures. The service schedule is a guide for correct maintenance of the Bobcat loader. [1] Check every 8 - 10 hours for the first 24 hours, then at 50 hour intervals. [2] Perform at first 50 hours, then as scheduled. [3] Change oil and filter every 100 hours when operating under severe conditions. [4] Perform at first 500 hours, then as scheduled. [5] Or every 12 months. SERVICE SCHEDULE HOURS ITEM SERVICE REQUIRED 8-10 50 100 [5] 250 [5] 500 [5] 1000 Engine Oil Check the oil level and add as needed. Do not overfill. Engine Air Filter and Air System Check display panel. Service only when required. Check for leaks and damaged components. Engine Cooling System Clean debris from oil cooler, radiator and grille. Check coolant level COLD and add premixed coolant as needed. Fuel Filter Remove the trapped water. Lift Arms, Lift Links, Cylinders, Bob-Tach, Pivot Pins, Wedges Lubricate with multi-purpose lithium based grease. Tires Check for damaged tires and correct air pressure. Inflate to MAXIMUM pressure shown on the sidewall of the tire. Seat Bar, Control Interlocks, Seat Belt, Seat Belt Retractors Check the condition of seat belt. Clean or replace seat belt retractors as needed. Check the seat bar and control interlocks for correct operation. Clean dirt and debris from moving parts. Bobcat Interlock Control Systems (BICS) Check for correct function. Lift and Tilt functions MUST NOT operate with seat bar raised. See details in this Manual. Front Horn / Back-up Alarm Check for proper function. Safety Signs and Safety Treads Check for damaged signs (decals) and safety treads. Replace any signs or safety treads that are damaged or worn. Operator Cab Check the fastening bolts, washers and nuts. Check the condition of the cab. Indicators and Lights Check for correct operation of all indicators and lights. Heater and A/C Filters (If Equipped) Clean or replace filters as needed. Hydraulic Fluid Check fluid level and add as needed. Hydraulic Hoses and Tubelines Check for damage and leaks. Repair or replace as needed. Final Drive Trans. (Chaincase), Check fluid level and add as needed. Parking Brake, Foot Pedals, Hand Controls and Steering Levers or Joysticks Check for correct operation. Repair or adjust as needed. Wheel Nuts Check for loose wheel nuts and tighten to correct torque. (See TIRE MAINTENANCE in this manual.) [1] Spark Arrestor Muffler Clean the spark chamber. Battery Check cables, connections and electrolyte level. Add distilled water as needed. Fuel Filter Replace filter element. Engine / Hydro. Drive Belt Check for wear or damage. Check idler arm stop. [2] Drive Belts (Alternator, air conditioning, water pump) Check condition. Replace as needed. Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS) Check the function of the lift arm bypass control. Engine Oil and Filter Replace oil and filter. [2] [3] Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Filter, Charge Filter, Reservoir Breather Replace the hydraulic / hydrostatic filter, charge filter, and the reservoir breather. Final Drive Trans. (Chaincase) Replace the fluid. Hydraulic Reservoir Replace the fluid. Engine Valves Adjust the engine valves. [4] Coolant Replace the coolant Every 2 years WARNING Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Operator’s Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-0903 10-70-2 S650 Service Manual 10-80-1 S650 Service Manual AIR CLEANER SERVICE Replacing Filter Elements Figure 10-80-1 It is important to change the air filter element only when necessary. The service indicator (Item 1) will FLASH. Press the information button (Item 3) until the display screen (Item 2) shows the service codes. Service code [M0117] (Air Filter Plugged) will show in the display screen (Item 2) [Figure 10-80-1] when air filter change is necessary. Replace the inner filter every third time the outer filter is replaced or as indicated. Outer Filter Figure 10-80-2 Open the latches (Item 1) and remove the dust cover (Item 2) [Figure 10-80-2]. Figure 10-80-3 Pull the outer filter element (Item 1) [Figure 10-80-3] out and discard. NOTE: Make sure all sealing surfaces are free of dirt and debris. DO NOT use compressed air. Install new filter element. Push all the way in until it contacts the base of the housing. Install the dust cover and secure the latches [Figure 10- 80-2]. P-76460G 1 2 3 P100072 2 1 P-90523A 1 10-80-2 S650 Service Manual AIR CLEANER SERVICE (CONT’D) Replacing Filter Elements (Cont’d) Inner Filter Only replace the inner filter element under the following conditions: • Replace the inner filter element every third time the outer filter is replaced. • After the outer element has been replaced, start the engine and run at full RPM. If service code [M0117] (Air Filter Plugged) is still displayed in the data display, replace the inner filter element. Remove the dust cover [Figure 10-80-2] and the outer filter element [Figure 10-80-3]. Figure 10-80-4 Remove the inner filter element (Item 1) [Figure 10-80- 4]. NOTE: Make sure all sealing surfaces are free of dirt and debris. DO NOT use compressed air. Install new inner filter element. Push all the way in until it contacts the base of the housing. Install the outer filter element [Figure 10-80-3]. Figure 10-80-5 Install the dust cover (Item 2) and secure the latches (Item 1) [Figure 10-80-5]. P-90524A 1 P100072 2 1 10-90-1 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM Check the cooling system every day to prevent over- heating, loss of performance or engine damage. Maintenance Platform Figure 10-90-1 A maintenance platform (Item 1) [Figure 10-90-1] is available from your Bobcat dealer to facilitate access when cleaning the engine cooling system. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Wear safety glasses to prevent eye injury when any of the following conditions exist: • When fluids are under pressure. • Flying debris or loose material is present. • Engine is running. • Tools are being used. W-2019-0907 Cleaning Open the rear door. (See REAR DOOR (TAILGATE) on Page 50-70-1.) Remove the rear grille. (See REAR GRILLE on Page 50- 60-1.) Loaders With Air Conditioning Figure 10-90-2 Use low air pressure or water pressure to clean the top of the air conditioning condenser (Item 1) [Figure 10-90-2]. The area between the air conditioning condenser and the oil cooler will require occasional cleaning. Remove the bolts (Item 2) and the brackets (Item 3) [Figure 10-90-2]. Figure 10-90-3 NOTE: Be careful when raising and lowering the air conditioning condenser so that the air conditioning condenser does not fall on the oil cooler and damage the fins. Raise the air conditioning condenser (Item 1) and use low air pressure or water pressure to clean the top of the oil cooler (Item 2) [Figure 10-90-3]. Lower the air conditioning condenser (Item 1) [Figure 10-90-3]. Install the brackets (Item 3) [Figure 10-90-2] and the bolts (Item 2) [Figure 10-90-2]. P100040A 1 P100180 1 3 2 2 P100056A 1 2 10-90-2 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT’D) Cleaning (Cont’d) Loaders Without Air Conditioning Figure 10-90-4 Use low air pressure or water pressure to clean the top of the oil cooler (Item 1) [Figure 10-90-4]. All Loaders Unhook the two rubber straps (Item 2) [Figure 10-90-4]. Figure 10-90-5 Raise the oil cooler (Item 1) until the bar (Item 2) drops into place to support the oil cooler. Use low air pressure or water pressure to clean the top of the radiator (Item 3) [Figure 10-90-5]. Raise the bar (Item 2) [Figure 10-90-5] slightly and lower the oil cooler. Fasten the two rubber straps. Check the cooling system for leaks. Install the rear grille and close the rear door. P100181 1 2 P100179 3 1 2 10-90-3 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT’D) Checking Level Open the rear door and raise the rear grille. Figure 10-90-6 Check coolant level using the level markers (Item 2) [Figure 10-90-6] on the tank. Coolant must be at the bottom marker when the engine is cold; top marker when hot. Lower the rear grille and close the rear door. IMPORTANT AVOID ENGINE DAMAGE Always use the correct ratio of water to antifreeze. Too much antifreeze reduces cooling system efficiency and may cause serious premature engine damage. Too little antifreeze reduces the additives which protect the internal engine components; reduces the boiling point and freeze protection of the system. Always add a premixed solution. Adding full strength concentrated coolant can cause serious premature engine damage. I-2124-0497 Removing And Replacing Coolant For the service interval for replacing the engine coolant (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Open the rear door and remove the rear grille. Remove the coolant fill cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-90-6]. Figure 10-90-7 Disconnect the coolant hose (Item 1) [Figure 10-90-7] from the oil filter assembly. Drain the coolant into a container. Connect the coolant hose to the oil filter assembly. Recycle or dispose of coolant in an environmentally safe manner. Mix new coolant in a separate container. (See Capacities on Page SPEC-10-4.) The correct mixture of coolant to provide a -37°C (-34°F) freeze protection is 5 L propylene glycol mixed with 4,4 L of water OR 1 U.S. gal propylene glycol mixed with 3.5 qt of water. NOTE: The loader is factory filled with propylene glycol coolant (purple color). DO NOT mix propylene glycol with ethylene glycol. Add premixed coolant, 47% water and 53% propylene glycol to the coolant tank until the coolant level reaches the lower marker on the tank [Figure 10-90-6]. Use a refractometer to check the condition of propylene glycol in your cooling system and install coolant fill cap. NOTE: When installing the coolant fill cap, the cap must be tightened until it clicks. Run the engine until it is at operating temperature. Stop the engine. Check the coolant level when cool. Add coolant as needed. Install the rear grille and close the rear door. P-90529A 2 1 P-85606 1 10-90-4 S650 Service Manual 10-100-1 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM Fuel Specifications Use only clean, high quality diesel fuel, Grade No. 2 or Grade No. 1. The following is one suggested blending guideline which should prevent fuel gelling during cold temperatures: At a minimum, Low Sulfur (500 ppm sulfur) Diesel Fuel must be used in this machine: The following fuels may also be used in this machine: • Ultra Low Sulfur (15 ppm sulfur) Diesel Fuel. • Biodiesel Blend Fuel - Must contain no more than five percent biodiesel mixed with low sulfur or ultra low sulfur petroleum based diesel. This is commonly marketed as B5 blended diesel fuel. B5 blended diesel fuel must meet ASTM D975 (US Standard) or EN590 (EU Standard) specifications. Biodiesel Blend Fuel Biodiesel blend fuel has unique qualities that should be considered before using in this machine: • Cold weather conditions can lead to plugged fuel system components and hard starting. • Biodiesel blend fuel is an excellent medium for microbial growth and contamination which can cause corrosion and plugging of fuel system components. • Use of biodiesel blend fuel may result in premature failure of fuel system components, such as plugged fuel filters and deteriorated fuel lines. • Shorter maintenance intervals may be required, such as cleaning the fuel system and replacing fuel filters and fuel lines. • Using biodiesel blended fuels containing more than five percent biodiesel can affect engine life and cause deterioration of hoses, tubelines, injectors, injector pump and seals. Apply the following guidelines if biodiesel blend fuel is used: • Ensure the fuel tank is as full as possible at all times to prevent moisture from collecting in the fuel tank. • Ensure that the fuel tank cap is securely tightened. • Biodiesel blend fuel can damage painted surfaces, remove all spilled fuel from painted surfaces immediately. • Drain all water from the fuel filter daily before operating the machine. • Do not exceed engine oil change interval. Extended oil change intervals can cause engine damage. • Before vehicle storage; drain the fuel tank, refill with 100% petroleum diesel fuel, add fuel stabilizer and run the engine for at least 30 minutes. NOTE: Biodiesel blend fuel does not have long term stability and should not be stored for more than three months. TEMPERATURE NO. 2 NO. 1 -9°C (+15°F) 100% 0% Down to -29°C (-20°F) 50% 50% Below -29°C (-20°F) 0% 100% 10-100-2 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT’D) Filling The Fuel Tank WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Stop and cool the engine before adding fuel. NO SMOKING! Failure to obey warnings can cause an explosion or fire. W-2063-0807 Open the rear door. Figure 10-100-1 Remove the fill cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-100-1]. Figure 10-100-2 Use a clean, approved safety container to add fuel of the correct specification. Add fuel only in an area that has free movement of air and no open flames or sparks NO SMOKING [Figure 10-100-2]. Install and tighten the fuel cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-100- 1]. Close the rear door. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 P-85367 1 NA1684 WRONG 10-100-3 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT’D) Fuel Filter For the service interval for removing water from, or replacing the fuel filter (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Removing Water Figure 10-100-3 Loosen the drain (Item 1) [Figure 10-100-3] at the bottom of the filter element to remove water from the filter. Replacing Element Remove the filter element (Item 2) [Figure 10-100-3]. Clean the area around the filter housing. Put clean oil on the seal of the new filter element. Install the fuel filter, and hand tighten. Remove air from the fuel system. (See Removing Air From The Fuel System on Page 10-100-3.) WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 Removing Air From The Fuel System After replacing the filter element or when the fuel tank has run out of fuel, the air must be removed from the fuel system before starting the engine. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 Figure 10-100-4 Open the vent (Item 2) [Figure 10-100-4] on the fuel filter housing. Squeeze the hand pump (priming bulb) (Item 1) [Figure 10-100-4] until fuel flows from the vent with no air bubbles. Close the vent (Item 2) [Figure 10-100-4]. P-85508 1 2 P-85507 2 1 10-100-4 S650 Service Manual 10-110-1 S650 Service Manual ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM Checking And Adding Engine Oil Check the engine oil level every day before starting the engine for the work shift. Figure 10-110-1 Park the machine on level ground. Open the rear door and remove the dipstick (Item 1) [Figure 10-110-1]. Keep the oil level between the marks on the dipstick. Do not overfill. Engine Oil Chart Figure 10-110-2 ENGINE OIL RECOMMENDED SAE VISCOSITY NUMBER (LUBRICATION OILS FOR DIESEL ENGINE CRANKCASE) TEMPERATURE RANGE ANTICIPATED BEFORE NEXT OIL CHANGE (DIESEL ENGINES MUST USE API CLASSIFICATION CI-4 OR BETTER) [1] Synthetic Oil - Use recommendation from Synthetic Oil Manufacturer. Use good quality engine oil that meets API Service Classification of CI-4 or better [Figure 10-110-2]. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 P-85506 1 10-110-2 S650 Service Manual ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM (CONT’D) Removing And Replacing Oil And Filter For the service interval for replacing the engine oil and filter (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Run the engine until it is at operating temperature. Stop the engine. Figure 10-110-3 The oil drain hose is located behind a cover under the right rear corner of the loader (Inset) [Figure 10-110-3]. Remove two cover mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 10- 110-3]. Loosen one cover mounting bolt (Item 2) and slide the cover (Item 3) [Figure 10-110-3] to the rear of the loader. Figure 10-110-4 Remove the oil drain cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-110-4] from the oil drain hose and drain the oil into a container. Recycle or dispose of used oil in an environmentally safe manner. Install and tighten the oil drain cap [Figure 10-110-4]. Install the cover and the cover mounting bolts [Figure 10-110-3]. Tighten all bolts. Figure 10-110-5 Open the rear door, remove the oil filter (Item 3) [Figure 10-110-5] and clean the filter housing surface. Use genuine Bobcat filter only. Put oil on the new filter gasket, install the filter and hand tighten. Remove the oil fill cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-110-5]. Put oil in the engine. For the correct quantity (See Capacities on Page SPEC-10-4.) Do not overfill. Start the engine and let it run for several minutes. Stop the engine and check for leaks at the filter. Remove the dipstick (Item 2) [Figure 10-110-5] and check the oil level. Add oil as needed if it is not at the top mark on the dipstick. Install the dipstick and close the rear door. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 P-90497A P-90499A 3 2 1 P-90498A 1 P-85506 1 2 3 10-120-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM Checking And Adding Fluid Check the hydraulic / hydrostatic fluid level every day before starting the work shift. Park the loader on a level surface, lower the lift arms and place the attachment flat on the ground or tilt the Bob- Tach fully back if no attachment is installed. Stop the engine. Figure 10-120-1 Check the fluid level in the sight gauge (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-1]. Keep the fluid level within the operating range. Remove the rear grille. (See REAR GRILLE on Page 50- 60-1.) Figure 10-120-2 Remove the fill cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-2]. Add fluid as needed to bring the level within the operating range in the sight gauge (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-1]. Install the fill cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-2] and install the rear grille. Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Fluid Chart Figure 10-120-3 HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FLUID RECOMMENDED ISO VISCOSITY GRADE (VG) AND VISCOSITY INDEX (VI) TEMPERATURE RANGE ANTICIPATED DURING MACHINE USE [1] VG 100; Minimum VI 130 [2] VG 46; Minimum VI 150 [3] BOBCAT All-Season Fluid [4] BOBCAT Synthetic Fluid [5] BOBCAT Biodegradable Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Fluid (Unlike biodegradable fluids that are vegetable based, Bobcat biodegradable fluid is formulated to prevent oxidation and thermal breakdown at operating temperatures.) Use only recommended fluid in the hydraulic system [Figure 10-120-3]. (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 P-90538A 1 P100055 1 10-120-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM (CONT’D) Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid For the correct service interval (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Replace the fluid if it becomes contaminated or after major repair. Always replace the hydraulic / hydrostatic filter and the hydraulic charge filter whenever the hydraulic fluid is replaced. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Filter on Page 10-120-4.) Remove the rear grille. (See REAR GRILLE on Page 50- 60-1.) Figure 10-120-4 Remove the hydraulic fill cap (Item 1) and unhook the two rubber straps (Item 2) [Figure 10-120-4]. Figure 10-120-5 Raise the oil cooler (Item 1) until the bar (Item 2) [Figure 10-120-5] drops into place to support the oil cooler. This will aid in draining the hydraulic fluid. Figure 10-120-6 Remove the right side access cover bolts (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-6] and remove the cover. (Lift arms shown raised for visual clarity.) 2 P100181 1 P100055 P100179 1 2 P100007 1 10-120-3 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM (CONT’D) Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid (Cont’d) Figure 10-120-7 Pinch off and disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 10- 120-7] from the cooling fan motor. Route the hose out the side of the loader and drain the fluid into a container. Connect the hose to the cooling fan motor when the fluid stops draining. Recycle or dispose of used fluid in an environmentally safe manner. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 Install the side access cover. Raise the bar supporting the oil cooler and lower the oil cooler. Fasten the two rubber straps. Figure 10-120-8 Remove and clean the hydraulic fill screen (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-8]. Use low air pressure to dry the screen. Install hydraulic fill screen and add the correct fluid to the reservoir until the fluid level is within the operating range of the sight gauge. (See Capacities on Page SPEC-10- 4.) and (See Checking And Adding Fluid on Page 10- 120-1.) Install the hydraulic fill cap. Install the rear grille. Start the engine and operate the loader hydraulic controls. Stop the engine and check for leaks. Check the fluid level in the reservoir and add as needed. (See Checking And Adding Fluid on Page 10-120-1.) P-85721 1 P-90506 1 10-120-4 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM (CONT’D) Removing And Replacing Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Filter For the correct service interval. (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Remove the rear grille. (See REAR GRILLE on Page 50- 60-1.) The filter housing is located behind the hydraulic fluid reservoir. Clean the top of the filter housing. Figure 10-120-9 Two types of filters are used on this model loader [Figure 10-120-9]. Select the correct procedure for your machine. Earlier Models Figure 10-120-10 Remove the filter (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-10] using a socket wrench. Figure 10-120-11 Discard the entire filter (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-11]. Clean the surface of the filter housing where the filter seal contacts the housing. Install new filter and tighten to 61 N•m (45 ft-lb) torque. P-90500A Earlier Model Later Model P100047A P-90500 1 P-85478 1 10-120-5 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM (CONT’D) Removing And Replacing Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Filter (Cont’d) Later Models Figure 10-120-12 Remove the filter cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-12]. Figure 10-120-13 Remove the filter element (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-13] and discard. Remove the O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 10-120-13] and discard. Install new O-ring and lubricate with clean oil. Install new filter element ensuring that element is fully seated in the housing. Install the filter cap and tighten to 25 N•m (18 ft-lb) torque. All Models WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 Install the rear grille. Start the engine and operate the loader hydraulic controls. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 Stop the engine and check for leaks at the filter. Check the fluid level in the reservoir and add as needed. (See Checking And Adding Fluid on Page 10-120-1.) P100047 1 P100046 1 P100044 2 10-120-6 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM (CONT’D) Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Charge Filter The hydraulic charge filter is located under the operator cab. For the correct service interval (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 10-120-14 Unhook the rubber straps (Item 1) and remove the lower fan duct (Item 2) [Figure 10-120-14]. Figure 10-120-15 Place a suitable container below the filter housing and remove the filter housing (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-15] using a socket wrench. Recycle or dispose of used fluid in an environmentally safe manner. Figure 10-120-16 Remove and discard the filter element (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-16]. Clean the surface of the filter housing and the filter base where they contact the filter element seal. Put clean oil on the seal of the new filter element. Install the element on the filter base. Install and tighten the filter housing to 47 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 Install the lower fan duct [Figure 10-120-14]. NOTE: Failure to install the lower fan duct correctly may result in decreased cooling. Lower the operator cab. (See Lowering on Page 10-30- 3.) Start the engine and operate the loader hydraulic controls. P-85470 2 1 P-85489 1 P-85489A 1 10-120-7 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM (CONT’D) Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Charge Filter (Cont’d) WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 Stop the engine and check for leaks at the filter. Check the fluid level in the reservoir and add as needed. (See Checking And Adding Fluid on Page 10-120-1.) Breather Cap See the SERVICE SCHEDULE for the correct replacement interval. (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Remove the rear grille. (See REAR GRILLE on Page 50- 60-1.) Figure 10-120-17 Remove the breather cap (Item 1) [Figure 10-120-17] and discard. Install new breather cap. Install the rear grille. P100055 1 10-120-8 S650 Service Manual 10-130-1 S650 Service Manual FINAL DRIVE TRANSMISSION (CHAINCASE) Checking And Adding Oil The chaincase contains the final drive sprockets and chains and uses the same type of oil as the hydraulic / hydrostatic system. (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) Stop the loader on a level surface and stop the engine. Figure 10-130-1 Remove the check plug (Item 1) [Figure 10-130-1] from the front of the chaincase housing. (Lift arms shown raised for clarity.) If oil can be reached with the tip of your finger through the hole, the oil level is correct. If the level is low, add oil through the check plug hole until the oil flows from the hole. Install and tighten the plug. Removing And Replacing Oil Figure 10-130-2 Remove the check plug (Item 1) [Figure 10-130-2] from the front of the chaincase housing. Figure 10-130-3 Pump the oil out of the chaincase [Figure 10-130-3]. Recycle or dispose of the used oil in an environmentally safe manner. Add oil through the check plug hole until the oil flows from the hole. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 1 P-85744 1 P-85745 P-85742 10-130-2 S650 Service Manual 10-140-1 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) Inspection And Maintenance Figure 10-140-1 Move the Bob-Tach levers down to engage the wedges [Figure 10-140-1]. The levers and wedges must move freely. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH The Bob-Tach wedges must extend through the holes in the attachment mounting frame. Levers must be fully down and locked. Failure to secure wedges can allow attachment to come off. W-2715-0208 Figure 10-140-2 The wedges (Item 1) [Figure 10-140-2] must extend through the holes in the attachment mounting frame. The spring loaded wedges (Item 1) must contact the lower edge of the holes in the attachment mounting frame (Item 2) [Figure 10-140-2]. If the wedges do not contact the lower edge of the holes [Figure 10-140-2], the attachment will be loose and can come off the Bob-Tach. Figure 10-140-3 Inspect the mounting frame on the attachment and Bob- Tach, linkages and wedges for excessive wear or damage [Figure 10-140-3]. Replace any parts that are damaged, bent or missing. Keep all fasteners tight. Look for cracked welds. Contact your Bobcat dealer for repair or replacement parts. Lubricate the wedges. (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) (See LUBRICATING THE LOADER on Page 10-150-1.) P-85513A P-31233A P-31233 2 1 Wedge must contact lowe r edge of hole in th e attachment mountin g frame. B-17460 10-140-2 S650 Service Manual 10-141-1 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) This machine may be equipped with a Power Bob-Tach. Inspection And Maintenance Figure 10-141-1 Push and hold the BOB-TACH “WEDGES UP” switch (Item 1) until wedges are fully raised. Push and hold the BOB-TACH “WEDGES DOWN” switch (Item 2) [Figure 10-141-1] until the wedges are fully down. The levers and wedges must move freely. WARNING Bob-Tach wedges must extend through the holes in attachment. Lever(s) must be fully down and locked. Failure to secure wedges can allow attachment to come off and cause injury or death. W-2102-0497 Figure 10-141-2 The wedges (Item 1) [Figure 10-141-2] must extend through the holes in the attachment mounting frame. The spring loaded wedges (Item 1) must contact the lower edge of the holes in the attachment mounting frame (Item 2) [Figure 10-141-2]. If the wedges do not contact the lower edge of the holes [Figure 10-141-2], the attachment will be loose and can come off the Bob-Tach. Figure 10-141-3 Inspect the mounting frame on the attachment and Bob- Tach, linkages and wedges for excessive wear or damage [Figure 10-141-3]. Replace any parts that are damaged, bent or missing. Keep all fasteners tight. Look for cracked welds. Contact your Bobcat dealer for repair or replacement parts. Lubricate the wedges. (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) and (See LUBRICATING THE LOADER on Page 10-150-1.) P-85320A 1 2 P-31233A P-31233 2 1 Wedge must contact lowe r edge of hole in th e attachment mountin g frame. B-17460 10-141-2 S650 Service Manual 10-150-1 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATING THE LOADER Lubrication Locations Lubricate the loader as specified for the best performance of the loader. (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Record the operating hours each time you lubricate the Bobcat loader. Always use a good quality lithium based multi-purpose grease when you lubricate the loader. Apply the lubricant until extra grease shows. Remove attachment from the loader. Tilt the Bob-Tach forward until it contacts the ground. Stop the engine. Lubricate the following: Figure 10-150-1 1. Rod End Lift Cylinder (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10- 150-1]. Figure 10-150-2 2. Base End Lift Cylinder (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10- 150-2]. Figure 10-150-3 3. Lift Arm Pivot Pin (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10-150-3]. Figure 10-150-4 4. Lift Arm Link Pivot (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10-150-4]. P-90540 1 P-90572A 2 P-90543A 3 P-90542A 4 10-150-2 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATING THE LOADER (CONT’D) Lubrication Locations (Cont’d) Figure 10-150-5 5. Base End Tilt Cylinder (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10- 150-5]. Figure 10-150-6 6. Rod End Tilt Cylinder (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10- 150-6]. Figure 10-150-7 7. Bob-Tach Pivot Pin (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10-150- 7]. Figure 10-150-8 8. Bob-Tach Wedge (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10-150-8]. P-85484 5 P-85720 6 P-85719 7 P-85487 8 10-150-3 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATING THE LOADER (CONT’D) Lubrication Locations (Cont’d) Figure 10-150-9 9. Rear Control Link (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10-150-9]. Figure 10-150-10 10. Front Control Link (Both Sides) (2) [Figure 10-150- 10]. P-90570A 9 P-90544A 10 10-150-4 S650 Service Manual 10-160-1 S650 Service Manual TIRE MAINTENANCE Wheel Nuts Figure 10-160-1 See your SERVICE SCHEDULE for the correct interval to check the wheel nuts [Figure 10-160-1]. (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) When installing wheel nuts, tighten to 217 N•m (160 ft-lb) torque. When checking wheel nut torque, set the torque wrench to 190 N•m (140 ft-lb) to prevent over-tightening. Rotating Check the tires regularly for wear, damage and pressure. Figure 10-160-2 Rear tires usually wear faster than front tires. To keep tire wear even, move the front tires to the rear and rear tires to the front [Figure 10-160-2]. It is important to keep the same size tires on each side of the loader. If different sizes are used, each tire will be turning at a different rate and cause excessive wear. The tread bars of all the tires must face the same direction. Recommended tire pressure must be maintained to avoid excessive tire wear and loss of stability and handling capability. Check for correct pressure before operating the loader. Mounting Tires are to be repaired only by an authorized person using the proper procedures and safe equipment. Tires and rims must always be checked for correct size before mounting. Check rim and tire bead for damage. The rim flange must be cleaned and free of rust. The tire bead and rim flange must be lubricated with a rubber lubricant before mounting the tire. Avoid excessive pressure which can rupture the tire and cause serious injury or death. During inflation of the tire, check the tire pressure frequently to avoid over inflation. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Do not inflate tires above specified pressure. Failure to use correct tire mounting procedure can cause an explosion which can result in injury or death. W-2078-1007 IMPORTANT Inflate tires to the MAXIMUM pressure shown on the sidewall of the tire. DO NOT mix brands of tires used on the same loader. I-2057-0794 P-85479 NA1023A 10-160-2 S650 Service Manual 10-170-1 S650 Service Manual SPARK ARRESTOR MUFFLER Cleaning Procedure See the SERVICE SCHEDULE for service interval for cleaning the spark arrestor muffler. (See SERVICE SCHEDULE on Page 10-70-1.) Do not operate the loader with a defective exhaust system. IMPORTANT This machine is factory equipped with a U.S.D.A. Forestry Service approved spark arrestor exhaust system. The spark arrestor muffler, if equipped, must be cleaned to keep it in working condition. The spark arrestor muffler must be serviced by dumping the spark chamber every 100 hours of operation. On some models, the turbocharger functions as the spark arrestor and must operate correctly for proper spark arrestor function. If this machine is operated on flammable forest, brush, or grass covered land, it must be equipped with a spark arrestor attached to the exhaust system and maintained in working order. Failure to do so will be in violation of California State Law, Section 4442. PRC. Refer to local laws and regulations for spark arrestor requirements. I-2284-0409 Stop the engine and open the rear door. Figure 10-170-1 Remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 10-170-1] from the bottom of the muffler. WARNING When the engine is running during service, the driving and steering controls must be in neutral and the parking brake engaged. Failure to do so can cause injury or death. W-2006-1209 Start the engine and run for about 10 seconds while a second person, wearing safety glasses, holds a piece of wood over the outlet of the muffler. This will force contaminants out through the cleanout hole. Stop the engine. Install and tighten the plug. Close the rear door. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH When an engine is running in an enclosed area, fresh air must be added to avoid concentration of exhaust fumes. If the engine is stationary, vent the exhaust outside. Exhaust fumes contain odorless, invisible gases which can kill without warning. W-2050-0807 WARNING Stop engine and allow the muffler to cool before cleaning the spark chamber. Wear safety goggles. Failure to obey can cause serious injury. W-2011-1285 WARNING Never use machine in atmosphere with explosive dust or gases or where exhaust can contact flammable material. Failure to obey warnings can cause injury or death. W-2068-1285 P-85509 1 10-170-2 S650 Service Manual 10-180-1 S650 Service Manual PIVOT PINS Inspection And Maintenance Figure 10-180-1 All lift arm and cylinder pivots have a large pin held in position with a retainer bolt and lock nut (Item 1) [Figure 10-180-1]. Check that the lock nuts are tightened to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. P-90536A 1 10-180-2 S650 Service Manual 10-190-1 S650 Service Manual LOADER STORAGE AND RETURN TO SERVICE Storage Sometimes it may be necessary to store your Bobcat loader for an extend period of time. Below is a list of items to perform before storage. • Thoroughly clean the loader including the engine compartment. • Lubricate the loader. • Replace worn or damaged parts. • Park the loader in a dry protected shelter. • Lower the lift arms all the way and put the bucket flat on the ground. • Put blocks under the frame to remove weight from the tires. • Put grease on any exposed cylinder rods. • Put fuel stabilizer in the fuel tank and run the engine a few minutes to circulate the stabilizer to the pump and fuel injectors. If biodiesel blend fuel has been used, perform the following: Drain the fuel tank, refill with 100% petroleum diesel fuel, add fuel stabilizer and run the engine for at least 30 minutes. • Drain and flush the cooling system. Refill with premixed coolant. • Replace all fluids and filters (engine, hydraulic / hydrostatic). • Replace air cleaner, heater and air conditioning filters. • Put all controls in neutral position. • Remove the battery. Be sure the electrolyte level is correct then charge the battery. Store it in a cool dry place above freezing temperatures and charge it periodically during storage. • Cover the exhaust pipe opening. • Tag the machine to indicate that it is in storage condition. Return To Service After the Bobcat loader has been in storage, it is necessary to follow a list of items to return the loader to service. • Check the engine and hydraulic oil levels; check coolant level. • Install a fully charged battery. • Remove grease from exposed cylinder rods. • Check all belt tensions. • Be sure all shields and guards are in place. • Lubricate the loader. • Check tire inflation and remove blocks from under frame. • Remove cover from exhaust pipe opening. • Start the engine and let run for a few minutes while observing the instrument panels and systems for correct operation. • Operate machine, check for correct function. • Stop the engine and check for leaks. Repair as needed. 10-190-2 S650 Service Manual 10-200-1 S650 Service Manual STOPPING THE ENGINE AND LEAVING THE LOADER Procedure Stop the loader on level ground. Fully lower the lift arms and put the attachment flat on the ground. Figure 10-200-1 Push the engine speed control fully down [Figure 10- 200-1] to decrease the engine speed. Engage the parking brake. Figure 10-200-2 Turn the key switch to the STOP position (Item 1) or press the STOP button (Item 2) [Figure 10-200-2]. NOTE: If the loader lights are ON, they will remain ON for approximately 90 seconds after turning the loader OFF. Raise the seat bar and make sure the lift and tilt functions are deactivated. Unbuckle the seat belt. Remove the key from the switch (Standard Key Panel) to prevent operation of the loader by unauthorized personnel. NOTE: Activating the Password Lockout Feature on machines with the Keyless Start Panel or the Deluxe Instrumentation Panel allows operation of the loader without using a password. (See Password Lockout Feature on Page 60-190-2.) or (See Password Lockout Feature on Page 60-191-1.) Figure 10-200-3 Exit the loader using grab handles, safety tread and steps (maintaining a 3-point contact) [Figure 10-200-3]. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Before you leave the operator’s seat: • Lower the lift arms and put the attachment flat on the ground. • Stop the engine. • Engage the parking brake. • Raise the seat bar. • Move all controls to the NEUTRAL / LOCKED position to make sure the lift, tilt and traction drive functions are deactivated. The seat bar system must deactivate these functions when the seat bar is up. Service the system if controls do not deactivate. W-2463-0610 P-90525A P-90688A 1 P-90214A 2 P-85737A P-85735A 10-200-2 S650 Service Manual 10-210-1 S650 Service Manual EMERGENCY EXIT The front opening on the operator cab and rear window provide exits. External Access Figure 10-210-1 The rear window can be removed from outside the loader using a T40 TORX® driver. Turn both screws (Item 1) [Figure 10-210-1] in until the latches disengage from the window frame. Pull the top of the window away from the cab and lift up to remove. Rear Window NOTE: Use this procedure to remove the rear window only under emergency conditions. Damage to machine may occur. Figure 10-210-2 Turn both latches (Item 1) [Figure 10-210-2] in until they disengage from the window frame. Push the rear window out of the rear of the operator cab. Figure 10-210-3 Exit through the rear of the operator cab [Figure 10-210- 3]. Front Door This machine may be equipped with a front door. NOTE: Use this procedure to remove the front door only under emergency conditions. Damage to machine may occur. Figure 10-210-4 Turn both latches (Item 1) [Figure 10-210-4] down until they disengage from the door frame. Push the door out of the operator cab door frame. Exit through the opening. P-85724 1 P-85309A 1 P-90563A P-90725 1 10-210-2 S650 Service Manual EMERGENCY EXIT (CONT’D) Front Door (Cont’d) Front Door Reassembly Figure 10-210-5 Disconnect electrical connector (Item 2) and washer fluid hose (Item 1) [Figure 10-210-5]. Figure 10-210-6 Rotate and pull the clip (Item 1) out of the gas spring socket. Pull the gas spring socket (Item 3) straight off the ball stud fitting (Item 2) [Figure 10-210-6]. Remove the door hinges from the loader. Figure 10-210-7 Orient the latches as shown (Item 1) and install the door hinges (Item 2) [Figure 10-210-7] on the door. (Bottom hinge shown) Figure 10-210-8 Install cast washers (Item 2) on door hinges taking care to match rectangular surfaces. Hold cast washer firmly against door and rotate latch (Item 1) [Figure 10-210-8] up to lock cast washer into place. (Bottom hinge shown) (Plastic cap shown removed for clarity) Install door on loader. Install the gas spring socket on the ball stud fitting. Install the clip into the hole in the gas spring socket. Rotate the clip to lock into place [Figure 10-210-6]. Connect electrical connector (Item 2) and washer fluid hose (Item 1) [Figure 10-210-5]. P-85781A 1 2 P-85588A 1 P-85589A 2 3 P-90685 1 2 P-90686A 1 2 10-220-1 S650 Service Manual SEAT BELT Inspection And Maintenance WARNING Failure to properly inspect and maintain the seat belt can cause lack of operator restraint resulting in serious injury or death. W-2466-0703 Check the seat belt daily for correct function. Inspect the seat belt system thoroughly at least once each year or more often if the machine is exposed to severe environmental conditions or applications. Any seat belt system that shows cuts, fraying, extreme or unusual wear, significant discolorations due to ultraviolet UV exposure, dusty / dirty conditions, abrasion to the seat belt webbing, or damage to the buckle, latch plate, retractor (if equipped), hardware or any other obvious problem should be replaced immediately. The items below are referenced in [Figure 10-220-1]. 1. Check the webbing. If the system is equipped with a retractor, pull the webbing completely out and inspect the full length of the webbing. Look for cuts, wear, fraying, dirt and stiffness. 2. Check the buckle and latch for correct operation. Make sure latch plate is not excessively worn, deformed or buckle is not damaged or casing broken. 3. Check the retractor web storage device (if equipped) by extending webbing to determine if it looks correct and that it spools out and retracts webbing correctly. 4. Check webbing in areas exposed to ultraviolet (UV) rays from the sun or extreme dust or dirt. If the original color of the webbing in these areas is extremely faded and / or the webbing is packed with dirt, the webbing strength may have deteriorated. See your Bobcat dealer for seat belt system replacement parts for your machine. Figure 10-220-1 B-22283 1 2 3 4 10-220-2 S650 Service Manual 20-01 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC SYSTEM HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-10-1 Glossary Of Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-10-1 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-10-5 CYLINDER (LIFT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-20-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-20-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-20-2 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-20-6 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-20-7 Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-20-8 CYLINDER (TILT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21-2 Base End Pivot Pin Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21-4 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21-5 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21-6 Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-21-8 CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22-2 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22-3 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22-4 Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-22-5 MAIN RELIEF VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-30-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-30-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-30-2 Adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-30-4 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-30-5 20-02 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-2 Mount Bracket Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-5 Identification Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-6 Lift Load Check Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-7 Load Check Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt & Auxiliary) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-8 Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Rod End) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-9 Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Base End) . . . . . . 20-40-9 Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Base End) . . . . . 20-40-10 Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Rod End) . . . . . 20-40-10 Port Relief Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-40-11 Plug Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-12 Rubber Boot Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-13 End Cap Block Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-14 Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-15 Tilt Spool Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-25 Auxiliary Spool Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-27 Auxiliary Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-29 Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-30 Lock Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-31 Lift Arm Bypass Orifice Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-33 Main Relief Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-33 Check Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-40-34 HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-1 Actuator Removal And Installation (In Loader) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-5 Actuator Removal And Installation (Out Of Loader) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-7 Identification Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-10 Mount Bracket Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-41-11 Lift Load Check Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-41-11 Load Check Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt & Auxiliary) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-12 Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Rod End) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-13 Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Base End) . . . . . 20-41-13 Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Base End) . . . . . 20-41-14 Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Rod End) . . . . . 20-41-14 Port Relief Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-15 Plug Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-16 End Cap Block Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-17 Lift Spool Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-17 Tilt Spool Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-22 Auxiliary Spool Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-24 Auxiliary Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-26 Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-27 Lock Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-28 Lift Arm Bypass Orifice Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-29 Main Relief Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-29 Check Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-41-30 20-03 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-50-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-50-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-50-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-50-2 Bracket Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-50-3 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-50-3 HYDRAULIC PUMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-1 Pump Test At Quick Couplers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-1 Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-2 Direct Pump Test (Charge Section) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-4 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-6 Hydraulic Pump Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-7 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-8 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-60-9 HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-1 Pump Test At Quick Couplers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-1 Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-2 Direct Pump Test (Charge Section) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-3 Direct Pump Test (High Flow Section) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-5 High Flow Relief Valve Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-7 High Flow Relief Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-8 Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-9 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-10 Hydraulic Pump Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-61-11 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-12 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-61-13 HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FILTERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-70-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-70-1 Housing Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-70-1 HYDRAULIC FLUID RESERVOIR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-80-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-80-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-80-1 Hydraulic Fluid Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-80-2 OIL COOLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-90-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-90-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-90-1 BUCKET POSITION VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-100-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-100-1 Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-100-1 Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-100-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-100-2 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-100-4 20-04 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-110-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-110-1 Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-110-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-110-2 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-110-3 BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-120-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-120-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-120-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-120-3 FRONT AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC COUPLER BLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-130-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-130-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-130-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-130-1 HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC WITH NO OPTIONS S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) (PRINTED JUNE 2009) V-1348legend FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 25 PSI (1,7 bar) RESERVOIR: Capacity at sight gauge . . 10.7 Qts. (10,2 L) System Capacity . . . . . . . 10.5 Gal. (39,7 L) 1 2 19 PULL BUTTON ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT ARM BY-PASS 14 LOAD CHECK VALVE 9 RELIEF VALVE - MAIN: 3500 PSI (241 bar) at Front Quick Couplers 11 12 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - AUXILIARY 10 5 6 24 25 26 27 28 29 V-1348legend (6-8-09) NOTE: Unless otherwise specified springs have NO significant pressure value. LEGEND PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT CONTROL PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - TILT CONTROL DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH: 15 PSI (1,07 bar) Normally Closed 3 22 38 21 20 Printed in U.S.A. SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BICS CONTROL 8 HYDRAULIC PUMP . . . . . . . Gear Type 23.0 GPM (87,1 L/min.) at High Engine Idle 23 35 36 4 7 FRONT AUXILIARY MANUAL PRESSURE BLEED-OFF VALVE 13 LIFT CYLINDER SPOOL - MADE TO RESTRICT FLOW DURING BOOM DOWN BUT NOT DURING BOOM UP 37 CHARGE PUMP - 13.5 GPM (51,1 L/min) at High Engine Idle RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT 4000 PSI (276 bar) FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT HYDRAULIC MOTOR ANTICAVITATION VALVE PROPORTIONAL RELIEF VALVE – (Fan Speed Regulator): 1566 - 1784 PSI (108 - 123 bar) SENSOR – HYD. TEMPERATURE SENSOR – CHARGE PRESSURE – Fan Filter 15 SIGHT GUAGE DIAGNOSTIC COUPLER RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT (OPTIONAL) 4000 PSI (276 bar) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 75 - 83 PSI (5,2 - 5,7 bar) FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) 30 FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC MOTOR FILTER - BICS CONTROL VALVE (SCREEN) 17 16 CHECK VALVE - With 14.5 PSI (1,0 bar) Spring 18 RESTRICTION . . . . . . . 0.079 in. (2,0 mm) 32 31 33 34 RELIEF/REPLENISHING VALVE - HIGH PRESSURE: 5294 PSI (365 bar) VARIABLE CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC PUMP RELIEF VALVE - CHARGE INLET: 465 PSI (32, bar) at High Engine Idle With 140 degrees F. (60 degrees C.) Fluid ANTICAVITATION VALVE RESTRICTION - 0.06 inch (1,5 mm) CHECK VALVE - With 200 PSI (13,8 bar) Spring CHECK VALVE – COLD WEATHER BY-PASS With 50 PSI (3,45 bar) Spring DRIVE MOTOR SHUTTLE VALVE HYDROSTATIC PUMP 19 IN OUT 16 18 20 15 ? 13 14 9 10 8 17 16 Tilt Spool Lift Spool Auxiliary Spool 8 HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE BICS CONTROL VALVE DRAIN / RETURN MANIFOLD 33 12 12 INTEGRATED COUPLER BLOCK Male Male Female 28 34 8 10 7 27 11 11 11 6 37 35 35 T Charge Inlet 36 VARIABLE SPEED HYDRAULIC FAN MOTOR W/ INTEGRATED FILTER 24 25 26 23 21 DR P 22 1 2 38 36 36 36 B A L 29 31 30 32 A B L 31 30 29 32 A C D B M1 M 3 M4 M 2 RESERVOIR (VENTED) HYDRAULIC FILTER 4 5 1 2 PRINTED IN U.S.A. Oil Cooler LIFT CYLINDERS TILT CYLINDERS DRIVE MOTOR DRIVE MOTOR PUMP SUPPLY DRAIN / RETURN PILOT PRESSURE WORKING CIRCUIT 3 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7170812 HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC WITH NO OPTIONS S650 (S/N A3NV11001 & ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 & ABOVE) HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC WITH ALL OPTIONS S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) (PRINTED JUNE 2009) V-1349legend FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 25 PSI (1,7 bar) RESERVOIR: Capacity at sight gauge . . 10.7 Qts. (10,2 L) System Capacity . . . . . . . 10.5 Gal. (39,7 L) 1 2 19 PULL BUTTON ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT ARM BY-PASS 14 LOAD CHECK VALVE 9 RELIEF VALVE - MAIN: 3500 PSI (241 bar) at Front Quick Couplers 11 44 39 CHECK VALVE - With 80 PSI (5,5 bar) Spring 12 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - AUXILIARY 10 5 6 24 25 26 27 28 29 42 V-1349legend (6-8-09) NOTE: Unless otherwise specified springs have NO significant pressure value. LEGEND FLOW DIVIDER ADJUSTMENT VALVE PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - FLOW CONTROL SPOOL PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT CONTROL CHECK VALVE - BUCKET POSITION VALVE PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - TILT CONTROL DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH: 15 PSI (1,07 bar) Normally Closed 3 22 38 21 20 43 40 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BUCKET POSITION VALVE (ON/OFF) Printed in U.S.A. SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BICS CONTROL 8 HYDRAULIC PUMP . . . . . . . Gear Type 23.0 GPM (87,1 L/min.) at High Engine Idle 23 41 35 36 47 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE (TWO COIL) 48 RELIEF VALVE - 2000 PSI (137 bar) 46 4 7 FRONT AUXILIARY MANUAL PRESSURE BLEED-OFF VALVE 13 LIFT CYLINDER SPOOL - MADE TO RESTRICT FLOW DURING BOOM DOWN BUT NOT DURING BOOM UP 37 45 RESTRICTION - 0.025 inch (0,6 mm) RELIEF VALVE - 1200 PSI (83 bar) CHARGE PUMP - 13.5 GPM (51,1 L/min) at High Engine Idle CHECK VALVE - With 300 PSI (20,7 bar) Spring And With 0.016 inch (0,40 mm) Orifice RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT 4000 PSI (276 bar) FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT HYDRAULIC MOTOR ANTICAVITATION VALVE PROPORTIONAL RELIEF VALVE – (Fan Speed Regulator): 1566 - 1784 PSI (108 - 123 bar) SENSOR – HYD. TEMPERATURE SENSOR – CHARGE PRESSURE – Fan Filter 15 SIGHT GUAGE DIAGNOSTIC COUPLER RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT (OPTIONAL) 4000 PSI (276 bar) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 75 - 83 PSI (5,2 - 5,7 bar) FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) 30 LOAD SHUTTLE VALVE - BLEED OFF SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - TWO COIL PILOT ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - REAR AUXILIARY RESTRICTOR - 0.031 inch (0,8 mm) FILTER - BRAKE HYDRAULIC BRAKE – SPRING APPLIED – PRESSURE RELEASE (SAPR) FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC MOTOR – 2 SPEED HIGH PRESSURE SHUTTLE RELIEF VALVE: 3300 PSI (228 bar) 57 58 59 60 61 62 FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC MOTOR SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – 2 SPEED CHECK VALVE 63 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – MAKE-UP 65 64 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – BRAKE FILTER - BICS CONTROL VALVE (SCREEN) 17 16 CHECK VALVE - With 14.5 PSI (1,0 bar) Spring 18 RESTRICTION . . . . . . . 0.079 in. (2,0 mm) 32 31 33 PILOT ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - HYDRAULIC POWERED BOB-TACH 34 RESTRICTION - 0.089 inch (2,26 mm) FILTER - BOB-TACH VALVE PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - UNLOADING SPOOL RELIEF/REPLENISHING VALVE - HIGH PRESSURE: 5294 PSI (365 bar) VARIABLE CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC PUMP 49 50 51 52 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BASE SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - ROD RELIEF VALVE - CHARGE INLET: 465 PSI (32, bar) at High Engine Idle With 140 degrees F. (60 degrees C.) Fluid 53 66 67 69 68 HIGH FLOW HYDRAULIC PUMP Gear Type 7.5 GPM (28,4 L/min.) at High Engine Idle RELIEF VALVE - 3500 PSI (241 bar) DUMP VALVE – ON / OFF CHECK VALVE - With 5.0 PSI (0,34 bar) Spring 70 ANTICAVITATION VALVE 54 RESTRICTION - 0.06 inch (1,5 mm) 55 CHECK VALVE - With 200 PSI (13,8 bar) Spring 71 RIDE CONTROL VALVE 72 HIGH PRESSURE CHAMBER 73 LOW PRESSURE CHAMBER FILTER – BOB-TACH VALVE 74 75 CHECK VALVE – COLD WEATHER BY-PASS With 50 PSI (3,45 bar) Spring 56 DRIVE MOTOR SHUTTLE VALVE HYDROSTATIC PUMP 19 IN OUT 16 18 20 15 ? 13 14 9 10 8 17 16 Tilt Spool Lift Spool Auxiliary Spool 8 HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE BICS CONTROL VALVE DRAIN / RETURN MANIFOLD 43 66 12 12 INTEGRATED COUPLER BLOCK Male Male Female 41 42 8 10 7 70 11 11 11 6 P1 P2 37 38 36 39 34 40 33 35 ?? 32 BOBTACH VALVE (OPTIONAL) DR PP 53 51 51 T Charge Inlet 52 VARIABLE SPEED HYDRAULIC FAN MOTOR W/ INTEGRATED FILTER 24 25 26 23 21 DR P 22 1 2 REAR AUXILIARY VALVE (OPTIONAL) 46 ?? Base 49 ? Rod 50 ? 48 FEMALE MALE 47 45 44 T P - outP - in BUCKET POSITIONING VALVE (OPTIONAL) B A 31 29 27 ? 30 C D 28 HIGH FLOW VALVE (OPTIONAL) 67 68 ? 75 52 52 52 P 63 61 ? 65 62 62 64 64 2-SPEED & SAPR BRAKE VALVE (OPTIONAL) T A D C B B1 A1 B A Z L X W 54 60 56 55 59 57 58 Z A B L X W 60 56 55 54 59 57 58 A C D B M1 M 3 M4 M 2 RESERVOIR (VENTED) HYDRAULIC FILTER 4 5 1 2 69 74 74 6 PRINTED IN U.S.A. PUMP SUPPLY DRAIN / RETURN PILOT PRESSURE WORKING CIRCUIT Oil Cooler BOB-TACH CYLINDER (OPTIONAL) RIDE CONTROL (OPTIONAL) 71 73 72 DUAL STAGE ACCUMULATOR LIFT CYLINDERS TILT CYLINDERS TWO SPEED DRIVE MOTOR (OPTIONAL) TWO SPEED DRIVE MOTOR (OPTIONAL) REAR AUXILIARY COUPLERS (OPTIONAL) 3 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7170812 HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC WITH ALL OPTIONS S650 (S/N A3NV11001 & ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 & ABOVE) HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC SJC WITH NO OPTIONS S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) (PRINTED JUNE 2009) V-1350legend FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 25 PSI (1,7 bar) RESERVOIR: Capacity at sight gauge . . 10.7 Qts. (10,2 L) System Capacity . . . . . . . 10.5 Gal. (39,7 L) 1 2 PULL BUTTON ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT ARM BY-PASS LOAD CHECK VALVE 9 RELIEF VALVE - MAIN: 3500 PSI (241 bar) at Front Quick Couplers 11 37 12 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - AUXILIARY 10 5 6 24 25 26 27 40 V-1350legend (6-8-09) NOTE: Unless otherwise specified springs have NO significant pressure value. LEGEND DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH: 15 PSI (1,07 bar) Normally Closed 3 22 21 20 38 Printed in U.S.A. 8 23 39 4 7 FRONT AUXILIARY MANUAL PRESSURE BLEED-OFF VALVE 13 RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT 4000 PSI (276 bar) FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT HYDRAULIC MOTOR ANTICAVITATION VALVE PROPORTIONAL RELIEF VALVE – (Fan Speed Regulator): 1566 - 1784 PSI (108 - 123 bar) SENSOR – HYD. TEMPERATURE SIGHT GUAGE DIAGNOSTIC COUPLER RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT (OPTIONAL) 4000 PSI (276 bar) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 75 - 83 PSI (5,2 - 5,7 bar) FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC MOTOR RESTRICTION . . . . . . . 0.079 in. (2,0 mm) ANTICAVITATION VALVE RESTRICTION - 0.06 inch (1,5 mm) CHECK VALVE - With 200 PSI (13,8 bar) Spring DRIVE MOTOR SHUTTLE VALVE CHECK VALVE – COLD WEATHER BY-PASS With 50 PSI (3,45 bar) Spring 35 32 33 34 RELIEF/REPLENISHING VALVE - HIGH PRESSURE: 5294 PSI (365 bar) RELIEF VALVE - CHARGE INLET: 385 PSI (26,5 bar) at High Engine Idle With 140 degrees F. (60 degrees C.) Fluid 36 SERVO PISTON – Swash Plate SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – FORWARD/REVERSE FILTER 19 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BICS CONTROL FILTER - BICS CONTROL VALVE (SCREEN) 17 16 CHECK VALVE - With 14.5 PSI (1,0 bar) Spring 18 PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT CONTROL 14 PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - TILT CONTROL LIFT CYLINDER SPOOL - MADE TO RESTRICT FLOW DURING BOOM DOWN BUT NOT DURING BOOM UP 15 28 29 41 HYDRAULIC PUMP . . . . . . . Gear Type 23.0 GPM (87,1 L/min.) at High Engine Idle CHARGE PUMP - 13.5 GPM (51,1 L/min) at High Engine Idle SENSOR – CHARGE PRESSURE – Fan Filter 30 VARIABLE CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC PUMP 31 TANDEM HYDROSTATIC DRIVE PUMP R IN OUT 18 20 14 8 17 ? 15 16 10 19 18 13 HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (SPOOL VALVE) BICS CONTROL VALVE DRAIN/RETURN MANIFOLD 30 12 12 INTEGRATED COUPLER BLOCK Male Male Female 22 29 10 7 11 11 11 6 33 35 ? ? 34 31 35 34 31 M M M A A X X X X M G R M B B T T Charge Inlet 32 32 32 32 VARIABLE SPEED HYDRAULIC FAN MOTOR W/ INTEGRATED FILTER 26 27 28 25 23 DR P 24 1 2 9 37 LIFT CYLINDERS 8 8 TWO SPEED DRIVE MOTOR (OPTIONAL) A B L 40 39 38 41 B A L 38 40 39 41 DRIVE MOTOR 36 36 36 36 RESERVOIR (VENTED) HYDRAULIC FILTER 3 4 5 21 1 2 6 PUMP SUPPLY DRAIN / RETURN PILOT PRESSURE WORKING CIRCUIT OIL COOLER TILT CYLINDERS HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC SJC WITH NO OPTION S650 (S/N A3NV11001 & ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 & ABOVE) (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7170813 PRINTED IN U.S.A. HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC SJC WITH ALL OPTIONS S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) (PRINTED JUNE 2009) V-1351legend FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 25 PSI (1,7 bar) RESERVOIR: Capacity at sight gauge . . 10.7 Qts. (10,2 L) System Capacity . . . . . . . 10.5 Gal. (39,7 L) 1 2 19 PULL BUTTON ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT ARM BY-PASS 14 LOAD CHECK VALVE 9 RELIEF VALVE - MAIN: 3500 PSI (241 bar) at Front Quick Couplers 11 44 39 CHECK VALVE - With 80 PSI (5,5 bar) Spring 12 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - AUXILIARY 10 5 6 24 25 26 27 28 29 42 V-1351legend (6-8-09) NOTE: Unless otherwise specified springs have NO significant pressure value. LEGEND FLOW DIVIDER ADJUSTMENT VALVE PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - FLOW CONTROL SPOOL PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - LIFT CONTROL CHECK VALVE - BUCKET POSITION VALVE PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - TILT CONTROL DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH: 15 PSI (1,07 bar) Normally Closed 3 22 21 20 43 40 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BUCKET POSITION VALVE (ON/OFF) Printed in U.S.A. SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BICS CONTROL 8 HYDRAULIC PUMP . . . . . . . Gear Type 23.0 GPM (87,1 L/min.) at High Engine Idle 23 41 35 47 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE (TWO COIL) 48 RELIEF VALVE - 2000 PSI (137 bar) 46 4 7 FRONT AUXILIARY MANUAL PRESSURE BLEED-OFF VALVE 13 LIFT CYLINDER SPOOL - MADE TO RESTRICT FLOW DURING BOOM DOWN BUT NOT DURING BOOM UP 45 RESTRICTION - 0.025 inch (0,6 mm) CHARGE PUMP - 13.5 GPM (51,1 L/min) at High Engine Idle CHECK VALVE - With 300 PSI (20,7 bar) Spring And With 0.016 inch (0,40 mm) Orifice RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT 4000 PSI (276 bar) FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT HYDRAULIC MOTOR ANTICAVITATION VALVE PROPORTIONAL RELIEF VALVE – (Fan Speed Regulator): 1566 - 1784 PSI (108 - 123 bar) SENSOR – HYD. TEMPERATURE SENSOR – CHARGE PRESSURE – Fan Filter 15 SIGHT GUAGE DIAGNOSTIC COUPLER RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - PORT (OPTIONAL) 4000 PSI (276 bar) SPRING LOADED FILTER BY-PASS VALVE: 75 - 83 PSI (5,2 - 5,7 bar) FILTER - HYDRAULIC (CANISTER) 30 LOAD SHUTTLE VALVE - BLEED OFF SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - TWO COIL PILOT ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - REAR AUXILIARY RESTRICTOR - 0.031 inch (0,8 mm) FILTER - BRAKE HYDRAULIC BRAKE – SPRING APPLIED – PRESSURE RELEASE (SAPR) FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC MOTOR – 2 SPEED HIGH PRESSURE SHUTTLE RELIEF VALVE: 3300 PSI (228 bar) 61 62 FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC MOTOR SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – 2 SPEED CHECK VALVE 63 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – MAKE-UP 65 64 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – BRAKE FILTER - BICS CONTROL VALVE (SCREEN) 17 16 CHECK VALVE - With 14.5 PSI (1,0 bar) Spring 18 RESTRICTION . . . . . . . 0.079 in. (2,0 mm) 32 31 33 PILOT ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - HYDRAULIC POWERED BOB-TACH 34 RESTRICTION - 0.089 inch (2,26 mm) FILTER - BOB-TACH VALVE PILOTED ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - UNLOADING SPOOL RELIEF/REPLENISHING VALVE - HIGH PRESSURE: 5294 PSI (365 bar) VARIABLE CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDROSTATIC PUMP 49 50 51 52 SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - BASE SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE - ROD RELIEF VALVE - CHARGE INLET: 385 PSI (26,5 bar) at High Engine Idle With 140 degrees F. (60 degrees C.) Fluid 53 66 67 69 68 HIGH FLOW HYDRAULIC PUMP Gear Type 7.5 GPM (28,4 L/min.) at High Engine Idle RELIEF VALVE - 3500 PSI (241 bar) DUMP VALVE – ON / OFF CHECK VALVE - With 5.0 PSI (0,34 bar) Spring 70 ANTICAVITATION VALVE 54 55 71 RIDE CONTROL VALVE 72 HIGH PRESSURE CHAMBER 73 LOW PRESSURE CHAMBER FILTER – BOB-TACH VALVE 74 75 56 38 36 37 RELIEF VALVE - 1200 PSI (83 bar) 57 58 59 SERVO PISTON – Swash Plate SOLENOID ACTIVATED DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE – FORWARD/REVERSE FILTER RESTRICTION - 0.06 inch (1,5 mm) CHECK VALVE - With 200 PSI (13,8 bar) Spring DRIVE MOTOR SHUTTLE VALVE 76 77 78 CHECK VALVE – COLD WEATHER BY-PASS With 50 PSI (3,45 bar) Spring 60 TANDEM HYDROSTATIC R IN OUT 18 20 14 8 17 ? 15 16 10 19 18 13 HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (SPOOL VALVE) BICS CONTROL VALVE DRAIN/RETURN MANIFOLD 46 73 12 12 INTEGRATED COUPLER BLOCK Male Male Female 44 45 10 7 11 11 11 6 P1 P2 39 4138 36 43 35 42 37 ?? 34 POWER BOBTACH VALVE (OPTIONAL) DR PP BOBTACH CYLINDER (OPTIONAL) 56 58 ? ? 57 54 58 57 54 M M M A A X X X X M G R M B B T T Charge Inlet 55 55 55 55 VARIABLE SPEED HYDRAULIC FAN MOTOR W/ INTEGRATED FILTER 26 27 28 25 23 DR P 24 1 2 9 REAR AUXILIARY VALVE (OPTIONAL) 49 ?? 52 ? 53 ? 51 FEMALE MALE 50 48 47 T P outP in REAR QUICK COUPLERS BUCKET POSITIONING VALVE (OPTIONAL) B A 33 31 29 ? 32 C D 30 HIGH FLOW VALVE (OPTIONAL) 74 75 ? 60 LIFT CYLINDERS 8 8 TWO SPEED DRIVE MOTOR (OPTIONAL) Z A B L X W 67 63 62 61 66 64 65 B A Z L X W 61 67 63 62 66 64 65 TWO SPEED DRIVE MOTOR (OPTIONAL) P 70 68 ? 72 69 69 71 71 2-SPEED & SAPR BRAKE VALVE T A D C B B1 A1 59 59 59 59 RESERVOIR (VENTED) HYDRAULIC FILTER 3 4 5 21 1 2 76 40 40 6 22 78 77 PUMP SUPPLY DRAIN / RETURN PILOT PRESSURE WORKING CIRCUIT OIL COOLER TILT CYLINDERS HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SCHEMATIC SJC WITH ALL OPTION S650 (S/N A3NV11001 & ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 & ABOVE) (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7170813 PRINTED IN U.S.A. 20-10-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION Glossary Of Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Symbols WORKING CIRCUITS - Continuous, Solid Line - Working (Main) Line, Return Line (line conducting fluid from working devices to the reservoir) and Feed line (main line conductor). PILOT PRESSURE - Dashed Line - Pilot Line (Line which conducts control fluid). DRAIN CIRCUITS - Dotted Line - Drain Line (drain or bleed line - line conducting fluid from a component housing to the reservoir. MECHANICAL CONNECTIONS - Double Line (Shaft, Lever, Piston Rod). CONNECTED JUNCTION OF OIL LINES (Flow Line Connection). OIL LINES CROSSING (NOT Connected). COUPLER - Quick - Acting Coupling (uncoupled, closed by non-return valve). COMPONENTS - Long Chain Line - Enclosure outline for several components assembled in one unit. SYMBOL DESCRIPTION FLOW LINES and CONNECTIONS SYMBOL DESCRIPTION BASIC and MISCELLANEOUS SYMBOLS RESTRICTION - Line with Fixe d Restriction - Affected by Viscosit y (property of resistance to flowin g fluid). VARIABLE ADJUSTMEN T RESTRICTION - Regulated o r Variable Restriction. TEMPERATURE CONTROL - (Indication of temperature). TEMPERATURE INDICATOR - (temperature measurement - thermometer). FILTER (strainer or screen) - For fluid conditioning. VENTED AND FILTERED RESERVOIR (reservoir open t o atmosphere). PRESSURIZED, VENTED AND FiLTERED RESERVOIR (Reservoi r uses a pressured cap). OIL COOLER (heat exchanger) - The arrows in the diamond indicate the extraction of heat (heat dissipation). PRESSURE SENSOR - Varies electric signal with pressure. DIFFERENTIAL PRESSURE SWITCH - Switch activates when pressure difference reaches specified level. PRESSURE SWITCH - Switch activates when pressure reaches specified level. MUFFLER (silencer) - Reduces noise. 20-10-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Glossary Of Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Symbols (Cont’d) DOUBLE ACTING HYDRAULIC CYLINDER, UNEQUAL DISPLACEMENT - With single piston rod. DOUBLE ACTING HYDRAULIC CYLINDER, UNEQUAL DISPLACEMENT and CUSHION ON ONE END - With single piston rod. VARIABLE CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDRAULIC PUMP - With two directions of flow (bidirectional). FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT BIDIRECTIONAL HYDRAULIC MOTOR - With two directions of flow (bidirectional. FIXED CAPACITY DISPLACEMENT HYDRAULIC PUMP - With one direction of flow. SYMBOL DESCRIPTION C YLINDER: Equipment to convert hydraulic energy into l inear energy and in which the fluid pressure operates a lternately in both directions (forward and backward s trokes). SYMBOL DESCRIPTION CONTROL MECHANISMS CONTROL VALVE WITH DETEN T (Holds Valve in Position) - device fo r maintaining a given positio n (mechanical). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY A PULL BUTTON (manual). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY A PUSH-PULL BUTTON (manual). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY A LEVER (manual). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY A PEDAL (manual). CONTROL VALVE WITH SPRING RETURN (mechanical). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY AN ELECTRIC SOLENOID (electrical). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY A PROPORTIONAL ELECTRICAL SOLENOID (electrical). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY DUAL ELECTRICAL SOLENOID (electrical). CONTROL VALVE ACTIVATED BY PILOT PRESSURE (indirect control, pilot actuated by application of pressure). P UMP: To convert mechanical energy into hydraulic e nergy. M OTOR: To convert hydraulic energy into rotary m echanical energy. 20-10-3 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Glossary Of Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Symbols (Cont’d) NON-RETURN VALVE (Check Valve) - Used as Replenishing Valve, Lock Check Valve or Anticavitation Valve - Opens if the Inlet pressure is higher than the Outlet pressure. Often contains internal spring which has NO significant pressure value. SPRING LOADED VALVE (bypass Valve) - Opens if the Inlet pressure is greater than the Outlet pressure plus the spring pressure. SHUTTLE VALVE - The Inlet port connected to the higher pressure is automatically connected to the Outlet port while the other Inlet port is closed. PILOT CONTROLLED NON- RETURN VALVE- It is possible to open the valve by pilot pressure. O UT IN OUT IN OUT I N SYMBOL DESCRIPTION N ON-RETURN VALVE, SHUTTLE VALVE: Valve which a llows free flow in one direction only. SYMBOL DESCRIPTION DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALVE: Valve providing for th e opening (fully or restricted) or the closing of one or mo re flow paths (represented by several squares). TWO PORTS and CLOSED FLOW PATHS SOLENOID ACTIVATE D DIRECTIONAL CONTROL VALV E (Two Position) - controlled by a n electric solenoid (with return spring). PILOT ACTIVATED DIRECTIONA L CONTROL VALVE (Two Position) - controlled by pressure (with retur n spring). MANUALLY ACTIVATED DIRECTIO N CONTROL VALVE (Variable Position ) Joystick Controlled, variable pressur e to shift the pilot activated directiona l control valve spool. T P OUT I N IN MANUALLY ACTIVATED FLOW CONTROL VALVE (Two Position ) allows for changing pilot flow t o control switching joystick functions fo r STD / ISO Control (Excavators Only ). BACK FRONT STD ISO STEERING CONTROL VALV E (Variable Position) - Used fo r controlling the hydraulic flow for th e steering cylinders in relationship t o the amount the steering wheel is rotated. 20-10-4 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Glossary Of Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Symbols (Cont’d) RELIEF VALVE - When the Inlet pressure overcomes the opposing force of the spring, the valve opens permitting flow from the Outlet port. RELIEF/REPLENISHING VALVE or RELIEF/ANTICAVITATION VALVE - When the Inlet pressure overcomes the opposing force of the spring, the valve opens permitting flow from the Outlet port - Allows free flow in the opposite direction. LOCK VALVE - hydraulic pressure is applied to open the valve to allow the hydraulic cylinder to move. ONE WAY RESTRICTOR VALVE (Non-Return Valve with Restriction) - Unit allowing free flow in one direction but restricted flow in the other direction. DUAL PRESSURE RELIEF VALVE - When the Inlet pressure overcomes the opposing force of the spring, the valve opens permitting flow from the Outlet port. Pilot pressure provides a second pressure value. OUT IN OUT IN OU T I N SYMBOL DESCRIPTION P RESSURE CONTROL VALVE: Valve ensuring the c ontrol of pressure. SYMBOL DESCRIPTION MISCELLANEOUS ACCUMULATOR - Supplie s temporary reserve pressure to th e hydraulic system when the engin e has been stopped. F LOW CONTROL VALVE: Valve controlling the flow in o ne or both directions. TOW VALVE - Normally in closed position. LOAD SENSE BLEED VALVE - Regulates small amount of fluid flow (leakage). 20-10-5 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT'D) Troubleshooting The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. If a service code appears in the left instrument panel. (See DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES on Page 60-90- 1.) WARNING Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to make correct repairs or adjustments can cause injury or death. W-2004-1285 PROBLEM CAUSE The hydraulic system will not operate. 1, 2, 3, 5, 8 Slow hydraulic system action. 1, 3, 4, 6, 8 Hydraulic action is not smooth. 1, 4, 5, 6, 7 Lift arms go up slowly at full engine RPM 1, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 The lift arms or Bob-Tach will move when the pedal is in neutral position 4 The lift arms come down when the pedal is in neutral position 4, 9, 10, 11 Lift arm bypass control valve stuck 12 Lift arm bypass control valve stem bent or broken 13 KEY TO CORRECT CAUSE 1. The fluid level is not correct. 2. The pedal linkage is disconnected. 3. The hydraulic pump has damage. 4. The pedal linkage is not adjusted correctly. 5. Relief valve is not at the correct pressure. 6. Suction leak on the inlet side of the hydraulic pump. 7. Fluid is cold. Wrong viscosity fluid. (See HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FLUID SPECIFICATIONS on Page SPEC-40-1.) 8. Exceeding the loaders rated operating capacity. 9. Internal leak in the lift cylinder(s). 10. External leak from the cylinder(s). 11. Damaged lift spool. 12. Rotate shaft. 13. Replace lift arm bypass control valve assembly. 20-10-6 S650 Service Manual 20-20-1 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) Testing Figure 20-20-1 Lower the lift arms. Stop the engine. Raise the seat bar. WARNING Hydraulic fluid escaping under pressure can have sufficient force to enter a person’s body by penetrating the skin. This can cause serious injury and possible death if proper medical treatment by a physician familiar with this injury is not received immediately. W-2145-0290 Check only one cylinder at a time. Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-1] which goes to the base end of the lift cylinder. Figure 20-20-2 Install a cap (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-2] on the hose and tighten. Engage the parking brake. Lower the seat bar. Start the engine and press the PTOL button. Operate the controls that lower the lift arms. If there is any leakage from the fitting on the cylinder (Item 2) [Figure 20-20-2], remove the lift cylinder for repair. Repeat the procedure to check the other lift cylinder. P-90616 1 P-90617 1 2 20-20-2 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) NOTE: Remove only one cylinder at a time. WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 20-20-3 Mark and disconnect the two hydraulic hoses (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-3]. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 Figure 20-20-4 Cap and plug both fittings on the cylinder (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-4]. NOTE: Do not cap or plug the two hydraulic hoses (Item 2) [Figure 20-20-4]. Place the hoses (Item 2) [Figure 20-20-4] in a suitable container to collect the hydraulic oil as the lift arms are raised. Recycle or dispose of used fluid in an environmentally safe manner. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 P-90616 1 P-90824 1 2 2 20-20-3 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-20-5 Remove the retaining bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 20- 20-5] from the pin on the rod end of the cylinder. Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-20-6 With a slide hammer, remove the pin (Item 1) [Figure 20- 20-6] from the rod end of the cylinder. P-90602A 1 2 P-90611 1 20-20-4 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Figure 20-20-7 Install a sling in the middle of the Bob-Tach as shown in (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-7]. Using a chain hoist raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device on the cylinder that is connected to the lift arm. Figure 20-20-8 Install a bolt (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-8] through the eyelet of the cylinder and install a strap (Item 2) [Figure 20-20- 8] to secure the cylinder. P-90605 1 P-90823 1 2 20-20-5 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Open the rear door. NOTE: When removing the left side lift cylinder the battery will need to be removed to gain access to the lower retaining bolt and nut. Remove the battery (If required). (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-20-1.) Figure 20-20-9 Remove the retaining bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 20- 20-9] from the pin on the base end of the lift cylinder. Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-20-10 Remove the grease fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-10] from the base end of the lift cylinder. Installation: Tighten the grease fitting to 20 N•m (15 ft- lb) torque. Figure 20-20-11 With a slide hammer, remove the pin (Item 1) [Figure 20- 20-11] from the base end of the lift cylinder. Figure 20-20-12 Using a chain hoist remove the lift cylinder (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-12] from the loader. P-90834 1 1 P-90825 1 P-90827 1 P-90823 1 20-20-6 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Parts Identification 1. Seal 2. Hydraulic Tubeline 3. Cylinder Case Tube 4. Plug 5. Clamp 6. Nut 7. Back-up Ring 8. O-ring 9. Piston Assembly 10. Spacer 11. O-ring 12. Back-up Ring 13. O-ring 14. Head 15. Rod Seal 16. Wiper Seal 17. Rod 18. Grease Fitting NA1413S 2 3 4 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12 1 13 14 15 16 17 18 11 20-20-7 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Disassembly Use the following tools to disassemble the cylinder: MEL1074 - O-ring Seal Hook Spanner Wrench Hold the hydraulic cylinder over a drain pan and move the rod in and out slowly to remove the fluid from the cylinder. Put the base end of the cylinder in a vise. Figure 20-20-13 Use a spanner wrench to loosen the head (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-13] from the cylinder case. Figure 20-20-14 Remove the nut (Item 1), piston (Item 2), spacer (Item 3) and head (Item 4) [Figure 20-20-14]. Figure 20-20-15 Remove the back-up ring (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-20-15] from the piston. NOTE: If the fiber surface (Item 3) [Figure 20-20-15] on the piston, becomes damaged, the complete piston must be replaced. Figure 20-20-16 Remove the O-ring (Item 1). Remove the O-ring (Item 2) and the back-up ring (Item 3) [Figure 20-20-16] from the cylinder head. NOTE: The O-ring (Item 2) and back-up ring (Item 3) [Figure 20-20-16] are no longer available parts. The seal kit will contain a one piece seal that is used in place of the O-ring and back-up ring. P-48033 1 P-48036 1 2 3 4 P-48038 1 2 3 P-48039 1 3 2 20-20-8 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-20-17 Remove the wiper seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-17] from the cylinder head. Figure 20-20-18 Remove the rod seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-18] from the cylinder head. Assembly Use the following tools to assemble the cylinder: MEL1396 - Seal Installation Tool MEL1033 - Rod Seal Installation Tool Piston Ring Compressor Spanner Wrench Figure 20-20-19 Wash the cylinder parts in solvent and air dry them. Inspect the cylinder parts for nicks, scratches or other damage. Replace any damaged parts. Always install new O-rings and seals during assembly. Lubricate all O-rings and seals with hydraulic oil during installation. Install the new seal on the tool and slowly stretch it until it fits the piston [Figure 20-20-19]. Allow the seal to stretch for 30 seconds before installing it on the piston. P-48040 1 P-48042 1 P7424 20-20-9 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 20-20-20 Install the O-ring (Item 1) and seal (Item 2) [Figure 20- 20-20] on the cylinder piston. Figure 20-20-21 Install the rod seal on the rod seal tool [Figure 20-20-21]. NOTE: During installation the spring side of the seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-21] must be installed toward the inside of the cylinder. Rotate the handles to collapse the rod seal [Figure 20- 20-21]. Figure 20-20-22 Install the rod seal in the head [Figure 20-20-22]. Figure 20-20-23 Install the wiper seal, with the wiper side of the seal (Item 1) toward the outside of the head (Item 2) [Figure 20-20- 23]. P-48038 1 2 P7427 P-48043 1 P7425 P-48042 P-4804 1 1 2 20-20-10 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (LIFT) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-20-24 Install the O-ring (Item 1) and the seal (Item 2) [Figure 20-20-24] on the cylinder head. Figure 20-20-25 NOTE: Clean and dry the threads before installing the nut. Install the new nut from the kit. Install the head (Item 1), spacer (Item 2) piston (Item 3), and nut (Item 4) [Figure 20-20-25]. Tighten the nut (Item 4) [Figure 20-20-25] to 1152 N•m (850 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-20-26 Put the base end of the hydraulic cylinder in a vise. Using a spanner wrench, tighten the head (Item 1) [Figure 20-20-26] until the head is flush with the end of the cylinder tube assembly. P101716 1 2 P-48036 1 2 3 4 P-48035 1 20-21-1 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) Testing Figure 20-21-1 Remove the attachment. Roll the Bob-Tach fully back. Stop the engine. Raise the seat bar. WARNING Hydraulic fluid escaping under pressure can have sufficient force to enter a person’s body by penetrating the skin. This can cause serious injury and possible death if proper medical treatment by a physician familiar with this injury is not received immediately. W-2145-0290 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-1] which goes to the rod end of the tilt cylinder. Figure 20-21-2 Install a cap (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-2] in the hydraulic hose and tighten. Engage the parking brake. Lower the seat bar. Start the engine and press the PTOL button. Operate the controls that rolls the Bob-Tach forward. If there is any leakage from the fitting on the cylinder (Item 2) [Figure 20-21-2]. Remove the cylinder for repair. Repeat procedure to check the other cylinder. P-85553 1 P100721 2 1 20-21-2 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation Figure 20-21-3 Remove the attachment from the Bob-Tach. Roll the Bob- Tach forward Stop the engine. Raise the seat bar. Remove the retainer bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 20-21- 3] from the rod end pivot pin. Installation: Tighten the retainer nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-21-4 Remove the rod end pivot pin (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-4]. Figure 20-21-5 Disconnect the two hydraulic hoses (Items 1 & 2) [Figure 20-21-5] from the cylinder. Cap the hoses and plug the fittings on the cylinder. Figure 20-21-6 Remove the base end pivot bolt and washer (Item 3) [Figure 20-21-5]. Remove the retainer nut and washer (Item 1) [Figure 20- 21-6] from the base end pivot pin. Installation: Tighten the retainer nut to 257,6 N•m (190 ft-lb) torque. P-85554 1 P-85649 1 P-85562 3 2 1 P-85648 1 20-21-3 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-21-7 Slide the cylinder from the base pin and remove the cylinder from the loader [Figure 20-21-7]. P-85564 20-21-4 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Base End Pivot Pin Removal And Installation Use the following tools to assemble the cylinder: MEL1396 - Seal Installation Tool MEL1033 - Rod Seal Installation Tool Piston Ring Compressor Spanner Wrench Figure 20-21-8 Figure 20-21-9 Remove the cylinder from the cylinder base pin (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-8]. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-21-2.) Use a shaft (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-9] and a hammer to remove the cylinder base pin from the lift arms. Figure 20-21-10 Check pivot pin and replace as needed [Figure 20-21- 10]. P-85565 1 P-85566 1 P-85567 20-21-5 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Parts Identification NA1210S 1. Tubeline 2. Case 3. Plug 4. Grease Fitting 5. Clamp 6. Nut 7. Back-up Ring 8. O-ring 9. Piston 10. O-ring 11. Back-up Ring 12. O-ring 13. Head 14. Seal 15. Wiper 16. Rod 17. Bushing 18. Seal 4 5 6 7 8 9 3 3 1 10 11 18 12 13 14 15 16 17 4 2 20-21-6 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Disassembly Use the following tools to disassemble the cylinder: MEL1074 - O-ring Seal Hook Spanner Wrench Hold the hydraulic cylinder over a drain pan and move the rod in and out slowly to remove the fluid from the cylinder. Put the base end of the cylinder in a vise. Figure 20-21-11 Remove the seals (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-11] on both sides of the pivot bushing. Remove and replace bushing (Item 2) with a driver tool and hammer [Figure 20-21-11]. Figure 20-21-12 Use a spanner wrench to loosen the head (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-12] from the cylinder case. Figure 20-21-13 Remove the nut (Item 1), piston (Item 2) and head (Item 3) [Figure 20-21-13]. P-85651 1 1 2 P-48035 1 P-48071 1 2 3 20-21-7 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-21-14 Remove the seal (Item 1), and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-21-14] from the piston. Figure 20-21-15 Remove the O-ring (Item 1). Remove the O-ring (Item 2) and back-up washer (Item 3) [Figure 20-21-15]. NOTE: The O-ring (Item 2) and back-up ring (Item 3) [Figure 20-21-15] are no longer available parts. The seal kit will contain a one piece seal that is used in place of the O-ring and back-up ring. Figure 20-21-16 Remove the wiper seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-16] from the cylinder head. Figure 20-21-17 Remove the rod seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-17] from the cylinder head. P-48073 1 2 P-48039 3 1 2 P-48040 1 P-48042 1 20-21-8 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Assembly Use the following tools to assemble the cylinder: MEL1396 - Seal Installation Tool MEL1033 - Rod Seal Installation Tool Piston Ring Compressor Spanner Wrench Wash the cylinder parts in solvent and air dry them. Inspect the cylinder parts for nicks, scratches or other damage. Replace any damaged parts. Always install new O-rings and seals during assembly. Lubricate all O-rings and seals with hydraulic oil during installation. Figure 20-21-18 Install the new seal on the tool and slowly stretch it until it fits the piston [Figure 20-21-18]. Allow the seal to stretch for 30 seconds before installing it on the piston. Figure 20-21-19 Install the O-ring (Item 1) and seal (Item 2) [Figure 20- 21-19] on the cylinder piston. Figure 20-21-20 Install the rod seal on the rod seal tool [Figure 20-21-20]. NOTE: During installation the spring side of the seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-20] must be installed toward the inside of the cylinder. Rotate the handles to collapse the rod seal [Figure 20- 21-20]. P7424 P-48073 1 2 P7427 P-48043 1 20-21-9 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-21-21 Install the rod seal in the head [Figure 20-21-21]. Figure 20-21-22 Install the wiper seal, with the wiper side of the seal (Item 1) toward the outside of the head (Item 2) [Figure 20-21- 22]. Figure 20-21-23 Install the O-ring (Item 1) and seal (Item 2) [Figure 20- 21-16] on the cylinder head. Figure 20-21-24 NOTE: Clean and dry the threads before installing the nut. Install the new nut from the kit. Install the head (Item 1), piston (Item 2) and nut (Item 3) [Figure 20-21-24]. Tighten the nut (Item 3) [Figure 20-21-24] to 1152 N•m (850 ft-lb) torque. Put the base end of the hydraulic cylinder in a vise. P7425 P-48042 P-4804 1 1 2 P101716 1 2 P-48071 1 2 3 20-21-10 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (TILT) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-21-25 Using a spanner wrench, tighten the head (Item 1) [Figure 20-21-25] until the head is flush with the end of the cylinder tube assembly. Figure 20-21-26 Install the bushing (Item 1) and seals (Item 2) [Figure 20- 21-26] using a driver tool and hammer. P-48035 1 P-85650 1 2 2 20-22-1 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) Testing WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Always clean up spilled fuel or oil. Keep heat, flames, sparks or lighted tobacco away from fuel and oil. Failure to use care around combustibles can cause explosion or fire. W-2103-0508 Figure 20-22-1 Tilt the Bob-Tach forward, so it is parallel to the floor [Figure 20-22-1]. Push and hold BOB-TACH “WEDGES UP” switch until levers are in the unlocked position (Wedges fully raised). Figure 20-22-2 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-22-2] from the power Bob-Tach cylinder base end port. Figure 20-22-3 Install a plug in the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-22-3] and tighten. Engage the parking brake. Lower the seat bar. Start the engine. Push and hold the BOB-TACH “WEDGES UP” Switch (Front Accessory Panel). If there is any leakage from the base end cylinder port (Item 2) [Figure 20-22-3], remove the cylinder for repair. P-85570 P-85570 1 P-85568 1 20-22-2 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Figure 20-22-4 Disconnect the hoses from the rod and base end cylinder fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-22-4]. Installation: Tighten the hoses to 29,8 - 32,5 N•m (22 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Install plugs in the hoses and cap on fittings. Figure 20-22-5 Remove the bolts and washers (Item 1) [Figure 20-22- 5]. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft- lb) torque. Remove the cylinder from the lever pivots. P-85570 1 P-85569 1 1 20-22-3 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) (CONT’D) Parts Identification PE3954S 1. Tube 2. Nut 3. Piston 4. O-ring 5. Ring 6. Spacer 7. O-ring 8. Ring 9. O-ring 10. Head 11. Seal 12. Seal 13. Rod 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 20-22-4 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) (CONT’D) Disassembly Figure 20-22-6 Use the following tools to disassemble the cylinder: MEL1074 - O-ring Seal Hook Spanner Wrench Hold the hydraulic cylinder over a drain pan and move the rod in and out slowly to remove the fluid from the cylinder. Put the base end of the cylinder in a vise. Use a spanner wrench to loosen the head [Figure 20-22- 6]. Figure 20-22-7 Remove the head and rod assembly from the cylinder [Figure 20-22-7]. Put the rod end in a vise. Remove the nut (Item 1), piston (Item 2), spacer (Item 3), and head (Item 4) [Figure 20-22-7] from the rod. Figure 20-22-8 Piston: Remove the O-ring (Item 1), and seal (Item 2) from the piston (Item 3) [Figure 20-22-8]. Figure 20-22-9 Remove the wiper seal (Item 1), and rod seal (Item 2), the back-up washer (Item 3), the thin O-ring (Item 4), and the thick O-ring (Item 5) [Figure 20-22-9] from the head. P-85647 P16294 1 2 3 4 P16295 1 2 3 N-20611 1 2 4 3 5 20-22-5 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) (CONT’D) Assembly Figure 20-22-10 Use the following tools to assembly the cylinder: MEL1396 - Seal Installation Tool MEL1033 - Rod Seal Installation Tool Piston Ring Compressor Spanner Wrench Wash the cylinder parts in solvent and air dry them. Inspect the cylinder parts for nicks, scratches or other damage. Replace any damaged parts. Always install new O-rings and seals during assembly. Lubricate all O-rings and seals with hydraulic oil during installation. Install the new seal on the tool and slowly stretch it until it fits the piston [Figure 20-22-10]. Allow the seal to stretch for 30 seconds before installing it on the piston. Figure 20-22-11 Piston: Install the O-ring (Item 1) and seal (Item 2) on the piston (Item 3) [Figure 20-22-11]. NOTE: The piston center hole (Item 4) [Figure 20-22- 11] has a bevel on one end. The bevel goes toward the rod. Figure 20-22-12 Install the rod seal on the rod seal tool [Figure 20-22-12]. NOTE: During installation the spring side of the seal must be toward the inside of the cylinder. P7424 P16295 1 2 3 4 N-20612 20-22-6 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) (CONT’D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 20-22-13 Rotate the handles to collapse the rod seal [Figure 20- 22-13]. Figure 20-22-14 Install the rod seal in the head [Figure 20-22-14]. Install the wiper seal with the wiper toward the outside of the head. Figure 20-22-15 Install the thin O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-22-15]. Install the back-up washer (Item 2) and thick O-ring (Item 3) [Figure 20-22-15] into the groove on the head. NOTE: Clean and dry the threads before installing the nut. Install the new nut from the seal kit. Figure 20-22-16 Install the head (Item 1), and spacer (Item 2) [Figure 20- 22-16]. Install the piston (Item 3) [Figure 20-22-16]. Grease the piston where the nut contacts the piston. do not get grease on the threads. Install the new nut (Item 4) [Figure 20-22-16]. Tighten the nut to 122 N•m (90 ft-lb) torque. N-20613 P7425 P7422 1 2 3 P16294 1 2 3 4 20-22-7 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-22-17 Put the base end of the hydraulic cylinder in a vise. Tighten the head using a spanner wrench [Figure 20-22- 17]. P-85647 20-22-8 S650 Service Manual 20-30-1 S650 Service Manual MAIN RELIEF VALVE Description The main relief valve limits the hydraulic system pressure by opening at a certain pressure and allowing the hydraulic oil to flow back to the hydraulic reservoir. (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) The main relief valve is adjustable and is located on the hydraulic control valve near the bottom, facing the front of the loader. 20-30-2 S650 Service Manual MAIN RELIEF VALVE (CONT’D) Testing IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. I-2024-0284 WARNING When the engine is running during service, the driving and steering controls must be in neutral and the parking brake engaged. Failure to do so can cause injury or death. W-2006-1209 WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: TWX-RFIK200-S-6 54 U.S. gpm FLOW METER MEL10006 - Hydraulic Test Kit NOTE: This procedure is for standard loaders, loaders equipped with ACS option and loaders equipped with SJC option. The main relief valve is located in the same place on all of the loaders. Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Figure 20-30-1 Connect the IN port (Item 1) [Figure 20-30-1] of the hydraulic tester to the bottom (female) quick coupler on the loader. Connect the OUT port (Item 2) [Figure 20-30-1] of the hydraulic tester to the top (male) quick coupler on the loader. Figure 20-30-2 Start the engine and run at low idle. • Press the AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS Button (Item 1) [Figure 20-30-2] once to engage the auxiliary hydraulics. NOTE: The light (Item 2) [Figure 20-30-2] will be on. P-85571 2 1 P-76460C 1 2 20-30-3 S650 Service Manual MAIN RELIEF VALVE (CONT’D) Testing (Cont’d) Figure 20-30-3 Figure 20-30-4 • Push the front switch (Item 1) [Figure 20-30-3] and [Figure 20-30-4] to give the front quick couplers a constant flow of fluid. • To release from continuous operation, press the front switch (Item 1) [Figure 20-30-3] and [Figure 20-30- 4] a second time. Watch the flow meter on the hydraulic tester to make sure the flow is correct. Increase the engine speed to full RPM. Refer to (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) for both flow and pressure specifications of the hydraulic system. Check the free flow specification. With the engine at high idle and hydraulic oil at 140 °F turn the restrictor control on the tester until the flow through the tester drops to zero. Check the relief pressure. If the relief pressure is not correct, stop the engine and adjust the main relief valve. P-85572 Right Steering Lever Control 1 P-26697 1 Right Steering Lever Control Joystick Option Only 20-30-4 S650 Service Manual MAIN RELIEF VALVE (CONT’D) Adjusting NOTE: This procedure is for standard loaders, loaders equipped with ACS option and loaders equipped with SJC option. The main relief valve is located in the same place on all of the loaders. Figure 20-30-5 If the pressure is not correct, adjust the main relief valve. Loosen the lock nut (Item 1) [Figure 20-30-5]. Turn the adjusting screw (Item 2) [Figure 20-30-5] in or out until the pressure is correct. Turning screw in will increase pressure. NOTE: If the correct pressure can not be reached, replace the main relief valve. Check the pressure setting of the new relief valve. P-85573 1 2 20-30-5 S650 Service Manual MAIN RELIEF VALVE (CONT’D) Removal And Installation IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Clean the area around the control valve. NOTE: This procedure is for standard loaders, loaders equipped with ACS option and loaders equipped with SJC option. The main relief valve is located in the same place on all of the loaders. Figure 20-30-6 If the pressure is not correct, adjust the main relief valve. Loosen the lock nut (Item 1) [Figure 20-30-5]. Turn the adjusting screw (Item 2) [Figure 20-30-5] in or out until the pressure is correct. Turning screw in will increase pressure. NOTE: If the correct pressure can not be reached, replace the main relief valve. Check the pressure setting of the new relief valve. Figure 20-30-7 Remove the O-rings and back-up washers from the main relief valve [Figure 20-30-7]. Clean the main relief valve in clean solvent. Use air pressure to dry the valve. Install new O-rings and back-up washers. Install the main relief valve and tighten [Figure 20-30-7]. Installation: Tighten the main relief valve to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Check the pressure again. (See Testing on Page 20-30- 2.) P-85573 1 2 P-37689 20-30-6 S650 Service Manual 20-40-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) Description Figure 20-40-1 The hydraulic control valve is located inside the main frame on the right hand side, below the operators cab. The hydraulic control valve is the hydraulic component that uses spools to direct the flow of hydraulic fluid to the lift, tilt and auxiliary functions. The lift and tilt functions in the hydraulic control valve are operated by linkage connected to the foot pedals. The auxiliary function is operated by pilot pressure. There is one solenoid located by each side of the spool. Only one solenoid at a time is activated by the switch on the right side control handle/lever. The activated solenoid sends pilot pressure oil to one side of the spool and forces the spool to shift. The hydraulic control valve also contains a main relief valve which is adjustable. P-90327 20-40-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE on Page 10- 20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Remove the control linkage. (See Linkage Removal And Installation on Page 50-90-2.) NOTE: Mark all tubelines, hoses, and electrical connections for correct installation. NOTE: Cap and plug all hydraulic connection points when tubelines or hoses are removed. Clean area around control valve. Open rear door. Figure 20-40-2 Remove the two bolts (Item 1), move the hose clamp (Item 2) to the middle of the hose, and the place the fuel inlet assembly (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-2] off to the side. P-90187 2 3 1 20-40-3 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-40-3 The fixed end main valve hose assembly is connected to a fixed end fitting on the control valve. The hose is routed to the junction block at the rear of the loader where it feeds the base end of both lift cylinders. The hose can only be removed by first removing it from the fitting (Item 1)[Figure 20-40-3]. Figure 20-40-4 Disconnect the wire harness connectors (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-4] from the control valve. Disconnect the hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-4] that routes from the control valve to the drain manifold. Disconnect the hose (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-4] that routes from the control valve to the inlet fitting of the hydraulic pump. Figure 20-40-5 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-5] that routes from the control valve to the brake valve. Disconnect the hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-5] that routes from the control valve to the fan motor. Figure 20-40-6 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-6] that routes from the top of the control valve to the hydraulic filter. P-90267 1 P-90269 2 3 1 1 P-90270 2 1 P-90271 1 20-40-4 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-40-7 Remove the tubeline clamp (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-7]. Disconnect the two tubelines (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-7] that route from the control valve to the front auxiliary hydraulics. Figure 20-40-8 Remove the tubeline clamp (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-8]. Figure 20-40-9 Disconnect the three tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-9] that route from the control valve to the junction block at the rear of the loader. Figure 20-40-10 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-10] that routes from the control valve to the junction block at the rear of the machine. Disconnect the lift arm bypass drain hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-10] from the control valve. P-90272 1 2 2 P-90273 1 P-90274 1 1 1 P-90275 1 2 20-40-5 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-40-11 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-11] that routes from the bottom of the control valve to the outlet fitting of the hydraulic pump. Figure 20-40-12 Support the control valve and remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-12]. Remove the control valve from the loader. Mount Bracket Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-13 Support the mounting bracket (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-13]. Figure 20-40-14 Remove the two control valve mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-14]. Remove the two frame bolts (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-14] Installation: Torque the two frame bolts (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-14] to 406 - 447 N•m (300 - 330 ft-lb). Remove the control valve bracket from the loader. P-90276 1 P-90278 1 P-90280 1 P-90279 1 2 20-40-6 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Identification Chart Figure 20-40-15 P-90307 A2 A3 B2 B3 D1 C2 C3 J2 E1 E2 E3 E3 D5 D2 D3 C1 B1 A1 F1 F2 H1 H3 G1 G2 J3 F3 F4 MR J1 J4 D4 H2 C4 ITEM S650 LOADER A1 Lift Cylinder Base End A2 Tilt Cylinder Base End A3 Auxiliary Hydraulic Rod End B1 Lift Cylinder Rod End B2 Tilt Cylinder Rod End B3 Auxiliary Hydraulics Base End C1 Load Check C2 Load Check Valve Tilt Function C3 Load Check Valve Auxiliary Function C4 Check Valve D1 Anti-Cavitation Valve Lift (Rod End) D2 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve – 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) Lift (Base End) D3 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve – 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) Tilt (Base End) D4 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve – 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) Tilt (Rod End) D5 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve (Auxiliary) 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) (Optional) ITEM S650 LOADER E1 Lift Spool Detent E2 Tilt Spool Centering Spring E3 Auxiliary Spool/Centering Springs F1 Lift Spool F2 Tilt Spool F3 Lift Spool Lock Solenoid F4 Tilt Spool Lock Solenoid G1 Auxiliary Solenoid Stem G2 Auxiliary Solenoid Stem H1 BICS Solenoid H2 BICS Lock Valve (Tilt) H3 BICS Lock Valve (Lift) J1 Inlet Fluid Flow (From Pump) J2 Outlet Fluid Flow (Return to Tank) J3 Lift Arm Bypass Orifice J4 Drain (Case) MR Main Relief Valve – 24,1 MPa (241,3 bar) (3500 psi) 20-40-7 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Load Check Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-16 Remove the charge tubeline (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-16] from the BICS valve fitting on the top of the lift load check valve. Figure 20-40-17 Remove the lift load check valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40- 17] and fitting from the top of the control valve. Installation: Lubricate the O-ring and threads and tighten to 75 - 88 N•m (55 - 65 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-18 Remove and install new O-rings (Item 1) and back-up ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-18]. Check the free movement load check valve and spring (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-18]. P-90308 1 P-90310 1 P-90309 1 2 3 20-40-8 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Load Check Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt & Auxiliary) Figure 20-40-19 At the front side of the control valve locate the tilt section load check valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-19]. At the front side of the control valve locate the auxiliary section load check valve (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-19]. NOTE: The tilt and auxiliary load check valves are interchangeable. Figure 20-40-20 Remove the spring (Item 1) and poppet (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-20]. Check the orifice (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-20] in the poppet to be sure it is not plugged. Installation: Install a new O-ring (Item 4) [Figure 20-40- 20] on the plug and lightly lubricate with oil before installing. Tighten the plug to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 P-90311 1 2 P-90312 2 3 4 1 20-40-9 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Rod End) Figure 20-40-21 At the back side of the control valve, remove the lift section anti-cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-21]. Figure 20-40-22 Remove the spring (Item 1) and poppet (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-22]. Check the orifice (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-22] in the poppet to be sure it is not plugged. Installation: Install a new O-ring (Item 4) [Figure 20-40- 22] on the plug and lightly lubricate with oil before installing. Tighten the plug to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Base End) Figure 20-40-23 Loosen the lift circuit port relief / anti cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-23]. Figure 20-40-24 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-24] before installation. Installation: Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90314 1 P-90312 2 3 4 1 P-90314 1 P-90315 1 20-40-10 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Base End) Figure 20-40-25 Remove the tilt port relief / anti cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-25] from the base end of the tilt section. Figure 20-40-26 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-26] before installation. Installation: Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Rod End) Figure 20-40-27 Remove the tilt port relief / anti cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-27] from the rod end of the tilt section. Figure 20-40-28 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-28] before installation. Installation: Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90314 1 P-90316 1 P-90314 1 P-90319 1 20-40-11 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Port Relief Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-29 Remove the port relief plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-29] from the auxiliary circuit of the control valve. Figure 20-40-30 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-30]. Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-31 The control valve may be equipped with an optional auxiliary port relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-31]. Remove the auxiliary port relief valve. Figure 20-40-32 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-32]. Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90314 1 P-90318 1 2 P-90318A 1 P-51640 1 20-40-12 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Plug Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-33 At the top side of the control valve, remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-33]. Figure 20-40-34 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-34]. Tighten to 54 N•m (40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-35 At the bottom side of the control valve remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-35]. Figure 20-40-36 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-36]. Tighten to 54 N•m (40 ft-lb) torque. P-68016 1 P-51460A 1 P-51461 1 P-51462 1 20-40-13 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Rubber Boot Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-37 Remove the three screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-37] on the rubber boot retainer plate. Installation: Tighten the screws to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-38 Remove the rubber boots (Item 1) from the retainer plate (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-38]. P-51506 1 1 1 P-51701 1 1 2 20-40-14 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) End Cap Block Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-39 Remove the lift spool lock solenoid (Item 1) and the tilt spool lock solenoid (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-39] from the end cap / spool lock block. Figure 20-40-40 Disconnect the tube line (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-40] from the end cap / spool lock block. Figure 20-40-41 Figure 20-40-42 Remove the four end cap / spool lock block mount screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-41] and [Figure 20-40- 42]. Installation: Tighten the screws to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Remove the rubber boots and retainer plate (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-42] from the lift and tilt spools. Remove the end cap / spool lock block (Item 4) [Figure 20-40-42] from the control valve. P-51697 2 1 P-90320 1 P-51699A 1 1 1 1 P-51701 4 2 1 1 20-40-15 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1278 - Detent Tool MEL1285 - Detent Spring Tool Remove the end cap / spool lock block from the control valve. Figure 20-40-43 Remove the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-43]. Installation: Replace the O-ring, and lubricate the o-ring lightly with grease or oil before installation of the end cap/ spool lock block. Figure 20-40-44 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-44] from the lift spool. Figure 20-40-45 Remove the end cap (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-45]. Figure 20-40-46 Use a screwdriver to remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-46]. Remove the washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-46]. P-51511A 1 P-51512 1 2 P-90321 1 P-51514 1 2 20-40-16 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-47 Remove the screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-47] from the detent bonnet. Remove the detent bonnet (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-47]. Installation: Lubricate the screws and tighten to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. IMPORTANT The detent assembly has small springs and balls. Do not lose these parts during disassembly and assembly. I-2012-0284 Figure 20-40-48 Put a rag around the detent assembly [Figure 20-40-48]. This will prevent the detent balls and spring from being lost when the detent sleeve is removed. Figure 20-40-49 Remove the detent sleeve (Item 1), detent balls (Item 2) and spring (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-49]. P-51515 1 2 1 P-51516 P-51517 1 2 3 2 20-40-17 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-50 Remove the lift spool assembly and seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-50] from the control valve. Figure 20-40-51 Remove the lift spool seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-51] from the linkage end of the valve. Figure 20-40-52 Clamp the linkage end of the spool in a vise [Figure 20- 40-52]. NOTE: Protect spool before clamping in vise. Figure 20-40-53 Install the spring tool (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-53] over the centering spring. NOTE: Be careful when removing the detent adapter (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-53] from the centering spring, as it is under spring pressure. P-51518 1 P-51519 1 P-8988 N-18915 2 1 3 20-40-18 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-54 Put a rag around the detent assembly [Figure 20-40-54]. This will prevent the detent balls and spring from being lost when the detent adapter is removed. Remove the detent adapter with an Alan wrench. Remove the back-up washer (Item 1) and spool seal (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-54]. Figure 20-40-55 Remove the detent adapter (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-55] from the spring assembly. Figure 20-40-56 Remove spring tool (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-56] from the spring assembly. Figure 20-40-57 Inspect the adapter (Item 1), collar (Item 2), spring (Item 3) and washer (Item 4) [Figure 20-40-57]. N-18916 1 2 N-19004 1 N-19009 1 N-18919A 4 3 2 1 20-40-19 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-58 Remove the stud from the end of the spool [Figure 20- 40-58]. Figure 20-40-59 Removal of the plastic plug: Make a center point in the plug using a 1,6 mm (1/16 in) drill. Drill a hole all the way through the plug using a 2,8 mm (7/64 in) tap drill Turn a 6-32 tap (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-59] into the plug. Pull the tap and plug out of the spool. Be careful, do not break the tap. Clean all the debris from inside the spool bore. NOTE: DO NOT USE Loctite® ON THE STUD THREADS. Figure 20-40-60 Install the O-ring (Item 1) over the nipple on the plastic plug (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-60]. NOTE: Check the O-ring for damage. The lift spool will have an internal leak if there is damage to this O-ring. Always replace the O-ring and recheck the lift spool before the control valve is replaced. Figure 20-40-61 Install the plastic plug and O-ring in the spool [Figure 20- 40-61]. N-18918 N-18920 1 N-18961 2 1 N-18963 20-40-20 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-62 Install the stud and tighten until the other end of the stud is out about 15,2 mm (0.600 in) from the spool [Figure 20-40-62]. Figure 20-40-63 Clamp the collar (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-63] in a vice. Figure 20-40-64 Apply grease on all the detent component surfaces before assembly [Figure 20-40-64]. Install the spring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-64] and detent balls (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-64] into the adapter (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-64] and compress with the detent pliers (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-65]. Figure 20-40-65 Install the detent adapter to the collar [Figure 20-40-65]. NOTE: The collar and the detent adapter are held together by spring pressure when assembled to the lift spool not the detent balls. Hold the detent adapter and collar together to prevent the detent balls and spring from falling out. B-14712 Plastic Plug O-ring 15,2 mm (0.60 inch) N-18967 1 N-18958 3 2 1 2 N-18968 1 20-40-21 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-66 Install the spring tool (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-66] over the washer, spring, collar and detent adapter. Figure 20-40-67 Install the spool seal (Item 1) and back-up washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-67]. Figure 20-40-68 Install the spring assembly to the lift spool hand tight [Figure 20-40-68]. Remove the spring tool. Check the alignment of the detent adapter and the washer. Tighten the adapter to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb). NOTE: The adapter must fit in the center of the washer (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-68]. Figure 20-40-69 Install the detent balls and spring [Figure 20-40-69]. N-19004 1 N-18917 1 2 N-19005 1 CD-15051 20-40-22 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-70 Hold the detent balls in place with the detent pliers [Figure 20-40-70]. Figure 20-40-71 Install the detent sleeve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-71] to the detent adapter. Figure 20-40-72 Install the lift spool assembly in the spool bore [Figure 20-40-72]. Install the detent bonnet (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-72]. Install the mounting screws (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-72]. Installation: Lubricate the screws and tighten to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-73 Install the washer (Item 1) and snap ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-73]. N-19007 N-19008 1 P-51515 2 2 1 P-51514 2 1 20-40-23 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-74 Install the end cap (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-74]. Figure 20-40-75 Install the spool seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-75] on the linkage end of the valve. Figure 20-40-76 Install the O-ring (Item 1) and bushing (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-76] on the lift spool. Figure 20-40-77 Install the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-77] on the control valve. P-90321 1 P-51520 1 P-51512 2 1 P-51511A 1 20-40-24 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Spool And Detent Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-78 Install the end cap / spool lock block (Item 1) and the mount bolt (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-78]. Install the lift and tilt spool rubber boots and mount plate (Item 3) and install the three mounting screws (Item 4) [Figure 20-40-78]. Installation: Tighten the screws to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-79 Connect the tubeline (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-79]. Figure 20-40-80 Use an ohmmeter to measure the lock solenoid coils resistance. The correct resistance for the coil is 16.02 - 19.58 ohm. Installation: Install the lift spool (Item 1) and tilt spool (Item 2) lock solenoids and tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque [Figure 20-40-80]. P-51701 1 3 4 2 P-90320 1 P-51697 2 1 20-40-25 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Tilt Spool Removal And Installation Remove the lift and tilt end cap/spool lock block. (See End Cap Block Removal And Installation on Page 20-40- 14.) Figure 20-40-81 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-81] from the tilt spool. Figure 20-40-82 Disconnect the two tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-82] from the spool centering block. Remove the three screws (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-82] from the spool centering block. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-83 Remove the spool centering block (Item 1) [Figure 20- 40-83] from the control valve. Installation: Replace the O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-40- 83] and lubricate the O-ring lightly with grease or oil before installation of the end cap / spool lock block. Figure 20-40-84 Remove the tilt spool, centering spring, back-up washer and spool seal [Figure 20-40-84]. Assembly: Always use a new spool seal. P-51521 1 2 P-90321 2 1 1 2 P-90323 1 2 P-51544 20-40-26 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Tilt Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-40-85 Put the linkage end of the spool in the vice [Figure 20- 40-85]. Install the spool tool (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-85] over the centering spring. Figure 20-40-86 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-86] holding the centering spring to the spool. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Remove spring tool from the spring assembly. Figure 20-40-87 Inspect the adapter (Item 1), collar (Item 2), spring (Item 3) and washer (Item 4) [Figure 20-40-87]. Figure 20-40-88 Remove the spool seal(s) (Item 1) and the back-up washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-88]. Assembly: Always use a new spool seal. N-18942 1 N-19014 1 N-18944A 4 3 2 1 N-18943 P-51545 1 2 1 20-40-27 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Auxiliary Spool Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-89 Remove the two tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-89] from the spool centering block. Remove the three screws (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-89] from the spool centering block. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Remove the spool centering block (Item 3) [Figure 20- 40-89] from the control valve. Figure 20-40-90 Remove the spring (Item 1) and center spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-90] from the auxiliary spool. NOTE: If the centering spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-90] must be replaced, replace the retainer on the opposite end also. Figure 20-40-91 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-91] from the auxiliary spool. Figure 20-40-92 Remove the spring (Item 1) and center spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-92] from the auxiliary spool. NOTE: If the centering spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-92] must be replaced, replace the retainer on the opposite end also. P-90321 2 1 1 2 3 P-51546A 2 1 P-51547 1 2 P-51549A 1 2 20-40-28 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Auxiliary Spool Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-40-93 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-93] from the auxiliary spool. Figure 20-40-94 Remove the spool (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-94]. P-51550 1 2 P-51551 1 20-40-29 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Auxiliary Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-95 Remove the screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-95] from both solenoids. Remove the solenoids (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-95] from the control valve. Installation: Tighten the nut to 2,44 - 2,98 N•m (21.6 - 26.4 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-96 Check and remove the O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-40- 96] from the solenoid stem. Use an ohmmeter to measure the solenoid coil resistance. The correct resistance for the coil is 4.1 - 6.1 ohm. P-85528 1 1 2 2 P-85556 1 20-40-30 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-97 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-97] from the solenoid stem. Installation: Tighten the nut to 6 N•m (53 in-lb) torque. Remove the solenoid coil (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-97]. Figure 20-40-98 Remove the O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-98] from both ends of the solenoid coil. Use an ohmmeter to measure the solenoid coil resistance. The correct resistance for the coil is 9.5 - 10.08 ohm. Figure 20-40-99 Remove the solenoid stem (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-99]. Installation: Lubricate the O-rings and tighten the stem to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-100 Remove the O-rings (Item 1) and back-up rings (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-100] from the stem. Clean all parts in solvent and dry with compressed air. Inspect all parts for wear and replace any showing excessive wear. NOTE: The screen (Item 3) [Figure 20-40-100] may be cleaned with solvent. If it is torn or worn, replace the solenoid valve Use only new O-rings and apply oil to all O-rings and back-up rings before installation. Install new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-98] and [Figure 20-40-100] and new back-up rings (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-100] on the solenoid stem. P-90310 2 1 N-18693A 1 1 P-85528 1 N-18694 2 1 3 20-40-31 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lock Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-101 Locate the two BICS lock valves, (Item 1) is for the tilt circuit and (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-101] is for the lift circuit. Figure 20-40-102 Remove the lift lock valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-102] from the back of the control valve. Installation: Lightly lubricate the lock valve O-rings and tighten to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-103 Remove the O-rings (Item 1) and back-up rings (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-103] from the lift lock valve, and replace with new. Figure 20-40-104 Locate the tilt circuit lock valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40- 104]. P-90310 2 1 P-90321 1 P-51564 1 2 2 2 1 1 1 P-51705 1 20-40-32 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lock Valve Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-40-105 Remove the lift spool lock solenoid (Item 1) [Figure 20- 40-105]. Remove the tilt spool lock solenoid (Item 2) [Figure 20- 40-105]. Installation: Lubricate the O-rings and tighten the spool lock solenoids to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-106 Remove the tilt lock valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-106] from the front of the control valve. Installation: Lightly lubricate the lock valve O-rings and tighten to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-107 Remove the O-rings (Item 1) and back-up rings (Item 2) [Figure 20-40-107] from the tilt lock valve, and replace with new. P-90325 1 2 P-90324 1 P-51564 1 2 2 2 1 1 1 20-40-33 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Lift Arm Bypass Orifice Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-108 Remove the fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-108] from the valve. Figure 20-40-109 Check the lift arm bypass orifice (Item 1) [Figure 20-40- 109]. NOTE: This orifice is not removable from the valve casting. Main Relief Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-110 Remove the main relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40- 110]. Figure 20-40-111 Remove the O-rings from the main relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-111]. Installation: Always use new O-rings. Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90308 1 P-51437 1 P-51707 1 P-51463 1 20-40-34 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) (CONT'D) Check Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-40-112 Remove the tubeline (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-112]. Figure 20-40-113 Remove the check valve fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-40- 113] from the hydraulic control valve. Figure 20-40-114 Installation: Lubricate the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-40- 114] and tighten the fitting to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-40-115 Inspect the screen (Item 1) [Figure 20-40-115]. P-90308 1 P-90310 1 P-68869 1 P-90326 1 20-41-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) Description Figure 20-41-1 The hydraulic control valve is located inside the main frame on the right hand side, below the operator’s cab. The hydraulic control valve is the hydraulic component that uses spools to direct the flow of hydraulic fluid to the lift, tilt and auxiliary functions. The lift and tilt functions in the hydraulic control valve are operated using electronic control handles / levers that send an electronic signal to the electronic actuators to move the lift and tilt spools in the control valve. The auxiliary function is operated by pilot pressure. There is one solenoid located by each side of the spool. Only one solenoid at a time is activated by the switch on the right side control handles / levers. The activated solenoid sends pilot pressure oil to one side of the spool and forces the spool to shift. The hydraulic control valve also contains a main relief valve which is adjustable. Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 P-90337 20-41-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) NOTE: Mark all tubelines, hoses, and electrical connections for correct installation. NOTE: Cap and plug all hydraulic connection points when tubelines or hoses are removed. Clean area around control valve. Open rear door. Figure 20-41-2 Remove the two bolts (Item 1), move the hose clamp (Item 2) to the middle of the hose, and the place the fuel inlet assembly (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-2] off to the side. Figure 20-41-3 The fixed end main valve hose assembly is connected to a fixed end fitting on the control valve. The hose is routed to the junction block at the rear of the loader where it feeds the base end of both lift cylinders. The hose can only be removed by first removing it from the fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-3]. P-90187 2 3 1 P-90267 1 20-41-3 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-4 Disconnect the wire harness connectors (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-4] from the control valve. Disconnect the hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-4] that routes from the control valve to the drain manifold. Disconnect the hose (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-4] that routes from the control valve to the inlet fitting of the hydraulic pump. Figure 20-41-5 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-5] that routes from the control valve to the brake valve. Disconnect the hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-5] that routes from the control valve to the fan motor. Figure 20-41-6 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-6] that routes from the top of the control valve to the hydraulic filter. Figure 20-41-7 Remove the tubeline clamp (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-7]. Disconnect the two tubelines (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-7] that route from the control valve to the front auxiliary hydraulics. P-90269 2 3 1 1 P-90270 2 1 P-90271 1 P-90272 1 2 2 20-41-4 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-8 Remove the tubeline clamp (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-8]. Figure 20-41-9 Disconnect the three tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-9] that route from the control valve to the junction block at the rear of the loader. Figure 20-41-10 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-10] that routes from the control valve to the junction block at the rear of the machine. Disconnect the lift arm bypass drain hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-10] from the control valve. Figure 20-41-11 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-11] that routes from the bottom of the control valve to the outlet fitting of the hydraulic pump. P-90273 1 P-90274 1 1 1 P-90275 1 2 P-90276 1 20-41-5 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-12 Support the control valve and remove the two bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-12]. Remove the control valve from the loader. Actuator Removal And Installation (In Loader) WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Stop the engine. Raise the seat bar. Mark the actuator wiring harness connectors for proper installation. Figure 20-41-13 Unplug the actuator connectors (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 13] from the loader harness. P-90278 1 P-90330 1 20-41-6 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Actuator Removal And Installation (In Loader) (Cont’d) Figure 20-41-14 Remove the two screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-14] from the actuator retainer. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-15 Pull the actuator (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-15] away from the control valve. Use a punch to remove the actuator pin (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-15] from the actuator and spool. Remove the actuator from the hydraulic control valve. NOTE: The calibration procedure must be followed when replacing a lift or tilt actuator. (See Lift And Tilt Calibration (SJC) on Page 60-160-4.) Figure 20-41-16 Inspect the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-16] on the face of the actuator, and replace as needed. Check the linkage pin (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-16] and replace as needed. P-54587 1 P-54566 1 2 P-54568 1 2 20-41-7 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Actuator Removal And Installation (Out Of Loader) Remove the control valve from the loader. Figure 20-41-17 Remove the two mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-17] from the tilt actuator. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-18 Slide the actuator mount bracket (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 18] away from the control valve. Pull the actuator away from the control valve [Figure 20- 41-18]. Figure 20-41-19 Using a punch and a hammer, remove the actuator linkage pin (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-19] from the actuator and the tilt spool. Remove the actuator and linkage pin from the valve. Figure 20-41-20 Inspect the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-20] on the face of the actuator, and replace as needed. Check the linkage pin (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-20] and replace as needed. P-54337 1 1 P-54338 1 P-54339 1 P-54340 1 2 20-41-8 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Actuator Removal And Installation (Out of Loader) (Cont’d) Figure 20-41-21 Remove the two mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-21] from the lift actuator. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-22 Slide the actuator mount bracket (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 22] away from the control valve. Pull the actuator away from the control valve [Figure 20- 41-22]. Figure 20-41-23 Using a punch and a hammer, remove the actuator linkage pin (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-23] from the actuator and the tilt spool. Remove the actuator and linkage pin from the valve. Figure 20-41-24 Inspect the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-24] on the face of the actuator, and replace as needed. Check the linkage pin (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-24] and replace as needed. P-54341 1 1 P-54342 1 P-54343 1 P-54340 1 2 20-41-9 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Actuator Removal And Installation (Out Of Loader) (Cont’d) Figure 20-41-25 NOTE: The two longer bolts (Item 1) are used to mount the lift actuator and end cap (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-25] to the control valve. The two shorter mount bolts (Item 3) are used to mount the tilt actuator to the end cap (Item 4) [Figure 20-41-25]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-25] P-90329 3 1 2 4 3 20-41-10 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Identification Chart Figure 20-41-26 P-90307 A2 A3 B2 B3 D1 C2 C3 J2 E1 E2 E3 E3 D5 D2 D3 C1 B1 A1 F1 F2 H1 H3 G1 G2 J3 F3 F4 MR J1 J4 D4 H2 C4 ITEM S650 LOADER A1 Lift Cylinder Base End A2 Tilt Cylinder Base End A3 Auxiliary Hydraulic Rod End B1 Lift Cylinder Rod End B2 Tilt Cylinder Rod End B3 Auxiliary Hydraulics Base End C1 Load Check C2 Load Check Valve Tilt Function C3 Load Check Valve Auxiliary Function C4 Check Valve D1 Anti-Cavitation Valve Lift (Rod End) D2 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve – 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) Lift (Base End) D3 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve – 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) Tilt (Base End) D4 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve – 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) Tilt (Rod End) D5 Port Relief/Anti-Cavitation Valve (Auxiliary) 27,6 MPa (275,8 bar) (4000 psi) (Optional) ITEM S650 LOADER E1 Lift Spool Detent E2 Tilt Spool Centering Spring E3 Auxiliary Spool/Centering Springs F1 Lift Spool F2 Tilt Spool F3 Lift Spool Lock Solenoid F4 Tilt Spool Lock Solenoid G1 Auxiliary Solenoid Stem G2 Auxiliary Solenoid Stem H1 BICS Solenoid H2 BICS Lock Valve (Tilt) H3 BICS Lock Valve (Lift) J1 Inlet Fluid Flow (From Pump) J2 Outlet Fluid Flow (Return to Tank) J3 Lift Arm Bypass Orifice J4 Drain (Case) MR Main Relief Valve – 24,1 MPa (241,3 bar) (3500 psi) 20-41-11 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Mount Bracket Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-27 Support the mounting bracket (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-27]. Figure 20-41-28 Remove the two control valve mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-28]. Remove the two frame bolts (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-28] Installation: Torque the two frame bolts (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-28] to 406 - 447 N•m (300 - 330 ft lb). Remove the control valve bracket from the loader. Lift Load Check Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-29 Remove the charge tubeline (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-29] from the BICS valve fitting on the top of the lift load check valve. Figure 20-41-30 Remove the lift load check valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 30] and fitting from the top of the control valve. Installation: Lubricate the O-ring and threads and tighten to 75 - 88 N•m (55 - 65 ft-lb) torque. P-90280 1 P-90279 1 2 P-90308 1 P-90310 1 20-41-12 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lift Load Check Valve Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-41-31 Remove and install new O-rings (Item 1) and back-up ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-31]. Check the free movement load check valve and spring (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-31]. IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Load Check Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt & Auxiliary) Figure 20-41-32 At the front side of the control valve locate the tilt section load check valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-32]. At the front side of the control valve locate the auxiliary section load check valve (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-32]. NOTE: The tilt and auxiliary load check valves are interchangeable. Figure 20-41-33 Remove the spring (Item 1) and poppet (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-33]. Check the orifice (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-33] in the poppet to be sure it is not plugged. Installation: Install a new O-ring (Item 4) [Figure 20-41- 33] on the plug and lightly lubricate with oil before installing. Tighten the plug to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90309 1 2 3 P-90311 1 2 P-90312 2 3 4 1 20-41-13 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Rod End) Figure 20-41-34 At the back side of the control valve, remove the lift section anti-cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-34]. Figure 20-41-35 Remove the spring (Item 1) and poppet (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-35]. Check the orifice (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-35] in the poppet to be sure it is not plugged. Installation: Install a new O-ring (Item 4) [Figure 20-41- 35] on the plug and lightly lubricate with oil before installing. Tighten the plug to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Lift, Base End) Figure 20-41-36 Loosen the lift circuit port relief / anti cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-36]. Figure 20-41-37 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-37] before installation. Installation: Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90314 1 P-90312 2 3 4 1 P-90314 1 P-90315 1 20-41-14 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Base End) Figure 20-41-38 Remove the tilt port relief / anti cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-38] from the base end of the tilt section. Figure 20-41-39 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-39] before installation. Installation: Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Port Relief / Anti-Cavitation Valve Removal And Installation (Tilt, Rod End) Figure 20-41-40 Remove the tilt port relief / anti cavitation valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-40] from the rod end of the tilt section. Figure 20-41-41 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-41] before installation. Installation: Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90314 1 P-90316 1 P-90314 1 P-90319 1 20-41-15 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Port Relief Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-42 Remove the port relief plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-42] from the auxiliary circuit of the control valve. Figure 20-41-43 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-43]. Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-44 The control valve may be equipped with an optional auxiliary port relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-44]. Remove the auxiliary port relief valve. Figure 20-41-45 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-45]. Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90314 1 P-90318 1 P-90318A 1 P-51640 1 20-41-16 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Plug Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-46 At the top side of the control valve, remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-46]. Figure 20-41-47 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-47]. Tighten to 81,3 N•m (60 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-48 At the bottom side of the control valve remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-48]. Figure 20-41-49 Installation: Always use new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-49]. Tighten to 81,3 N•m (60 ft-lb) torque. P-68016 1 P-51460A 1 P-51461 1 P-51462 1 20-41-17 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) End Cap Block Removal And Installation Remove the lift and tilt actuators from the control valve. (See Actuator Removal And Installation (In Loader) on Page 20-41-5.) Figure 20-41-50 Disconnect the tube line (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-50] from the end cap block. Remove the two end cap block mount screws (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-50]. Installation: Tighten the screws to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-51 Remove the end cap block (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-51] from the control valve. Lift Spool Removal And Installation The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 1285 - Spring Tool Remove the end cap block from the control valve. Figure 20-41-52 Remove the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-52]. Installation: Replace the O-ring, and lubricate lightly with oil before installation of the end cap block. Figure 20-41-53 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-53] from the lift spool. P-90338 1 2 P-90339 1 P-68042 1 P-68047 1 2 20-41-18 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lift Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-54 Remove the two screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-54] from the lift spool end cap. Installation: Lubricate the screws and tighten to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-55 Remove the lift spool end cap (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-55] from the control valve. Figure 20-41-56 Remove the lift spool assembly and seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-56] from the control valve. Figure 20-41-57 Remove the lift spool seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-57] from the linkage end of the valve. P-68043 1 1 P-68044 1 P-68045 1 P-68046 1 20-41-19 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lift Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-58 Clamp the linkage end of the spool in a vise [Figure 20- 41-58]. NOTE: Protect spool before clamping in vise. Figure 20-41-59 Install the spring tool (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-59] over the centering spring. Figure 20-41-60 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-60] holding the centering spring to the spool. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Remove spring tool from the spring assembly. Figure 20-41-61 Inspect the adapter (Item 1), collar (Item 2), spring (Item 3) and washer (Item 4) [Figure 20-41-61]. P-51772 P-51773 1 N-190146 1 P-51776 4 3 2 1 20-41-20 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lift Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-62 Removal of the plastic plug: Make a center point in the plug using a 1,6 mm (1/16 in) drill. Drill a hole all the way through the plug using a 2,8 mm (7/64 in) tap drill. Turn a 6-32 tap (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-62] into the plug. Pull the tap and plug out of the spool. Be careful, do not break the tap. Clean all the debris from inside the spool bore. NOTE: DO NOT USE Loctite® ON THE STUD THREADS. Figure 20-41-63 Install the O-ring (Item 1) over the nipple on the plastic plug (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-63]. NOTE: Check the O-ring for damage. The lift spool will have an internal leak if there is damage to this O-ring. Always replace the O-ring and recheck the lift spool before the control valve is replaced. Figure 20-41-64 Install the plastic plug and O-ring in the spool [Figure 20- 41-64]. Figure 20-41-65 Remove the spool seal(s) (Item 1) and the back-up washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-65]. Assembly: Always use a new spool seal. N-18920 1 P-74183 2 1 P-74184 P-51775 P-68046 1 2 1 20-41-21 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lift Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-66 Install the lift spool assembly (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-66] in the spool bore. Install the end cap (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-66]. Install the mounting screws (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-66]. Installation: Lubricate the screws and tighten to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-67 Install the spool seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-67] on the linkage end of the valve. Figure 20-41-68 Install the O-ring (Item 1) and bushing (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-68] on the lift spool. Figure 20-41-69 Install the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-69] on the control valve. Installation: Replace the O-ring, lubricate lightly with oil or grease before installation of the end cap block. P-68044 2 3 1 3 P-68048 1 P-68047 2 1 P-68042 1 20-41-22 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lift Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-70 Install the end cap block (Item 1) and the two mount bolts (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-70]. Installation: Tighten the screws to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Connect the tubeline (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-70] to the end cap block. Install the lift and tilt actuators to the control valve. Tilt Spool Removal And Installation Remove the end cap block. (See End Cap Block Removal And Installation on Page 20-41-17.) Figure 20-41-71 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-71] from the tilt spool. Figure 20-41-72 Disconnect the two tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-72]. Remove the three screws (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-72] from the spool centering block. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. P-68040 2 1 3 P-68049 1 2 P-90321 1 1 2 2 20-41-23 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Tilt Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-73 Remove the spool centering block (Item 1) [Figure 20- 41-73] from the control valve. Installation: Replace the O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-41- 73] and lubricate lightly with oil / grease before installation of the end cap block. Figure 20-41-74 Remove the tilt spool, centering spring, back-up washer and spool seal (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-74]. Assembly: Always use a new spool seal. Figure 20-41-75 Put the linkage end of the spool in the vice [Figure 20- 41-75]. Install the spring tool (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-75] over the centering spring. Figure 20-41-76 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-76] holding the centering spring to the spool. Installation: Tighten the bolt to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Remove spring tool from the spring assembly. P-90342 1 2 P-68052 1 N-18942 1 N-19014 1 20-41-24 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Tilt Spool Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-41-77 Inspect the adapter (Item 1), collar (Item 2), spring (Item 3) and washer (Item 4) [Figure 20-41-77]. Figure 20-41-78 Remove the spool seal(s) (Item 1) and the back-up washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-78]. Assembly: Always use a new spool seal. Auxiliary Spool Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-79 Disconnect the two tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-79] from the spool centering block. Remove the three screws (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-79] from the spool centering block. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 10,2 - 11,3 N•m (90 - 100 in-lb) torque. Remove the spool centering block from the control valve. Figure 20-41-80 Remove the spring (Item 1) and center spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-80] from the auxiliary spool. NOTE: If the centering spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-80] must be replaced, replace the retainer on the opposite end also. N-18944A 4 3 2 1 N-18943 P-51545 1 2 1 P-90321 1 1 2 2 P-68053 2 1 20-41-25 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Auxiliary Spool Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-41-81 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-81] from the auxiliary spool. Figure 20-41-82 Remove the spring (Item 1) and center spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-82] from the auxiliary spool. NOTE: If the centering spring retainer (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-82] must be replaced, replace the retainer on the opposite end also. Figure 20-41-83 Remove the spacer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-83] from the auxiliary spool. Figure 20-41-84 Remove the auxiliary spool (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-84]. P-68054 2 1 P-68076 1 2 P-68077 1 2 P-68078 1 20-41-26 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Auxiliary Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-85 Remove the screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-85] from both solenoids. Remove the solenoids (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-85]. Installation: Tighten the screws to 2,44 - 2,98 N•m (21.6 - 26.4 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-86 Check and remove the O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 86] from the solenoid stem. Use an ohmmeter to measure the solenoid coil resistance. The correct resistance for the coil is 4.1 - 6.1 ohm. P-90337 1 1 2 2 P-85556 1 20-41-27 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-87 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-87] from the solenoid stem. Installation: Tighten the nut to 6 N•m (53 in-lb) torque. Remove the solenoid coil (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-87]. Figure 20-41-88 Remove the O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-88] from both ends of the solenoid coil. Use an ohmmeter to measure the solenoid coil resistance. The correct resistance for the coil is 9.5 - 10.08 ohm. Figure 20-41-89 Remove the solenoid stem (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-89]. Installation: Lubricate the O-rings and tighten the stem to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-90 Remove the O-rings (Item 1) and back-up rings (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-90] from the stem. Clean all parts in solvent and dry with compressed air. Inspect all parts for wear and replace any showing excessive wear. NOTE: The screen (Item 3) [Figure 20-41-90] may be cleaned with solvent. If it is torn or worn the solenoid needs to be replaced. Use only new O-rings and apply oil to all O-rings and back-up rings before installation. Install new O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-88] and [Figure 20-41-90] and new back-up rings (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-90] on the solenoid stem. P-90337 1 2 N-18693A 1 1 P-90346 1 N-18694 2 1 3 20-41-28 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lock Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-91 Locate the two BICS lock valves, (Item 1) is for the tilt circuit and (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-91] is for the lift circuit. Figure 20-41-92 Remove the lift lock valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-92] from the back of the control valve. Installation: Lightly lubricate the lock valve O-rings and tighten to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-93 Remove the tilt lock valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-93] from the back of the control valve. Installation: Lightly lubricate the lock valve O-rings and tighten to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-94 Remove the O-rings (Item 1) and back-up rings (Item 2) [Figure 20-41-94] from the valve, and replace with new. P-90310 2 1 P-90321 1 P-51792 1 P-51564 1 2 2 2 1 1 1 20-41-29 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Lift Arm Bypass Orifice Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-95 Remove the fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-95] from the valve. Figure 20-41-96 Check the lift arm bypass orifice (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 96]. NOTE: This orifice is not removable from the valve casting. Main Relief Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-97 Remove the main relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-97]. Figure 20-41-98 Remove the O-rings from the main relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-98]. Installation: Always use new O-rings. Tighten to 52 - 61 N•m (38 - 45 ft-lb) torque. P-90308 1 P-51437 1 P-51794 1 P-90344 1 20-41-30 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) (CONT’D) Check Valve Removal And Installation Figure 20-41-99 Remove the tubeline (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-99]. Figure 20-41-100 Remove the check valve fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 100] from the hydraulic control valve. Figure 20-41-101 Installation: Lubricate the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-41- 101] and tighten the fitting to 27 - 33 N•m (20 - 24 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-41-102 Inspect the screen (Item 1) [Figure 20-41-102]. P-90308 1 P-90310 1 P-68869 1 P-90326 1 20-50-1 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL VALVE Description The lift arm bypass control valve is located on the right side of the machine. The lift arm bypass control valve is manually operated by pulling on the valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-50-1] and turning the knob 90° clockwise. The valve releases the hydraulic fluid from the base end of the lift cylinder(s) which allows the lift arm to slowly come down to the transport position. Testing Figure 20-50-1 Raise the lift arms 2 m (6 ft) off the ground. Stop the engine. Turn the Lift Arm Bypass Control Knob (Item 1) [Figure 20-50-1] 90° clockwise. Then pull up and hold the Lift Arm Bypass Control Knob until the lift arms slowly lower. The knob should return to its normal position. P-85290B 1 P-85290A 20-50-2 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL VALVE (CONT’D) Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Lower the lift arms. Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 20-50-2 Hold the lift arm bypass control knob (Item 1) [Figure 20- 50-2] and loosen the jam nut on the lift arm bypass valve shaft. Remove the lift arm bypass control knob (Item 1). Remove the jam nut (Item 2) from the valve shaft [Figure 20-50-2]. Remove the rubber washer (Item 3) [Figure 20-50-2]. Figure 20-50-3 Disconnect and cap the hydraulic tubeline and hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-50-3]. Remove the two mounting bolts and nuts (Item 2) [Figure 20-50-3]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 21 - 23 N•m (180 - 200 in-lb) torque. Remove the lift arm bypass valve. P-85670 2 3 1 P-85671 1 2 20-50-3 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL VALVE (CONT'D) Bracket Removal And Installation Figure 20-50-4 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-50-4] to replace the bypass valve mounting bracket if necessary. Reverse the removal procedure to install the lift arm bypass valve in the loader. Disassembly And Assembly Figure 20-50-5 Remove the lift arm bypass valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-50- 5] from the valve block. Inspect the bypass valve for damage and replace if necessary. Installation: Tighten the valve to 45 - 50 N•m (33 - 37 ft- lb) torque. Inspect the hydraulic fittings (Item 2) [Figure 20-50-5] on the valve block for damage and replace if necessary. P-85672 1 P-85673 1 2 20-50-4 S650 Service Manual 20-60-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP Description The hydraulic pump is attached to the end of the hydrostatic pumps and is located on the right side of the loader between the hydraulic control valve and the engine. The hydraulic pump is a combination of gear pumps that provide hydraulic flow to several hydraulic systems. The hydraulic pump has a dedicated charge pump. This supplies flow to the hydraulic fan motor and charge pressure to the hydrostatic pump. A seal kit is available to service the hydraulic pump. If any of the main components of the pump are damaged, the entire pump must be replaced. Pump Test At Quick Couplers The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: TWX-RFIK200-S-6 54 U.S. gpm Flow Meter MEL10006 - Fitting Kit Figure 20-60-1 NOTE: When testing the hydraulic flow of a machine, hoses must be at least 19,1 mm (0.75 in) in diameter and connected directly to the hydraulic tester without using any type of “quick coupler” on the connection to the tester. Also make sure your hydraulic tester is capable of at least 189,3 L/min (50 U.S. gpm). Install a hydraulic tester (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-1] onto the front auxiliary quick couplers. This procedure will require one operator in the cab and one operator running the tester. Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Press the Auxiliary hydraulics button. Engage the front auxiliary with the trigger on the right handle or joystick. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*. Warm the fluid to 60°C (140°F) by turning the restrictor control clockwise on the tester so it reads about 6,9 MPa (69 bar) (1000 psi). NOTE: DO NOT EXCEED 25,5 MPa (255 bar) (3700 psi). Turn the restrictor control (Item 2) [Figure 20-60-1] on the tester counterclockwise to obtain free flow, the flow should be approximately 87,1 - 90,8 L/min (23 - 24 U.S. gpm). Start turning the restrictor clockwise, causing more restriction on the flow. The gpm should drop off slightly until the pressure reaches approximately 21,4 MPa (213,7 bar) (3100 psi). At approximately 21,4 MPa (213,7 bar) (3100 psi) the flow should start decreasing rapidly until the pressure reaches 23,8 - 24,1 MPa (237,9 - 241,3 bar) (3450 - 3500 psi). At 23,8 - 24,1 MPa (237,9 - 241,3 bar) (3450 - 3500 psi) the flow should be at zero U.S. gpm. Turn the restrictor (Item 2) [Figure 20-60-1] counterclockwise to free flow. Shut the auxiliary hydraulics off. If flow and pressure specifications are not obtained, go to Direct Pump Testing. (See Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) on Page 20-60-2.) *Refer to (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) for system relief pressure and full RPM. P-90171 11 2 20-60-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1563 or 7003031 - Remote Start Tool TWX-RFIK200-S-6 54 U.S. gpm Flow Meter MEL10006 - Fitting Kit WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) NOTE: The control panel is shown removed for photo clarity. Figure 20-60-2 Disconnect the OUTLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-2] that comes from the gear pump, and connects to the control valve. Figure 20-60-3 Connect the INLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-3] from the tester to the OUTLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-2] of the pump. Connect the OUTLET hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-60-3] from the tester to the control valve fitting (Item 2) [Figure 20-60-2] on the control valve. IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. I-2024-0284 P-90176 1 P-90178 2 1 2 P-90580 1 2 20-60-3 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) (Cont'd) Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*. Warm the fluid to 60°C (140°F) by turning the restrictor control on the tester to about 6,9 MPa (69 bar) (1000 psi). DO NOT exceed system relief pressure. Open the restrictor control and record the free flow (U.S. gpm) at full rpm*. On the remote start tool engage the auxiliary hydraulics, the light will come ON. Pull the trigger on the right handle or joystick for fluid flow to the quick coupler (fluid pressure will go over main relief). Record the highest pressure (psi) and flow (gpm). The high pressure flow must be at least 80% of free flow. A low percentage may indicate a failed pump. *Refer to (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) for system relief pressure and full RPM. HIGH PRESSURE FLOW (U.S. gpm) FREE FLOW (U.S. gpm) % = X 100 20-60-4 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (Charge Section) The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1563 or 7003031 - Remote Start Tool TWX-RFIK200-S-6 54 U.S. gpm Flow Meter MEL10006 - Fitting Kit WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 NOTE: The fluid from the charge pump must be filtered after it passes through the Hydraulic Tester, to prevent any contamination to the Hydrostatic Pumps. Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Open the rear door of the loader. Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) Figure 20-60-4 Disconnect the inlet hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-4]. Figure 20-60-5 Connect the INLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-5] from the tester to the OUTLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-4] of the pump. Connect the OUTLET hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-60-5] from the tester to the inlet fitting on the fan (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-4]. P-85897A 1 P-90580 1 2 20-60-5 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (Charge Section) (Cont’d) IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. I-2024-0284 Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*. Warm the fluid to 60°C (140°F) by turning the restrictor control on the tester to about 4,1 MPa (41,4 bar) (600 psi). DO NOT exceed 8,3 MPa (82,7 bar) (1200 psi). Open the restrictor control and record the free flow (U.S. gpm) at full rpm*. Turn the restrictor down to system operating pressure approximately 6,9 MPa (69 bar) (1000 psi). DO NOT EXCEED 8,3 MPa (82,7 bar) (1200 psi). Refer to Hydraulic Schematics for flow. The high pressure flow must be at least 80% of free flow. A low percentage may indicate a failed pump. *Refer to the Hydraulic Schematics for pump flow and rpm. HIGH PRESSURE FLOW (U.S. gpm) FREE FLOW (U.S. gpm) % = X 100 20-60-6 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Removal And Installation WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Lift and block the rear of the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10-1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic fluid from the reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10- 120-2.) Open the rear door of the loader. Figure 20-60-6 Disconnect and cap the four hoses (Item 1) [Figure 20- 60-6] from the hydraulic pump. Remove the Power Bob-Tach block if equipped. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-130-1.) Figure 20-60-7 Disconnect and cap the outlet hoses (Item 1) [Figure 20- 60-7] from the hydraulic pump. Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 2) [Figure 20-60- 7] from the hydraulic pump. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 75 - 85 N•m (55 - 60 ft-lb) torque. Remove the hydraulic pump (Item 3) [Figure 20-60-7] from the loader. P-90180 1 1 1 1 P-90509 1 1 3 2 2 20-60-7 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-60-8 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-60-8] on the hydraulic pump. Reverse the removal procedure to install the hydraulic pump. Hydraulic Pump Startup NOTE: This procedure is necessary to prevent a dry startup of the hydraulic pump. Fill the system with hydraulic fluid. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Figure 20-60-9 To crank the engine without starting, the machine key switch can be bypassed. Obtain a starter bypass tool from a local source which can be used as a universal connection to remotely crank the engine without starting. The starter bypass tool consists of two wires, each with a clamp. The momentary switch, when depressed, will allow current to pass through the circuit. Connect the starter bypass tool to the starter solenoid battery terminal and S terminal. Crank the engine for 15 seconds, then stop for at least 30 seconds. Again, crank the engine for 15 seconds. Remove the starter bypass tool. Start the loader from the operators cab and run the engine at low idle for 1 - 2 minutes without operating the hydraulics. After operating the engine at low idle, remove the lift arm support device and fully raise and lower the loader lift arms several times or until air is purged from the system. Avoid running over the relief valve setting at the end of cylinder stroke. With the loader parked on a level surface and lift arms down, check and fill the hydraulic reservoir as required. Check for hydraulic leaks. P-43938AP-43940 1 P-59354 Momentary Switch Starter Bypass Tool 20-60-8 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Parts Identification Figure 20-60-10 P-66540 6 5 4 3 2 6 8 7 9 1 10 2 3 12 13 14 6 6 15 16 5 11 4 17 2 2 5 5 18 20-60-9 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (CONT'D) Parts Identification (Cont’d) The items listed below refer to Page 20-60-8 [Figure 20- 60-10]. 1. Auxiliary Pump End Section 2. Section Seal 3. Pre-Load Seal 4. Load Seal 5. Wear Plate 6. Alignment Pins 7. Drive Gear (Auxiliary Pump) 8. Idler Gear (Auxiliary Pump) 9. Auxiliary Pump Center Section 10. Auxiliary Pump End Section 11. Spline Shaft 12. Drive Gear (Charge Pump) 13. Idler Gear (Charge Pump) 14. Charge Pump Center Section 15. Charge Pump End Section 16. Shaft Seal 17. Bolts (4) 18. Bolts (4) Disassembly And Assembly IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Mark the pump sections for correct assembly. To disassemble and assemble the hydraulic pump, follow the Parts Identification page (See Parts Identification on Page 20-60-8.) for proper placement of components along with the information below. NOTE: A seal kit is available through Bobcat Service Parts. Assembly: Tighten the eight pump housing bolts (Item 19) [Figure 20-60-10] to 50 N•m (37 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Position the wear plate (Item 5) [Figure 20-60- 10] inlets and traps as shown with the bronze side toward the gears on all wear plates. NOTE: Inspect all gears, shafts and pump end sections. If any of these components have excessive wear or damage is visible, the complete pump must be replaced. 20-60-10 S650 Service Manual 20-61-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) Description The hydraulic gear pump is attached to the end of the hydrostatic pumps and is located on the right side of the loader between the hydraulic control valve and the engine. The hydraulic gear pump is a combination of gear pumps that provide hydraulic flow to several hydraulic systems. The hydraulic gear pump has a dedicated charge pump. This supplies flow to the hydraulic fan motor and charge pressure to the hydrostatic pump. The high flow hydraulic pump has an additional pump section that provides an additional amount of flow that is controlled by an external valve. The valve is switched from a button on the panel in the cab. A seal kit is available to service the hydraulic pump. If any of the main components of the pump are damaged, the entire pump must be replaced. Pump Test At Quick Couplers The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: TWX-RFIK200-S-6 54 U.S. gpm Flow Meter MEL10006 - Fitting Kit Figure 20-61-1 NOTE: When testing the hydraulic flow of a machine, hoses must be at least 19,1 mm (0.75 in) in diameter and connected directly to the hydraulic tester without using any type of “quick coupler” on the connection to the tester. Also make sure your hydraulic tester is capable of at least 189,3 L/min (50 U.S. gpm). Install a hydraulic tester (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-1] onto the front auxiliary quick couplers. This procedure will require one operator in the cab and one operator running the tester. Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Press the Auxiliary hydraulics button. Engage the front auxiliary with the trigger on the right handle or joystick. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*. Warm the fluid to 60°C (140°F) by turning the restrictor control clockwise on the tester so it reads about 6,9 MPa (69 bar) (1000 psi). NOTE: DO NOT EXCEED 25,5 MPa (255 bar) (3700 psi). Turn the restrictor control (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-1] on the tester counterclockwise to obtain free flow, the flow should be approximately 87,1 - 90,8 L/min (23 - 24 U.S. gpm). Start turning the restrictor clockwise, causing more restriction on the flow. The gpm should drop off slightly until the pressure reaches approximately 21,4 MPa (213,7 bar) (3100 psi). At approximately 21,4 MPa (213,7 bar) (3100 psi) the flow should start decreasing rapidly until the pressure reaches 23,8 - 24,1 MPa (237,9 - 241,3 bar) (3450 - 3500 psi). At 23,8 - 24,1 MPa (237,9 - 241,3 bar) (3450 - 3500 psi) the flow should be at zero U.S. gpm. Turn the restrictor (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-1] counterclockwise to free flow. Shut the auxiliary hydraulics off. If flow and pressure specifications are not obtained, go to Direct Pump Testing. (See Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) on Page 20-61-2.) *Refer to (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) for system relief pressure and full RPM. P-90171 11 2 20-61-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1563 or 7003031 - Remote Start Tool TWX-RFIK200-S-6 54 U.S. gpm Flow Meter MEL10006 - Fitting Kit WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) NOTE: The control panel is shown removed for photo clarity. Figure 20-61-2 Disconnect the OUTLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-2] that comes from the gear pump, and connects to the control valve. Figure 20-61-3 Connect the INLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-3] from the tester to the OUTLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-2] of the pump. Connect the OUTLET hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-3] from the tester to the control valve fitting (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-2] on the control valve. P-90176 1 P-90178 2 1 2 P-90580 1 2 20-61-3 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (Standard Section) (Cont'd) Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*. Warm the fluid to 60°C (140°F) by turning the restrictor control on the tester to about 6,9 MPa (69 bar) (1000 psi). DO NOT exceed system relief pressure. Open the restrictor control and record the free flow (U.S. gpm) at full rpm*. On the remote start tool engage the auxiliary hydraulics, the light will come ON. Pull the trigger on the right handle or joystick for fluid flow to the quick coupler (fluid pressure will go over main relief). Record the highest pressure (psi) and flow (gpm). The high pressure flow must be at least 80% of free flow. A low percentage may indicate a failed pump. *Refer to (See Hydraulic System on Page SPEC-10-3.) for system relief pressure and full RPM. Direct Pump Test (Charge Section) The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1563 or 7003031 - Remote Start Tool TWX-RFIK200-S-6 54 U.S. gpm Flow Meter MEL10006 - Fitting Kit WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 NOTE: The fluid from the charge pump must be filtered after it passes through the Hydraulic Tester, to prevent any contamination to the Hydrostatic Pumps. Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Open the rear door of the loader. Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) HIGH PRESSURE FLOW (U.S. gpm) FREE FLOW (U.S. gpm) % = X 100 20-61-4 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (Charge Section) (Cont’d) Figure 20-61-4 Disconnect the inlet hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-4]. Figure 20-61-5 Connect the INLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-5] from the tester to the OUTLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-4] of the pump. Connect the OUTLET hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-5] from the tester to the inlet fitting on the fan (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-4]. IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. I-2024-0284 Start the engine and run at low idle RPM. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full RPM*. Warm the fluid to 60°C (140°F) by turning the restrictor control on the tester to about 4,1 MPa (41,4 bar) (600 psi). DO NOT exceed 8,3 MPa (82,7 bar) (1200 psi). Open the restrictor control and record the free flow (U.S. gpm) at full rpm*. Turn the restrictor down to system operating pressure approximately 6,9 MPa (69 bar) (1000 psi). DO NOT EXCEED 8,3 MPa (82,7 bar) (1200 psi). Refer to Hydraulic Schematics for flow. The high pressure flow must be at least 80% of free flow. A low percentage may indicate a failed pump. *Refer to the Hydraulic Schematics for pump flow and rpm. P-85897A 1 P-90580 1 2 HIGH PRESSURE FLOW (U.S. gpm) FREE FLOW (U.S. gpm) % = X 100 20-61-5 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (High Flow Section) WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 IMPORTANT The hydraulic tester must be in the fully open position before you start the engine. I-2024-0284 The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1563 or 7003031 - Remote Start Tool MEL10003 - Hydraulic Tester MEL10006 - Hydraulic Test Kit Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Open the rear door of the loader. Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) Figure 20-61-6 Install a jumper hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-6] onto the front auxiliary quick couplers. Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) P-90186 1 20-61-6 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Direct Pump Test (High Flow Section) (Cont'd) Figure 20-61-7 Disconnect the high flow pump OUTLET hose (Item 1) from the high flow check valve INLET fitting (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-7]. Figure 20-61-8 Connect the INLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-8] from the tester, to the high flow pump OUTLET hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-7]. Connect the OUTLET hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-8] from the tester, to the high flow check valve INLET fitting (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-7]. Lower the cab. Start the engine and run at low idle rpm. Press the front auxiliary button. Press the High Flow button. Push the button (on the right control lever) for fluid flow to the quick coupler. Make sure the tester is connected correctly. If no flow is indicated on the tester, the hoses are connected wrong. With the hoses connected correctly, increase the engine speed to full rpm*. Warm the fluid to 60°C (140°F) by turning the restrictor control on the tester to about 6,9 MPa (69 bar) (1000 psi). NOTE: DO NOT EXCEED 3700 PSI. Open the restrictor control and record the free flow (U.S. gpm) at full rpm. Increase the restriction and the flow should drop to zero U.S. gpm between 24,1 MPa (241,3 bar) (3500 psi) and 25,5 MPa (255,1 bar) (3700 psi). If pressure readings are not obtained go to the High Flow Valve, relief valve adjustment procedure.(See High Flow Relief Valve Removal And Installation on Page 20-61-8.) Record the highest pressure (psi) and flow (U.S. gpm). The high pressure flow must be at least 80% of free flow. A low percentage may indicate a failed pump. *Refer to Hydraulic Schematics for system relief pressure and full rpm. P-90183 1 2 P-90580 1 2 %= HIGH PRESSURE FLOW (U.S. gpm) X100 FREE FLOW (U.S. gpm) 20-61-7 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) High Flow Relief Valve Adjustment If the pump is unable to reach 3500 PSI stop the engine. The relief screw (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-11] will need to be turned clockwise 90° and retested with the procedure above. (90° equals approximately 1,4 MPa (13,8 bar) (200 PSI).) NOTE: If the relief screw has been turned in 1/4 turn and the pressure remains the same, go to the high flow relief valve removal and installation section. (See High Flow Relief Valve Removal And Installation on Page 20-61-8.) If relief valve has been checked and is OK, go to the high flow pump disassembly and assembly section. (See Disassembly And Assembly on Page 20-61-13.) Remove right rear wheel. (See Wheel Nuts on Page 10- 160-1.) Figure 20-61-9 Remove the mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-9] from the access cover and remove the cover from the loader. Figure 20-61-10 Locate the high flow relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-61- 10] along the right side of the engine. Remove the plug (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-10] located on the bottom of the high flow relief valve. Figure 20-61-11 NOTE: [Figure 20-61-11] shows adjusting the relief screw. If the pump reaches 25,5 MPa (255,1 bar) (3700 psi) and there is flow stop the engine. The relief screw must be turned 90° counterclockwise and retested with the procedure above. P-90577 1 P-45443 1 2 P-45445 1 20-61-8 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) High Flow Relief Valve Removal And Installation WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Remove right rear wheel. (See Wheel Nuts on Page 10- 160-1.) Figure 20-61-12 Remove the mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-12] from the access cover and remove the cover from the loader. Figure 20-61-13 Locate the high flow relief valve through rear door along the right side of the engine. Remove the relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-13] from the pump. Installation: Tighten the relief valve to 41 - 47 N•m (30 - 35 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-61-14 Inspect the relief valve and replace the two O-rings (Item 1) and washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-14]. If the relief valve is bad, it must be replaced as a complete unit. Remove the plug (Item 3) and inspect the O-ring [Figure 20-61-14] damage and replace as needed. P-90577 1 P-45444 1 P-45459 1 1 2 3 20-61-9 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 20-61-15 At the right side access hole, disconnect the electrical connector (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-15] from the high flow pump solenoid. Figure 20-61-16 Remove the solenoid nut (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-16]. Remove the solenoid (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-16]. Installation: Tighten the solenoid nut to 5 - 8 N•m (48 - 72 in-lb) Figure 20-61-17 NOTE: Mark the pump housing (Item 1) [Figure 20-61- 17] for proper installation of the solenoid valve cartridge. Remove the valve cartridge (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-17]. Installation: Tighten the solenoid valve to 47 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb). Figure 20-61-18 Inspect the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-18] and replace as needed. Inspect the O-ring and back-up washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-61-18] and replace as needed. P-43958 1 P-45460 1 2 P-45461 2 1 P-45462 2 1 20-61-10 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Lift and block the rear of the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10-1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic fluid from the reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10- 120-2.) Open the rear door of the loader. Figure 20-61-19 Disconnect and cap the inlet hoses (Item 1) [Figure 20- 61-19] from the front of the hydraulic pump. Figure 20-61-20 Disconnect and cap the hoses (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-20] from the back of the hydraulic pump. Remove the Power Bob-Tach block if equipped. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-61-10.) P-90184 1 1 1 1 P-90185 1 20-61-11 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-61-21 Disconnect and cap the outlet hoses (Item 1) [Figure 20- 61-21] from the hydraulic pump. Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 2) [Figure 20-61- 21] from the hydraulic pump. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 75 - 85 N•m (55 - 60 ft-lb) torque. Remove the hydraulic pump (Item 3) [Figure 20-61-21] from the loader. Figure 20-61-22 Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-61-22] on the hydraulic pump. Reverse the removal procedure to install the hydraulic pump. Hydraulic Pump Startup NOTE: This procedure is necessary to prevent a dry startup of the hydraulic pump. Fill the system with hydraulic fluid. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Figure 20-61-23 To crank the engine without starting, the machine key switch can be bypassed. Obtain a starter bypass tool from a local source which can be used as a universal connection to remotely crank the engine without starting. The starter bypass tool consists of two wires, each with a clamp. The momentary switch, when depressed, will allow current to pass through the circuit. Connect the starter bypass tool to the starter solenoid battery terminal and S terminal. Crank the engine for 15 seconds, then stop for at least 30 seconds. Again, crank the engine for 15 seconds. Remove the starter bypass tool. Start the loader from the operators cab and run the engine at low idle for 1 - 2 minutes without operating the hydraulics. After operating the engine at low idle, remove the lift arm support device and fully raise and lower the loader lift arms several times or until air is purged from the system. Avoid running over the relief valve setting at the end of cylinder stroke. With the loader parked on a level surface and lift arms down, check and fill the hydraulic reservoir as required. Check for hydraulic leaks. P-90509A 1 1 2 2 3 P-43938AP-43940 1 P-59354 Momentary Switch Starter Bypass Tool 20-61-12 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Parts Identification Figure 20-61-24 6 MS1456S 22 1. Stem 2. Valve 3. Wear Plate 4. Seal Section 5. Rear Housing 6. Bolt 7. Pre-load Seal 8. Load Seal 9. Spline Connector 10. Pin 11. Gear Set 12. Gear Housing 13. Gear Housing 14. Gear Set 15. Gear Housing 16. Gear Set 17. Center Housing 18. Center Housing 19. Front Housing 20. Shaft Seal 21. High Flow Relief 22. Seal 23. Nut 24. Coil 5 1 21 22 4 3 3 3 3 3 4 4 7 8 9 8 7 4 4 4 7 8 4 2 10 10 11 12 17 10 10 10 10 16 15 13 14 18 19 20 24 23 9 20-61-13 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Mark the pump sections for correct assembly. To disassemble and assemble the hydraulic pump, follow the Parts Identification page (See Parts Identification on Page 20-61-12.) for proper placement of components along with the information below. NOTE: A seal kit is available through Bobcat Service Parts. Assembly: Tighten the eight pump housing bolts (Item 6) [Figure 20-61-24] to 50 N•m (37 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Position the wear plate (Item 3) [Figure 20-61- 19] inlets and traps as shown with the bronze side toward the gears on all wear plates. NOTE: Inspect all gears, shafts and pump end sections. If any of these components have excessive wear or damage is visible, the complete pump must be replaced. NOTE: The relief valve and the solenoid can be replaced along with the o-rings and back-up washers. 20-61-14 S650 Service Manual 20-70-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FILTERS Description The hydraulic / hydrostatic filters help to remove contaminants from the fluid when the hydraulic / hydrostatic systems are operating. The hydraulic / hydrostatic filter system consists of one main filter and one charge flow filter. The main filter removes contaminants before entering gear pumps including oil returning from the main valve. The charge flow filter removes contaminants after the charge pump. Housing Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Figure 20-70-1 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the fluid from the reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Disconnect the electrical connector (Item 1) [Figure 20- 70-1] from the hydraulic / hydrostatic filter sender. Disconnect and plug the three hoses (Item 2) [Figure 20- 70-1] from the hydraulic / hydrostatic filter housing. P-90010 1 2 2 2 20-70-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FILTERS (CONT’D) Housing Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-70-2 Remove and plug the two hoses (Item 1) [Figure 20-70- 2] from the bottom of the hydraulic / hydrostatic filter housing. Figure 20-70-3 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-70-3]. Remove the hydraulic / hydrostatic filter housing from the loader. P-90011 1 P-90537 1 1 20-80-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC FLUID RESERVOIR Description The hydraulic fluid reservoir is a storage container for the loader’s hydraulic / hydrostatic fluid. The reservoir contains a vented fill cap with a fluid screen to prevent contaminants from entering the reservoir while adding fluid. The hydraulic fluid reservoir is located behind the operator’s cab under the rear grille on the right side of the loader. Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the fluid from the reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Remove the Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Filter Housing (See Housing Removal And Installation on Page 20-70-1.) Remove the rear grille (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-60-1.) Figure 20-80-1 Remove the clamp and the hose (Item 1) [Figure 20-80- 1]. Figure 20-80-2 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-80-2]. Remove the hydraulic fluid reservoir from the loader. Installation: Tighten the mount bolts and nuts to 21,7 - 24,4 N•m (16 - 18 ft-lb) torque. P-90013 1 P-90579 1 20-80-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC FLUID RESERVOIR (CONT'D) Hydraulic Fluid Screen Remove the rear grille (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-60-1.) Figure 20-80-3 Remove the hydraulic fluid reservoir breather cap [Figure 20-80-3] from the reservoir. Remove the hydraulic fluid screen (Item 1) [Figure 20- 80-3] from the reservoir. Wash the screen in clean solvent and air dry, before replacing. P-90506 1 20-90-1 S650 Service Manual OIL COOLER Description The oil cooler is used to cool the loaders hydraulic and hydrostatic oil. Oil passages are coiled into a heat exchanger. Air is forced, with the cooling fan, around the passages cooling the oil. The oil cooler is located underneath the rear grille between the A/C condenser (if so equipped) and the radiator. Removal And Installation IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Remove the rear grille from the loader. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-60-1.) Figure 20-90-1 Slide the plastic sleeve (Item 1) away from the oil cooler (Item 2). Remove the clip (Item 3) [Figure 20-90-1] and pull hose out. Cap or plug all hoses and fittings. Figure 20-90-2 Slide the plastic sleeve (Item 1) away from the oil cooler (Item 2). Remove the clip (Item 3) [Figure 20-90-2] and pull hose out. Cap or plug all hoses and fittings. Figure 20-90-3 Undo the rubber straps (Item 1) [Figure 20-90-3] Remove the bolts (Item 2) and remove the condenser guards (Item 3) [Figure 20-90-3]. Remove the clips and pins (Item 4) [Figure 20-90-3]. Remove the bolt (Item 5) [Figure 20-90-3] from the prop rod. NOTE: When installing the cooler hoses, the fittings should make a clicking sound when pushed together. Lift up the oil cooler and remove the cooler from the loader. P-85938 1 2 3 P-90589 1 2 3 P-90501 1 2 2 4 4 3 5 20-90-2 S650 Service Manual 20-100-1 S650 Service Manual BUCKET POSITION VALVE Description The Bucket Position Valve is an option that allows the operator to hold the attachment at the same angle from the ground to maximum lift height without using the tilt function. The bucket position valve is mounted to the inside lower right rear side of the loader frame. See Hydraulic Schematic for more circuit information. Solenoid Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Figure 20-100-1 Remove the two bolts (Item 1), move the hose clamp (Item 2) to the middle of the hose, and the place the fuel inlet assembly (Item 3) [Figure 20-100-1] off to the side. Cover the fuel tank inlet. Figure 20-100-2 Disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 20-100-2] from the bucket position shut-off solenoid. Disconnect the cap the two tubelines (Item 2) [Figure 20- 100-2]. Remove the solenoid nut, coil, and stem (Item 3) from the bucket positioning valve [Figure 20-100-2]. Installation: Put oil on O-rings and back-up washers and tighten the solenoid stem to 40,7 - 50,2 N•m (30 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Installation: Tighten the solenoid nut to 8 N•m (6 ft-lb) torque. Overtightening may cause valve failure. NOTE: The engine is shown removed for photo clarity. Figure 20-100-3 Inspect the solenoid stem and replace the O-rings (Item 1) and the back-up washer (Item 2) [Figure 20-100-3]. P-90187 2 3 1 P-90197 1 2 3 N-18191 1 2 20-100-2 S650 Service Manual BUCKET POSITION VALVE (CONT'D) Solenoid Testing Refer to Bobcat Advanced Troubleshooting System (B.A.T.S.) for electrical testing and troubleshooting information. It is recommended that these procedures be performed by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Figure 20-100-4 Remove the two bolts (Item 1), move the hose clamp (Item 2) to the middle of the hose, and the place the fuel inlet assembly (Item 3) [Figure 20-100-4] off to the side. Cover the fuel tank inlet. Figure 20-100-5 NOTE: The engine is shown removed for photo clarity. NOTE: Mark all hoses and tubelines for correct installation. Disconnect the electric solenoid connector (Item 1) [Figure 20-100-5]. Figure 20-100-6 Disconnect and cap the tilt base inlet hose (Item 1), the tilt rod inlet hose (Item 2), the lift rod inlet hose (Item 3), and the lift base inlet hose (Item 4) [Figure 20-100-6] that route from the control valve. P-90187 2 3 1 P-90197 1 P-90188 1 2 3 4 20-100-3 S650 Service Manual BUCKET POSITION VALVE (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-100-7 Disconnect and cap the tilt cylinder hose (Item 1) and the tilt cylinder base end hose (Item 2) [Figure 20-100-7] from the valve block. Figure 20-100-8 Disconnect and cap the lift base outlet hose and tubeline (Item 1) and the lift rod outlet hose and tubeline (Item 2) [Figure 20-100-8] that route from the lift cylinders. Figure 20-100-9 Remove the mounting screws (Item 1) [Figure 20-100- 9]. Remove the bucket position valve from the loader. P-90189A 1 2 P-90197A 1 2 2 1 P-90190A 1 20-100-4 S650 Service Manual BUCKET POSITION VALVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly Figure 20-100-10 Remove the solenoid nut (Item 1), coil (Item 2), and the stem (Item 3) [Figure 20-100-10]. Assembly: Tighten the nut to a maximum of 8 N•m (6 ft- lb) torque. Overtightening may cause valve failure. Assembly: Put oil on O-rings and back-up washers and tighten the solenoid stem to 40,7 - 50,2 N•m (30 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-100-11 Remove the flow adjustment valve and O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 20-100-11]. Assembly: Tighten the flow adjustment valve to 36,6 - 48,8 N•m (27 - 36 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Always install new O-rings before any parts are installed into the valve. Inspect the parts for wear or damage and replace as needed. Figure 20-100-12 Remove the tilt cylinder check valve (Item 1), spring (Item 2), and plug (Item 3) [Figure 20-100-12]. Inspect for wear, inspect the O-ring and replace as needed. Assembly: Tighten the plug to 75,9 - 86,8 N•m (56 - 64 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-100-13 Remove the plug (Item 1), spring (Item 2) and unloading spool (Item 3) [Figure 20-100-13]. Inspect all parts and replace as needed. Install a new O- ring on the plug before installing. Assembly: Tighten the plug to torque. P-90192 1 2 3 P-90195 1 P-90194 3 1 2 P-90193 1 2 3 20-110-1 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE Description The rear auxiliary diverter valve is an optional valve that diverts oil from the main valve inlet to two sets of rear auxiliary couplers. The couplers are used for rear mounted attachments.The right side auxiliaries are used for older attachments. The rear couplers are located, one set on each side of the rear frame uprights. See Hydraulic Schematic for more circuit information. Solenoid Testing Figure 20-110-1 Use a test meter to measure coil resistance [Figure 20- 110-1]. Coil wires do not have polarity. Correct resistance is 8.6 - 9.5 ohm. Replace the test meter with 12 volt power. You can see and hear the spool shift. P9137 20-110-2 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE (CONT'D) Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 Put jackstands under the rear corners of the loader. Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Figure 20-110-2 Disconnect and cap the tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20- 110-2] Figure 20-110-3 Disconnect and cap the tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 20- 110-3] Figure 20-110-4 Disconnect the accessory wiring harness (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-4] from the main harness. P-90583 1 P-93303 1 1 P-93312 1 20-110-3 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 20-110-5 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) and remove the valve (Item 2) [Figure 20-110-5] Disassembly And Assembly Figure 20-110-6 Figure 20-110-7 Clean the diverter valve to remove dirt before disassembly. Valve ports are labeled for correct assembly. Several plugs (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-6] and [Figure 20- 110-7] are located all over the diverter valve and can be removed for clean out purposes. Assembly: Put oil on O-rings and back-up washers. Tighten to 13,6 N•m (10 ft-lb) torque. P-90581 1 2 P-48751 1 1 P-48752 1 20-110-4 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 20-110-8 Figure 20-110-9 Remove the shuttle valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-8] and [Figure 20-110-9] from diverter valve and inspect the O- rings and back-up washers (Item 2) [Figure 20-110-9] for damage. Assembly: Put oil on the O-rings and back-up washers. Tighten to 14 - 16 N•m (10 - 12 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-110-10 Figure 20-110-11 Remove the differential sensing valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-10] and [Figure 20-110-11] from diverter valve and inspect the O-rings and back-up washers (Item 2) [Figure 20-110-11] for damage. Assembly: Put oil on O-ring and back-up washers. Tighten to 68 - 75 N•m (50 - 55 ft-lb) torque. P-48755 1 P-48756 2 2 2 1 P-48755 1 P-48757 1 2 2 20-110-5 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-110-12 Figure 20-110-13 Remove the relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-12] and [Figure 20-110-13] from the diverter valve and inspect the O-rings and back-up washers (Item 2) [Figure 20- 110-13] for damage. Assembly: Put oil on O-ring and back-up washers. Tighten to 27 - 34 N•m (20 - 25 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-110-14 Figure 20-110-15 NOTE: Before removing the solenoid coils mark the coils for proper alignment. Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-14] and [Figure 20-110-15] from the solenoid valve stem. Assembly: Tighten the nut to 5 - 8 N•m (4 - 6 ft-lb) torque. Remove the spacer (Item 2) and solenoid valve coils (Item 3) [Figure 20-110-15]. P-48753 1 P-48754 1 2 P-48759 1 P-48760 1 2 3 20-110-6 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-110-16 NOTE: Before removing the solenoid coils mark the coils for proper alignment. Remove the nuts (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-16] from the solenoid valve stems. Assembly: Tighten the nut to 5 - 8 N•m (4 - 6 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-110-17 Figure 20-110-18 Remove the solenoid valve stem (Item 1) [Figure 20- 110-17] and [Figure 20-110-18] and inspect the O-rings and back-up washers (Item 2) [Figure 20-110-18] for damage. Assembly: Put oil on O-rings and back-up washers. Tighten to 27 - 34 N•m (20 - 25 ft-lb) torque. P-48761 1 P-48762 1 P-48763 1 1 2 2 20-110-7 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-110-19 Figure 20-110-20 Remove the solenoid valve stem (Item 1) [Figure 20- 110-19] & [Figure 20-110-20] and inspect the O-rings and back-up washers (Item 2) [Figure 20-110-20] for damage. Assembly: Put oil on O-rings and back-up washers. Tighten to 41 - 47 N•m (30 - 35 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-110-21 Remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-21]. Assembly: Tighten the plug to 51,5 N•m (38 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-110-22 Remove and inspect the orifice (Item 1) [Figure 20-110- 22] for dirt and debris. Assembly: Tighten the orifice to 29,8 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. P-48763A 1 P-48764 1 2 P-48765 1 P-48766 1 20-110-8 S650 Service Manual REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-110-23 Remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-23]. Assembly: Tighten the plug to 13,6 N•m (10 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-110-24 Remove the orifice (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-24]. Assembly: Tighten the orifice to 4,5 N•m (3.3 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-110-25 Remove the plugs (Item 1) [Figure 20-110-25]. Assembly: Tighten the plug to 19 N•m (14 ft-lb) torque. Inspect cartridges, check valves, solenoid valves and sealing washers for contamination or damage. Wash all parts in clean solvent. Use air pressure for drying them. Install new O-rings and back-up washers. Inspect diverter valve cavities for contamination. Wash valve in clean solvent. Use air pressure to dry. P-48765 1 P-48786 1 P-48758 1 20-120-1 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK Description The power Bob-Tach is an option that allows the operator to hydraulically control the Bob-Tach levers for mounting and dismounting the attachments. The power Bob-Tach is operated by a switch on the right switch panel. The power Bob-Tach block is mounted on the right side of the machine in front of the engine on the back side of the hydraulic pump. Removal And Installation WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 20-120-2 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 20-120-1 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Disconnect and cap the two electrical solenoid connectors (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-1] from the loader electrical harness. Figure 20-120-2 Mark the hydraulic hoses for proper installation. Disconnect and cap the outlet hose (Item 1) [Figure 20- 120-2] from block. Remove the hydraulic muffler (if equipped) (Item 2) [Figure 20-120-2] from block. Disconnect and cap the hoses (Item 3) [Figure 20-120-2] from block. Remove the four mounting bolts (Item 4) [Figure 20-120- 2] from block. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Remove the power Bob-Tach block. P-90968 1 P-90969 3 2 1 3 3 4 20-120-3 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly Figure 20-120-3 Clean the block (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-3] to remove dirt before disassembly. Block ports are labeled for correct assembly. Remove the plug (Item 2) [Figure 20-120-3]. Installation: Tighten the plug to 34 - 40,6 N•m (25 - 30 ft- lb) torque. IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 20-120-4 Remove the spring guide (Item 1), spring (Item 2) and the spool (Item 3) [Figure 20-120-4]. Inspect the O-ring (Item 4) [Figure 20-120-4] on the plug and replace as needed. Figure 20-120-5 NOTE: This plug is a zero leak plug and should not be removed. If removed damage may occur and the plug and O-ring must be replaced. Do not remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-5]. Installation: Tighten the plug to 16,3 - 19 N•m (12 - 14 ft- lb) torque. P-48115 1 2 P-48120 1 2 4 3 P-48116 1 20-120-4 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-120-6 Remove the check valve (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-6]. Installation: Oil the check valve and O-rings and tighten the check valve to 27,1 - 34 N•m (20 - 25 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-120-7 Inspect the check valve (Item 1) and piston assembly (Item 2) [Figure 20-120-7]. Inspect the O-rings and back-up washers (Item 3) [Figure 20-120-7] on the check valve and piston assembly and replace as needed. Figure 20-120-8 Do not remove the plugs (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-8]. NOTE: Do not remove plugs. If the plugs are removed the internal pressure relieving spring setting will be altered. Figure 20-120-9 Remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-9], inspect the O-ring and replace as needed. Installation: Tighten the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-9] to 16,3 - 19 N•m (12 - 14 ft-lb) torque. P-48382 1 P-48119 1 2 3 P-48122 1 P-48384 1 20-120-5 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-120-10 Remove the orifice screw (Item 2) located behind the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-10]. Installation: Tighten the orifice screw (Item 2) [Figure 20-120-10] to 8,1 - 10,8 N•m (6 - 8 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-120-11 NOTE: This plug is a zero leak plug and should not be removed. If removed damage may occur and the plug and O-ring must be replaced. Do not remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-11]. Remove the solenoid nut (Item 2) [Figure 20-120-11]. Installation: Tighten the solenoid valve stem nut to 1,7 - 5,1 N•m (15 - 45 in-lb) torque. Figure 20-120-12 Remove the first solenoid coil (Item 1) and the second solenoid coil (Item 2) [Figure 20-120-12]. NOTE: Remember the solenoid coil orientation for ease of installation. Figure 20-120-13 Remove the solenoid stem (Item 1) [Figure 20-120-13]. Installation: Tighten the solenoid stem to 27,1 - 34 N•m (20 - 25 ft-lb) torque. P-48664 2 1 P-48127 1 2 P-48106A 1 2 P-48386 1 20-120-6 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 20-120-14 Remove the armature assembly (Item 1) [Figure 20-120- 14]. Figure 20-120-15 Inspect the solenoid stem (Item 1), armature assembly (Item 2) and the spool (Item 3) for damage [Figure 20- 120-15]. NOTE: If the solenoid stem is damaged (Item 1) inspect the armature assembly (Item 2) for damage. The armature assembly (Item 2) and spool (Item 3) are non-serviceable parts. If they are damaged, order a new power Bob-Tach block assembly from Bobcat parts [Figure 20-120- 15]. Figure 20-120-16 Remove the screened orifice plug (Item 1) [Figure 20- 120-16]. Installation: Tighten the screened orifice plug to 14,9 - 16,3 N•m (11 - 12 ft-lb) torque. Figure 20-120-17 Inspect the screened orifice plug (Item 1) [Figure 20- 120-17] for damage replace as needed. If the screened orifice plug is blocked replace with a new plug. Inspect the O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 20-120-17] and replace as needed. P-48175 1 P-48173 1 3 2 P-48174 1 P-48138 1 2 20-130-1 S650 Service Manual FRONT AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC COUPLER BLOCK Description The front auxiliary hydraulic coupler block is the connection block that houses the two main auxiliary couplers along with a case drain coupler. These couplers are for suppling hydraulic flow for various attachments. The front auxiliary coupler block is located at the front of the left side lift arm. Removal And Installation IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 20-130-1 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 20-130- 1]. Pull the block away from the lift arms and disconnect the auxiliary hoses from the coupler block [Figure 20-130-1]. Disassembly And Assembly Figure 20-130-2 Figure 20-130-3 P-85281 1 1 P-90002 2 3 1 P-90003 2 3 1 20-130-2 S650 Service Manual FRONT AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC COUPLER BLOCK (CONT’D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 20-130-4 Remove the male coupler, spring, and fitting (Item 1) [Figure 20-130-2], [Figure 20-130-4] and [Figure 20- 130-4] Assembly: Tighten the male coupler (Item 1) [Figure 20- 130-3] and [Figure 20-130-4] to 80 N•m (59 ft-lb) Remove the drain coupler, spring, and fitting (Item 2) [Figure 20-130-2], [Figure 20-130-4] and [Figure 20- 130-4]. Assembly: Tighten the drain coupler (Item 2) [Figure 20-130-3] and [Figure 20-130-4] to 50 N•m (37 ft-lb) Remove the female coupler, spring, and fitting (Item 3) [Figure 20-130-2], [Figure 20-130-4] and [Figure 20- 130-4]. Assembly: Tighten the female coupler (Item 3) [Figure 20-130-3] and [Figure 20-130-4] to 80 N•m (59 ft-lb) Check the O-rings (Item 4) [Figure 20-130-4] and replace as needed. . Figure 20-130-5 Check the O-rings (Item 1) back-up O-rings (Item 2) for damage and replace as needed [Figure 20-130-5]. Figure 20-130-6 Check the O-rings (Item 1) back-up O-rings (Item 2) for damage and replace as needed [Figure 20-130-6]. P-90001 2 4 4 4 1 3 4 P-34665 1 2 P-34664 2 1 30-01 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-10-1 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-10-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-10-2 HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-20-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-20-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-20-2 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-20-4 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-20-5 HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-21-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-21-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-21-1 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-21-4 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-21-5 Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-21-11 HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-30-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-30-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-30-2 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-30-3 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-30-4 Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-30-5 HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-31-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-31-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-31-2 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-31-3 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-31-4 Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-31-6 CHARGE PRESSURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-40-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-40-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-40-1 Sender Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-40-3 Adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-40-4 HYDROSTATIC PUMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-2 Hydrostatic Pump Startup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-3 Replenishing / High Pressure Relief Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-4 Parts Identification (Left Half) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-5 Parts Identification (Right Half) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-6 Disassembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-7 Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-50-14 30-02 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-1 Hydraulic Controller Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-4 Hydrostatic Pump Start Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-6 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-7 High Pressure Relief And Bypass Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-8 Charge Relief Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-9 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-10 Mechanical Neutral Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-23 Hydraulic Controller Neutral Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-51-26 DRIVE BELT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-60-1 Belt Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-60-1 Belt Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-60-1 Stop Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-60-3 Tensioner Pulley Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-60-4 Tensioner Pulley Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-60-4 TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-70-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-70-1 Valve Block Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-70-2 Valve Block Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-70-4 DRAIN MANIFOLD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-80-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-80-1 Drain Manifold Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30-80-1 30-10-1 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM INFORMATION Troubleshooting The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat service personnel only. If a service code appears in the left instrument panel. (See DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES on Page 60-90- 1.) WARNING Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to make correct repairs or adjustments can cause injury or death. W-2004-1285 PROBLEM CAUSE No drive on one side, in one direction. 1, 2 No drive on one side in both directions. 2, 3, 4, 5 The loader does not move in a straight line. 2, 3, 5, 6, 7, 10 The hydrostatic system is overheating. 8, 9 KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE 1. The hydrostatic pump relief / replenishing valves not seating. 2. The steering linkage needs adjustment. 3. The hydrostatic pump has damage. 4. The final drive chains are broken. 5. The hydrostatic motor has damage. 6. The tires do not have the correct tire pressure. 7. The tires are not the same size. 8. The hydrostatic fluid is not at the correct level. 9. The oil cooler has a restriction. 10. The hydrostatic pump is not properly calibrated, and/or incorrect steering drift compensation setting. 30-10-2 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Description The hydrostatic system consists of a tandem hydrostatic pump and two hydrostatic motors. The hydrostatic system allows forward and reverse motion of the loader. The hydrostatic pump is connected to the engine by a drive belt and provides fluid to the hydrostatic motors. The charge pressure system assists in replenishing the fluid that is lost due to internal leakage in the components of the hydrostatic system. 30-20-1 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR Description The hydrostatic motors are driven by high pressure from the hydrostatic pumps. The hydrostatic motors do not have an internal brake. Inside the endcap of the hydrostatic motor, there is a shuttle valve. The shuttle valve helps to keep the motor cool by mixing case drain oil with cooled low pressure oil from the charge circuit. The shuttle valve is shifted by the high pressure oil coming from the hydrostatic pumps. If the shuttle valve sticks, a delay or lack of drive may or may not be felt in the controls and/or an overheated hydrostatic motor will result. There are two hydrostatic motors mounted to motor carriers. The motor carriers are mounted to the transmission chaincase which houses the drive chains. 30-20-2 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (CONT'D) Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-90-1.) Figure 30-20-1 Remove the motor cover. Mark the hoses for correct installation. Disconnect the case drain hose (Item 1) [Figure 30-20- 1]. Disconnect the high pressure hoses (Item 2) [Figure 30- 20-1]. Figure 30-20-2 Remove the ten mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-20- 2]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 149,2 N•m (110 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: The two bolts (Item 2) [Figure 30-20-2] mount the cam ring to the motor, and do not have to be removed, to remove the motor from the loader. Remove the motor/cam ring section from the loader. P-90510 1 2 P-90495 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 30-20-3 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 30-20-3 Remove the piston / roller section (Item 1) [Figure 30-20- 3] from the loader, if it was not removed with the motor/ cam ring. To remove the motor carrier. (See Removal And Installation on Page 30-30-2.) P5405 1 30-20-4 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (CONT'D) Parts Identification B-17125 5 2 25 3 19 23 6 9 15 17 16 4 16 20 26 14 1 21 1. Distributor 2. Spring 3. Seal 4. O-ring 5. Plug 6. O-ring 7. Spring 8. Washer 9. Spool 10. Spring 11. Rear Housing 12. Plug 13. O-ring 14. O-ring 15. Stop Pin 16. Bolt 17. Plug 18. O-ring 19. Spring 20. Shim 21. Poppet 22. O-ring 23. Seal 24. O-ring 25. Seal 26. O-ring 27. Cam 28. Roller 29. Piston 30. Block 18 27 30 3 4 7 8 10 11 13 12 29 28 24 22 30-20-5 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 30-20-4 Remove the piston / roller section (Item 1) [Figure 30-20- 4] from the motor. Assembly: Install the motor on the loader and tighten the mount bolts to 149,2 N•m (110 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Before operating the hydrostatic motor, make sure it is full of oil. There are several methods to fill the motor with oil; (1) with the case drain hose disconnected, fill the motor with oil through the case drain port; (2) with the case drain hose disconnected, BICS] brake locked, engine running, stroke the steering lever until oil comes out of the case drain port. Figure 30-20-5 Apply low air pressure to each port in the cylinder block to remove the roller (Item 1) and piston/ring assembly (Item 2) [Figure 30-20-5]. Inspect the cylinder block surface and the roller/piston assemblies for scratches or wear. NOTE: Put all the roller/piston assembly back in their original position. Assembly: Install the roller (Item 1) in the piston (Item 2) [Figure 30-20-5]. Assembly: Dip the roller / piston assembly into oil and install into the bore in the cylinder. Repeat for each roller / piston assembly. N-17861 1 P5765 1 2 30-20-6 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-20-6 Remove the two cam ring mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-6]. Assembly: Install the two cam ring mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-6] and tighten to 67,8 N•m (50 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-20-7 Remove the cam ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-7] from the motor housing. Inspect the cam ring for surface scratches or wear. Assembly: Install the cam ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-7] and align the mounting bolt holes. Figure 30-20-8 Remove the stop pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-8] from the rear motor housing. Assembly: Install the stop pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-8] and tighten to 10-12 N•m (7-9 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-20-9 NOTE: The distributor removal, is best accomplished by lifting the housing (Item 2) [Figure 30-20-8] 50,8 - 76,2 mm (2 - 3 in) above a wooden surface, and dropping the housing. Assembly: Install the stop pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-8] and tighten to 10 - 12 N•m (7 - 9 ft-lb) torque. Assembly: Install the distributor (Item 2) [Figure 30-20- 9] into the housing. Assembly: Align the distributor hole (Item 3) [Figure 30- 20-9] with the stop pin. When aligned correctly, the distributor can be depressed slightly. Assembly: Install and lightly smear grease on the O-ring (Item 4) [Figure 30-20-9]. N-17860 1 1 N-17863 1 N-17864 1 2 N-17868 2 4 1 3 30-20-7 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-20-10 Remove and replace the two seals and back-up O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-10] on the distributor. Inspect the distributor and springs (Item 2) [Figure 30- 20-10] for damage or surface scratches. Assembly: Put grease on the springs to hold them in place. Assembly: Install the springs into the distributor. Figure 30-20-11 Remove the two seals (Item 1) [Figure 30-20-11] from the housing and replace with new seals. Remove the two O-rings and replace with new O-rings. The O-rings are located under the seals. Assembly: Lightly smear grease over the seals. Figure 30-20-12 Remove, inspect and install the plug (Item 1), spring (Item 2), shim (Item 3) and poppet (Item 4) [Figure 30- 20-12]. Assembly: Remove and replace the O-ring (Item 5) [Figure 30-20-12]. Assembly: Tighten the plug to 12 - 15 N•m (9 - 11 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-20-13 Remove, inspect and install the plug (Item 1), springs (Item 2), spool (Item 3) and washer (Item 4) [Figure 30- 20-13]. Assembly: Remove and replace the O-ring (Item 5) [Figure 30-20-13]. Assembly: Tighten the plug to 25 - 30 N•m (18 - 22 ft-lb) torque. N-17869 2 1 N-17866 1 N-17872 1 2 3 4 5 N-17871 1 2 3 4 2 5 30-20-8 S650 Service Manual 30-21-1 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) Description The hydrostatic motors are driven by high pressure from the hydrostatic pumps. This hydrostatic motor contains a spring applied pressure release braking system to stop the loader. This braking system is located on the end of the hydrostatic motor. The hydrostatic motor contains a shuttle valve. The shuttle valve helps to keep the motor cool by mixing case drain oil with cooled low pressure oil from the charge circuit. The shuttle valve is shifted by the high pressure oil coming from the hydrostatic pumps. If the shuttle valve sticks, a delay or lack of drive may or may not be felt in the controls and/or an overheated hydrostatic motor will result. There are two hydrostatic motors mounted to motor carriers. The motor carriers are mounted to the transmission chaincase which houses the drive chains. Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-90-1.) 30-21-2 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-1 Remove the motor cover mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-1]. Remove the motor cover from the loader. Mark the hoses for correct installation. Figure 30-21-2 Disconnect the hydraulic hose (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-2] that goes to the two-speed port on the two-speed/brake block. Disconnect the hydraulic hose (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-2] that goes to the brake port on the two-speed / brake block. Disconnect the hydraulic hose (Item 3) [Figure 30-21-2] that goes to the make-up port on the two-speed / brake block. Figure 30-21-3 Disconnect the hydraulic hose (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-3] that goes to the drain manifold. Figure 30-21-4 Remove the eight flange bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-4] from the high pressure hoses on the motor. Installation: Install the lower collar to the motor and connect the high pressure hoses behind the collar, then install the upper collar and tighten the bolts to 34 N•m (25 ft-lb) torque. P-90256 1 P-90258 3 2 1 P-90257 1 P-90257 1 1 30-21-3 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-5 Remove the 10 (12 mm) mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30- 21-5] from the motor. NOTE: The two smaller diameter bolts (8 mm), hold the cam ring to the motor and do not have to be remove for motor removal. Remove the motor from the loader. Figure 30-21-6 Installation: Replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-21- 6] and hold it in place with a light cover of lithium base grease. Tighten the 10 mounting bolts to 149 N•m (110 ft- lb) torque. P-90496 1 N-22535 1 30-21-4 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Parts Identification 1 2 8 5 4 6 9 13 12 11 7 3 16 14 15 10 21 19 20 22 23 24 34 35 37 33 36 32 38 30 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 29 28 50 27 26 25 31 49 17 18 4 5 13 24 51 MS1467S Ref. Description 1. Roller 2. Piston 3. Ring 4. Clamp 5. Ring 6. Block 7. Cam 8. Quad Ring 9. Distributor 10. Spring 11. Seal/O-ring 12. Seal/O-ring 13. Seal/O-ring 14. Seal/O-ring 15. Seal/O-ring 16. Poppet 17. Spool 18. Spring 19. O-ring 20. Plug 21. Pin 22. Plug 23. Housing 24. Spring 25. Spool 26. Washer 27. O-ring 28. Plug 29. Quad Ring 30. Bushing 31. Shaft 32. Dowel 33. Housing 34. Bolt 35. Shim 36. Brake Disc 37. O-ring 38. Snap Ring 39. Washer 40. Spring 41. Spool 42. Bolt 43. Seal 44. O-ring 45. Clamp 46. Piston 47. O-ring 48 Spring 49. Gasket 50. Cover 51. Bolt Ref. Description 1. Roller 2. Piston 3. Ring 4. Clamp 5. Ring 6. Block 7. Cam 8. Quad Ring 9. Distributor 10. Spring 11. Seal/O-ring 12. Seal/O-ring 13. Seal/O-ring 14. Seal/O-ring 15. Seal/O-ring 16. Poppet 17. Spool 18. Spring 19. O-ring 20. Plug 21. Pin 22. Plug 23. Housing 24. Spring 25. Spool 26. Washer 27. O-ring 28. Plug 29. Quad Ring 30. Bushing 31. Shaft 32. Dowel 33. Housing 34. Bolt 35. Shim 36. Brake Disc 37. O-ring 38. Snap Ring 39. Washer 40. Spring 41. Spool 42. Bolt 43. Seal 44. O-ring 45. Clamp 46. Piston 47. O-ring 48 Spring 49. Gasket 50. Cover 51. Bolt 30-21-5 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Disassembly Figure 30-21-7 NOTE: Install a mark on the motor, brake, and motor carrier housings for correct assembly [Figure 30-21-7]. NOTE: Always protect any sealing surfaces. Any scratches or marks will cause premature failure. Place the cam sealing surface (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-7] on a protective material. Drain the oil from the motor casing. Figure 30-21-8 Remove the twelve mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30- 21-8] from the brake cover plate. NOTE: Remove and / or tightened the bolts one turn at a time to maintain equal preload on the end cap and the brake spring. Figure 30-21-9 Remove the cover plate from the brake housing. Remove the cover plate gasket (Item 1) [Figure 30-21- 9]. Remove the brake spring (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-9] from the brake housing. NOTE: Mark the top side of the brake spring for proper installation. Figure 30-21-10 Remove the piston from the brake housing (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-10]. NOTE: The use of air pressure through the brake line connection (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-10] will aid in piston removal. Check the brake piston for damage and replace the seal. N-22489 1 N-22490 1 N-22492 1 2 N-22493 1 2 30-21-6 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-11 Remove the five mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-21- 11] from the brake housing. Remove the brake housing (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-11] from the rear housing. Figure 30-21-12 Protect the sealing surface. Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-12] to remove the seal from the brake housing. Figure 30-21-13 Remove the brake disks (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-13] from the brake shaft. Mark the position of the brake disks and the shims. Figure 30-21-14 Remove the two-speed spool (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-14] from the housing assembly. Remove and discard the o-rings (Item 2) [Figure 30-21- 14] on the housing. P-69973 1 2 P-73062 1 P-69985 1 P-69978 1 2 2 30-21-7 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-15 Inspect the spool (Item 1), the spring (Item 2), washer (Item 3) and the snap ring (Item 4) and replace as needed [Figure 30-21-15]. NOTE: The spool (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-15] is marked with either an A or B. The spool must be replaced with a spool with the same mark. Figure 30-21-16 Remove the flushing spool plug (Item 1) [Figure 30-21- 16] from the housing. Installation: Tighten the plug to 30 Nm (22 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Current motor housings are provided with break off plugs (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-16] on the side of the flushing spool housing. Earlier motors were equipped with threaded plugs. Figure 30-21-17 Remove the flushing spool assembly (Item 1) [Figure 30- 21-17] from the housing. Figure 30-21-18 Remove the spring (Item 1), washer (Item 2) and rear spring (Item 3) from the spool (Item 4) [Figure 30-21-18]. Inspect all parts and replace as needed. N-22501 1 4 3 2 P-69979 1 2 P-73057 1 N-22504 1 2 4 3 30-21-8 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-19 Remove the plug (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-19] from the housing. Installation: Tighten the plug to 22 N•m (18 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-21-20 Remove the poppet assembly (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-20] from the housing. Figure 30-21-21 Inspect the poppet (Item 1), shim (Item 2) and spring (Item 3) for wear and replace as needed [Figure 30-21- 21]. Figure 30-21-22 Remove the two (8 mm) cam ring mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-22]. Turn the housing, cam ring, and rotating group assembly over and place on a stand. Remove the cam ring from the housing. P-69981 1 P-69982 1 N-22507 1 3 2 P-73058 1 1 30-21-9 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-23 Protect the sealing surfaces. Check the cam ring inside surface for wear and scratches [Figure 30-21-23]. Figure 30-21-24 Remove the cylinder block (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-24] from the housing. Remove the O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-24] from the housing. Figure 30-21-25 Protect the sealing surfaces. Remove the roller/piston assembly (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-25] from the cylinder block. Check all roller and piston assemblies for wear and replace as needed. NOTE: Put all roller/piston assembles back in the original bore. Figure 30-21-26 Remove the shaft from the distributor [Figure 30-21-26]. NOTE: The end of the shaft with the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-26] must be toward the brake housing during assembly. Remove the distributor from the housing. N-22510 N-22509 1 2 N-22511 1 P-73059 1 30-21-10 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-27 NOTE: The distributor removal is best accomplished by lifting the housing (Item 1) [Figure 30-21- 27] 2-3 inches above a wooden surface, and dropping the housing [Figure 30-21-27]. Figure 30-21-28 Protect the sealing surfaces. Remove the locating pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-28] from the distributor. Remove the springs (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-28] from the distributor. Inspect the springs, distributor surface and bushing for damage or wear and replace as needed. Figure 30-21-29 Remove the bushing (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-29] from the distributor, if worn or scratched. Figure 30-21-30 Remove the six seals (Item 1), and six back-up O-rings (Item 2) from the distributor [Figure 30-21-30]. P-69984 1 N-22521 1 2 N-22523 1 N-22519 1 30-21-11 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Assembly NOTE: Always use new O-rings and seals during motor and brake assembly. Figure 30-21-31 During installation of pistons in the bore, position the piston ring gap 180° from one piston to the next. One piston installed with the gap to the right, the next piston installed with the gap to the left. Dip each of the roller/piston assemblies (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-31] in oil and replace back its original bore. Figure 30-21-32 Apply a small amount of grease to the locating pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-32] and install the locating pin in the housing Figure 30-21-33 Install a new bushing (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-33] in the distributor if the old bushing was removed. Install new O-rings and seals on the distributor [Figure 30-21-34]. NOTE: When installing seals, apply a light coating of oil to the seal and the mating surfaces of the distributor. Install the O-rings and seals, allow 30 minutes for the seals to set on the distributor before installing the distributor in the housing. Figure 30-21-34 Using a small amount of grease, install the springs into the distributor valve (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-34]. N-22511 1 N-22518 1 N-22525 1 P-73060 1 30-21-12 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-35 Install the distributor (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-35] in the housing. Protect the sealing surface of the distributor. Figure 30-21-36 The pin in the distributor must align with the hole in the housing (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-36]. Use a hand press to push the distributor in place. When installed correctly, the distributor will spring back slightly when pushed by hand into the housing. Figure 30-21-37 Install the cylinder block assembly (Item 1) [Figure 30- 21-37]. Install the cam ring to the rear housing. Apply liquid adhesive (Loctite® 243) to the two cam ring mounting bolts. Install the bolts finger tight. Figure 30-21-38 Turn the motor so that it sets on the cam ring, and cylinder block [Figure 30-21-38]. NOTE: Be careful when turning or moving the motor so the cylinder block stays in the motor housing and the sealing surfaces are protected. Tighten the two cam ring mounting bolts to 35 - 39 N•m (26 - 29 ft-lb) torque. N-22515 1 P-73061 1 N-22509 1 P-69983 1 1 30-21-13 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-39 Install new o-rings (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-39] on the housing assembly and apply grease to the o-rings. Install the two speed spool (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-39]. Install the shaft into the distributor [Figure 30-21-39]. Figure 30-21-40 Clamp the disc pack in a vise and measure the height [Figure 30-21-40]. The height must be 31,1 mm (1.22 in). The normal thickness of the individual brake disc is 1 mm (0.039 in). If any individual disc's thickness is 0,95 mm (0.037 in) or less, replace the complete disc pack. Figure 30-21-41 Install the brake housing (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-41] on the motor housing. Apply liquid adhesive (Loctite® 243) to the five mounting bolts. Install the bolts (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-41] and tighten evenly to 117 - 122 N•m (86 - 90 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-21-42 If needed, install the shims first, then install the brake disc pack starting with an outer disc (Item 1) [Figure 30- 21-42] and alternating with an inner disc, throughout the pack. End the disc pack with an outer disc. P-69978 1 2 N-18347 P-69986 2 1 P-73064 1 30-21-14 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-43 Install the brake seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-43]. NOTE: Install the seal with the metal case end towards the brake pack. Install the snap ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-43] to secure the seal in the brake housing. Install a new o-ring (Item 3) [Figure 30-21-43] in the seal. Figure 30-21-44 Lightly coat the piston with oil and install a new piston seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-44]. Figure 30-21-45 Install the piston (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-45] in the brake housing. Figure 30-21-46 Install the brake spring (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-46]. Install the end plate gasket (Item 2) [Figure 30-21-46]. P-73055 1 3 2 N-22498 1 N-22493 1 N-22492 1 2 30-21-15 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO-SPEED) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-21-47 Install the brake end cover (Item 1) [Figure 30-21-47]. Install the twelve end cover mount bolts and tighten evenly to 14 - 16 N•m (10 - 12 ft-lb) torque. N-22490 1 30-21-16 S650 Service Manual 30-30-1 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER Description The hydrostatic motor carrier is the mating connection from the hydrostatic drive motor to the transmission chain case. The hydrostatic motor carrier contains a shaft that rotates on two tapered roller bearings. The shaft has two sprockets that turn the drive chains. The hydrostatic motor carrier has a seal which isolates the chain case oil from the hydrostatic motor case drain oil. The hydrostatic motor carriers are made to fit on both the right and left hand side of the loader. 30-30-2 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (CONT’D) Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arm and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the fluid from the chain case. (See CHAINCASE on Page 40-30-1.) Remove the center chain case cover. (See Center Cover Removal And Installation on Page 40-30-2.) Remove the front axle sprocket. (See Chain Removal And Installation on Page 40-20-9.) If the motor carrier is removed from the right side, remove the lift arm bypass valve, (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-50-2.) and remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Remove the control pedal linkages. (See Linkage Removal And Installation on Page 50-90-2.) Figure 30-30-1 Remove the six mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-30-1] from the carrier. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 461 - 488 N•m (340 - 360 ft-lb) torque. Slide the motor carrier toward the rear and remove the rear drive chain. Figure 30-30-2 NOTE: For easier access for the motor carrier coming out and going into the chain case, tie the front drive chain to the chain case with a wire [Figure 30-30-2]. Slide the motor carrier out of the chain case far enough to install a chain and chain hoist to the carrier [Figure 30- 30-2]. Pull the motor carrier away from the chain case and out of the loader. [Figure 30-30-2]. P5467A 1 1 P5489A 30-30-3 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (CONT'D) Parts Identification TS-1227B 1 2 8 5 4 6 7 1. Shaft 2. Bearing 3. Race 4. Housing 5. Seal (2) 6. Race 7. Bearing 8. Snap Ring 3 30-30-4 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (CONT'D) Disassembly Figure 30-30-3 Remove the large O-ring from the groove (Item 1) [Figure 30-30-3] in the housing. Figure 30-30-4 Put the motor carrier in a hydraulic press [Figure 30-30- 4]. Put a small amount of pressure on the shaft to release the pre-load on the snap ring. Figure 30-30-5 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-30-5] from the shaft. Figure 30-30-6 Use a hydraulic press to remove the shaft from the housing [Figure 30-30-6]. P5760 1 P5768 P-76544 1 P5766 30-30-5 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-30-7 Install the bearing puller tool under the bearing flange, use the hydraulic press to remove the bearing from the shaft [Figure 30-30-7]. Figure 30-30-8 Remove the two seals (Item 1) [Figure 30-30-8] from the housing. Check the bearing cup (Item 2) [Figure 30-30-8] (both sides) and replace as needed. Assembly Figure 30-30-9 The tool listed will be needed to the following procedure: MEL1431 - Seal Driver Tool Install the first seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-30-9] into the housing with the seal lip facing away from you. Use the tool (Item 2) [Figure 30-30-9] as shown in the figure. Figure 30-30-10 Install the second seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-30-10] into the housing with the seal lip facing toward you. Use the tool (Item 2) [Figure 30-30-10] as shown in the figure. P5761 P5763 1 2 P5764 1 2 P5762 2 1 30-30-6 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-30-11 Install the bearing on the shaft [Figure 30-30-11]. Use a pipe (Item 1) [Figure 30-30-11] with O.D. that seats on the I.D. of the bearing. Figure 30-30-12 install the shaft/bearing assembly into the housing. Install the bearing (Item 1) using the tool (Item 2) [Figure 30-30-12] (MEL1431). After the bearing is seated. Install the snap ring on the shaft and reposition the motor carrier to allow back press operation. NOTE: Slight press pressure may be used to preload both bearings. After installation of the snap ring a back press operation may be necessary to reduce the preload and remove the clearance from between the snap ring and the main bearing. Use the press and apply pressure to the end of the spline shaft to reduce preload and clearance. P5767 1 P5769 1 2 30-31-1 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) Description The hydrostatic motor carrier is the mating connection from the hydrostatic drive motor to the transmission chaincase. The hydrostatic motor carrier contains a shaft that rotates on two tapered roller bearings. The shaft has two sprockets that turn the drive chains. The hydrostatic motor carrier has a seal which isolates the chain case oil from the hydrostatic motor case drain oil. The hydrostatic motor carrier with (SJC) uses a speed sensor installed in the motor carrier housing. The speed sensor senses a disk that is fixed to the shaft in the motor carrier. A brake disk is installed on each hydrostatic motor carrier. The brake disk is mounted to the shaft in the motor carrier (single speed loaders only). The hydrostatic motor carriers are made to fit on both the right and left hand side of the loader. 30-31-2 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the fluid from the chaincase. (See CHAINCASE on Page 40-30-1.) Remove the center chaincase cover. (See Center Cover Removal And Installation on Page 40-30-2.) Remove the brake disc. (Single speed loaders only) (See Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation on Page 40-20-4.) Remove the front axle sprocket. (See Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation on Page 40-20-4.) If the motor carrier is removed from the right side, remove the lift arm bypass valve, (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-50-2.) and remove the control panel. (See Shock Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-18.) Figure 30-31-1 Remove the six mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-1] from the carrier. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 461 - 488 N•m (340 - 360 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-31-2 Slide the motor carrier toward the rear and remove the rear drive chain. NOTE: For easier access for the motor carrier coming out and going into the chaincase, tie the front drive chain to the chaincase with a wire [Figure 30-31-2]. Slide the motor carrier out of the chaincase far enough to install a chain and chain hoist to the carrier [Figure 30- 31-2]. NOTE: When installing the motor carrier into the loader, use caution to protect the wheel speed washer from damage. P5467A 1 1 P5489A 30-31-3 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) (CONT'D) Parts Identification PE3328SA 7 6 2 3 5 4 3 2 8 Ref. Description 1. Snap Ring 2. Bearing 3. Race 4. Seal 5. Housing 6. Speed Washer 7. Shaft 8. Cover 1 30-31-4 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly Figure 30-31-3 Remove the large O-ring from the groove (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-3] in the housing. Figure 30-31-4 Put the motor carrier in a hydraulic press [Figure 30-31- 4]. Put a small amount of pressure on the shaft to release the pre-load on the snap ring. Figure 30-31-5 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-5] from the shaft. Figure 30-31-6 Use a hydraulic press, remove the shaft from the housing [Figure 30-31-6]. P5760 1 P-76540 P-28155 1 P5766 30-31-5 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-31-7 NOTE: The bearing (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-7] and the wheel speed washer (Item 2) [Figure 30-31-7], must both be replaced, due to damage to the wheel speed washer from removing the bearing. Figure 30-31-8 Install the bearing puller tool (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-8] under the bearing flange, between the bearing and the speed washer. Figure 30-31-9 Use the hydraulic press to remove the bearing from the shaft [Figure 30-31-9]. Figure 30-31-10 Remove the wheel speed washer (Item 1) [Figure 30-31- 10] from the shaft. P-76462 1 2 P-28157 1 P-28158 P-76464 1 30-31-6 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-31-11 Remove the two seals (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-11] from the housing. Check the bearing cup (Item 2) [Figure 30-31-11] (both sides) and replace as needed. Assembly Figure 30-31-12 The tool listed will be needed to the following procedure: MEL1431 - Seal Driver Tool Install the first seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-12] into the housing with the seal lip facing away from you. Use the tool (Item 2) [Figure 30-31-12] as shown in the figure. Figure 30-31-13 Install the second seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-13] into the housing with the seal lip facing toward you. Use the tool (Item 2) [Figure 30-31-13] as shown in the figure. P-28164 1 2 P5764 2 1 P5762 2 1 30-31-7 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-31-14 The wheel speed washer, has one alignment pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-14]. Check the new wheel speed washer with a straight edge, to be sure it is square [Figure 30-31-14]. If the washer is more than 0.080 (2,03 mm) out of square, it must be replaced. Figure 30-31-15 Inspect the wheel speed washer for damage to the magnetic surface (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-15]. NOTE: Do not contact the magnetic surface of the wheel speed washer (Item 1) [Figure 30-31- 15], with a magnet. This may cause damage to the magnetic surface. Install the wheel speed washer on the shaft [Figure 30- 31-15]. Align the one pin (Item 2) [Figure 30-31-15] in the sprocket. P-76541 1 P-76542 1 2 30-31-8 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) (CONT'D) Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-31-16 Install the bearing on the shaft [Figure 30-31-16]. Use a pipe (Item 1) [Figure 30-31-16] with O.D. that seats on the I.D. of the bearing. Seat the bearing on the shaft, down against the wheel speed washer. NOTE: The wheel speed washer should be tight on the shaft. Figure 30-31-17 Install the shaft/bearing assembly into the housing. Install the bearing (Item 1) using the tool (MEL1431) (Item 2) [Figure 30-31-17]. After the bearing is seated. Install the snap ring on the shaft and reposition the motor carrier to allow back press operation. NOTE: Slight press pressure may be used to preload both bearings. After installation of the snap ring a back press operation may be necessary to reduce the preload and remove the clearance from between the snap ring and the main bearing. Use the press and apply pressure to the end of the spline shaft to reduce preload and clearance. P-76539 1 P-5769 1 2 30-40-1 S650 Service Manual CHARGE PRESSURE Description Charge pressure is a supply of oil to the hydrostatic pumps. Charge pressure is regulated by a charge relief valve located inside the hydrostatic pump. Charge pressure is used to replenish hydrostatic fluid removed from the drive circuit, pump and motor “internal leakage” and from the hydrostatic motors shuttle (flushing) valve. Charge pressure is also used to operate other hydraulic functions, such as shifting the auxiliary spool, and to pilot open the BICS system for the lift and tilt in the main hydraulic control valve. The charge pressure sender is located on the hydraulic fan motor. Charge pressure alarm settings are pre- programmed into the main controller and are based on loader type and options installed. Testing Figure 30-40-1 The tools needed to check charge pressure, hydraulic hose (Item 1), T fitting (P/N 13K-5) (Item 2), Hydraulic gauge 6,9 MPa (69,0 bar) (1000 psi) (Item 3) and adapter fitting (P/N 93F-5) (Item 4) [Figure 30-40-1]. Figure 30-40-2 Connect the gauge (Item 1), to the adapter fitting (P/N 93F5) (Item 2) [Figure 30-40-2]. Connect the hydraulic hose (Item 3) [Figure 30-40-2] to the adapter fitting. Tighten all connections. P-43196 1 2 3 4 P-43197 1 2 3 30-40-2 S650 Service Manual CHARGE PRESSURE (CONT’D) Testing (Cont’d) WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the loader lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Place the loader on jackstands. (See Procedure on Page 10-10-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 30-40-3 Disconnect the hydraulic hose (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-3]. Figure 30-40-4 Install the T fitting (P/N 13K-5) (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-4]. Install the hose (Item 2) [Figure 30-40-4], that was disconnected from the motor, to the T fitting. Install the hose (Item 3) [Figure 30-40-4], that is attached to the pressure gauge, to the T fitting. Tighten the hydraulic fittings. Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) Start the loader and warm the hydraulic fluid to 140° F. On non-SJC equipped loaders the charge pressure at high idle, with the fluid temperature of 60°C (140°F) is 3,0 - 3,4 MPa (30,0 - 34,1 bar) (435 - 495 psi) with the pump in neutral. NOTE: If the machine is equipped with SJC option the charge pressure should be set at 2,5 - 2,8 MPa (24,8 - 28,2 bar) (360 - 410 psi) at 60°C (140°F) fluid @ High idle. P-90302 1 P-90301 1 2 3 30-40-3 S650 Service Manual CHARGE PRESSURE (CONT’D) Sender Removal And Installation Figure 30-40-5 Disconnect the wire (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-5] from the sender. Remove the sender (Item 2) [Figure 30-40-5] from the motor. Installation: Tighten the charge pressure sender to 10 - 10,9 N•m (7.4 - 8.1 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Inspect the O-ring on the sender before installation. P-90302 2 1 30-40-4 S650 Service Manual CHARGE PRESSURE (CONT’D) Adjusting Non SJC Machines IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 30-40-6 If the charge pressure is not correct loosen the charge relief valve plug (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-6]. Always use a new O-ring. Tighten the plug to 41 - 68 N•m (30 - 50 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-40-7 Remove the plug, spring and poppet [Figure 30-40-7]. Check the poppet, spring and poppet seat for wear or damage. Figure 30-40-8 There are several different thickness of the shims (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-8] and are used to adjust the charge pressure. NOTE: 0,254 mm (0.010 in) is approximately 55,2 kPa (0,6 bar) (8 psi) increase in pressure. Do not add more than 5 shims without retesting. If testing is still low more shims may be added. On non-SJC equipped loaders the charge pressure at high idle, with the fluid temperature of 60°C (140°F) is 3,0 - 3,4 MPa (30,0 - 34,1 bar) (435 - 495 psi) with the pump in neutral. P-43856 1 N-17231 N-19568 1 30-40-5 S650 Service Manual CHARGE PRESSURE (CONT'D) Adjusting (Cont’d) SJC Machines IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 30-40-9 If the charge pressure is not correct remove the charge relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-9]. NOTE: The pump has been removed for photo clarity. The charge pressure relief valve is located on the engine side of the hydrostatic pump when installed in the loader. Assembly: Always use a new O-ring. Tighten the plug to 41 - 68 N•m (30 - 50 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-40-10 Check the poppet and spring for wear or damage. Inspect the seat inside the hydrostatic pump case for wear or damage. There are several different thickness of shims (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-10] used to adjust the charge pressure. NOTE: 1,0 mm shim (Item 1) [Figure 30-40-10] = 300,0 kPa (3 bar) (43.5 PSI) in pressure change. Adding shims increases charge pressure. Removing shims decreases charge pressure. The charge pressure should be set at 2,5 - 2,8 MPa (24,8 - 28,2 bar) (360 - 410 psi). P-64431 1 P-64435 1 30-40-6 S650 Service Manual 30-50-1 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP Description The hydrostatic pump is composed of two hydrostatic piston pumps connected together. The pumps provide bi- directional flow to two separate drive motors. The pump flow and direction are controlled by two hand levers, one for each pump. The hydrostatic pump contains replenishing valves. The function of these valves is to give replacement fluid to the low pressure side of the hydrostatic circuit. Replacement fluid is needed because of normal internal leakage and the controlled flow to the oil cooler for cooling. Another function of the replenishing valve is to keep high pressure fluid out of the low pressure side of the hydrostatic circuit. The hydrostatic pump is located in the center of the mainframe mounted to the engine flywheel housing. 30-50-2 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Remove the hydrostatic pump / engine assembly from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) Remove the Hydraulic Pump. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-60-6.) Remove the Drive Belt. (See DRIVE BELT on Page 30- 60-1.) IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 30-50-1 Loosen the nut (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-1] on the hydrostatic pump drive shaft. Installation: Tighten the nut to 258 - 325 N•m (190 - 240 ft-lb) torque Figure 30-50-2 Use a puller (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-2] to loosen the pulley from the pump drive shaft. NOTE: DO NOT strike puller or pump shaft with a hammer. Internal pump damage may result. Remove the nut and washer from the pump drive shaft. Remove the pump pulley and key from the pump drive shaft. Figure 30-50-3 Remove the two mounting bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-3]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts and nuts to 88 - 95 N•m (65 - 70 ft-lb) torque. P-90221 1 P-90222 1 P-90223 1 1 30-50-3 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-4 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-50- 4] at the hydraulic pump mounting bracket. Installation: Tighten mounting bolt to 125 - 135 N•m (90 - 100 ft-lb) Remove the hydrostatic pump from the mounting bracket and drive belt housing. BEFORE START UP: Fill the hydrostatic pump with hydraulic oil. This will remove trapped air in the hydrostatic pumps before start up. (See Hydrostatic Pump Startup on Page 30-50-3.) Hydrostatic Pump Startup Follow the hydraulic pump startup procedure. (See Hydrostatic Pump Startup on Page 30-50-3.) P-90224 1 30-50-4 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Replenishing / High Pressure Relief Valve Removal And Installation Figure 30-50-5 There are four replenishing / high pressure relief valves (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-5] in the hydrostatic pump assembly. Two are located at the top of the pumps and two at the bottom of the pumps for valve function. NOTE: The two top valves are for the reverse drive loop and the two bottom valves are for the forward drive loop. Figure 30-50-6 Remove the high pressure relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-5] and [Figure 30-50-6] from the pump. Assemble: Tighten the plug to 41 - 68 N•m (30 - 50 ft-lb) torque. Check for damage and replace as needed. Check the O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-6] for damage and replace as needed. If the high pressure relief valve must be replaced, it must be replaced as a complete unit. The pressure setting for a new high pressure relief valve is 36,2 MPa (362 bar) (5250 PSI). P-43857 1 P-66670 1 2 30-50-5 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Parts Identification (Left Half) 1 2 3 1 1 4 1 5 6 7 8 9 4 3 9 10 11 12 9 8 4 9 10 11 13 14 15 16 17 2 12 17 18 2 19 17 2 20 12 21 4 42 9 12 9 8 9 8 22 19 23 24 9 12 9 25 11 9 24 D-2428C 9 26 Ref. Description 1. Snap Ring 2. Washer 3. Seal 4. Bearing 5. Key 6. Shaft 7. Housing 8. Plug 9. O-ring 10. Cover 11. Bolt 12. Pin 13. Swash Plate 14. Wear Plate 15. Piston Assembly 16. Piston Retainer 17. Retainer 18. Block 19. Spring 20. Valve Plate 21. Gasket 22. Poppet 23. Shim 24. Replenishing/High Pressure Relief Valve 25. Coupler 26. Dust Seal 30-50-6 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Parts Identification (Right Half) 1 2 3 4 3 4 5 1 6 7 3 4 5 8 13 10 11 10 12 13 8 10 13 23 14 15 16 8 17 3 7 18 19 4 1 20 21 7 21 7 4 21 3 4 19 9 1 D-2427B 22 4 4 Ref. Description 1. Bolt 2. End Cap 3. Plug 4. O-ring 5. Replenishing/High Pressure Relief Valve 6. Gasket 7. Bearing 8. Pin 9. Valve Plate 10. Washer 11. Spring 12. Block 13. Retainer 14. Piston Assembly 15. Wear Plate 16. Swash Plate 17. Housing 18. Seal 19. Cover 20. Shaft 21. Snap Ring 22. Dust Seal 23. Piston Retainer 4 30-50-7 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Disassembly Figure 30-50-7 Remove the four mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-50- 7]. Figure 30-50-8 Separate the two hydrostatic pumps [Figure 30-50-8]. Figure 30-50-9 Remove the pump coupler (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-9]. Remove the large O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-9]. Remove the two small O-rings (Item 3) [Figure 30-50-9]. Figure 30-50-10 Remove the four bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-10] from the pump housing end cap. P-43858 1 1 1 N-19570 N-19571 3 1 2 3 N-19550 1 1 30-50-8 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-50-11 Remove the pump housing end cap (Item 1) [Figure 30- 50-11]. Remove the gasket (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-11]. Figure 30-50-12 Remove the valve plate (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-12]. Check the valve plate for wear. (Both Sides.) Figure 30-50-13 Check the valve plate locating pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-50- 13] for wear and replace if needed. Check the needle bearing (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-13] for wear and replace if needed. Figure 30-50-14 Remove the rotating group (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-14] from the pump. N-19551 1 2 N-17193 1 N-17194 1 2 N-17197 1 30-50-9 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-50-15 Remove the slipper guide and pistons (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-15] from the cylinder block. Check all the pistons (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-15] for wear and replace the rotating group as needed. Figure 30-50-16 Remove the ball guide retainer (Item 1) [Figure 30-50- 16] from the cylinder block. Figure 30-50-17 Check the ball guide retainer (Item 1) and washer (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-17] for wear and replace as needed. Remove the four pins (Item 3) [Figure 30-50-17] from the cylinder block. Check the cylinder block for wear and replace as needed. Check pins (Item 3) [Figure 30-50-17] to see if they are all the same length. Figure 30-50-18 Remove the thrust plate (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-18] from the pump housing. N-17198 2 1 N-17199 1 N-17200 3 3 3 3 2 1 N-17201 1 30-50-10 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Disassembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-50-19 Remove the driveshaft key (Item 1) the snap ring (Item 2) and the support washer (Item 3) [Figure 30-50-19] from the drive shaft end of the pump. Figure 30-50-20 Use a seal puller and remove the seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-20] from the pump housing. Figure 30-50-21 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-21] from the pump housing and remove the driveshaft and bearing from the housing. Figure 30-50-22 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-22] from the driveshaft and remove the bearing. Check the bearing for wear and replace if worn. N-17481 1 2 3 N-17239 1 N-17240 1 N-17241 1 30-50-11 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Disassembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-23 Check the pump shaft (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-23] for wear and replace if needed. Figure 30-50-24 Remove the four mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-24] from the lower trunnion cover. Remove the cover. Figure 30-50-25 Remove the O-ring (Item 1) and bearing race (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-25] from the pump housing. Figure 30-50-26 Check the bearing race (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-26] for wear and replace as needed. N-17242 1 N-17243 1 1 N-17244 2 1 N-17245 1 2 30-50-12 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Disassembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-27 Inspect the dust seal on the pintle shaft. Remove the four mount bolts (Item 1) from the pump housing and remove the linkage bracket (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-27]. Figure 30-50-28 Remove the upper trunnion cover (Item 1) [Figure 30-50- 28]. Figure 30-50-29 Inspect the seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-29] in the upper trunnion cover and replace if needed. Figure 30-50-30 Remove the O-ring (Item 1) and bearing race (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-30] from the pump housing. N-17246 1 1 2 N-17247 1 N-17250 1 N-17248 1 2 30-50-13 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Disassembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-31 Inspect the bearing race (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-31] and replace as needed. Figure 30-50-32 Slide the swash plate from side to side and remove the tapered roller bearing (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-32] from the swash plate shaft. Figure 30-50-33 Tilt the swash plate (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-33] and remove the swash plate and lower bearing from the pump housing. N-17249 1 2 N-17251 1 N-17252 1 30-50-14 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT'D) Assembly Figure 30-50-34 Install the lower bearing (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-34] on the swash plate. Figure 30-50-35 Install the swash plate and bearing into the pump housing [Figure 30-50-35]. Figure 30-50-36 Install the tapered bearing (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-36] on the swash plate shaft. Figure 30-50-37 Install the bearing race (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-36] and O- ring (Item 3) [Figure 30-50-36] as shown in [Figure 30- 50-37]. N-17253 1 N-17252 N-17249 1 2 3 N-17248 30-50-15 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-38 Install the upper trunnion seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-38] and cover. Figure 30-50-39 Install the linkage bracket (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-39] and the four mounting bolts and tighten to 24 - 30 N•m (18 - 22 ft-lb) torque. Install the dust seals onto the pintle shafts Figure 30-50-40 Figure 30-50-41 Install the bearing race (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-40] and O- ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-40] at the lower trunnion as shown in [Figure 30-50-41]. N-17247 1 N-17246 1 N-17245 1 2 N-17244 30-50-16 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-42 Align the marks on the lower trunnion cover and pump housing as shown in [Figure 30-50-42]. Install the four mounting bolts and tighten to 24 - 30 N•m (18 - 22 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-50-43 Install the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-43] on the pump shaft. Figure 30-50-44 Install the bearing and snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-50- 44] on the pump shaft. Figure 30-50-45 Install the pump shaft into the pump housing [Figure 30- 50-45]. Install the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-45]. N-17243 N-17242 1 N-17241 1 N-17240 1 30-50-17 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-46 Install the four slipper pins (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-46] into the cylinder block. Apply a small amount of grease to the washer (Item 2) and install into the ball guide retainer (Item 3) [Figure 30- 50-46]. Figure 30-50-47 Install the ball guide retainer and washer (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-47] onto the slipper holddown pins. Figure 30-50-48 Assemble the piston assemblies into the slipper guide. Lubricate the pistons and cylinder block bores and insert the piston assemblies into the cylinder bores [Figure 30- 50-48]. Lay the pump housing on its side and install the cylinder block, piston assembly into the housing. Figure 30-50-49 Place the pump on a work surface with the end cap opening up [Figure 30-50-49]. N-17200 1 1 1 1 2 3 N-17199 1 N-17198 N-17197 30-50-18 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-50 Replace the needle bearing (Item 1) and valve plate locating pin (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-50] in the charge pump. Figure 30-50-51 The bearing cage (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-51] will protrude from 2,0 - 2,5 mm (0.08 - 0.10 in) from the surface of the charge pump. The valve plate locating spring pin (Item 2) [Figure 30- 50-51] will protrude from 4,19 - 4,70 mm (0.165 - 0.185 in) from the surface of the charge pump. Figure 30-50-52 Coat the backside of the valve plate with petroleum jelly to hold it in position and install the valve plate onto the charge pump, bronze face up [Figure 30-50-52]. The notch (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-52] on the valve plate must engage the locating pin. Figure 30-50-53 Coat a new end cap gasket (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-53] with petroleum jelly and install onto the end cap. N-17194 1 2 N-17196 1 2 N-17193 1 N-19551 1 30-50-19 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (CONT’D) Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-50-54 Install the valve plate and end cap on the pump housing. Tighten the bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-54] to 47 - 61 N•m (35 - 45 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-50-55 Install the two small O-rings (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-55]. Install the large new O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-50-55]. Install the pump coupler (Item 3) [Figure 30-50-55]. Figure 30-50-56 Install the two pumps together [Figure 30-50-56]. Figure 30-50-57 Tighten the four bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-50-57] to 47 - 61 N•m (35 - 45 ft-lb) torque. N-19550 1 1 N-19571 1 3 2 1 N-19570 P-43858 1 1 30-50-20 S650 Service Manual 30-51-1 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) Description The SJC hydrostatic pump is a fully proportional dual piston pump in one pump casing. The endcaps are removable to gain access to the rotating assemblies. The hydraulic controllers are fed charge pressure from an external charge pump. 12 volt electrical solenoids shift a spool in the hydraulic controller that directs flow to a servo piston. The servo piston strokes the swash plate in the rotating group. The rotating group generates flow to the A or B ports on the hydrostatic pump. The flow from the A and B ports is sent to the hydrostatic drive motors where forward or reverse drive motor rotation is obtained. There are swash plate angle sensors on the bottom of the pump that monitor swash plate movement. Ports are labeled on the hydrostatic pump casting. Figure 30-51-1 P-90206 A,B Service Line Ports (High Pressure Outlet Ports to Drive Motors) T 1 Case Drain Port M A Operating Pressure of “A” Port M B Operating Pressure of “B” Port R Air Bleed Port X 1,X2 Control Pressure Gauge Port G Charge Pressure Inlet Port M G Gauge Port For Charge Pressure 30-51-2 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Hydraulic Controller Removal And Installation The loader’s right hand side hydraulic controller can be removed with the hydrostatic pump still in the loader. The loader’s left hand side hydraulic controller can only be removed when the hydrostatic pump is separated from the engine / hydrostatic pump cast mount. Controller solenoids can be bled of trapped air in the controller. This should be performed when hydraulic controllers are replaced, removed or uncommanded oscillations in the controls are present. Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Place the loader on jackstands. (See Procedure on Page 10-10-1.) WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 30-51-2 Locate the two hydraulic controllers (Item 1) [Figure 30- 51-2] on the hydrostatic pumps. Figure 30-51-3 Disconnect the electrical harness connectors (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-3] from both sides of the hydrostatic pump. Removal: IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 30-51-4 Remove the four mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-4] from the hydraulic controller. P-90207 1 P-90239 1 1 P-90208 1 1 30-51-3 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Hydraulic Controller Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-5 Remove the controller (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-5] from the pump. Remove the controller gaskets (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-5] from the pump. Installation: Figure 30-51-6 NOTE: Do NOT remove the three screens (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-6] they will be damaged during removal and must be replaced. Be sure the feedback lever (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-5] is in the center of the servo piston groove (Item 1) [Figure 30- 51-6]. Use a small amount of grease on a new gasket and install the gasket on the hydraulic controller (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-5]. Figure 30-51-7 Alternately tighten bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-7] to 10,4 N•m (7.7 ft-lb) torque. Ensure bolts are tightened to specifications. NOTE: When a hydraulic controller is replaced, the hydrostatic pumps must be calibrated. (See Hydraulic Controller Neutral Adjustment on Page 30-51-26.) Figure 30-51-8 With the engine running and the loader on jack stands: Bleed the trapped air in the controller by loosening the small set screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-8] a maximum of 2 turns. Leave the screw loose until oil comes dripping out of the set screw. Tighten set screw to 2 N•m (18 in-lb) torque. Repeat the bleed procedure for all the solenoids. P-90210 1 2 2 3 P-90209 1 2 2 P-90210 1 1 P-64978 1 30-51-4 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation Remove the hydrostatic pump / engine assembly from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) Remove the Hydraulic Pump. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-60-6.) Remove the Drive Belt. (See DRIVE BELT on Page 30- 60-1.) IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Figure 30-51-9 Loosen the nut (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-9] on the hydrostatic pump drive shaft. Installation: Tighten the nut to 258 - 325 N•m (190 - 240 ft-lb) torque Figure 30-51-10 Use a puller (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-10] to loosen the pulley from the pump drive shaft. NOTE: DO NOT strike puller or pump shaft with a hammer. Internal pump damage may result. Remove the nut and washer from the pump drive shaft. Remove the pump pulley from the pump drive shaft. Figure 30-51-11 Remove the two mounting bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-11]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts and nuts to 88 - 95 N•m (65 - 70 ft-lb) torque. P-90221 1 P-90222 1 P-90223 1 1 30-51-5 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 30-51-12 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-51- 12] at the hydraulic pump mounting bracket. Installation: Tighten mounting bolt to 125 - 135 N•m (90 - 100 ft-lb) Remove the hydrostatic pump from the mounting bracket and drive belt housing. BEFORE START UP: Fill the hydrostatic pump with hydraulic oil. This will remove trapped air in the hydrostatic pumps before start up. (See Hydrostatic Pump Start Up on Page 30-51-6.) P-90224 1 30-51-6 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Hydrostatic Pump Start Up Before putting a hydrostatic pump back into operation, the hydrostatic pump should be filled with hydrostatic fluid. This should be performed when installing a new hydrostatic pump or a pump that has been disassembled. Starting a hydrostatic pump dry may cause premature wear or permanent pump damage. Under normal operation, the charge pump will keep the hydrostatic pumps filled. Filling the hydrostatic pump is best done by removing a plug at the top of the hydrostatic pump. A clean funnel should be used to avoid washing contaminants into the hydrostatic pump. The goal is to fill the hydrostatic pump as much as possible before start up. Figure 30-51-13 Remove the air bleed plugs (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-13]. BEFORE START UP: Fill one of the air bleed ports with new hydraulic oil until the hydraulic oil flows out of the other air bleed port. This will remove trapped air in the hydrostatic pumps before start up. Assembly: Tighten plugs to 25 N•m (18 ft-lb) torque. P-90226 1 30-51-7 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Parts Identification P-90240 2 1 3 4 5 6 7 8 2 9 13 11 10 12 15 16 17 14 18 19 20 19 28 27 29 4 7 18 6 25 24 23 21 22 1. O-ring 2. Bolt 3. End Housing 4. O-ring 5. Right Rotating Assembly 6. Timing Pin 7. Bearing 8. Spacer/Coupler 9. Pin 10. Positioning Pin 11. O-ring 12. O-ring 13. Position Sensor 14. Washer 15. Bolt 16. Steel Cover 17. Bolt 18. Hydraulic Controller 19. High Pressure Relief 20. Case Housing 21. Bolt 22. Plug 23. Plug 24. Dowel Pin 25. Charge Pressure Relief 26. Left Servo 27. Right Servo 28. Left Rotating Assembly 29. End Housing 26 26 30-51-8 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) High Pressure Relief And Bypass Valve Figure 30-51-14 There are four system check relief valves (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-14] in the back of the hydrostatic pump. Remove the relief valve cap (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-14]. Assembly: Tighten cap to 150 - 170 N•m (111 - 125 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-51-15 Check the valve cap O-ring (Item 1) and back-up ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-15], replace as needed. Remove relief valve assembly (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-15] from the valve cap. Check the conical spring (Item 4) [Figure 30-51-15] to ensure it is not broken or flattened. Figure 30-51-16 Check the valve seat surface (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-16] for scratches and replace as needed. Inspect the spring (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-16] for breakage. Inspect seats inside case housing. Do not disassemble the relief valve assembly. If replacement is required, replace as an assembly. Factory setting on the relief valve is 36,2 MPa (362 bar) (5250 PSI). P-64431 1 1 P-64436 2 3 1 4 P-64437 1 2 30-51-9 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Charge Relief Valve Figure 30-51-17 The charge relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-17] is located on the back of the hydrostatic pump. Remove the charge relief valve. Assembly: Tighten charge relief valve to 70 N•m (52 ft- lb) torque. Figure 30-51-18 Check and replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-18]. Figure 30-51-19 Inspect the poppet (Item 1) and the mating seat (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-19] for damage or foreign material. Ensure the poppet moves freely in it’s bore. Inspect the sealing ring (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-19] and the mating seat in the pump housing for damage or foreign material. Inspect the spring (Item 4) and the charge relief valve shims (Item 5) [Figure 30-51-19]. NOTE: 1,0 mm shim (Item 5) [Figure 30-51-19] = 296,5 kPa (3 bar) (43.5 psi) in pressure change. Adding shims increases charge pressure. Removing shims decreases charge pressure. P-64431 1 P-64435 1 P-64435 1 2 3 4 5 30-51-10 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly Remove the hydrostatic pump / engine assembly from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) Remove the hydrostatic pump. (See Removal And Installation on Page 30-51-4.) Figure 30-51-20 Remove the hydraulic controllers (Item 1) [Figure 30-51- 20]. (See Hydraulic Controller Removal And Installation on Page 30-51-2.) Figure 30-51-21 Swash plate angle sensors (Item 1) are mounted on the bottom of the hydrostatic pump. They are protected by steel covers (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-21]. Remove the two bolts (Item 3) and the steel cover (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-21] from both sides. Assembly: Tighten bolts to 51 N•m (38 ft-lb) torque. Note the connectors facing each other. Figure 30-51-22 Remove the mounting bolts (Item 1) for the swash plate angle sensor (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-22]. Assembly: Tighten bolts to 3,1 N•m (27.4 in-lb) torque. P-90226 1 1 P-90227 1 1 2 2 3 3 3 3 P-90228 2 1 1 30-51-11 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-23 Assembly: Note the slotted portion (Item 1) of the positioning pin tightly fits the machined section on the swash plate angle sensor shaft (Item 2) [Figure 30-51- 23]. Figure 30-51-24 Check and replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-24]. Right End Housing Figure 30-51-25 Left End Housing Figure 30-51-26 Remove the four mount bolts (Item 1) securing the end housing (Item 2) to the main case housing (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-25] and [Figure 30-51-26]. Assembly: Alternately, tighten mount bolts to 130 N•m (96 ft-lb) torque. P-90217 2 1 P-90218 1 P-64445 2 1 1 3 P-64447 2 1 1 3 30-51-12 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-27 Pull the end housings from the case housing [Figure 30- 51-27]. Figure 30-51-28 Replace O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-28]. Figure 30-51-29 Ensure servo follower (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-28] is swung out for proper engagement with the notch in the servo piston (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-29]. Figure 30-51-30 Assembly: Ensure dowel pin (Item 1) is aligned with hole in case housing (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-30] before tightening screws. P-64464 P-64465 2 1 P-64466 1 P-64463 1 2 30-51-13 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-31 Figure 30-51-32 Remove valve plate (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-31] and [Figure 30-51-32] from the case housing. Inspect valve plate for scratches or scoring. Replace a valve plate if the scratches are deep enough to catch with a fingernail. NOTE: Pay attention to the notches (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-31] and [Figure 30-51-32] in the valve plate for assembly reasons. There are different valve plates for the left and right side. The valve plates are NOT interchangeable. P-64454 1 2 RIGHT SIDE P-64501 1 2 LEFT SIDE 30-51-14 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-33 Figure 30-51-34 Figure 30-51-35 Figure 30-51-36 Assembly: Align the timing pin (Item 1) [Figure 30-51- 33] and [Figure 30-51-34] in the case housing with the notch (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-35] and [Figure 30-51-36] that does not go through the valve plate. Align the shoulder of the roller bearing (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-33] and [Figure 30-51-34] with the beveled edge on the valve plate (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-35] and [Figure 30-51-36]. NOTE: Valve plate should sit FLUSH with the case housing when properly installed. P-64455 1 2 RIGHT SIDE P-64502 1 2 LEFT SIDE P-64456 2 1 RIGHT SIDE P-64503 2 1 LEFT SIDE 30-51-15 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-37 Right Side Rotating Group [Figure 30-51-37]. Figure 30-51-38 Left Side Rotating Group [Figure 30-51-38]. Figure 30-51-39 Remove the piston assembly (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-39]. Figure 30-51-40 Remove the pistons (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-40] from the rotating block. B25012 B25011 P-64469 1 P-64475 1 30-51-16 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-41 Inspect the pistons, look for scoring and scratches. Ensure the holes (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-41] in the slippers, are not plugged. Figure 30-51-42 Inspect the mating surface of the spherical washer for scoring or scratches (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-42]. Figure 30-51-43 Remove the spherical washer (Item 1) [Figure 30-51- 43]. Figure 30-51-44 Inspect the pins (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-44]. They should be all the same length. Do not remove. P-64476 1 P-64477 1 P-64471 1 P-64472 1 1 30-51-17 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-45 Inspect the spherical washer for scoring and wear (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-45]. Figure 30-51-46 Inspect the back surface of the rotating block (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-46] where the valve plate seals. Ensure there is no scratches or scoring. Visually ensure spring (Item 2) and c-clip (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-46] are not bent or damaged. Figure 30-51-47 Inspect mating surface for the slippers on the swash plate (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-47]. Remove the swash plate from the endcap housing (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-47]. Remove the slide ring (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-47], ensure it pivots freely. Figure 30-51-48 Assembly: Carefully align bearing pin eyelets (Item 1) into holes in endcap housing (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-48]. P-64474 1 P-64478 1 2 3 P-64479 1 2 3 P-64480 1 2 30-51-18 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-49 Assembly: Ensure bearing pins are in the holes of the swash plate (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-49]. Figure 30-51-50 Remove the shell bearing (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-50]. Inspect individual roller bearings and machined surfaces (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-50] on swash plate. Figure 30-51-51 Remove the shell bearing races (Item 1) [Figure 30-51- 51]. Assembly: Note shell bearing races have an edge (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-51] on them. The edges face towards the outside of the endcap housing Inspect bearing surfaces for scratches or scoring. Remove the positioning pin (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-51]. Figure 30-51-52 Replace O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-52]. Inspect wear surfaces (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-52] for scratches or scoring. Ensure positioning pin can rotate smoothly in the end housing without excessive play. P-64481 1 P-64482 1 2 P-64483 1 1 2 2 3 P-64485 1 2 30-51-19 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-53 Figure 30-51-54 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-53] and [Figure 30-51-54] from the end housing. Figure 30-51-55 The pump seal (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-55] is removed by inserting a screw into the seal and prying out. Figure 30-51-56 The drive shaft can be tapped out of the end housing with a rubber mallet. Inspect wear surfaces for scratches, and inspect splines for excessive wear. Inspect bearing (Item 1); if bearing needs replacement, remove snap ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-56] and remove bearing. P-64486 1 LEFT SIDE P-76743 1 RIGHT SIDE P-76742 1 P-64488 2 1 30-51-20 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-57 Servo Piston Assembly [Figure 30-51-57]. The Servo Piston Assembly [Figure 30-51-57] cannot be removed unless the hydraulic controller and rotating group is removed first. Figure 30-51-58 Measure and record servo piston depth at the adjustment screw [Figure 30-51-58]. Figure 30-51-59 Remove servo piston mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30- 51-59]. Installation: Tighten bolts to 10,4 N•m (7.7 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-51-60 Use a rubber mallet to rotate servo piston cover (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-60]. B25013 P-64490 P-90232 1 1 P-90231 1 30-51-21 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-61 Slide the servo piston assembly out of the bore. [Figure 30-51-61]. Figure 30-51-62 Figure 30-51-63 Assembly: Align the servo piston so the guide slot (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-63] is parallel to the driveshaft centerline. Measure with a straight-edge [Figure 30-51- 62]. Figure 30-51-64 Remove the bushings (Item 1), seals and O-rings (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-64] from the pump housing. P-90237 P-64467 P-64466 1 P-64493 1 1 2 2 30-51-22 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-65 Each servo has a pair of bushings (Item 1), O-rings (Item 2) and square-cut seals (Item 3) [Figure 30-51-65]. Figure 30-51-66 Remove the lock nut (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-66] from the servo piston. Assembly: Tighten lock nut to 30 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-51-67 Remove the servo cover (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-67] from the servo piston. Figure 30-51-68 Remove snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-68] from the servo piston. P-64494 1 2 3 P-64495 1 P-64496 1 P-64497 1 30-51-23 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-51-69 Remove the piston stop adjustment mechanism (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-69] from the servo piston. Inspect mechanism for broken parts. Replace O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-69] Figure 30-51-70 Bearings (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-70] in case housing are replaced by using a press and bearing driver. Inspect center coupler (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-70]. Mechanical Neutral Adjustment The pump mechanical neutral adjustment sets the position of the servo piston and pump swash plate relative to the hydraulic controller. This procedure should be followed if the hydrostatic pump has been disassembled for servicing the servo piston and the setting has been disrupted. Place the loader on jackstands. (See Procedure on Page 10-10-1.) WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Raise the lift arms, and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) Disconnect the swash plate angle sensors in the electrical harness. This prevents unwanted swash plate movement error codes from occurring during adjustments. Disconnecting the sensors does not have to be done directly at the sensor, follow the harness back to find an accessible connector to disconnect. Disconnect the speed sensors located on the top of the motor carriers. This prevents uncommanded wheel movement error codes from occurring during adjustments. WARNING Hydraulic fluid escaping under pressure can have sufficient force to enter a person’s body by penetrating the skin. This can cause serious injury and possible death if proper medical treatment by a physician familiar with this injury is not received immediately. W-2145-0290 P-64498 1 2 P-64502 1 2 30-51-24 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Mechanical Neutral Adjustment (Cont’d) Figure 30-51-71 Connect a hydraulic hose (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-71] between port X1 and port X2 on each side of the hydrostatic pump, to equalize the pressures on both ends of the servo pistons. Figure 30-51-72 Remove the plugs (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-72] from the MB ports on the front side of the pump, and install 51,7 MPa (517 bar) (7500 psi) pressure gauges. Figure 30-51-73 Remove the plugs (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-73] from the MA ports on the bottom of the pump, and install 51,7 MPa (517 bar) (7500 psi) pressure gauges. Figure 30-51-74 Remove drive hoses from the A and B ports (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-74]. Plug the ports with metal caps. The caps must be able to handle at least 51,7 MPa (517 bar) (7500 psi). Plugging the A and B ports eliminates leakage at the drive motors from causing errors in the pump mechanical neutral setting. P-64973 1 1 P-90242 1 1 P-64438 1 P-90243 1 1 1 1 30-51-25 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Mechanical Neutral Adjustment (Cont’d) Figure 30-51-75 Loosen the pump neutral adjustment lock nut (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-75]. Start the loader using the remote start tool and run at idle. WARNING Stay clear of the loader wheels. They will turn whenever the pump is not centered. W-2276-1297 Figure 30-51-76 Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-76] clockwise, until one of the gauges registers an increase in system pressure. Mark the position of the adjustment screw. Figure 30-51-77 Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-77] counterclockwise, until the other gauge registers an increase in system pressure. Mark the position of the adjustment screw. Figure 30-51-78 Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-78] clockwise, to a position halfway between the recorded positions. The pressure gauges should read equal pressures. P-90226 1 P-90238 1 P-90238 1 P-90238 1 30-51-26 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Mechanical Neutral Adjustment (Cont’d) Figure 30-51-79 While holding the adjustment screw (Item 1) in position, tighten the lock nut (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-79] to 30 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. Shut loader OFF. Remove the hydraulic hose from the X1 and X2 ports on the pump. Install the plugs and tighten to 25 N•m (18 ft- lb) torque. Remove the pressure gauges from the MA and MB ports on the pump. Install the plugs and tighten to 25 N•m (18 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: The Hydraulic Controller Neutral Adjustment must be performed whenever the Mechanical Neutral Adjustment is done. (See Hydraulic Controller Neutral Adjustment on Page 30-51- 26.) Hydraulic Controller Neutral Adjustment The hydraulic controller neutral adjustment, aligns the pump swash plate and the control spool so that a zero angle control setting provides a zero degree swash plate setting. This adjustment should be performed whenever any part of the control or swash plate mechanisms are adjusted or removed or after the pump mechanical neutral setting is adjusted. Ensure the pump mechanical neutral setting is correct before performing hydraulic controller neutral adjustments. NOTE: Procedure is shown for the left side hydraulic controller. Procedure is the same for the right side hydraulic controller, except you disconnect the electrical connectors for the right side hydraulic controller and connect pressure gauges in the X1 and X2 ports on the right side of the pump. Place the loader on jackstands. (See Procedure on Page 10-10-1.) WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Raise the lift arms, and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the remote start tool. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) WARNING Hydraulic fluid escaping under pressure can have sufficient force to enter a person’s body by penetrating the skin. This can cause serious injury and possible death if proper medical treatment by a physician familiar with this injury is not received immediately. W-2145-0290 P-90238 1 2 30-51-27 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Hydraulic Controller Neutral Adjustment (Cont’d) Figure 30-51-80 Disconnect the hydraulic controller connectors (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-80] from the loader wiring harness for the hydraulic controller you are adjusting. Figure 30-51-81 Remove the X1 plug (Item 1) and X2 plug (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-81] pertaining to the side of the hydrostatic pump you are adjusting. Figure 30-51-82 Install 3,4 MPa (34,5 bar) (500 psi) pressure gauges in the X1 and X2 ports pertaining to the side of the hydrostatic pump you are adjusting. Figure 30-51-83 Loosen the locking screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-83]. Start the loader using the remote start tool and run at an idle. WARNING Stay clear of the loader wheels. They will turn whenever the pump is not centered. W-2276-1297 P-90239 1 1 P-90226 1 2 P-64975 P-90236 1 30-51-28 S650 Service Manual HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) (CONT'D) Hydraulic Controller Neutral Adjustment (Cont’d) Figure 30-51-84 Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-84] clockwise, until one of the gauges registers an increase in system pressure. Mark the position of the adjustment screw. Figure 30-51-85 Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-85] counterclockwise, until the other gauge registers an increase in system pressure. Mark the position of the adjustment screw. Figure 30-51-86 Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 30-51-86] clockwise, to a position halfway between the recorded positions. The pressure gauges should read equal pressures. Figure 30-51-87 While holding the adjustment screw (Item 1) in position, tighten the locking screw (Item 2) [Figure 30-51-87] to 6,1 N•m (4.5 ft-lb) torque. Shut loader OFF. Remove the pressure gauges from the X1 and X2 ports on the pump. Install the plugs and tighten to 25 N•m (18 ft-lb) torque. Connect the hydraulic controller wire connectors to the loader wiring harness. Perform a controller calibration procedure. (See CALIBRATION on Page 60-160-1.) P-90236 1 P-90236 1 P-90236 1 P-90236 1 2 30-60-1 S650 Service Manual DRIVE BELT Belt Adjustment The drive belt does not need adjustment. The belt has a spring loaded idler which constantly maintains the correct belt tension. Belt Replacement Stop the engine and open the rear door. Remove the battery. (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-20-1.) Figure 30-60-1 Remove the drive belt shield bolt (Item 1) [Figure 30-60- 1]. Figure 30-60-2 Do NOT loosen the drive belt shield mounting bolts (top bolt shown) (Item 1). Slide the drive belt shield (Item 2) toward the back of the loader to unseat the shield from the top and bottom drive belt shield mounting bolts. Remove the drive belt shield (Item 2) [Figure 30-60-2]. P-85518 1 P-90467 1 2 30-60-2 S650 Service Manual DRIVE BELT (CONT’D) Belt Replacement (Cont’d) Figure 30-60-3 Loosen the spring loaded idler adjustment bolt (Item 1). Insert a 12,7 mm (0.50 in). breaker bar (Item 2) [Figure 30-60-3] into the slot provided in the stop arm as shown and push breaker bar down to release tension on drive belt. Tighten the adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-3] to hold the spring loaded idler off the drive belt. Remove the drive belt from the hydrostatic pump pulley and flywheel pulley. Inspect the pulleys for wear. Install new drive belt. Loosen the spring loaded idler adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-3] and allow the idler to contact the drive belt. Figure 30-60-4 Move the breaker bar to adjust the stop arm until a gap of 3,2 mm (0.125 in) (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-4] is achieved. Tighten the spring loaded idler adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-3] to 105 - 115 N•m (78 - 85 ft-lb) torque. Figure 30-60-5 Position the drive belt shield over the drive belt shield mounting bolts and slide the drive belt shield toward the front of the loader to fully seat the shield onto the top and bottom mounting bolts (Items 1 and 2) [Figure 30-60-5]. Figure 30-60-6 Install the drive belt shield bolt (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-6]. Install the battery. (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-20-1.) Close the rear door. P-90470 1 2 P-90471 1 P-90468A 1 Top Mounting Bolt P-90469A 2 Bottom Mounting Bolt P-85518 1 30-60-3 S650 Service Manual DRIVE BELT (CONT’D) Stop Adjustment Stop the engine and open the rear door. Figure 30-60-7 Loosen the spring loaded idler adjustment bolt (Item 1) and insert a 12,7 mm (0.50 in) breaker bar (Item 2) [Figure 30-60-7] into the slot provided in the stop arm as shown. Figure 30-60-8 Move the breaker bar to adjust the stop arm until a gap of 3,2 mm (0.125 in) (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-8] is achieved. Tighten the spring loaded idler adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-7] to 105 - 115 N•m (78 - 85 ft-lb) torque. P-90470 1 2 P-90471 1 30-60-4 S650 Service Manual DRIVE BELT (CONT’D) Tensioner Pulley Removal And Installation Remove the engine air cleaner. (See Housing Removal And Installation on Page 70-40-1.) Remove the belt. (See Belt Replacement on Page 30-60- 1.) Figure 30-60-9 Loosen the spring loaded idler adjustment bolt (Item 1). Insert a 12,7 mm (0.50 in) breaker bar (Item 2) [Figure 30-60-9] into the slot provided in the stop arm as shown and push breaker bar down to release tension on drive belt. Tighten adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-9] to hold the spring loaded idler off the drive belt. Figure 30-60-10 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-60- 10]. Remove the tensioner pulley (Item 2) [Figure 30-60-10]. Installation: Apply Loctite® 242 to the mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-10]. Tensioner Pulley Disassembly And Assembly Figure 30-60-11 Loosen the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-11] but do not remove. Release the spring tension by allowing the adjustment plate (Item 2) to slide past the tensioner pulley stop (Item 3) [Figure 30-60-11]. Remove the two bolts (Item 1) and the adjustment plate (Item 2) [Figure 30-60-11]. Figure 30-60-12 Remove the pivot sleeve (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-12]. P-85520 1 2 P-85741 2 1 P-90306 1 3 2 1 P-90304 1 30-60-5 S650 Service Manual DRIVE BELT (CONT'D) Tensioner Pulley Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 30-60-13 Disassembly the tensioner pulley as shown [Figure 30- 60-13]. Check the parts for wear and replace as needed. NOTE: The wheel and arm assembly (Item 1) [Figure 30-60-13] are not serviceable and must be replaced as a complete assembly. P-90303 1 30-60-6 S650 Service Manual 30-70-1 S650 Service Manual TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE Description Figure 30-70-1 The two-speed / brake valve (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-1] is located on top of the chaincase in front of the hydrostatic pump. The high range is selected by a switch located on the right handle for manual loaders and on the left joystick for SJC loaders. When the high range is selected, the two-speed solenoid is energized by the Bobcat Controller. The valve shifts and directs charge pressure oil to the shift spool in each motor. The charge pressure hydraulic oil shifts the spools allowing the motors to move into high range. When low range is selected, the solenoid is de-energized and the shift spools are spring returned to low range. P-90507 1 30-70-2 S650 Service Manual TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE (CONT'D) Valve Block Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 30-70-2 Remove the steering shock (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-2]. Mark all hydraulic hoses for proper installation. Disconnect the five hydraulic hoses (Item 2) [Figure 30- 70-2] from the brake / two speed valve block. Figure 30-70-3 Disconnect the three hydraulic hoses (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-3] from the brake / two speed block. P-90437 1 2 2 P-90425 1 30-70-3 S650 Service Manual TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE (CONT'D) Valve Block Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 30-70-4 Disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-4] from the two speed solenoid. Disconnect the wire harness connectors (Item 2) [Figure 30-70-4] from the brake solenoid and make-up valve. Figure 30-70-5 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-70- 5] from the valve block. P-90444 1 2 P-90446 1 30-70-4 S650 Service Manual TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE (CONT'D) Valve Block Disassembly And Assembly Figure 30-70-6 Mark all hydraulic hoses and fittings for proper installation. Remove the hydraulic fittings (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-6] from the valve block. Figure 30-70-7 Remove the check valves (Items 1 and 2) [Figure 30-70- 7] from the two-speed valve. NOTE: The check valves (Items 1 and 2) [Figure 30- 70-7] are interchangeable. Figure 30-70-8 Check the back-up washers (Item 1) and O-rings (Item 2) [Figure 30-70-8] for wear and replace as needed. Figure 30-70-9 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) from the brake valve solenoid (Item 2) [Figure 30-70-9]. Remove the electrical solenoid nut (Item 3) from the make-up solenoid (Item 4) [Figure 30-70-9]. Assembly: Tighten the nut to 6,78 - 9,49 N•m (60 - 84 in- lb) torque. P-90548 1 1 1 P-90549 1 2 N-22580 2 1 P-90550 1 2 3 4 30-70-5 S650 Service Manual TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE (CONT'D) Valve Block Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-70-10 Use a test meter and test the solenoid coils (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-10] for resistance. The resistance value for the solenoid coil can be found on the electrical schematic. Figure 30-70-11 Use a test meter and test the solenoid coils (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-10] for resistance. The resistance value for the solenoid coil can be found on the electrical schematic. Assembly: Always install new O-rings [Figure 30-70- 10]. Figure 30-70-12 Remove the make-up solenoid (Item 1) [Figure 30-70- 12] from the valve block. Figure 30-70-13 Assembly: Always install new O-rings and back-up washers [Figure 30-70-13]. Tighten the solenoid valve to 27,1 N•m (20 ft-lb) torque. P-90435 1 P-90551 1 P-90552 1 N-22584 30-70-6 S650 Service Manual TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE (CONT'D) Valve Block Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 30-70-14 Remove the plugs (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-14] from the brake / two-speed valve block. Check the O-ring [Figure 30-70-14] on the plugs and replace as needed. Figure 30-70-15 Remove the two speed solenoid bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-15]. Figure 30-70-16 Use a test meter and test the solenoid (Item 1) [Figure 30-70-16] for resistance. The resistance value for the solenoid coil can be found on the electrical schematic. Assembly: Always install new O-rings [Figure 30-70- 10]. P-90553 1 1 P-90554 1 P-90547 1 30-80-1 S650 Service Manual DRAIN MANIFOLD Description The drain manifold is an external assembly in the drain circuit that returns the hydraulic oil to the reservoir. Drain Manifold Removal And Installation IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Figure 30-80-1 Remove and plug all hose’s from the drain manifold (Item 1) [Figure 30-80-1]. Disconnect the wiring harness from the oil temperature switch (Item 2) [Figure 30-80-1]. Figure 30-80-2 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 30-80-2]. P-90484 1 2 P-90485 1 30-80-2 S650 Service Manual 40-01 S650 Service Manual DRIVE SYSTEM BRAKE (SINGLE SPEED) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-10-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-10-1 Disc Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-10-1 BRAKE (TWO-SPEED) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40-11-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40-11-1 DRIVE COMPONENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-20-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-20-1 Axle Seal Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-20-2 Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-20-4 Chain Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-20-9 CHAINCASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-30-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-30-1 Front Cover Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-30-1 Center Cover Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-30-2 Rear Cover Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-30-3 40-02 S650 Service Manual 40-10-1 S650 Service Manual BRAKE (SINGLE SPEED) Description The brake is used to hold the machine in place. The brake is operated by a switch (Item 1) [Figure 40-10-1] located on the front accessory panel. The brake is applied by a spring-loaded wedge that drops into two notched brake discs attached to the motor carrier shafts. An electric solenoid is sent power from a relay to pull the wedge away from the discs. A signal from the main Bobcat controller holds the wedge away from the discs. The hold signal will be interrupted and the wedge will drop if the engine rpm drops below 700 rpm, the seat bar sensor fails or if there is a break in the wires for the brake solenoid. For more information on the brake. (See TRACTION LOCK on Page 60-120-1.) Figure 40-10-1 Disc Removal And Installation Raise the loader lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the loader operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10- 30-2.) Disconnect and remove the engine speed control. (See Removal And Installation on Page 70-20-1.) Remove the control panel from the loader. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Remove the center chaincase cover. (See Center Cover Removal And Installation on Page 40-30-2.) Remove the traction lock assembly. Figure 40-10-2 The parking brake discs (Item 1) [Figure 40-10-2] are located beneath the center chaincase cover. Figure 40-10-3 Inspect the traction lock guides (Item 1) [Figure 40-10-3] and the brake disc for damage or wear and replace as necessary. (See Inspecting on Page 60-120-3.) P-85491 1 N-19081A 1 1 N-19105 1 40-10-2 S650 Service Manual BRAKE (SINGLE SPEED) (CONT’D) Disc Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 40-10-4 Figure 40-10-5 A snap ring pliers with 90° tips are necessary for removing the parking brake disc. Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 40-10-4] from the end of the sprocket on the hydrostatic motor carrier. Slide the disc (Item 2) [Figure 40-10-4] off the sprocket (Item 1) [Figure 40-10-5] and remove the disc through the front chaincase cover. Reverse the removal procedure to install the disc in the loader. N-19082A 1 2 N-19083A 1 40-11-1 S650 Service Manual BRAKE (TWO-SPEED) Description Figure 40-11-1 The brake is used to hold the machine in place. The brake is operated by a switch (Item 1) [Figure 40-11-1] located on the front accessory panel. The brake is a spring applied pressure release system, which is self contained on the end of each drive motor. The brake block solenoid is sent power from a relay to open the circuit which releases the charge pressure oil to the brakes. The charge pressure oil pushes the spring away from the brake discs allowing the drive motor to move. A signal from the main Bobcat controller holds the brake solenoid open to allow constant flow of the charge pressure oil to hold the spring away from the brake discs. When the hold signal is interrupted the solenoid will close the circuit and the charge oil will be shut off an the spring will apply the brakes. This will happen if the engine rpm drops below a set rpm, the seat bar sensor fails or if there is a break in the wires for the brake block solenoid. For more information on the brake. (See TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE on Page 30-70-1.) . P-85413 1 40-11-2 S650 Service Manual 40-20-1 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS Description The drive components consist of the chaincase, drive chains, sprockets, axleshafts, hubs, drive motor carrier and a brake (Single speed only). The two speed brake is part of the two speed drive motor. The chaincase is partially filled with hydraulic fluid to lubricate the chains and bearings. On the bottom of the chaincase, these is a cover for access to the fuel tank drain plug. NA1285 40-20-2 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Axle Seal Removal And Installation The tools listed are needed for the following procedure: Axle Hub Puller Tool MEL1407 - Seal Driver Tool MEL1242 - Power Ram (may be used if desired) Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) NOTE: If the axle and bearings are being replaced, also loosen the sprocket mounting bolt inside the chaincase before lifting and blocking the loader. (See Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation on Page 40-20-4.) Remove the tire/wheel assembly. (See Mounting on Page 10-160-1.) Remove the front chaincase cover. (See Front Cover Removal And Installation on Page 40-30-1.) Remove the fluid from the chaincase. (See Removing And Replacing Oil on Page 10-130-1.) Figure 40-20-1 Remove the bolts (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-1] and plate. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 240 - 260 N•m (175 - 190 ft-lb) torque. Remove the two wheel studs (Item 2) [Figure 40-20-1] across from each other. Figure 40-20-2 Install puller (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-2] on the wheel hub. WARNING NEVER STAND IN-LINE OF THE HUB WHEN REMOVING A HUB FROM AN AXLE. The hub has a tapered fit on the axle end and can come off the axle with great force and cause serious injury. W-2186-0395 Remove the hub from the axle. Figure 40-20-3 Remove the key (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-3] from the axle. P4850 1 2 2 P4849 1 P4848 1 40-20-3 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Axle Seal Removal And Installation Figure 40-20-4 Install a slide hammer (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-4] with a screw tip end into the axle seal. Remove the axle seal. Figure 40-20-5 Installation: Place the seal with the lip facing in [Figure 40-20-5]. Installation: Use a hammer, install the new axle seal until the tool (MEL1407) is flush with the edge of the axle tube [Figure 40-20-5]. P4817 1 P4814 40-20-4 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1242 - Port-a-Power MEL1202B - Axle Bearing Service Set NOTE: The procedure shown for removal and installation of the axle, sprocket and bearings is for a front axle. This procedure will be the same for the rear axle. DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Remove the front chaincase cover. (See Front Cover Removal And Installation on Page 40-30-1.) Remove the fluid from the chaincase. (See Removing And Replacing Oil on Page 10-130-1.) Figure 40-20-6 Remove the axle sprocket bolt (Item 1) and backing washer (Item 2) [Figure 40-20-6]. Installation: Tighten the axle sprocket bolt to 699 - 726 N•m (515 - 535 ft-lb) torque. Remove the axle hub. (See Axle Seal Removal And Installation on Page 40-20-2.) Figure 40-20-7 Install a Port-a-Power ram between the two sprockets [Figure 40-20-7]. P-68196 1 2 P-4158A 40-20-5 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 40-20-8 Push the axle out until the ram is at the end of the stroke. Add a spacer and push the axle out again. Repeat this procedure until the axle is out of the sprocket. Remove the drive chain from the sprocket. Remove the sprocket (Item 1) and inner bearing (Item 2) [Figure 40-20-8]. Installation: Pack the inner and outer bearing with grease before installing them. Figure 40-20-9 A bearing puller (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-9] is needed to do the following procedure: Be sure the bearing puller makes good contact with the inner race and press the bearing off the mounting surface of the axle [Figure 40-20-9]. NOTE: Hold the axle during removal because it will slide freely after the bearing is removed from the mounting surface. Figure 40-20-10 Press the splined end of the axle free from the bearing [Figure 40-20-10]. P5406A 1 2 P-4170 1 P-4171 40-20-6 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 40-20-11 Installation: Put the spline end of the axle shaft into the bearing and press the bearing onto the axle. NOTE: Hold the axle during installation because it will slide freely after the bearing is pressed over the splined end of the shaft. Put a piece of tubing over the axle (Item 1) [Figure 40- 20-11] that contacts inner race of the bearing only. Press the bearing onto the mounting surface until the bearing is fully seated [Figure 40-20-11]. Figure 40-20-12 Use the tools provided in the MEL1202B Axle Bearing Service Set. A slide hammer is also needed. Use the long driver handle (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-12] and the bearing cup removal tool to remove the inner bearing cup. The bearing cup removal tool must fall into the recess behind the bearing cup, drive the cup out of the axle tube [Figure 40-20-13]. Figure 40-20-13 P-4175 1 P4812 1 MC-2164 Recess Tool Bearing Cup 40-20-7 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 40-20-14 To remove the outer bearing, install a bearing cup removal tool on the slide hammer. Install the slide hammer/tool assembly behind the bearing cup [Figure 40-20-14]. Figure 40-20-15 Use the slide hammer to remove the bearing cup from the axle tube [Figure 40-20-15]. Figure 40-20-16 Use the bearing cup installation tool (Item 1) [Figure 40- 20-16] and (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-17]. Put the inner cup (Item 2) [Figure 40-20-16] in the axle tube. Install the long threaded rod (Item 2) [Figure 40-20-17] into the axle tube and through the installation tool (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-16]. Install the nut (Item 3) [Figure 40-20-16]. Figure 40-20-17 Install the installation tool (Item 1) [Figure 40-20-17] on the threaded rod. Install the nut. Hold the inside nut (Item 3) [Figure 40-20-16] with a wrench and tighten the outside nut [Figure 40-20-17]. Tighten the nut until the bearing cup is seated. Remove the installation tool and threaded rod. P5637 P4816 P5468A 1 2 3 P4811 1 2 40-20-8 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 40-20-18 To install the outer bearing cup, install the bearing cup installation tool on the driver handle. Install the bearing cup into the axle tube, and put the tool into the bearing cup. Hit the driver handle with a hammer until the bearing cup is seated inside the axle tube [Figure 40-20-18]. P4813 40-20-9 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Chain Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Remove the front or rear chaincase cover. (See Front Cover Removal And Installation on Page 40-30-1.) Remove the center chaincase cover. (See Center Cover Removal And Installation on Page 40-30-2.) Remove the fluid from the chaincase. (See Removing And Replacing Oil on Page 10-130-1.) Remove the brake disc. (See Disc Removal And Installation on Page 40-10-1.) Remove the front or rear axle and sprocket. (See Axle, Sprocket And Bearings Removal And Installation on Page 40-20-4.) Figure 40-20-19 NOTE: It is necessary to remove the rear axle and drive chain if the front chain has to be removed. Remove the motor carrier. (See Removal And Installation on Page 30-30-2.) P-68194 Front Drive Chain Rear Drive Chain 40-20-10 S650 Service Manual DRIVE COMPONENTS (CONT'D) Chain Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 40-20-20 The tool listed is needed for the following procedure: MEL1246 - Chain Link Tool Installation: If a new chain is installed, a connector link must be used to connect the chain together. Use MEL1246 Chain Link Tool and #120 chain adapter. Secure the tool and place the connector link in the tool as shown [Figure 40-20-20]. Turn the threaded rod of the tool and press the connector link together on the chain [Figure 40-20-20]. Tighten the threaded rod of the chain link tool to 339 N•m (250 ft-lb) torque. WARNING DO NOT exceed the recommended torque. The tool may fail under too much torque. Put cloth around the tool to protect yourself from flying debris. W-2233-0307 B-13504A 40-30-1 S650 Service Manual CHAINCASE Description The chaincase contains the drive components. Front Cover Removal And Installation Raise the loader lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the loader operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10- 30-2.) Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Figure 40-30-1 Remove the front chaincase cover mounting screws (Item 1) [Figure 40-30-1]. Remove the front chaincase cover (Item 2) [Figure 40- 30-1] from the loader. NOTE: There are tabs (Item 3) [Figure 40-30-1] on the side of the cover to help pry the covers off. Installation: Apply polyurethane sealer to mating surfaces. Polyurethane sealant should be applied to the screw threads to stop oil leakage. Tighten the mounting screws to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft-lb) torque. P-34255 2 1 3 3 3 3 40-30-2 S650 Service Manual CHAINCASE (CONT’D) Center Cover Removal And Installation Raise the loader lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the loader operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10- 30-2.) DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Figure 40-30-2 If loader is equipped with SJC, skip to [Figure 40-30-3]. Disconnect the lift control cross bar from the lift pedal linkage (Item 1) [Figure 40-30-2]. Disconnect the lift control cross bar (Item 2) [Figure 40- 30-2] from the lift spool on the main control valve. Disconnect the electrical connector (Item 3) [Figure 40- 30-2] from the traction lock solenoid. Remove the crossbar mounting bolt (Item 4) [Figure 40- 30-2]. Remove the crossbar and wire harness from the center chaincase cover. WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Figure 40-30-3 Remove the chaincase cover mounting screws (Item 1) [Figure 40-30-3]. Remove the center chaincase cover (Item 2) [Figure 40- 30-3] from the loader. NOTE: There are tabs (Item 3) [Figure 40-30-3] on the side of the cover to help pry the covers off. Installation: Apply polyurethane sealer to mating surfaces. Polyurethane sealant should be applied to the screw threads to stop oil leakage. Tighten the mounting screws to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft-lb) torque. P-90047 3 4 2 1 P-90048 1 1 2 3 40-30-3 S650 Service Manual CHAINCASE (CONT’D) Rear Cover Removal And Installation Raise the loader lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the loader operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10- 30-2.) DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 If loader is equipped with two-speed, remove the two- speed valve. (See Valve Block Removal And Installation on Page 30-70-2.) Remove the drain manifold. (See Drain Manifold Removal And Installation on Page 30-80-1.) Disconnect the front steering linkage bars from the rear linkage bars. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50- 100-2.) Move the linkage bars to allow adequate space to remove the rear chaincase cover. Figure 40-30-4 Remove the rear chaincase cover mounting screws (Item 1) [Figure 40-30-4]. Remove chain case cover (Item 2) [Figure 40-30-4]. NOTE: There are tabs (Item 3) [Figure 40-30-4] on the side of the cover to help pry the covers off. Installation: Apply polyurethane sealer to mating surfaces. Polyurethane sealant should be applied to the screw threads to stop oil leakage. Tighten the mounting screws to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft-lb) torque. P-90056 1 1 3 2 3 40-30-4 S650 Service Manual 50-01 S650 Service Manual MAINFRAME SEAT BAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-10-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-10-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-10-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-10-2 Compression Spring Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-10-3 OPERATOR CAB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-20-1 Gas Spring Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-20-1 Gas Spring Bracket Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-20-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-20-2 OPERATOR SEAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-30-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-30-1 Seat Belt Removal And Installation (Retractable) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-30-1 Seat Belt And Bracket Removal And Installation (Standard) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-30-2 Seat Belt Bracket Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-30-2 OPERATOR SEAT (SUSPENSION) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-1 Slide Rail Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-1 Seat Belt Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-2 Lower Cushion Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-2 Lower Cushion Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-3 Back Cushion Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-3 Shock Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-4 3-Point Seat Belt Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-31-4 BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-40-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-40-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-40-1 Lever And Wedge Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-40-3 Pivot Pin Bushing And Seal Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-40-5 BOB-TACH (POWER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-41-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-41-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-41-1 Lever And Wedge Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-41-4 Pivot Pin Bushing And Seal Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-41-5 LIFT ARMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-50-1 Stabilizer Bar Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-50-1 Link Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-50-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-50-3 REAR GRILLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-60-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-60-1 50-02 S650 Service Manual REAR DOOR (TAILGATE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-70-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-70-1 Striker Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-70-2 Striker Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-70-2 Striker (Adjusting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-70-2 Latch Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-70-3 FUEL TANK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-80-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-80-1 Fuel Level Sender Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-80-3 Fuel Fill Screen Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-80-3 CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-90-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-90-1 Pedal Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-90-1 Linkage Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-90-2 Pedal (Adjusting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-90-3 Floor Pan Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-90-4 CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-91-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-91-1 Pedal Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-91-1 Linkage Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-91-2 Pedal (Adjusting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-91-2 Floor Pan Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-91-3 CONTROL PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-2 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-3 Linkage Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-5 Pintle Arm Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-9 Linkage Neutral (Adjusting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-10 Linkage Travel (Adjusting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-14 Shock Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-100-18 CONTROL PANEL (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-101-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-101-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-101-1 CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-110-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-110-1 Lever Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-110-1 Boot Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-110-2 50-03 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-111-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-111-1 Handle Sensor Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-111-1 Handle Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-111-4 Handle Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-111-5 Lever Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-111-5 Boot Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-111-6 CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-112-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-112-1 Joystick Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-112-1 Joystick Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-112-2 ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-120-1 Removal And Installation (Left) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-120-1 Removal And Installation (Right) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-120-1 ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-121-1 Removal And Installation (Left) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-121-1 Removal And Installation (Right) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-121-1 WINDOW (REAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-130-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-130-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-130-1 WINDOW (TOP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-131-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-131-1 WINDOW (SIDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-132-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-132-1 CAB DOOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-140-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-140-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-140-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-140-2 Aligning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-140-3 Adjusting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-140-4 Checking Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-140-4 ARMREST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-150-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-150-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-150-2 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-150-3 LEFT SIDE LOWER PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-160-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-160-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-160-3 50-04 S650 Service Manual RIGHT SIDE LOWER PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-170-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-170-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-170-2 HEADLINER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-180-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-180-1 50-10-1 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR Description The seat bar is the secondary restraint system that has a sensor that automatically stops the loader functions until the seat bar is lowered. The seat bar is located in the operator cab. Removal And Installation Figure 50-10-1 Raise the seat bar (Item 1) [Figure 50-10-1]. Disconnect the seat bar sensor (Item 2) [Figure 50-10-1] from the cab harness. Lower the seat bar. Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 50-10-2 Remove the seat bar mounting nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50- 10-2] (both sides). Installation: Tighten the nuts to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft- lb) torque. Lower the operator cab. (See Lowering on Page 10-30- 3.) Figure 50-10-3 Remove the seat bar (Item 1) [Figure 50-10-3] from the operator cab. Reverse the above procedure to install the seat bar into the operator cab. P-85654 P-85653 2 1 P-85652 1 P-90021 1 50-10-2 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-10-4 Figure 50-10-5 Assemble the parts as shown for the left side of the seat bar pivot assembly [Figure 50-10-4] and [Figure 50-10- 5]. Seat Bar Mount (Item 1) Mounting Bolt (Item 2) Keyed Plastic Bushing (Item 3) Seat Bar (Item 4) Magnetic Bushing Assembly (Item 5) Pivot Bushing (Item 6) Sensor Bracket (Item 7) Sensor Mounting Nut (Item 8) Sensor Mounting Bolt (Item 9) Mounting Nut (Item 10) Installation: Tighten the mounting bolt (Item 9) [Figure 50-10-4] and [Figure 50-10-5] to 5,6 - 7,9 N•m (50 - 70 in-lb) torque. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolt (Item 2) [Figure 50-10-4] and [Figure 50-10-5] to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft- lb) torque. Figure 50-10-6 Figure 50-10-7 Assemble the parts as shown for the right side of the seat bar pivot assembly [Figure 50-10-6] and [Figure 50-10- 7]. Seat Bar Mount (Item 1) Mounting Nut (Item 2) Pivot Bushing (Item 3) Spacer Bushing (Item 4) Seat Bar (Item 5) Keyed Plastic Bushing (Item 6) Mounting Bolt (Item 7) Installation: Tighten the mounting bolt (Item 7) [Figure 50-10-6] and [Figure 50-10-7] to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft- lb) torque. P-90022 4 3 2 1 10 9 8 7 6 5 N-19219 1 3 4 5 9 8 6 10 7 2 P-90023 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 N-19220 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 50-10-3 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR (CONT'D) Compression Spring Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-10-8 Turn the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-10-8] and [Figure 50- 10-9] out of the clevis. Assembly: Apply Loctite® #518 adhesive to the bolt threads. Adjust the compression spring by turning the bolt in past the end of the clevis three turns. NOTE: For procedures requiring the use of Loctite® #518 adhesive, thoroughly clean and dry affected parts before the application of Loctite® #518. Figure 50-10-9 Disassemble and assemble the seat bar compression spring and parts as shown in [Figure 50-10-9]. Bolt (Item 1) Bushing (Item 2) Spring (Item 3) Bushing (Item 4) Clevis (Item 5) Pin (Item 6) Bushing (Item 7) Rue Ring (Item 8) N-19222 1 P-90028 1 2 3 4 5 8 7 6 50-10-4 S650 Service Manual 50-20-1 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR CAB Gas Spring Removal And Installation WARNING Cylinder contains high pressure gas. Do not open. Opening cylinder can release rod and cause injury or death. W-2113-0288 Raise the operator cab (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Attach a chain hoist to the grab handles of the operator cab before removing the operator cab gas spring(s). If the operator cab is tilted forward without the gas spring(s) operational, the cab will fall and could cause injury or death. W-2760-0309 Figure 50-20-1 Install a strap and hoist (Item 1) [Figure 50-20-1] to the cab handles. Lift the cab with the hoist to release the pressure on the gas spring(s). Figure 50-20-2 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-20-2]. Figure 50-20-3 Remove the retaining pin (Item 1), the pin (Item 2), and the gas spring (Item 3) [Figure 50-20-3] from the loader. NOTE: If the loader is equipped with a second gas spring repeat the procedure for the other side. P-85662 1 P-85657 1 P-85652 1 2 3 50-20-2 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR CAB (CONT’D) Gas Spring Bracket Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-20-4 Remove the clevis (Item 1) from both ends, and the outer housing (Item 2) from the gas spring (Item 3) [Figure 50- 20-4]. Installation: Apply a small amount of thread-locker on the threads of the gas spring rod before installing the clevis (Item 1) [Figure 50-20-4]. WARNING AVOID INJURY Cylinders for raising and lowering operator cab have gas under pressure. Do not open cylinder. Only qualified service personnel can remove the cylinder. W-2112-0987 Removal And Installation WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Attach a chain hoist to the grab handles of the operator cab before removing the operator cab gas spring(s). If the operator cab is tilted forward without the gas spring(s) operational, the cab will fall and could cause injury or death. W-2760-0309 Remove the throttle cable from the cab. (See Cable Removal And Installation on Page 70-20-2.) Remove the operator cab gas spring(s). (See Gas Spring Removal And Installation on Page 50-20-1.) NOTE: Use the hoist connected to the operator cab grab handles to lower or (raise) the operator cab when the gas spring(s) are disconnected. Figure 50-20-5 Disconnect the cab harness connector screw (Item 1) [Figure 50-20-5]. Installation: Tighten the connector screw to 3,39 - 3,96 N•m (30 - 35 in-lb) torque. P-85661 3 2 1 1 P-85663 1 50-20-3 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR CAB (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-20-6 Remove the two cab mount bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-20-6] from both sides of the cab. Installation: Tighten the cab mount bolts and nuts to 24,4 - 29,8 N•m (18 - 22 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-20-7 Using a strap and a hoist remove the cab from the loader. P-85658 1 P-85662 50-20-4 S650 Service Manual 50-30-1 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR SEAT Removal And Installation Figure 50-30-1 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the four seat mounting nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50- 30-1] and washers from the operator seat mounting studs. Lower the operator cab. (See Lowering on Page 10-30- 3.) Remove the seat. NOTE: With the seat removed, the cab may raise. Seat Belt Removal And Installation (Retractable) Figure 50-30-2 Remove the mounting nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-30-2]. Remove the seat belt. Installation: Tighten the mounting nut to 73 N•m (54 ft- lb) torque. P-85776 1 P-90355 1 50-30-2 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR SEAT (CONT’D) Seat Belt And Bracket Removal And Installation (Standard) Figure 50-30-3 Remove the lower mounting bolt, washer and nut (Item 1). Remove the upper mounting bolt and nut (Item 2) [Figure 50-30-3]. Remove the seat belt. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 73 N•m (54 ft- lb) torque. Seat Belt Bracket Removal And Installation Figure 50-30-4 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the bracket mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50- 30-4]. Remove the bracket (Item 3) [Figure 50-30-3]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to torque. P101249 1 2 3 P101250 1 50-31-1 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR SEAT (SUSPENSION) Removal And Installation Figure 50-31-1 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the four seat mounting nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50- 31-1] and washers from the operator seat mounting studs. Lower the operator cab. (See Lowering on Page 10-30- 3.) Remove the seat. NOTE: With the seat removed, the cab may raise. Slide Rail Removal And Installation Figure 50-31-2 Remove the operator seat. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-31-1.) Remove the two slide rail mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-2]. Figure 50-31-3 Remove the two slide rails mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-3]. Remove the slide rail (Item 2) [Figure 50-31-3] from the bottom of the seat frame. P-85776 1 P-85769 1 1 P-85770 1 2 50-31-2 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR SEAT (SUSPENSION) (CONT’D) Seat Belt Removal And Installation Figure 50-31-4 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-4] from the seat belt mount. Figure 50-31-5 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-5] from the seat belt mount. Remove the seat belt. Lower Cushion Removal Figure 50-31-6 Lift up and push forward on the rear of the seat cushion (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-6]. P-85771 1 P-85772 1 P-85773 1 50-31-3 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR SEAT (SUSPENSION) (CONT’D) Lower Cushion Installation Figure 50-31-7 Insert the tab (Item 1) into the slot (Item 2) [Figure 50-31- 7]. Figure 50-31-8 Push down on the front of the seat (Item 1) and push back (Item 2) [Figure 50-31-8] to lock the seat into position. Back Cushion Removal And Installation Figure 50-31-9 Tilt the seat all the way forward. Remove the two screws (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-9] and tilt the seat back to the upright position. Remove the back cushion from the seat P-85778 2 P-85774 2 1 P-85775 1 1 2 P-85773 1 50-31-4 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR SEAT (SUSPENSION) (CONT’D) Shock Removal And Installation Figure 50-31-10 Remove the operator seat. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-31-1.) Remove the seat shock clips (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-10]. (Both ends.) Remove the seat shock (Item 2) [Figure 50-31-10]. 3-Point Seat Belt Removal And Installation Remove the operator seat. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-31-1.) Figure 50-31-11 Remove the mounting nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-11]. Remove the end release buckle (Item 2) [Figure 50-31- 11]. Figure 50-31-12 Remove the mounting nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-12]. Remove the seat belt retractor (Item 2) [Figure 50-31- 12]. P-85777 1 1 2 P-85785 1 2 P-85784 1 2 50-31-5 S650 Service Manual OPERATOR SEAT (SUSPENSION) (CONT’D) 3-Point Seat Belt Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-31-13 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-31- 13]. Figure 50-31-14 Remove the shoulder harness retractor (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-14]. Figure 50-31-15 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-31-15]. Remove the shoulder harness guide and bushing (Item 2) and hardened washer (Item 3) [Figure 50-31-15]. P-85786 1 P-85787 1 P-85788 2 1 3 50-31-6 S650 Service Manual 50-40-1 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) Description The Bob-Tach is the section of the loader lift arm that attachments mount to. The Hand Lever Bob-Tach uses two manually operated, spring assisted, locking wedge and lever assemblies to secure the attachment the Bob- Tach . The Bob-Tach is located on the front of the loader connected to the loader lift arms. Removal And Installation Figure 50-40-1 Tilt the Bob-Tach forward, so it is parallel to the floor. Put blocks (approximately 76,2 mm (3 in)) under each side of the Bob-Tach [Figure 50-40-1]. Lower the Bob-Tach onto the blocks. Remove the retainer bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-40- 1] from the rod end pivot pin. Installation: Tighten the retainer nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-40-2 Remove the rod end pivot pin (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-2]. P-85554 1 P-85649 1 50-40-2 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-40-3 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-3] from the Bob-Tach pivot pin grease plug (both sides). Figure 50-40-4 Use a grease gun and pump grease into the pivot pin forcing the grease plug out of the Bob-Tach (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-4]. Figure 50-40-5 Check and replace O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-5] on the grease plug. Figure 50-40-6 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-6] from the Bob- Tach pivot pin retaining bolt (both sides). P-31402 1 P-31404 1 P-31405 1 P-31403 1 50-40-3 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-40-7 Remove the retainer bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-7] from the Bob-Tach pin. Installation: Tighten the retainer nut and bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-6] and [Figure 50-40-7] to 446 N•m (330 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-40-8 With a punch (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-8] and a hammer, drive the pivot pin out of the lift arm and Bob-Tach. Lever And Wedge Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-40-9 Remove the lever mounting nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-40- 9]. Installation: Tighten the nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-40-10 Remove the washer and spring, (Item 1) and the lever assembly (Item 2) [Figure 50-40-10]. P-31406 1 P-31407 1 P-85664 1 P-85665 1 2 50-40-4 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) (CONT'D) Lever And Wedge Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 50-40-11 Use a punch and hammer to remove the roll pin (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-11] from the Bob-Tach wedge and spring clevis. Remove the spring clevis assembly (Item 2) [Figure 50- 40-11]. Figure 50-40-12 Remove the wedge (Item 1) [Figure 50-40-12] out the bottom of the Bob-Tach. Always replace bent or broken wedges. Figure 50-40-13 If the bolt (Item 1), handle pivot (Item 2), spring (Item 3), or clevis (Item 4) [Figure 50-40-13] are damaged, put the assembly in a vise. Remove the bolt and replace the damaged parts as needed. P-85666 1 2 P-85667 1 P-85668 1 2 3 4 50-40-5 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) (CONT'D) Pivot Pin Bushing And Seal Removal And Installation Figure 50-40-14 Remove the Bob-Tach. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-40-1.) Use a seal pick to remove seal (Item 1) [Figure 50-40- 14] from the Bob-Tach. Remove and replace bushing (Item 2) [Figure 50-40-14] with a driver tool and hammer. P-85669 1 2 50-40-6 S650 Service Manual 50-41-1 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) Description The Bob-Tach is the section of the loader lift arm that attachments mount to. The Power Bob-Tach option uses two hydraulically operated, spring assisted, locking wedge and lever assemblies to secure the attachment to the Bob-Tach. The hydraulically operated Power Bob-Tach has a hydraulic cylinder that opens and closes both wedge and lever assemblies by pressing a switch on the right switch panel. The switch activates the Power Bob-Tach block to allow flow into or out of the hydraulic cylinder connected to the levers on the Bob-Tach. The Power Bob-Tach block is located on the rear of the gear pump. The Bob-Tach is located on the front of the loader connected to the loader lift arms. Removal And Installation Figure 50-41-1 Tilt the Bob-Tach forward, so it is parallel to the floor. Put 2x4 blocks under each side of the Bob-Tach [Figure 50- 41-1]. Lower the Bob-Tach onto the blocks. Mark the hoses (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-1] for correct installation. Remove and cap the hoses from the cylinder. Remove the washers and bolts (Item 2) [Figure 50-41-1] from the cylinder (both ends). Installation: Tighten the retainer nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Remove the cylinder from the Bob-Tach. P-85570 1 2 2 50-41-2 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-41-2 Remove the retainer bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-41- 2] from the rod end pivot pin. Installation: Tighten the retainer nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-41-3 Remove the rod end pivot pin (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-3]. Figure 50-41-4 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-4] at the Bob-Tach pivot pin grease plug (both sides). Figure 50-41-5 Use a grease gun and pump grease into the pivot pin forcing the grease plug out of the Bob-Tach (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-5] (both sides). P-85554 1 P-85649 1 P-31402 1 P-31404 1 50-41-3 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER - OPTION) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-41-6 Check and replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-6] on the grease plug. Figure 50-41-7 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-7] from the Bob- Tach pivot pin retaining bolt (both sides). Figure 50-41-8 Remove the retainer bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-8] from the Bob-Tach pivot pin (both sides). Installation: Tighten the retainer nut and bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-7] and [Figure 50-41-8] to 446 N•m (330 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-41-9 With a punch (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-9] and a hammer, drive the pivot pin out of the lift arm and Bob-Tach (both sides). Remove the Bob-Tach from the loader. P-31405 1 P-31403 1 P-31406 1 P-31407 1 50-41-4 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER) (CONT'D) Lever And Wedge Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-41-1 Remove the washers and bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-1] from the cylinder (both ends). Installation: Tighten the bolts to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft- lb) torque. Remove the cylinder from the lever pivots. Figure 50-41-2 Remove the lever mounting nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-41- 2]. Installation: Tighten the nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-41-3 Remove the washer and spring, (Item 1) and the lever assembly (Item 2) [Figure 50-41-3]. Figure 50-41-4 Use a punch and hammer to remove the roll pin (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-4] from the Bob-Tach wedge and spring clevis. Remove the spring clevis assembly (Item 2) [Figure 50- 41-4]. P-85570 1 1 P-85664 1 P-85665 1 2 P-85666 1 2 50-41-5 S650 Service Manual BOB-TACH (POWER - OPTION) (CONT'D) Lever And Wedge Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 50-41-5 Remove the wedge (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-5] out the bottom of the Bob-Tach. Always replace bent or broken wedges. Figure 50-41-6 If the bolt (Item 1), handle pivot (Item 2), spring (Item 3), or clevis (Item 4) [Figure 50-41-6] are damaged, put the assembly in a vise. Remove the bolt and replace the damaged parts as needed. Pivot Pin Bushing And Seal Removal And Installation Figure 50-41-7 Remove the Power Bob-Tach. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-41-1.) Use a seal pick to remove seal (Item 1) [Figure 50-41-7] from the Bob-Tach. Remove and replace bushing (Item 2) [Figure 50-41-7] with a driver tool and hammer. P-85667 1 P-85668 1 2 3 4 P-85669 1 2 50-41-6 S650 Service Manual 50-50-1 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARMS Stabilizer Bar Removal And Installation Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) NOTE: Remove the lift arm stabilizer bar from one side of the loader at a time. Figure 50-50-1 Remove the retainer bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-1] and nut from the front stabilizer bar pivot pin. Remove the stabilizer bar pivot pin (Item 2) [Figure 50- 50-1]. Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-50-2 Remove the retainer bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-2] from the stabilizer bar rear pivot pin at the lift arm. Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-50-3 With a slide hammer, remove the rear lift arm stabilizer pin (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-3]. Remove the stabilizer bar from the loader. Figure 50-50-4 Remove the bushings (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-4] from the stabilizer bar (both ends). Inspect the bushings and replace as needed. P-90592A 1 2 P-90593 1 P-90591 1 P-31595 1 50-50-2 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARMS (CONT'D) Link Removal And Installation Figure 50-50-5 Install a sling and chain hoist on the lift arm link [Figure 50-50-5]. Figure 50-50-6 Remove the retainer bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-50- 6] from the lift arm pivot pin (both sides). Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-50-7 Remove the retainer bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-50- 7] from the lift arm link pivot pin (both sides). Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-50-8 Remove the lift arm pivot pin (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-8] (both sides). P-90595 P-90597 1 P-90594 1 P-90598 1 50-50-3 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARMS (CONT'D) Link Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-50-9 Remove the lift arm link pivot pin (Item 1) [Figure 50-50- 9] (both sides). Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Remove the lift arm link from the loader. Removal And Installation Put jackstands under the rear corners of the loader. Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Figure 50-50-10 At the right side upright disconnect and cap the two tilt cylinder hoses (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-10]. NOTE: Mark the hoses for proper installation. Figure 50-50-11 At the left side upright disconnect and cap the three auxiliary hydraulic hoses (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-11]. NOTE: Mark the hoses for proper installation. P-90610 1 P-90600 1 P-90599 1 50-50-4 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARMS (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-50-12 Disconnect the electrical controls harness (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-12]. (If equipped.) Figure 50-50-13 Remove the retaining bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 50- 50-13] from the pin on the rod end of the lift cylinder (both sides). Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-50-14 With a slide hammer, remove the pin (Item 1) [Figure 50- 50-14] from the rod end of the lift cylinder (both sides). Figure 50-50-15 Install slings (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-15] on the lift arms and connect to a chain hoist. P-85692 1 P-90602 1 P-90611 1 P-90606 1 1 1 50-50-5 S650 Service Manual LIFT ARMS (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-50-16 NOTE: Be sure the slings on the lift arms are in a position to balance the lift arms when being removed. See (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-16]. Disconnect the stabilizer bar from both sides of the lift arms (Item 2) [Figure 50-50-16]. Figure 50-50-17 Position the front sling in the middle of the Bob-Tach as shown in (Item 1) [Figure 50-50-17]. Support the lift arms with the chain hoist. Figure 50-50-18 Remove the retaining bolt and nut (Item 1) and the pin (Item 2) [Figure 50-50-18] (both sides). Installation: Tighten the retainer bolt and nut to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Remove the lift arms from the loader. P-90604 1 2 P-90605 1 P-90609 2 1 50-50-6 S650 Service Manual 50-60-1 S650 Service Manual REAR GRILLE Removal And Installation Figure 50-60-1 Flip up the lockable handle (Item 1) [Figure 50-60-1] and turn the handle a quarter turn counter-clockwise. Lift and pull the rear grille to remove it from the loader. Figure 50-60-2 Lift and remove the two side covers (Item 1) [Figure 50- 60-2]. Figure 50-60-3 Align the tabs of the two side covers into the slots in the loader frame and lower [Figure 50-60-3]. Figure 50-60-4 Align the edge of the rear grille under the loader frame and slide rear grille in while lowering [Figure 50-60-4]. Turn the lockable handle a quarter turn clockwise and fold the handle down. P-85496 1 P100052 1 P-85602 P-85604 50-60-2 S650 Service Manual 50-70-1 S650 Service Manual REAR DOOR (TAILGATE) Removal And Installation Figure 50-70-1 Disconnect the light harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-1] from the main frame harness. Remove both rear lights (Item 2) [Figure 50-70-1] from the door. (See Rear Removal And Installation on Page 60-60-2.) Figure 50-70-2 Secure the chain hooks (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-2] to the door as shown. Connect a chain hoist (Item 2) [Figure 50-70-2] to the lifting chain. Figure 50-70-3 Remove the top and bottom door hinge mounting bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-3]. NOTE: Install the door stop (Item 2) and the door stop retainer (Item 3) in the top hinge as shown [Figure 50-70-3]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts and nuts to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft-lb) torque. Lift the door away from the loader frame and put the door flat on the floor. P-85697 2 1 P-90584 1 1 2 P-85695 2 1 3 50-70-2 S650 Service Manual REAR DOOR (TAILGATE) (CONT’D) Striker Removal And Installation Figure 50-70-4 Remove the two striker mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50- 70-4]. Remove the striker assembly from the loader. Striker Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-70-5 Remove the lock nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-5]. Remove the rollers (Item 2) and the spacer (Item 3) from the bolt (Item 4) [Figure 50-70-5]. Check the parts for wear and replace as needed. Installation: Tighten the bolt (Item 4) and nut (Item 1) to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft-lb) torque. Striker (Adjusting) WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Never service or adjust the machine when the engine is running unless instructed to do so in the manual. W-2012-0497 Figure 50-70-6 Loosen the striker assembly mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-6]. Align the striker assembly in the center of the mounting holes. NOTE: Tighten the striker assembly, top mount bolt only, until it will hold the striker assembly in the center of the mounting slots. Close the rear door. (This will align the striker assembly to the correct position.) Open the door. Tighten both striker mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-6] to 125 - 135 N•m (90 - 100 ft-lb) torque. Close the rear door. P-85698A 1 1 P-31320A 1 3 2 4 P-85698A 1 1 50-70-3 S650 Service Manual REAR DOOR (TAILGATE) (CONT’D) Latch Removal And Installation Figure 50-70-7 Disconnect the spring (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-7] from the rear door. Remove the bolt and nut (Item 2) [Figure 50-70-7] from the latch. Figure 50-70-8 Remove the spring (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-8] from the door handle. Remove the spring (Item 2) [Figure 50-70-8] from the door latch. Remove the door latch (Item 3) [Figure 50-70-8] from the door handle. Figure 50-70-9 Remove the door handle (Item 1) [Figure 50-70-9] from the rear door. P-85699 1 2 P-85700 1 2 3 P-85701 1 50-70-4 S650 Service Manual 50-80-1 S650 Service Manual FUEL TANK Removal And Installation Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Remove the engine / hydrostatic pump assembly from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) Figure 50-80-1 Remove the three mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-1] from the access cover at the rear of the loader frame. Remove the access cover. Figure 50-80-2 Remove the drain plug (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-2]. Drain the fuel into a container. Figure 50-80-3 Disconnect the fuel vent hose (Item 1) and remove the two bolts (Item 2) [Figure 50-80-3]. Figure 50-80-4 Disconnect the two fuel lines (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-4]. Disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 2) [Figure 50-80-4] from the fuel level sender. Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 3) and remove the bracket (Item 4) [Figure 50-80-4]. P-85714 1 1 P-85713 1 P-85707 1 2 P-85708 1 3 2 4 50-80-2 S650 Service Manual FUEL TANK (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 50-80-5 Remove the bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-5] from the battery hold down plate. Remove the hold down plate from the loader. Figure 50-80-6 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) and the bracket (Item 2) [Figure 50-80-6]. Figure 50-80-7 At the right side of the loader, remove the two main frame mount bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-7]. Installation: Tighten the main frame mount bolts to 542 - 583 N•m (400 - 430 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-80-8 At the left side of the loader, remove the two main frame mount bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-7]. Installation: Tighten the main frame mount bolts to 542 - 583 N•m (400 - 430 ft-lb) torque. Lift the fuel tank and remove it from the loader frame. NOTE: When installing the fuel tank, avoid striking the tank with heavy objects to prevent damage. P-85710 1 1 P-85709 1 2 1 P-85711 1 1 P-85712 1 1 50-80-3 S650 Service Manual FUEL TANK (CONT'D) Fuel Level Sender Removal And Installation Figure 50-80-9 Disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-9] from the fuel level sender. Remove the fuel level sender. Figure 50-80-10 Inspect the fuel level sender and replace if worn or damaged. Fuel Fill Screen Removal And Installation Figure 50-80-11 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) and disconnect the fuel fill hose (Item 2) [Figure 50-80-11]. Figure 50-80-12 Remove the fuel fill screen (Item 1) [Figure 50-80-12]. Inspect and replace as needed. P-85708 1 P-85716 P-85707 2 1 P-85715 1 50-80-4 S650 Service Manual 50-90-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES Description The control pedals and linkages are connected to the control valve. The control pedals will mechanically move the lift and tilt spools on the control valve. The control pedals and linkages are located on the lower mainframe at the operators feet. Pedal Removal And Installation WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device.(See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab.(See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 Figure 50-90-1 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-1] and nut from the pedal linkage. Check the bushing in the pedal for wear and replace as needed. Figure 50-90-2 Remove the two nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-2] from the pedal mounting bracket. Remove the pedal assembly from the loader. P-85675 1 P-85676 1 50-90-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (CONT’D) Linkage Removal And Installation Figure 50-90-3 Remove the bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-3] to disconnect the lift pedal linkage from the crossbar. Figure 50-90-4 Remove the hairpin clips (Item 1) and cross-pins (Item 2) [Figure 50-90-4] from the control valve lift spool. Disconnect the crossbar from the control valve. Figure 50-90-5 Remove the crossbar pivot bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-90- 5]. Remove the crossbar from the pivot (Item 2) [Figure 50- 90-6]. Figure 50-90-6 Installation: Check the nylon bushing (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-6] for wear and replace as needed. P-85678 1 P-85680 1 2 1 2 P-85679 1 2 P-85681 1 50-90-3 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (CONT’D) Linkage Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-90-7 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-7] and nut from the pedal linkage. Remove the linkage (Item 2) [Figure 50-90-7]. Figure 50-90-8 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-8] and nut from the pedal linkage. Remove the linkage (Item 2) [Figure 50-90-8]. Pedal (Adjusting) After installing the pedal, adjust the pedal angle so that there is clearance under the rear of the pedal. The valve spool must travel full stroke without the pedal hitting the floor panel. The pedals should be positioned at a comfortable angle so full movement of the pedal can be reached easily while properly sitting in the loader seat. Figure 50-90-9 Loosen the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-9] from the pedal mounting bracket. Figure 50-90-10 Loosen the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-10] and nut on the pedal linkage. Check the bushing in the pedal for wear and replace as needed. Tilt the pedal back and forth until an acceptable “neutral” angle is achieved on the pedal. Tighten the two nuts (Item 2) and pivot bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-10] on the pedal assembly to standard torque. P-85675 1 2 P-85675A 1 2 P-85676 1 P-85675 1 2 50-90-4 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (CONT’D) Floor Pan Removal And Installation Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Remove the pedals. (See Pedal Removal And Installation on Page 50-90-1.) Remove the access panels. (See ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) on Page 50-120-1.) Figure 50-90-11 Figure 50-90-12 Remove the clips (Item 1) [Figure 50-90-11] and [Figure 50-90-12] from the sides of the floor pan. Remove the floor pan (Item 2) [Figure 50-90-12]. P-85860 P-85859 1 1 P-85858 2 1 1 50-91-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (ACS) Description The control pedals are connected to foot sensors located behind the control panel. The foot sensors send an electronic pulse to the actuators on the control valve. The electronic pulse tells the actuators to move the lift or tilt spools on the control valve. The control pedals and linkages are located on the lower mainframe at the operators feet. Pedal Removal And Installation WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device.(See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab.(See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 Figure 50-91-1 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-91-1] and nut from the pedal linkage. Check the bushing in the pedal for wear and replace as needed. Figure 50-91-2 Remove the two nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-91-2] from the pedal mounting bracket. Remove the pedal assembly from the loader. P-85675 1 P-85676 1 50-91-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (ACS) (CONT’D) Linkage Removal And Installation Figure 50-91-3 Remove the hairpin clip and the pin (Item 1) [Figure 50- 91-3] from the foot sensor. Figure 50-91-4 Remove the linkage (Item 1) [Figure 50-91-4] and the rubber boot. Repeat for other side. Pedal (Adjusting) After installing the pedal, adjust the pedal angle so that there is clearance under the rear of the pedal. The valve spool must travel full stroke without the pedal hitting the floor panel. The pedals should be positioned at a comfortable angle so full movement of the pedal can be reached easily while properly sitting in the loader seat. Figure 50-91-5 Loosen the two mounting nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-91-5] from the pedal mounting bracket. Figure 50-91-6 Loosen the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-91-6] and nut on the pedal linkage. Check the bushing in the pedal for wear and replace as needed. Tilt the pedal back and forth until an acceptable “neutral” angle is achieved on the pedal. Tighten the two nuts (Item 2) and pivot bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-91-6] on the pedal assembly to standard torque. P-90979 1 1 P-90981 1 P-85676 1 P-85675 1 2 50-91-3 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (ACS) (CONT’D) Floor Pan Removal And Installation Remove the control panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Remove the pedals. (See Pedal Removal And Installation on Page 50-91-1.) Remove the access panels. (See ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) on Page 50-120-1.) Figure 50-91-7 Figure 50-91-8 Remove the clips (Item 1) [Figure 50-91-7] and [Figure 50-91-8] from the sides of the floor pan. Remove the floor pan (Item 2) [Figure 50-91-8]. P-85860 P-85859 1 1 P-85858 2 1 1 50-91-4 S650 Service Manual 50-100-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL Description Figure 50-100-1 The steering system consists of independent steering levers the operator uses to provide steering input to the loader. The steering levers are attached to pivoting bellcranks that pivot on a steering shaft and plastic bushings. The forward travel is adjusted by drift adjustment bolts. The bellcranks are attached to steering linkage bars with torsion bushings pressed into the bellcranks. Bellcranks mount to the control handle assembly and mount to the control panel. Steering linkage bars are a two-piece design. Steering linkage bars are adjustable in length for “full travel adjustment”. Steering linkage bars attach to the pintle arms where a rubber torsion bushing is pressed into the pintle arms. Pintle arms are of a two-piece design that allow easy adjustment of the neutral or “creep”. The steering system returns the levers to their starting position by means of the centering spring and the returning force of the torsion bushings. NOTE: Torsion bushings need to be replaced if torn or rotating in the housing. Loosen torsion bushing bolts slightly before adjustments are made. Sequence of steering adjustments: 1. Set neutral of pintle arms, “creep” 2. Set full travel at steering linkage bars 3. Set drift at drift adjustment bolts NA1034 50-100-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 50-100-2 Figure 50-100-3 Disconnect the control harness connectors (Item 1) and the back-up alarm wires (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-2] & [Figure 50-100-3] from the control levers. P-85846 2 1 P-85847 1 2 50-100-3 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 50-100-4 Scribe a mark across the top of the steering linkage bars (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-4] which are connected to the steering shaft on the control panel. Remove the four steering linkage mounting bolts, nuts and rubber isolators (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-4]. Inspect and replace any damaged parts. Installation: Align the marks on the steering linkage bars. Tighten the steering linkage mounting bolts to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-100-5 Remove the two bracket mounting bolts (Item 1) and the knob (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-5] from the lift arm bypass valve. Remove the eight control panel bolts (Item 3) and the control panel assembly (Item 4) [Figure 50-100-5]. Disassembly And Assembly Remove Control Panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-100-2.) Figure 50-100-6 Remove the nuts (Item 1) and the steering stabilizers (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-6]. P-90612 1 2 2 P-85848 1 3 2 3 3 3 4 P-85864 1 1 2 1 2 1 50-100-4 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-7 Figure 50-100-8 Remove the bolt and nut (Item 1), steering link, (Item 2), and washers (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-7] and [Figure 50- 100-8]. Installation: Verify correct orientation of components [Figure 50-100-7] and [Figure 50-100-8]. Figure 50-100-9 Remove the four bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-9] from the control panel. Remove the control handle assembly (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-9]. Figure 50-100-10 Remove the tie straps (Item 1), the four nuts (Item 2), and the plate (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-10]. Remove the control handle (Item 4) [Figure 50-100-10]. P-85865 2 3 3 2 3 3 1 1 P-85861 1 P-85867 1 2 P-85868 1 2 3 4 50-100-5 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-11 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) from the bellcrank (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-11]. Remove the bellcrank from the bracket [Figure 50-100- 11]. Figure 50-100-12 Inspect the shaft (Item 1), the bellcrank (Item 2), and the bushings (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-11] for wear and replace as need. Repeat the procedure for the other control handle assembly. Linkage Removal And Installation WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) P-85872 21 1 P-85873 2 1 3 50-100-6 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-13 Scribe a mark across the top of the steering linkage bars (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-13] which are connected to the steering shaft on the control panel. Remove the four steering linkage mounting bolts, nuts and rubber isolators (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-13]. Inspect and replace any damaged parts. Installation: Align the marks on the steering linkage bars. Tighten the steering linkage mounting bolts to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: After removal and installation of the linkage, the linkage neutral adjusting procedure must be performed. (See Linkage Neutral (Adjusting) on Page 50-100-10.) Figure 50-100-14 Remove the nut (Item 1) from the end of the centering spring shoulder bolt (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-14]. Remove the bolt / spring assembly. Installation: Tighten the centering spring bolt and a NEW lock nut to 34 - 38 N•m (25 - 28 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-100-15 Slide the centering plate (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-15] to the right to remove it from the hydrostatic pumps. NOTE: Directions are shown and stated as if you were sitting in the operator’s seat. P-90612 1 2 2 P-48631 1 2 P-48632 1 50-100-7 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-16 The centering plate / centering spring assembly consists of the following parts: Figure 50-100-17 Check the wear on the centering blocks (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-17]. If the centering blocks need replacement, remove the bolts (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-17]. Remove the centering blocks. Installation: Tighten the centering block bolts to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: The washers go between the bolts and the centering plate. NOTE: If the centering blocks are worn, they can be removed and rotated 180 degrees and reinstalled. P-48630 8 7 6 1 2 2 4 5 3 ITEM DESCRIPTION 1Bolt 2 Bushings 3 Washer 4 Bushing Spacer 5Spring 6Lock Nut 7 Centering Plate 8 Guide Bushings P-48629 2 2 1 1 50-100-8 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-18 Remove the bolts and washers (Item 1) [Figure 50-100- 18] from the pintle. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Remove the pintle arm (Item 2) from the pintle base (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-18]. Figure 50-100-19 Remove the bolt and nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-19]. Inspect the washers (Item 2), pintle arm (Item 3) and the steering control lever (Item 4) for damage and replace as needed [Figure 50-100-19]. NOTE: The washers (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-19] are hardened, and should only be replaced through Bobcat Parts. Figure 50-100-20 Loosen the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-20]. Remove the pintle base (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-20]. Figure 50-100-21 NOTE: When installing the pintle base (Item 1) onto the pump shaft, the cutouts on the pump shaft will not line up with the bolt (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-21]. Installation: Install the pintle base (Item 1) onto the pump shaft (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-21]. The top of the pintle base should be level with the top of the pump shaft. Tighten the bolts to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: After installing the linkage onto the hydrostatic pumps the linkage neutral adjusting procedure must be performed. (See Linkage Neutral (Adjusting) on Page 50-100- 10.) P-54617 1 2 3 P-48624 1 3 2 1 2 4 P-54615 2 1 P-48659 1 2 3 50-100-9 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Pintle Arm Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-100-22 Remove the nut (Item 1) from the pintle roller cams (Item 2) and inspect the pintle roller cams and washers (Item 3) for damage [Figure 50-100-22]. Inspect the torsion bushing (Item 4) [Figure 50-100-22] for damage and replace as needed. Installation: Tighten the nuts to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 50-100-23 Remove the base pintle (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-23] from the pump shaft. Remove the retaining bolt (Item 2), adjusting screw (Item 3) and neoprene dampener (Item 4) from the base pintle [Figure 50-100-23]. Inspect parts for wear and damage, replace as needed [Figure 50-100-23]. NOTE: Anti-seize should be used on the adjusting screw to prevent corrosion and allow free movement while adjusting. Figure 50-100-24 Using a bushing driver (Item 1) remove the torsion bushing (Item 2) by pressing the bushing through the pintle arm into an oversized socket (Item 3) to catch the torsion bushing [Figure 50-100-24]. Installation: Install the torsion bushing (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-24] into the pintle arm using the same procedure as the removal. NOTE: When the torsion bushing is installed, the amount of bushing on each side of the pintle arm should be the same. P-54624 1 2 3 2 4 P-54626 1 2 4 3 P-48619 1 2 3 50-100-10 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Neutral (Adjusting) The following tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: Kit - 6689778 Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) or MEL1563 Remote Start Tool. Connect the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) OR (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Figure 50-100-25 Tool that may assist in the neutral adjustment [Figure 50- 100-25]. To make this tool use a locking grip C-Clamp and grind one edge flat (Item 1) and grind the other edge (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-25] to a small rounded edge. A steering centering block (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-25] is also needed. The centering block can be placed as shown and welded to the C-clamp if desired. WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Figure 50-100-26 Loosen the bolt / nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-26] only until the tension is released from the torsion bushing. Figure 50-100-27 Loosen the nut (Item 1) only until the tension is released from the torsion bushing (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-27]. NOTE: The bolt must be loose enough to allow the torsion bushing (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-27] to turn freely between the torsion bushing and the steering linkage bar. P-48450A 1 2 3 P-85845 1 P-54613 2 1 50-100-11 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Neutral (Adjusting) (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-28 Loosen the two bolts (Item 1) holding the right centering block. Move the right hand centering block (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-28] until both pintle cams contact the centering block. NOTE: The left centering block is not adjustable. By adjusting the right centering block the left centering block will also become aligned properly. Figure 50-100-29 A modified locking grip C-Clamp and steering block shown in [Figure 50-100-25] may be used to help in aligning the centering blocks. Install the centering block (Item 1) on the inside of the pintle cams and the C-Clamp (Item 2) [Figure 50-100- 29] around both centering blocks. Lock the C-Clamp in place. WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Connect the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60-1.) OR (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) Start the engine and run at low idle. Move the traction lock override switch so the traction function is unlocked. On a standard loader the wedge brake will unlock. NOTE: When the engine is started, the wheels / tracks may begin to move. NOTE: In loaders equipped with manual steering and hydraulic brake, the steering levers may have to be moved during engine start-up to reduce the amount of creep. This reduction in creep will allow time for the engine to run and build up hydraulic charge pressure, which will release the hydraulic brake. Tighten bolts (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-29] to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb). NOTE: Check for slack between centering blocks and pintle cams. If there is excessive slack repeat above steps [Figure 50-100-28] & [Figure 50- 100-29]. P-54614 2 1 P-48451 3 1 2 50-100-12 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Neutral (Adjusting) (Cont’d) Start the neutral adjustment procedure with the left pump first and complete the neutral adjustment for the left pump before adjusting the right pump. Figure 50-100-30 Loosen the left pump pintle adjustment lock bolts (Item 1). (The right pump pintle adjustment lock bolts are (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-30].) Loosen the bolts enough to allow free movement between the pintle arm and the pintle base. NOTE: If the bolts are too loose or too tight, the neutral adjustment may be affected. Figure 50-100-31 Move the engine speed control to high idle. NOTE: The neutral range (dead-band) will vary between the hydrostatic pumps. NOTE: This procedure is shown for neutral adjustment on the left side of the loader. The procedure is the same for the right side neutral adjustment. Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-31] counterclockwise until forward creep is seen. Turn the adjustment screw (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-31] to a point between forward and reverse where there is zero creep. Stroke the left steering lever to forward and allow the lever to return to neutral. Stroke the left steering lever to reverse and allow the lever to return to neutral. Check that there is zero creep when the lever returns from either direction, on the left side. Turn the adjustment screw (if necessary) until zero creep is obtained. P-48632 1 2 P-54610 1 50-100-13 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Neutral (Adjusting) (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-32 Torque the left pump pintle adjustment lock bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-32] to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb). Repeat the adjustment procedure for the right pump. Torque the right pump pintle adjustment lock bolts (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-32] to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb). Test both levers by moving them backward and forward and letting them return to neutral by the return spring force. If the levers do not return to neutral and the wheels / tracks do not come to a complete stop, repeat the adjustment procedure again. Stop the engine. Remove one pintle adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50- 100-32] at a time and apply Loctite® #242 or equivalent thread locker to the bolt and re-install the bolt. Torque the bolt to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb). Repeat for the three remaining pintle adjustment lock bolts. NOTE: To maintain proper adjustment setting, remove and reinstall only one bolt at a time. New bolts can be installed with pre-applied Loctite®. Remove the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool). NOTE: After the neutral adjustment is completed on both pumps, the linkage travel adjustment MUST be completed. (See Linkage Travel (Adjusting) on Page 50-100-14.) P-48632 1 1 2 2 50-100-14 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Travel (Adjusting) NOTE: When the linkage travel adjusting procedure is being done as part of the loader neutral adjusting procedure, check the torsion bushings at the pump and at the bell cranks to be sure they are not binding or too loose, which will affect the procedure. WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Pre-load tension in the torsion bushings must be removed before adjusting the steering linkage. Figure 50-100-33 Loosen the bolt / nut (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-33] only until the tension is released from the torsion bushing. Figure 50-100-34 Loosen the nuts (Item 1) only until the tension is released from the torsion bushings (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-34]. The bolts must be loose enough to allow the torsion bushing (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-34] to turn freely between the torsion bushing and the linkage bar. P-85845 1 P-54613 2 1 50-100-15 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Travel (Adjusting) (Cont’d) Figure 50-100-35 Locate the control lever drift adjustment access hole in the front of the control panel. Turn the control lever drift adjustment bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-35] (one on each control lever) out until they no longer contact the bellcrank. Figure 50-100-36 Move the right side steering lever to the rear and install a 10 mm (3/8 in) thick spacer (Item 1) between the pintle arm cam (Item 2) and the centering block (Item 3) [Figure 50-100-36]. Figure 50-100-37 Move the right side steering lever forward and install a 24 mm (15/16 in) thick spacer (Item 1) between the center plate (Item 2) and the mounting plate (Item 3) [Figure 50- 100-37]. This will allow the pintle arms to move freely while adjusting the steering linkage for full forward travel speed. Remove the 10 mm (3/8 in) thick spacer. Figure 50-100-38 Before adjusting the linkage, verify the base pintle arm mounting bolt (Item 1) and both of the upper pintle mount bolts (Item 2) are tightened to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. There should be no play between the pintle arm and the square pump shaft [Figure 50-100-38]. Verify the cam mounting nuts (Item 4) [Figure 50-100- 36] are tightened to 48 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft lb) torque. P-85878 1 P-51131 3 1 2 4 P-51132 2 1 3 P-51133 1 2 3 50-100-16 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Travel (Adjusting) (Cont'd) Figure 50-100-39 Loosen the two bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-100- 39] on each steering linkage bar. Figure 50-100-40 Move the left control lever to the full forward position, then pull forward on the left rear linkage bar until the pintle arm is rotated to the front as far as possible [Figure 50-100-40]. Use a locking plier, clamp the two linkage bars together. Installation: Tighten the nuts and bolts to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Check the lever movement to make sure that the pintle arm and the control lever are both at full stroke at the same time. This will allow for maximum forward speed. Repeat the linkage travel adjustment procedure for the right side linkage. Figure 50-100-41 Remove the spacer (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-41]. Figure 50-100-42 Tighten the two bolts (Item 1) and nuts (Item 2) to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) [Figure 50-100-42]. P-85844 1 1 P-90615 P-51132 1 P-54613 1 2 50-100-17 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Linkage Travel (Adjusting) (Cont'd) WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Figure 50-100-43 Tighten the two bolts and nuts (Items 1) [Figure 50-100- 43] to 47,5 - 54,2 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque at the steering bell cranks. Installation: After removal, installation, and adjusting of the linkage, the Back-up Alarm must be inspected. (See Inspecting on Page 60-210-1.) Figure 50-100-44 Figure 50-100-45 Push the control lever to full stroke and turn drift adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-44] and [Figure 50-100-45] in until it contacts the bellcrank. Repeat steps on the other control lever. Drive the loader forward and check for drift. The traditional benchmark for drift is less than 3 m (10 ft) of “drift” in 30,5 m (100 ft) of travel distance. If the drift is excessive to the left, turn the right adjustment bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-44] and [Figure 50-100-45] in. If the drift is excessive to the right, turn the left adjustment bolt in. NOTE: When using the drift adjustment bolts, only adjust one bolt for each test drive. In addition, only move each bolt a maximum of one turn for each test drive. This will help prevent over-correction and excessive reduction in travel speed. Drift adjustment is for forward travel only. Adjust the drift to an acceptable level. Reinstall the plug in the drift bolt access hole after adjustment. P-85845 1 P-85877 1 P-85878 1 50-100-18 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (CONT'D) Shock Removal And Installation Figure 50-100-46 Remove the mounting nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-100-46] from the end of the shocks connected to the steering linkages. Remove the mounting nuts (Item 2) [Figure 50-100-46] from the other end of the shocks connected to the brackets on the control panel. Installation: Tighten the nuts to torque. P-85845 1 2 2 1 50-101-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL (SJC) Description The control panel is connected to the lower main frame and wraps around the operator seat. There are no mechanical linkages connecting to the hydrostatic pumps or the control valve. Removal And Installation WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 50-101-1 Remove the three mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-101-1] that secure the controller. Figure 50-101-2 Remove the 10 panel mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50- 101-2]. Remove the lift arm bypass knob and rubber washer (Item 2) [Figure 50-101-2]. Remove the control panel (Item 3) [Figure 50-101-2]. P-85879 1 1 P-85881 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 50-101-2 S650 Service Manual 50-110-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER Description The control handles / levers are used to control the forward and reverse travel. The control handles / levers are mounted to the control panel assembly. Lever Removal And Installation Figure 50-110-1 Remove the tie strap and disconnect the electrical connectors (Item 1) [Figure 50-110-1] from the control lever. Remove the four nuts (Item 2) and the plate (Item 3) [Figure 50-110-1] used to mount the control lever. Remove the control lever (Item 4) [Figure 50-110-1] by sliding the lever through the control panel. Installation: Tighten the four nuts to the plate so the lever cannot be moved either right or left when seated in the operator’s seat. P-85882 1 2 3 4 50-110-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE/LEVER (CONT’D) Boot Removal And Installation Remove the control handle / lever. (See Lever Removal And Installation on Page 50-110-1.) Figure 50-110-2 Remove the rubber boot (Item 1) [Figure 50-110-2]. Install the new boot and reinstall the steering lever. P-85883A 1 50-111-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) Description Figure 50-111-1 The control handles / levers are used to control the forward and reverse travel and the lift and tilt functions.The lift and tilt functions can be controlled by handle sensors (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-1] that are located in the base of the control handle / levers. The control handles / levers are mounted to the control panel. Handle Sensor Removal And Installation Figure 50-111-2 NOTE: The calibration procedure must be followed when replacing handle sensor, foot pedal sensor, actuator or ACS Controller. (See Lift And Tilt Calibration (ACS) on Page 60-160-11.) Loosen the nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-2]. Installation: Tighten the nuts so the lever cannot be moved either right or left when seated in the operator seat. P-21879 1 P-85882 1 50-111-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) (CONT'D) Handle Sensor Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 50-111-3 Disconnect the harness connector (Item 1) from the handle sensor connector.[Figure 50-111-3]. Disconnect the harness connector (Item 2) [Figure 50- 111-3] from the handle lock solenoid connector. Figure 50-111-4 Remove the handle sensor connector (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-4] from the clip. NOTE: Pry out with a small screwdriver and push the connector down. Figure 50-111-5 Remove the handle lock solenoid connector (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-5] from the clip. NOTE: Pry out with a small screwdriver and push the connector down. Figure 50-111-6 Remove one of the two mounting screws (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-6] from the handle sensor. Installation: Tighten screws to 3,6 - 4,3 N•m (32 - 38 in- lb) torque. While removing the mounting pin (Item 2) from the handle sensor, remove the plastic spacer (Item 3), the spring (Item 4) and washer (Item 5) [Figure 50-111-6]. P-21836 2 1 P-21861 1 P-21860 1 P-21862 1 4 5 1 2 3 50-111-3 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) (CONT’D) Handle Sensor Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 50-111-7 Remove one of the two mounting screws (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-7] from the handle sensor. Installation: Tighten bolt to 3,6 - 4,3 N•m (32 - 38 in-lb) torque. Figure 50-111-8 Remove the handle sensor (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-8] from the handle assembly. NOTE: The handle sensor (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-8] can only be replaced as a complete assembly. Check the spacer (Item 2), screws (Item 3), mounting pins (Item 4), spring (Item 5), washer (Item 6), bolt / nut (Item 7), and stop strap (Item 8) [Figure 50-111-8] and replace as needed. Figure 50-111-9 Figure 50-111-10 Installation: When installing the handle sensor into the control handle, check the routing of the switch handle wire harness (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-9] and [Figure 50- 111-10] to assure proper return of the control handle to neutral and minimize harness movement. NOTE: Route wires (Item 2) [Figure 50-111-9] and [Figure 50-111-10] as shown away from stop strap (Item 3) [Figure 50-111-9] and [Figure 50- 111-10] to avoid wire damage. NOTE: The calibration procedure must be followed when replacing handle sensor, foot pedal sensor, actuator or ACS Controller. (See Lift And Tilt Calibration (ACS) on Page 60-160-11.) P-21880 1 P-21882 8 1 5 4 3 2 6 7 7 P-21878 1 2 3 P-21799 1 3 2 50-111-4 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) (CONT'D) Handle Removal And Installation Figure 50-111-11 Remove the handle sensor (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-11]. (See Handle Sensor Removal And Installation on Page 50-111-1.) Figure 50-111-12 Remove the switch handle (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-12]. (See Switch Handle Removal on Page 60-130-4.) Figure 50-111-13 Remove the rubber handle cover (Item 1) [Figure 50- 111-13] from the handle. Figure 50-111-14 Using a small screwdriver, hold the handle spacer (Item 1) and remove the allen head screws (Item 2) [Figure 50-111-14] from the handle assembly. Installation: Tighten the allen head screws to 4 N•m (35 in-lb) torque. P-21879 1 P16534 1 N-17384 1 N-17385 2 1 2 50-111-5 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) (CONT'D) Handle Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-111-15 Remove the handle sleeve (Item 1) and bushings (Item 2) [Figure 50-111-15] from the handle. Check all parts for wear and replace as needed. Figure 50-111-16 Check the mounting bolt (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-16] that connects the handle to the handle sensor unit for wear, replace as needed. Lever Removal And Installation Figure 50-111-17 Remove the tie strap and disconnect the electrical connectors (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-17] from the control lever. Remove the four nuts (Item 2) and the plate (Item 3) [Figure 50-111-17] used to mount the control lever. Remove the control lever (Item 4) [Figure 50-111-17] by sliding the lever through the control panel. Installation: Tighten the four nuts to the plate so the lever cannot be moved either right or left when seated in the operator’s seat. N-17394 1 2 2 N-22796 1 P-85882 1 2 3 4 50-111-6 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) (CONT'D) Boot Removal And Installation Remove the control handle / lever. (See Lever Removal And Installation on Page 50-111-5.) Figure 50-111-18 Remove the rubber boot (Item 1) [Figure 50-111-18]. Install the new boot and reinstall the steering lever. P-85883A 1 50-112-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (SJC) Description The control panel has two electronic handles that control the steering, lift, and tilt functions. There are no mechanical connections to the hydrostatic pumps or the control valve. Joystick Testing See Bobcat Advanced Troubleshooting System (B.A.T.S.) or connect to service analyzer to check function. 50-112-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (SJC) (CONT'D) Joystick Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Figure 50-112-1 Lift the rubber boot (Item 1) [Figure 50-112-1]. Figure 50-112-2 Remove the four screws (Item 1) [Figure 50-112-2] and lift the joystick control from the base. Installation: Tighten the four screws to 4,0 - 4,5 N•m (35 - 40 in-lb) torque. Figure 50-112-3 Disconnect the joystick connector (Item 1) [Figure 50- 112-3] from the harness connector. P-85890 1 P-85889 1 1 1 1 P-85891 1 50-120-1 S650 Service Manual ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) Removal And Installation (Left) Remove the control pedal. (See Pedal Removal And Installation on Page 50-90-1.) Figure 50-120-1 Remove the four mounting screws, (Item 1), washer (Item 2), and remove the left access panel (Item 3) [Figure 50- 120-1]. Remove the front access panel from the loader. Removal And Installation (Right) Remove the control pedal. (See Pedal Removal And Installation on Page 50-90-1.) Figure 50-120-2 Remove the top mounting screw (Item 1), washer (Item 2), and loosen the two bottom mounting screws (Item 3) [Figure 50-120-2] from the front access panel. Remove the front access panel from the loader. P-85677 1 1 3 2 P-85677A 3 1 1 2 50-120-2 S650 Service Manual 50-121-1 S650 Service Manual ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) (SJC) Removal And Installation (Left) Figure 50-121-1 Remove the two mounting nuts (Item 1), and remove the foot rest (Item 2) [Figure 50-121-1]. Figure 50-121-2 Remove the mounting screws (Item 1), and remove the inside left access panel (Item 2) [Figure 50-121-2]. Removal And Installation (Right) Figure 50-121-3 Remove the two mounting nuts (Item 1), and remove the foot rest (Item 2) [Figure 50-121-3]. Figure 50-121-4 Remove the bolt and throttle pedal (Item 1), and remove the mounting screws (Item 2) [Figure 50-121-4]. Remove the right inside access panel (Item 3) [Figure 50-121-4]. P-85887 2 1 P-85884 1 1 2 P-90587 12 P-90588 1 2 2 2 3 50-121-2 S650 Service Manual 50-130-1 S650 Service Manual WINDOW (REAR) Removal And Installation WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Wear safety glasses to prevent eye injury when any of the following conditions exist: • When fluids are under pressure. • Flying debris or loose material is present. • Engine is running. • Tools are being used. W-2019-0907 Figure 50-130-1 Remove the rear window assembly by turning the two latches (Item 1) [Figure 50-130-1] in until they disengage from the window frame. Push the rear window out the rear of the operator cab. NOTE: If rear window is broken, remove all glass fragments from the rubber molding before installing a new window. Clean the area before installing the rear window assembly. Reverse the procedure to install the rear window. Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-130-2 Remove the screw (Item 1) from the latch [Figure 50- 130-2]. Installation: Tighten the screw (Item 1) [Figure 50-130- 2] to 21 - 23 N•m (180 - 200 in-lb) torque. Figure 50-130-3 Inspect and replace any damaged parts. The items listed below refer to [Figure 50-130-3]. 1. Latch 2. Spacer 3. Bushing 4. Washer 5. Screw 6. Rear Window 7. Seal P-85706 1 1 P-85705 1 P-85704 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 50-130-2 S650 Service Manual 50-131-1 S650 Service Manual WINDOW (TOP) Removal And Installation Figure 50-131-1 Install the bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-131-1] through the window grommets and through the cab holes. Figure 50-131-2 From inside the operator cab, install and tighten the four nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-131-2] on the window bolts. Tighten the nuts (Item 1) [Figure 50-131-2] to 9 - 10 N•m (80 - 90 in-lb) torque. P-85807 1 1 P-85808 1 1 1 1 50-131-2 S650 Service Manual 50-132-1 S650 Service Manual WINDOW (SIDE) Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Figure 50-132-1 Figure 50-132-2 From inside the operator cab, remove the plastic cap (Item 1), nut (Item 2), spring (Item 3), knob (Item 4), and sleeve (Item 5) [Figure 50-132-1] and [Figure 50-132-2] from the window assembly. Installation: Tighten the nut (Item 2) [Figure 50-132-1] flush to the end of the bolt. Figure 50-132-3 Support the window assembly and remove the six bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-132-3] from the window frame and the operator cab. Installation: Tighten the six bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50- 132-3] to 9 - 10 N•m (80 - 90 in-lb) torque. Remove the window assembly. NOTE: The window assembly can only be replaced as a complete unit. P-85821 2 P-85819 1 2 3 4 5 P-90586 1 1 1 1 1 1 50-132-2 S650 Service Manual 50-140-1 S650 Service Manual CAB DOOR Description The standard cab door is available as an option or dealer installed kit. Removal And Installation Figure 50-140-1 Open the cab door. Disconnect electrical connector (Item 2) and washer fluid hose (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-1]. Figure 50-140-2 Rotate and pull the clip (Item 1) out of the gas spring socket. Pull the gas spring socket (Item 3) straight off the ball stud fitting (Item 2) [Figure 50-140-2]. Figure 50-140-3 Lift the door (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-3] off the hinges. Figure 50-140-4 Remove the four bolts and nuts (Item 2) [Figure 50-140- 4] from the cab. Remove the hinges (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-4] from the cab. Installation: Install the hinges (Item 1) on the cab and use the bolts and nuts (Item 2) [Figure 50-140-4] to secure the hinges. Tighten to 9,6 - 10,7 N•m (85 - 90 in- lb) torque. P-85781A 1 2 P-85588A 1 P-85589A 2 3 P-85828 1 2 2 1 1 P-85837 50-140-2 S650 Service Manual CAB DOOR (CONT’D) Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-140-5 Remove the nuts (Items 1 and 2) and the wiper arms (Item 3) [Figure 50-140-5]. Installation: Tighten the nut (Item 1) to 20 - 24 N•m (177 - 212 in-lb) torque and nut (Item 2) to 9 - 11 N•m (80 - 97 in-lb) torque. Remove the wiper motor shaft nut (Item 4) [Figure 50- 140-5]. Installation: Tighten the nut (Item 4) to 9,9 - 14 N•m (88 - 124 in-lb) torque. Remove the door from the loader. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-140-1.) Figure 50-140-6 Remove the three tie straps (Item 1) and the wiper motor assembly cover (Item 2) [Figure 50-140-6]. Figure 50-140-7 Remove the three bolts (Item 1) and the wiper motor assembly (Item 2) [Figure 50-140-7]. Figure 50-140-8 Remove the bolt (Item 1), the latch (Item 2), and spring (Item 3) [Figure 50-140-8]. Remove the two nuts and bolts (Item 4) [Figure 50-140- 8]. Installation: Tighten the nuts (Item 4) to 31 - 34 N•m (270 - 300 in-lb) torque. P-85829 3 1 2 4 P-85841 2 1 1 1 P-85834 2 1 1 1 P-85835 1 2 4 3 4 50-140-3 S650 Service Manual CAB DOOR (CONT’D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 50-140-9 Remove the bolt (Item 1), the latch (Item 2), and spring (Item 3) [Figure 50-140-9]. Remove the two nuts and bolts (Item 4) [Figure 50-140- 9]. Installation: Tighten the nuts (Item 4) to 31 - 34 N•m (270 - 300 in-lb) torque. Figure 50-140-10 Disconnect the harness (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-10]. Remove the two bolts (Item 2), and the latch assembly (Item 3) from the cab door [Figure 50-140-10]. Remove the glass from the frame. Aligning Figure 50-140-11 Figure 50-140-12 When the striker or latch is NOT adjusted properly there will be a gap (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-11] between the door and the cab or the striker and the latch. If adjustment is needed. (See Adjusting on Page 50-140- 4.) When the striker or latch is adjusted properly there will be no gap (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-12] between the door and the cab or the striker and the latch. After verifying alignment check for proper operation. (See Checking Operation on Page 50-140-4.) P-85836 1 2 4 4 3 P-85830A 1 2 3 2 P-85832A 1 WRONG P-85839A 1 WRONG P-85833A 1 CORRECT P-85838A 1 CORRECT 50-140-4 S650 Service Manual CAB DOOR (CONT’D) Adjusting Figure 50-140-13 Loosen the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-13] and adjust the latch as needed. Figure 50-140-14 Loosen the striker and adjust as needed (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-14]. After adjusting the striker and latch recheck the alignment of the door sensor. (See Aligning on Page 50- 140-3.) Checking Operation Figure 50-140-15 Sit in operator’s seat. Turn key ON, lower seat bar and close the door. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button (Item 1) [Figure 50-140-15]. Open the door. The LIFT & TILT VALVE light (Item 2) [Figure 50-140-15] will flash, an audible tone will sound, and the message [DOOR] will appear in the display. Close the door and the LIFT & TILT VALVE light (Item 2) [Figure 50-140-15] will go out and the display will return to machine hours. P-85830 1 1 P-85831 1 P-85413 2 1 50-150-1 S650 Service Manual ARMREST Description The armrests are located on each side of the seat. They are adjustable for comfort. Figure 50-150-1 Adjustable armrests (Item 1) [Figure 50-150-1]. P-90837 1 50-150-2 S650 Service Manual ARMREST (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Slide the seat and the backrest all the way forward. Remove the seat belt (See Seat Belt Removal And Installation on Page 50-31-2.) Figure 50-150-2 Remove the two nuts and bolts (Item 1) [Figure 50-150- 2]. Figure 50-150-3 Remove the tie strap (Item 1) and disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 2) [Figure 50-150-3]. Remove the nut (Item 3) [Figure 50-150-3]. Remove the armrest (Item 4) [Figure 50-150-3] from the seat. Figure 50-150-4 Remove the top spacer (Item 1) and the bottom spacer (Item 2) [Figure 50-150-4] from the seat. Repeat for the other side. P-90835 1 P-90836 1 2 3 4 P-90845 1 2 50-150-3 S650 Service Manual ARMREST (CONT’D) Disassembly And Assembly Remove the Joystick. (See Joystick Removal And Installation on Page 50-112-2.) Remove the armrest. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-150-2.) Figure 50-150-5 Lift up on one edge and remove armrest cover (Item 1) [Figure 50-150-5]. Figure 50-150-6 Remove the two bolts and washers (Item 1) and the armrest shell (Item 2) [Figure 50-150-6]. Figure 50-150-7 Remove the two washers (Item 1) [Figure 50-150-7]. Figure 50-150-8 Remove the two nuts and bolts (Item 1) and the support tube (Item 2) [Figure 50-150-8]. P-90838 1 P-90839 2 1 1 P-90840 1 1 P-90841 2 1 50-150-4 S650 Service Manual ARMREST (CONT’D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 50-150-9 Figure 50-150-10 Remove the nut (Item 1), washer (Item 2), and the plastic washer (Item 3) [Figure 50-150-9] and [Figure 50-150- 10]. Remove the spacer (Item 4), plastic washer (Item 5), and the bolt (Item 6) [Figure 50-150-10]. Installation: Tighten the nut to 21 - 23 N•m (180 - 200 in- lb) torque. Figure 50-150-11 Remove the two nuts (Item 1) and the slide rail (Item 2) [Figure 50-150-11] from the armrest mount. Repeat for the other side. P-90842 1 2 3 P-90843 1 2 3 4 5 6 P-90844 2 1 1 50-160-1 S650 Service Manual LEFT SIDE LOWER PANEL Removal And Installation Raise the operator’s cab. Figure 50-160-1 Remove the five plastic rivets (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-1]. Remove the seat. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-30-1.) Remove the 3-Point seat belt retractor (If equipped). (See 3-Point Seat Belt Removal And Installation on Page 50-31-4.) Lower the operator’s cab. NOTE: With the seat removed, the cab may raise. Figure 50-160-2 Remove the storage compartment (Item 1) (if equipped) [Figure 50-160-3] from the left side lower panel. Figure 50-160-3 Disconnect the wiper washer pump (Item 1) (if equipped) [Figure 50-160-3] from the left side lower panel. Figure 50-160-4 Remove three plastic screws and the anchors (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-4] from the left side lower panel. P-90897 1 1 1 1 1 P-90867 1 P-90856 1 P-90863 1 P-90856 1 1 1 50-160-2 S650 Service Manual LEFT SIDE LOWER PANEL (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-160-5 Remove the three plastic rivets and anchors (Item 1) and the screw (Item 2) [Figure 50-160-5]. Figure 50-160-6 Remove the two screws (Item 1) and the plastic rivet (Item 2) [Figure 50-160-6]. Figure 50-160-7 Disconnect the hose (if equipped) (Item 1) and remove the hose (Item 2) [Figure 50-160-7] from the panel. Figure 50-160-8 Pull the left side lower panel (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-8] rear out and away from the side of the cab. NOTE: Pull the left side lower panel away from the side of the cab far enough to access the wire harness. P-90855 1 1 1 2 P-90857 2 1 1 P-90858 1 2 P-90852 1 50-160-3 S650 Service Manual LEFT SIDE LOWER PANEL (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-160-9 Disconnect the HVAC or radio wire harnesses (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-9] (if equipped). Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-160-10 Press the four tabs (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-10] and remove the HVAC control out of the left side lower panel. Figure 50-160-11 NOTE: If the three clips (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-11] are removed the cup holder will need to be replaced. P-90859 1 1 1 1 P-90860 1 1 1 1 1 P-90865 1 50-160-4 S650 Service Manual LEFT SIDE LOWER PANEL (CONT’D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 50-160-12 Remove the four screws (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-12] and remove the speaker from the left side lower panel. Figure 50-160-13 Remove the three screws (Item 1) [Figure 50-160-13] and remove the washer tank from the left side lower panel. P-90866 1 1 1 1 P-90864 1 50-170-1 S650 Service Manual RIGHT SIDE LOWER PANEL Removal And Installation Raise the operator’s cab. Figure 50-170-1 Remove the five plastic rivets (Item 1) [Figure 50-170-1]. Remove the seat. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-30-1.) Lower the operator’s cab. NOTE: With the seat removed, the cab may raise. Figure 50-170-2 Remove the three plastic screws and the anchors (Item 1) [Figure 50-170-2] from the right side lower panel. Figure 50-170-3 Remove the three plastic rivets and anchors (Item 1) and the screw (Item 2) [Figure 50-170-3]. Figure 50-170-4 Remove the two screws (Item 1) and the plastic rivet (Item 2) [Figure 50-170-4]. P-90897 1 1 1 1 1 P-90869 1 1 1 P-90870 1 1 1 2 P-90871 2 1 1 50-170-2 S650 Service Manual RIGHT SIDE LOWER PANEL (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 50-170-5 Pull the right side lower panel (Item 1) [Figure 50-170-5] rear out and away from the side of the cab. NOTE: Pull the right side lower panel away from the side of the cab far enough to access the wire harness. Figure 50-170-6 Disconnect the wire harnesses (Item 1) and the antenna (Item 2) [Figure 50-170-6] (if equipped with radio). NOTE: Install the right side lower panel with the radio removed to assist in connecting the power port wire. Disassembly And Assembly Figure 50-170-7 Remove the plastic nut and the lock washer (Item 1) [Figure 50-170-7] from power port and remove the power port from the right side lower panel. NOTE: The power port lock washer must be replaced with a new when it has been removed. Figure 50-170-8 Depress the tab (Item 1) [Figure 50-170-8] and remove the radio from the right side lower panel. Installation: Insert a screwdriver into the slot (Item 2) [Figure 50-170-8] to lock the tab into place. P-90872 1 P-90873 1 2 1 1 P-90879 1 P-90881 P-90877 2 1 50-170-3 S650 Service Manual RIGHT SIDE LOWER PANEL (CONT’D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 50-170-9 Remove the nut, washer, and cover, (Item 1) [Figure 50- 170-9] from the input. Remove the input from the right side lower panel. Figure 50-170-10 Remove the four screws (Item 1) [Figure 50-170-10] and remove the speaker from the right side lower panel. P-90875 1 P-90876 1 1 1 1 50-170-4 S650 Service Manual 50-180-1 S650 Service Manual HEADLINER Removal And Installation Figure 50-180-1 Remove the two screws (Item 1) and the rear shelf (Item 2) [Figure 50-180-1] (if equipped). NOTE: The rear shelf has two panel clips on the underneath side, lift vertically to disengage. Installation: Tighten the screws to 2,3 N•m (20 in-lb) torque. Figure 50-180-2 Remove the air duct (Item 1) [Figure 50-180-2] (if equipped). Figure 50-180-3 Remove the air duct (Item 1) [Figure 50-180-3] (if equipped). Remove the cab light (if equipped). (See Cab Light Removal And Installation on Page 60-60-2.) Figure 50-180-4 Remove the four retainers (Item 1) and remove the headliner (Item 2) [Figure 50-180-4]. Installation: Route the cab light wire harness in the grove on the topside of the headliner (if equipped with HVAC). NOTE: Replace the retainers if needed. P-90893 1 1 2 P-90894 1 P-90895 1 P-90896 1 1 1 1 2 50-180-2 S650 Service Manual 60-01 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM & ANALYSIS ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-1 Glossary Of Electrical Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-1 Standard Cab Harness Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-4 Deluxe Cab Harness Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-5 Mainframe Harness Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-6 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-7 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-8 Fuse And Relay Location / Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-9 Solenoid Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-10-12 BATTERY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-20-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-20-1 Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-20-2 Using A Booster Battery (Jump Starting) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-20-3 ALTERNATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-1 Belt Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-1 Belt Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-1 Charging System Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-2 Alternator Voltage Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-3 Low Voltage Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-3 High Voltage Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-4 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-5 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-30-6 STARTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-40-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-40-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-40-1 Parts Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-40-2 INSTRUMENT PANELS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-1 Left Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-1 Display Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-3 Right Panel (Standard Key Panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-4 Right Panel (Keyless Start Panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-5 Right Panel (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-6 Left Switch Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-8 Right Switch Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-8 Left Panel Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-9 Right Panel (Standard Key Panel) Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-9 Right Panel (Keyless Start Panel) Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-10 Right Panel (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . 60-50-10 Key Switch Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-50-11 Alarm Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-50-11 Left Switch Panel Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-12 Right Switch Panel Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-50-12 60-02 S650 Service Manual LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-60-1 Front Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-60-1 Rear Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-60-2 Cab Light Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-60-2 BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-70-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-70-1 Connector Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-70-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-70-8 BOBCAT CONTROLLER (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-71-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-71-1 Connector And Wire Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-71-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-71-3 BOBCAT CONTROLLER (SJC) (DRIVE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-72-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-72-1 Connector Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-72-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-72-4 SPEED SENSORS (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-80-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-80-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-80-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-80-3 DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-90-1 Viewing Service Codes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-90-1 Service Codes List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-90-2 BOBCAT INTERLOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (BICS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-1 Inspecting The BICS (Engine STOPPED - Key ON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-2 Inspecting Deactivation Of The Auxiliary Hydraulics System (Engine STOPPED - Key ON) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-2 Inspecting The Seat Bar Sensor (Engine RUNNING) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-2 Inspecting The Traction Lock (Engine RUNNING) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-2 Inspecting The Lift Arm Bypass Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-2 Inspecting Deactivation Of Lift And Tilt Functions (ACS And SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-2 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-100-3 SEAT BAR SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-110-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-110-1 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-110-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-110-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-110-3 Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS) Circuit Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-110-4 60-03 S650 Service Manual TRACTION LOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-120-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-120-1 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-120-2 Inspecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-120-3 CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-1 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-2 Handle Sensor Connector Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-3 Switch Handle Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-4 Switch Handle Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-6 Actuator Connector Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-9 Handle Lock Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-10 Handle Lock Solenoid Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-10 Foot Sensor Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-130-11 Foot Sensor Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-12 Foot Sensor Lock Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-130-12 ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-140-1 Identification Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-140-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-140-2 Identification Chart ACD Group 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-140-3 Identification Chart ACD Group 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-140-4 Identification Chart ACD Group 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-140-5 Identification Chart ACD Group 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-140-6 ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-141-1 Identification Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-141-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-141-2 Identification Chart ACD Group 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-141-3 Identification Chart ACD Group 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-141-4 Identification Chart ACD Group 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-141-5 Identification Chart ACD Group 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-141-6 ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-142-1 Identification Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-142-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-142-2 Identification Chart ACD Group 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-142-3 Identification Chart ACD Group 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-142-4 Identification Chart ACD Group 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-142-5 Identification Chart ACD Group 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-142-6 SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-150-1 Connecting Remote Start Tool . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-150-1 Connecting Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-150-1 60-04 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-160-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-160-1 Actuator Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-160-1 Lift And Tilt Calibration (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-160-4 Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-160-6 Lift And Tilt Calibration (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-160-11 STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-161-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-161-1 Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-161-1 FLYWHEEL RPM SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-170-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-170-1 Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-170-2 CONTROL PANEL SETUP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-180-1 Right Panel Setup (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-180-1 PASSWORD SETUP (DELUXE INSTRUMENTATION PANEL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-190-1 Password Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-190-1 Changing The Owner Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-190-1 Changing The User Passwords . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-190-2 Password Lockout Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-190-2 PASSWORD SETUP (KEYLESS START PANEL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-191-1 Password Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-191-1 Changing The Owner Password . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-191-1 Password Lockout Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-191-1 MAINTENANCE CLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-200-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-200-1 Setup . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-200-2 Reset . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-200-5 BACK-UP ALARM SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-1 Inspecting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-1 Adjusting Switch Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-2 Troubleshooting (Standard And ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-3 Troubleshooting (Joystick) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-4 Alarm Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-5 Switch Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-210-5 FRONT HORN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-220-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-220-1 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET C101 FUEL SHUTOFF SOLENOID 3 6 C421 TILT SPOOL LOCK 3 10 FC1 FUSE CENTER 1 3 C103 TAILGATE 8 4,10,11,13 C422 LIFT SPOOL LOCK 3 10 FC2 FUSE CENTER 2 3 C104 ENGINE COOLANT SENSOR 2 6 C423 BUCKET POSITION 2 13 FRC1 FUSE RELAY CENTER 3,6,7,11,12 C105 HYD CHARGE PRESSURE 3 7 C425 BRAKE SOLENOID 3 7 C106 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR 2 6 C426 CAN (Remote Start Tool, ACD) 7 5 C107 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE 3 6 C434-1 LEFT WORKLIGHT 1 2 11 C108 HYD TEMPERATURE SENDER 2 7 C434-2 LEFT WORKLIGHT 2 2 11 T1 BATT GROUND 4 C109 S/R ADAPTER HARNESS 2 6 C435-1 RIGHT WORKLIGHT 1 2 11 T2 BUZZER GROUND 8 C110 ALTERNATOR 2 6 C435-2 RIGHT WORKLIGHT 2 2 11 T3 FLASHER 13 C112 HYD OIL FILTER SWITCH 2 7 C437 TWO SPEED MAKEUP 2 7 T6 BATT GROUND 4 C126 HORN 2 13 C441 TWO SPEED 2 7 T8 BATT GROUND 4 C129 ACCESSORY 3 9 C446 HYDRAULIC FAN 2 7 T13 BUZZER POWER 8 C209 DOME LIGHT 3 9 C449 LEFT JOYSTICK 4 5 T14 PRE HEATER 6 C212 POWER SOCKET 2 9 C450 RIGHT JOYSTICK 4 5 T15 RIGHT REAR WORK LIGHT(+) 11 C250 DOOR SENSOR 2 9 C479 LEFT PANEL(BLACK) 12 5,8 T16 RIGHT REAR WORK LIGHT(-) 11 C251 WIPER 5 9 C480 LEFT PANEL(GRAY) 12 8 T17 LEFT REAR WORK LIGHT (+) 11 C252 WASHER 2 9 C482 SEATBAR SENSOR 3 9 T18 LEFT REAR WORK LIGHT (-) 11 C277 AIR RIDE SEAT 6 9 C483 TEMP CONTROL SWITCH 3 12 T19 BACKUP ALARM 10 C278 RIGHT SPEAKER 2 9 C486 AC COMPRESSOR 2 12 T20 BACKUP ALARM (GND) 10 C279 LEFT SPEAKER 2 9 C489 ACCESSORY 2 3,4 C308 BRAKE SOLENOID 2 7 C499 PTOL 4 8 C350 AC EVAPORATOR SWITCH 2 12 C500 RH KEY SWITCH 6 8 C355 DLX or STD FUEL HARNESS 6 6,12,13 C503 RH DLX PANEL 6 5,8 C362 REAR AUX SOLENOID 8 7 C602 LEFT REAR TAIL LIGHT 2 11 C404 BACKUP ALARM 2 3,10 C603 RIGHT REAR TAIL LIGHT 2 11 C405 AIR FILTER SWITCH 2 6 C606 POWER BOBTACH OPEN 2 13 C406 FUEL SENDER 2 6 C607 POWER BOBTACH CLOSE 2 13 C408 CAB CONNECTOR 48 3-5, 8-13 C611 BLOWER MOTOR 4 12 C409 RIGHT HANDLE 10 10 C630 THERMOSTAT 3 12 SW1 BRAKE SWITCH 9 C410 LEFT HANDLE 10 10 C635 HEATER VALVE 6 12 SW2 BEACON SWITCH 13 C411 LEFT HANDLE 5 WAY 5 10,13 C667 DOOR KIT 6 9 SW3 HAZARD SWITCH 13 C412 HANDLE(HORN) 2 10,13 C670 EXTERIOR BEACON 6 13 SW4 HAND/FOOT, H/ISO SWITCH 9 C413 REAR ROD 2 7 C676 RADIO 6 9 SW5 POWER BOBTACH SWITCH 13 C414 REAR BASE 2 7 SW6 BUCKET POSITION SWITCH 13 C415 HIGH FLOW SOLENOID 2 7 SW8 FRONT WIPER SWITCH 9 C416 DIVERTER SOLENOID 2 7 SW9 TRAVEL CONTROL SWITCH 8 C417 REAR AUX RELIEF 2 7 J1A GATEWAY COTROLLER 34 SW10 BLOWER SWITCH 12 C418 FRONT ROD 2 7 J1B GATEWAY CONTOLLER 26 SW11 AC SWITCH 12 C419 FRONT BASE 2 7 J2A AUX CONTROLLER 34 C420 HYD LOCK 2 7 J2B AUX CONTROLLER 26 WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 1 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. J1 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS(GATEWAY CONTROLLER) PIN FUNCTION PIN FUNCTION A-1 HYDRAULIC LOCK RETURN B-1 HYD CHARGE PRESS A-2 LIFT SPOOL LOCK RETURN B-2 UNSW BATT A-3 FUEL PULL RELAY B-3 UNSW BATT A-4 SWITCHED POWER OUT RELAY B-4 FUEL HOLD A-5 LIGHT 1 RELAY B-5 LIFT SPOOL LOCK A-6 GLOW PLUG RELAY B-6 TRACTION LOCK HOLD A-7 STARTER RELAY B-7 TILT SPOOL LOCK A-8 TRACTION PULL RELAY B-8 CAN LO 1 A-9 FAN 1 RELAY B-9 CAN HI 1 A-10 TILT SPOOL LOCK RETURN B-10 SPOOL LOCK SENSOR 2 A-11 SPARE DIGITAL, ECU SINKS B-11 SEAT BAR A-12 SPARE DIGITAL, ECU SOURCES B-12 FUEL LEVEL A-13 TRACTION PULL RELAY FDBK B-13 BICS HYD LOCK HOLD A-14 GLOW PLUG RELAY FDBK B-14 CAN HI 2 A-15 ENGINE SPEED B-15 GROUND P1 A-16 AIR FILTER SWITCH B-16 GROUND P2 A-17 LIGHT 2 RELAY B-17 GROUND P3, SENSOR A-18 FAN 2 RELAY B-18 ENGINE COOLANT TEMP A-19 PTOL LED B-19 FAN 2 OUTPUT A-20 PTOL SWITCH B-20 CAN LO 2 A-21 SWITCHED POWER OUT RELAY FDBK B-21 REMOTE KEY A-22 STATER RELAY FDBK B-22 RUN/ENTER A-23 HYD OIL FILTER SW2 B-23 SENSOR SUPPLY 8V A-24 START ENGINE B-24 SENSOR SUPPLY 5V A-25 ENGINE OIL PRESS B-25 TWO SPEED MAKEUP A-26 SPARE B-26 TWO SPEED COIL A-27 SPARE A-28 LIGHT 2 RELAY FDBK A-29 FAN 1 RELAY FDBK A-30 FUEL PULL RELAY FDBK A-31 LIGHT 1 RELAY FDBK A-32 HYD OIL TEMP A-33 SPARE ANALOG A-34 HYD OIL FILTER SW1 J2 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS(AUXILLIARY CONTROLLER) PIN FUNCTION PIN FUNCTION A-1 FRONT AUX (F) RETURN B-1 A-2 REAR AUX (F) RETURN B-2 UNSW BATT A-3 LEFT BLINKER RELAY B-3 UNSW BATT A-4 RIGHT BLINKER RELAY B-4 DIVERTED SOLENOID A-5 HORN RELAY B-5 REAR AUX (F) A-6 B-6 RELIEF SOLENOID A-7 OUTPUT SPARE B-7 REAR AUX (M) A-8 B-8 CAN LO 1 A-9 B-9 CAN HI 1 A-10 REAR AUX (M) RETURN B-10 A-11 LH PADDLE RIGHT B-11 A-12 LH PADDLE LEFT B-12 A-13 RH RIGHT BUTTON UP B-13 FRONT AUX (F) A-14 DIGITAL INPUT SPARE B-14 CAN HI 2 A-15 B-15 GROUND A-16 B-16 GROUND A-17 B-17 HANDLE POT GND A-18 FRONT AUX (M) RETURN B-18 RH PVM POT SIGNAL A-19 B-19 FRONT AUX (M) A-20 LH FLOAT BUTTON B-20 CAN LO 2 A-21 HYDRAULIC DETENT B-21 RH TRIGGER A-22 LH RIGHT BUTTON DOWN B-22 SWITCHED POWER A-23 RH CENTER BUTTON B-23 HANDLE POT POWER A-24 DIGITAL INPUT SPARE B-24 A-25 B-25 BUCKET POSITION (SPARE) A-26 HIGH FLOW RETURN B-26 HIGH FLOW A-27 BUCKET POSITION(SPARE) RETURN A-28 LH RIGHT BUTTON A-29 RH RIGHT BUTTON DOWN A-30 RH LEFT UP A-31 RH LEFT DOWN A-32 A-33 A-34 DIGITAL INPUT SPARE HARNESS PART NUMBER MAIN FRAME 7174782 STD CAB 7165991 DLX CAB 7176098 DLX FUEL 7175293 STD FUEL 7149219 DOOR 7155024 S/R 6733370 TAILGATE DOM 7175271 TAILGATE EUR 7175287 2 SPD ADP 7159366 BACKUP ALARM 7175017 BRAKE ADAPTER 7165061 WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 2 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. 25 A FC2 FUSE 2 25 A FRC1 FUSE 11 20 A FRC1 FUSE 10 15 A FRC1 FUSE 9 POWER SWITCHED 85 86 30 87 1760/RNG/WHT C489 A 1040/RED 1070/RED 30 A FRC1 FUSE 5 30 A FRC 1 FUSE 6 MEGAFUSE 100.0 Amps 1010/RED BATTERY BATT_CABLE 1110/RED/WHT 1130/RED/WHT 1790/RNG/WHT 1310/RED 1050/RED 1050/RED SHEET 6 2055/BLK 1300/RED 1060/RED 1030/RED 8000/TAN C408 17 C408 43 1660/RNG/WHT 1340/RED 1120/RED/WHT 1450/RED/WHT 1150/RED/WHT 1180/RED/WHT J2B 2 J2B 3 J1B 3 J1B 2 J1A 4 SHEET 12 1450/RED/WHT 1660/RNG/WHT 1785/RNG/WHT SHEET 5 SHEET 5 SHEET 9 25 A FC1 FUSE 2 1160/RED/WHT1025/RED 25 A FC1 FUSE 1 SHEET 6 SHEET 6 1830/RNG/WHT 1840/RNG/WHT SHEET 13 SHEET 8 1440/RED/WHT SHEET 8 1420/RED/WHT 15 A FRC1 FUSE 3 1795/RNG/WHT SHEET 9 1400/RED/WHT 15 A FC2 FUSE 4 25 A FRC1 FUSE1 25 A FRC1 FUSE 2 25 A FRC1 FUSE 8 5 A FRC1 FUSE 4 25 A FRC1 FUSE 7 SHEET 8 1940/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1620/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1930/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1950/RNG/WHT SHEET 9 1775/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1960/RNG/WHT POWER C408 6 1920/RNG/WHT 1920/RNG/WHT SHEET 13 1460/RED/WHT 25 A FC2 FUSE 1 SHEET 12 2030/BLK C404 B 1410/RED/WHT 1490/RED/WHT 1190/RED SHEET 10 1570/RNG/WHT 1765/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 SHEET 8 1590/RNG/WHT 1240/RED/WHT 1290/RED WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SHEET 9 1580/RNG/WHT SHEET 9 1370/RED/WHT SHEET 9 1850/RNG/WHT SHEET 13 1550/RNG/WHT SHEET 5 1165/RED/WHT SHEET 5 1730/RNG/WHT SHEET 7 1360/RED/WHT SHEET 6 1350/RED/WHT SHEET 12 1140/RED/WHT SHEET 11 1320/RED/WHT SHEET 11 1330/RED/WHT SHEET 6 SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 1780/RNG/WHT1750/RNG/WHT 1720/RNG/WHT WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 3 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. C489 B SHEET 6 3800/LBL SHEET 5 SHEET 9 2790/BLK 2390/BLK SHEET 7 SHEET 9 3910/LBL 3410/LBL 2900/BLK C103 B 2600/BLK SHEET 7 2720/BLK 2000/BLK 2200/BLK T1 BATT GND SHEET 12 2745/BLK SHEET 7 3310/LBL SHEET 6 3510/LBL SHEET 6 3110/LBL T8 BATT GND 2110/BLK SHEET 11 SHEET 13 SHEET 9 2765/BLK 2780/BLK 2730/BLK T6 BATT GND 2500/BLK 3010/LBL 2510/BLK SHEET 6 3710/LBL 2300/BLK2710/BLK SHEET 13 2741/BLK 2540/BLK 2550/BLK SHEET 7 2480/BLK J2B 15 J2B 16 SHEET 7 2450/BLK J1B 15 J1B 16 J1B 17 2900/BLK C408 42 SHEET 8 SHEET 5 2920/BLK SHEET 11 2070/BLK SHEET 5 2080/BLK SHEET 13 2830/BLK SHEET 8 2940/BLK SHEET 8 2960/BLK SHEET 9 2930/BLK SHEET 8 2700/BLK GROUND SHEET 13 2751/BLK C408 32 2950/BLK 2950/BLK SHEET 13 2785/BLK SHEET 7 3530/LBL 2090/BLK SHEET 8 2250/BLK 2600/BLK SHEET 10 2650/BLK SHEET 11 2640/BLK SHEET 11 2610/BLK SHEET 11 2620/BLK SHEET 11 2630/BLK WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 SHEET6 2810/BLK WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 4 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. FF EE GG DD BB AA SHEET 4 2710/BLK 9400/PUR 9500/PUR/WHT 9600/PUR C426 C408 7 C408 8 9120/PUR/WHT 9220/PUR J2B 9 J2B 8 J1B 8 J1B 9 J1B 14 J1B 20 J1B 21 C479 3 C479 4 C503 2 C503 4 9530/PUR/WHT9130/PUR/WHT 9630/PUR9230/PUR 4 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 2070/BLK 2080/BLK 1830/RNG/WHT 1840/RNG/WHT 9640/PUR 9540/PUR/WHT C450 C449 SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 9650/PUR 9550/PUR/WHT 9260/PUR 9160/PUR/WHT 9230/PUR 9130/PUR/WHT 9240/PUR 9250/PUR 9140/PUR/WHT 9150/PUR/WHT CAN BUS 9200/PUR 9100/PUR/WHT RESISTOR 120 OHM RESISTOR 120 OHM 9660/PUR 9560/PUR/WHT 9270/PUR 9170/PUR/WHT SHEET 3 1165/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1730/RNG/WHT CC WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 # CONNECTOR DOES NOT EXIST IN 7165991 # # CAN (Remote Start Tool, ACD) RIGHT JOYSTICK LEFT JOYSTICK LEFT PANEL RH DLX PANEL AUX CTRLR GWY CTRLR WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 5 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. SHEET 4 SHEET 4 C A B 3520/LBL 3510/LBL 3600/LBL 3800/LBL STARTER 85 86 30 87 8200/TAN 8250/TAN PULL FUEL 85 86 30 87 A B C 8800/TAN PLUG GLOW 85 86 30 87 8500/TAN A3700/LBL B3710/LBL C110 T14 PRE HEATER 2016/BLK 8510/TAN 8550/TAN 8110/TAN 8150/TAN 8210/TAN 3200/LBL SHEET 4 SHEET 4 L S 1020/RED 1015/RED A B 3210/LBL 2015/BLK B A ENGINE SPEED SENSOR 3610/LBL SWITCH AIR FILTER SENSOR (500-3000 OHM) ENGINE COOLANT SENDER (0.5 ~ 4.5V) ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SOLENOID FUEL SHUTOFF 2800 BLK 8800 TAN 8100 TAN C101 24.5 OHM 0.33 OHM C405 M S R STARTER G ALTERNATOR C104 B EXCITATION PULL HOLD 8100/TAN8120/TAN 2800/BLK J1B 4 J1B 12 J1B 18 J1A 22 J1A 15 J1A 16 J1A 25 J1A 14 J1A 6 J1A 30 J1A 3 J1A 7 D5 A B C109 8250/TAN 8200/TAN SHEET 3 1060/RED SHEET 3 1030/RED SHEET 12 2005/BLK SHEET 7 2025/BLK 15 A FRC1 FUSE 12 ENGINE SHEET 12 1815/RNG/WHT A B SHEET 3 2055/BLK 3110/LBL 3110/LBL 3100/LBL 3100/LBL C355 D C355 C SHEET 9 3500/LBL WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SHEET 3 1350/RED/WHT 1800/RNG/WHT C106 SIG GND SIG GND +5V PWR SIG GND C107 C406 GND SIG SHEET 3 B SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 SIG GND FUEL SENDER SHEET4 2810/BLK WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 6 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. LOCK TRACTION 85 86 30 87 B C A SHEET 4 2200/BLK 4200/LGN 4150/LGN 4110/LGN A C B 3400/LBL 3420/LBL 3410/LBL A B 4410/LGN 2410/BLK SHEET 4 A C112 B A3300/LBL 3310/LBL 3430/LBL B 1 2 4010/LGN 2910/BLK B A4200/RED 2200/BLK 0.5-7.5V PRESSURE CHARGE HYDRAULIC HARN BRAKE ADAPTER 7165061 9.8 OHM 12V HYD LOCK SOLENOID 12 V 9.8 OHM SOLENOID BRAKE C425 12 V 7.2 OHM FAN SOLENOID HYDRAULIC C105 C446 C420 C108 C308 TRACK MACHINES B C A C425 HYDRAULIC TEMPERATURE SENDER 500 - 3000 OHM 2 1 C441 2350/BLK TWO SPEED SOLENOID 4350/LGN 1 2 4340/LGN 2340/BLK 4430/LGN 4440/LGN 4450/LGN 4480/LGN 1 2 4330/LGN 2330/BLK B A4460/LGN 3.3 OHM PWM FRONT ROD SOLENOID (MALE) 3.3 OHM PWM FRONT BASE SOLENOID (FEMALE) 12 V 7.5 OHM SOLENOID OPTIONAL HIGH FLOW C415 C419 C418 2 2 1 2440/BLK 1 2430/BLK 7.5 OHM 12V MALE COUPLER DIRECTIONAL SOLENOID OPTIONAL REAR AUX 7.5 OHM 12V FEMALE COUPLER DIRECTIONAL SOLENOID OPTIONAL REAR AUX C413 C414 1 2 2 1 2450/BLK 7.5 OHM 12 V SOLENOID MALE COUPLER BLEED / LOCK VALVE OPTIONAL REAR AUX SOLENOID FEMALE COUPLER BLEED / LOCK VALVE OPTIONAL REAR AUX C417 C416 2480/BLK SHEET 4 2460/BLK J2B 13 J2B 19 J2B 26 J2B 5 J2B 7 J2B 4 J2B 6 J2A 2 J2A 10 J2A 1 J2A 18 J2A 26 B A D C F E H G 4480/LGN 2480/BLK 2450/BLK 4450/LGN 4430/LGN 2430/BLK 2440/BLK 4440/LGN C362 SHEET 4 J1B 6 J1B 13 J1B 19 J1B 26 J1B 1 J1B 23 J1A 18 J1A 1 J1A 32 J1A 34 J1A 13 J1A 8 2 1 C437 MAKEUP SOLENOID TWO SPEED J1B 25 4360/LGN 2360/BLK J1A 27 J1A 26 HYDRAULICS SHEET 11 2035/BLK +8V SHEET 6 2025/BLK 4100/LGN SHEET 4 3530/LBL SHEET 3 1360/RED/WHT WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 HYDRAULIC FILTER SWITCH WHEEL MACHINES 0.3 OHM 10.9 OHM HOLD PULL TRACTION LOCK WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 7 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. 9350/PUR C408 4 C408 40 C408 1 C408 37 9370/PUR 9380/PUR 9360/PUR J1B 22 J1A 24 J1A 20 J1A 19 22 1212 C480 C479 8 C479 7 C479 10 C479 9 C479 11 C479 1 C479 2 C479 5 2920/BLK T2 BUZZER (-) 1940/RNG/WHT 9320/PUR T13 BUZZER (+) 4730/LGN 2700/BLK GROUND Left Blinker Input Battery (+) Right Blinker Input Travel Control Input Switched Power BUZZER Park Break Output Reserved Output 5 Park Break Input 1960/RNG/WHT SWITCH (OPTIONAL) TRAVEL CONTROL SW9 1 2 3 4 5 6 1440/RED/WHT 1620/RNG/WHT 11 22 33 44 C499 SWITCH POWER PTOL OUTPUT PTOL LED GROUND 9380/PUR 9370/PUR 1930/RNG/WHT 2940/BLK 2960/BLK 1950/RNG/WHT 44 11 55 33 22 C500 RUN/ENTER SW START Switched Power Battery (+) GROUND 1420/RED/WHT SHEET 4 SHEET 3 SHEET 3 SHEET 9 4750/LGN SHEET 3 SHEET 3 SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 9360/PUR 9350/PUR SHEET 13 SHEET 13 6550/PNK 6450/PNK CAB DISPLAY 2250/BLK 1590/RNG/WHT C503 1 C503 5 C503 3 Switched Power Battery (+) GROUND 1240/RED/WHT SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 SHEET 9 9310/PUR SHEET 9 4500/LGN WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 66 LEFT PANEL (BLACK) RH KEY SWITCH RH DLX PANEL LEFT PANEL (GRAY) PTOL (Press To Operate Loader) WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 8 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. SHEET 4 3920/LBL 3910/LBL 3900/LBL 2790/BLK C408 24 C408 44 C408 45 C408 46 C408 33 C408 23 SHEET 4 2730/BLK 3930/LBL SHEET 4 J1B 11 BRAKE SWITCH SW1 2 1 3 5 6 4 2930/BLK C408 5 C408 3 C408 2 1775/RNG/WHT 2 5 6 4 3 1 2840/BLK C667 SWITCH FRONT WIPER SW8 2 1 3 5 4 6 C408 27 7330/WHT 7300/WHT 7310/WHT BB AA 22 11 1390/RED/WHT1370/RED/WHT 2010/BLK2790/BLK 2840/BLK C B A C251 X L C252 MOTOR WIPER PARK LOW GND MOTOR WASHER DOOR SENSOR 2730/BLK 2795/BLK 1400/RED/WHT - + C212 SENSOR SHOWN WITH DOOR OPEN SWITCH (SJC, AWS) H/ISO (ACS) HAND/FOOT SW4 5 6 4 2 1 3 4550/LGN 2060/BLK C B C129 2820/BLK 1375/RED/WHT A 1210/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1785/RNG/WHT 4235/LGN 4275/LGN C 3900/LBL A B 3910/LBL 3920/LBL SENSOR SEATBAR GND SIG PWR SHEET 3 SHEET 8 1850/RNG/WHT C408 16 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 2 5 6 3 4 1 C676 1 2 1 2 C279 7830/WHT 7820/WHT 7810/WHT 7800/WHT C278 RIGHT SPEAKER LEFT SPEAKER 1865/RNG/WHT1580/RNG/WHT 1885/RNG/WHT 2885/BLK J1B 24 +5V D SW PWR E 4740/LGN 1400/RED/WHT 7310/WHT 2845/BLK 1850/RNG/WHT 1860/RNG/WHT 1570/RNG/WHT 2 1 C250 CC 4750/LGN 4740/LGN 4760/LGN 5 4 C277 1510/RNG/WHT 2210/BLK SHEET 6 3500/LBL 7165991Standard Cab Harness 7176098 Deluxe Cab Harness SHEET 8 9310/PUR SHEET 8 4500/LGN 7176098 ONLY SHEET 3 1580/RNG/WHT SHEET 3 1370/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1850/RNG/WHT C209 - + - + SEAT SOLENOID AIR RIDE C482 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT * SPLICE DOES NOT EXIST IN 7165991 * * SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACCESSORY CONN POWER SOCKET RADIO CONN DOME LIGHT WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 9 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. 2370/BLK 2380/BLK 3 14370/LGN 1 3 4380/LGN TILT SPOOL LOCK SOLENOID LIFT SPOOL LOCK SOLENOID J2B 22 J1B 7 J1B 5 J1A 2 J1A 10 1560/RNG/WHT G F B C D A E H J K 4810/LGN 4820/LGN 4830/LGN 4840/LGN 1710/RNG/WHT C410 B C E D J H 4300/LGN 4310/LGN 4920/LGN 4930/LGN 4320/LGN 4940/LGN A F G K 1590/RNG/WHT 4910/LGN C409 SKI CTRL SIDE SHIFT PWM TWO SPD DETENT FLOW SKI CTRL F G B C D A +B D -C A H J E F E H G K J K E C A D B B A HORN TURN SIGNAL J2B 23 J2B 17 J2A 22 J2A 30 J2A 31 J2B 21 J2A 13 J2B 18 J2A 28 J2A 12 J2A 11 SHEET 3 1570/RNG/WHT 2 2 C103 C C404 A 7100/WHT 7001923 BACKUP ALARM + - 7100/WHT SHEET 4 2650/BLK MANUAL CONTROLS C411 C412 C421 C422 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 T19 1 T20 1 LEFT HANDLE RIGHT HANDLE WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 10 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. LIGHTS WORK FRONT 85 86 30 87 LIGHT REAR 85 86 30 87 C103 A C103 H 6310/PNK 6000/PNK 6210/PNK 6320/PNK C408 25 C408 28 SHEET 4 2765/BLK 6230/PNK 6330/PNK 6340/PNK J1A 28 J1A 17 J1A 5 J1A 31 A B 6110/PNK A B 6120/PNK 2760/BLK 2750/BLK WORK LIGHT LEFT FRONT 50.00 Watts WORK LIGHT RIGHT FRONT 37.00 Watts 6000/PNK 2765/BLK 2045/BLK 2045/BLK SHEET 4 2000/BLK LIGHTS A B WORK LIGHT LEFT FRONT 37.00 Watts A B WORK LIGHT RIGHT FRONT 50.00 Watts 6100/PNK 6130/PNK 2735/BLK 2705/BLK SHEET 7 2035/BLK 6200/PNK 1 C603 2 WORK LIGHT RIGHT REAR TAIL LIGHT RIGHT REAR 1 C602 2 WORK LIGHT LEFT REAR TAIL LIGHT LEFT REAR 6330/PNK 6320/PNK 6200/PNK T16 1 T15 1 T18 1 T17 1 6210/PNK 6310/PNK SHEET 4 2640/BLK SHEET 4 2610/BLK SHEET 4 2620/BLK SHEET 4 2630/BLK SHEET 3 1320/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1330/RED/WHT C435-2 C435-1 C434-1 C434-2 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 11 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. HVAC 85 86 30 87 1500/RNG/WHT 2745/BLK SHEET 4 8020/TAN A B 7024/WHT C350 (AC PRESS SWITCH) EVAPORATOR J1A 21 A B C D C611 2745/BLK C408 22 1500/RNG/WHT 5 SWITCH BLOWER SW10 6 3 OFF 2 1 4 C408 21 1970/RNG/WHT 1520/RNG/WHT 7320/WHT 1900/RNG/WHT C408 34 A B C 1980/RNG/WHT C483 A D C B E F C635 1910/RNG/WHT 7220/WHT 2560/BLK 2130/BLK High14.00 Amps Med7.50 Amps Low5.00 Amps SWITCH) (TEMP CONTROL POTENTIOMETER DBL WHT BLK VALVE HEATER 12V SIG GND 2580/BLK MOTOR BLOWER A B C 3320/LBL C630 2570/BLK 7020/WHT THERMOSTAT AC SWITCH SW11 C 1 2100/BLK 3 7040/WHT SHEET 3 1790/RNG/WHT SHEET 3 2030/BLK HVAC SHEET 6 1815/RNG/WHT 2 2280/BLK 1 2290/BLK 7025/WHT D4 SHEET 13 7020/WHT 7023/WHT J1A 11 7021/WHT SHEET 6 2005/BLK C486 (COMPRESSOR) MAGNET CLUTCH SHEET 3 1140/RED/WHT WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 C355 A 7024/WHT WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 12 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. C103 D C103 E 6410/PNK 6510/PNK C408 29 C408 36 C408 15 C408 26 SHEET 4 SHEET 12 2290/BLK C408 30 C408 13 SHEET 4 2780/BLK C408 35 6500/PNK 6400/PNK BB2740/BLK AA 7030/WHT 9.8 OHM SOLENOID POSITION BUCKET OPTIONAL A B D C411 6515/PNK 6010/PNK 6415/PNK A B C126 A B 7210/WHT C412 SHEET 4 2785/BLK 1460/RED/WHT 7022/WHT SHEET 4 2741/BLK D3 6500/PNK HAZARD SWITCH SW3 5 4 6 2 1 3 6530/PNK 6400/PNK E D A C F B C670 6440/PNK 6430/PNK 6540/PNK 6540/PNK 6700/PNK 2780/BLK L X 1430/RED/WHT 1410/RED/WHT T3 FLASHER CONN 6570/PNK 6010/PNK 2725/BLK SWITCH BOBTACH POWER SW5 5 4 6 2 1 3 C408 9 C408 10 1380/RED/WHT BLINKER RIGHT BEACON STROBE BLINKER LEFT 1200/RED/WHT 2420/BLK2850/BLK D2 D1 SWITCH POSITION BUCKET SW6 2 1 3 5 6 4 1550/RNG/WHT 7022/WHT 2830/BLK (PINS 3 & 6 INTERNALLY INSULATED) 6550/PNK 6450/PNK SHEET 3 SHEET 3 1410/RED/WHT SHEET 4 OPTIONS SHEET 8 SHEET 8 A C606 B 2775/BLK B A C607 2770/BLK 7000/WHT 7010/WHT C408 38 7210/WHT 2751/BLK 2751/BLK C355 B C355 E C355 F 7010/WHT 7010/WHT 7000/WHT 7000/WHT SHEET 3 1550/RNG/WHT WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT C E SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 C423 LEFT HANDLE 2 PIN LEFT HANDLE 5 PIN PWR BOB CLOSE PWR BOB OPEN SWITCH BEACON SW2 1 2 3 4 5 6 WIRING SCHEMATIC (STANDARD MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 13 of 13 (PRINTED JUNE 2009) 7175752 Printed In U.S.A. WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET C101 FUEL SHUTOFF SOLENOID 3 6 C421 TILT SPOOL LOCK 3 10 J1A GATEWAY COTROLLER 34 C103 TAILGATE 8 4,10,11,13 C422 LIFT SPOOL LOCK 3 10 J1B GATEWAY CONTOLLER 26 C104 ENGINE COOLANT SENSOR 2 6 C423 BUCKET POSITION 2 13 J2A AUX CONTROLLER 34 C105 HYD CHARGE PRESSURE 3 7 C425 BRAKE SOLENOID 3 7 J2B AUX CONTROLLER 26 C106 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR 2 6 C426 CAN (Remote Start Tool, ACD) 7 5 J1-ACS ACS CONTROLLER 8 C107 ENGINE OIL PRESSURE 3 6 C434-1 LEFT WORKLIGHT 1 2 11 J2-ACS ACS CONTROLLER 10 C108 HYD TEMPERATURE SENDER 2 7 C434-2 LEFT WORKLIGHT 2 2 11 J3-ACS ACS CONTROLLER 10 C109 S/R ADAPTER HARNESS 2 6 C435-1 RIGHT WORKLIGHT 1 2 11 J5 DRIVE CONTROLLER 50 C110 ALTERNATOR 2 6 C435-2 RIGHT WORKLIGHT 2 2 11 C112 HYD OIL FILTER SWITCH 2 7 C437 TWO SPEED MAKEUP 2 7 C126 HORN 2 13 C441 TWO SPEED 2 7 FC1 FUSE CENTER 1 3 C129 ACCESSORY 3 9 C446 HYDRAULIC FAN 2 7 FC2 FUSE CENTER 2 3 C209 DOME LIGHT 3 9 C449 LEFT JOYSTICK 4 5,15 FRC1 FUSE RELAY CENTER 3,6,7,11,12 C212 POWER SOCKET 2 9 C450 RIGHT JOYSTICK 4 5,15 C250 DOOR SENSOR 2 9 C459 LEFT JOYSTICK 4 15 C251 WIPER 5 9 C460 RIGHT JOYSTICK 4 15 T1 BATT GROUND 4 C252 WASHER 2 9 C479 LEFT PANEL(BLACK) 12 5,8 T2 BUZZER GROUND 8 C277 AIR RIDE SEAT 6 9 C480 LEFT PANEL(GRAY) 12 8 T3 FLASHER 13 C278 RIGHT SPEAKER 2 9 C482 SEATBAR SENSOR 3 9 T6 BATT GROUND 4 C279 LEFT SPEAKER 2 9 C483 TEMP CONTROL SWITCH 3 12 T8 BATT GROUND 4 C308 BRAKE SOLENOID 2 7 C486 AC COMPRESSOR 2 12 T13 BUZZER POWER 8 C350 AC EVAPORATOR SWITCH 2 12 C489 ACCESSORY 2 3,4 T14 PRE HEATER 6 C355 DLX or STD FUEL HARNESS 6 6,12,13 C492 ACS/SJC/AWS 1 8 3,5,9,14,15 T15 RIGHT REAR WORK LIGHT(+) 11 C362 REAR AUX SOLENOID 8 7 C493 ACS/SJC/AWS 2 4 3,4,14,15 T16 RIGHT REAR WORK LIGHT(-) 11 C404 BACKUP ALARM 2 3,10 C497 SJC HORN/BLINKER 3 13 T17 LEFT REAR WORK LIGHT (+) 11 C405 AIR FILTER SWITCH 2 6 C499 PTOL 4 8 T18 LEFT REAR WORK LIGHT (-) 11 C406 FUEL SENDER 2 6 C500 RH KEY SWITCH 6 8 T19 BACKUP ALARM 10 C408 CAB CONNECTOR 48 3-5, 8-13 C503 RH DLX PANEL 6 5,8 T20 BACKUP ALARM (GND) 10 C409 RIGHT HANDLE 10 10 C602 LEFT REAR TAIL LIGHT 2 11 C410 LEFT HANDLE 10 10 C603 RIGHT REAR TAIL LIGHT 2 11 C411 LEFT HANDLE 5 WAY 5 10,13 C606 POWER BOBTACH OPEN 2 13 SW1 BRAKE SWITCH 9 C412 HANDLE(HORN) 2 10,13 C607 POWER BOBTACH CLOSE 2 13 SW2 BEACON SWITCH 13 C413 REAR ROD 2 7 C611 BLOWER MOTOR 4 12 SW3 HAZARD SWITCH 13 C414 REAR BASE 2 7 C630 THERMOSTAT 3 12 SW4 HAND/FOOT, H/ISO SWITCH 9 C415 HIGH FLOW SOLENOID 2 7 C635 HEATER VALVE 6 12 SW5 POWER BOBTACH SWITCH 13 C416 DIVERTER SOLENOID 2 7 C667 DOOR KIT 6 9 SW6 BUCKET POSITION SWITCH 13 C417 REAR AUX RELIEF 2 7 C670 EXTERIOR BEACON 6 13 SW8 FRONT WIPER SWITCH 9 C418 FRONT ROD 2 7 C676 RADIO 6 9 SW9 TRAVEL CONTROL SWITCH 8 C419 FRONT BASE 2 7 SW10 BLOWER SWITCH 12 C420 HYD LOCK 2 7 SW11 AC SWITCH 12 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS (ACS) CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET C428 TILT ACTUATOR 8 14 C429 LIFT ACTUATOR 8 14 C467 LIFT PEDAL LOCK 3 14 C468 TILT PEDAL LOCK 3 14 C469 TILT HANDLE 3 14 C470 TILT PEDAL 3 14 C471 LIFT PEDAL 3 14 C472 LIFT HANDLE 3 14 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS (SJC) CONN DESCRIPTION NUM OF PINS SHEET C536 RIGHT SWASHPLATE 4 15 C537 LEFT SWASHPLATE 4 15 C428 TILT ACTUATOR 8 15 C429 LIFT ACTUATOR 8 15 C453 RIGHT QUAD A DRIVE 4 15 C454 LEFT QUAD DIRVE 4 15 C474 BRAKE LIGHT 1 15 C501 A22 PUMP HARNESS 8 15 C544 LEFT FORWARD DRIVE 2 15 C545 LEFT REVERSE DRIVE 2 15 C546 RIGHT FORWARD DRIVE 2 15 C547 RIGHT REVERSE DRIVE 2 15 C542 LEFT SWASHPLATE 3 15 C543 RIGHT SWASHPLATE 3 15 C707 OBW STOP BRAKE LIGHT 3 15 WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 1 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. J1 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS(GATEWAY CONTROLLER) PIN FUNCTION PIN FUNCTION A-1 HYDRAULIC LOCK RETURN B-1 HYD CHARGE PRESS A-2 LIFT SPOOL LOCK RETURN B-2 UNSW BATT A-3 FUEL PULL RELAY B-3 UNSW BATT A-4 SWITCHED POWER OUT RELAY B-4 FUEL HOLD A-5 LIGHT 1 RELAY B-5 LIFT SPOOL LOCK A-6 GLOW PLUG RELAY B-6 TRACTION LOCK HOLD A-7 STARTER RELAY B-7 TILT SPOOL LOCK A-8 TRACTION PULL RELAY B-8 CAN LO 1 A-9 FAN 1 RELAY B-9 CAN HI 1 A-10 TILT SPOOL LOCK RETURN B-10 SPOOL LOCK SENSOR 2 A-11 SPARE DIGITAL, ECU SINKS B-11 SEAT BAR A-12 SPARE DIGITAL, ECU SOURCES B-12 FUEL LEVEL A-13 TRACTION PULL RELAY FDBK B-13 BICS HYD LOCK HOLD A-14 GLOW PLUG RELAY FDBK B-14 CAN HI 2 A-15 ENGINE SPEED B-15 GROUND P1 A-16 AIR FILTER SWITCH B-16 GROUND P2 A-17 LIGHT 2 RELAY B-17 GROUND P3, SENSOR A-18 FAN 2 RELAY B-18 ENGINE COOLANT TEMP A-19 PTOL LED B-19 FAN 2 OUTPUT A-20 PTOL SWITCH B-20 CAN LO 2 A-21 SWITCHED POWER OUT RELAY FDBK B-21 REMOTE KEY A-22 STATER RELAY FDBK B-22 RUN/ENTER A-23 HYD OIL FILTER SW2 B-23 SENSOR SUPPLY 8V A-24 START ENGINE B-24 SENSOR SUPPLY 5V A-25 ENGINE OIL PRESS B-25 TWO SPEED MAKEUP A-26 SPARE B-26 TWO SPEED COIL A-27 SPARE A-28 LIGHT 2 RELAY FDBK A-29 FAN 1 RELAY FDBK A-30 FUEL PULL RELAY FDBK A-31 LIGHT 1 RELAY FDBK A-32 HYD OIL TEMP A-33 SPARE ANALOG A-34 HYD OIL FILTER SW1 J2 CONNECTOR ASSIGNMENTS(AUXILLIARY CONTROLLER) PIN FUNCTION PIN FUNCTION A-1 FRONT AUX (F) RETURN B-1 A-2 REAR AUX (F) RETURN B-2 UNSW BATT A-3 LEFT BLINKER RELAY B-3 UNSW BATT A-4 RIGHT BLINKER RELAY B-4 DIVERTED SOLENOID A-5 HORN RELAY B-5 REAR AUX (F) A-6 B-6 RELIEF SOLENOID A-7 OUTPUT SPARE B-7 REAR AUX (M) A-8 B-8 CAN LO 1 A-9 B-9 CAN HI 1 A-10 REAR AUX (M) RETURN B-10 A-11 LH PADDLE RIGHT B-11 A-12 LH PADDLE LEFT B-12 A-13 RH RIGHT BUTTON UP B-13 FRONT AUX (F) A-14 DIGITAL INPUT SPARE B-14 CAN HI 2 A-15 B-15 GROUND A-16 B-16 GROUND A-17 B-17 HANDLE POT GND A-18 FRONT AUX (M) RETURN B-18 RH PVM POT SIGNAL A-19 B-19 FRONT AUX (M) A-20 LH FLOAT BUTTON B-20 CAN LO 2 A-21 HYDRAULIC DETENT B-21 RH TRIGGER A-22 LH RIGHT BUTTON DOWN B-22 SWITCHED POWER A-23 RH CENTER BUTTON B-23 HANDLE POT POWER A-24 DIGITAL INPUT SPARE B-24 A-25 B-25 BUCKET POSITION (SPARE) A-26 HIGH FLOW RETURN B-26 HIGH FLOW A-27 BUCKET POSITION(SPARE) RETURN A-28 LH RIGHT BUTTON A-29 RH RIGHT BUTTON DOWN A-30 RH LEFT UP A-31 RH LEFT DOWN A-32 A-33 A-34 DIGITAL INPUT SPARE J5 DRIVE CONTROLLER PIN FUNCTION 1 SAFETY IN 2 TWO SPEED SWITCH 3 SPARE DIGITAL INPUT 2 4 H PAT SWITCH 5 ISO PAT SWITCH 6 ISO LITE 7 L SWASH PLATE ANGLE 8 R SWASH PLATE ANGLE 9 SPARE ANALOG 4 10 SPARE ANALOG 5 11 L FWD RETURN 12 CAN HIGH 13 LF ANGLE 14 RF ANGLE 15 LR ANGLE 16 H PAT LITE 17 RR ANGLE 18 L JOYSTICK X 19 L JOYSTICK Y 20 R JOYSTICK X 21 L FWD DRIVE 22 CAN LOW 23 R QUAD A DRIVE 24 R QUAD B DRIVE 25 TWO SPEED 1 26 BRAKE LIGHT OUTPUT 27 GROUND 28 GROUND 29 SENSOR GROUND 30 SENSOR SUPPLY 2 +5V 31 L REV DRIVE 32 CAN SHIELD 33 L QUAD A DRIVE 34 L QUAD B DRIVE 35 SAFETY OUT 36 BACKUP ALARM 37 R JOYSTICK Y 38 SPARE ANALOG 1 39 SPARE PWM COIL 7 40 SENSOR SUPPLY 1 +5V 41 L REV RETURN 42 R FWD RETURN 43 R FWD DRIVE 44 R REV DRIVE 45 R REV RETURN 46 TWO SPEED 2 47 UNSWITCHED BATTERY 48 UNSWITCHED BATTERY 49 SPARE PWN COIL 6 50 SWITCHED BATTERY ACS CONTROLLER CONNECTOR J1-ACS CONNECTOR J2-ACS CONNECTOR J3-ACS PIN FUNCTION PIN FUNCTION PIN FUNCTION A +5V TO SENSORS A LIFT CYLINDER SENSOR-SPARE A TILT MOTOR 1 B SWITCHED POWER B FLOAT-SPARE B UNSWITCHED POWER C HAND/FOOT INPUT C RESPONSE SELECTOR-SPARE C UNSWITCHED POWER D CAN HIGH D TILT CYLINDER SENSOR-SPARE D LIFT MOTOR 2 E CAN LOW E TILT ACTUATOR FEEDBACK E HANDLE ENABLE F F LIFT HANDLE F LIFT MOTOR 1 G GROUND G TILT HANDLE G PEDAL ENABLE H GROUND H LIFT ACTUATOR FEEDBACK H GROUND J LIFT PEDAL J GROUND K TILT PEDAL K TILT MOTOR 2 HARNESS PART NUMBER MAINFRAME 7175625 STD CAB 7165991 DLX CAB 7176098 DLX FUEL 7175293 STD FUEL 7149219 DOOR 7155024 S/R 6733370 TAILGATE DOM 7175271 TAILGATE EUR 7175287 2 SPD ADP 7159366 ACS 7164144 SJC WHEEL 7159325 HARNESS PART NUMBER SJC TRACK 7159458 A22 PUMP 7169309 SUSP JSTK 7163706 BACKUP ALARM 7175017 BRAKE ADAPTER 7165061 WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 2 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. 25 A FC2 FUSE 2 25 A FRC1 FUSE 11 20 A FRC1 FUSE 10 15 A FRC1 FUSE 9 POWER SWITCHED 85 86 30 87 1760/RNG/WHT C489 A 1040/RED 1070/RED 30 A FRC1 FUSE 5 30 A FRC 1 FUSE 6 25 A FC1 FUSE 3 MEGAFUSE 100.0 Amps 1010/RED BATTERY BATT_CABLE 1110/RED/WHT 1130/RED/WHT 1790/RNG/WHT 1310/RED 1050/RED 1050/RED SHEET 6 2055/BLK 1300/RED 1060/RED 1030/RED 8000/TAN 1740/RNG/WHT C408 17 C408 43 1660/RNG/WHT 1340/RED 1120/RED/WHT 1270/RED 1450/RED/WHT 1150/RED/WHT 1180/RED/WHT J2B 2 J2B 3 J1B 3 J1B 2 J1A 4 SHEET 12 25 A FC1 FUSE 4 1235/RED/WHT 1170/RED/WHT 1280/RED 1450/RED/WHT 1660/RNG/WHT 1785/RNG/WHT SHEET 5 SHEET 5 SHEET 9 25 A FC1 FUSE 2 1160/RED/WHT1025/RED 25 A FC1 FUSE 1 SHEET 6 SHEET 6 1830/RNG/WHT 1840/RNG/WHT SHEET 13 SHEET 8 1440/RED/WHT SHEET 8 1420/RED/WHT 15 A FRC1 FUSE 3 1795/RNG/WHT SHEET 9 1400/RED/WHT 15 A FC2 FUSE 4 25 A FRC1 FUSE1 25 A FRC1 FUSE 2 25 A FRC1 FUSE 8 5 A FRC1 FUSE 4 25 A FRC1 FUSE 7 SHEET 8 1940/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1620/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1930/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1950/RNG/WHT SHEET 9 1775/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 1960/RNG/WHT POWER C493 1 C493 2 C492 6 C408 6 1920/RNG/WHT 1920/RNG/WHT SHEET 13 1460/RED/WHT 25 A FC2 FUSE 1 SHEET 12 2030/BLK C404 B 1410/RED/WHT 1490/RED/WHT 1190/RED SHEET 10 1570/RNG/WHT 1765/RNG/WHT SHEET 8 SHEET 8 1590/RNG/WHT 1240/RED/WHT 1290/RED WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SHEET 9 1580/RNG/WHT SHEET 9 1370/RED/WHT SHEET 9 1850/RNG/WHT SHEET 13 1550/RNG/WHT SHEET 5 1165/RED/WHT SHEET 5 1730/RNG/WHT SHEET 7 1360/RED/WHT SHEET 6 1350/RED/WHT SHEET 12 1140/RED/WHT SHEET 11 1320/RED/WHT SHEET 11 1330/RED/WHT SHEET 6 SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 1780/RNG/WHT 1750/RNG/WHT 1720/RNG/WHT WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 3 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. C489 B SHEET 6 3800/LBL SHEET 5 SHEET 9 2790/BLK 2390/BLK SHEET 7 SHEET 9 3910/LBL 3410/LBL 2900/BLK C103 B 2600/BLK SHEET 7 2720/BLK 2000/BLK 2200/BLK T1 BATT GND SHEET 12 2745/BLK SHEET 7 3310/LBL SHEET 6 3510/LBL SHEET 6 3110/LBL T8 BATT GND 2110/BLK SHEET 11 SHEET 13 SHEET 9 2765/BLK 2780/BLK 2730/BLK T6 BATT GND 2500/BLK 3010/LBL 2510/BLK SHEET 6 3710/LBL 2300/BLK2710/BLK SHEET 13 2741/BLK 2540/BLK 2550/BLK SHEET 7 2480/BLK J2B 15 J2B 16 SHEET 7 2450/BLK J1B 15 J1B 16 J1B 17 2235/BLK 2240/BLK 2900/BLK C408 42 SHEET 8 SHEET 5 2920/BLK SHEET 11 2105/BLK 2070/BLK SHEET 5 2080/BLK SHEET 13 2830/BLK SHEET 8 2940/BLK SHEET 8 2960/BLK SHEET 9 2930/BLK SHEET 8 2700/BLK GROUND SHEET 13 2751/BLK C493 3 C493 4 SHEET 10 2530/BLK SHEET 10 2520/BLK C408 32 2950/BLK 2950/BLK SHEET 13 2785/BLK SHEET 7 3530/LBL 2090/BLK SHEET 8 2250/BLK 2600/BLK SHEET 10 2650/BLK SHEET 11 2640/BLK SHEET 11 2610/BLK SHEET 11 2620/BLK SHEET 11 2630/BLK WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 SHEET 6 2810/BLK WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 4 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. FF EE GG DD BB AA SHEET 4 2710/BLK 9400/PUR 9500/PUR/WHT 9600/PUR C426 C408 7 C408 8 9120/PUR/WHT 9220/PUR J2B 9 J2B 8 J1B 8 J1B 9 J1B 14 J1B 20 J1B 21 C479 3 C479 4 C503 2 C503 4 9530/PUR/WHT9130/PUR/WHT 9630/PUR9230/PUR 4 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 2070/BLK 2080/BLK 1830/RNG/WHT 1840/RNG/WHT 9640/PUR 9540/PUR/WHT C450 C449 SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 9650/PUR 9550/PUR/WHT 9260/PUR 9160/PUR/WHT 9230/PUR 9130/PUR/WHT 9240/PUR 9250/PUR 9140/PUR/WHT 9150/PUR/WHT CAN BUS C492 4 C492 1 9210/PUR 9110/PUR/WHT 9200/PUR 9100/PUR/WHT 9240/PUR 9140/PUR/WHT RESISTOR 120 OHM RESISTOR 120 OHM 9660/PUR 9560/PUR/WHT 9270/PUR 9170/PUR/WHT C492 7 C492 8 9280/PUR 9180/PUR/WHT 9190/PUR/WHT 9290/PUR DRIVE CTRLR ACS CTRLR SHEET 3 1165/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1730/RNG/WHT CC WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 # CONNECTOR DOES NOT EXIST IN 7165991 # # CAN (Remote Start Tool, ACD) RIGHT JOYSTICK LEFT JOYSTICK AUX CTRLR GWY CTRLR RH DLX PANEL LEFT PANEL WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 5 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. SHEET 4 SHEET 4 C A B 3520/LBL 3510/LBL 3600/LBL 3800/LBL STARTER 85 86 30 87 8200/TAN 8250/TAN PULL FUEL 85 86 30 87 A B C 8800/TAN PLUG GLOW 85 86 30 87 8500/TAN A3700/LBL B3710/LBL C110 T14 PRE HEATER 2016/BLK 8510/TAN 8550/TAN 8110/TAN 8150/TAN 8210/TAN 3200/LBL SHEET 4 SHEET 4 L S 1020/RED 1015/RED A B 3210/LBL 2015/BLK B A ENGINE SPEED SENSOR 3610/LBL SWITCH AIR FILTER SENSOR (500-3000 OHM) ENGINE COOLANT SENDER (0.5-4.5V) ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SOLENOID FUEL SHUTOFF 2800 BLK 8800 TAN 8100 TAN C101 24.5 OHM 0.33 OHM C405 M S R STARTER G ALTERNATOR C104 B EXCITATION PULL HOLD 8100/TAN8120/TAN 2800/BLK J1B 4 J1B 12 J1B 18 J1A 22 J1A 15 J1A 16 J1A 25 J1A 14 J1A 6 J1A 30 J1A 3 J1A 7 D5 A B C109 8250/TAN 8200/TAN SHEET 3 1060/RED SHEET 3 1030/RED SHEET 12 2005/BLK SHEET 7 2025/BLK 15 A FRC1 FUSE 12 ENGINE SHEET 12 1815/RNG/WHT A B SHEET 3 2055/BLK 3110/LBL 3110/LBL 3100/LBL 3100/LBL C355 D C355 C SHEET 9 3500/LBL WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SHEET 3 1350/RED/WHT 1800/RNG/WHT C106 SIG GND SIG GND +5V PWR SIG GND C107 C406 GND SIG SHEET 3 B SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 SIG GND FUEL SENDER SHEET 4 2810/BLK WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 6 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. LOCK TRACTION 85 86 30 87 B C A SHEET 4 2200/BLK 4200/LGN 4150/LGN 4110/LGN A C B 3400/LBL 3420/LBL 3410/LBL A B 4410/LGN 2410/BLK SHEET 4 A C112 B A3300/LBL 3310/LBL 3430/LBL B 1 2 4010/LGN 2910/BLK B A4200/RED 2200/BLK 0.5-7.5V PRESSURE CHARGE HYDRAULIC HARN BRAKE ADAPTER 7165061 9.8 OHM 12V SOLENOID HYD LOCK 12 V 9.8 OHM SOLENOID BRAKE C425 12 V 7.2 OHM FAN SOLENOID HYDRAULIC C105 C446 C420 C108 C308 TRACK MACHINES B C A C425 WHEEL MACHINES 0.3 OHM 10.9 OHM HOLD PULL TRACTION LOCK SOLENOID HYDRAULIC TEMPERATURE SENDER 500 - 3000 OHM 2 1 C441 2350/BLK SOLENOID TWO SPEED 4350/LGN 1 2 4340/LGN 2340/BLK 4430/LGN 4440/LGN 4450/LGN 4480/LGN 1 2 4330/LGN 2330/BLK B A4460/LGN 3.3 OHM PWM FRONT ROD SOLENOID (MALE) 3.3 OHM PWM FRONT BASE SOLENOID (FEMALE) 7.5 OHM 12 V SOLENOID OPTIONAL HIGH FLOW C415 C419 C418 2 2 1 2440/BLK 1 2430/BLK 7.5 OHM 12V MALE COUPLER DIRECIONAL SOLENOID OPTIONAL REAR AUX 7.5 OHM 12V FEMALE COUPLER DIRECTIONAL SOLENOID OPTIONAL REAR AUX C413 C414 1 2 2 1 2450/BLK 7.5 OHM 12 V SOLENOID MALE COUPLER BLEED / LOCK VALVE OPTIONAL REAR AUX 9.8 OHM 12 V SOLENOID FEMALE COUPLER BLEED / LOCK VALVE OPTIONAL REAR AUX C417 C416 2480/BLK SHEET 4 2460/BLK J2B 13 J2B 19 J2B 26 J2B 5 J2B 7 J2B 4 J2B 6 J2A 2 J2A 10 J2A 1 J2A 18 J2A 26 B A D C F E H G 4480/LGN 2480/BLK 2450/BLK 4450/LGN 4430/LGN 2430/BLK 2440/BLK 4440/LGN C362 SHEET 4 J1B 6 J1B 13 J1B 19 J1B 26 J1B 1 J1B 23 J1A 18 J1A 1 J1A 32 J1A 34 J1A 13 J1A 8 2 1 C437 MAKEUP SOLENOID OPTIONAL TWO SPEED J1B 25 4360/LGN 2360/BLK J1A 27 J1A 26 SHEET 11 2035/BLK +8V SHEET 6 2025/BLK 4100/LGN SHEET 4 3530/LBL SHEET 3 1360/RED/WHT WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG GND SIG SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 HYDRAULIC OIL FILTER SWITCH WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 7 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. 9350/PUR C408 4 C408 40 C408 1 C408 37 9370/PUR 9380/PUR 9360/PUR J1B 22 J1A 24 J1A 20 J1A 19 22 1212 C479 8 C479 7 C479 10 C479 9 C479 11 C479 1 C479 2 C479 5 2920/BLK T2 BUZZER (-) 1940/RNG/WHT 9320/PUR T13 BUZZER (+) 4730/LGN 2700/BLK 1960/RNG/WHT SWITCH OPTIONAL TRAVEL CONTROL SW9 1 2 3 4 5 6 1440/RED/WHT 1620/RNG/WHT 11 22 33 44 C499 9380/PUR 9370/PUR 1930/RNG/WHT 2940/BLK 2960/BLK 1950/RNG/WHT 44 11 55 33 22 C500 1420/RED/WHT SHEET 4 SHEET 3 SHEET 3 SHEET 9 4750/LGN SHEET 3 SHEET 3 SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 9360/PUR 9350/PUR SHEET 13 SHEET 13 6550/PNK 6450/PNK CAB DISPLAY 2250/BLK 1590/RNG/WHT C503 1 C503 5 C503 3 1240/RED/WHT SHEET 3 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 SHEET 9 9310/PUR SHEET 9 4500/LGN WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 66 LEFT PANEL (BLACK) RH KEY SWITCH RH DLX PANEL LEFT PANEL (GRAY) PTOL (Press To Operate Loader) C480 WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 8 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. SHEET 4 3920/LBL 3910/LBL 3900/LBL 2790/BLK C408 24 C408 44 C408 45 C408 46 C408 33 C408 23 SHEET 4 2730/BLK 3930/LBL SHEET 4 J1B 11 BRAKE SWITCH SW1 2 1 3 5 6 4 2930/BLK C408 5 C408 3 C408 2 1775/RNG/WHT 2 5 6 4 3 1 2840/BLK C667 SWITCH FRONT WIPER SW8 2 1 3 5 4 6 C408 27 7330/WHT 7300/WHT 7310/WHT BB AA 22 11 1390/RED/WHT1370/RED/WHT 2010/BLK2790/BLK 2840/BLK C B A C251 X L C252 MOTOR WIPER PARK LOW GND MOTOR WASHER DOOR SENSOR 2730/BLK 2795/BLK 1400/RED/WHT - + C212 SENSOR SHOWN WITH DOOR OPEN SWITCH (SJC, AWS) H/ISO (ACS) HAND/FOOT SW4 5 6 4 2 1 3 4550/LGN 2060/BLK C B C129 2820/BLK 1375/RED/WHT A 1210/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1785/RNG/WHT 4235/LGN 4275/LGN C 3900/LBL A B 3910/LBL 3920/LBL SENSOR SEATBAR GND SIG PWR SHEET 3 SHEET 8 1850/RNG/WHT C408 16 SHEET 4 SHEET 3 2 5 6 3 4 1 C676 1 2 1 2 C279 7830/WHT 7820/WHT 7810/WHT 7800/WHT C278 RIGHT SPEAKER LEFT SPEAKER 1865/RNG/WHT1580/RNG/WHT 1885/RNG/WHT 2885/BLK J1B 24 +5V D SW PWR E 4740/LGN 1400/RED/WHT 7310/WHT 2845/BLK 1850/RNG/WHT 1860/RNG/WHT 1570/RNG/WHT C492 5 4235/LGN 4220/LGN C492 3 C492 2 4275/LGN 4550/LGN 2 1 C250 CC 4750/LGN 4740/LGN 4760/LGN 5 4 C277 1510/RNG/WHT 2210/BLK SHEET 6 3500/LBL 7165991 Standard Cab 7176098 Deluxe Cab SHEET 8 9310/PUR SHEET 8 4500/LGN 7176098 ONLY SHEET 3 1580/RNG/WHT SHEET 3 1370/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1850/RNG/WHT C209 - + - + SEAT SOLENOID AIR RIDE C482 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT * SPLICE DOES NOT EXIST IN 7165991 * * SHEET 10 4230/LGN SHEET 10 4240/LGN SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 ACCESSORY CONN POWER SOCKET RADIO CONN DOME LIGHT WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 9 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. 2370/BLK 2380/BLK 3 14370/LGN 1 3 4380/LGN (NOT USED WITH ACS) TILT SPOOL LOCK SOLENOID (NOT USED WITH ACS) LIFT SPOOL LOCK SOLENOID J2B 22 J1B 7 J1B 5 J1A 2 J1A 10 1560/RNG/WHT G F B C D A E H J K 4810/LGN 4820/LGN 4830/LGN 4840/LGN 4640/LGN 1710/RNG/WHT C410 2520/BLK B C E D J H 4300/LGN 4310/LGN 4920/LGN 4930/LGN 4320/LGN 4940/LGN A F G K SHEET 4 1590/RNG/WHT 4910/LGN 2530/BLK C409 SHEET 4 SKI CTRL SIDE SHIFT PWM TWO SPD DETENT FLOW SKI CTRL F G B C D A +B D -C A H J E F E H G K J K E C A D B B A HORN TURN SIGNAL J2B 23 J2B 17 J2A 22 J2A 30 J2A 31 J2B 21 J2A 13 J2B 18 J2A 28 J2A 12 J2A 11 J2A 20 SHEET 3 1570/RNG/WHT 2 2 C103 C C404 A 7100/WHT 7001923 BACKUP ALARM + - 7100/WHT SHEET 4 2650/BLK MANUAL CONTROLS C411 C412 C421 C422 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SHEET 9 4230/LGN SHEET 9 4240/LGN SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 T19 1 T20 1 LEFT HANDLE RIGHT HANDLE WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 10 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. LIGHTS WORK FRONT 85 86 30 87 LIGHT REAR 85 86 30 87 C103 A C103 H 6310/PNK 6000/PNK 6210/PNK 6320/PNK C408 25 C408 28 SHEET 4 2765/BLK 6230/PNK 6330/PNK 6340/PNK J1A 28 J1A 17 J1A 5 J1A 31 A B 6110/PNK A B 6120/PNK 2760/BLK 2750/BLK WORK LIGHT LEFT FRONT 50.00 Watts WORK LIGHT RIGHT FRONT 37.00 Watts 6000/PNK 2765/BLK 2045/BLK 2045/BLK SHEET 4 2105/BLK LIGHTS A B WORK LIGHT LEFT FRONT 37.00 Watts A B WORK LIGHT RIGHT FRONT 50.00 Watts 6100/PNK 6130/PNK 2735/BLK 2705/BLK SHEET 7 2035/BLK 6200/PNK 1 C603 2 WORK LIGHT RIGHT REAR TAIL LIGHT RIGHT REAR 1 C602 2 WORK LIGHT LEFT REAR TAIL LIGHT LEFT REAR 6330/PNK 6320/PNK 6200/PNK T16 1 T15 1 T18 1 T17 1 6210/PNK 6310/PNK SHEET 4 2640/BLK SHEET 4 2610/BLK SHEET 4 2620/BLK SHEET 4 2630/BLK SHEET 3 1320/RED/WHT SHEET 3 1330/RED/WHT C435-2 C435-1 C434-1 C434-2 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 11 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. HVAC 85 86 30 87 1500/RNG/WHT 2745/BLK SHEET 4 8020/TAN A B 7024/WHT C350 (AC PRESS SWITCH) EVAPORATOR J1A 21 A B C D C611 2745/BLK C408 22 1500/RNG/WHT 5 SWITCH BLOWER SW10 6 3 OFF 2 1 4 C408 21 1970/RNG/WHT 1520/RNG/WHT 7320/WHT 1900/RNG/WHT C408 34 A B C 1980/RNG/WHT C483 A D C B E F C635 1910/RNG/WHT 7220/WHT 2560/BLK 2130/BLK High14.00 Amps Med7.50 Amps Low5.00 Amps SWITCH) (TEMP CONTROL POTENTIOMETER DBL WHT BLK VALVE HEATER 12V SIG GND 2580/BLK MOTOR BLOWER A B C 3320/LBL C630 2570/BLK 7020/WHT THERMOSTAT AC SWITCH SW11 C 1 2100/BLK 3 7040/WHT SHEET 3 1790/RNG/WHT SHEET 3 2030/BLK HVAC SHEET 6 1815/RNG/WHT 2 2280/BLK 1 2290/BLK 7025/WHT D4 SHEET 13 7020/WHT 7023/WHT J1A 11 7021/WHT SHEET 6 2005/BLK C486 (COMPRESSOR) MAGNET CLUTCH SHEET 3 1140/RED/WHT WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 C355 A 7024/WHT WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 12 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. C103 D C103 E 6410/PNK 6510/PNK C408 29 C408 36 C408 15 C408 26 SHEET 4 SHEET 12 2290/BLK C408 30 C408 13 SHEET 4 2780/BLK C408 35 6500/PNK 6400/PNK BB 2740/BLK AA 7030/WHT A B D C411 6515/PNK 6010/PNK 6415/PNK A B C126 A B 7210/WHT C412 SHEET 4 2785/BLK 1460/RED/WHT 7022/WHT SHEET 4 2741/BLK C A B J2A 5 J2A 4 J2A 3 6520/PNK 6420/PNK 7200/WHT D3 6500/PNK HAZARD SWITCH SW3 5 4 6 2 1 3 6530/PNK 6400/PNK E D A C F B C670 6440/PNK 6430/PNK 6540/PNK 6540/PNK 6700/PNK 2780/BLK L X 1430/RED/WHT 1410/RED/WHT T3 FLASHER CONN 6570/PNK 6010/PNK 2725/BLK SWITCH BOBTACH POWER SW5 5 4 6 2 1 3 C408 9 C408 10 1380/RED/WHT BLINKER RIGHT BEACON STROBE BLINKER LEFT 1200/RED/WHT 2420/BLK2850/BLK D2 D1 SWITCH POSITION BUCKET SW6 2 1 3 5 6 4 1550/RNG/WHT 7022/WHT 2830/BLK (PINS 3 & 6 INTERNALLY INSULATED) 6550/PNK 6450/PNK SHEET 3 SHEET 3 1410/RED/WHT SHEET 4 OPTIONS SHEET 8 SHEET 8 A C606 B 2775/BLK B A C607 2770/BLK 7000/WHT 7010/WHT C408 38 7210/WHT 2751/BLK 2751/BLK C355 B C355 E C355 F 7010/WHT 7010/WHT 7000/WHT 7000/WHT SHEET 3 1550/RNG/WHT WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT C E SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 SJC HORN/BLINKER C497 LEFT HANDLE 2 PIN LEFT HANDLE 5 PIN C423 PWR BOB CLOSE PWR BOB OPEN SWITCH BEACON SW2 1 2 3 4 5 6 WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 13 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. 1 6 4 1 3 2 5 4 1 3 1 3 2 2 5 8 5 8 TILT ACTUATOR 1630/RNG/WHT 1630/RNG/WHT 3 LIFT ACTUATOR 3 1 1530/RNG/WHT 1530/RNG/WHT 7 6 4 2670/BLK 6 7 4 1 2770/BLK 2770/BLK 1 3 2 1 3 2 HALL SENSOR TILT PEDAL HALL SENSOR LIFT PEDAL PWR SIG GND PWR SIG GND B C A B C A A A C C B B HALL SENSOR HANDLE LIFT HALL SENSOR HANDLE TILT C470 2510/BLK 2500/BLK 2650/BLK 2760/BLK 2660/BLK 4650/LGN 4750/LGN 4670/LGN 4670/LGN 4770/LGN 4770/LGN 4680/LGN 4690/LGN 4780/LGN 4790/LGN 4280/LGN 4270/LGN4260/LGN 4760/LGN 4660/LGN 1500/RNG/WHT 1620/RNG/WHT 1520/RNG/WHT 1510/RNG/WHT 1510/RNG/WHT 1610/RNG/WHT 1610/RNG/WHT 1190/RED/WHT 1180/RED/WHT 1170/RED/WHT 4450/LGN 9240/PUR 9140/PUR/WHT 2240/BLK 2250/BLK 2280/BLK 2260/BLK 2270/BLK 4220/LGN 4220/LGN 4220/LGN 4275/LGN 4275/LGN 1740/RNG/WHT SKI CTRL FLOAT SHIFT SIDE PWM TWO SPD FLOW DETENT SKI CTRL F G B C D A B D C A H J E F B A B A E H G K LOCK HANDLE LOCK HANDLE 2750/BLK J K C465 C466 C472 C469 C467 C468 C410 C409 C492 2 C493 2 2 3 7 8 C429 C428 C471 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT ACS CONTROLS H G C A E D B F H E A B C D G J K B C D F J H K A G E J1-ACS J2-ACS J3-ACS E C A D B B A HORN TURN SIGNAL C411 C412 SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 See manual controls for harness connection MAINFRAME HARNESS LIFT SOLENOID TILT SOLENOID GND PWR SIG GND PWR SIG HALL SENSOR HANDLE TILT GND PWR SIG GND PWR SIG WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 14 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. 1740/RNG/WHT 4220/LGN 4275/LGN 4550/LGN 1170/RED/WHT 2240/BLK 1 2 3 4 2 C454 4 3 1 C453 3 4 5 1 2 6 7 8 4670/LGN 3 4 5 1 2 6 7 8 4770/LGN 4790/LGN 4780/LGN 4690/LGN 4680/LGN 1180/RED/WHT 1190/RED/WHT 2270/BLK 2260/BLK 2770/BLK 2630/BLK 1630/RNG/WHT 2250/BLK 1500/RNG/WHT 2280/BLK 1610/RNG/WHT 2235/BLK2470/BLK 2490/BLK 7100/WHT 9140/PUR/WHT 9240/PUR 1750/RNG/WHT 1250/RED/WHT 1260/RED/WHT 3070/LBL 3000/LBL 2570/BLK 1530/RNG/WHT 3080/LBL 3020/LBL 2580/BLK 1540/RNG/WHT 1640/RNG/WHT 2510/BLK 1 2 4270/LGN 7 2670/BLK 8 1 22680/BLK 6 4280/LGN 5 1 2 4250/LGN 3 2650/BLK 4 1 2 2660/BLK 2 4260/LGN 1 4210/LGN A 1810/RNG/WHT 2 2810/BLK 4 4950/LGN 3 4720/LGN 3 1710/RNG/WHT 1 4260/LGN 2660/BLK 4250/LGN 2650/BLK 4280/LGN 2680/BLK 4270/LGN 2670/BLK ACS CONTROLLER 1 2 34950/LGN 1770/RNG/WHT1 2860/BLK4 1 2 34720/LGN HARNESS, A22 PUMP 7169309 ACTUATOR LIFT TILT ACTUATOR BRAKE LIGHT RELAY 85 86 30 87 4210/LGN B C A1730/RNG/WHT 6600/PNK 2730/BLK C707 LIGHT BRAKE 2 1760/RNG/WHT 1770/RNG/WHT 2860/BLK 1820/RNG/WHT 1710/RNG/WHT 2810/BLK GND SWASHPLATE RIGHT SWASHPLATE LEFT SIG PWR GND SIG PWR PWR GND SIG 1 6 1 4 3 2 5 4 (CONNECTS TO BACKUP ALARM C404 ON MFR HARNESS) SENSOR LEFT SPEED SENSOR RIGHT SPEED GND GND PWR PWR SIG SIG SIG SIG 3 21235/RED/WHT RIGHT FORWARD DRIVE RIGHT REVERSE DRIVE LEFT REVERSE DRIVE LEFT FORWARD DRIVE C543 C542 C547 C546 C545 C544 C501 C537 C474 C429 C428 C493 C492 C536 HARNESS, OBW STOP LTS 7151696 J3-ACS J1-ACS J2-ACS 29 40 33 34 23 24 8 7 43 42 44 45 31 41 21 11 26 36 50 12 22 16 4 6 48 47 28 27 G E B C J H F D A K H C B D E F A G A B D C G F H E J K 9290/PUR 9190/PUR/WHT 7 8 4 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 JOYSTICK LEFT 1840/RNG/WHT 9640/PUR 9540/PUR/WHT +12V PWR CAN LOW CAN HIGH GND2080/BLK 1 4 2 3 JOYSTICK RIGHT 1830/RNG/WHT 9660/PUR 9560/PUR/WHT +12V PWR CAN LOW CAN HIGH GND 2070/BLK 1 4 2 3 C460C450 C449 C459 HARNESS, JOYSTICK 7163706 C103 C B A 7100/WHT C404 ALARM BACKUP + -SHEET4 WIRE CATEGORIES FOR COLORS AND NUMBER RANGE GROUP DESCRIPTION GROUP NUMBER RANGE WIRE COLOR COLOR CODE BATT FEED, GENERAL 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED RED BATT FEED, FUSED 1000 THROUGH 1499 RED/WHITE RED/WHT BATT FEED, SWITCHED 1500 THROUGH 1999 ORANGE/WHITE RNG/WHT GROUNDING 2000 THROUGH 2999 BLACK BLK MONITORING 3000 THROUGH 3999 LIGHT BLUE LBL HYDRAULIC 4000 THROUGH 4999 LIGHT GREEN LGN ATTACHMENT CONTROLS 5000 THROUGH 5999 YELLOW YEL LIGHTS 6000 THROUGH 6999 PINK PNK ACCESSORIES 7000 THROUGH 7999 WHITE WHT ENGINE 8000 THROUGH 8999 TAN TAN COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE PUR COMMUNICATION 9000 THROUGH 9999 PURPLE/WHITE PUR/WHT SJC CONTROLS SCHEMATIC INDEX OVERVIEW PAGE 1,2 POWER PAGE 3 GROUND PAGE 4 CAN BUS PAGE 5 ENGINE PAGE 6 HYDRAULICS PAGE 7 CAB DISPLAY PAGE 8 CABIN PAGE 9 MANUAL CONTROLS PAGE 10 LIGHTS PAGE 11 HVAC PAGE 12 OPTIONS PAGE 13 ACS CONTROL PAGE 14 SJC CONTROL PAGE 15 MAINFRAME HARNESS J5 - DRIVE CONTROLLER WIRING SCHEMATIC (ACS & SJC MACHINE) S650 (S/N A3NV11001 AND ABOVE) (S/N A3NW11001 AND ABOVE) Sheet 15 of 15 Printed In U.S.A. GND PWR SIG 60-10-1 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION Glossary Of Electrical Symbols CONNECTOR - Harness - Used for connecting 2 harnesses together or a harness to a component. The connector can vary from a single pin to any number of pins (Example: 3 pin connectors shown). The connector pins can be numbered alphabetical (shown) or numerical (1, 2, 3 etc.). The harness wires numbers are called out next to the connector (Example: 3500). The connector number is called out next to the connector (Example: C107). These connector numbers are used for schematic identification only and do not appear on the harness or connector. BATTERY - Used for supplying and storing electrical power for the machine. POSITIVE ELECTRICAL CIRCUIT - Indicates positive battery circuit. NEGATIVE ELECTRICAL CIRCUIT - Indicates battery ground circuit. ALTERNATOR - Used to create the electrical current to supply voltage to the battery and components. COMPONENTS G - + + - 3 510 3 500 3 520 AA B C B C 351 0 350 0 352 0 C107 C1 07 35 10 35 00 35 20 B C A 3 510 3 500 3 520 B C A SYMBOL DESCRIPTION CONNECTIONS SYMBOL DESCRIPTION COMPONENTS GROUND - Frame - Used t o represent an component that is internally grounded. LIGHT - SWITCH - Single Pole - Single Throw (ON-OFF) Normally Open SWITCH - Single Pole - Single Throw (ON-OFF) Normally Closed. SWITCH - Single Pole - Double Throw (ON-OFF-ON) - This switch can be in any of three positions . (Some switches are spring activated to return them to a certain position when released.) SWITCH - Double Pole - Single Throw (ON-OFF) Open and Closed positions will be specified depending on switch application.) SWITCH - Double Pole - Double Throw (ON-OFF) Open and Closed positions will be specified depending on switch application. POTENTIOMETER - Variable resistance - Provides variable resistance. + - STARTER - Uses battery current to start the machine engine. M GROUND - Used to represent an external ground connection. 60-10-2 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Glossary Of Electrical Symbols (Cont’d) SWITCH - Ignition - Multi position switch to activate various start functions at different positions. SWITCH - Light - Multi position switch to activate various lights at different positions. RELAY - Uses a low amp switch to control a high amp component. FUSE - Used to protect the wire harness from an overloaded circuit. (The fuse rating is listed next to the fuse.) ROTARY CONTROL - Provides variable voltage proportional to position. 25A 8530 868787A 1 3 2 4 6 5 B ST I RUN S TART OFF SYMBOL DESCRIPTION COMPONENTS SYMBOL DESCRIPTION SOLENOID - Fuel and Traction Lock - Dual solenoids. (The ohm rating o f the solenoid coils are listed next t o the component [if available]). The pu ll solenoid is energized for a short time . P U L L HOLD B A 1 5 ohm 0 .5 ohm HORN - Audible alarm. Sound is activated manually by a switch. BUZZER - Audible alarm. Sounds at a predetermined setting to warn the operator of a component condition. RESISTOR - Limits current flow. DIODE - Allows electrical current to flow in 1 direction only. MOTOR - HVAC - Multi speed motor. MOTOR - Wiper - Single or mult i speed motor. MOTOR - Washer - Single speed. L M M H G RD M V P ARK H IGH GRD M SPLICE (•) - Used to show when multiple wires are connected together on the schematic. 3110 37103700 7.7 ohm 1 2 SOLENOID - ON / OFF - Electrically activated coil that controls movement magnetically. (The ohm rating of the solenoid coil is listed next to the component [if available]). SOLENOID - VARIABLE - Electrically activated coil that controls movement magnetically. (The ohm rating and voltage of the solenoid coil is listed next to the component [if available]). 7.5 ohm 12V A B PUMP - FUEL H + - HOURMETER - Records the time the engine is running. POWER PLUG - Supplies 12 volt power for customer supplied accessories. -+ GAUGE - Instrument - Indicates certain engine or other component conditions. (The different types of gauge are marked with a icon that represents what function the gauge is monitoring. Example: the gauge shown is for fuel.) S G I 60-10-3 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Glossary Of Electrical Symbols (Cont’d) PRESSURE SENDER - Provides a variable voltage proportional to pressure. (Sender voltage rating is listed to show volts at high and low setting.) PRESSURE SWITCH - Switch opens or closes at a predetermined pressure to active a function or to turn on a warning light. (Switch is shown in the open position.) TEMPERATURE SWITCH - The switch opens or closes at a predetermined temperature to active a function or to turn on a warning light. (Switch is shown in the closed position.) TEMPERATURE SENDER - Provides a variable resistance (ohm) signal proportional to temperature. (Sender ohm rating is listed to show ohms at high and low setting.) t 500-3000ohm B A o B A 0.5 - 7.5 V + - C B A B C A SYMBOL DESCRIPTION SENDERS AND SENSORS A B FUEL SENDER - Provides a variable resistance, based on the fuel level in the tank. (Sender ohm rating is listed to show ohms at full and empty setting.) 3 0 - 2 7 0 o h m B A HALL EFFECT SENSOR - Detects linear or rotary position and provides a proportional variable voltage. A C B SPEED SENSOR - magnetic pickup - detects RPM. B A 60-10-4 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Standard Cab Harness Connectors MS2824 C408 C500 C435-1 C435-2 SW1 C126 C434-1 C434-2 C479 C480 T13 T2 C499 C482 C503 C129 60-10-5 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Deluxe Cab Harness Connectors MS2827 C278 C676 C212 C126 C253 C279 C483 S3 T3 C129 C277 C449 C450 C611 C630 C635 C426 SW4 SW5 SW9 C252 C667 SW6 SW2 SW3 SW1 C499 C479 C670 C503 C482 C209 C434-1 T13 C500 C435-1 C435-2 C480 C434-2 T2 60-10-6 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Mainframe Harness Connectors MS2825 C 408C 350 FRC1 FC1 FC2 C362 J2A J1A C489 C497 J2B J1B C410 C411 C412 C404 C437 C425 C492 C493 C418 C421 C422 C409 C441 C419 C420 C108 C105 C355 C405 C446 C362 C423 C415 C486 C107 T12 C101 T11 C110 C426 C103 C104 T6 T1 T8 T10 T4 60-10-7 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Description Figure 60-10-1 The loader has a 12 volt, negative ground, alternator charging system. The electrical system is protected by fuses located in the operator cab (located under the operator cab in earlier models) and a 100 ampere master fuse [Figure 60-10-1] located under the air cleaner in the engine compartment. The fuses will protect the electrical system when there is an electrical overload. The reason for the overload must be found before starting the engine again. P-85472 P-13849 60-10-8 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Troubleshooting The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Operator’s Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-0807 PROBLEM CAUSE Battery will not take a charge. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 Alternator will not charge. 1, 2, 5 Starter will not turn the engine. 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9 KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE 1. Alternator belt is loose or damaged. 2. Battery connections are dirty or loose. 3. Battery is damaged. 4. The ground connection is not making a good contact. 5. The alternator is damaged. 6. The engine is locked. 7. The starter is damaged. 8. The wiring or solenoid is damaged. 9. Check the fuses. 60-10-9 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Fuse And Relay Location / Identification Earlier Models Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 60-10-2 The electrical system is protected from overload by fuses and relays located under three fuse panel covers (Item 1) [Figure 60-10-2]. Figure 60-10-3 Remove the covers to check or replace the fuses [Figure 60-10-3]. A decal is located inside the large cover to show location and amp ratings. A table is provided with details on amperage ratings and circuits affected by each fuse and relay. (See Fuse And Relay Location / Identification (Cont’d) on Page 60-10- 11.) Later Models Figure 60-10-4 The fuse / relay panels are located behind an access panel near the left foot pedal / footrest. Pull the panel at each end (Item 1) [Figure 60-10-4] to remove. Figure 60-10-5 The electrical system is protected from overload by fuses and relays located under three fuse panel covers (Item 1) [Figure 60-10-5]. P-85411 1 P-85412 P100414 1 P100415 1 60-10-10 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Fuse And Relay Location / Identification (Cont’d) Later Models (Cont’d) Figure 60-10-6 Remove the covers to check or replace the fuses [Figure 60-10-6]. A decal is located inside the access panel to show location and amperage ratings. Line up the clips on the back of the access panel with the slots provided and push the panel into place when finished [Figure 60-10-4]. A locating pin prevents the panel from being installed upside down. A table is provided with details on amperage ratings and circuits affected by each fuse and relay. (See Fuse And Relay Location / Identification (Cont’d) on Page 60-10- 11.) P100416 60-10-11 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM (CONT’D) Fuse And Relay Location / Identification (Cont’d) The location and amperage ratings are shown in the table below and on the decal above. Relays are identified by the letter “R” in the AMP column. REF ICON DESCRIPTION AMP REF ICON DESCRIPTION AMP REF ICON DESCRIPTION AMP 1 Alternator 15 11 Glow Plugs R 21 Bobcat Controller 25 2 Heater / HVAC 25 12 Fuel Shutoff R 22 ACS Controller 25 3 Front Lights 20 13 Cab Switched Power 5 23 Attachments 25 4 Rear Lights 15 14 Bucket Position 15 24 Not Used - - 5 Starter R 15 Wiper / Washer 25 25 Auxiliary Controller 25 6 Front Lights R 16 Switched Power & Back-up Alarm (Standard/ACS) 25 26 Drive Controller & Back-up Alarm (SJC) 25 7 Heater / HVAC R 17 Switched Power 25 27 Accessories & Front Horn 25 8 Rear Lights R 18 Switched Power 25 28 Power Port 15 9 Switched Power R 19 Traction 30 10 Traction R 20 Fuel Shutoff 30 6 7 19 18 5 17 11 13 15 8 10 20 12 14 16 9 1 2 3 4 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 60-10-12 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION (CONT’D) Solenoid Testing Figure 60-10-7 Use a test meter to measure coil resistance [Figure 60- 10-7]. Coil wires do not have polarity. Correct resistance for the pressure relief (small) coil is 7 - 10 ohm and the other coils 5 - 8 ohm. Replace the test meter with 12 volt power. You can see and hear the spool shift. P9175 60-20-1 S650 Service Manual BATTERY Removal And Installation WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Batteries contain acid which burns eyes and skin on contact. Wear goggles, protective clothing and rubber gloves to keep acid off body. In case of acid contact, wash immediately with water. In case of eye contact get prompt medical attention and wash eye with clean, cool water for at least 15 minutes. If electrolyte is taken internally drink large quantities of water or milk! DO NOT induce vomiting. Get prompt medical attention. W-2065-0807 Open the rear door. Figure 60-20-1 Disconnect the negative (-) cable (Item 1) [Figure 60-20- 1]. Remove the battery hold down clamp (Item 2) [Figure 60-20-1]. Disconnect the positive (+) cable (Item 3) [Figure 60-20- 1] from the battery. Remove the battery from the loader. Figure 60-20-2 Always clean the battery terminals and cable ends when installing a new or used battery [Figure 60-20-2]. When installing the battery in the loader, do not touch any metal parts with the battery terminals. Connect the negative (-) cable last to prevent sparks. Connect and tighten the battery cables. Install and tighten the battery hold down. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Keep arcs, sparks, flames and lighted tobacco away from batteries. When jumping from booster battery make final connection (negative) at machine frame. Do not jump start or charge a frozen or damaged battery. Warm battery to 60°F (16°C) before connecting to a charger. Unplug charger before connecting or disconnecting cables to battery. Never lean over battery while boosting, testing or charging. Battery gas can explode and cause serious injury. W-2066-0705 P-85473 1 2 3 P-09589 P-09590 60-20-2 S650 Service Manual BATTERY (CONT’D) Servicing Figure 60-20-3 The battery cables must be clean and tight [Figure 60- 20-3]. Check electrolyte level in the battery. Add distilled water as needed. Remove acid or corrosion from battery and cables with sodium bicarbonate (baking soda) and water solution. Put Bobcat Battery Saver or grease on the battery terminals and cable ends to prevent corrosion. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Batteries contain acid which burns eyes and skin on contact. Wear goggles, protective clothing and rubber gloves to keep acid off body. In case of acid contact, wash immediately with water. In case of eye contact get prompt medical attention and wash eye with clean, cool water for at least 15 minutes. If electrolyte is taken internally drink large quantities of water or milk! DO NOT induce vomiting. Get prompt medical attention. W-2065-0807 P-09589 P-09590 60-20-3 S650 Service Manual BATTERY (CONT’D) Using A Booster Battery (Jump Starting) If it is necessary to use a booster battery to start the engine, BE CAREFUL! There must be one person in the operator’s seat and one person to connect and disconnect the battery cables. The key switch must be OFF or the STOP button must be pressed. The booster battery must be 12 volt. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Keep arcs, sparks, flames and lighted tobacco away from batteries. When jumping from booster battery make final connection (negative) at machine frame. Do not jump start or charge a frozen or damaged battery. Warm battery to 60°F (16°C) before connecting to a charger. Unplug charger before connecting or disconnecting cables to battery. Never lean over battery while boosting, testing or charging. Battery gas can explode and cause serious injury. W-2066-0705 Figure 60-20-4 Connect the end of the first cable (Item 1) [Figure 60-20- 4] to the positive (+) terminal of the booster battery. Connect the other end of the same cable (Item 2) [Figure 60-20-4] to the positive terminal on the loader starter. Connect the end of the second cable (Item 3) [Figure 60- 20-4] to the negative terminal of the booster battery. Connect the other end of the same cable (Item 4) [Figure 60-20-4] to the engine. Keep cables away from moving parts. Start the engine. After the engine has started, remove the ground (-) cable (Item 4) [Figure 60-20-4] first. Remove the cable from the positive terminal (Item 2) [Figure 60-20-4]. IMPORTANT Damage to the alternator can occur if: • Engine is operated with battery cables disconnected. • Battery cables are connected when using a fast charger or when welding on the loader. (Remove both cables from the battery.) • Extra battery cables (booster cables) are connected wrong. I-2023-1285 P-85474 1 3 2 4 60-20-4 S650 Service Manual 60-30-1 S650 Service Manual ALTERNATOR Belt Adjustment The alternator belt is a special maintenance free type that is pretensioned over the pulleys. This belt eliminates the need for a tensioning device and does not require periodic adjustment. Contact your Bobcat dealer for replacement parts. Belt Replacement Stop the engine and open the rear door. Remove the air conditioning belt. (See REGULAR MAINTENANCE on Page 80-20-1.) Figure 60-30-1 Remove the belt shield mounting nuts and bolts (Item 1) and remove the belt shield (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-1]. Figure 60-30-2 Remove the cable bracket mounting nut and bolts (Item 1) and move the cable bracket (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-2] up slightly. Figure 60-30-3 Remove the top alternator mounting bolt (Item 1) and loosen the bottom alternator mounting bolt (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-3]. Move the alternator toward the engine as far as it will go and remove the belt from the pulleys. Inspect the pulleys for wear. Install new belt. Figure 60-30-4 Use a prybar (Item 1) [Figure 60-30-4] to move the alternator until the top alternator mounting bolt (Item 1) [Figure 60-30-3] can be installed. Tighten the top and bottom alternator mounting bolts (Items 1 and 2) [Figure 60-30-3]. Install the air conditioning belt. (See REGULAR MAINTENANCE on Page 80-20-1.) Install the cable bracket and belt shield. Close the rear door. P-90472 1 2 P-90521A 1 2 P-90474 2 1 P-90475 1 60-30-2 S650 Service Manual ALTERNATOR (CONT’D) Charging System Inspection WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Batteries contain acid which burns eyes and skin on contact. Wear goggles, protective clothing and rubber gloves to keep acid off body. In case of acid contact, wash immediately with water. In case of eye contact get prompt medical attention and wash eye with clean, cool water for at least 15 minutes. If electrolyte is taken internally drink large quantities of water or milk! DO NOT induce vomiting. Get prompt medical attention. W-2065-0807 WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Keep arcs, sparks, flames and lighted tobacco away from batteries. When jumping from booster battery make final connection (negative) at machine frame. Do not jump start or charge a frozen or damaged battery. Warm battery to 60°F (16°C) before connecting to a charger. Unplug charger before connecting or disconnecting cables to battery. Never lean over battery while boosting, testing or charging. Battery gas can explode and cause serious injury. W-2066-0705 IMPORTANT Damage to the alternator can occur if: • Engine is operated with battery cables disconnected. • Battery cables are connected when using a fast charger or when welding on the loader. (Remove both cables from the battery.) • Extra battery cables (booster cables) are connected wrong. I-2023-1285 If the charging system malfunctions check the following: Check the condition and tension of the alternator belt. (See Belt Adjustment on Page 60-30-1.) Replace belt if worn or deteriorated. Inspect the alternator wiring harness and connectors at alternator. Harness and connectors must be clean and tight. Check the fuse for the alternator in the fuse panel. If fuse is burned, find the cause and repair / replace. If fuse is in doubt, remove it and check for continuity. Check the electrolyte level in the battery. Add distilled water as needed. (Does not apply to maintenance free batteries.) Verify the charge of the battery. Make sure battery is fully charged. Disconnect the battery cables (negative first, then positive). Inspect the cable clamps and battery posts for corrosion. Remove acid or corrosion from the battery and cables with a sodium bicarbonate and water solution. Put grease on the cable ends and battery terminals to prevent corrosion. Reconnect the cable to the positive terminal. 60-30-3 S650 Service Manual ALTERNATOR (CONT’D) Alternator Voltage Testing Figure 60-30-5 Open rear door. Connect the remote start tool to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60- 1.) Turn the engine on with the remote start tool and run at idle. With a voltmeter, check the voltage between the B+ terminal and ground at the starter [Figure 60-30-5]. The voltage must be higher than 13.5 volts but lower than 14.7 volts at 21°C (70°F) (Alternator Temperature). If the voltage is higher that 14.7 volts, proceed to the following high voltage test. If the voltage is lower than 13.5 volts, run the engine at high idle and recheck voltage. If voltage is still below 13.5 volts, proceed with the following low voltage test. Low Voltage Testing Figure 60-30-6 Turn engine OFF and remove the L & S terminal connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-30-6] from the alternator. Turn the remote start tool key to the ON position. Figure 60-30-7 Check the voltage across the “L” terminal (Item 1) and ground (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-7]. The voltage should be what the battery voltage is. If not, check wire harness, relay and fuses. If the wire harness, relay and fuses are okay remove alternator for replacement or repair. P-85916 P-85914 1 P-85915 2 1 60-30-4 S650 Service Manual ALTERNATOR (CONT’D) High Voltage Testing Figure 60-30-8 Turn engine OFF and remove the L & S Terminal connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-30-6] off the alternator. Check the continuity between the “S” terminal (Item 1) [Figure 60-30-8] and the positive (+) terminal on the battery or starter terminal (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-8]. There should be continuity. If no continuity, replace wire harness. If voltage is still above 14.7 volts at 21°C (70°F) (Alternator Temperature), then remove alternator for replacement or repair. P-85917 1 2 60-30-5 S650 Service Manual ALTERNATOR (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Remove the air conditioning belt. (See Compressor Drive Belt Replacement on Page 80-20-2.) IMPORTANT Damage to the alternator can occur if: • Engine is operated with battery cables disconnected. • Battery cables are connected when using a fast charger or when welding on the loader. (Remove both cables from the battery.) • Extra battery cables (booster cables) are connected wrong. I-2023-1285 Figure 60-30-9 Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery. Disconnect the red wire (Item 1) [Figure 60-30-9] from the alternator which comes from the battery. Disconnect the wiring harness connector (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-9] from the alternator. Figure 60-30-10 Remove the alternator rain shield mounting nut and bolts (Item 1) and remove the alternator rain shield (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-10]. Figure 60-30-11 Remove the belt shield mounting nuts and bolts (Item 1) and remove the belt shield (Item 2) [Figure 60-30-11]. P-85914 1 2 P-85718 1 2 P-85609 1 2 60-30-6 S650 Service Manual ALTERNATOR (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 60-30-12 Remove the top alternator mounting bolt (Item 1) and the bottom alternator mounting bolt (Item 2) [Figure 60-30- 12]. Remove the belt and alternator from the loader. Parts Identification Figure 60-30-13 P-85611 2 1 C-3529B 1. Alternator 2. Nut 3. Pulley 4. Spacer 5. Bolt 6. Bracket 7. Bolt 8. Bearing 9. Retainer 10. Rotor 11. Bearing 12. Stator 13. Bracket 14. Sleeve 15. Regulator 16. Rectifier 17. Cover 18. Spacer 19. Nut 2 3 4 6 7 1 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 5 19 17 18 16 15 60-40-1 S650 Service Manual STARTER Testing Figure 60-40-1 The key switch must be in the OFF position. The battery must be at full charge. The cable connections on the battery must be clean and tight. Connect a jumper wire between S terminal and BAT terminal [Figure 60-40-1]. If the starter turns but does not turn the engine, the starter drive has a defect. Figure 60-40-2 Connect a jumper wire (of at least 4 gauge in size) between the M terminal and the BAT terminal [Figure 60- 40-2]. If the starter turns, the defect is in the solenoid. If the starter does not turn, the starter is defective. Removal And Installation Figure 60-40-3 Open the rear door. Disconnect the negative (-) cable from the battery. Disconnect the wires and positive (+) cable (Item 1) [Figure 60-40-3] from the starter solenoid. Installation: Tighten the nut to 14,7 - 16,7 N•m (10.8 - 12.3 ft-lb) torque. Disconnect the wire connector (Item 2) [Figure 60-40-3] from the two solenoid wires. Remove the three mounting bolts (Item 3) [Figure 60-40- 3]. Remove the starter from the engine. A-1992 Bat S M Cranking Motor A-1991 Bat S M Cranking Motor P-85857 1 2 3 3 60-40-2 S650 Service Manual STARTER (CONT'D) Parts Identification B-19824 1. Starter 2. Shaft 3. Gear 4. Washer 5. Shaft 6. Stop Ring 7. Lever 8. Holder 9. Spring 10. Spring 11. Plate 12. Seal 36 2 8 4 6 23 16 9 17 31 11 7 14 29 22 18 19 10 13 5 3 32 30 33 34 20 15 21 37 14 28 27 26 25 24 24. Yoke 25. Holder 26. Bracket 27. Ring 28. Bolt 29. Bolt 30. Switch 31. Seal 32. Bolt 33. Washer 34. Nut 35. Boot 36. Bracket 37. Bearing 35 1 23 13. Lever 14. Gear 15. Bracket 16. Spring 17. Gear 18. Stop 19. Stop Ring 20. Ball 21. Armature 22. Washer 23. Seal 12 60-50-1 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS Left Panel Figure 60-50-1 The left instrument panel [Figure 60-50-1] is the same for Standard Key Panel, Keyless Start Panel and Deluxe Instrumentation Panel equipped machines. The table on the facing page shows the DESCRIPTION and FUNCTION / OPERATION for each of the components of the left panel. P-90726B 1 4 5 6 7 8 3 2 13 9 10 11 12 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 60-50-2 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT’D) Left Panel (Cont’d) * See SYSTEM SETUP & ANALYSIS for Service Code description. (See DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES on Page 60- 90-1.) REF. NO. DESCRIPTION FUNCTION / OPERATION 1 ENGINE TEMPERATURE GAUGE Shows the engine coolant temperature. 2 LEFT DIRECTION INDICATOR (Option) Indicates left flasher signals are ON. 3 GENERAL WARNING Malfunction with one or more machine functions. (See Service Codes*) 4 TWO-SPEED (Option) High range selected. 5 ENGINE MALFUNCTION Engine malfunction or failure. (See Service Codes*) 6 ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE Engine coolant temperature high or sensor error. 7 DISPLAY SCREEN Displays information. (See Display Screen in this manual.) 8 SEAT BELT Instructs operator to fasten seat belt. Remains lit for 45 seconds. 9 SEAT BAR The light comes on when the seat bar is UP. 10 LIFT & TILT VALVE The light comes on when the lift and tilt functions cannot be operated. 11 PARKING BRAKE The light comes on when the loader cannot be driven. 12 RIGHT DIRECTION INDICATOR (Option) Indicates right flasher signals are ON. 13 SHOULDER BELT (Option) Instructs operator to fasten shoulder belt when operating in high range. Remains lit while in high range. 14 HYDRAULIC SYSTEM MALFUNCTION Hydraulic system malfunction or failure. (See Service Codes*) 15 FUEL Fuel level low or sensor error. 16 FUEL GAUGE Shows the amount of fuel in the tank. 17 LIGHTS Press once for FRONT work lights and REAR taillights. (Left green LED will light.) Press a second time to add REAR work lights. (Left and right green LEDs will light.) Press a third time to turn all lights off. (Left and right green LEDs will be off.) Press and hold five seconds to display software version in display screen. 18 HIGH-FLOW (Option) Press once to engage the HIGH-FLOW auxiliary hydraulics. (Left green LED will light.) Press a second time to disengage. 19 AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS Press once to activate the auxiliary hydraulic system. (Left green LED will light.) Press a second time to deactivate the system. 20 INFORMATION Cycles through (after each button press): • Hourmeter (On start up) • Engine RPM • Battery voltage • Maintenance clock (Press and hold for seven seconds when displayed to reset the maintenance clock.) • Service codes* 21 TRACTION LOCK OVERRIDE Functions only when the seat bar is raised and the engine is running. Press once to unlock the brakes. Allows you to use the steering levers or joystick(s) to move the loader forward or backward when using the backhoe attachment or for service. (See TRACTION LOCK OVERRIDE in this manual.) Press a second time to lock the brakes. 22 PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER Press to activate the BICS™ System when the seat bar is down and operator is seated in operating position. Button will light. Press and hold three seconds to engage Drive Response and Steering Drift Compensation. (See DRIVE RESPONSE and STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION in this manual.) 23 PARKING BRAKE (Standard on all loaders) Press the top to engage the Parking Brake. Press the bottom to disengage. (See PARKING BRAKE in this manual.) 60-50-3 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT’D) Display Screen The display screen can display the following information: • Operating hours. • Engine revolutions per minute (RPM). • Speed management setting. • Maintenance clock countdown. • Battery voltage. • Service codes. • Engine preheat countdown. • Steering drift compensation setting. • Drive response setting. Figure 60-50-2 The display screen is shown in [Figure 60-50-2]. The data display will show operating hours upon startup. 1. Data Display 2. Hourmeter 3. Speed Management 4. Engine Preheat 5. Engine Revolutions Per Minute 6. Battery / Charging Voltage 7. Service P-76461A 7 1 6 54 3 2 60-50-4 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT’D) Right Panel (Standard Key Panel) Figure 60-50-3 This machine may be equipped with a Standard Key Panel [Figure 60-50-3]. The Standard Key Panel has a key switch (Item 1) [Figure 60-50-9] used to turn the loader’s electrical system on and off, and to start and stop the engine. The switch location (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-3] can have different functions depending on machine configuration. See the following table for more information. REF. DESCRIPTION FUNCTION / OPERATION ADVANCED CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (Option) Press the top to select Hand Controls; bottom to select Foot Controls. P-85285 1 2 SELECTABLE JOYSTICK CONTROLS (SJC) (Option) Press the top to select ‘ISO’ Control Pattern; bottom to select ‘H’ Control Pattern. FOUR-WAY FLASHER LIGHTS (Option) Press the top to turn lights ON; bottom to turn OFF. ROTATING BEACON (Option) or STROBE LIGHT (Option) Press the top to turn light ON; bottom to turn OFF. REF. DESCRIPTION FUNCTION / OPERATION 60-50-5 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT’D) Right Panel (Keyless Start Panel) Figure 60-50-4 1. Keypad (keys 1 through 0): Used to enter a number code (password) to allow starting the engine. An asterisk will show in the left panel display screen for each key press. 2. LOCK Key: Used to lock keypad. The lock key will display a red light to indicate a password is required to start the loader. (See Password Lockout Feature on Page 60-191-1.) 3. UNLOCK Key: Used to unlock keypad. The unlock key will display a green light to indicate the loader can be started without a password. (See Password Lockout Feature on Page 60-191-1.) 4. START Button: Used to start the engine. 5. STOP Button: Used to stop the engine and shut down the loaders electrical system. 6. RUN Button: Used to turn on the loaders electrical system. The switch location (Item 7) [Figure 60-50-4] can have different functions depending on machine configuration. See the following table for more information. P-90819B 7 4 5 6 1 2 3 REF. DESCRIPTION FUNCTION / OPERATION ADVANCED CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (Option) Press the top to select Hand Controls; bottom to select Foot Controls. SELECTABLE JOYSTICK CONTROLS (SJC) (Option) Press the top to select ‘ISO’ Control Pattern; bottom to select ‘H’ Control Pattern. FOUR-WAY FLASHER LIGHTS (Option) Press the top to turn lights ON; bottom to turn OFF. ROTATING BEACON (Option) or STROBE LIGHT (Option) Press the top to turn light ON; bottom to turn OFF. 60-50-6 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT’D) Right Panel (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) Figure 60-50-5 This machine may be equipped with a Deluxe Instrumentation Panel [Figure 60-50-5]. 1. Keypad (1 through 0): The keypad has two functions: - To enter a number code (password) to allow starting the engine. - To enter a number as directed for further use of the display screen. 2. Display Screen: The Display Screen is where all system setup, monitoring and error conditions are displayed. 3. Scroll Buttons: Used to scroll through display screen choices. 4. ENTER Button: Used to make selections on the display screen. 5. START Button: Used to start the engine. 6. STOP Button: Used to stop the engine and shut down the loader’s electrical system. 7. RUN Button: Used to turn on the loader’s electrical system. The switch location (Item 8) [Figure 60-50-5] can have different functions depending on machine configuration. See the following table for more information. P-90212A 8 2 4 1 3 5 6 7 REF. DESCRIPTION FUNCTION / OPERATION ADVANCED CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (Option) Press the top to select Hand Controls; bottom to select Foot Controls. SELECTABLE JOYSTICK CONTROLS (SJC) (Option) Press the top to select ‘ISO’ Control Pattern; bottom to select ‘H’ Control Pattern. FOUR-WAY FLASHER LIGHTS (Option) Press the top to turn lights ON; bottom to turn OFF. ROTATING BEACON (Option) or STROBE LIGHT (Option) Press the top to turn light ON; bottom to turn OFF. 60-50-7 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANEL IDENTIFICATION (CONT’D) Right Panel (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) (Cont’d) Figure 60-50-6 The first screen you will see on your new loader will be as shown in [Figure 60-50-6]. When this screen is on the display you can enter the password and start the engine or change the default language. NOTE: Your new loader (with Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) will have an Owner Password. Your dealer will provide you with this password. Change the password to one that you will easily remember to prevent unauthorized use of your loader. Keep your password in a safe place for future needs. Change Language: Press the left or right scroll button to cycle through the languages. The language that is stopped on will be the default language used for the deluxe instrumentation panel [Figure 60-50-6]. The language can be changed at any time. (See CONTROL PANEL SETUP on Page 60-180-1.) Enter The Password: Use the numbers on the keypad to enter the password. Then press the [Enter] button a symbol will appear on the display screen for each number entered [Figure 60- 50-6]. The left scroll button can be used to backspace if an incorrect number is entered. If the correct password is not entered, [INVALID PASSWORD TRY AGAIN] will appear on the display screen and the password will have to be reentered. See CONTROL PANEL SETUP for further description of screens to setup the system for your use. (See CONTROL PANEL SETUP on Page 60-180-1.) NA3017 60-50-8 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT’D) Left Switch Panel Figure 60-50-7 This machine may be equipped with a Left Switch Panel [Figure 60-50-7]. Right Switch Panel Figure 60-50-8 This machine may be equipped with a Right Switch Panel [Figure 60-50-8]. REF . NO. DESCRIPTION FUNCTION / OPERATION 1 FOUR-WAY FLASHER LIGHTS (Option) Press the top to turn lights ON; bottom to turn OFF. 2 ROTATING BEACON (Option) or STROBE LIGHT (Option) Press the top to turn light ON; bottom to turn OFF. 3 HYDRAULIC BUCKET POSITIONING (Option) Press the top to engage Hydraulic Bucket Positioning; bottom to disengage. P-85319 1 2 3 REF . NO. DESCRIPTION FUNCTION / OPERATION 1POWER BOB-TACH (Option) Press and hold the up arrow to disengage the Bob-Tach wedges. Press and hold the down arrow to engage the Bob-Tach wedges into the attachment mounting frame holes. 2 NOT USED - - - P-85320 1 2 60-50-9 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT’D) Left Panel Removal And Installation Figure 60-50-9 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) and the fastener (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-9]. Installation: Be careful to not overtighten the instrument panel mounting bolts to prevent stripping of the threaded holes in the panels. Tighten the panel screws to 3 - 4 N•m (25 - 35 in-lb) torque. NOTE: Inspect and replace the seal as needed (Item 3) [Figure 60-50-9]. Figure 60-50-10 Pull the right instrument panel down and disconnect the wire harness connectors (Item 1) [Figure 60-50-10] from the panel. Remove the panel from the loader cab. Right Panel (Standard Key Panel) Removal And Installation Figure 60-50-11 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) and the fastener (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-11]. Installation: Be careful to not overtighten the instrument panel mounting bolts to prevent stripping of the threaded holes in the panels. Tighten the panel screws to 3 - 4 N•m (25 - 35 in-lb) torque. NOTE: Inspect and replace the seal as needed (Item 3) [Figure 60-50-11]. Figure 60-50-12 Pull the right instrument panel down and disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-50-12]. Remove the panel from the loader cab. P-85928 1 1 2 3 P-85930 1 1 1 P-85929 2 1 1 3 P-85931 1 60-50-10 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT'D) Right Panel (Keyless Start Panel) Removal And Installation Figure 60-50-13 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) and the fastener (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-13]. Installation: Be careful to not overtighten the instrument panel mounting bolts to prevent stripping of the threaded holes in the panels. Tighten the panel screws to 3 - 4 N•m (25 - 35 in-lb) torque. NOTE: Inspect and replace the seal as needed (Item 3) [Figure 60-50-13]. Figure 60-50-14 Pull the right instrument panel down and disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-50-14]. Remove the panel from the loader cab. Right Panel (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) Removal And Installation Figure 60-50-15 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) and the fastener (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-15]. Installation: Be careful to not overtighten the instrument panel mounting bolts to prevent stripping of the threaded holes in the panels. Tighten the panel screws to 3 - 4 N•m (25 - 35 in-lb) torque. NOTE: Inspect and replace the seal as needed (Item 3) [Figure 60-50-15]. Figure 60-50-16 Pull the right instrument panel down and disconnect the wire harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-50-16]. Remove the panel from the loader cab. P-90819A 2 1 1 3 P-90818A 1 P-90527 2 1 1 3 P-90530 1 60-50-11 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT'D) Key Switch Disassembly And Assembly Remove the right instrument panel. (See INSTRUMENT PANELS on Page 60-50-1.) Disconnect the key switch wiring harness. Figure 60-50-17 Remove the ignition key (Item 1) from the switch. Remove the ignition switch retaining nut (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-17] from the switch. Remove the ignition switch from the control panel. Alarm Disassembly And Assembly Remove the left instrument panel. (See Left Panel Removal And Installation on Page 60-50-9.) Figure 60-50-18 Remove the left side instrument panel. Remove the retaining nut (Item 1) [Figure 60-50-18] from the loader alarm. Remove the alarm from the loader instrument panel. P-85948 2 1 P-85947 1 60-50-12 S650 Service Manual INSTRUMENT PANELS (CONT'D) Left Switch Panel Removal And Installation Remove the left panel. (See Left Panel Removal And Installation on Page 60-50-9.) Figure 60-50-19 Remove the two fasteners (Item 1) [Figure 60-50-19]. Figure 60-50-20 Remove the fastener (Item 1) and the left side panel (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-20]. Right Switch Panel Removal And Installation Remove the right panel. (See Right Panel (Standard Key Panel) on Page 60-50-4.) Figure 60-50-21 Remove the two fasteners (Item 1) and the knob (item 2) [Figure 60-50-21]. Figure 60-50-22 Remove the fastener (Item 1) and the left side panel (Item 2) [Figure 60-50-22]. P-85945 1 1 P-85946 2 1 P-85943 2 1 1 P-85944 2 1 60-60-1 S650 Service Manual LIGHTS Front Removal And Installation Disconnect the negative(-) cable from the battery. (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-20-1.) Figure 60-60-1 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 60-60-1]. Installation: Tighten the two bolts to 22 - 27 N•m (40 - 45 in-lb) torque. Figure 60-60-2 Disconnect the bulbs (Item 1) [Figure 60-60-2] from the wire harness connectors. Figure 60-60-3 Figure 60-60-4 Remove the two bulbs (Item 1) [Figure 60-60-3] and [Figure 60-60-4] from the housing by turning bulb a 1/4 turn. NOTE: Two different light bulbs are used, take note when removing to assure correct installation. Reverse the above procedure to install the bulb. P-85433 1 1 P-85434 1 1 P-85436 1 1 P-85435 1 60-60-2 S650 Service Manual LIGHTS (CONT’D) Rear Removal And Installation Figure 60-60-5 Remove the bulb assembly (Items 1 and 2) from the light housing (Item 3) [Figure 60-60-5] by turning bulb assembly a 1/4 turn. Figure 60-60-6 Using care press the rear light and housing from the door [Figure 60-60-6]. Reverse this procedure for installation. Cab Light Removal And Installation Figure 60-60-7 Remove the screws (Items 1) [Figure 60-60-7] from the cab light. NOTE: Do not pull the cab light to far away from the headliner to prevent damage to the wires. Figure 60-60-8 Disconnect the cab light (Item 1) [Figure 60-60-8]. P-85438 1 2 3 P-85437 P-85274 1 1 P-85783 1 60-70-1 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) Description The Gateway controller is the main controller, it provides information to all other controllers. All loaders have a Gateway and Auxiliary controller. The Gateway and Auxiliary controller are located behind the access panel near the operators left foot. 60-70-2 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) (CONT’D) Connector Identification P-76622 P-76623 P-76624 J1A J1B 1 1 Harness Connector View Harness Connector View Gateway Controller 1 1 10 3 579 18 26 28 34 25 17 32 26 25 13 19 7 53 8 14 20 21 J1B J1A 34 26 60-70-3 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) (CONT’D) Connector Identification (Cont’d) J1A PIN WIRE NUMBER COLOR DESCRIPTION 1 2410 BLACK HYD LOCK VALVE SOLENOID GROUND 2 2380 BLACK LIFT SPOOL SOLENOID GROUND 3 8110 TAN FUEL RELAY SIGNAL 4 8000 TAN SWITCHED POWER RELAY SIGNAL 5 6320 PINK MRKR LIGHT PWR RELAY SIGNAL 6 8510 TAN GLOW PLUG RELAY SIGNAL 7 8210 TAN STARTER RELAY SIGNAL 8 4110 LGN TRACTION LOCK RELAY SIGNAL 9OPEN NA NA 10 2370 BLACK TILT SPOOL LOCK SOLENOID GROUND 11 7023 WHITE AC SIGNAL MONITOR 12 OPEN NA NA 13 4150 LGN TRACTION LOCK RELAY FEEDBACK 14 8550 TAN GLOW PLUG RELAY FEEDBACK 15 3600 LBL ENGINE SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL 16 3700 LBL AIR FILTER SENDER SIGNAL 17 6210 PINK REAR LIGHT RELAY SIGNAL 18 2910 BLACK HYDRAULIC FAN GROUND 19 9370 PURPLE PTOL LED 20 9380 PURPLE PTOL SWITCH 21 8020 TAN SWITCHED POWER RELAY FEEDBACK 22 8250 TAN STARTER RELAY FEEDBACK 23 3440 LBL HYD FAN DIFF PRESS SWITCH SIGNAL 24 9360 PURPLE START ENGINE 25 3520 LBL ENGINE OIL PRESS SENDER POWER 26 2350 BLACK TWO SPEED GROUND 27 2360 BLACK TWO SPEED MAKEUP GROUND 28 6230 PINK REAR LIGHT RELAY FEEDBACK 29 OPEN NA NA 30 8150 TAN FUEL RELAY FEEDBACK 31 6330 PINK MRKR LIGHT PWR RELAY FEEDBACK 32 3300 LBL HYD TEMP SIGNAL 33 OPEN NA NA 34 3430 LBL HYD FILTER DIFF PRESS 60-70-4 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) (CONT’D) Connector Identification (Cont’d) J1B PIN WIRE NUMBER COLOR DESCRIPTION 1 3420 LBL HYD CHARGE PRESS SENDER SIGNAL 2 1110 RED/WHT COMPUTER FUSE POWER OUT 3 1130 RED/WHT COMPUTER FUSE POWER OUT 4 8800 TAN FUEL SHUTOFF SOLENOID HOLD 5 4380 LGN LIFT SPOOL LOCK SOLENOID SIGNAL 6 4200 LGN TRACTION SOLENOID OUTPUT 7 4370 LGN TILT SPOOL LOCK SOLENOID SIGNAL 8 9210 PUR/WHT CAN LO 0 9 9110 PUR/WHT CAN HI 0 10 OPEN NA NA 11 3920 LBL SEATBAR SENSOR SIGNAL 12 3100 LBL FUEL SENDER SIGNAL 13 4410 LGN HYD LOCK SOLENOID SIGNAL 14 9500 PUR/WHT CAN HIGH 1 15 2500 BLACK COMPUTER GROUND 16 2510 BLACK COMPUTER GROUND 17 3010 LBL SENSOR GROUND 18 3200 LBL ENGINE COOLANT SENSOR SIGNAL 19 4010 LGN HYDRAULIC FAN SIGNAL 20 9600 PURPLE CAN LOW 1 21 9800 PURPLE REMOTE ATTACHMENT SIGNAL 22 9350 PURPLE RUN / ENTER 23 3400 LBL HYDRAULIC CHARGE PRESSURE 24 3930 LBL +5V SUPPLY 25 4360 LGN TWO SPEED MAKEUP 26 4350 LGN TWO SPEED SIGNAL 60-70-5 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) (CONT’D) Connector Identification P-76647 P-76646 P-76645 J2A J2B 1 1 Harness Connector View Harness Connector View Auxiliary Controller 1 1 10 3 579 18 26 28 34 25 17 32 26 25 13 19 7 53 8 14 20 21 J2B J2A 34 26 60-70-6 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) (CONT’D) Connector Identification (Cont’d) J2A PIN WIRE NUMBER COLOR DESCRIPTION 1 2340 BLACK FRONT BASE SOLENOID GROUND 2 2440 BLACK JEM BLOCK REAR BASE SOLENOID GROUND 3 6520 PINK LEFT BLINKER SIGNAL 4 6420 PINK RIGHT BLINKER SIGNAL 5 7200 WHITE HORN SIGNAL 6OPEN NA NA 7OPEN NA NA 8OPEN NA NA 9OPEN NA NA 10 2430 BLACK JEM BLOCK REAR ROD SOLENOID GROUND 11 4810 LGN LEFT HANDLE PADDLE RIGHT 12 4820 LGN LEFT HANDLE PADDLE LEFT 13 4910 LGN RIGHT HANDLE RIGHT ROCKER UP 14 OPEN NA NA 15 OPEN NA NA 16 OPEN NA NA 17 OPEN NA NA 18 2330 BLACK FRONT ROD SOLENOID GROUND 19 OPEN NA NA 20 4640 LGN FLOAT SIGNAL 21 OPEN NA NA 22 4830 LGN LEFT HANDLE RIGHT ROCKER DOWN 23 OPEN NA NA 24 OPEN NA NA 25 OPEN NA NA 26 2460 BLACK HIGH FLOW SOLENOID GROUND 27 OPEN NA NA 28 4840 LGN LEFT HANDLE RIGHT ROCKER UP 29 OPEN NA NA 30 4940 LGN RIGHT HANDLE LEFT ROCKER UP 31 4930 LGN RIGHT HANDLE LEFT ROCKER DOWN 32 OPEN NA NA 33 OPEN NA NA 34 OPEN NA NA 60-70-7 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) (CONT’D) Connector Identification (Cont’d) J2B PIN WIRE NUMBER COLOR DESCRIPTION 1OPENNA NA 2 1180 RED/WHT COMPUTER FUSE POWER OUT 3 1150 RED/WHT COMPUTER FUSE POWER OUT 4 4450 LGN DIVERTER SOLENOID SIGNAL 5 4440 LGN REAR BASE SIGNAL 6 4480 LGN FRONT / REAR AUXILIARY SIGNAL 7 4430 LGN REAR ROD SIGNAL 8 9220 PURPLE CAN LO 0 9 9120 PUR/WHT CAN HI 0 10 OPEN NA NA 11 OPEN NA NA 12 OPEN NA NA 13 4340 LGN FRONT BASE SOLENOID SIGNAL 14 OPEN NA NA 15 2550 BLACK AUXILIARY CONTROLLER GROUND 16 2540 BLACK AUXILIARY CONTROLLER GROUND 17 4310 LBL RIGHT HANDLE PWM LOW 18 4320 LBL RIGHT HANDLE PWM SIGNAL 19 4330 LGN FRONT ROD SOLENOID SIGNAL 20 OPEN NA NA 21 4920 LGN RIGHT HANDLE TRIGGER RETURN 22 1560 RNG SWITCHED INPUT POWER 23 4300 LGN RIGHT HANDLE PWM HIGH 24 OPEN NA NA 25 OPEN NA NA 26 4460 LGN HIGH FLOW SOLENOID SIGNAL 60-70-8 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the left inside access panel. (See Removal And Installation (Left) on Page 50-120-1.) Figure 60-70-1 Unplug the two harness connectors (Item 1) [Figure 60- 70-1] from the Gateway controller. Unplug the two harness connectors (Item 2) [Figure 60- 70-1] from the Auxiliary controller. NOTE: The connectors are keyed and will only plug in one way. Figure 60-70-2 Remove the controller mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 60-70-2] from the left fender. Installation: Tighten the controller mounting bolts to 16 - 19 N•m (12 - 14 ft-lb) torque. Remove the Gateway and Auxiliary controllers from the loader. P-85900 1 2 P-85901 1 1 1 1 60-71-1 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLER (ACS) Description The ACS controller is on loaders equipped with the ACS or the SJC option. This controller processes information for the lift and tilt functions. The ACS controller is housed in a grey colored plastic shell with black potting. The ACS controller communicates with the Bobcat Gateway Controller by CAN communication wires. The ACS controller is capable of receiving upgrades to the software. 60-71-2 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLER (ACS) (CONT’D) Connector And Wire Identification P/N PIN DESCRIPTION P/N PIN DESCRIPTION J1 CONNECTOR, METRI-PACK J3 CONNECTOR, METRI-PACK Orange A 5V HALL EFFECT SUPPLY Red A TILT ACTUATOR FORWARD Orange B SWITCHED ACS POWER Red/White B UNSWITCHED ACS POWER Green C HAND/FOOT INPUT Red/White C UNSWITCHED ACS POWER Purple D CAN SIGNAL HIGH ACS Black D LIFT ACTUATOR REVERSE Purple E CAN SIGNAL LOW ACS Green E HANDLE LOCK POWER Purple F CAN SHIELD ACS Red F LIFT ACTUATOR FORWARD Black G ACS GROUND Green G PEDAL LOCK POWER Black H ACS GROUND Black H ACS GROUND J2 CONNECTOR, METRI-PACK Black J ACS GROUND A OPEN Black K TILT ACTUATOR REVERSE BOPEN COPEN DOPEN Green E TILT SPOOL SIGNAL Green F LIFT HANDLE SIGNAL Green G TILT HANDLE SIGNAL Green H LIFT SPOOL SIGNAL Green J LIFT PEDAL SIGNAL Green K TILT PEDAL SIGNAL J1 J3 J2 J3 J2 J1 J1 J3 J2 B A H G C D E F B B A A H H G G C C D D E E F F J K J K P-21843 60-71-3 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLER (ACS) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 60-71-1 Unplug the harness connectors (Item 1) [Figure 60-71-1] from the controller. NOTE: The connectors are keyed and will only plug in one way. Figure 60-71-2 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 60-71- 2] from the controller. Remove the controller from the loader. NOTE: The calibration procedure must be followed when replacing a controller. (See Lift And Tilt Calibration (ACS) on Page 60-160-11.) P-85903 1 1 P-85902 1 60-71-4 S650 Service Manual 60-72-1 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLER (SJC) (DRIVE) Description The drive controller is only on loaders equipped with the SJC option. This controller processes information for the drive functions. The drive controller is located behind the right side access panel near the operator’s right foot. The drive controller monitors the position of the left joystick, pump swash plate angles and the output of the wheel speed sensors. The drive controller works along with the ACS controller and communicates with the main Bobcat controller in an SJC system. All these controllers are capable of software upgrades. The SJC system uses electronic joysticks to control both of the workgroups (lift and tilt) and the drive functions of the loader. The control can be switched from ISO and H- Pattern drive control layouts. The workgroup actuators are the same as those used on the ACS system. The hydrostatic drive pump is a Rexroth A22 unit. It has two electromagnetic coils on each of the two pumps to control the drive of the loader. The coils will direct the forward and reverse outputs of the pump to the drive motors. The Rexroth pump is equipped with position sensors mounted to the bottom of the swash plates to provide feedback to the controllers to sense uncommanded swash plate movement. NA1208 ENGINE GEAR PUMP DRIVE PUMP SPEED SENSOR HYDRAULIC MOTOR ACS CONTROL LIFT / TILT ACTUATORS SPEED SENSOR HYDRAULIC MOTOR ACD CONTROL GATEWAY CONTROL RIGHT JOYSTICK LEFT JOYSTICK AUXILIARY CONTROL DRIVE CONTROL RIGHT HAND PANEL LEFT HAND PANEL ISO SWITCH FWD / REV SWASH PLAT E SENSORS INTERNAL CAN BUS EXTERNAL CAN BUS SERIAL TT BUS 60-72-2 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLER (SJC) (DRIVE) (CONT’D) Connector Identification P-64295 60-72-3 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLER (SJC) (DRIVE) (CONT’D) Connector Identification (Cont'd) P-64296 60-72-4 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT CONTROLLER (SJC) (DRIVE) (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 60-72-1 Remove the three bolts (Item 1) [Figure 60-72-1] that secure the controller. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 16 - 19 N•m (12 - 14 ft-lb) torque. Figure 60-72-2 Remove the screw and wire harness (Item 1) [Figure 60- 72-2]. Installation: Tighten the connector screw to 3,39 - 3,96 N•m (30 - 35 in-lb) torque. DO NOT OVERTIGHTEN! Figure 60-72-3 Installation: Note the keyed hole in the controller socket. (Item 1) [Figure 60-72-3]. The keyed hole matches a tab on the connector on the wire harness. Figure 60-72-4 Remove the drive controller [Figure 60-72-4]. P-85879 1 1 P-64324 1 J S P-64325 1 P-64325 60-80-1 S650 Service Manual SPEED SENSORS (SJC) Description Figure 60-80-1 On SJC equipped loaders, the speed sensor [Figure 60- 80-1] is used by the loader’s controllers to sense if the drive motor is rotating. The end of the sensor is magnetic and counts the magnetic pulses as a rotating disc, attached to the motor carrier shaft, rotates by the sensor end. The speed sensor is sealed with an O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-1] to keep hydraulic oil inside the motor carrier and dirt out. Testing Figure 60-80-2 The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1609-Wheel Speed Sensor Test Harness [Figure 60-80-2] MEL1563 or 7003031-Remote Start Tool Kit Multimeter Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the remote start tool to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60- 1.) or (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) P-64765 1 P-28302 60-80-2 S650 Service Manual SPEED SENSORS (SJC) (CONT'D) Testing (Cont’d) Figure 60-80-3 Locate the speed sensor (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-3] on the top of the right or left hydrostatic motor carrier. Remove the transmission cover screw (Item 2) [Figure 60-80-3], to loosen the connector clamp. Installation: Tighten screw to 20 - 27 N•m (15 - 20 ft-lb) torque. Disconnect the speed sensor wire connector (Item 3) [Figure 60-80-3] from the loader harness wire connector. Figure 60-80-4 Connect the speed sensor test harness (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-4] in line, between the loader wiring harness and the speed sensor harness. Turn the remote start key to ON position without starting the loader. Take a voltage reading, with the multimeter, at the speed sensor test harness, between pin 1 and pin 3 (Item 2) [Figure 60-80-4]. The voltage should be approximately 5 volts. Repeat the procedure for the opposite side speed sensor. (If needed.) P-64762 1 3 2 P-64976 1 2 60-80-3 S650 Service Manual SPEED SENSORS (SJC) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation Figure 60-80-5 Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the two, speed sensor mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-5] from the top of the hydrostatic motor carrier. Remove the mount plate (Item 2) [Figure 60-80-5]. Figure 60-80-6 Remove the transmission cover screw (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-6], to loosen the connector clamp. Installation: Tighten screw to 20 - 27 N•m (15 - 20 ft-lb) torque. Disconnect the speed sensor electrical harness connector (Item 2) [Figure 60-80-6]. Figure 60-80-7 Lift the speed sensor (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-7] out from the motor carrier. DO NOT pull on the wires, gently pry up with a screwdriver if necessary. Figure 60-80-8 Remove the speed sensor [Figure 60-80-8]. P-64762 2 1 P-64762 2 1 P-64764 1 P-64765 60-80-4 S650 Service Manual SPEED SENSORS (SJC) (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 60-80-9 The electrical connector can be replaced. Remove the connector wedge (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-9]. Figure 60-80-10 With a thin screwdriver lift the tabs and remove the wires from the connector [Figure 60-80-10]. Wire Code 1 Red 2 White 3 Black 4 Blue Figure 60-80-11 Installation: Be sure to install the speed sensor (Item 1) [Figure 60-80-11] pointing toward the transmission case. Figure 60-80-12 Installation: The alignment pin (Item 1) at the bottom of the speed sensor must be installed in the hole (Item 2) [Figure 60-80-12] in the motor carrier. P-26293 1 P-26294 1 2 4 3 P-26292 1 P-26295 2 1 60-90-1 S650 Service Manual DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES Viewing Service Codes The Service Codes will aid your dealer in diagnosing conditions which can damage your machine. Figure 60-90-1 Press the INFORMATION button (Item 1) to cycle the DATA DISPLAY (Item 2) [Figure 60-90-1] until the service code screen is displayed. If more than one SERVICE CODE is present, the codes will scroll on the DATA DISPLAY. NOTE: Corroded or loose grounds can cause multiple service codes and / or abnormal symptoms. All instrument panel lights flashing, alarm sounding, headlights and taillights flashing, could indicate a bad ground. The same symptoms could apply if the voltage is low, such as loose or corroded battery cables. If you observe these symptoms, check grounds and positive leads first. Deluxe Instrumentation Panel The optional Deluxe Instrumentation Panel offers an additional view of service codes that includes a brief description. The last 40 codes stored in history can also be viewed using the Deluxe Instrumentation Panel. Figure 60-90-2 P-76455G 2 1 P-90378 / NA3025 / NA3000 / NA3038 / NA3035 Press a scroll butto n (Item 1) repeatedly unt il the Active Warning s screen icon (Inset) i s highlighted. 1 1 The ACTIVE WARNING S screen displays activ e service codes. Press [9 ] to view the next servic e code if more than one i s present. Press [4] t o display a history o f service codes. The WARNING S HISTORY screen will lis t the Service Cod e Number (CODE ), Hourmeter reading whe n the error occurre d (HOUR), and the Use r (USER) who was logge d in to operate the machin e when the error occurred. Press [9] to view the next eight Service Codes. A total of 40 Codes can be stored. When more than 4 0 codes occur, the oldest code will disappear and th e newest code will be in the number 1 position. Press the list numbe r next to the service cod e for more detail. Press left scroll button t o back up one screen. 60-90-2 S650 Service Manual DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES (CONT'D) Service Codes List Figure 60-90-3 Service Codes may be either a word (Item 1) or a number (Item 2) [Figure 60-90-3]. The following word errors may be displayed: [REPLY] One or both instrument panel(s) not communicating with the controller. [CODE] The controller is asking for a password. (Keyless Start and Deluxe Instrumentation Panels only.) [ERROR] The wrong password was entered. (Keyless Start and Deluxe Instrumentation Panels only.) [SHTDN] A shutdown condition exists. [DOOR] Operator cab door is open. (Lift and Tilt functions will not operate.) P-76461H P-76461P P-76455G 1 2 CODE DESCRIPTION CODE DESCRIPTION A3623 ACD not programmed A8503 ACD output ‘F’ error OFF A8002 ACD output ‘A’ error ON A8505 ACD output ‘F’ short to battery A8003 ACD output ‘A’ error OFF A8506 ACD output ‘F’ short to ground A8005 ACD output ‘A’ short to battery A8507 ACD output ‘F’ open circuit A8006 ACD output ‘A’ short to ground A8532 ACD output ‘F’ overcurrent A8007 ACD output ‘A’ open circuit A8602 ACD output ‘G’ error ON A8032 ACD output ‘A’ overcurrent A8603 ACD output ‘G’ error OFF A8102 ACD output ‘B’ error ON A8605 ACD output ‘G’ short to battery A8103 ACD output ‘B’ error OFF A8606 ACD output ‘G’ short to ground A8105 ACD output ‘B’ short to battery A8607 ACD output ‘G’ open circuit A8106 ACD output ‘B’ short to ground A8702 ACD output ‘H’ error ON A8107 ACD output ‘B’ open circuit A8703 ACD output ‘H’ error OFF A8132 ACD output ‘B’ overcurrent A8705 ACD output ‘H’ short to battery A8202 ACD output ‘C’ error ON A8706 ACD output ‘H’ short to ground A8203 ACD output ‘C’ error OFF A8707 ACD output ‘H’ open circuit A8205 ACD output ‘C’ short to battery A8206 ACD output ‘C’ short to ground D3905 Left joystick X-axis not in neutral A8207 ACD output ‘C’ open circuit D3907 Left joystick Y-axis not in neutral A8232 ACD output ‘C’ overcurrent D4007 Right joystick Y-axis not in neutral A8302 ACD output ‘D’ error ON D7501 CAN joystick communication error A8303 ACD output ‘D’ error OFF D7504 No communication from drive controller A8305 ACD output ‘D’ short to battery D7505 Left joystick X-axis not in neutral A8306 ACD output ‘D’ short to ground D7507 Left joystick Y-axis not in neutral A8307 ACD output ‘D’ open circuit D7508 Right joystick Y-axis not in neutral A8332 ACD output ‘D’ overcurrent D7509 Operating mode switch short to ground or battery A8402 ACD output ‘E’ error ON D7513 Right front wheel angle sensor unresponsive A8403 ACD output ‘E’ error OFF D7514 Left front wheel angle sensor unresponsive A8405 ACD output ‘E’ short to battery D7515 Right rear wheel angle sensor unresponsive A8406 ACD output ‘E’ short to ground D7516 Left rear wheel angle sensor unresponsive A8407 ACD output ‘E’ open circuit D7517 Left swash plate not in neutral A8432 ACD output ‘E’ overcurrent D7518 Right swash plate not in neutral A8502 ACD output ‘F’ error ON D7519 Left joystick X-axis out of range high 60-90-3 S650 Service Manual DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES (CONT'D) Service Codes List (Cont’d) CODE DESCRIPTION CODE DESCRIPTION D7521 Left joystick Y-axis out of range high D7572 Drive pump not calibrated D7522 Right joystick Y-axis out of range high D7573 Operating mode switch flipped while operating D7523 Right front wheel angle sensor out of range high D7574 Right wheel speed uncommanded motion D7524 Left front wheel angle sensor out of range high D7575 Left wheel speed uncommanded motion D7525 Right rear wheel angle sensor out of range high D7576 No communication from ACS controller D7526 Left rear wheel angle sensor out of range high D7577 Left speed sensor out of range high D7527 Left swash plate out of position D7578 Right speed sensor out of range high D7528 Right swash plate out of position D7579 Left speed sensor out of range low D7529 Left joystick X-axis out of range low D7580 Right speed sensor out of range low D7531 Left joystick Y-axis out of range low D7581 Right front steer retract short to battery D7532 Right joystick Y-axis out of range low D7582 Left front steer retract short to battery D7533 Right front wheel angle sensor out of range low D7583 Right rear steer retract short to battery D7534 Left front wheel angle sensor out of range low D7584 Left rear steer retract short to battery D7535 Right rear wheel angle sensor out of range low D7585 Sensor supply 1 out of range high D7536 Left rear wheel angle sensor out of range low D7586 Sensor supply 2 out of range high D7537 Sensor supply 1 out of range low D7587 Software update required D7538 Sensor supply 2 out of range low D7588 Switched power stuck ON D7539 Left swash plate sensor out of range high D7589 Switched power error OFF D7540 Left swash plate sensor out of range low D7591 Left swash plate sensor reversed D7541 Right swash plate sensor out of range high D7592 Right swash plate sensor reversed D7542 Right swash plate sensor out of range low D7593 Right speed sensor unresponsive D7543 Left forward drive solenoid error ON D7594 Left speed sensor unresponsive D7544 Left reverse drive solenoid error ON D7595 Left speed sensor reversed D7545 Right forward drive solenoid error ON D7596 Right speed sensor reversed D7546 Right reverse drive solenoid error ON D7597 Controller programmed D7547 Right front steer extend short to battery D7598 In drive calibration mode D7548 Left front steer extend short to battery D7599 In angle calibration mode D7549 Right rear steer extend short to battery D7550 Left rear steer extend short to battery H1221 Right Primary out of range high D7551 Steer pressure short to battery H1222 Right Primary out of range low D7552 Back-up alarm error ON H1224 Right Primary not in neutral D7553 Left forward drive solenoid error OFF H1321 Left Primary out of range high D7554 Left reverse drive solenoid error OFF H1322 Left Primary out of range low D7555 Right forward drive solenoid error OFF H1324 Left Primary not in neutral D7556 Right reverse drive solenoid error OFF H2005 Boost solenoid short to battery D7557 Right front steer extend short to ground H2006 Boost solenoid short to ground D7558 Right front steer retract short to ground H2007 Boost solenoid open circuit D7559 Left front steer extend short to ground H2032 Boost solenoid overcurrent D7560 Left front steer retract short to ground H2205 Pressure control solenoid short to battery D7561 Right rear steer extend short to ground H2206 Pressure control solenoid short to ground D7562 Right rear steer retract short to ground H2207 Pressure control solenoid open circuit D7563 Left rear steer extend short to ground H2232 Pressure control solenoid overcurrent D7564 Left rear steer retract short to ground H2305 Rear base solenoid short to battery D7565 Steer pressure short to ground H2306 Rear base solenoid short to ground D7566 Back-up alarm error OFF H2307 Rear base solenoid open circuit D7567 No communication from Gateway controller H2332 Rear base solenoid overcurrent D7568 Angle sensors not calibrated H2405 Rear rod solenoid short to battery D7569 Battery voltage out of range high H2406 Rear rod solenoid short to ground D7570 Interrupted power H2407 Rear rod solenoid open circuit D7571 Battery voltage out of range low H2432 Rear rod solenoid overcurrent 60-90-4 S650 Service Manual DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES (CONT'D) Service Codes List (Cont’d) CODE DESCRIPTION CODE DESCRIPTION H2505 Rear aux relief short to battery M0116 Air filter not connected H2506 Rear aux relief short to ground M0117 Air filter plugged H2507 Rear aux relief open circuit M0216 Hydraulic/Hydrostatic filter not connected H2605 Front base solenoid short to battery M0217 Hydraulic/Hydrostatic filter plugged H2606 Front base solenoid short to ground M0309 Battery voltage low H2607 Front base solenoid open circuit M0310 Battery voltage high H2632 Front base solenoid overcurrent M0311 Battery voltage extremely high H2705 Front rod solenoid short to battery M0314 Battery voltage extremely low H2706 Front rod solenoid short to ground M0322 Battery voltage out of range low H2707 Front rod solenoid open circuit M0409 Engine oil pressure low H2732 Front rod solenoid overcurrent M0414 Engine oil pressure extremely low H2805 Diverter rod solenoid short to battery M0415 Engine oil pressure shutdown H2806 Diverter rod solenoid short to ground M0421 Engine oil pressure out of range high H2807 Diverter rod solenoid open circuit M0422 Engine oil pressure out of range low H2905 High-flow solenoid short to battery M0509 Hydraulic charge pressure low H2906 High-flow solenoid short to ground M0510 Hydraulic charge pressure high H2907 High-flow solenoid open circuit M0511 Hydraulic charge pressure extremely high H2932 High-flow solenoid overcurrent M0514 Hydraulic charge pressure extremely low H3028 Controller memory failure M0515 Hydraulic charge pressure shutdown H3128 Interrupted power failure M0521 Hydraulic charge pressure out of range high H3648 ACD multiple M0522 Hydraulic charge pressure out of range low H3913 Left joystick grip no communication M0610 Engine speed high H3916 Left joystick not connected M0611 Engine speed extremely high H3928 Left joystick failure M0613 Engine speed no signal H3948 Left joystick multiple M0615 Engine speed shutdown H4013 Right joystick grip no communication M0618 Engine speed out of range H4016 Right joystick not connected M0710 Hydraulic oil temperature high H4028 Right joystick failure M0711 Hydraulic oil temperature extremely high H4048 Right joystick multiple M0715 Hydraulic oil temperature shutdown H4302 Horn error ON M0721 Hydraulic oil temperature out of range high H4303 Horn error OFF M0722 Hydraulic oil temperature out of range low H4423 Auxiliary not programmed M0810 Engine coolant temperature high H4502 Right signal error ON M0811 Engine coolant temperature extremely high H4503 Right signal error OFF M0815 Engine coolant temperature shutdown H4602 Left signal error ON M0821 Engine coolant temperature out of range high H4603 Left signal error OFF M0822 Engine coolant temperature out of range low H4721 Sensor supply 1 out of range high M0909 Fuel level low H4722 Sensor supply 1 out of range low M0921 Fuel level out of range high H7314 Remote control failure M0922 Fuel level out of range low H7328 Remote control no signal M1016 Hydraulic charge filter not connected H7404 Main controller no communication M1017 Hydraulic charge filter plugged H7604 Left hand panel no communication M1121 Seat bar sensor out of range high M1122 Seat bar sensor out of range low L0102 Left panel button 1 error ON M1305 Fuel hold solenoid short to battery L0202 Left panel button 2 error ON M1306 Fuel hold solenoid short to ground L0302 Left panel button 3 error ON M1307 Fuel hold solenoid open circuit L0402 Left panel button 4 error ON M1402 Fuel pull output error ON L7404 Left panel main controller no communication M1403 Fuel pull output error OFF L7672 Left panel programming error M1407 Fuel pull output open circuit M1428 Fuel pull output failure 60-90-5 S650 Service Manual DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES (CONT'D) Service Codes List (Cont’d) CODE DESCRIPTION CODE DESCRIPTION M1502 Traction lock pull output error ON M3805 Auxiliary hydraulic lock short to battery M1503 Traction lock pull output error OFF M3806 Auxiliary hydraulic lock short to ground M1507 Traction lock pull output open circuit M3807 Auxiliary hydraulic lock open circuit M1528 Traction lock pull output failure M3832 Auxiliary hydraulic lock overcurrent M1605 Traction lock hold solenoid short to battery M4109 Alternator low M1606 Traction lock hold solenoid short to ground M4110 Alternator high M1607 Traction lock hold solenoid open circuit M4304 Keyless panel no communication M1705 Hydraulic lock valve solenoid short to battery M4404 Auxiliary no communication M1706 Hydraulic lock valve solenoid short to ground M4621 5 volt sensor supply out of range high M1707 Hydraulic lock valve solenoid open circuit M4622 5 volt sensor supply out of range low M1732 Hydraulic lock valve solenoid overcurrent M4721 8 volt sensor supply out of range high M1805 Lift spool lock short to battery M4722 8 volt sensor supply out of range low M1806 Lift spool lock short to ground M4802 Front light relay error ON M1807 Lift spool lock open circuit M4803 Front light relay error OFF M1832 Lift spool lock overcurrent M4807 Front light relay open circuit M2005 Two-speed primary short to battery M4902 Rear light relay error ON M2006 Two-speed primary short to ground M4903 Rear light relay error OFF M2007 Two-speed primary open circuit M4907 Rear light relay open circuit M2032 Two-speed primary overcurrent M5002 Front light output error ON M2102 Glow plug output error ON M5003 Front light output error OFF M2103 Glow plug output error OFF M5007 Front light output open circuit M2107 Glow plug output open circuit M5028 Front light output failure M2128 Glow plug output failure M5102 Rear light output error ON M2202 Starter output error ON M5103 Rear light output error OFF M2203 Starter output error OFF M5107 Rear light output open circuit M2207 Starter output open circuit M5128 Rear light output failure M2228 Starter output failure M5202 PTOL switch error ON M2302 Starter relay error ON M5221 PTOL switch out of range high M2303 Starter relay error OFF M5222 PTOL switch out of range low M2402 Fuel pull relay error ON M5305 PTOL LED short to battery M2403 Fuel pull relay error OFF M5306 PTOL LED short to ground M2502 Traction pull relay error ON M5405 Tilt spool lock short to battery M2503 Traction pull relay error OFF M5406 Tilt spool lock short to ground M2602 Glow plug relay error ON M5407 Tilt spool lock open circuit M2603 Glow plug relay error OFF M5432 Tilt spool lock overcurrent M2721 Throttle primary out of range high M6402 Switched power relay error ON M2722 Throttle primary out of range low M6403 Switched power relay error OFF M2821 Throttle secondary out of range high M6505 EEC power short to battery M2822 Throttle secondary out of range low M6506 EEC power short to ground M3128 Interrupted power failure M6507 EEC power open circuit M3204 Workgroup no communication M6604 EEC power no communications M3304 Deluxe panel no communication M7002 Switched power output error ON M3505 Hydraulic fan short to battery M7003 Switched power output error OFF M3506 Hydraulic fan short to ground M7007 Switched power output open circuit M3507 Hydraulic fan open circuit M7028 Switched power output failure M3532 Hydraulic fan overcurrent M7102 Electric fan 1 output error ON M3705 Two-speed secondary short to battery M7103 Electric fan 1 output error OFF M3706 Two-speed secondary short to ground M7128 Electric fan 1 output failure M3707 Two-speed secondary open circuit M7202 Electric fan 1 relay error ON M3732 Two-speed secondary overcurrent M7203 Electric fan 1 relay error OFF 60-90-6 S650 Service Manual DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES (CONT'D) Service Codes List (Cont’d) CODE DESCRIPTION CODE DESCRIPTION M7207 Electric fan 1 relay open circuit W3251 Lift actuator short to battery M7304 Remote control no communication W3252 Tilt actuator short to battery M7316 Remote control no signal from transmitter W3253 Lift handle / pedal short to ground M7423 Main controller not programmed W3254 Tilt handle / pedal short to ground M7472 Main controller in boot code W3255 Lift handle / pedal short to battery M7497 Main controller software updated W3256 Tilt handle / pedal short to battery M7504 Drive no communication W3257 Lift actuator reduced performance M7604 Left display panel no communication W3258 Tilt actuator reduced performance M7748 Key switch multiple W3259 Lift actuator wrong direction M7839 Hourmeter changed W3260 Tilt actuator wrong direction M7974 Door open W3261 Handle lock short to ground W3262 Handle lock short to battery W3223 ACS calibration required W3263 Pedal lock short to ground W3224 ACS calibration failed W3264 Pedal lock short to battery W3231 Tilt actuator fault W3265 Sensor supply voltage out of range W3232 Tilt actuator wiring fault W3266 Battery voltage out of range W3233 Tilt handle wiring fault W3267 Handle/pedal switch flipped while operating W3234 Tilt actuator not in neutral W3268 Lift handle information error W3235 Tilt handle / pedal not in neutral W3270 Right hand drive short to ground W3236 Lift actuator fault W3271 Right hand drive short to battery W3237 Lift actuator wiring fault W3274 Left joystick X-axis out of range W3238 Lift handle wiring fault W3275 Interrupted unswitched power W3239 Lift actuator not in neutral W3276 CAN joystick information error W3240 Lift handle / pedal not in neutral W3277 Remote control information error W3241 No communication W3905 Left joystick X-axis not in neutral W3249 Lift actuator short to ground W4005 Right joystick X-axis not in neutral W3250 Tilt actuator short to ground W4007 Right joystick Y-axis not in neutral 60-100-1 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT INTERLOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (BICS) Description Figure 60-100-1 The Bobcat Interlock Control System is an electronic system that is used to protect the operator. The system consists of the traction lock, seat bar sensor and the lift and tilt lockouts solenoid. These all have indicator lights on the left panel (Items 1, 2, 3) [Figure 60-100-1] of the loader cab. The Press To Operate button (Items 4) [Figure 60-100-1] activates the system and allows the operator to function the loader. P-85413C 1 2 3 34 60-100-2 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT INTERLOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (BICS) (CONT'D) Inspecting The BICS (Engine STOPPED - Key ON) Figure 60-100-2 1. Sit in operator’s seat. Turn key to RUN or press RUN button. Lower seat bar and disengage parking brake. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button (Item 6). Two BICS™ lights (Items 1 and 2) [Figure 60-100-2] [SEAT BAR AND LIFT & TILT VALVE] on left instrument panel must be OFF. The PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button will light. 2. Raise seat bar fully. All three BICS™ lights (Items 1, 2 and 3) [Figure 60-100-2] [SEAT BAR, LIFT & TILT VALVE and PARKING BRAKE] on left instrument panel must be ON. The PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button light will turn OFF. Inspecting Deactivation Of The Auxiliary Hydraulics System (Engine STOPPED - Key ON) 3. Sit in operator’s seat, lower seat bar and press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button (Item 6). Press the auxiliary hydraulics button (Item 5). The auxiliary hydraulics light will be ON (Item 4) [Figure 60-100-2]. Raise the seat bar. The light must be OFF. Inspecting The Seat Bar Sensor (Engine RUNNING) 4. Sit in operator’s seat, lower seat bar, engage parking brake and fasten seat belt. 5. Start engine and operate at low idle. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button. While raising the lift arms, raise the seat bar fully. The lift arms must stop. Repeat using the tilt function. Inspecting The Traction Lock (Engine RUNNING) 6. Fasten seat belt, disengage parking brake, press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button and raise seat bar fully. Move steering levers or joystick(s) slowly forward and backward. The TRACTION lock must be engaged. Lower the seat bar. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button. 7. Engage parking brake and move steering levers or joystick(s) slowly forward and backward. The TRACTION lock must be engaged. NOTE: The PARKING BRAKE light on the left instrument panel will remain ON until the engine is started, the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button is pressed and the parking brake is disengaged. Inspecting The Lift Arm Bypass Control 8. Raise the lift arms 2 m (6 ft) off the ground. Stop engine. Turn lift arm bypass control knob clockwise 1/ 4 turn. Pull up and hold lift arm bypass control knob until lift arms slowly lower. Inspecting Deactivation Of Lift And Tilt Functions (ACS And SJC) 9. Sit in operator’s seat and fasten seat belt. Lower seat bar, start engine and press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button. 10. Raise lift arms about 2 m (6 ft) off the ground. 11. Turn key OFF or press STOP button and wait for the engine to come to a complete stop. 12. Turn key ON or press RUN button. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button, move the control (foot pedal, hand control or joystick) to lower the lift arms. Lift arms must not lower. 13. Move the control (foot pedal, hand control or joystick) to tilt the bucket (or attachment) forward. The bucket (or attachment) must not tilt forward. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH The Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS) must deactivate the lift, tilt and traction drive functions. If it does not, contact your dealer for service. DO NOT modify the system. W-2151-0394 P-85413C 5 1 2 3 6 4 60-100-3 S650 Service Manual BOBCAT INTERLOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (BICS) (CONT'D) Troubleshooting The following troubleshooting guide is provided for assistance in locating and correcting BICS system problems. It is recommended that these procedures be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. WARNING Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to make correct repairs or adjustments can cause injury or death. W-2004-1285 PROBLEM SOLUTION# All indicator lights flashing. 5 One of the indicator lights flashing. 1 Intermittent indicator lights. 2, 3, 4 SOLUTION SUGGESTIONS 1. Refer to BICS troubleshooting chart. 2. Check wire connections on Bobcat controller to make sure connectors are locked into place. 3. Check pins in connectors for pins pushed back or bent. 4. Use seatbar sensor tester MEL1428 to isolate problem between sensor and controller and wiring. 5. Possible low or high voltage. 60-100-4 S650 Service Manual 60-110-1 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR SENSOR Description The seat bar sensor is part of the BICS system. The seat bar sensor sends a signal that indicates whether the seat bar is in the down or up position. The sensor is located on the left side of seat bar. Troubleshooting The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting BICS system problems. It is recommended that these procedures be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. WARNING Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to make correct repairs or adjustments can cause injury or death. W-2004-1285 PROBLEM SOLUTION # Indicator light does not come ON when seat bar is lowered. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 SOLUTION SUGGESTIONS 1. Check sensor wire connection. 2. Use the BICS sensor tester MEL1428 with seat bar adapter MEL1567 to check sensor and controller. 3. Check for loose hardware. 4. Check keyed bushing to make sure magnet collar rotates with seat bar. 5. Check magnet collar magnets for contamination such as metal particles. 60-110-2 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR SENSOR (CONT'D) Testing Figure 60-110-1 Use Sensor Tester (MEL1428) and seat bar sensor tester adapter (MEL1567) for the following procedure: Connect the seat bar adapter sensor leads (MEL1567) to the sensor tester. Disconnect the seat bar sensor connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-1]. Figure 60-110-2 Connect the Sensor Tester (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-2] inline, to the seat bar sensor connectors. [Figure 60-110- 2]. Turn the key to the ON position. DO NOT START THE ENGINE. The toggle switch (Item 2) [Figure 60-110-3] can be in either the Absent or Present position. Figure 60-110-3 If there is no power light (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-3] on the sensor tester, check the tester or wiring harness. Figure 60-110-4 Lower the seat bar. The Sensor Test light (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-4] should illuminate. Raise the seat bar. The Sensor Test light (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-4] should go off. If the above test fails, there is a problem with the seat bar sensor. Disconnect the Sensor Tester. Replace the Seat Bar Sensor. (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-110-3.) If the above test passes, run the seat bar sensor BICS circuit test. (See Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS) Circuit Test on Page 60-110-4.) P-85653 1 P-85925 1 P-4698 2 1 P-4699 1 60-110-3 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR SENSOR (CONT'D) Removal And Installation Remove the seat bar from the loader. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-10-1.) Figure 60-110-5 Remove the mounting bolt (Item 1) from the seat bar mount (Item 2) [Figure 60-110-5]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolt to 5,6 - 7,9 N•m (50 - 70 in-lb) torque. Remove the sensor mounting bolt (Item 3) [Figure 60- 110-5] and nut. Figure 60-110-6 Remove the keyed plastic bushing (Item 1) magnetic bushing assembly (Item 2) and sensor bracket (Item 3) [Figure 60-110-6]. IMPORTANT Be careful to not overtighten the sensor mounting bolt and nut to prevent breakage of the sensor. I-2088-1095 Installation: Be sure the tabs on the pivot bushing are positioned in the slotted hole (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-6] of the seat bar. Inspect all parts for damage and wear and replace if necessary. Reverse the removal procedure to install the seat bar sensor. N-19219 1 2 3 N-19383 1 2 3 60-110-4 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR SENSOR (CONT'D) Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS) Circuit Test Figure 60-110-7 Use Sensor Testers (MEL1428) and seat bar sensor tester adapter (MEL1567) for the following procedure: Connect the seat bar sensor tester adapter MEL1567 to the sensor tester. Disconnect the seat bar sensor connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-7]. Figure 60-110-8 Connect Sensor Tester (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-8] inline to the seat bar sensor connectors. Turn the key to the ON position. DO NOT START THE ENGINE. If there is no power light on the sensor tester, check the tester or wiring harness. When the power light is illuminated, move the toggle switch (Item 2) [Figure 60-110-8] on the sensor tester to the Present position. NOTE: The sensor test light (Item 3) [Figure 60-110-8] is only activated by the seat bar. It will be off with the seat bar up or on with the seat bar down. P-85653 1 P-4703 3 2 1 60-110-5 S650 Service Manual SEAT BAR SENSOR (CONT'D) Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS) Circuit Test (Cont’d) Figure 60-110-9 The BICS seat bar indicator light (Item 1) [Figure 60-110- 9] should illuminate. Figure 60-110-10 Move the toggle switch (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-10] on the sensor tester to the Absent position. The Seat Bar light (Item 1) [Figure 60-110-9] should go off. If the above test fails, there is a problem with the Bobcat controller or the wiring harness. P-85413 1 P-4699 1 60-110-6 S650 Service Manual 60-120-1 S650 Service Manual TRACTION LOCK Description The Traction Lock Control System will lock the traction drive system when the engine stops. The Traction Lock Control System is incorporated into the Bobcat Interlock Control System (BICS). 60-120-2 S650 Service Manual TRACTION LOCK (CONT'D) Troubleshooting The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting BICS system problems. It is recommended that these procedures be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. WARNING Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Failure to make correct repairs or adjustments can cause injury or death. W-2004-1285 SOLUTION SUGGESTIONS 1. Make sure brake switch is not engaged. 2. Check the display for an error code. 3. If all lights indicate the brake should be released, but it doesn’t, check the brake 30 amp fuse. 4. When checking fuse, also check other fuses. Check the fuse block for correct orientation and location of fuses. (See Electrical System, Information Page 60-01.) 5. To test the solenoid, the coil should be about 9.8 ohm. 6. Check brake solenoid wiring voltage, solenoid wiring should read 12 volts. 7. Check the brake solenoid mounting nut for correct torque. 8. Check wire connections for loose connector body. 9. Check for loose or bent pins in connectors. 10. Check for loose spade connectors in fuse holder. 11. Check the flywheel RPM sensor and wiring. PROBLEM SOLUTION # Brake stays engaged. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7,11 Intermittent activation of brake. 8, 9, 10,11 60-120-3 S650 Service Manual TRACTION LOCK (CONT'D) Inspecting Figure 60-120-1 Fasten the seat belt, disengage the parking brake button, press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER Button (Item 1) and raise the Seat Bar fully. Move the steering levers slowly forward and backward. The TRACTION lock (Item 4) should be engaged. Lower the Seat Bar. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER Button (Item 1) [Figure 60-120-1]. Engage the parking brake pedal and move the steering levers slowly forward and backward. The TRACTION lock should be engaged. NOTE: The TRACTION light on the left instrument panel will remain ON until the engine is started, the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER Button is pressed and the parking brake is disengaged. Figure 60-120-2 Check the wire connections at the engine speed sensor (Item 1) [Figure 60-120-2]. Check the adjustment of the flywheel speed sensor and replace the speed sensor if needed. (See Adjustment on Page 60-170-2.) NOTE: When the Traction Lock Override Button is activated, the Traction Lock Override Control System will NOT engage the Traction Lock if the engine stops. P-85413 1 P-85923 1 60-120-4 S650 Service Manual 60-130-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) Description The ACS option allows the operator to quickly switch between foot and hand control modes. It uses the electric actuators to control the lift and tilt spools, foot sensors, handle sensors and a specially designed control handle. 60-130-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Troubleshooting The Advanced Control System (ACS) has a built-in diagnostic function to indicate the condition of the ACS controller. The ACS controller continually monitors the lift handle sensor, lift actuator, tilt handle sensor, and the tilt actuator. The controller also records alarm condition(s) as service code(s). To see what error occurred. (See DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES on Page 60-90-1.) 60-130-3 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Handle Sensor Connector Disassembly And Assembly Figure 60-130-1 The wire connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-1] can be removed from the handle sensor wires, use the following procedure. Figure 60-130-2 Remove the wedge (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-2] from the connector. Figure 60-130-3 With a pointed tool, lift the tab (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-3] and pull the wire from the connector. Installation: Install the wires into the connector as listed below [Figure 60-130-3]: 1-Terminal - Red 2-Terminal - Black 3-Terminal - Green P16578 1 P13732 1 1 P13725 1 P13725 1 P13733 1 3 1 2 60-130-4 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Switch Handle Removal Figure 60-130-4 NOTE: Switch handle can be removed and installed while in loader. Disconnect the harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 60- 130-4] from the handle sensor connector. Disconnect the harness connector (Item 2) [Figure 60- 130-4] from the handle lock solenoid connector. Figure 60-130-5 Remove the wedge (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-5] from the harness connector (Gray) that connects to the handle sensor connector. Figure 60-130-6 Using a pointed tool, press down on the tab (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-6] and pull the wire from the connector. Figure 60-130-7 Remove the wedge (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-7] from the harness connector (Black) that connects to the handle lock solenoid connector. P-21879 1 2 P13732 1 P13725 1 P13735 1 3 1 2 P13732 1 P13725 1 60-130-5 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Switch Handle Removal (Cont'd) Figure 60-130-8 Use a pointed tool, press down on the tab (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-8] and pull the wire from the connector. Figure 60-130-9 Disconnect the right switch handle connectors (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-9] from the loader wiring harness connectors. Figure 60-130-10 Disconnect the left switch handle connectors (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-10] from the loader wiring harness connectors. Figure 60-130-11 Roll the pistol grip handle cover (Item 1) [Figure 60-130- 11] down. Using a small screwdriver, lift the handle tabs (Item 2) [Figure 60-130-11] and slightly rotate the switch handle. P13735 1 3 1 2 P-90995 1 P-90994 1 1 1 N-22783 1 2 2 60-130-6 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Switch Handle Removal (Cont'd) Figure 60-130-12 Pull the switch handle and wiring harness assembly (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-12] from the control lever. Cut the wires (Item 2) [Figure 60-130-12] below the switch handle and remove switch handle. NOTE: Only cut the wires if the switch handle is bad and needs replacement. If the switch handle is good and just needs to be removed for control handle or lever replacement, then remove the connectors on the end of the harness and pull switch handle up out of lever tube. Figure 60-130-13 Pull harness (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-13] out the bottom of the control lever tube. Switch Handle Installation Figure 60-130-14 When installing the new switch handle, tape the wire terminals together. The switch handle comes with a 6 inch piece of heat shrink tube side on the end of the wires. Remove the heat shrink tube from the end of the wires before routing through handle and control lever tube. NOTE: Leave all the other heat shrink tube on the wires for protection. Tape half of the wires back and half forward [Figure 60- 130-14] to keep the harness small enough to route through the control lever tube. N-22784 1 P-24233 2 P-90996 1 P-21699 Tape back 1/2 of Wires Tape 1/2 of Wires 60-130-7 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Switch Handle Installation (Cont’d) Figure 60-130-15 Install the new switch handle and wires from the top of the control lever. Route wire (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-15] through the casting, along side the handle sensor and into the control lever tube. NOTE: Do not pull the wire harness tight, allow a small amount of slack or slight bend at the handle pivot area. Verify the control handle returns to neutral position. Figure 60-130-16 Remove tape from wires for installation and install the 6 inches of heat shrink tube (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-16] approximately 3 inches into the control lever. Apply heat to the exposed heat shrink tube. Inspect the wire terminal tabs (Item 2) [Figure 60-130- 16] and re-bend tabs if necessary. Install the wires into the connectors as listed below: Right Switch Handle Ten-Pin Connector A-Terminal - Orange B-Terminal - White C-Terminal - White/Black D-Terminal - White/Red E-Terminal - Dk. Green F-Terminal - White/Lt. Green G-Terminal - Yellow/Red H-Terminal - Lt. Green J-Terminal - Yellow K-Terminal - Orange/Black Three-Pin Connector A-Terminal - Red/White B-Terminal - Black/White C-Terminal - Purple/White Left Switch Handle Ten-Pin Connector A-Terminal - Orange B-Terminal - Dk. Blue C-Terminal - White D-Terminal - Purple E-Terminal - Yellow/Red F-Terminal - Tan G-Terminal - Pink H-Terminal - Orange/Black J-Terminal - Blank K-Terminal - Blank Three-Pin Connector A-Terminal - Red/White B-Terminal - Black/White C-Terminal - Purple/White Two-Pin Connector A-Terminal - Black B-Terminal - Red Five-Pin Connector A-Terminal - Dk. Green B-Terminal - Brown C-Terminal - Blank D-Terminal - Yellow E-Terminal - Blank P-21700 1 P-21695 2 1 60-130-8 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Switch Handle Installation (Cont'd) Figure 60-130-17 Figure 60-130-18 Connect the handle harness connectors (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-17] and [Figure 60-130-18] to the loader harness connectors. Figure 60-130-19 Install the wires into the connectors as listed below: Left and Right Control Lever Switch Handle [Figure 60- 130-19] 1-Terminal - Red/White 2-Terminal - Black/White 3-Terminal - Purple/White Figure 60-130-20 Left and Right Control Lever Switch Handle [Figure 60- 130-20] 1-Terminal - Yellow/Red 2-Terminal - Open 3-Terminal - Orange/Black P-90995 1 P-90994 1 1 1 P13735 3 1 2 P13735 2 3 1 60-130-9 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Switch Handle Installation (Cont'd) Figure 60-130-21 Connect the handle harness connectors to the sensor and lock solenoid connectors [Figure 60-130-21]. Actuator Connector Disassembly And Assembly NOTE: Actuator shown removed for clarity. Not necessary for procedure. Figure 60-130-22 Check the actuator wiring harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-22] and replace if broken. Figure 60-130-23 Installation: Install the wires into the connector as listed below. The terminal numbers are written on the back of the connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-23]. Lift and Tilt Actuator 1. Terminal-Black/Green-Larger diameter wire (16 gauge) 2. Terminal-Green-Larger diameter wire (16 gauge) 3. Terminal-Red/Green-Larger diameter wire (16 gauge) 4. Terminal-Open 5. Terminal-Red-Smaller diameter wire (18 gauge) 6. Terminal-Open 7. Terminal-Open 8. Terminal-Black-Smaller diameter wire (18 gauge) P-21804 P-6684 2 1 N-17741 1 60-130-10 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Handle Lock Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 60-130-24 Disconnect the harness connector (Item 1) [Figure 60- 130-24] from the handle sensor connector. Disconnect the harness connector (Item 2) [Figure 60- 130-24] from the handle lock solenoid connector. Figure 60-130-25 Remove the two screws (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-25] holding the handle lock solenoid to the handle. Installation: Tighten the screws to 3,6 - 4,3 N•m (32 - 38 in-lb) torque. Remove handle lock solenoid assembly from handle. Handle Lock Solenoid Disassembly And Assembly Figure 60-130-26 Remove solenoid (Item 1) from the solenoid mount (Item 2) [Figure 60-130-26]. Installation: Apply a drop of oil to the solenoid threads and tighten solenoid to 47 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 60-130-27 Check the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-27] for damage. Replace as necessary. P-21836 1 2 P-21832 1 P-21878A 1 2 P-21789 1 60-130-11 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Foot Sensor Removal And Installation Figure 60-130-28 Remove the hairpin clip and the pin (Item 1) [Figure 60- 130-28] from the foot sensor. Figure 60-130-29 Disconnect the wire harness (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-29] from the foot sensor. Figure 60-130-30 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) and the foot sensor (Item 2) [Figure 60-130-30]. Repeat for other side. P-90979 1 1 P-90982 1 1 P-90980 1 2‘ 60-130-12 S650 Service Manual CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) (CONT'D) Foot Sensor Disassembly And Assembly Figure 60-130-31 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-31] from the end of the foot sensor. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 10,2 N•m (90 in-lb) torque. Apply Loctite® #242 to the threads. Figure 60-130-32 Remove the boot retainer (Item 1), boot (Item 2), spool stop plate (Item 3) and O-ring (Item 4) [Figure 60-130- 32]. NOTE: Do not disassemble the sensor assembly (Item 5) [Figure 60-130-32]. The sensor assembly is a calibrated assembly and cannot be serviced. Order through Bobcat Parts. Foot Sensor Lock Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 60-130-33 Disconnect the wire harness (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-33] from the foot sensor shield lock solenoid. Remove foot lock solenoid (Item 2) [Figure 60-130-33]. Installation: Apply a drop of oil on the solenoid threads and tighten the solenoid to 47 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 60-130-34 Check the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 60-130-34] for damage. Replace as necessary. P-24269 1 1 P-24270 5 4 3 2 1 P-90992 1 2 P-21790 1 60-140-1 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS Identification Chart REF. NO. DESCRIPTION 1 TURN SIGNALS (Option) 2 REAR AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS (Option) Also: ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 3 ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 4 FRONT HORN 5 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL 6 STEERING LEVERS 7 LIFT ARM PEDAL 8TILT PEDAL 9 LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL 10 ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 11 FRONT AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS 12 NOT USED 13 CONTINUOUS FLOW CONTROL FOR AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS B-15781F / NA1014A / B-15781E 1 2 3 7 8 4 13 12 11 10 9 5 6 60-140-2 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (CONT’D) Description The Attachment Control Device (ACD) uses a 7 or 14 pin connector to communicate between the loader and the attachment. Attachments with a 14 pin connector use four different groups to control operations and hydraulic flow. Use service Analyzer to determine what group is being used and to troubleshoot the attachment / loader functions. If service analyzer is not available use a Ohmmeter to check for jumpers on the attachment harness. Group 0 = No Jumpers Group 1 = Pins K,L Group 2 = Pins K,P Group 3 = Pins C,D Refer to the Identification Chart ACD Group 0,1,2, or 3 for more detailed information. 60-140-3 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 0 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 4 2 3,5,6 2 3,5,6 K,A,D 5 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,A,C 6 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,E 7 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,F 8 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,G 9 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,H B-16447 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K No Jumpers B-16448 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-140-4 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 1 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 4 1 1 1 1 K,M,D 5 1 1 1 1 K,M,C 61111 K,M,E 7 1 1 1 1 K,M,F 8 1 1 1 1 K,M,G 9 1 1 1 1 K,M,H B-16447 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K Jumpers K,L B-16448 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-140-5 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 2 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 42222 K,A 5 1 1 1,7 1,7 K,A 6--- - K,E 7--- - K,F 8--- - K,G 9--- - K,H B-16447 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K Jumpers K,P B-16448 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-140-6 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 3 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 111- - K 222- - K 311- - K 4 - - - - K,A,D 5 - - - - K,A,C 6--- - K,E 7--- - K,F 8--- - K,G 9--- - K,H B-16447 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 - -- -- K Jumpers C,D B-16448 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-141-1 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) Identification Chart B-15781D / NA1164A / B-15781E 1 2 3 8 9 5 14 13 12 11 6 7 4 10 REF. NO. DESCRIPTION 1 TURN SIGNALS (Option) 2 REAR AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS (Option) Also: ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 3 ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 4 FLOAT CONTROL 5 FRONT HORN 6 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL 7 STEERING LEVERS AND LIFT / TILT HANDLES 8 LIFT ARM PEDAL 9TILT PEDAL 10 LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL 11 ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 12 FRONT AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS 13 NOT USED 14 CONTINUOUS FLOW CONTROL FOR AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS 60-141-2 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) (CONT’D) Description The Attachment Control Device (ACD) uses a 7 or 14 pin connector to communicate between the loader and the attachment. Attachments with a 14 pin connector use four different groups to control operations and hydraulic flow. Use service Analyzer to determine what group is being used and to troubleshoot the attachment / loader functions. If service analyzer is not available use a Ohmmeter to check for jumpers on the attachment harness. Group 0 = No Jumpers Group 1 = Pins K,L Group 2 = Pins K,P Group 3 = Pins C,D Refer to the Identification Chart ACD Group 0,1,2, or 3 for more detailed information. 60-141-3 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 0 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 4 2 3,5,6 2 3,5,6 K,A,D 5 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,A,C 6 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,E 7 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,F 8 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,G 9 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,H P-90898 P-90900 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K No Jumpers P-90899 P-90900A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-141-4 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 1 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 4 1 1 1 1 K,M,D 5 1 1 1 1 K,M,C 61111 K,M,E 7 1 1 1 1 K,M,F 8 1 1 1 1 K,M,G 9 1 1 1 1 K,M,H P-90898 P-90900 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K Jumpers K,L P-90899 P-90900A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-141-5 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 2 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 42222 K,A 5 1 1 1,7 1,7 K,A 6--- - K,E 7--- - K,F 8--- - K,G 9--- - K,H P-90898 P-90900 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K Jumpers K,P P-90899 P-90900A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-141-6 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 3 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 111- - K 222- - K 311- - K 4 - - - - K,A,D 5 - - - - K,A,C 6--- - K,E 7--- - K,F 8--- - K,G 9--- - K,H P-90898 P-90900 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 - -- -- K Jumpers C,D P-90899 P-90900A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-142-1 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) Identification Chart B-19873A / NA1165A / B-19874A 18 9 6 3 4 2 1 5 12 11 13 14 15 16 17 7 19 8 10 REF. NO. DESCRIPTION 1 SPEED MANAGEMENT 2 STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION Also: DRIVE RESPONSE 3 REAR AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS (Option) Also: ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 4 STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION Also: DRIVE RESPONSE 5 ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 6 SPEED MANAGEMENT 7 FRONT HORN 8 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (HAND) 9 JOYSTICKS 10 FOOTRESTS 11 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (FOOT) 12 LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL 13 ATTACHMENT FUNCTION CONTROL 14 NOT USED 15 FRONT AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS 16 NOT USED 17 TURN SIGNALS (Option) 18 FLOAT CONTROL 19 CONTINUOUS FLOW CONTROL FOR AUXILIARY HYDRAULICS 60-142-2 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) (CONT’D) Description The Attachment Control Device (ACD) uses a 7 or 14 pin connector to communicate between the loader and the attachment. Attachments with a 14 pin connector use four different groups to control operations and hydraulic flow. Use service Analyzer to determine what group is being used and to troubleshoot the attachment / loader functions. If service analyzer is not available use a Ohmmeter to check for jumpers on the attachment harness. Group 0 = No Jumpers Group 1 = Pins K,L Group 2 = Pins K,P Group 3 = Pins C,D Refer to the Identification Chart ACD Group 0,1,2, or 3 for more detailed information. 60-142-3 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 0 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 4 2 3,5,6 2 3,5,6 K,A,D 5 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,A,C 6 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,E 7 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,F 8 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,G 9 1 4,5,6 1 4,5,6 K,H P-24820A P-28316A 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K No Jumpers P-24802A P-28316A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-142-4 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 1 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 4 1 1 1 1 K,M,D 5 1 1 1 1 K,M,C 61111 K,M,E 7 1 1 1 1 K,M,F 8 1 1 1 1 K,M,G 9 1 1 1 1 K,M,H P-24820A P-28316A 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K Jumpers K,L P-24802A P-28316A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-142-5 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 2 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 1 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 22222 K 3 1 1 1, 7 1,7 K 42222 K,A 5 1 1 1,7 1,7 K,A 6--- - K,E 7--- - K,F 8--- - K,G 9--- - K,H P-24820A P-28316A 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 ----- K Jumpers K,P P-24802A P-28316A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-142-6 S650 Service Manual ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) (CONT’D) Identification Chart ACD Group 3 RH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics Option. HFH - Loaders with High Flow Hydraulics Option. RH / HFH - Loaders with Rear Hydraulics and High Flow Hydraulics Option. Terminal K is activated with Key switch ON. NOTE: For diagnostics and troubleshooting connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) The ACD (Attachment Control Device) automatically recognizes the use of the seven or fourteen pin connector when connected. Pressing the auxiliary hydraulics button and moving the rear auxiliary hydraulic switch to the right and left several times activates solenoid numbers 3,4,5, and 6 at the diverter valve. Front Auxiliary Pressure Release is accomplished by manually pushing the male and female couplers in at the front auxiliary block. The High Flow Button in the left side instrument panel must be pushed ON to activate solenoid number seven at the gear pump. Left side Control Handle Switches Switch Number Solenoid Number Activated Attachment Harness Terminal Activated Attachment Harness Connector RIght Side Control Handle Switches STD RH HFH RH / HFH 111- - K 222- - K 311- - K 4 - - - - K,A,D 5 - - - - K,A,C 6--- - K,E 7--- - K,F 8--- - K,G 9--- - K,H P-24820A P-28316A 10, 11, 12, 13, 14 - -- -- K Jumpers C,D P-24802A P-28316A 14 13 12 4 5 7 6 1 2 8 9 3 11 10 Fourteen Pin Connector Viewed from front (pin side of connector) of loader. Solenoid Number Hydraulic Coupler Wiring Number 1 Front Male (Rod) 4330 2 Front Female (Base) 4340 3 Diverter Rear (Rod) 4430 4 Diverter Rear (Base) 4440 5 Bleed / Lock Valve (Base) 4480 6 Bleed / Lock Valve (Rod) 4450 7 High Flow on Pump 4460 NA1892 1 2 5 6 7 3 4 60-150-1 S650 Service Manual SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) Connecting Remote Start Tool Figure 60-150-1 The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL1563 or 7003031 - Remote Start Tool MEL1565 - Service Tool Harness Control MEL1566 - Service Tool Harness Communicator (Computer Interface) NOTE: Make all connections with the key in the OFF position. The Service PC (Item 1) with the Remote Start Tool (Item 2) [Figure 60-150-1]. When connected to the loader, the Service PC is used to monitor, conduct diagnostics, and upgrade software. Connect the Service Tool Harness Communicator (MEL1566) (Item 3) [Figure 60-150-1] to the designated serial port on the Service PC. NOTE: The recommended serial cable length should not exceed 15 feet. A serial cable longer than 15 feet will create a degraded signal causing communication errors. Connect the other end to the connector on the Remote Start Tool. Connect the remote start tool to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60- 1.) NOTE: Refer to BobcatNET for PC requirements and the latest Service Analyzer software. Connecting Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) Figure 60-150-2 The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: Order from Bobcat Parts P/N: 7003031 - Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) Kit Kit Includes: 7003030 - Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) 6689747 - Loader Service Tool Harness 6689746 - Computer Service Tool Harness 6689745 - BOSS® Service Tool Harness NOTE: Make all connections with the key in the OFF position. The Service PC (Item 1) with the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) (Item 2) [Figure 60-150-2]. When connected to the loader, the Service PC is used to monitor, conduct diagnostics, and upgrade software. Connect the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) Computer Service Tool Harness (Item 3) [Figure 60-150-2] to the designated serial port on the Service PC. NOTE: The recommended serial cable length should not exceed 15 feet. A serial cable longer than 15 feet will create a degraded signal causing communication errors. Connect the other end to the connector on the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool). Connect the Remote Start Tool (Service Tool) to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 on Page 10-61-1.) NOTE: Refer to BobcatNET for PC requirements and the latest Service Analyzer software. P16119 3 1 2 P-76450 3 1 2 60-150-2 S650 Service Manual 60-160-1 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION Description Calibration procedures must be followed when replacing a hydraulic control valve, actuator, Drive / Drive+ Controller, ACS Controller, pump controller, hydrostatic pump, or hydrostatic motor. Failure to calibrate after component replacement may result in poor performance or reduced life of actuator(s). The Actuator Test is performed with the Service PC. The Actuator Test should be used if reduced performance codes are present or when replacing a controller or actuator. NOTE: The Actuator Test should be used as the preferred method of actuator and valve spool calibration. The Lift and Tilt Calibration (ACS) provides set points to the ACS controller to actuate the lift and tilt valve. The Lift and Tilt Calibration (ACS) should be used if reduced performance codes are present or when replacing a controller or actuator. The Lift and Tilt Calibration (SJC) provides set points to the ACS controller to actuate the lift and tilt valve. The Lift and Tilt Calibration (SJC) should be used if reduced performance codes are present or when replacing a controller or actuator. The Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) provides set points to the Drive controller to actuate the hydrostatic controller that directs flow to a servo piston. Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) should be performed when a desired travel path cannot be attained or replacing the hydrostatic pump, hydrostatic motor, or controller. After Performing a Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC), Steering Drift Compensation can be used to fine tune the hydrostatic pump control. For more information on Steering Drift Compensation (See STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION on Page 60- 161-1.) NOTE: The Actuator Test is the only test that uses a Service PC. The Lift and Tilt Calibration (ACS or SJC) does not need to be performed if the Actuator Testing is being performed with the Service PC. The Hydrostatic Pump Calibration does not need to be performed with the Actuator Test or Lift and Tilt Calibration (SJC). Actuator Testing Figure 60-160-1 [Figure 60-160-1] Excessive actuator loading can occur if the actuator and valve spool components are misaligned. Misalignment may reduce spool stroke performance and reduce the life of the actuator. Starting with software version 36, the Bobcat Service Analyzer will be able to perform tests to diagnose actuator and valve spool misalignment. Connect the Service PC. (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) If a Service PC is not available, (See Lift And Tilt Calibration (SJC) on Page 60-160-4.) or (See Lift And Tilt Calibration (ACS) on Page 60-160-11.). NOTE: Warm the hydraulic oil to room temperature 22°C (72°F), stop the engine and clear all active service codes before running the test. Once the test is initiated, an automatic calibration sequence will start. When calibration is complete, the test will be performed and the results can be viewed on the Service PC (Laptop) monitor. P-54336 CONTROL VALVE ACTUATORS 60-160-2 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT’D) Actuator Testing (Cont’d) This test will engage both actuators to fully stroke the spools then allow the centering springs to return the spools to neutral. Next, both actuators are engaged to move the spools just past the neutral points then allow the centering springs to return the spools to neutral. When complete, the Actuator Test will show a pass mode or fail mode. The pass mode indicates that no problems were detected. The fail mode indicates one or a combination of three problems below. • Actuator slow return to neutral. The spool returns to neutral too slowly. • Actuator did not fully extend / retract. During the test, the spool was not able to fully stroke in both directions. • Actuator out of neutral. The spool did not return to the neutral window during the test. NOTE: A time out will occur if the test cannot be completed within 8 seconds. If this happens, retry the test. Figure 60-160-2 [Figure 60-160-2] If the initial Actuator Test results in a fail mode due to a slow return to neutral, follow the troubleshooting tree to pinpoint the probable cause. If the Actuator Test fails after the hydraulic oil is warmed, go to the next step and loosen the bolts that mount the actuator to the control valve. Loosen the bolts just enough so the actuator can be moved slightly up / down or side / side. Rerun the Actuator Test, if the test passes, check the following probable causes in Column 1 [Figure 60-160- 2]. Check the probable causes in the order they are listed. Repairing one cause may be all that is required. Re-run the test to verify. NOTE: Actuator and spool misalignment. Re-tighten the two bolts evenly, turn the first bolt one turn, then turn the other bolt one turn until both bolts are tight. If the Actuator Test failed due to a slow return to neutral after checking the probable causes in Column 1 [Figure 60-160-2], check the following probable causes in Column 2 [Figure 60-160-2]. • Contamination in the spool. • The spool end cap may be defective or the centering spring may be broken. Inspect the end cap and the centering spring, replace if necessary. • The wire harness or connectors may have an intermittent short. Check the connections and wire harnesses. • The controller may be defective, replace the controller. Run Actuator Test Pass Fail Retest With Warm Hydraulic Oil Loosen Actuator Pass Fail Pass Fail • Misaligned Assembly • Pin • Contamination in Spool • Actuator • End Cap / Center Spring • Wire Harness • Controller Probable Cause Probable Cause Column 1 Column 2 • Contamination in Spool 60-160-3 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT’D) Actuator Testing (Cont’d) If the initial Actuator Test results in the fail mode actuator did not fully extend / retract, check the following. • The actuator connectors may be reversed between the lift and tilt actuator. Reverse the connectors and rerun the Actuator Test. • The actuator may be weak, replace the actuator. • The spool end cap may be defective or the centering spring may be broken. Inspect the end cap and the centering spring, replace if necessary. • Contamination in the spool. If the initial Actuator Test results in the fail mode actuator out of neutral, check the following. • The actuator may be defective, replace the actuator. • The spool end cap may be defective or the centering spring may be broken. Inspect the end cap and the centering spring, replace if necessary. • Contamination in the spool. 60-160-4 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT’D) Lift And Tilt Calibration (SJC) The controller uses a calibration sequence to optimize the control system. The optimizing ensures full spool stroke (full flow) while preventing over stroke (loading) of the actuator and resets the calibration points in the controller. NOTE: The Actuator Test is the preferred method to calibrate the lift and tilt actuator. (See Actuator Testing on Page 60-160-1.) NOTE: This calibration procedure must be followed when replacing the hydraulic control valve, lift or tilt actuator. Failure to calibrate after component replacement may result in poor performance or reduced life of actuator(s). Figure 60-160-3 With an operator in the seat and the seat bar down. Close the cab door. (If loader is equipped.) Place the loader Control Pattern Switch (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-3] in the ISO position. Figure 60-160-4 Move the right joystick to the forward-right corner position [Figure 60-160-4] and hold in position. P-85307 SJC 1 P-85958 P-85958 60-160-5 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT’D) Lift And Tilt Calibration (SJC) (Cont’d) Figure 60-160-5 With the seat bar down, turn the ignition key ON [Figure 60-160-5]. NOTE: Do not start the engine. Figure 60-160-6 The loader Control Pattern Switch (Item 1) [Figure 60- 160-6] will start flashing and will continue to flash until the calibration procedure is completed. Figure 60-160-7 At the left panel, press the PRESS TO OPERATE Button (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-7] while holding the right joystick in position. Release the joystick. NOTE: During the calibration cycle, the system will beep three times. Once the calibration is complete, code W3224 (Calibration Performed) will be generated. The ACS controller will cycle the actuators. The lift and tilt calibration is complete. P-85493A P-85307 SJC 1 P-85413C 1 60-160-6 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT’D) Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Place the loader on jackstands. (See Procedure on Page 10-10-1.) Operator must be in the seat and the seat bar down. Figure 60-160-8 Close the cab door. (If loader is so equipped.) Place the loader Control Pattern Switch (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-8] in the ISO position. Verify the parking brake. Figure 60-160-9 With the seat bar down, turn the ignition key ON [Figure 60-160-9]. NOTE: Do not start the engine. Figure 60-160-10 The Control Pattern ISO Switch (Item 1) [Figure 60-160- 10] will start flashing. P-85307 SJC 1 P-85493A P-85307 SJC 1 60-160-7 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT'D) Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) (Cont'd) Figure 60-160-11 Move the left joystick to the forward-left corner position [Figure 60-160-11] and hold in position. Figure 60-160-12 Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER Button (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-12] while holding the left joystick in position. Three audible beeps will sound. Figure 60-160-13 Move the left joystick to the reverse-right corner position [Figure 60-160-13] and hold in position. Figure 60-160-14 Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER Button (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-14] while holding the left joystick in position. Three audible beeps will sound. B-19873 P-85959 P-85413C 1 B-19873 P-85960 P-85413C 1 60-160-8 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT'D) Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) (Cont'd) Figure 60-160-15 Allow the left joystick to go to the neutral position [Figure 60-160-15]. Figure 60-160-16 Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER Button (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-16]. Three audible beeps will sound. Start the engine from the RUN, RUN / ENTER position. DO NOT TURN TO OFF POSITION. This would cancel the calibration mode and the procedure would have to be repeated. Figure 60-160-17 The Control Pattern ISO Switch (Item 1) [Figure 60-160- 17] will stop flashing, and will remain ON for the rest of the calibration procedure. Figure 60-160-18 Move the throttle (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-18] to high idle. NOTE: If at any time, during calibration, the operator needs to stop the loader, turn the key OFF, lift the seat bar, or return the joystick to the neutral position. The calibration procedure will stop. To return to calibration mode, the operator must start the complete procedure from the beginning. P-85961 P-85413C 1 P-85307 SJC 1 P-85760A 1 60-160-9 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT'D) Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) (Cont'd) WARNING Put jackstands under the front axles and rear corners of the frame before running the engine for service. Failure to use jackstands can allow the machine to fall or move and cause injury or death. W-2017-0286 Figure 60-160-19 Move and hold the left joystick to the forward position [Figure 60-160-19] until the forward calibration is completed. Figure 60-160-20 The loader speed will “ramp up” quickly (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-20] and slow down 3 times in a row. The loader will then “stair step” the speed (Item 2) [Figure 60-160-20] until it reaches full speed and then come to a stop. Continue to hold the left joystick in the forward position until the loader wheels or tracks come to a stop and an audible beep is heard. Forward calibration is complete. NOTE: If the wheels or tracks do not stop moving in Full Speed Forward in 2 minutes or less, there was an error in the calibration procedure. The operator must shut the loader OFF, and start the calibration procedure from the beginning. B-19873 P-85962 P-64321 1 2 60-160-10 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT'D) Hydrostatic Pump Calibration (SJC) (Cont'd) Figure 60-160-21 Move and hold the left joystick to the reverse position [Figure 60-160-21] until the reverse calibration is completed. Figure 60-160-22 The loader speed will “ramp up” quickly (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-22] and slow down 3 times in a row. The loader will then “stair step” the speed (Item 2) [Figure 60-160-22] until it reaches full speed and then come to a stop. Continue to hold the left joystick in the reverse position until the loader wheels or tracks come to a stop and an audible beep is heard. Reverse calibration is complete. NOTE: If the wheels or tracks do not stop moving in Full Speed Reverse in 2 minutes or less, there was an error in the calibration procedure. The operator must shut the loader OFF, and start the calibration procedure from the beginning. There will be an audible beep, the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button light will remain on. The TRACTION light will illuminate, the SEAT BAR, and LIFT AND TILT lights will be off. The D7598 error code will clear. There should be no other codes in the display area. Allow the joystick to go to the neutral position. Once the calibration procedure is complete the Steering Drift Compensation values will be reset to [S----] or neutral. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button. Move the left joystick to forward position [Figure 60-160-19] and check for normal forward wheel or track rotation. Move the left joystick to the reverse position [Figure 60- 160-21] and check for normal reverse wheel or track rotation. Stop the engine, and remove the loader from jackstands. The calibration procedure is completed. After calibration is complete, use Steering Drift Compensation for fine tuning or if an acceptable line of drift cannot be achieved. (See STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION on Page 60-161-1.) If loader does not maintain a desired travel path with Steering Drift Compensation at maximum setting [S-R10] or [S-L10], see the electrical and hydrostatic troubleshooting. (See Troubleshooting on Page 30-10-1.) or (See Troubleshooting on Page 60-10-8.) B-19873 P-85963 P-64321 1 2 60-160-11 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT’D) Lift And Tilt Calibration (ACS) The controller uses a calibration sequence to optimize the control system. The optimizing ensures full spool stroke (full flow) while preventing over stroke (loading) of the actuator and resets the calibration points in the controller. NOTE: The Actuator Test is the preferred method to calibrate the lift and tilt actuator. (See Actuator Testing on Page 60-160-1.) NOTE: This calibration procedure must be followed when replacing a hydraulic control valve, actuator or ACS controller. Failure to calibrate after component replacement may result in poor performance or reduced life of actuator(s). Figure 60-160-23 Update the loader service software to the latest version. Place the rocker switch (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-23] in the hand control mode. Figure 60-160-24 Close the cab door. (If loader is equipped.) With the seat bar down, turn the ignition key ON (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel press RUN / ENTER) (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-24]. NOTE: Do not start the engine. Figure 60-160-25 Push the PRESS TO OPERATE button (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-25] to unlock the hand controls. P-85307B ACS 1 P-85493A P-85413C 1 60-160-12 S650 Service Manual CALIBRATION (CONT’D) Lift And Tilt Calibration (ACS) (Cont’d) Figure 60-160-26 Fully stroke both control handles in toward the center of the cab and hold the handles [Figure 60-160-26]. Lift the seat bar, high enough for the PRESS TO OPERATE light (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-27] to go OFF. Lower the seat bar. Figure 60-160-27 Push the PRESS TO OPERATE button (Item 1) [Figure 60-160-27] to begin calibration. NOTE: The ACS icon will light up and if you listen closely the cycling of the actuators can be heard. The ACS icon will stay lit until the ignition key is cycled or the loader is started and a function is operated. NOTE: During the calibration cycle, the system will beep three times. Once the calibration is complete, code W3224 (Calibration Performed) will be generated. Release the control handles. Calibration is complete. B-16628 Stroke Both Handles Fully In and Hold Them P-85413C 1 60-161-1 S650 Service Manual STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION Steering Drift Compensation is available on SJC equipped machines. Description Steering Drift Compensation can be used to reduce steering drift to maintain a desired travel path in both forward and reverse directions. Examples of applications where this feature can be used: • To compensate for normal variations such as tire inflation pressure, track tension, tire wear and track wear. • Using side shift attachments such as trenchers, planers and silt fence installers. • Driving on uneven terrain such as crowned road surfaces. Figure 60-161-1 Steering drift compensation contains a total of 21 settings. Steering drift compensation can be set to any point from neutral to [S-L10] left and from neutral to [S- R10] right. [S----] is displayed when set for neutral [Figure 60-161-1]. Operation NOTE: Changes CANNOT be performed until the seat bar is lowered, the engine is started and the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button is pressed to activate the BICS. Perform pre-starting and starting procedures: 1. Fasten seat belt. 2. Lower seat bar. 3. Place joysticks in neutral position. 4. Start the engine. 5. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button. 6. Current drive response setting will be displayed briefly in the data display. NOTE: Raising the seat bar or changing control mode (ISO / H) will cause the machine to disengage from steering drift compensation. The last displayed setting will remain in effect until the machine is turned OFF. B-23580C STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION 60-161-2 S650 Service Manual STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION (CONT’D) Operation (Cont’d) Figure 60-161-2 Press and hold the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button (Item 1) for three seconds to enter the drive response adjustment menu. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button (Item 1) again to adjust the loader’s steering drift compensation setting. The current steering drift compensation setting will appear in the data display (Item 2) [Figure 60-161-2]. Press the upper left button (Item 6) on the left joystick to adjust the machine left. [S-L01] (Item 3) through a maximum of [S-L10] will appear in the data display (Item 2) [Figure 60-161-2]. The number will increase by one each time you press the button. The higher the number, the greater the amount of steering drift compensation to the left. Adjustments to steering drift compensation will be effective immediately. Press the upper right button (Item 7) on the left joystick to adjust back toward center. The display will decrease down to neutral displayed as [S----] (Item 4). Another press of the upper right button will cause [S-R01] (Item 5) to appear in the data display (Item 2) [Figure 60-161-2]. The number will increase by one each time you press the button up to a maximum of [S-R10]. The higher the number, the greater the amount of steering drift compensation to the right. Adjustments to steering drift compensation will be effective immediately. Figure 60-161-3 Saving The Steering Drift Compensation Setting: The current steering drift compensation setting can be saved by pressing and holding the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button (Item 1) for three seconds. [SET] (Item 3) will appear in the data display (Item 2) [Figure 60-161- 3] and the machine will exit from the steering drift compensation adjustment menu. OR Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button to exit from the steering drift compensation adjustment menu without saving the current setting. [DONE] (Item 4) will appear in the data display (Item 2) [Figure 60-161-3] and the upper left and upper right buttons on the left joystick will no longer make changes to steering drift compensation. NOTE: The last displayed steering drift compensation setting will remain in effect until the machine is turned OFF. The machine will revert back to the last saved setting the next time it is started. P-24820C 6 7 Left Joystick Right Joystick P-24802C 1 2 NA1011 P-76461L P-76461N P-76461M 4 5 3 1 2 NA1011 P-76461K P-76461O 4 3 60-170-1 S650 Service Manual FLYWHEEL RPM SENSOR Description The flywheel rpm sensor has a magnet located on the end of the sensor which senses breaks between the ring gear teeth, the sensor relays this information back to the controller which registers the rpm of the engine. The flywheel rpm sensor is located just above the starter on the left side of the engine. 60-170-2 S650 Service Manual FLYWHEEL RPM SENSOR (CONT’D) Adjustment Figure 60-170-1 When reinstalling the rpm sensor, turn the rpm sensor (Item 1) [Figure 60-170-1] in until it makes contact with the engine flywheel. Turn the jam nut (Item 2) [Figure 60-170-1] until it contacts the flywheel housing. The jam nut should not be tightened, it needs to turn with the rpm sensor when the sensor is turned back out for adjustment. Figure 60-170-2 Turn the RPM sensor and the jam nut out from the flywheel. Set a clearance of 1,27 mm (0.050 in) between the jam nut and the housing with a feeler gauge (Item 1) [Figure 60-170-2]. Remove the feeler gauge. Tighten the jam nut (Item 2) [Figure 60-170-2] to 16 - 23 N•m (12 - 17 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: New rpm sensors have a plastic tip which is used as a gauge during installation. The plastic tip is designed to come off after the engine is started. P-85922 1 2 P-85921 1 2 60-180-1 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL SETUP Right Panel Setup (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) Icon Identification Figure 60-180-1 Example Languages Figure 60-180-2 ICON DESCRIPTION DATE / TIME USER / HOURMETER CURRENT JOB HOURS ACTIVE WARNINGS screen icon VITALS screen icon SERVICE screen icon MAIN screen icon ATTACHMENTS screen icon SECURITY screen icon DISPLAY screen icon LEFT SCROLL button RIGHT SCROLL button ENTER button NA3025 P-90385 / NA3025 / NA3012 / NA302 3 Press a scroll butto n (Item 1) repeatedly unt il the Display screen ico n (Inset) is highlighted. 1 1 Select [2. LANGUAGES]. Select the desire d language. 60-180-2 S650 Service Manual CONTROL PANEL SETUP (CONT’D) Right Panel Setup (Deluxe Instrumentation Panel) (Cont’d) More Examples Clocks Select … DISPLAY screen icon [1. CLOCKS] SET TIME AND DATE Select [1. TIME] Use the keypad to enter date. Press ENTER to continue. Use the keypad to enter time. Select AM / PM / 24hr. Press ENTER to continue. RESET JOB CLOCK (Owner password required if Job Clock is locked.) Select [2. JOB CLOCK] Press [4] to cycle between lock and unlock. Press [9] to reset. SET ALARM Select [3. ALARM CLOCK] Select alarm 1, 2 or 3. Press [1] to cycle between ON and OFF. Press [2] and use the keypad to enter alarm time. Select AM / PM / 24hr. Press ENTER to continue. Press [3] to cycle between ONCE, DAILY and WEEKLY. Selecting WEEKLY will prompt for a day selection using number [4]. Press ENTER to continue. Vitals (Monitor the engine, hydraulic / hydrostatic, electrical functions when engine is running.) Select … VITALS screen icon Press [6] to cycle between METRIC or ENGLISH (M / E) readouts. You can monitor real-time readouts of: Engine Speed Engine Oil Pressure Engine Coolant Temperature System Voltage Hydraulic Charge Pressure Hydraulic Oil Temperature The Deluxe Instrumentation Panel is easy to use. Continue to set your own preferences for running / monitoring your Bobcat loader. 60-190-1 S650 Service Manual PASSWORD SETUP (DELUXE INSTRUMENTATION PANEL) Password Setup is available on machines with a Deluxe Instrumentation Panel. Password Description All new machines with a Deluxe Instrumentation Panel arrive at Bobcat dealerships with the keypad in locked mode. This means that a password must be used to start the engine. For security purposes, your dealer may change the password and also set it in the locked mode. Your dealer will provide you with the password. Master Password: A permanent, randomly selected password set at the factory which cannot be changed. This password is used for service by the Bobcat dealer if the owner password is not known; or to change the owner password. Owner Password: Allows for full use of the loader and to setup the Deluxe Instrumentation Panel. There is only one owner password. It must be used to change the owner or user passwords. Owner should change the password as soon as possible for security of the loader. User Password: Allows starting and operating the loader; cannot change password or any of the other setup features. For the procedures to change passwords (See Changing The Owner Password on Page 60-190-1.) and (See Changing The User Passwords on Page 60-190-2.) Changing The Owner Password Figure 60-190-1 P-90399/NA3025/NA3016/NA3031/NA3033/NA3028/NA3015/NA3027 Press a scroll button (Item 1) repeatedly until th e Security screen ico n (Inset) is highlighted. 1 1 Enter owner password an d press [ENTER]. Select [1. USER SETTINGS]. Select [1. OWNER]. Select [2. CHANG E PASSWORD]. Enter new owne r password and pres s [ENTER]. You will be prompted t o reenter the new owne r password. Press [ENTER]. 60-190-2 S650 Service Manual PASSWORD SETUP (DELUXE INSTRUMENTATION PANEL) (CONT’D) Changing The User Passwords Figure 60-190-2 Password Lockout Feature This feature allows the owner to unlock the password feature so that a password does not need to be used every time the engine is started. Figure 60-190-3 NOTE: The procedure above can be followed to reset the machine lock so that the machine requires a password to start the engine. P-90399/NA3025/NA3016/NA3031/NA3033/NA3026/NA3010/NA3027 Press a scroll button (Item 2) repeatedly until th e Security screen ico n (Inset) is highlighted. 1 1 Enter owner password an d press [ENTER]. Select [1. USER SETTINGS]. Select user. Select [2. CHANG E PASSWORD]. Enter new user passwor d and press [ENTER]. Press [ENTER]. P-90399 / NA3025 / NA3016 / NA3031 Press a scroll butto n (Item 2) repeatedly unt il the Security screen ico n (Inset) is highlighted. 1 1 Enter owner passwor d and press [ENTER]. Select [2. MACHIN E LOCK]. 60-191-1 S650 Service Manual PASSWORD SETUP (KEYLESS START PANEL) Password Description Master Password: A permanent, randomly selected password set at the factory which cannot be changed. This password is used for service by the Bobcat dealer if the owner password is not known; or to change the owner password. Owner Password: Allows for full use of the loader. It must be used to change the owner password. Changing The Owner Password Press the RUN button to turn on the loaders electrical system. Enter the five digit owner password using the number keys (1 through 0) if locked. Figure 60-191-1 Press and hold the lock (Item 1) and unlock (Item 2) [Figure 60-191-1] keys for two seconds. The lock key red light will flash and the left panel display screen will show [ENTER]. Enter a new five digit password using the number keys (1 through 0). An asterisk will show in the left panel display screen for each key press. The left panel display screen will show [AGAIN]. Enter the new five digit password again. The lock key red light will become solid. Password Lockout Feature This feature allows the owner to unlock the password feature so that a password does not need to be used every time the engine is started. Press the RUN button to turn on the loaders electrical system. Enter the five digit owner password using the number keys (1 through 0). Figure 60-191-2 Press the unlock key (Item 2) [Figure 60-191-2]. The left panel display screen will show [CODE]. Enter the five digit owner password using the number keys (1 through 0). The unlock key green light will flash, then become solid. The loader can now be started without using a password. NOTE: Use the following procedure to reset the machine lock so that the loader requires a password to start the engine. Press the RUN button to turn on the loaders electrical system. Press the lock key (Item 1) [Figure 60-191-2]. The lock key red light will flash and the left panel display screen will show [CODE]. Enter the five digit owner password using the number keys (1 through 0). The unlock key green light will flash, then the lock key red light will become solid. You must now enter the password every time to start the loader. P-90805 1 2 P-90805 1 2 60-191-2 S650 Service Manual 60-200-1 S650 Service Manual MAINTENANCE CLOCK Description The Maintenance Clock alerts the operator when the next service interval is due. EXAMPLE: The Maintenance Clock can be set to a 500 hour interval as a reminder for the next 500 hour planned maintenance. Figure 60-200-1 During machine operation, a two beep alarm will sound when there are less than 10 hours until the next planned maintenance. The remaining hours before maintenance is required will appear in the data display (Item 1) for five seconds while the service icon (Item 3) and hourmeter icon (Item 2) [Figure 60-200-1] flash. NOTE: The display will show negative numbers after counting down to zero. The display will then revert back to the previous display and will appear for five seconds every time the machine is started until the maintenance clock is reset. Figure 60-200-2 The Deluxe Instrumentation Panel, if equipped, will display a message (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-2] alerting the operator to service the machine. This message will remain for 10 seconds and will appear for 10 seconds every time the machine is started until the maintenance clock is reset. Figure 60-200-3 The Deluxe Instrumentation Panel, if equipped, will display a bar (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-3] showing time remaining until next service. This bar will turn red when service is past due. NEXT MAINTENANCE DUE will change to MAINTENANCE PAST DUE and display the number of hours past due. Keys [4] and [9] can be used to adjust the service interval when the owner is logged in [Figure 60-200-3]. NOTE: Loaders equipped with a Standard Key Panel or Keyless Start Panel will not display the BobCARE PM SM message or NEXT MAINTENANCE TYPE on the right panel. P-76461R 3 2 1 NA3034 1 NA3040 1 60-200-2 S650 Service Manual MAINTENANCE CLOCK (CONT’D) Setup Figure 60-200-4 The first analyzer screen has an added bar for the Maintenance Clock. The clock will remain OFF until activated. Click Continue (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-4] to view the next analyzer screen. Figure 60-200-5 Click Options (Item 1) and add your dealer name and phone number (Item 2). Click Save Options (Item 3) [Figure 60-200-5] the information is now stored. Figure 60-200-6 Select Install (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-6] to begin sending the dealer information to the controller. Figure 60-200-7 Click SEND TO MACHINE (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-7] to send the dealer information to the machine controller. NOTE: Verify that all correct option and kits are selected before clicking SEND TO MACHINE. P-64243A 1 P-76110 1 2 3 P-76110 1 P-76113 1 60-200-3 S650 Service Manual MAINTENANCE CLOCK (CONT’D) Setup (Cont’d) Figure 60-200-8 A green COMPLETE (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-8] message will be displayed when the dealer information has been transferred to the machine controller. Click Back (Item 2) [Figure 60-200-8] to return to the Bobcat Service Analyzer screen. Figure 60-200-9 Select Warnings (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-9]. Figure 60-200-10 Click the right arrow (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-10] to scroll through the tabs. Figure 60-200-11 Click the Maintenance tab (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-11] to view the maintenance clock screen. Click ON/OFF (Item 2) to turn the maintenance clock on or off [Figure 60-200-11]. The default Interval (Item 3) is 250 hours, it can also be changed by placing the cursor in the box and typing the new interval. Click SET/RESET (Item 4) [Figure 60-200- 11] to reset and set the maintenance clock. P-76114 1 2 P-76110 1 P-76112 1 P-76111 1 3 4 2 60-200-4 S650 Service Manual MAINTENANCE CLOCK (CONT’D) Setup (Cont’d) Figure 60-200-12 The current maintenance clock Length (Interval) and Time Reset will be displayed (Item 1). This screen will also store the most recent 20 entries of history. Once an entry is added, it cannot be changed. If an entry is made and the interval is not correct, make another entry and click SET/RESET (Item 2) [Figure 60-200-12]. NOTE: If the interval is set to 10 hours or less, the maintenance clock will reset and log a reset time but the wrench icon, hour interval and service icon will NOT be removed from the left display screen. Figure 60-200-13 Select Back (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-13] to return to the main menu. Figure 60-200-14 Select Program / Update (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-14] to view the maintenance clock. Figure 60-200-15 After the maintenance clock has been activated, the first analyzer screen shows the hours remaining on current maintenance interval (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-15]. If past the interval, the number will reflect negative hours. P-76111 1 2 P-76111 1 P-76110 1 P-64244A 1 60-200-5 S650 Service Manual MAINTENANCE CLOCK (CONT’D) Reset Figure 60-200-16 Press the information button (Item 2) until the display screen (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-16] shows the maintenance clock. Press and hold the information button (Item 2) for seven seconds until [RESET] (Inset) appears in the display screen (Item 1) [Figure 60-200-16]. P-76455H 2 1 60-200-6 S650 Service Manual 60-210-1 S650 Service Manual BACK-UP ALARM SYSTEM Description The back-up alarm will sound when the operator moves both steering levers or joystick(s) into the reverse position. Slight movement of the steering levers into the reverse position is required with hydrostatic transmissions, before the back-up alarm will sound. Inspecting Figure 60-210-1 Inspect for damaged or missing back-up alarm decal (Item 1) [Figure 60-210-1]. Replace if required. Sit in the seat and fasten the seat belt. Engage the parking brake. Pull the seat bar all the way down. Start the engine. Press the PRESS TO OPERATE LOADER button. Disengage the parking brake. Move both steering levers or joystick(s) into the reverse position. The back-up alarm must sound when all wheels or both tracks are moving in reverse. The back-up alarm is located on the inside of the rear door. Figure 60-210-2 Inspect the back-up alarm electrical connections (Item 1) [Figure 60-210-2], wire harness (Item 2) [Figure 60-210- 2] and back-up alarm switches (if equipped) (Item 1) [Figure 60-210-3] for tightness and damage. Repair or replace any damaged components. If the back-up alarm switches require adjustment, (See Adjusting Switch Position on Page 60-210-2.) P-85994 1 P-90531A 1 2 60-210-2 S650 Service Manual BACK-UP ALARM SYSTEM (CONT’D) Adjusting Switch Position NOTE: Joystick equipped machines do not have back-up alarm switches and cannot be adjusted. See your Bobcat dealer for service if your back-up alarm does not sound. Standard Controls and ACS (If Equipped) Stop the engine and raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Place the steering levers in the neutral position. Figure 60-210-3 The back-up alarm switches (Item 1) [Figure 60-210-3] are located alongside the steering bellcranks. Both switches must be adjusted properly for the back-up alarm to operate correctly. Figure 60-210-4 Loosen the screws (Item 3) [Figure 60-210-4] securing the back-up alarm switch. (Left side shown) Position the back-up alarm switch so that the roller (Item 1) just makes contact with the bellcrank (Item 2) [Figure 60-210-4] without compressing the switch spring. Torque the screws (Item 3) [Figure 60-210-4] securing the switch to the bracket to 1,6 - 2,1 N•m (14 - 19 in-lb). Repeat adjustment procedure for the other switch. Lower the operator cab. (See Lowering on Page 10-30- 3.) Inspect back-up alarm system for proper function. (See Inspecting on Page 60-210-1.) P-85722 1 P-85723A 3 1 2 60-210-3 S650 Service Manual BACK-UP ALARM SYSTEM (CONT’D) Troubleshooting (Standard And ACS) The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Operator’s Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-0807 PROBLEM CAUSE Back-up alarm will not sound when the operator moves both steering levers into the reverse position. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7 Back-up alarm sounds when steering levers in neutral / forward position. 2, 6, 7 KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE 1. The ground connection is not making a good contact. 2. The back-up alarm switches are damaged. 3. The alarm is damaged. 4. The back-up alarm or switch wires are disconnected. 5. Check the fuses. 6. The wiring is damaged. 7. The back-up alarm switches need adjusting. 60-210-4 S650 Service Manual BACK-UP ALARM SYSTEM (CONT’D) Troubleshooting (Joystick) The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Instructions are necessary before operating or servicing machine. Read and understand the Operation & Maintenance Manual, Operator’s Handbook and signs (decals) on machine. Follow warnings and instructions in the manuals when making repairs, adjustments or servicing. Check for correct function after adjustments, repairs or service. Untrained operators and failure to follow instructions can cause injury or death. W-2003-0807 PROBLEM CAUSE Back-up alarm will not sound when the operator moves joystick(s) into the reverse position. 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 Back-up alarm sounds when joystick(s) in neutral / forward position. 5, 6 KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE 1. The ground connection is not making a good contact. 2. The alarm is damaged. 3. The alarm wires are disconnected. 4. Check the fuses. 5. The wiring is damaged. 6. The joystick controller is not working correctly. 60-210-5 S650 Service Manual BACK-UP ALARM SYSTEM (CONT’D) Alarm Removal And Installation Stop the engine and open the rear door. Figure 60-210-5 Disconnect the alarm connector (Item 1) [Figure 60-210- 5] from the alarm. Remove the two nuts (Item 2) [Figure 60-210-5]. Remove the alarm and bracket from the loader. Switch Removal And Installation NOTE: Joystick equipped machines do not have back-up alarm switches. Standard Controls and ACS (If Equipped) Stop the engine and raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 60-210-6 Place the steering levers in the neutral position. Loosen the screws (Item 1) securing the back-up alarm switches. Slide the switch (Item 2) [Figure 60-210-6] off the mounting bracket. Mark the wires for ease of assembly and disconnect them from the switch. Repeat for other side. Installation: Slide the alarm switches onto the mounting bracket so the threaded plates are under the mounting bracket. The rollers will face to the inside. During installation of switches, adjust the switches (See Adjusting Switch Position on Page 60-210-2.) and inspect back-up alarm operation (See Inspecting on Page 60-210-1.) are required. P-85280 1 2 P-85723A 2 1 60-210-6 S650 Service Manual 60-220-1 S650 Service Manual FRONT HORN Removal And Installation NOTE: Two different style horns are used. Remove the left side lower panel. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-160-1.) Figure 60-220-1 Figure 60-220-2 Disconnect wire harness (Item 1) [Figure 60-220-1] and [Figure 60-220-2] from the front horn. Remove the two bolts and nuts (Item 2) [Figure 60-220- 1] and [Figure 60-220-2]. Remove the front horn and bracket from the loader (Item 3) [Figure 60-220-2]. Figure 60-220-3 Remove the two bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 60-220- 3]. Remove the front horn from the bracket. P-90901 1 2 3 P-90885 2 1 1 P-90902 2 3 1 P-90903 2 3 P-90886 1 60-220-2 S650 Service Manual 70-01 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SERVICE ENGINE INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-1 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-2 Torque Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-5 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-5 Engine Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-7 Engine Mount Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-14 Compression - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-10-15 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-20-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-20-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-20-1 Cable Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-20-2 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12469 AND BELOW & S/N A3NW11130 AND BELOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-21-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-21-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-21-2 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12470 AND ABOVE & S/N A3NW11131 AND ABOVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-22-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-22-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-22-2 MUFFLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-30-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-30-1 AIR CLEANER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-40-1 Housing Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-40-1 Housing Bracket Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-40-2 ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-1 Radiator Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-1 Hydraulic Fan Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-3 Hydraulic Fan Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-4 Lower Fan Duct Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-5 Blower Housing Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-5 Hydraulic Fan Motor Assembly Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-6 Fan Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-6 Hydraulic Fan Motor Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-7 Water Pump Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-8 Water Pump Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-8 Thermostat Housing Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-9 Thermostat - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-50-10 70-02 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATION SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-60-1 Oil Pan Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-60-1 Oil Pump Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-60-1 Relief Valve - Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-60-2 Oil Pump Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-60-2 Oil Filter Cooler Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-60-3 Engine Oil Pressure - Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-60-4 FUEL SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-1 Fuel Shutoff Solenoid - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-1 Fuel Shutoff Solenoid Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-1 Fuel Injection Pump - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-2 Fuel Injection Pump Assembly Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-3 Governor Housing Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-6 Governor Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-8 Fuel Camshaft Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-10 Fuel Injection Pump Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-12 Fuel Injection Pump - Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-14 Fuel Injector Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-15 Fuel Injector Nozzle Pressure - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-17 Nozzle Spray Condition . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-18 Valve Seat Tightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-70-18 CYLINDER HEAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-1 Glow Plugs - Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-1 Glow Plugs Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-1 Valve Clearance Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-2 Valve Timing - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-3 Cylinder Head Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-4 Cylinder Head Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-7 Cylinder Head - Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-7 Cylinder Head Top Clearance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-8 Valve Guide - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-8 Valve Guide Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-9 Reconditioning The Valve And Valve Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-9 Valve Spring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-80-11 Valve Tappets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-12 Rocker Arm And Shaft - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-13 Bridge Arm And Bridge Arm Shaft - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-13 Bridge Arm Shaft - Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-14 Push Rod Alignment - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-80-15 CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-1 Piston And Connecting Rod Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-1 Piston And Connecting Rod - Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-2 Cylinder Bore - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-5 Connecting Rod Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-6 Crankshaft Gear Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-6 Crankshaft And Bearings Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-7 Crankshaft And Bearings - Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-90-9 70-03 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-100-1 Timing Gearcase Cover Removal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-100-1 Timing Gearcase Cover Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-100-2 Timing Gears Backlash - Checking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-100-5 Idler Gear And Camshaft Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-100-5 Camshaft - Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-100-6 Idler Gear And Shaft - Servicing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-100-7 TURBOCHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-110-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-110-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-110-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-110-2 FLYWHEEL AND HOUSING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-120-1 Flywheel Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-120-1 Ring Gear Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-120-3 Housing Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-120-3 EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-130-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-130-1 Testing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-130-2 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-130-5 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-130-6 70-04 S650 Service Manual 70-10-1 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION Description The S650 has a Kubota direct injected V3307-DI-T turbo diesel engine with a displacement of 3,3 L (203 in 3 ). The engine is rated at an SAE Gross 55,4 kW (74.3 hp) and has a closed breather system [Figure 70-10-1]. The engine has 4 cylinders and the rotation is counter- clockwise (viewed from the flywheel side). It is equipped with glow plugs for assisting in cold starts. Engine block heaters are also available from Bobcat Parts. To meet emission regulations it is also equipped with an Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) system to reduce Nitrogen Oxide (NOx). The engine serial number is stamped on the engine and is located near the injection pump. The model number is located on the valve cover. Use these numbers to obtain the correct service parts. The engine is liquid cooled with a propylene glycol/water mixture in a radiator. Coolant flow is controlled by a thermostat. The cooling fan is driven by a hydraulic motor. The speed of the fan is determined by the engine coolant temperature sensor and the hydraulic/hydrostatic fluid temperature sensor. Figure 70-10-1 P-85028 70-10-2 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Specifications All dimensions are shown in millimeters. Respective imperial dimensions are given in inches enclosed by parentheses. Valve Springs Valve Timing Rocker Arms Camshaft Tappet Free Length (Intake and Exhaust) 35,1 - 35,6 (1.39 - 1.40) Allowable Limit 34,6(1.36) Fitted Length (Intake and Exhaust) 31,5 (1.24) Setting Load/ Setting Length (Intake and Exhaust) 63,5 N/31,5mm (14.3 lb./1.24in) Allowable Limit 45,9 N/31,5mm (10.3 lb./1.24in) Tilt Allowable Limit (Intake and Exhaust) 1,0 (0.039) Intake Valve (Open) 14 degrees B.T.D.C. (Close) 40 degrees A.B.D.C. Exhaust Valve (Open) 50 degrees B.B.D.C. (Close) 14 degrees A.T.D.C. O.D. of Rocker Arm Shaft 14,973 - 14,984 (0.58949 - 0.58992) I.D. of Rocker Arm Bushings 15,000 - 15,018 (0.59056 - 0.59125) Oil Clearance Between Rocker Arm & Bushing 0,016 - 0,045 (0.00063 - 0.0017) Allowable Limit 0,15 (0.0059) Journal O.D. 1 34.934 - 34,950 (1.3754 - 1.3759) Bearing I.D. 1 35,0 - 35,025 (1.3780 - 1.3789) Journal O.D. 2 43,934 - 43,950 (1.7297 - 1.7303) Bearing I.D. 2 44,000 - 44,025 (1.7323 - 1.7332) Oil Clearance 0,050 - 0,091 (0.002 - 0.0035) Allowable Limit 0,15 (0.0059) Alignment Allowable Limit 0,01 (0.0004) Cam Lobe Height (Intake) 37,50 (1.476) Allowable Limit (Intake) 37,00 (1.457) Cam Lobe Height (Exhaust) 37,90 (1.492) Allowable Limit (Exhaust) 37,40 (1.472) Side Clearance Allowable Limit 0,10 (0.0039) Oil Clearance Between Tappet & Guide 0,020 - 0,050 (0.0079 - 0.0019) Allowable Limit 0,07 (0.003) Tappet O.D. 9,965 - 9,980 (0.3924 - 0.3929) Tappet Guide I.D. 10,000 - 10,015 (0.39370 - 0.39429) 70-10-3 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Specifications (Cont’d) All dimensions are shown in millimeters. Respective imperial dimensions are given in inches enclosed by parentheses. Cylinder Liner Piston Rings Pistons Connecting Rod Oil Pump Cylinder Bore I.D. 94,000 - 94,022 (3.7008 - 3.7016) Allowable Limit 87,15 (3.431) Oversized Cylinder Liner (Bore) I.D. 94,500 - 94,522 (3.7205 - 3.7213) Allowable Limit 94,65 (3.726) Ring Gap (Top Ring) 0,25 - 0,40 (0.0099 - 0.015) Allowable Limit 1,25 (0.0492) Ring Gap (2nd Ring) 0,30 - 0,45 (0.012 - 0.017) Allowable Limit 1,25 (0.0492) Ring Gap (Oil Ring) 0,25 - 0,45 (0.0099 - 0.017) Allowable Limit 1,25 (0.0492) Side Clearance of Ring Groove: Top Ring 0,050 - 0,090 (0.0020 - 0.0035) Allowable Limit 0,15 (0.0059) Second Ring 0,090 - 0,12 (0.0035 - 0.0047) Allowable Limit 0,0079 (0.20) Oil Ring 0,020 - 0,060 (0.00079 - 0.0023) Allowable Limit 0,15 (0.0059) Piston Pin Bore 28,000 - 28,013 (1.1024 - 1.1028) Allowable Limit 28,05 (0.0059) Piston Pin O.D. 28,006 - 28,011 (1.1026 - 1.1027) Small End Bushing I.D. 28,031 - 28,046 (1.1036 - 1.1041) Oil Clearance Between Piston Pin & Small End Bushing 0,020 - 0,040 (0.00079 - 0.0015) Allowable Limit 0,15 (0.0059) Connecting Rod Alignment Allowable Limit 0,05 (0.002) Oil Pressure Rated RPM 193,1 - 393,0 kPa (1,9 - 3,9 bar) (28 - 57 psi) Allowable Limit 144,8 kPa (1,4 bar) (21 psi) Idle Speed Allowable Limit 48,3 kPa (0,48 bar) (7 psi) Clearance Between Inner Rotor & Outer Rotor 0,030 - 0,090 (0.002 - 0.003) Clearance Between Outer Rotor & Pump Body 0,100 - 0,184 (0.00394 - 0.00724) End Clearance Between Inner Rotor & Cover 0,025 - 0,075 (0.00099 - 0.0029) 70-10-4 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Specifications (Cont’d) All dimensions are shown in millimeters. Respective imperial dimensions are given in inches enclosed by parentheses. Crankshaft Timing Gear Thermostat Crankshaft Alignment Limit Permitted 0,02 (0.0008) Oil Clearance Between Journal & Bearing 0,030 - 0,073 (0.0012 - 0.0028) Limit Permitted 0,020 (0.0079) Journal O.D. 79,977 - 79,990 (3.1487 - 3.1492) Oil Clearance Between Crank Pin & Bearing 0,017 - 0,048 (0.00067 - 0.0018) Limit Permitted 0,20 (0.0079) Crank Pin O.D. 49,980 - 49,991 (1.9678 - 1.9681) Crank Pin I.D. (Blue) 53,010 - 53,020 (2.0870 - 2.0874) Crank Pin I.D. (No Color) 53,000 - 53,010 (2.0867 - 2.0870) Crankshaft Side Clearance 0,15 - 0,35 (0.0059 - 0.013) Limit Permitted 0,50 (0.020) Timing Gear Backlash: Crank Gear-Cam Gear 0,0410 - 0,139 (0.00162 - 0.00547) Allowable Limit 0,22 (0.0087) Idle Gear-Cam Gear 0,0410 - 0,134 (0.00162 - 0.00527) Allowable Limit 0,22 (0.0087) Idle Gear-Injection Pump Gear 0,0410 - 0,134 (0.00162 - 0.00527) Allowable Limit 0,22 (0.0087) Oil Clearance Between Idle Gear Shaft & Idle Gear Bushing: 0,050 - 0,091 (0.0020 - 0.0035) Idle Gear Bushing I.D. 35,025 - 35,050 (1.3790 - 1.3799) Idle Gear Shaft O.D. 34,959 - 34,975 (1.3764 - 1.3769) Idle Gear Side Clearance 0,15 - 0,25 (0.0059 - 0.0098) Allowable Limit 0,90 (0.035) Valve Opening Temperature 74,5 - 78,5°C (166.1 - 173°F) Valve Fully Open 90°C (194°F) 70-10-5 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) All dimensions are shown in millimeters. Respective imperial dimensions are given in inches enclosed by parentheses. Torque Values Troubleshooting The following troubleshooting chart is provided for assistance in locating and correcting problems which are most common. Many of the recommended procedures must be done by authorized Bobcat Service Personnel only. Thread Size (Dia. x Pitch) Material Head Mark 4 Head Mark 7 Head Mark 10 M5 x 0.8 4 - 5 N•m (3 - 4 ft-lb) M6 x 1.0 8 - 9 N•m (6 - 7 ft-lb) 8 - 12 N•m (6 - 9 ft-lb) M8 x 1.25 8 - 12 N•m (6 - 9 ft-lb) 15 - 22 N•m (11 - 16 ft-lb) 24 - 34 N•m (18 - 25 ft-lb) M10 x 1.25 18 - 24 N•m (13 - 18 ft-lb) 30 - 41 N•m (22 - 30 ft-lb) 49 - 68 N•m (36 - 50 ft-lb) M12 x 1.25 30 - 41 N•m (22 - 30 ft-lb) 54 - 73 N•m (40 - 54 ft-lb) 94 - 118 N•m (69 - 87 ft-lb) M14 x 1.5 49 - 68 N•m (36 - 50 ft-lb) 79 - 108 N•m (58 - 80 ft-lb) 157 - 186 N•m (116 - 137 ft-lb) PROBLEM CAUSE Slow cranking speed. 1, 2, 3, 54 Engine will not start. 2, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 19, 27, 28, 29 Difficult to start. 1, 2, 5, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 25, 27, 28, 29,54 No power for engine. 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 15, 16, 17, 18, 20, 21, 22, 23, 27, 28, 29 Engine is mis-firing. 8, 9, 11, 12, 13, 15, 16, 17, 21, 22, 24, 25, 26, 28 Too much fuel consumption. 10, 12, 13, 15, 16, 17, 19, 20, 21, 23, 24, 25, 27, 28, 29 Black exhaust. 10, 12, 13, 15, 16, 17, 19, 20, 21, 23, 24, 25, 27, 28, 29 Blue/white exhaust. 4, 10, 15, 16, 17, 21, 23, 27, 29, 30, 50 Low oil pressure. 4, 31, 32, 33, 34, 35, 37, 38, 39, 52 Engine knocking. 13, 15, 16, 19, 22, 24, 25, 27, 29, 31, 40, 41, 53 Engine running rough. 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 17, 18, 22, 24, 25, 26, 29, 40, 53 Vibration. 12, 13, 17, 21, 22, 25, 26, 29, 40, 42, 43 High oil pressure warning. 4, 33, 36 Overheating. 10, 12, 13, 15, 16, 20, 21, 40, 44, 45, 46, 47, 48, 51 Too much crankcase pressure. 22, 27, 29, 30, 40, 49 Poor compression. 10, 16, 21, 24, 25, 27, 28, 29, 30, 41, 53 Start and stop. 9, 10, 11 70-10-6 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Troubleshooting (Cont’d) KEY TO CORRECT THE CAUSE 1. Alternator belt is loose or damaged. 28. Worn valve and seats. 2. Bad electrical connections. 29. Broken or worn piston rings. 3. Faulty starter motor. 30. Worn valve stems or guides. 4. Incorrect grade of oil. 31. Worn or damaged bearings. 5. Low cranking speed. 32. Not enough oil in the crankcase. 6. Fuel tank empty. 33. Switch/sensor is defective. 7. Faulty stop control operation. 34. Oil pump worn. 8. Plugged fuel line. 35. Relief valve is sticking open. 9. Plugged fuel filter. 36. Relief valve is sticking closed. 10. Restriction in the air cleaner. 37. Broken relief valve spring. 11. Air in the fuel system. 38. Faulty suction pipe. 12. Faulty fuel injection pump. 39. Plugged oil filter. 13. Faulty fuel injectors. 40. Piston seizure. 14. Broken injection pump drive. 41. Incorrect piston height. 15. Incorrect injection pump timing. 42. Faulty engine mounting. 16. Incorrect valve timing. 43. Incorrect flywheel alignment. 17. Poor compression. 44. Faulty thermostat. 18. Plugged fuel tank vent. 45. Restriction in water jacket. 19. Incorrect grade of fuel. 46. Loose alternator belt. 20. Exhaust pipe restriction. 47. Plugged radiator. 21. Cylinder head gasket leaking. 48. Faulty water pump. 22. Overheating. 49. Plugged breather pipe. 23. Cold running. 50. Damaged valve stem deflectors. 24. Incorrect tappet adjustment. 51. Coolant level to low. 25. Sticking valves. 52. Plugged oil pump pipe strainer. 26. Incorrect fuel lines. 53. Broken valve spring. 27. Worn cylinder bores. 54. Damaged Battery 70-10-7 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Removal And Installation DANGER P-90328 AVOID DEATH • Disconnecting or loosening any hydraulic tubeline, hose, fitting, component or a part failure can cause lift arms to drop. • Keep out of this area when lift arms are raised unless supported by an approved lift arm support. Replace if damaged. D-1009-0409 WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Put jackstands under the rear corners of the loader. Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Drain the hydraulic reservoir. (See Removing And Replacing Hydraulic Fluid on Page 10-120-2.) Disconnect the steering linkage. Remove the battery from the loader. (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-20-1.) Drain the engine coolant from the cooling system. (See Removing And Replacing Coolant on Page 10-90-3.) Remove the air cleaner. (See Housing Removal And Installation on Page 70-40-1.) Remove the muffler. (See Removal And Installation on Page 70-30-1.) Figure 70-10-2 Loosen the engine speed control cable adjustment nuts (Item 1) and remove the engine speed control cable from the ball pivot (Item 2). [Figure 70-10-2]. Figure 70-10-3 Disconnect engine ground cable (Item 1) and chassis ground cable (Item 2) [Figure 70-10-3]. P-90575 1 2 P-85852 1 2 70-10-8 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-10-4 Disconnect engine oil pressure sender connector (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-4]. Disconnect the alternator wiring (Item 2) [Figure 70-10- 4]. Disconnect the engine ground cable (Item 3) [Figure 70- 10-4]. Disconnect fuel shut-off solenoid connector (Item 4) [Figure 70-10-4]. Cut cable tie (Item 5) [Figure 70-10-4]. Figure 70-10-5 Disconnect glow plug wiring (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-5]. Figure 70-10-6 Disconnect flywheel rpm sensor (Item 1) [Figure 70-10- 6]. Cut cable ties (Item 2) [Figure 70-10-6]. Disconnect the engine starter positive cable (Item 3) [Figure 70-10-6]. Disconnect the starter wiring harness connector (Item 4) [Figure 70-10-6]. Figure 70-10-7 Disconnect fuel line (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-10] for lift pump and plug. P-85849 1 3 4 2 5 P-85853 1 P-85857 3 1 4 2 P-85854 1 70-10-9 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-10-8 Disconnect and plug fuel return line (Item 1) [Figure 70- 10-8]. Figure 70-10-9 Disconnect coolant return line (Item 1) [Figure 70-10- 13]. Figure 70-10-10 Disconnect radiator hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-10]. Figure 70-10-11 Disconnect radiator hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-11] from the thermostat housing. P-85855 1 P-85895 1 P-85894 1 P-85892 1 70-10-10 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-10-12 Disconnect coolant temperature connector (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-12] from thermostat housing. Cap or plug all hoses and fittings. Figure 70-10-13 Remove and cap fan inlet hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-10- 13]. Remove and cap fan outlet hose (Item 2) [Figure 70-10- 13]. Figure 70-10-14 Mark and disconnect the drive motor hoses (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-14]. Disconnect the tandem pump case drain hose (Item 2) [Figure 70-10-14]. Cap or plug all hoses and fittings. NOTE: The hydraulic fittings (Item 1) [Figure 70-10- 17] on the hydrostatic pump must be tightened to 156 - 170 N•m (115 - 125 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-10-15 Disconnect tandem pump suction hoses (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-15]. Disconnect the charge pump inlet hose (Item 2) [Figure 70-10-15]. Cap or plug all hoses and fittings. P-85893 1 P-85897 1 2 P-85909 1 1 2 P-85907 1 1 2 70-10-11 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-10-16 Disconnect hydraulic control valve inlet hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-16]. Cap or plug all hoses and fittings. Figure 70-10-17 Remove rear engine mounting bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70- 10-17]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolt to 135 N•m (100 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-10-18 Remove the mounting bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-18] from the left engine mount. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-18] to 135 N•m (100 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-10-19 Remove the mounting bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-19] from the right engine mount. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolt to 135 N•m (100 ft-lb) torque. P-85908 1 P-85876 1 P-85911 P-85910 70-10-12 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-10-20 Use the engine removal tool (MEL 1653-1) [Figure 70- 10-20] and the attachment (MEL 1653-5) [Figure 70-10- 21] to aid in the removal and installation of the engine. Figure 70-10-21 Install the engine removal attachment (MEL1653-5) [Figure 70-10-21] on the engine. Figure 70-10-22 Install the engine removal attachment (Item 1) on the left hand muffler support bracket (Item 2) [Figure 70-10-22]. Installation: Use 9,525 x 38,1mm (0.375 x 1.5 in) bolts and nuts grade 5 minimum. Tighten the all bolts and nuts that hold the engine removal attachment onto the engine. P-76872 P-85912 P-85920 1 2 70-10-13 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-10-23 Install the engine removal attachment (Item 1) on the right hand muffler support bracket (Item 2) [Figure 70- 10-22]. Figure 70-10-24 Install the engine removal tool (Item 1) into the attachment (Item 2) and insert the pin (Item 3) [Figure 70-10-24]. Install the chain hoist on the eyelet [Figure 70-10-24] of the removal tool. Remove the engine/hydrostatic pump assembly from the loader. P-85918 2 1 P-85919 2 3 1 70-10-14 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Mount Replacement Figure 70-10-25 Use the following procedure to install new rear engine mount: Remove the existing mount from the engine. Refer to engine removal and installation for engine mount locations. Replace all three engine mounts one rear and two sides. Use the parts shown to install the new engine mounts [Figure 70-10-25]: Hex Nut - (Item 1) Washer - (Item 2) Cup Washer - (Item 3) Engine Mount - (Item 4) Tube Spacer - (Item 5) Engine Mount - (Item 6) Cup Washer - (Item 7) Mounting Bolt - (Item 8) Figure 70-10-26 Install the new engine mount as shown in the cut away side view [Figure 70-10-27]. Tighten the mounting bolts to 135 N•m (100 f.-lb) torque. Figure 70-10-27 Use the parts shown to install the new side engine mounts [Figure 70-10-25]. Mounting Bolt - (Item 1) Cup Washer - (Item 2) Engine Mount - (Item 3) Tube Spacer - (Item 4) Engine Mount - (Item 5) Cup Washer - (Item 6) Retaining Nut - (Item 7) P-85989 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 P-90300 Washer Engine Mounting Bracket Spacer Engine Mount Snubbing Washer Loader Frame P-85990A 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 70-10-15 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Engine Mount Replacement (Cont’d) Figure 70-10-28 Install the new engine mount as shown in the cut away side view [Figure 70-10-27]. Tighten the mounting bolts to 135 N•m (100 ft-lb) torque. Compression - Checking Figure 70-10-29 The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL10630 - Engine Compression Kit MEL1655 - Compression Adapter The engine must be at operating temperature. Remove the glow plugs. (See CYLINDER HEAD on Page 70-80-1.) Install the correct compression adapter (Item 1) [Figure 70-10-29] into the cylinder head. P-85987 Washer Engine Mounting Bracket Spacer Engine Mount Snubbing Washer Loader Frame P-85940 1 70-10-16 S650 Service Manual ENGINE INFORMATION (CONT’D) Compression - Checking (Cont’d) Figure 70-10-30 Connect the compression gauge to the adapter [Figure 70-10-30]. Make sure the engine speed control is fully backward (engine idle). Disconnect the fuel stop solenoid. Crank the engine with the starter cranking rpm. If the measurement is below the allowable limit, check the cylinder, piston ring, top clearance, valve and cylinder head. Compression Pressure should be 3,9 MPa (39,2 bar) (569 psi) Allowable Limit (minimum) is 2,9 MPa (29,0 bar) (421 psi) No more than 10% variance among cylinders. Figure 70-10-31 Push the button on the compression gauge to release pressure [Figure 70-10-31]. Connect the fuel stop solenoid. P-85941 P-85939 70-20-1 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL Removal And Installation Figure 70-20-1 Remove the two nuts (Item 1) [Figure 70-20-1]. Figure 70-20-2 The speed control cable (Item 1) is connected to the speed control handle (Item 2) by a ball and socket end [Figure 70-20-2]. Disconnect the speed control cable (Item 1) from the speed control handle (Item 2) [Figure 70-20-2]. Loosen the jam nut (Item 3) [Figure 70-20-2] from the speed control cable. Remove the cable from the speed control handle. Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-20-3 Remove the nut (Item 1) and remove the two conical washers (Item 2) [Figure 70-20-3]. Remove the handle (Item 3) [Figure 70-20-3]. Installation: Install the two conical washers with the concave surfaces facing each other (Item 2) [Figure 70- 20-3]. Installation: Tighten the nut (Item 1) [Figure 70-20-3] until the speed control lever moves backward and forward at a comfortable tension. Figure 70-20-4 Inspect and replaced any damaged parts [Figure 70-20- 4]. P-85789 2 1 P-85790 1 2 3 P-85791 2 1 3 P-85792 70-20-2 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (CONT’D) Cable Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Remove the speed control lever. (See Removal And Installation on Page 70-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 70-20-5 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-20-5] from the clamp that secures the cable. Figure 70-20-6 Remove the three bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-20-6] from the clamps that secure the cable. Figure 70-20-7 Remove the bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-20-7] from the clamp that secures the cable. Figure 70-20-8 The speed control cable is connected to the linkage by a ball and socket end [Figure 70-20-8]. Loosen the jam nut (Item 1) [Figure 70-20-8] from the speed control cable. Disconnect the speed control cable (Item 2) from the linkage (Item 3) by rolling the cable away from the engine [Figure 70-20-8]. Remove the speed control cable. P-85806 1 P-85801 1 P-85801 P-85805 1 P-90575 1 2 3 70-21-1 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12469 AND BELOW & S/N A3NW11130 AND BELOW Removal And Installation Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 70-21-1 Remove the two mounting nuts (Item 1) [Figure 70-21-1] from the right side foot rest. Remove the foot rest from the loader. Figure 70-21-2 Loosen the clamping bolt (Item 1) and remove the engine speed control foot pedal (Item 2) [Figure 70-21-2]. Installation: Install the engine speed foot pedal (Item 2) but do not tighten the clamping bolt. Set the hand throttle to high idle then place the foot pedal to high idle and tighten the clamping bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-21-2]. Figure 70-21-3 Remove the four bolts (Item 1) and washer (Item 2) [Figure 70-21-3]. Lay the assembly down. Figure 70-21-4 Loosen the engine speed control cable u-bolt nuts (Item 1) and remove the engine speed control cables from the ball pivots (Item 2) [Figure 70-21-4]. Remove panel assembly from the loader. P-90733 1 P-90734 1 2 P-90735 1 1 1 2 P-90754 1 1 2 2 70-21-2 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12469 AND BELOW & S/N A3NW11130 AND BELOW (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-21-5 Remove the spring (Item 1) from the engine speed control foot pedal pivot assembly (Item 2) and the engine speed control hand throttle bracket (Item 3) [Figure 70- 21-5] Figure 70-21-6 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-21-6] from the engine speed control hand assembly. Figure 70-21-7 Remove the nut (Item 1) and pivot bolt (Item 2) from the engine speed control hand bracket assembly (Item 3) [Figure 70-21-7]. Remove the engine speed control hand throttle cam lever (Item 4) [Figure 70-21-7]. Figure 70-21-8 The pivot assembly shown disassembled [Figure 70-21- 8]. NOTE: No lubrication is necessary or recommended on the engine speed control. P-90756 1 2 3 P-90755 1 P-90769 1 2 34 P-90767 70-21-3 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12469 AND BELOW & S/N A3NW11130 AND BELOW (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 70-21-9 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 70-21-9] from the engine speed control foot pedal pivot. Figure 70-21-10 The engine speed control foot pedal pivot assembly shown disassembled, [Figure 70-21-10] replace worn parts as needed. NOTE: No lubrication is necessary or recommended on the engine speed control. Figure 70-21-11 The engine speed control foot pedal pivot assembly roller bearing [Figure 70-21-11] shown disassembled. P-90736 1 P-90771 P-90773 70-21-4 S650 Service Manual 70-22-1 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12470 AND ABOVE & S/N A3NW11131 AND ABOVE Removal And Installation Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 70-22-1 Remove the two mounting nuts (Item 1) [Figure 70-22-1] from the right side foot rest. Remove the foot rest from the loader. Figure 70-22-2 Loosen the clamping bolt (Item 1) and remove the engine speed control foot pedal (Item 2) [Figure 70-22-2]. Installation: Install the engine speed foot pedal (Item 2) but do not tighten the clamping bolt. Set the hand throttle to high idle then place the foot pedal to high idle and tighten the clamping bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-22-2]. Figure 70-22-3 Remove the four bolts (Item 1) and washer (Item 2) [Figure 70-22-3]. Lay the assembly down. Figure 70-22-4 Loosen the engine speed control cable u-bolt nuts (Item 1) and remove the engine speed control cables from the ball pivots (Item 2) [Figure 70-22-4]. Remove panel assembly from the loader. P-90733 1 P-90734 1 2 P-90735 1 1 1 2 P100359 1 2 2 1 70-22-2 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12470 AND ABOVE & S/N A3NW11131 AND ABOVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-22-5 Remove the spring (Item 1) from the engine speed control foot pedal pivot assembly (Item 2) and the engine speed control hand throttle bracket (Item 3) [Figure 70- 22-5] Figure 70-22-6 Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-22-6] from the engine speed control hand assembly. Figure 70-22-7 Remove the nuts (Item 1) and pivot bolts (Item 2) from the engine speed control hand bracket assembly (Item 3) [Figure 70-22-7]. Remove the engine speed control hand throttle cam lever (Item 4) and engine throttle cable lever Item 5) [Figure 70-22-7]. Figure 70-22-8 The pivot assemblies shown disassembled [Figure 70- 22-8]. NOTE: No lubrication is necessary or recommended on the engine speed control. P100382 1 2 3 P-90755 1 P100381 3 4 1 2 5 P100380 70-22-3 S650 Service Manual ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12470 AND ABOVE & S/N A3NW11131 AND ABOVE (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 70-22-9 Remove the snap ring (Item 1) [Figure 70-22-9] from the engine speed control foot pedal pivot. Figure 70-22-10 The engine speed control foot pedal pivot assembly shown disassembled, [Figure 70-22-10] replace worn parts as needed. NOTE: No lubrication is necessary or recommended on the engine speed control. Figure 70-22-11 The engine speed control foot pedal pivot assembly roller bearing [Figure 70-22-11] shown disassembled. P-90736 1 P100376 P100375 70-22-4 S650 Service Manual 70-30-1 S650 Service Manual MUFFLER Removal And Installation Figure 70-30-1 Open the rear door and remove the rear grille and side panels. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-60-1.) Remove the bolts (Item 1) from the engine cover (Item 2) [Figure 70-30-1] and remove engine cover. Remove the muffler mounting bolts (Item 3) [Figure 70- 30-1]. Remove exhaust manifold to muffler mounting bolts (Item 4) [Figure 70-30-1]. Remove the muffler from the loader. Installation: Tighten the muffler mounting bolts to 43 - 47 N•m (32 - 35 ft-lb) torque. P-85843 1 1 1 2 3 3 4 70-30-2 S650 Service Manual 70-40-1 S650 Service Manual AIR CLEANER Housing Removal And Installation Open the rear door. Figure 70-40-1 Remove the top two mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70- 40-1] from the air cleaner mount bracket. Figure 70-40-2 Remove the bottom mounting bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70- 40-2] from the air cleaner mount bracket. Figure 70-40-3 Disconnect the wire connector (Item 1) [Figure 70-40-3] from the air cleaner sender. Loosen the hose clamp (Item 2) and disconnect the hose (Items 3) [Figure 70-40-3] from the air cleaner. NOTE: Disconnect the scavenger hose (Item 4) [Figure 70-40-3] if equipped. Remove the air cleaner from the loader. P-85689 1 P-85688 1 P-85694 1 2 3 4 70-40-2 S650 Service Manual AIR CLEANER (CONT’D) Housing Bracket Removal And Installation Figure 70-40-4 Remove the three bolts (Item 1) and remove the air cleaner bracket (Item 2) [Figure 70-40-4]. P-85691 1 2 70-50-1 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM Radiator Removal And Installation Stop the engine and open the rear door. Remove the rear grille and side panels. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-60-1.) Remove the oil cooler. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-90-1.) WARNING AVOID BURNS Do not remove radiator cap when the engine is hot. You can be seriously burned. W-2070-1203 Figure 70-50-1 Loosen the radiator cap (Item 1) from the pressurized expansion tank. Disconnect and plug radiator air bleed hose (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-1]. Figure 70-50-2 Remove hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-2] on the engine oil cooler and drain the coolant into a container. Figure 70-50-3 Disconnect the pressurized expansion tank fill hose (Item 1), disconnect the coolant air bleed hose (Item 2) and the radiator hose (Item 3) [Figure 70-50-3]. Remove the radiator hold down bolt (Item 4) [Figure 70- 50-3]. P-90574 2 1 P-85606 1 P-85949 1 2 3 4 70-50-2 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT'D) Radiator Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-50-4 Disconnect the radiator hose (Item 1) and remove the radiator hold down bolt (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-4]. Figure 70-50-5 Remove radiator hold down bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-50- 5]. Figure 70-50-6 Remove radiator hold down bolt (Item 1) [Figure 70-50- 6]. Remove the radiator (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-6]. Lift the radiator up and remove it from the loader. NOTE: Coolant recovery tank removed for photo clarity P-90555 2 1 P-85952 1 P-85954 1 2 70-50-3 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT’D) Hydraulic Fan Description The proportioning valve meters the flow through the fan motor. The proportioning valve receives signals from the controller which gathers information from both the engine and hydraulic temperature sensors. The hydraulic fan is used to cool the engine and hydraulic / hydrostatic systems. The hydraulic fan consists of a fan and hydraulic motor that is controlled by a proportioning valve. NOTE: The proportioning valve is factory set and can not be adjusted accurately in the field due to the adjustment being tamper proof. The fan speed is determined by the engine coolant temperature and the hydraulic fluid temperature. Depending on these temperatures the fan speed (rpms) can range from 0 - 4000 rpms. The hydraulic fan speed at cold engine startup will range from 0 to 500 rpms until the engine coolant and the hydraulic fluid reach normal operating temperatures. During normal operating temperatures the fan speed may range from approximately 1900 - 3500 rpms. 70-50-4 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT’D) Hydraulic Fan Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-50-7 NOTE: The mounting gasket (Item 1), proportioning valve, and proportioning valve O-rings, back up washer and coil mounting nut (Item 2) are available from Bobcat Parts. The fan motor (Item 3) [Figure 70-50-7] must be replaced as an assembly if damaged. Remove the filter cover (Item 4) [Figure 70-50-7]. Installation: Tighten filter cover (Item 4) [Figure 70-50- 7] to 47,5 - 54 N•m (35 - 40 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-50-8 Remove coil mounting nut (Item 1), the coil (Item 2), and the coil valve stem (Item 3) [Figure 70-50-8]. NOTE: Coil mounting nut must be replaced each time it is removed. Coil mounting nuts are available from Bobcat Parts. Installation: Install coil mounting nut with the counterbored space (Item 4) [Figure 70-50-8] facing towards the coil and tighten securely by hand. Installation: Tighten coil valve stem (Item 3) [Figure 70- 50-8] to 28 - 34 N•m (21 - 25 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-50-9 Inspect and replace O-rings (Item 1) and back up washer (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-9] if necessary. Figure 70-50-10 Remove the pressure transducer (Item 1) [Figure 70-50- 10]. Installation: Tighten the pressure transducer (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-10] to 10 - 10,9 N•m (7.4 - 8.1 ft-lb) torque. P-76714A 3 2 1 4 P-76716A 1 2 3 4 P-76637 1 2 P-76717 1 70-50-5 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT'D) Hydraulic Fan Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 70-50-11 Inspect and replace the O-ring (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-11] if necessary. Lower Fan Duct Removal And Installation Figure 70-50-12 Unhook the rubber straps (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-11] and remove lower fan duct. Blower Housing Removal And Installation IMPORTANT When repairing hydrostatic and hydraulic systems, clean the work area before disassembly and keep all parts clean. Always use caps and plugs on hoses, tubelines and ports to keep dirt out. Dirt can quickly damage the system. I-2003-0888 Remove the air conditioning condenser if equipped. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-60-1.) Remove the oil cooler. (See Removal And Installation on Page 20-90-1.) Remove the radiator. (See Radiator Removal And Installation on Page 70-50-1.) Figure 70-50-13 Remove the four bolts (Item 1)[Figure 70-50-13]. Remove the blower housing (Item 2)[Figure 70-50-13] from the loader. NOTE: Engine and hydraulic fan assembly removed for photo clarity. NOTE: Line up the bushings and bolts thru the fan shroud P-76726 1 P-85470 1 P-90063 1 1 2 70-50-6 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT’D) Hydraulic Fan Motor Assembly Removal And Installation Figure 70-50-14 Remove the fan motor inlet hose (Item 1) and outlet hose (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-14]. Remove the fan case drain hose (Item 3) [Figure 70-50- 14]. Remove the charge pressure hose (Item 4) [Figure 70- 50-14]. Cap and plug all hose’s. Disconnect the electrical connectors (Item 5) [Figure 70- 50-14]. Figure 70-50-15 Remove the four bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-15]. Remove fan assembly (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-15]. Fan Removal And Installation Figure 70-50-16 Remove the four bolts (Item 1) and the cover plate (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-16]. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 10,2 N•m (7.5 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-50-17 Remove the nut (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-17] and washer from the motor shaft. Installation: Tighten the nut to 61 - 75 N•m (45 - 55 ft-lb) torque. P-85897 1 2 5 3 5 4 P-90268 1 1 P-90313 1 1 2 P-90065 1 70-50-7 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT’D) Hydraulic Fan Motor Removal And Installation Figure 70-50-18 Remove and discard the two nuts and cotter pins (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-18]. Remove the two washers (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-18]. Installation: Tighten the nuts to 10,2 N•m (7.5 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-50-19 Remove and discard the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70- 50-19] then remove motor. Installation: Tighten the bolts to 10,2 N•m (7.5 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Always install new bolts, nuts, cotter pins, and rubber gasket when installing the fan motor. Figure 70-50-20 Use the following procedure to remove the fan hub from the fan motor shaft: Install a bushing (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-20] in the hub to protect the fan motor shaft and threads during removal. Use two bolts to position a puller (Item 2) on the bushing (Item 1) as shown [Figure 70-50-20]. NOTE: If a puller is not available one can be made if needed to remove the hub from the shaft. Tighten the bolts and strike the puller with a hammer to loosen the hub from the motor shaft. P-90069 1 2 2 P-90076 1 P-90062 70-50-8 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT'D) Water Pump Removal And Installation Drain the cooling system. Remove the alternator belt. Remove the water pump bolts. Figure 70-50-21 Remove the water pump (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-21]. Installation: Always use a new gasket (Item 2) [Figure 70-50-21] when installing the water pump. Water Pump Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-50-22 Remove the flange (Item 1) [Figure 70-50-22]. Press the shaft (Item 2) and impeller (Item 3) [Figure 70- 50-22] out the impeller side of the water pump. Remove the impeller (Item 3) [Figure 70-50-22] from the shaft. Remove the seal (Item 4) [Figure 70-50-22]. Install a new seal (Item 4) [Figure 70-50-22] when assembling the water pump. P-90018 1 2 P-90019 1 2 3 4 70-50-9 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT'D) Thermostat Housing Removal And Installation Figure 70-50-23 Remove the bolts (Item 1), housing (Item 2), gasket (Item 3) and thermostat (Item 4) [Figure 70-50-23]. Remove bolts (Item 5), housing (Item 6), and gasket (Item 7) from the cylinder head [Figure 70-50-23]. P-90166 1 2 3 4 5 7 6 70-50-10 S650 Service Manual ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM (CONT’D) Thermostat - Checking Figure 70-50-24 Push down the thermostat valve and insert a string between the valve and the valve seat. Place the thermostat and a thermometer in a container with water and gradually heat the water [Figure 70-50- 24]. Hold the string to suspend the thermostat in the water. When the water temperature rises, the thermostat valve will open, allowing it to fall down from the string. Continue heating the water and read the temperature when the valve has risen by about 8 mm (0.315 in). If the measurement is not acceptable, replace the thermostat. Thermostat’s valve opening tempera- ture Factory spec. 74,5 - 78,5°C 166.1 - 173°F Temperature at which thermostat completely opens Factory spec. 90°C 194°F P-37172 70-60-1 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATION SYSTEM Oil Pan Removal And Installation Remove the engine and hydrostatic pump assembly from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) The engine will have to be on an engine stand or suspended in the air safely to remove the oil pan. Figure 70-60-1 Remove oil pan bolts (Item 1) securing oil pan (Item 2) [Figure 70-60-2]. Slightly tapping on the oil pan with a soft mallet will break loose the oil pan from the engine block. Installation: Use a liquid gasket adhesive to the oil pan side of the oil pan gasket. Tighten oil pan bolts to 39 - 75 N•m (29 - 33 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-60-2 Remove the oil strainer (Item 1) and O-ring (Item 2) [Figure 70-60-2] from the engine block. Installation: Apply oil to O-ring. Oil Pump Removal And Installation Figure 70-60-3 Remove the bolts from the front cover / oil pump (Item 1) [Figure 70-60-3]. Installation: Use a liquid gasket adhesive.Tighten the front cover / oil pump mounting bolts to 24 - 27 N•m (18 - 20 ft-lb) torque. P-85062 1 2 P-85056 1 2 P-85061 1 70-60-2 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATION SYSTEM (CONT’D) Relief Valve - Testing Figure 70-60-4 Remove the relief valve retaining screw (Item 1) from the front cover / oil pump (Item 2) and remove the relief valve spring (Item 3) and relief valve (Item 4) [Figure 70-60-4]. Measure free length of relief valve spring (Item 3) [Figure 70-60-4] and check the entire surface of spring for any scratches. Replace if out of spec or any scratches. Installation: Tighten relief valve retaining screw (Item 1) [Figure 70-60-4] 69 - 78 N•m (51 - 57 ft-lb) torque. Oil Pump Inspection Figure 70-60-5 Remove oil pump cover screws. Measure the clearance between the lobes of the inner rotor and outer rotor [Figure 70-60-5]. Installation: Tighten cover screws to 7,9 - 9,3 N•m (5.8 - 6.8 ft-lb) If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the oil pump. Figure 70-60-6 Measure the clearance between the outer rotor and pump body [Figure 70-60-6]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the oil pump. Free Length 60,0 - 60,5 mm (2.37 - 2.38 in) Allowable Limit 55,0 mm (2.17 in) P-85057 1 2 4 3 P-85058 Clearance Between Inner & Outer Rotor 0,030 - 0,090 mm (0.0012 - 0.0035 in) Allowable limit 0,30 mm (0.012 in.) Clearance Between Outer Rotor & Body 0,100 - 0,184 mm (0.00394 - 0.00724 in) Allowable limit 0,30 mm (0.012 in) P-85059 70-60-3 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATION SYSTEM (CONT’D) Oil Pump Inspection (Cont’d) Figure 70-60-7 Put a piece of press gauge on the rotor face [Figure 70- 60-7]. Install the cover and tighten the bolts. Remove the cover carefully. Measure the width of the press gauge [Figure 70-60-7]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit replace the oil pump. Oil Filter Cooler Removal And Installation Figure 70-60-8 Remove the cooling hose’s (Item 1) [Figure 70-60-8]. Remove oil filter cartridge (Item 2) and the oil cooler joint screw (Item 3) [Figure 70-60-8]. Remove oil cooler (Item 4) [Figure 70-60-8]. Installation: Tighten oil cooler joint screw (Item 3) [Figure 70-60-8] 64 - 73 N•m (47 - 54 ft-lb) torque. End Clearance 0,25 - 0,75 mm (0.00099 - 0.0029 in) Allowable limit 0,225 mm (0.00886 in) P-85060 P-85072 1 2 3 4 70-60-4 S650 Service Manual LUBRICATION SYSTEM (CONT’D) Engine Oil Pressure - Testing Remove the oil pressure sender. Figure 70-60-9 Install a pressure gauge [Figure 70-60-9]. Start the engine and run until it is at operating temperature. If the oil pressure is less than the allowable limit, check the following items: * Engine Oil Level Low * Oil Pump Defective * Oil Galley Plugged * Oil Strainer Plugged * Excessive Clearance at the Rod & Main Bearings * Oil Pump Relief Valve Stuck At Idle Speed Allowable Limit 48,3 kPa (0.49 bar) (7 psi) At Rated Speed 193,0 - 393,0 kPa (1,9 - 3,9 bar) (28 - 57 psi) Allowable Limit 144,8 kPa (1,4 bar) (21 psi) PI-10010 70-70-1 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM Fuel Shutoff Solenoid - Checking Figure 70-70-1 Stop the engine and open the rear door [Figure 70-70-1]. Disconnect the connector (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-1] from the fuel shutoff solenoid. Use an ohmmeter to check the fuel shutoff solenoid. Figure 70-70-2 The reading between electrical connector terminal C and terminal A must be between approximately 0.33 ohm [Figure 70-70-2]. The reading between electrical connector terminal C and terminal B must be between approximately 24.5 ohm. Fuel Shutoff Solenoid Removal And Installation Figure 70-70-3 Stop the engine and open the rear door. Disconnect the connector (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-3]. Figure 70-70-4 Remove the mounting screws (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-4] of the fuel shutoff solenoid. Reverse the above procedure to install the fuel shutoff solenoid. P-85956 1 P-85955 P-85956 1 P-85957 1 70-70-2 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injection Pump - Checking The injection pump contains parts which have a very close tolerance and its operation has a direct effect on the performance of the engine. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 The tools listed will be needed to do the following procedure: MEL 1237 - Adapter Fuel Line MEL 1173-1 Pressure Gauge To check the discharge pressure at the fuel injection pump, use the following procedure: Disconnect a high pressure fuel line from the injection pump. Loosen the other end of the same fuel line so it can be turned away from the fitting. Figure 70-70-5 Connect the adapter fuel line (Item 1) to the fitting and connect the pressure gauge (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-5]. Move the speed control lever to the high engine idle position. Turn the flywheel to increase the pressure. If the pressure can not reach the allowable limit, replace the injection pump assembly. With the speed control lever at the low engine idle position, turn the flywheel until the pressure is at 18,6 MPa (186,3 bar) (2702 psi). Turn the flywheel back approximately one-half turn. Keep the flywheel at this position, and measure the time it takes the pressure to decrease from 17,7 MPa (176,5 bar) (2560 psi). B-8235 2 1 Fuel Tightness of Pump Element Allowable Limit 18,6 MPa (186,3 bar) (2702 psi) Fuel Tightness of Delivery Valve Allowable Limit 5 Seconds 70-70-3 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injection Pump Assembly Removal And Installation Remove the alternator. (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-30-5.) Figure 70-70-6 Clean the area around the injection pump thoroughly. Disconnect the high pressure fuel lines (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-6] from the fuel injectors. IMPORTANT Do not bend the high pressure fuel injection tubes when removing or installing them. I-2029-0289 Figure 70-70-7 Disconnect the fuel inlet hose (Item 1) and the fuel return hose (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-7] from the injection pump vent. Cap the inlets on the injection pump vent where the hoses were removed [Figure 70-70-7]. . Figure 70-70-8 Remove the high pressure fuel lines (Item 1) [Figure 70- 70-8] from the injection pump. Remove the engine speed control linkage (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-8]. P-85085 1 1 P-85082 1 2 P-85082 1 2 70-70-4 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injection Pump Assembly Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-70-9 Remove the window cover for the fuel injection pump assembly (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-9] from the flywheel housing. Figure 70-70-10 Place the number four piston at top dead center on the compression stroke and lock the flywheel in place using the flywheel stopper tool as described below. Look for the alignment mark on the idler gear and injection pump gear (Item 1)[Figure 70-70-10] then using a white marking pen or the like put a alignment mark to help reassemble these gears in mesh later. NOTE: When the already existing marks align with each other, there is no need to put another alignment mark. Figure 70-70-11 Make flywheel stop tool as shown above in [Figure 70- 70-11]. Figure 70-70-12 Construct two fuel camshaft lock screws as shown above [Figure 70-70-12] P-85095 1 P-85094 1 A 144 mm (5.67 in) B 104 mm (4.09 in) C 20,0 mm (0.787 in) D 10,0 mm dia. (0.394 in dia.) E 12,0 mm dia. (0.472 in dia.) F 16,0 mm dia. (0.630 in dia.) G 16,0 mm dia. (0.630 in dia.) H 32,0 mm (1.26 in) I 16,0 mm (0.630 in) P-85215 P-85091 M8 X 1.25 5,0mm (0.20 in) dia 0,79 rad 1 0mm (0.39 in) 5,0mm (0.20 in) 4,0mm (0.16 in) 45mm (1.8 in) 70-70-5 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injection Pump Assembly Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-70-13 Remove the two plugs (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-13]. Installation: Tighten the plugs to 9,81 - 11,2 N•m (7.24 - 8.31 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-70-14 Install one lock tool in the upper plug opening (Item 1) and tighten until it comes in contact with the fuel camshaft. Make sure the fuel camshaft is not moving. Install second lock tool in lower opening (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-14] and repeat the process. NOTE: Do not over tighten the lock screws after they have contacted the fuel camshaft. Otherwise the injection pump may become damaged. Figure 70-70-15 Remove the lubricating oil pipe (Item 1) [Figure 70-70- 15]. Remove the three injection pump mounting nuts (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-15] Installation: Tighten the lubricating oil pipe to 16 - 19 N•m (12 - 14 ft-lb) torque. Installation: Tighten the injection pump mounting nuts to 18 - 20 N•m (13 - 15 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-70-16 Remove injection pump support (Item 1) [Figure 70-70- 16]. Remove injection pump assembly (Item 2) [Figure 70- 70-16]. P-85095 1 P-85090 1 P-85093 1 2 P-85095 1 2 70-70-6 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Governor Housing Disassembly And Assembly The governor serves to keep the engine speed constant by automatically adjusting the amount of fuel supplied to the engine according to changes in the engine load. Disassemble and assemble the governor and fuel camshaft as shown in figure. Check all the parts for wear or damage and replace as needed. Figure 70-70-17 Jig for Governor Connecting Rod Application: Use this tool for connecting the governor connecting rod to the rack pin of the fuel injection pump assembly. Make the tool as shown in figure [Figure 70-70-17] or purchase part number below to connect the governor connecting rod to the rack pin of the fuel injection pump. MEL1667 - Jig for Governor Connecting Rod (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-17] Material: S43C-D (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-17] Permanent Magnet: 8 mm dia. (0.31 in dia.) Thickness: 3 mm (0.12 in) A 0,50 mm (0.020 in) B 12,7 - 13,0 mm (0.500 - 0.511 in) C 8,70 - 9,00 mm (0.343 - 0.354 in) D 39 mm dia (1.54 in dia.) E 10,0 ‘mm (0.394 in) F 7,0 mm (0.28 in) G 6,0 mm (0.24 in) H 80,0 mm (3.15 in) I 27,95 - 28,05 mm (1.101 - 1.104 in) J 5,0 mm (0.20 in) K 3,000 - 3,010 mm dia, 6,0 mm depth (0.1182 - 0.1185 in dia, 0.24 in depth) L 9,0 mm (0.35 in) M 5,0 mm (0.020 in) N 14,45 - 14,55 mm (0.5689 - 0.5728 in) O 5,0 mm (0.020 in) P 4,0 mm (0.16 in) P-85182 Q 2,955 - 2,965 mm dia. (0.1164 - 0.1167 in dia.) R 3,020 - 3,030 mm dia. (0.1189 - 0.1192 in dia.) S Ra = 1.6a AA Governor housing side BB Press in side a 0,60 mm radius (0.024 in radius) b 1,0 mm radius (0.039 in radius) C0.2 Chamfer 0,20 mm (0.0079 in) C0.4 Chamfer 0,40 mm (0.016 in) C0.5 Chamfer 0,50 mm (0.020 in) C1 Chamfer 1,0 mm (0.039 in) C2 Chamfer 2,0 mm (0.079 in) 70-70-7 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT’D) Governor Housing Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-18 Remove the fuel injection pump assembly. (See Fuel Injection Pump Assembly Removal And Installation on Page 70-70-3.) Remove the governor lubricating pipe (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-18]. Remove the stop solenoid (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-18]. Remove the sight cover (Item 3) [Figure 70-70-18] from the injection pump unit. Figure 70-70-19 Unhook the start spring (Item 1) from the rack pin (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-19] of injection pump assembly. Remove the nut (Item 3) [Figure 70-70-19]. Installation: Reverse procedure to install. Tighten the nut to 2.9 - 4,0 N•m (2.1 - 2.9 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Be careful not to drop the nut inside. NOTE: (See Fuel Injection Pump Removal And Installation on Page 70-70-12.) for proper alignment of the governor connection rod procedure. The procedure will require a special tool as shown on page 70-70-6. Figure 70-70-20 Slide off the governor connecting rod (Item 1) [Figure 70- 70-19] from the rack pin of injection pump assembly. For convenient sake, temporarily hook the start spring on the rack pin hole of the governor connecting rod. Remove the governor housing mounting bolts. Installation: Tighten the governor housing bolts to 9,81 - 11,2 N•m (7.24 - 8.31 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-70-21 Remove the governor housing assembly (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-21] from the injection pump unit. NOTE: The injection pump unit is lubricated with engine oil. Oil will leak when the governor housing is removed from the injection pump. P-85095 3 2 1 P-85099 1 2 3 P-85100 1 P-85097 1 70-70-8 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT’D) Governor Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-70-22 Remove the governor fork shaft lever (Item 1) using a bolt 4 mm dia. (0.16 in dia.), pitch 0,7 mm (0.03 in) at least a inch long (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-22]. NOTE: When assembling the inside parts, lightly put oil on each inside part. Figure 70-70-23 Unhook the governor spring (Item 1) at the fork lever (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-23]. Figure 70-70-24 Remove the governor fork lever assembly (Item 1) from the housing [Figure 70-70-24]. Figure 70-70-25 Remove the spring pin (Item 1), then remove speed control lever (Item 2) and the return spring (Item 3) [Figure 70-70-25]. P-85101 1 2 P-85188 1 2 P-85189 1 P-8519 0 1 2 3 70-70-9 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT’D) Governor Disassembly And Assembly (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-26 Remove the start spring (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-26] from the governor housing. After reassembling the governor housing assembly, check the movement of the governor fork lever (Item 2), the speed control lever, stop lever, governor spring (Item 3) and governor fork lever shaft (item 4) [Figure 70-70- 26]. NOTE: When assembling the inside parts, lightly put oil on each inside part. NOTE: Be careful not to deform the start spring. . P-85192 1 70-70-10 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT’D) Fuel Camshaft Removal And Installation Remove the fuel injection pump assembly. (See Fuel Injection Pump Assembly Removal And Installation on Page 70-70-3.) Remove the fuel injection pump unit. (See Fuel Injection Pump Assembly Removal And Installation on Page 70- 70-3.) WARNING Eye and body protection is required when welding or grinding. Wear approved goggles, helmet and clothing. Failure to wear eye and body protection can result in serious injury. W-2009-1285 Figure 70-70-27 To remove and replace the fuel camshaft, make the tool as shown in figure [Figure 70-70-27] or purchase part number below. MEL1666 - Injection Pump Gear Puller P-85123 A M35 x P1.5, 6,0 mm depth (0.24 in depth) B 35,0 mm dia.,12,0 mm depth (1.38 in dia., 0.472 in depth) C 30,0 mm dia.,27,5 mm depth (1.18 in dia., 1.08 in depth) D 40,00 - 40,20 mm dia. (1.575 - 1.582 in dia.) E 35,90 - 36,10 mm dia. (1.414 - 1.421 in dia.) F 2.09 rad (120 degrees) GM8 x P1.25 H 9,0 mm dia (0.35 in dia.) I 19,0 mm dia. (0.748 in dia.) J 12,0 mm (0.472 in) K 15,0 mm (0.591 in) L 27,5 mm (1.08 in) M 31,0 mm (1.22 in) N 2.26 in. (57,5 mm) O 3.94 in. (100 mm) P 3,75 - 4,00 mm (0.148 - 0.157 in) Q 16,17 mm (0.6366 in) a 5,0 mm radius (0.20 in radius) b 0,40 mm radius (0.016 in radius) C0.2 Chamfer 0,20 mm (0.0079 in) C0.5 Chamfer 0,50 mm (0.020 in) 70-70-11 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Camshaft Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-28 Remove the governor sleeve (Item 1) and remove the two fuel camshaft lock allen screws (Item 2) [Figure 70- 70-28]. NOTE: Do not use the fuel camshaft locks screws when removing governor weight, otherwise damage may occur to the allen screws or the governor housing. Figure 70-70-29 Make flywheel stop tool as shown above in [Figure 70- 70-29]. Figure 70-70-30 Install injection pump housing to the engine and tighten. Fix the flywheel with the flywheel stop tool (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-32]. Loosen the injection pump gear mounting nut (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-32]. Installation: Tighten injection pump gear mounting nut to 138 - 156 N•m (102 - 115 ft-lb). NOTE: The injection pump gear mounting nut is a left hand thread to loosen turn towards B and to tighten turn towards A as seen from the flywheel side Figure 70-70-31 Remove the fuel injection pump gear (Item 1) using the tool (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-31]. A 144 mm (5.67 in) B 104 mm (4.09 in) C 20,0 mm (0.787 in) D 10,0 mm dia. (0.394 in dia.) E 12,0 mm dia. (0.472 in dia.) P-85186A 1 2 P-85215 F 16,0 mm dia. (0.630 in dia.) G 16,0 mm dia. (0.630 in dia.) H 32,0 mm (1.26 in) I 16,0 mm (0.630 in) P-85183 1 2 P-85121 2 1 70-70-12 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Camshaft Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-32 Loosen fuel camshaft stopper mounting bolts (Item 1) and remove camshaft stopper (Item 2) [Figure 70-70- 32]. Installation: Tighten fuel camshaft stopper mounting bolts to 9,81 - 11,2 N•m (7.24 - 8.37 ft-lb). NOTE: When reassembling fuel camshaft stopper make sure the oil path hole (Item 3) [Figure 70- 70-32] is the proper alignment. Figure 70-70-33 Remove fuel camshaft (Item 1), then remove fuel camshaft stopper bearing screws (Item 2) [Figure 70-70- 33]. If replacing the fuel camshaft bearings tighten the fuel camshaft stopper bearing plate screws (item 2) [Figure 70-70-33] to 3,9 - 4,2 N•m (2.9 - 3.1 ft-lb) torque. Fuel Injection Pump Removal And Installation Figure 70-70-34 Remove all injection pipes (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-34]. Remove overflow hose (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-34]. Remove fuel stop solenoid (Item 3) [Figure 70-70-34]. Remove sight cover from housing (Item 4) [Figure 70- 70-34]. NOTE: The injection pump can be removed and installed with the crankshaft at any position. Figure 70-70-35 Unhook the start spring (Item 1) from the rack pin (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-35] of injection pump assembly. Remove the nut (Item 3) [Figure 70-70-35]. Installation: Reverse procedure to install. Tighten the nut to 2.9 - 4,0 N•m (2.1 - 2.9 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Be careful not to drop the nut inside. P-85122 2 1 3 P-85120 1 2 P-85199 1 1 1 2 P-85099 1 2 3 70-70-13 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injection Pump Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-36 Slide off the governor connecting rod (Item 1) [Figure 70- 70-36] from the rack pin of injection pump assembly. For convenient sake, temporarily hook the start spring on the rack pin hole of the governor connecting rod. Figure 70-70-37 Remove all of the mounting bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-37] from the fuel injection pump. Figure 70-70-38 Remove the fuel injection pump (Item 1) [Figure 70-70- 38]. Installation: Reverse procedure to install. Tighten the bolts to 24 - 27 N•m (18 - 20 ft-lb) torque.Tighten nuts to 18 - 20 N•m (13 - 15 ft-lb) Remove top cover (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-38] for adjusting the governor connecting rod. Figure 70-70-39 Hook the governor connecting rod (Item 1) to the rack pin (Item 2) and hand tighten the nut (Item 3) [Figure 70-70- 39]. Place service jig (Item 4) (Refer to page 70-70-6) in place of top cover and make sure the magnet is contacting the governor connecting rod (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-39]. Holding down the service jig tighten the nut to specified torque. Hook starter spring (Item 5) to rack pin (Item 2) [Figure 70-70-39]. Installation: Tighten the nut (Item 3) [Figure 70-70-39] to 2,9 - 4,0 N•m (2.1 - 2.9 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: A = 27,95 - 28,05 mm (1.100 - 1.104 in) P-85100 1 P-85198 1 P-85200 1 2 P-85203 1 2 3 4 5 70-70-14 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injection Pump - Timing IMPORTANT Do not attempt to maintain or adjust unless you are trained and have the correct equipment. I-2028-0289 Remove fuel injection high pressure lines. Remove the fuel shutoff solenoid. (See Fuel Shutoff Solenoid Removal And Installation on Page 70-70-1.) Figure 70-70-40 Align timing mark between the injection pump assembly and the flywheel housing (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-40]. NOTE: Timing the injection pump is done by rotating the injection pump assembly up for advance, down for retard. Figure 70-70-41 Rotate the flywheel counterclockwise (viewed from the flywheel side) until fuel fills up the hole of the delivery valve holder for the number one cylinder as shown in [Figure 70-70-41] below. Figure 70-70-42 After fuel fills up the hole of the number one cylinder delivery valve holder (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-42] turn back the flywheel clockwise 1,6 rad (90°) then turn counterclockwise to 0,17 rad (10°) before top dead center. Slowly turn the flywheel counterclockwise and stop turning when the fuel begins to come up to get the present injection timing (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-42]. P-85102 1 P-85104 P-85098 70-70-15 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Injection Pump - Timing (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-43 Check to see the degree marks on the flywheel (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-43]. The flywheel has a 1TC mark for the crank angle before the top dead center of cylinder number one. NOTE: If the injection pump timing is not within the specification, then rotate the injection pump assembly upwards for advancing, downwards for retarding injection pump timing. The injection timing is 0,00960 - 0,0357 rad. (0.550 - 2.05°) before T.D.C. Fuel Injector Removal And Installation WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 IMPORTANT Do not bend the high pressure fuel injection tubes when removing or installing them. I-2029-0289 P-85103 1 70-70-16 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injector Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-44 The following are some problems caused by faulty injectors: -Engine is hard to start or will not start -Rough engine operation and idle -Engine will not have full power -Excessive exhaust smoke Disconnect the high pressure fuel lines (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-44] from the fuel injectors and from the injection pump. Remove the high pressure fuel lines from the engine. Remove the glow plugs. (See Glow Plugs Removal And Installation on Page 70-80-1.) Remove the cylinder head valve cover (See Cylinder Head Removal And Installation on Page 70-80-4.) Figure 70-70-45 Remove the overflow pipe (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-45]. Installation: Tighten the overflow pipe assembly retaining screws to 9,81 - 11,2 N•m (7.24 - 8.31 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-70-46 Remove the nozzle holder clamps (Item 1) [Figure 70- 70-46]. Installation: Tighten the nozzle holder clamp screws to 24 - 27 N•m (18 - 20 ft-lb) torque. P-85085 1 P-85117 1 P-85118 1 70-70-17 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Fuel Injector Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-70-47 Remove the injector nozzle (Item 1) [Figure 70-70-47] from the cylinder head. Pull on the injector nozzle to remove the injector nozzle from the cylinder head. Figure 70-70-48 [Figure 70-70-48] shows the injector nozzle removed from the cylinder. Inspect the injector and replace if necessary. Check and replace the injector nozzle O-rings (Item 1) and the nozzle washer (Item 2) before installing new or used injectors. [Figure 70-70-48]. Fuel Injector Nozzle Pressure - Checking The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: OEM1064 - Injector Nozzle Tester Figure 70-70-49 Set the injection nozzle to the nozzle tester. Slowly move the tester handle to measure the pressure at which fuel begins jetting out from the nozzle. If the measurement is not within the factory specifications, replace or repair the injection nozzle assembly. NOTE: Injection nozzle gasket must be replaced when the injection nozzle is removed for checking. P-85119 1 P-37583 2 1 Injection pressure Factory spec. 18,6 -19,6 MPa (186,4 - 96 bar) (2703 - 2844 psi) 3EEABAC1P012A 70-70-18 S650 Service Manual FUEL SYSTEM (CONT'D) Nozzle Spray Condition The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: OEM1064 - Injector Nozzle Tester Figure 70-70-50 Set the injection nozzle to a nozzle tester, and check the nozzle spraying condition. If the spraying condition is defective, replace or repair the injection nozzle assembly. Valve Seat Tightness The tool listed will be needed to do the following procedure: OEM1064 - Injector Nozzle Tester Figure 70-70-51 Set the injection nozzle to a nozzle tester. Raise the fuel pressure, and keep at 16,7 MPa (166,7 bar) (2418 psi) for 10 seconds. If any fuel leak is found, replace or repair the injection nozzle assembly. 3EEABAC1P013A Correc t Incorrec t Valve seat tightness Factory spec No fuel leak at 16,7 MPa (166,7 bar) (2418 psi) 3EEABAC1P014A 70-80-1 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD Glow Plugs - Testing Figure 70-80-1 Disconnect the glow plug nuts (Item 1), remove glow plug connecting strap (Item 2) and glow plugs (Item 3) [Figure 70-80-1]. Installation: Tighten the glow plug to 7,7 - 9,3 N•m (5.7 - 6.8 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-80-2 Touch one probe to the end of the glow plug (Item 1) and the other probe to the body of glow plug (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-2]. Use an ohmmeter to check the glow plugs.The resistance should be approximately one ohm. Repeat the procedure for each glow plug. NOTE: Adjust the direction of the ditch (Item 3) [Figure 70-80-2] to the terminal side when the seal is installed on the glow plug. Glow Plugs Removal And Installation Figure 70-80-3 Disconnect the glow plug nuts (Item 1),remove glow plug connecting strap (Item 2) and glow plugs (Item 3) [Figure 70-80-3]. Installation: Tighten the glow plug to 7,7 - 9,3 N•m (5.7 - 6.8 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-80-4 NOTE: Adjust the direction of the ditch (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-4] to the terminal side when the seal is installed on the glow plug. P-85178 1 2 3 P-85179 1 2 3 P-85178 1 2 3 P-85179 1 70-80-2 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Glow Plugs Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-80-5 Photo [Figure 70-80-5] shows the glow plug removed from the engine. Inspect the glow plugs and replace when necessary. Valve Clearance Adjustment Figure 70-80-6 Adjust the valve clearance as follows: Loosen the lock nut (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-6]. Turn the adjustment screw (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-6] until the correct clearance is obtained. NOTE: The clearance is measured between the rocker arm and bridge head (Item 3) [Figure 70-80-6]. P-48708 P-85181 2 1 3 70-80-3 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Valve Clearance Adjustment (Cont’d) Figure 70-80-7 NOTE: (A) is the front cover side, (B) is the flywheel housing side. Figure 70-80-8 Adjust the valve clearance cold as follows: 0,13 - 0,17 mm (0.0052 - 0.0068 in) Intake & Exhaust Use the following sequence to set the valves [Figure 70- 80-7] & [Figure 70-80-8]: 1. With the No. 1 cylinder set at compression top dead center set valves 1,2,3 and 6. 2. With the No. 1 cylinder at overlap position set valves 4,5,7 and 8. Valve Timing - Checking Figure 70-80-9 Stop the engine and open the rear door. Remove the engine / hydrostatic pump package from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) Remove the flywheel. (See Flywheel Removal And Installation on Page 70-120-1.) Remove the timing gearcase cover. (See Timing Gearcase Cover Removal on Page 70-100-1.) Make sure timing marks are in correct alignment [Figure 70-80-9]. Injection Pump Gear (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-9]. Idle Gear (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-9]. Crank Gear (Item 3) [Figure 70-80-9]. Cam Gear (Item 4) [Figure 70-80-9]. B-05569 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 3 4 B A III IEEE E 1 23 45 678 1234 Cylinder Number Valve Number Valve I=Intake E=Exhaust P-85974 2 4 1 3 70-80-4 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Cylinder Head Removal And Installation Figure 70-80-10 Remove the glow plug connecting strap (Item 1), glow plugs (Item 2), and injection pipes (Item 3) [Figure 70- 80-10]. Remove the valve cover (Item 4) [Figure 70-80-10] and gasket. Installation: Gradually tighten the valve cover bolts to 9,81 - 11,2 N•m (7 - 8 ft-lb) torque. Tighten center bolts first, then work your way to the front and back of the valve cover. Installation: Tighten injection pipe retaining nuts to 23 - 36 N•m (17 - 26 ft-lb) torque. Installation: Tighten glow plugs to 7,7 - 9,3 N•m (5.7 - 6.8 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-80-11 Remove the overflow pipe (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-11]. Installation: Tighten overflow pipe to 9,81 - 11,2 N•m (7 - 8 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-80-12 Remove the nozzle holder clamps (Item 1) [Figure 70- 80-12]. Installation: Tighten the nozzle holder clamp bolts to 24 - 27 N•m (18 - 20 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-80-13 Remove the nozzle holder assembles and nozzle gaskets (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-12]. Installation: Tighten the nozzle holder clamp bolts to 24 - 27 N•m (18 - 20 ft-lb) torque. P-85174 2 3 4 1 P-85117 1 P-85118 1 P-85119 1 70-80-5 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Cylinder Head Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-80-14 Remove rocker arm assembly (Item 1)[Figure 70-80-14] as a unit. Remove push rods (Item 2) and bridge arms (Item 3) [Figure 70-80-14]. Figure 70-80-15 Installation: The push rod (Item 1) must be seated in the tappet (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-15] correctly or the push rods will be damaged. After installing the rocker arm assembly and push rods, the valve lash must be adjusted. (See Valve Clearance Adjustment on Page 70-80-2.) Figure 70-80-16 Remove the thermostat housing bolts and then remove the housing (Item 1), gasket (Item 2) and thermostat (Item 3) [Figure 70-80-16]. Figure 70-80-17 Remove the cylinder head bolts in order of #10 to #1 [Figure 70-80-17]. NOTE: (A) is the front cover side, (B) is the flywheel housing side. Installation: Put oil on the bolt threads. Tighten the bolts in the correct sequence in order of #1 - #10 to 187 - 196 N•m (138 - 144 ft-lb). NOTE: It is not necessary to retighten the cylinder head bolts after the engine has been run for 30 minutes. P-85115 1 2 3 P-47245 1 2 P-85170 1 2 3 P-85168 70-80-6 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Cylinder Head Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 70-80-18 Remove the cylinder head (Item 1) and gasket (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-18]. Figure 70-80-19 When replacing just the head gasket (Item 1), use a new gasket that has the same mark (Item 2) [Figure 70-80- 19] as the original gasket. When replacing the gasket after an engine rebuild, the piston protrusion must be measured. (See Cylinder Head Top Clearance on Page 70-80-8.) NOTE: (A) is the front cover side, (B) is the flywheel housing side. Figure 70-80-20 Find the average measurement of the highest piston protrusion and the lowest piston protrusion (recorded earlier) for each piston (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-20]. Figure 70-80-21 When identifying which head gasket you need [Figure 70-80-21] shows the correct number of notches and how they should look (a) 2 notches, (b) 1 notch and (c) no notch. Figure 70-80-22 Select the correct gasket size (thickness) from the chart [Figure 70-80-22]. After the gasket and cylinder head have been installed, turn the crankshaft by hand to be sure there is no interference between the piston, cylinder, and valves. P-85171 2 1 P-85968 A B 1 2 P-47252 1 P-85967 a b c Gasket Size (Number) Piston Protrusion 0,2500 - 0,3425 mm 0.009843 - 0.01348 in 0,0775 - 0,150 mm 0.00306 - 0.00590 in 0,150 - 0,250 mm 0.00591 - 0.00984 in 1 notch 2 notches no notches 70-80-7 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Cylinder Head Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-80-23 Use a valve spring compressor to compress the valve spring [Figure 70-80-23]. Figure 70-80-24 Remove the valve cap (Item 1) and valve spring collet (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-23] and [Figure 70-80-24]. Remove the valve spring retainer (Item 3) and the spring (Item 4) [Figure 70-80-23] and [Figure 70-80-24]. Remove the seal (Item 6) and the valve (Item 5) [Figure 70-80-23] and [Figure 70-80-24]. Cylinder Head - Servicing Clean the surface of the cylinder head. Figure 70-80-25 Put a straight edge (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-25] on the cylinder head. NOTE: Do not put the straight edge across combustion chambers. Put a feeler gauge (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-25] between the straight edge and the surface of the cylinder head. Figure 70-80-26 Put the straight edge on the cylinder head's four sides and two diagonal as shown in figure [Figure 70-80-26]. The maximum distortion of the head surface is ± 0,05 mm (± 0.002 in). If the measurement exceeds the specification, replace the cylinder head. PI-9987 B-4122C 5 4 3 6 2 1 Cap Collets Seal Retainer Spring Valve P-51629 1 2 PI-9988 70-80-8 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Cylinder Head Top Clearance Figure 70-80-27 Install the cylinder head gasket. Put the piston (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-27] being checked at T.D.C. Put 4 pieces of 1,5 mm (0.06 in) diameter solder (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-27] on the top of the piston. Use grease to hold them in position. NOTE: Put the solder in position so they do not touch the valves. Turn the piston to bottom dead center. Install the cylinder head and tighten to the correct torque in the correct sequence. (See Cylinder Head Removal And Installation on Page 70-80-4.) Turn the crankshaft until the piston exceeds T.D.C. Remove the cylinder head. Figure 70-80-28 Remove the solder (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-28] and measure it. If the measurement exceeds the specifications, check the oil clearance of the crank pin journal or the piston pin. Valve Guide - Checking Remove the valve and spring from the cylinder head. (See Cylinder Head Disassembly And Assembly on Page 70-80-7.) Remove the carbon from the valve guide. Figure 70-80-29 Measure the valve stem O.D. (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-29]. Measure the valve guide I.D. (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-29]. Calculate the clearance. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the valve and/or valve guide. P-85172 2 1 P-85173 1 Top Clearance 0,6 - 0,8 mm (0.024 - 0.031 in) Valve Guide I.D. 7,030 - 7,045 mm (0.2768 - 0.2773 in) Valve Stem O.D. 6,960 - 6,975 mm (0.2741 - 0.2746 in) Clearance Between Valve Stem and Guide 0,055 - 0,085 mm (0.0022- 0.0033 in) Allowable Limit 0,10 mm (0.0039 in) B-14335 1 2 70-80-9 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Valve Guide Removal And Installation Figure 70-80-30 To remove and replace the valve guide, make the driver tools as shown in figure [Figure 70-80-30]. Figure 70-80-31 Press the used valve guide out of the cylinder head using the special driver tool [Figure 70-80-31]. Put oil on the outside diameter of the new valve guide. Press the new valve guide into the cylinder head from the top side. Use the special driver tools (Items 1 and 2) [Figure 70-80-31], press the new guide until the tool contacts the cylinder head. Ream the valve guide to the correct specifications. Reconditioning The Valve And Valve Seat Figure 70-80-32 Grind the valve face to the correct angle using a valve refacer [Figure 70-80-32]. Clean the valve seat and combustion chamber. Figure 70-80-33 Install the valve into the guide. Measure the valve recessing with a depth gauge [Figure 70-80-33]. MC-1364 225 mm (8.86”) 20 mm (0.79”) 70mm (2.8”) 45 mm (1.8”) 6,50-6,60 mm (0.256-0.259”) 8,50-8,90 mm (0.335-0.350 “) 20,0 mm (0.79”) 12,5-12,8 mm (0.493-0.503”) 5,0 mm (0.2”) 6,70-7,00 mm (0.264-0.275”) 25,0 mm (0.98”) 11,7-11,9 mm (0.461-0.468”) PI-9992 1 2 PI-9993 P-51632 70-80-10 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Reconditioning The Valve And Valve Seat (Cont’d) Figure 70-80-34 If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the valve or cylinder head [Figure 70-80-34]. Figure 70-80-35 Grind the valve seat surface in the cylinder head to the correct angle [Figure 70-80-35]. Figure 70-80-36 Check the seat surface and valve face (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-36]. (a) identical dimensions above and below the valve seat If the seat surface (b) needs correction, slightly correct the seat using a 45 degree cutter and then resurface the seat surface with a 15 degree cutter to get the correct width (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-36]. Valve Seat Width Valve Seat & Face Angle Recessing 0,65 - 0,85 mm (0.026 - 0.33 in) Allowable Limit (Recessing) 1,20 mm (0.0472 in.) PI-9990 1. Cylinder Head Surface 2. Recessing 3. Protrusion PI-9994 45° Exhaust 45° Intake 15° Intake 15° Exhaust Intake & Exhaust 3,3 - 3,6 mm (0.13 - 0.14 in) Intake 45 degrees Exhaust 45 degrees PI-9995 1 2 30° Exhaust 30° Intake 70-80-11 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Valve Spring Figure 70-80-37 Measure the length of the valve spring. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace the spring [Figure 70-80-37]. Put the spring on a flat surface, place a square on the side of the spring [Figure 70-80-37]. Rotate the spring and measure the maximum tilt. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the spring. Figure 70-80-38 Put the spring on a tester and compress to specified length [Figure 70-80-38]. Read the compressed load on the gauge. If the measurement exceeds allowable limit, replace the spring. Free Length 35,1 - 35,6 mm (1.39 - 1.40 in) Allowable Limit 34,6 mm (1.36 in) Tilt Allowable Limit 1,0 mm (0.039 in) B-3680 Setting Length 31,5 mm (1.24 in) Setting Load 60,8 N (14.3 lb) Allowable Limit 45,9 N (10.3 lb) A-2759 70-80-12 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Valve Tappets Remove the oil pan and oil pump strainer. (See Oil Pan Removal And Installation on Page 70-60-1.) Remove the idler gear and camshaft. (See Idler Gear And Camshaft Removal And Installation on Page 70-100- 5.) Figure 70-80-39 Turn engine with the crankshaft facing up and remove the valve tappets (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-39]. Figure 70-80-40 Measure the ID of the tappet bore (Item 1) [Figure 70- 80-40]. Figure 70-80-41 Measure the OD of the tappet (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-41]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the tappets. Tappet Bore ID 10,000 -10,015 mm (0.39370 - 0.39429 in) Clearance Between Tappet and Tappet Bore 0,020 - 0,050 mm (0.00079 - 0.0019 in) Allowable limit 0,07 mm (0.003 in) P-85141 1 P-85142 1 Tappet OD 9,965 - 9,980mm (0.3924 - 0.3929 in) Clearance Between Tappet and Tappet Bore 0,020 - 0,050 mm (0.00079 - 0.0019 in) Allowable limit 0,07 mm (0.003 in) P-85175 1 70-80-13 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Rocker Arm And Shaft - Checking Figure 70-80-42 Measure the rocker arm I.D. (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-42] with an inside micrometer. Measure the rocker arm shaft O.D. (Item 2) [Figure 70- 80-42] with an outside micrometer. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the bushing. If the clearance still exceeds the allowable limit after the bushing is replace, replace the rocker arm shaft. Bridge Arm And Bridge Arm Shaft - Checking Figure 70-80-43 Measure the bridge arm ID (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-43]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the bridge arm (Item 1) [Figure 70-80-43]. Figure 70-80-44 Measure the bridge arm shaft OD (Item 1) [Figure 70-80- 44]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the bridge arm shaft (item 1) [Figure 70-80-44]. Oil Clearance Between Rocker Arm & Shaft 0,016 - 0,045 mm (0.00063 - 0.0017 in) Allowable Limit 0,15 mm (0.0059 in) Rocker Arm Shaft O.D. 14,973 - 14,984 mm (0.58949 - 0.58992 in) Rocker Arm I.D. 15,0 - 15,018 mm (0.59056 - 0.59125 in) B-3697 1 2 Bridge arm ID. 9,050 - 9,065 mm (0.3170 - 0.3181 in) Oil Clearance between Bridge arm and Bridge arm shaft. 0,018 - 0,042 mm (0.0.00071 - 0.0016 in) Bridge arm shaft OD. 9,023 - 9,8032 mm (0.3553 - 0.3555 in) Allowable Limit 0,15 mm (0.0059 in) P-85177 1 P-85176 1 70-80-14 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Bridge Arm Shaft - Removal And Installation Figure 70-80-45 Make valve bridge arm shaft replacement tool as shown above [Figure 70-80-45]. Figure 70-80-46 Remove the used valve bridge arm shaft (Item 1), then clean valve bridge arm shaft mounting hole. Use the valve bridge arm replacing tool to press in new shaft [Figure 70-80-46]. Figure 70-80-47 Install bridge arm shaft (Item 1) using the valve bridge shaft replacing tool (Item 2) [Figure 70-80-47] to the proper depth in [Figure 70-80-48]. A 9,50 mm (0.374 in) B 19,0 mm (0.748 in) C 23,2 mm (0.913 in) D 42,00 - 42,40 mm (1.654 - 1.669 in) E 12,5 mm dia. (0.492 in dia.) through hole F 61,0 mm (2.40 in) G 18,7 mm (0.736 in) H 30,90 - 31,70 mm (1.217 - 1.248 in) a 0,30 mm radius (0.012 in radius) C0.5 Chamfer 0,50 mm (0.020 in) C1 Chamfer 1,0 mm (0.039 in) C5 Chamfer 2,0 mm (0.079 in) P-85969 P-85972 1 P-85973 2 1 70-80-15 S650 Service Manual CYLINDER HEAD (CONT'D) Bridge Arm Shaft - Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-80-48 Set the depth of the bridge arm shaft (Item 1) to 31,1 - 31,7 mm (1.23 - 1.24 in) [Figure 70-80-48]. Push Rod Alignment - Checking Figure 70-80-49 Place the push rod on V blocks [Figure 70-80-49]. Measure the push rod alignment [Figure 70-80-49]. If the push rod exceeds the allowable limit, replace the push rod. P-85970 1 Push Rod Alignment Allowable Limit 0,25 mm (0.0098 in) P-76926 70-80-16 S650 Service Manual 70-90-1 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS Piston And Connecting Rod Removal And Installation Remove the cylinder head. (See Cylinder Head Removal And Installation on Page 70-80-4.) Remove the top edge from the cylinder bore with a ridge reamer. Remove the oil pan and oil pump strainer. (See Oil Pan Removal And Installation on Page 70-60-1.) Figure 70-90-1 Figure 70-90-2 Remove the tappet (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-1] from the tappet bore (Item 2) [Figure 70-90-2] using a magnetic tool. Installation: Apply engine oil to the tappet during installation. NOTE: Mark the location of the tappets to prevent them from becoming interchanged. Figure 70-90-3 Remove the connecting rod bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-90- 3]. NOTE: Mark the location of the rod bearings to prevent them from becoming interchanged. Installation: Tighten the connecting rod bolts to 69 - 73 N•m (51 - 54 ft-lb) torque. Installation: Apply engine oil to the connecting rod bolts and lightly screw in by hand. Installation: Install the rod bearing with the centrally lined groove towards the connecting rod, and the non grooved side towards the cap. Installation: Make sure the marks on the connecting rod and bearing are aligned and facing the injection pump when installing the bearing cap. P-85141 1 P-85142 2 Top View of Crankcase P-85143 1 70-90-2 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Piston And Connecting Rod Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-90-4 Use a hammer handle and push the piston / connecting rod assembly out of the cylinder bore [Figure 70-90-4]. NOTE: Make sure the pistons are marked so they will be returned to the same cylinder bore. Figure 70-90-5 Installation: Make sure the marks on the connecting rod and bearing (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-5] are aligned and facing the injection pump when installing the bearing cap. Repeat the procedure to remove the other piston / connecting rod assemblies from the engine block. Piston And Connecting Rod - Servicing Figure 70-90-6 Installation: When reassembling, align the marks (Item 1) on the connecting rod and piston (Item 2) [Figure 70- 90-6]. NOTE: Assemble the piston to the connecting rod with the mark (Item 2) and the connecting rod mark (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-6] facing the injection pump side. P-51633 P-85144 1 P-85145 1 2 70-90-3 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Piston And Connecting Rod - Servicing (Cont’d) Figure 70-90-7 Remove the top ring (Item 1), the second ring (Item 2) and the oil ring (Item 3) [Figure 70-90-7]. Remove the snap rings (Item 4) and piston pin (Item 7) [Figure 70-90-7]. Separate the piston (Item 5) from the connecting rod (Item 6) [Figure 70-90-7]. Installation: Heat the piston in clean engine oil to 80°C (176°F) and tap the piston pin into position. Place the piston rings so that there are gaps every 120 degrees with no gap facing the piston pin in the cylinder. NOTE: Mark the piston (Item 5) and connecting rod (Item 6) [Figure 70-90-7] with the same number to ensure correct installation and proper cylinder placement. Figure 70-90-8 Installation: When installing new rings, assemble the ring so the mark (Item 1) near the gap faces the top of the piston. When installing the oil ring, place the expander joint (Item 2) on the opposite side of the oil ring gap (Item 3) [Figure 70-90-8]. Figure 70-90-9 Measure the I.D. of the piston pin bore in both horizontal and vertical directions [Figure 70-90-9]. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the piston. P-85146 2 1 3 5 4 4 6 7 PI-10015 1 2 3 Piston Bore I.D. 28,0 - 28,013 mm (1.1024 - 1.1028 in) Allowable Limit 28,05 mm (1.104 in) P-47272 70-90-4 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Piston And Connecting Rod - Servicing (Cont’d) Figure 70-90-10 Measure the O.D. of the piston pin (Item 1) [Figure 70- 90-10]. Measure the I.D. of the connecting rod small end bushing (Item 2) [Figure 70-90-10]. Calculate the oil clearance. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the connecting rod. If it still exceeds the specifications, replace the piston pin. Figure 70-90-11 Install a piston ring into the lower part of the cylinder bore. Measure the ring gap with a feeler gauge [Figure 70-90-11]. If the gap exceeds the allowable limit, replace the ring. Piston Pin O.D. 28,006 - 28,011 mm (1.1026 - 1.1027 in) Bushing I.D. 28,031 - 28,046 mm (1.1036 - 1.1041 in) Oil Clearance Between Piston Pin & Bushing 0,020 - 0,040 mm (0.00079 - 0.0015 in) Allowable Limit 0,15 mm (0.0059 in) P-47273 1 2 Top Ring Gap 0,25 - 0,40 mm (0.0099 - 0.015 in) Oil Ring Gap 0,25 - 0,45 mm (0.0099 - 0.017 in) Allowable Limit 1,25 mm (0.0492 in) Second Ring Gap 0,30 - 0,45 mm (0.012 - 0.017 in) B-3622 70-90-5 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Piston And Connecting Rod - Servicing (Cont’d) Figure 70-90-12 Remove the carbon from the ring grooves. Measure the clearance between the ring and groove with a feeler gauge [Figure 70-90-12]. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the ring. If the clearance still exceeds the allowable limit, replace the piston. Cylinder Bore - Checking Figure 70-90-13 Use a gauge to check the inside measurement of the cylinder bore [Figure 70-90-13]. Figure 70-90-14 Measure the six points as shown in figure [Figure 70-90- 14] to find the maximum wear. The factory specifications are: 94 - 94,022 mm (3.7008 - 3.7016 in). The allowable limit is 94,15 mm (3.707 in). If the cylinder bore is not within specifications, bore and hone to oversize dimension. Top Ring 0,050 - 0,090 mm (0.0020 - 0.0035 in) Allowable Limit 0,15 mm (0.0059 in) Second Ring 0,090 - 0,12 mm (0.0036 - 0.0047 in) Allowable Limit 0,20 mm (0.0079 in) Oil Ring 0,020 - 0,060 mm (0.0079 - 0.0023 in) Allowable Limit 0,15 mm (0.0059 in) PI-10017 B-4066 P-37163 70-90-6 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Connecting Rod Alignment NOTE: The small end bushing is the basis of this check, check the bushing for wear before doing this check. Install the piston pin into the connecting rod. Install the connecting rod on an alignment tool. Put the gauge over the piston pin and move it against the face plate. Figure 70-90-15 If the gauge does not fit squarely against the face plate, measure the space between the gauge and face plate [Figure 70-90-15]. If the measurement exceeds the allowable limit, replace the connecting rod.- Crankshaft Gear Removal And Installation Remove the crankshaft. (See Crankshaft And Bearings Removal And Installation on Page 70-90-7.) Figure 70-90-16 Remove the crankshaft sleeve (Item 1), the crankshaft gears (Item 2), the seal (Item 3) and the key (Item 4) [Figure 70-90-16]. Installation: Install a new seal (Item 3) when servicing [Figure 70-90-16]. Figure 70-90-17 Installation: Heat the crankshaft sleeve (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-16] and [Figure 70-90-17] to 150 - 200°C (302 - 392°F). Install the crankshaft sleeve onto the crankshaft using the crankshaft sleeve guide (Item 2) and the crankshaft replacing tool (Item 3) MEL - 1660 [Figure 70- 90-17]. Installation: Install the crankshaft sleeve (Item 1) with the chamfered surface facing outward [Figure 70-90-17]. Rod Alignment 0,05 mm (0.002 in) B-4067 P-85149 1 2 4 3 2 P-85148 1 3 2 70-90-7 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Crankshaft Gear Removal And Installation (Cont’D) Figure 70-90-18 Installation: When installing the crankshaft sleeve (Item 1) allow for a space (Item 2) [Figure 70-90-18] from the end of the crankshaft to the edge of the crankshaft sleeve. Crankshaft And Bearings Removal And Installation Remove the piston and connecting rod assemblies. (See Piston And Connecting Rod Removal And Installation on Page 70-90-1.) Figure 70-90-19 Remove the crankcase mounting screws in order from Z to A [Figure 70-90-19]. Installation: Tighten the crankcase mounting bolts from A to J to 138 - 147 N•m (102 - 108 ft-lb) Installation: Tighten the crankcase mounting bolts from K to Z to 59 - 63 N•m (44 - 47 ft-lb). Figure 70-90-20 Remove crankcase 2 (Item 2) from crankcase 1 (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-20]. Remove the crankshaft (Item 3) [Figure 70-90-20]. Figure 70-90-21 This tool is used for aligning the crankcase 1 and crankcase 2. Make two of these tools. Material (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-21]: SS400 P-85150 2 1 0,850 - 1,15 mm (0.0335 - 0.0452 in) P-85151 A 126,6 mm (4.984 in) B 49,1 mm (1.93 in) C 37,5 mm (1.48 in) D 20 mm (0.79 in) E 14 mm dia. (0.55 in dia.) F 14 mm dia. (0.55 in dia.) G 14 mm dia. (0.55 in dia.) H 17,5 mm (0.689 in) I 17,5 mm (0.689 in) J 35 mm (1.4 in) K 19 mm (0.75 in) P-85153 1 2 3 P-85995 1 70-90-8 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Crankshaft And Bearings Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-90-22 NOTE: Make sure both crankcases are clean and dry before assembling. Install the bearings (Item 1) into the crankcase 2 (Item 2) [Figure 70-90-22]. Install the thrust bearings (Item 3) [Figure 70-90-22] with the groove facing out. Figure 70-90-23 Install the bearings (Item 2) into the crankcase 1 (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-23]. Install the thrust bearings (Item 3) [Figure 70-90-23] with the groove facing out. Carefully apply liquid gasket evenly (Item 4) to the crankcase 1 (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-23]. Figure 70-90-24 Apply oil to the thrust bearings and install the crankshaft (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-24]. Figure 70-90-25 Align and install crankcase 2 (Item 2) to crankcase 1 (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-25]. Apply engine oil to the crankcase mounting bolts and hand tighten from A to J and then K to Z [Figure 70-90- 19]. Install the jig (Item 3) [Figure 70-90-25] and tighten to 78 - 90 N•m (58 - 66 ft-lb) NOTE: The jig helps to minimize the level difference between the crankcase 1 and crankcase 2 at the flywheel side. The gap must be 0,05 mm (0.002 in) or smaller. Tighten the crankcase mounting bolts from A to J to 138 - 147 N•m (102 - 108 ft-lb) Tighten the crankcase mounting bolts from K to Z to 59 - 63 N•m (44 - 47 ft-lb). Remove the jig (Item 3) [Figure 70-90-25]. P-85157 3 1 2 P-85155 1 2 3 4 P-85156 1 P-85996 1 2 3 70-90-9 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Crankshaft And Bearings - Servicing Figure 70-90-26 Set a dial indicator with its tip on the end of the crankshaft (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-26]. Measure the side clearance by moving the crankshaft side to side (Item 2) [Figure 70-90-26]. If the misalignment exceeds the allowable limit, replace the crankshaft. Figure 70-90-27 Put the crankshaft on V-blocks. Install a dial indicator on the center journal [Figure 70-90-26]. Turn the crankshaft at a slow rate to obtain the misalignment (one half of the alignment measurement). If the misalignment exceeds the allowable limit, replace the crankshaft. Figure 70-90-28 Place plastigage on the crankshaft (Item 3) [Figure 70- 90-28]. Place crankcase 2 (Item 2) on crankcase 1 (Item 1) [Figure 70-90-28] and torque the bolts. Torque the bolts A to Z [Figure 70-90-19]. (See Crankshaft And Bearings Removal And Installation on Page 70-90-7.) Remove crankcase 2 (Item 2) [Figure 70-90-28] and measure the amount of the flattening with the scale to determine the oil clearance. Side clearance of crankshaft Factory Spec. 0,15 - 0,35 mm (0.0059 - 0.013 in) Allowable limit 0,50 mm (0.020 in.) P-85159 1 2 A-2763 Alignment 0,02 mm (0.0008 in) Crankshaft Journal O.D. Factory Spec. 79,977 - 79,990 mm (3.1487 - 31.1492 in) Oil clearance between crankshaft journal and crankshaft bearing Factory Spec. 0,030 - 0,073 mm (0.0012 - 0.0028 in) Allowable limit 0,20 mm (0.079 in) P-85160 1 2 3 70-90-10 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Crankshaft And Bearings - Servicing (Cont’d) Figure 70-90-29 Reference of undersize dimensions of crankshaft journal [Figure 70-90-29]. Figure 70-90-30 Clean the crank pin and crank pin bearing. Put a strip of plastigage [Figure 70-90-30] on the center of the crank pin. NOTE: Never insert the plastigage into the crank pin oil hole. Be sure not to move the crankshaft while the connecting rod screws are tightened. Install the connecting rod cap and tighten the connecting rod screws to the specified torque, and remove the cap again. Measure the amount of the flattening with the scale, and get the oil clearance. If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the crank pin bearing. If the same size bearing cannot be used because of the crank pin wear, replace it with an undersized one referring to the table. Undersize 0,2 mm (0.0079 in) 0,4 mm (0.016 in) Dimension A 2,8 - 3,2 mm radius (0.11 - 0.12 in radius) 2,8 - 3,2 mm radius (0.11 - 0.12 in radius) *Dimension B 1,0 - 1,5 mm relief (0.040 - 0.059 in relief) 1,0 - 1,5 mm relief (0.040 - 0.059 in relief) Dimension C 79,777 - 79,790 mm dia. (3.1409 - 3.1413 in dia.) 79,577 - 79,590 mm dia. (3.1330 -3.1334 in dia.) The crankshaft journal must be fine-finished to higher than ————(0.8-S) *Holes are to be de-burred and edges rounded with relief 1.0 - 1.5 mm (0.040 - 0.059 in) P-85161 Crankpin O.D. Factory spec. 49,980 - 49,991 mm (1.9678 - 1.9681 in) Oil clear- ance between crank pin and crank pin bearing Factory spec. 0,011 - 0,058 mm (0.00067 - 0.0018 in) Allowable limit 0,20 mm (0.0079 in) P-37145 70-90-11 S650 Service Manual CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS (CONT’D) Crankshaft And Bearings - Servicing (Cont’d) Figure 70-90-31 NOTE: To replace it with a specific STD service part, make sure the crank pin bearing has the same ID color as the connecting rod [Figure 70-90- 31]. Figure 70-90-32 Undersize dimensions of crankpin. ID Color Connecting rod Crank pin bearing Large-end in. dia. Class Center wall thick Blue 53,010 - 53,010 mm (2.0870 - 2.0874 in) L 1,496 - 1,501 mm (0.05890 - 0.05909 in) with- out Color 53,000 - 53,010 mm (2.0867 - 2.0870 in) S 1,491 - 1,496 mm (0.05870 - 0.05889 in) P-37147 1 2 3 Undersize 0,20 mm (0.0079 in) 0,40 mm (0.016 in) Dimension A 3,3 - 3,7 mm radius (0.13 - 0.14 in radius) 3,3 - 3,7 mm radius (0.13 - 0.14 in radius) *Dimen- sion B 1,0 - 1,5 mm relief (0.040 - 0.059 in relief) 1,0 - 1,5 mm relief (0.040 - 0.059 in relief) Dimension C 49,780 - 49,791 mm dia. (1.9599 - 1.9602 in dia.) 49,580 - 49,591 mm dia. (1.9520 - 1.9524 in dia.) (0.8-S) The crank pin must be fine-finished to higher than —— —— *Holes to be de-burred and edges rounded with relief. 1,0 -1,5 mm (0.040 - 0.059 in) P-85162 70-90-12 S650 Service Manual 70-100-1 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS Timing Gearcase Cover Removal Remove the flywheel. (See Flywheel Removal And Installation on Page 70-120-1.) Remove the housing. (See Housing Removal And Installation on Page 70-120-3.) Figure 70-100-1 Remove the eight outside timing gearcase cover mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-100-1]. Remove the eight inside timing gearcase cover mounting bolts (Item 2) [Figure 70-100-1]. Remove the timing gearcase cover (Item 3) [Figure 70- 100-1]. P-90121 2 3 1 70-100-2 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS (CONT’D) Timing Gearcase Cover Installation Figure 70-100-2 Make timing gearcase cover guide tool [Figure 70-100- 2]. A 70,0 mm (2.76 in) B 8,0 mm (0.31 in) C 22,0 mm (0.866 in) D 30,0 mm (1.18 in) E 87,0 mm dia. (3.43 in dia.) F 82,036 - 82,071 mm dia. (3.2298 - 3.2311 in dia.) G 77,0 mm dia. (3.03 in dia.) H 57,0 mm dia. (2.24 in dia.) I 35,0 mm dia. (1.38 in dia.) J 30,0 mm dia. (1.18 in dia.) K 84,0 mm (3.31 in) L 3,5 mm (0.14 in) M 3,0 mm (0.12 in) N 6,60 - 6,80 mm (0.260 - 0.267 in) O 8,0 mm (0.31 in) P 67,0 mm dia. (2.64 in dia.) Q 4,0 mm dia. (0.16 in) through hole a Ra = 1.6 a b 1,5 mm radius (0.059 in radius) c Ra = 3.2 a d 0,80 mm radius (0.031 in radius) C0.5 Chamfer 0,50 mm (0.020 in) C1.0 Chamfer 1,0 mm (0.039 in) P-90004A 70-100-3 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS (CONT’D) Timing Gearcase Cover Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-100-3 Make timing gearcase oil seal replacing tool [Figure 70- 100-3]. Figure 70-100-4 Make timing gearcase guide screws as shown above [Figure 70-100-4]. Figure 70-100-5 Apply engine oil to the timing gearcase oil seal (Item 1) [Figure 70-100-5]. Install timing gearcase guide screws (Item 2) [Figure 70- 100-5]. Install timing gearcase using the guide (Item 3) [Figure 70-100-5]. A 118 mm (4.65 in) B 12,0 mm (0.472 in) C 0,90 - 1,0 mm (0.36 - 0.039 in) D 10,0,0 mm (0.394 in) E 80,0 mm (3.15 in) F 10,0,0 mm (0.394 in) G 120 mm dia. (4.72 in dia.) H 100,90 - 101,10 mm dia. (3.9725 - 3.9803 in dia.) I 86,966 - 86,988 mm dia .(3.4239 - 3.4247 in dia.) J 79,0 mm dia. (3.11 in dia.) K 15,0 mm dia. (0.591 in dia.) L 30,0 mm dia. (1.18 in dia.) M 13,0 mm (0.512 in) N 90,00 mm (3.54 in) O 2,50 mm (0.0984 in) P 0,35 rad (20 degrees) Q 0,15 - 0,25 mm (0.0059 - 0.0098 in) a Ra = 3.2 a P-90006 b Ra = 1.6 a c 0,80 mm radius (0.031 in radius) d 1,5 mm radius (0.059 in radius) e 0,20 mm radius (0.0079 in radius) C0.3 Chamfer 0,30 mm (0.012 in) C1 Chamfer 1,0 mm (0.039 in) P-85218 P-85999 1 2 3 70-100-4 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS (CONT’D) Timing Gearcase Cover Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-100-6 Apply a liquid gasket (Three Bond 1217H) (Item 1) [Figure 70-100-6] to the two crankcase seams. Figure 70-100-7 Install timing gearcase oil seal using the timing gearcase oil seal replacing tool (Item 1) [Figure 70-100-7]. Figure 70-100-8 Tighten the seven outside timing gearcase cover mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-100-8]. Tighten the six inside timing gearcase cover mounting bolts (Item 2) [Figure 70-100-8]. Installation: Tighten the timing gearcase cover bolts to 103 - 117N•m (76 - 86 ft-lb) [Figure 70-100-8]. P-85998 1 P-85217 1 P-85997B 1 2 70-100-5 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS (CONT’D) Timing Gears Backlash - Checking When the gears are installed, check the backlash of the gears. Figure 70-100-9 Install a dial indicator to individually check backlash for cam gear (Item 1), idle gear (Item 2), injection pump gear (Item 3) and crank gear (Item 4) [Figure 70-100-9]. Hold one gear while turning the other gear [Figure 70- 100-9]. If the backlash exceeds the allowable limit, check the oil clearance of the shaft and gear. If the oil clearance is correct, replace the gear. Idler Gear And Camshaft Removal And Installation Remove the timing gearcase cover. (See Timing Gearcase Cover Removal on Page 70-100-1.) Remove the valve tappets. (See Valve Tappets on Page 70-80-12.) Figure 70-100-10 Rotate entire engine with the crankshaft (Item 1) [Figure 70-100-10] facing up to remove the tappets Remove the three camshaft set bolts (Item 2) and remove the cam (Item 3) [Figure 70-100-10]. Remove the idle gear mounting bolts (Item 4) and remove idle gear (Item 5) [Figure 70-100-10]. Installation: Make sure the timing marks are in correct alignment when installing the timing gears. Crank Gear & Cam Gear 0,0410 - 0,139 mm (0.00162 - 0.00547 in) Allowable Limit 0,22 mm (0.0087 in) Cam Gear & Idler Gear 0,0410 - 0,134 mm (0.00162 - 0.00527 in) Allowable Limit 0,22 mm (0.0087 in) Injection Pump Gear & Idler Gear 0,0410 - 0,134 mm (0.00162 - 0.00527 in) Allowable Limit 0,22 mm (0.0087 in) P-85205 1 2 3 4 P-90008 2 1 3 5 4 70-100-6 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS (CONT’D) Camshaft - Servicing Figure 70-100-11 Mount a dial indicator and check cam gear (Item 1) end play (Item 2) [Figure 70-100-11]. Installation: Check the camshaft end play. If clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the camshaft retainer plate [Figure 70-100-11]. Figure 70-100-12 Measure the cylinder block bore in the engine block [Figure 70-100-12]. Figure 70-100-13 Measure the camshaft journal (Item 1) and journal (Item 2) [Figure 70-100-13]. Calculate the oil clearance. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the camshaft. Camshaft End Play Allowable Limit 0,10 mm (0.0039 in) P-85209 1 2 P-47263 Cylinder Block Bore 1 I.D. 35,000 - 35,025 mm (1.3780 - 1.3789 in) Cylinder Block Bore 2 I.D. 44,000 - 44,025 mm (1.7323 - 1.7332 in) Camshaft Journal 1 O.D. 34,934 - 34,950 mm (1.3754 - 1.3759 in) Camshaft Journal 2 O.D. 43,934 - 43,950 mm (1.7297 - 1.7303 in) Oil Clearance of Cam- shaft Journal 0,050 - 0,091 mm (0.0020 - 0.0035 in) Allowable Limit 0,15 mm (0.0059 in) P-85212 2 1 70-100-7 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS (CONT’D) Camshaft - Servicing (Cont’d) Figure 70-100-14 Measure the cam lobes at their highest point (Item 2) [Figure 70-100-14]. If the measurement is less than the allowable limit, replace the camshaft (Item 1) [Figure 70-100-14]. Figure 70-100-15 Put the camshaft (Item 1) in V-blocks. Install a dial indicator [Figure 70-100-15]. Turn the camshaft at a slow rate. If the misalignment exceeds the allowable limit, replace the camshaft. Idler Gear And Shaft - Servicing Figure 70-100-16 Mount a dial indicator and check idle gear (Item 1) end play (Item 2) [Figure 70-100-16]. Installation: Check the idler gear end play. If the clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the gear collar. Cam Lobe Height Intake 37,50 mm (1.476 in) Cam Lobe Height Exhaust 37,90 mm (1.492 in) Allowable Limit Intake 37,00 mm (1.457 in) Allowable Limit Exhaust 37,40 mm (1.472 in) P-85214 1 2 P-85213 1 Camshaft Alignment Allowable Limit 0,01 mm (0.0004 in) Idler Gear End Play 0,15 - 0,25 mm (0.0059 - 0.0098 in) Allowable Limit 0,90 mm (0.035 in) P-85207 2 1 70-100-8 S650 Service Manual CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS (CONT’D) Idler Gear And Shaft - Servicing (Cont’d) Figure 70-100-17 Measure idle gear bushing ID (Item 1) and idle gear shaft OD (Item 2) [Figure 70-100-17]. Installation: If the oil clearance exceeds the allowable limit, replace the idle gear bushing. Figure 70-100-18 Make this idle gear bushing replacing tool as shown above [Figure 70-100-18]. Figure 70-100-19 When removing idle gear bushing, press out bushing as shown above (item 1) [Figure 70-100-19]. When replacing idle gear bushing, press in bushing as shown above (item 2) [Figure 70-100-19]. Idler Gear Shaft O.D. 34,959 - 34,975 mm 1.3764 - 1.3769 in) Idler Gear Bushing I.D. 35,025 - 35,050 mm (1.3790 - 1.3799 in) Oil Clearance Between Idler Shaft & Gear Bushing 0,050 - 0,091 mm (0.0020 - 0.0035 in) Allowable Limit 0,10 mm (0.0039 in) P-85208 2 1 P-85211 A 196 mm (7.72 in) B 25,00 mm (0.984 in) C 150 mm (5.91 in) D 34,5 mm dia. (1.36 in dia.) E 38,075 - 38,100 mm dia. (1.4991 - 1.5000 in dia.) F 20 mm dia. (0.79 in dia.) a 0,0063 mm (0.000248 in) b 0,0063 mm (0.000248 in) C1 Chamfer 1,0 mm (0.039 in) C2 Chamfer 1,0 mm (0.039 in) P-85210 1 2 70-110-1 S650 Service Manual TURBOCHARGER Description Figure 70-110-1 The turbocharger is placed between the exhaust and intake manifolds. It is driven by hot exhaust gases and supplies air at more than atmospheric pressure to the intake. It is lubricated by oil from the main galley. The location of the turbo is between the engine and the blower housing. The oil flows to the turbo by a tubeline (Item 1) and returns to the engine block through another tubeline (Item 2) [Figure 70-110-1]. The turbocharger internal components are not serviceable. Testing Remove the turbocharger. (See Removal And Installation on Page 70-110-2.) Radial Clearance Figure 70-110-2 Move the compressor / turbine wheel (up and down / right and left) (Item 1) [Figure 70-110-2]. If the wheel contacts the housing, replace the turbocharger assembly with a new one. Check the oil tubelines for leaks. P-85976 1 2 P-76099 1 70-110-2 S650 Service Manual TURBOCHARGER (CONT’D) Removal And Installation WARNING Turbochargers, operate at high speed and high temperatures. Keep fingers, tools and other objects away from the inlet and outlet ports. Avoid contact with hot surfaces. W-2257-1196 Remove the muffler. (See Removal And Installation on Page 70-30-1.) Remove the air cleaner. (See Housing Removal And Installation on Page 70-40-1.) Figure 70-110-3 Disconnect the two oil pipes (Item 1) [Figure 70-110-3]. Installation: Tighten the two tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 70-110-3] to 16 - 19 N•m (12 - 14 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-110-4 Remove the two exhaust manifold cover bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-110-4]. Figure 70-110-5 Remove the eight exhaust manifold bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-110-4]. Installation: Tighten the eight bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70- 110-3] to 24 - 27 N•m (17.7 - 19.9 ft-lb) torque. P-85975 1 1 P-85978 1 P-85979 1 1 70-110-3 S650 Service Manual TURBOCHARGER (CONT’D) Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-110-6 Remove the turbocharger assembly (Item 1) [Figure 70- 110-6]. Installation: During installation replace all gaskets with new ones. P-85127 1 70-110-4 S650 Service Manual 70-120-1 S650 Service Manual FLYWHEEL AND HOUSING Flywheel Removal And Installation Remove the engine / hydrostatic pump package from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) Remove the drive belt shield. (See DRIVE BELT on Page 30-60-1.) Remove the drive belt tension pulley. (See Tensioner Pulley Removal And Installation on Page 30-60-4.) Remove the drive belt. (See DRIVE BELT on Page 30- 60-1.) Figure 70-120-1 Remove the six mounting bolts (Item 1) from the pulley (Item 2) [Figure 70-120-1]. Remove the pulley (Item 2) [Figure 70-120-1]. Installation: Tighten to 43 - 47 N•m (32 - 35 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-120-2 Make flywheel stop tool as shown above in [Figure 70- 120-2]. Figure 70-120-3 Make flywheel guide bolts as shown above to aid in removal and installation of flywheel [Figure 70-120-3]. P-85138 1 2 A 144 mm (5.67 in) B 104 mm (4.09 in) C 20,0 mm (0.787 in) D 10,0 mm dia. (0.394 in dia.) E 12,0 mm dia. (0.472 in dia.) F 16,0 mm dia. (0.630 in dia.) G 16,0 mm dia. (0.630 in dia.) H 32,0 mm (1.26 in) I 16,0 mm (0.630 in) P-85215 P-85218 70-120-2 S650 Service Manual FLYWHEEL AND HOUSING (CONT’D) Flywheel Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 70-120-4 Install flywheel stop tool (Item 1) [Figure 70-120-4]. Remove two flywheel bolts and replace them with the flywheel guides bolts to aid in removal (Item 1) [Figure 70-120-3]. Remove the seven mounting bolts (Item 2)[Figure 70- 120-4] from the flywheel. Installation: Apply engine oil to the bolts and tighten to 98,1 - 107 N•m (72.4 - 79.5 ft-lb) torque. NOTE: Do not use a impact wrench. Serious damage will occur. There is one positioning pin in the crankshaft gear and it is installed in the flywheel. Figure 70-120-5 Install two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-120-5] into the threaded holes on the flywheel and tighten to remove flywheel. Figure 70-120-6 Install two guide bolts (Item 1) [Figure 70-120-6] to aid in installation of the flywheel. P-85074 1 2 P-85140A 1 P-85140 1 70-120-3 S650 Service Manual FLYWHEEL AND HOUSING (CONT’D) Ring Gear Removal And Installation Figure 70-120-7 The ring gear (Item 1) [Figure 70-120-7] on the flywheel is an interference fit. Heat the ring gear enough to expand the gear. Hit the ring gear evenly around the gear to remove it from the flywheel. Clean the outer surface of the flywheel thoroughly so the new ring gear will fit smoothly onto the flywheel. Clean the new ring gear and heat it to a temperature of 232 - 260°C (450 - 500°F). Fit the ring on the flywheel and be sure the gear is seated correctly. Housing Removal And Installation Remove the engine / hydrostatic pump package from the loader. (See Engine Removal And Installation on Page 70-10-7.) Remove the drive belt shield. (See DRIVE BELT on Page 30-60-1.) Remove the drive belt tension pulley. (See Tensioner Pulley Removal And Installation on Page 30-60-4.) Remove the drive belt. (See DRIVE BELT on Page 30- 60-1.) Remove the starter. (See Removal And Installation on Page 60-40-1.) Remove the flywheel. (See Flywheel Removal And Installation on Page 70-120-1.) Figure 70-120-8 Remove the four mounting bolts (Item 1) and the housing (Item 2) [Figure 70-120-8]. Installation: Tighten the mounting bolts to 80 - 84 N•m (56 - 62 ft-lb) torque. P-48850 1 P-85137 1 1 2 70-120-4 S650 Service Manual 70-130-1 S650 Service Manual EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM Description Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR) is a system in which the exhaust gas with lean oxygen is cooled and returned to the cylinders again in order to lower the combustion temperature. An External / Mechanical EGR consists of a water cooled EGR cooler, mechanical EGR valve, reed valve and thermo valve. When the coolant temperature is high and the boost pressure is low, the EGR valve will not open. If the coolant temperature is high and the boost pressure is also high, the EGR valve will open allowing cooled gas back into the intake manifold. The reed valve between the EGR valve and the intake manifold prevents fresh air from flowing into EGR system. Figure 70-130-1 The items listed below refer to [Figure 70-130-1]. 1. Thermo Valve 2. Mechanical EGR Valve 3. Cylinder Head 4. Reed Valve 5. EGR Cooler 6. Intake Manifold 7. Boost Pressure 8. Coolant Temperature 9. Cooled EGR Gas 10. To The Intake Manifold 11. Fresh Air 12. Cooled EGR Gas Merges With Fresh Air 13. Exhaust Gas 14. Coolant Inlet 15. Coolant Outlet P-85105 7 1 8 10 2 9 3 4 12 11 6 5 13 14 15 2 7 1 9 70-130-2 S650 Service Manual EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM (CONT'D) Testing There are two tests for checking the EGR system. Both tests will need to be performed and the coolant temperature must be monitored through the Service Analyzer. The Cold Engine Coolant Temperature Test will need to be performed with the engine coolant below 55°C (131°F). The Hot Engine Coolant Temperature Test will need to be performed with the engine coolant above 70°C (158°F). WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH When the engine is running during service, the steering levers or joysticks must be in neutral and the parking brake engaged. W-2717-0208 WARNING MACHINE FALLING OR MOVING CAN CAUSE SERIOUS INJURY OR DEATH Put jackstands under the front and rear of the machine before running engine for service. W-2718-0208 Lift and block the loader. (See Procedure on Page 10-10- 1.) Open the rear door. Connect the Service PC (See SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) on Page 60-150-1.) WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH When an engine is running in an enclosed area, fresh air must be added to avoid concentration of exhaust fumes. If the engine is stationary, vent the exhaust outside. Exhaust fumes contain odorless, invisible gases which can kill without warning. W-2050-0807 Cold Engine Coolant Temperature Test Start the engine and run at low idle. Start Service Analyzer and select [Monitor]. Select [Engine Temperature]. WARNING AVOID BURNS Some surfaces of the Exhaust Gas Recirculation system can be hot. Use caution when conducting diagnostic tests. Allow the engine to cool before servicing. W-2716-0208 NOTE: Verify the engine temperature is below 55°C (131°F). If the engine temperature is above 55°C (131°F), let the engine cool down and restart the Cold Engine Coolant temperature Test. NOTE: Monitor the engine coolant temperature using the Service Analyzer. Figure 70-130-2 Measure the surface temperature of the EGR system (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-2] with an Infrared Thermometer. If the engine coolant temperature is below 55°C (131°F) and the surface temperature of the EGR system is 150°C (302°F) or below, the EGR system is OK, Continue with the Hot Engine Coolant temperature Test. If the surface temperature of the EGR system reads 150°C (302°F) or above continue this Cold Engine Coolant Temperature Test. P-85108 1 70-130-3 S650 Service Manual EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM (CONT'D) Testing (Cont’d) Figure 70-130-3 Disconnect the boost hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-3] from the EGR valve. Figure 70-130-4 Measure the surface temperature of the EGR system (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-4] with an Infrared Thermometer. If the surface temperature of the EGR system declines, the thermo valve has failed. If the surface temperature of the EGR system stays above 150°C (302°F), the EGR valve has failed. Hot Engine Coolant Temperature Test Verify the engine temperature is above 70°C (158°F), if the engine temperature is below 70°C (158°F) run the engine to bring the temperature above 70°C (158°F) then continue with the Hot Engine Coolant Temperature Test. Figure 70-130-5 Measure the surface temperature of the EGR system (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-5] with an Infrared Thermometer. With the engine coolant temperature above 70°C (158°F) and the surface temperature of the EGR system 150°C (302°F) or above, the EGR system is OK. If the surface temperature of the EGR system is 150°C (302°F) or below continue this Hot Engine Coolant Temperature Test. Figure 70-130-6 Disconnect the intake hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-6]. P-85984 1 P-85108 1 P-85108 1 P-85980 1 70-130-4 S650 Service Manual EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM (CONT'D) Testing (Cont’d) Figure 70-130-7 Disconnect the EGR hose (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-6]. Figure 70-130-8 Connect a hose (Item 1) directly between the intake manifold (Item 2) and the EGR valve (Item 3) [Figure 70- 130-8]. Figure 70-130-9 Measure the surface temperature of the EGR system (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-9] with an Infrared Thermometer. If the surface temperature of the EGR system increases, the thermo valve has failed. If the surface temperature of the EGR system is 150°C (302°F) or below, the EGR valve has failed. P-85984 1 P-85981 1 2 3 P-85108 1 70-130-5 S650 Service Manual EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM (CONT'D) Removal And Installation WARNING AVOID BURNS Some surfaces of the Exhaust Gas Recirculation system can be hot. Use caution when conducting diagnostic tests. Allow the engine to cool before servicing. W-2716-0208 Allow the engine to cool before working on the EGR system. Figure 70-130-10 Disconnect and cap the EGR valve coolant hoses (Item 1) [Figure 70-130-10]. Disconnect the boost pressure hose (Item 2) [Figure 70- 130-10]. Figure 70-130-11 Remove the four EGR cooler mounting bolts (Item 1) and the EGR system assembly (Item 2) [Figure 70-130-11]. Installation: Replace the gaskets (Items 3 and 4) [Figure 70-130-11] with new ones. Figure 70-130-12 NOTE: The gasket (Item 3) [Figure 70-130-11] and [Figure 70-130-12] is marked with the letter “F” and must be installed downward. P-85982 1 2 P-85110 3 2 1 1 1 1 4 P-85113 2 3 70-130-6 S650 Service Manual EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly Figure 70-130-13 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) from the EGR cooler flange (Item 2) [Figure 70-130-13]. Remove and replace the gasket (Item 3) [Figure 70-130- 13]. Remove the four bolts (Item 4) from the EGR cooler (Item 5) and the EGR valve (Item 7) [Figure 70-130-13]. Remove and replace the gasket (Item 6) [Figure 70-130- 13]. Remove the thermo valve (Item 8) [Figure 70-130-13]. Installation: When reassembling replace with new gaskets. NOTE: If the thermo valve is dropped it must be replaced with a new one. Installation: Tighten the thermo valve to 30 - 39 N•m (22 - 28 ft-lb) torque. Figure 70-130-14 Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 1) from the EGR valve (Item 2) and EGR valve flange (Item 6) [Figure 70- 130-14]. Remove the two mounting bolts (Item 3) from the reed valve (Item 5) [Figure 70-130-14]. Remove and replace the gaskets (Item 4) [Figure 70- 130-14]. Installation: When reassembling replace with new gaskets. P-85112 1 2 3 5 6 7 4 8 P-85111 1 2 4 5 6 4 3 4 80-01 S650 Service Manual HEATING, VENTILATION, AIR CONDITIONING AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-10-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-10-1 Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-10-2 Components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-10-3 Safety Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-10-6 REGULAR MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-1 Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-1 Compressor Drive Belt Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-2 Compressor Drive Belt Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-2 Condenser . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-2 Air Conditioning Lubrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-2 Air Conditioning Service Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-3 Evaporator / Heater Coil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-20-4 TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-1 Blower Motor Does Not Operate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-1 Blower Motor Operates Normally, But Air Flow Is Insufficient . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-1 Insufficient Cooling Although Air Flow And Compressor Operation Are Normal . . . 80-30-1 The Compressor Does Not Operate At All, Or Operates Improperly . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-1 Gauge Pressure Related Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-2 Troubleshooting Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-4 Temperature / Pressure Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-8 Poor A/C Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-10 HVAC Repair And Leaks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-30-11 Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-12 Engine Coolant Bypassing The Heater Valve . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-18 Heater Valve Not Opening Or Closing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-30-19 SYSTEM CHARGING AND RECLAMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-40-1 Refrigerant Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-40-1 Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-40-2 COMPRESSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-50-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-50-1 Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-50-2 Oil Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-50-3 CONDENSER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-60-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-60-1 RECEIVER / DRIER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-70-1 Receiver / Drier Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-70-1 Pressure Relief Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-70-2 Pressure Switch Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-70-3 Schraeder Valve Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-70-4 80-02 S650 Service Manual EVAPORATOR / HEATER UNIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-80-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-80-1 THERMOSTAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-90-1 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-90-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-90-2 EXPANSION VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-100-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-100-1 EVAPORATOR COIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-110-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-110-1 HEATER COIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-120-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-120-1 BLOWER FAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-130-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-130-1 Disassembly And Assembly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-130-1 HEATER VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-140-1 Removal And Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-140-1 80-10-1 S650 Service Manual AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW Description In an air conditioning system the refrigerant is circulated under pressure through five major components in a closed circuit. At these five points in the system the refrigerant goes through pressure and temperature changes. The compressor (Item 1) (See Chart on Page 80-10-2.) takes in low temperature, low pressure refrigerant gas through the suction valve (low pressure side) and as the name indicates, pressurizes the refrigerant and forces it through the discharge valve (high pressure side) and to the condenser (Item 2) (See Chart on Page 80-10-2.) Ambient air passing through the condenser removes the heat from refrigerant resulting in physical state change in the refrigerant from a gas to a liquid. The liquid refrigerant moves on to the receiver / drier (Item 3) (See Chart on Page 80-10-2.) where impurities such as moisture and dirt are filtered out. The receiver / drier also serves as the storage tank for the liquid refrigerant. The liquid refrigerant (still under high pressure) flows to the expansion valve (Item 4) (See Chart on Page 80-10-2.) The expansion valve meters the amount of refrigerant entering the evaporator coil (Item 5) (See Chart on Page 80-10-2.) As the refrigerant passes through the expansion valve, it again changes its physical state. It becomes a low temperature, low-pressure liquid and saturated vapor. The low pressure liquid immediately starts to boil and vaporize as it enters the evaporator. The hot humid air of the machine's cab is drawn through or blown across the evaporator by the evaporator fan (Item 6) (See Chart on Page 80-10-2.) Since the refrigerant is colder than the air, it absorbs the heat from the air which results in cooled air, which is pushed into the cab by the blower. The moisture in the air condenses on the evaporator coil and drips into the drain pan, which directs the water out of the cab. The refrigerant cycle is completed when the low temperature low pressure gas is again drawn into the compressor. 80-10-2 S650 Service Manual AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW (CONT'D) Chart b-16691 Thermostat Expansion Valve Cold Air Evaporator Blower Compressor Fan Condenser Sight Glass Pressure Switch Receiver Drier Desiccant Evaporator 4 5 6 2 3 1 Status Of R134a_______________________________________________ High Pressure Gas High Pressure Liquid Low Pressure Gas Low Pressure Liquid 80-10-3 S650 Service Manual AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW (CONT'D) Components Figure 80-10-1 Compressor: The compressor (Item 1) [Figure 80-10-1] is the pump that circulates the refrigerant throughout the system. It raises the pressure of the refrigerant for heat transfer through the condenser and evaporator. NOTE: The A/C system (Compressor) is recommended to be turned on for at least 5 minutes weekly throughout the year to lubricate the internal components. Figure 80-10-2 Condenser: The condenser (Item 1) [Figure 80-10-2] is the unit that receives the high pressure, high temperature refrigerant vapor from the compressor and condenses it into a high temperature liquid. Figure 80-10-3 Receiver/Drier: The receiver / drier (Item 1) [Figure 80- 10-3] is the unit that receives the liquid refrigerant from the condenser and removes moisture and foreign matter from the system. It also serves as a storage tank for the extra liquid refrigerant until it is needed by the evaporator. Figure 80-10-4 Pressure Relief Valve: The pressure relief valve (Item 2) [Figure 80-10-3] is located on the receiver drier assembly. This small brass valve (Item 1) [Figure 80-10- 4] is a safety feature that is designed to open and release the A/C charge if the pressure reaches 3,7 MPa (36,9 bar) (535 psi). P-89538 1 P-85824 1 P-89545 2 1 N-22206 1 80-10-4 S650 Service Manual AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW (CONT'D) Components (Cont'd) Figure 80-10-5 Heater / Evaporator Unit: The heater / evaporator unit (Item 1) [Figure 80-10-5] is located behind the loader cab. The unit delivers the cold air for the A/C and warm air for heat into the cab. The unit contains the blower, heat & A/C coils, thermostat and expansion valve. Figure 80-10-6 Expansion Valve: The expansion valve (Item 1) [Figure 80-10-6] controls the amount of refrigerant entering the evaporator coil. Figure 80-10-7 Evaporator Coil: The evaporator coil (Item 1) [Figure 80- 10-7] cools and dehumidifies the air before it enters the cab. Thermostat: The thermostat (Item 2) [Figure 80-10-7] controls the temperature of the evaporator coil. Heater Coil: The heater coil (Item 3) [Figure 80-10-7] supplies the warm air into the cab by passing air through the coil. Heater / Evaporator Blower: The blower (Item 4) [Figure 80-10-7] is used to push air through the heater and evaporator coils and into the cab. P-92602 1 P-92659 1 P-89497 1 3 2 4 80-10-5 S650 Service Manual AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW (CONT'D) Components (Cont'd) Figure 80-10-8 Control Panel: The panel (Item 1) [Figure 80-10-8] has three separate components. Fan Switch: This is a four position rotary switch (Item 2) [Figure 80-10-8]. When the fan switch is in the off position the A/C will not engage, but the heat valve will operate, as it is controlled by the ignition power. A/C Switch: The rocker switch (Item 3) [Figure 80-10-8] will be illuminated when the A/C is engaged. Potentiometer: The potentiometer (Item 4) [Figure 80- 10-8] controls the Heat Valve from fully Off to fully On. This can be used in conjunction with the A/C for defrost of the windows and temperature control. Figure 80-10-9 Heater Valve: The heater valve (Item 1) [Figure 80-10-9] is used to control the amount of engine coolant that flows to the heater coil. Figure 80-10-10 Pressure Switch: The pressure switch (Item 1) [Figure 80-10-10] will disengage the compressor clutch at high pressure readings over 2647,6 kPa (26,5 bar) (384 psi.) on the high side, or at very low pressure of 193,0 kPa (1,9 bar) (28 psi) or less on the high side, which indicates loss of refrigerant. P-92638 3 4 2 1 P-90353 1 P-89545 1 80-10-6 S650 Service Manual AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW (CONT'D) Safety Equipment Figure 80-10-11 Figure 80-10-12 In servicing A/C and heater systems you will be exposed to high pressures, temperatures and several chemical hazards. Moving belts and pulleys are normal shop hazards. In addition to exercising caution in your work, DO WEAR SAFETY GLASSES OR A FACE SHIELD [Figure 80- 10-11] when you are using R-134a or a leak detector, adjusting service valves or the manifold gage set connectors. Safety glasses or a transparent face shield are practical safety items and one or the other is absolutely required. WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 R-134a inside a canister or in an A/C system is a liquid under pressure. When it escapes or releases into the air, ITS TEMPERATURE DROPS TO -5.8°C (21.6°F) “INSTANTLY”. If it spills on your skin or in your eyes you should flood the area with cool water and SEEK MEDICAL ATTENTION FAST! It is a good idea to wear gloves [Figure 80-10-12] to prevent frost bite if you should get refrigerant on your hands. WARNING HFC 134A refrigerant can be dangerous if not properly handled. Liquid 134A may cause blindness if it contacts the eyes and may cause serious frostbite if it contacts the skin. • Gaseous 134A becomes lethal (phosgene) gas when it contacts open flame or very hot substances. • NEVER SMOKE when there is the possibility of even small amounts of 134A in the air. Any servicing work that involves release or addition of 134A to the system must be done by a competent refrigeration dealer who has the proper equipment, knowledge, and experience to service refrigeration equipment. W-2373-0500 P16398 P16399 80-20-1 S650 Service Manual REGULAR MAINTENANCE Filters Fresh Air Filters Figure 80-20-1 The fresh air filters are located behind the side windows outside the operators cab. (Right side shown) Remove the clamping knob (Item 1) and filter cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-20-1]. Shake the filter (Item 3) [Figure 80-20-1] or use low pressure air to remove dirt. This can be done several times before replacement is required. Install the filter, filter cover and clamping knob. Recirculation Filter (Earlier Models) Figure 80-20-2 The recirculation filter is located behind the operators seat inside the operators cab. Flip the clamps (Item 1) holding the filter up and remove the filter (Item 2) [Figure 80-20-2]. Shake the filter or use a vacuum to clean. This can be done several times before replacement is required. Install the filter into the opening and flip the clamps down to hold the filter in place. Recirculation Filter (Later Models) Figure 80-20-3 The recirculation filter is located behind the operator’s seat inside the operator cab. The filter cover is held in place with three clips. Pull the cover at each end (Item 1) [Figure 80-20-3] to remove. Rinse the filter elements with water or use a vacuum to clean. Do not use solvents. Line up the clips on the filter cover with the slots provided and push the cover into place. P-90492A 3 P-90489A 1 2 P-90490A 2 1 P100755 1 80-20-2 S650 Service Manual REGULAR MAINTENANCE (CONT’D) Compressor Drive Belt Adjustment The air conditioning belt is a special maintenance free type that is pretensioned over the pulleys. This belt eliminates the need for a tensioning device and does not require periodic adjustment. Contact your Bobcat dealer for replacement parts. Compressor Drive Belt Replacement Stop the engine and open the rear door. Figure 80-20-4 NOTE: The engine is shown removed for visual clarity. Loosen the top air conditioning pump mounting bolts (Item 1) [Figure 80-20-4]. Remove the bottom air conditioning pump mounting bolt (Item 2) [Figure 80-20-4]. Move the air conditioning pump toward the engine as far as it will go and remove the belt from the pulleys. Inspect the pulleys for wear. Install new belt. Figure 80-20-5 Use a prybar at the two leverage points (Item 1) [Figure 80-20-5] to move the air conditioning pump until the bottom air conditioning pump mounting bolt (Item 2) [Figure 80-20-4] can be installed. Tighten the three mounting bolts (Items 1 and 2) [Figure 80-20-4]. Close the rear door. Condenser The condenser should be cleaned with the oil cooler and the radiator. Air Conditioning Lubrication Run the air conditioning for about five minutes every week to lubricate the internal components. P-85942A 1 2 P-85993 1 80-20-3 S650 Service Manual REGULAR MAINTENANCE (CONT’D) Air Conditioning Service Chart Service Company/Phone Number: Date: Machine Model: Machine Dealer: Machine Serial Number: Customer: Machine Hours: Pre Service Conditions 15 Minutes 30 Minutes Notes Ambient Temperature: Louver Temperature: Cab Temperature At Head Position: Temperature Into Condenser: High Side Pressure Low Side Pressure Ambient Humidity Observations: Explain Services Required: Post Service Conditions 15 Minutes 30 Minutes Notes Ambient Temperature: Louver Temperature: Cab Temperature at Head Position: Temperature Into Condenser: High Side Pressure Low Side Pressure Ambient Humidity Observations: 80-20-4 S650 Service Manual REGULAR MAINTENANCE (CONT’D) Evaporator / Heater Coil Earlier Models Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 80-20-6 Remove cover screws (Item 1) [Figure 80-20-6] and remove the cover. Figure 80-20-7 Use low pressure air or water to remove debris from the heater coil (Item 1) and evaporator (Item 2) [Figure 80- 20-7]. Install the cover and lower the operator cab. (See Lowering on Page 10-30-3.) Later Models Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 80-20-8 Unhook cover latches (Item 1) [Figure 80-20-8] and remove the cover. Figure 80-20-9 Use low pressure air or water to remove debris from the heater coil (Item 1) and evaporator (Item 2) [Figure 80- 20-9]. Install the cover and lower the operator cab. (See Lowering on Page 10-30-3.) P-90419A 1 P-90420A 2 1 P100756 1 P100757 2 1 80-30-1 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING Blower Motor Does Not Operate Blower Motor Operates Normally, But Air Flow Is Insufficient Insufficient Cooling Although Air Flow And Compressor Operation Are Normal The Compressor Does Not Operate At All, Or Operates Improperly Possible Cause Inspection Solution 1. Blown fuse. Inspect the fuse/wiring. Replace fuse/repair wiring. 2. Broken wiring or bad connection. Check the fan motor ground and connectors. Repair the wiring or connector. 3. Fan motor malfunction. Check the lead wires form the motor with a circuit tester. Replace Motor. 4. Resistor malfunction. Check resistor using a circuit tester. Replace Resistor. 5. Fan motor switch malfunc- tion. Check power into and out of the fan switch. Replace Fan Switch. Possible Cause Inspection Solution 1. Evaporator inlet obstruction. Check evaporator for plugging. Remove obstruction and clean evaporator fins with air or water. 2. Air leak. Check to make sure air ducts are properly con- nected and seals are not damaged. Repair or adjust. 3. Defective thermo. switch (frozen evaporator). Check thermostat using a circuit tester. Replace thermostat. 4. Plugged cab filters Check cab recirculation and fresh air filters. Clean or replace filters. Possible Cause Inspection Solution 1. System low on refrigerant. The high side pressure will be low and bubbles may be present in sight glass on receive drier. Repair any leaks and recharge the refrigerant to the correct level. 2. Excessive refrigerant. The high pressure side pressure will be high. Use refrigerant recovery equipment to capture excess refrigerant. Charge to the cor- rect refrigerant level. Possible Cause Inspection Solution 1. Loose belt. The belt is vibrating or oscillating. Replace belt. 2. Internal compressor mal- function. The compressor is locked up and the belt slips. Replace compressor. Magnetic clutch related 3. Low battery voltage. Clutch slips. Recharge the battery. 4. Faulty coil. Clutch slips. Replace the magnetic clutch. 5. Oil on the clutch surface. Clutch slips. Replace or clean the clutch surface. 6. Open coil. Clutch does not engage and there is no reading when a circuit tester is connected between the coil and terminals. Replace clutch. 7. Broken wiring or poor ground. Clutch will not engage. Inspect the ground and connections. Repair. 8. Wiring harness compo- nents. Test the conductance of the pressure switch, ther- mostat, Relay, etc. Check operation / thermostat LED status. 80-30-2 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Gauge Pressure Related Troubleshooting Normal compressor suction (low side) and discharge (high side) pressure at ambient temperatures of 30 - 38°C (86 - 96°F) and compressor speed of approximately 3200 RPM are: High pressure side pressure: 1447,9 - 1827,1 kPa (14,5 - 18,3 bar) (210 - 265 psi) Low pressure side pressure: 103,4 - 227,5 (1,0 - 2,3 bar) (15 - 33 psi) As a rule of thumb the high side pressure will be around eight times greater then the low side pressure. Possible Cause Inspection Solution Low pressure side Too high. The low pressure side pressure normally becomes too high when the high pressure side pressure is too high. As this is explained below, the following inspection is only used when the low pressure side is too high. 1. Expansion valve opens too far. Frost is present on the suction hose. Replace expansion valve. 2. Defective compres- sor. The high and low pressure side gauge pressures equal- ize when the magnetic clutch is engaged. Replace compressor. Low pressure side Too low. 1. Low refrigerant charge. The high side pressure will be low and bubbles may be present in sight glass on receiver drier. Repair any leaks and recharge the refrigerant to the correct level. 2. Clogged or closed expansion valve. The expansion valve’s inlet side is frosted. Moisture or other contaminants can be the cause. Clean or replace the expansion Valve. 3. Restriction between drier and expansion valve. Frost on the line between drier and expansion valve. A Negative low pressure reading may be shown. Flush system or replace hose. 4. Thermostat malfunc- tion. The evaporator is frozen. Adjust thermostat’s tempera- ture setting or probe place- ment or replace thermostat. 5. Restriction in receiver drier. Excessive frost on receiver drier. Replace receiver drier. High pressure side Too high. 1. Poor condenser per- formance. Dirty or clogged condenser fins. Condenser fans not operating. Clean fins, and/or repair the fan. 2. Excessive refriger- ant. The high pressure side pressure will be high. Use refrigerant recovery equip- ment to capture excess refrig- erant. Charge to the correct refrigerant level. 3. Excessive oil charge. The high pressure side will be high. Evacuate system. Remove oil from condenser and compres- sor. Measure oil from compres- sor and add correct oil charge back into compressor. Flush system with nitrogen. Replace drier. 4. Air in system. Pressure is high on both high and low sides. Evacuate and recharge with refrigerant. 5. Restriction in drier, condenser or high pres- sure line. High pressure side will be high, and low pressure side will be low. Evacuate and flush system replacing defective parts. 80-30-3 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Gauge Pressure Related Troubleshooting (Cont'd) Possible Cause Inspection Solution High pressure side Too low. 1. Low refrigerant charge. The high side pressure will be low. Repair any leaks and recharge the refrigerant to the correct level. System pressures Equal 1. Clutch not operating. See magnetic clutch related topics above. 2. Compressor not pump- ing. Equal high and low pressures. Replace compressor. 80-30-4 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Troubleshooting Tree P-90410 80-30-5 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Troubleshooting Tree (Cont’d) P-90411 80-30-6 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Troubleshooting Tree (Cont’d) P-90412 80-30-7 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Troubleshooting Tree (Cont’d) P-90413 80-30-8 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Temperature / Pressure Chart NORMAL EVAPORATOR RANGE NORMAL CONDENSER RANGE TEMP F PSIG TEMP F PSIG 16 15.69 93 110.20 18 17.04 94 112.10 20 18.43 95 114.10 22 19.87 100 124.30 24 21.35 102 128.50 26 22.88 104 132.90 28 24.47 106 137.30 30 26.10 108 141.90 32 27.79 110 146.50 34 29.52 112 151.30 36 31.32 114 156.10 38 33.17 116 161.10 40 35.07 118 166.10 42 37.03 120 171.30 44 39.05 122 176.60 45 40.09 124 182.00 50 45.48 126 187.50 55 51.27 128 193.10 60 57.47 130 198.90 65 64.10 135 213.70 70 71.19 140 229.40 75 78.75 145 245.80 80 86.80 150 263.00 85 95.40 155 281.10 90 104.40 160 300.10 91 106.30 165 320.10 92 108.20 170 340.80 80-30-9 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Temperature / Pressure Chart (Cont’d) Evaporator Pressures represent gas temperatures inside the coil. not the coil surface. For an estimate of the temperature of the air coming off the coil add -13 - -12°C (8 - 10°F) to the temperature on the chart. Condenser Temperatures are not ambient temperatures but condensing temperatures. Add 4.4°C (40°F) to the ambient temperature to get the condensing temperature and then refer to the pressure chart to see appropriate pressure for ambient temperature. Conditions and pressures will vary from system to system. Check with MCC for system specifications. Example: Ambient Temperature=90°F 90°F +40°F 130°F condenser temperature=200 psig 80-30-10 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Poor A/C Performance Start the loader, lock the park brake, and engage the A/C system with the blower fan on High. Run the loader at full throttle for approximately 15 minutes, with the loader cab door closed. Figure 80-30-1 Figure 80-30-2 Check the temperature at the louvers (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-1] with a thermometer [Figure 80-30-2]. The louver temperature should be between 2,2 - 11,6°C (45 - 53°F.) depending on the amount of humidity in the air and ambient temperature. If louver temperature is too high. (See Troubleshooting Tree on Page 80-30-4.) Check the blower for proper operation, or noise, and replace if necessary. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-130-1.) Check the A/C condenser for dirt or mud and clean if necessary. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80- 60-1.) Check the A/C evaporator coil for dirt or mud and clean if necessary. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80- 110-1.) Check the engine coolant to see if it is bypassing the heater valve. (See Engine Coolant Bypassing The Heater Valve on Page 80-30-18.) P-90356 1 N-22411 80-30-11 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) HVAC Repair And Leaks Figure 80-30-3 Whenever the A/C system is opened to the atmosphere or there has been a leak in the system, the receiver/drier (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-3] must be changed. Never leave hose fittings, compressor fittings or components uncapped while working on the A/C system. P-85954 1 80-30-12 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Electrical System Check to see if the compressor clutch is engaging. With an operator in the loader seat and the cab door open, turn the loader key switch to RUN OR press the RUN Button, without starting the loader. Figure 80-30-4 Push the A/C switch (Item 1) to the ON position. Turn the blower switch (Item 2) [Figure 80-30-4] to the first ON position. The compressor clutch should make a click sound, which indicates the clutch is engaging. Figure 80-30-5 If the compressor clutch does not engage, check the HVAC fuse (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-5] located in the fuse panel. Open the rear door (tailgate). Figure 80-30-6 Locate the loader harness and the compressor clutch wire (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-6]. Disconnect the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-6] from the compressor clutch wire. Figure 80-30-7 With a multi meter, check the resistance to the compressor clutch (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-7]. If there is no resistance value, replace the compressor clutch. P-92638 1 2 P-85412 1 P-90357 1 P-90358 1 80-30-13 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Electrical System (Cont'd) Figure 80-30-8 With a multi meter, check the voltage to the compressor clutch at the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-8]. The voltage reading should be around 12 volts. If there is no power at the clutch, check the wiring harness for broken wires. If there is power at the clutch, reconnect the wiring harness to the compressor clutch. Figure 80-30-9 Disconnect the loader harness (Item 1) from the pressure switch (Item 2) [Figure 80-30-9]. Figure 80-30-10 Using a multi meter check the loader wiring harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-10] for voltage. The voltage should be around 12 volts. If there is no voltage at the wiring harness, check the harness for broken wires. Figure 80-30-11 If there is voltage at the harness, check the resistance at the pressure switch (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-11]. If there is no resistance value, check for low refrigerant level. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40-2.) If a resistance value is seen, the pressure switch is good. Reconnect the loader harness to the pressure switch. P-90358 1 P-90361 1 2 P-90360 1 P-90360 1 80-30-14 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Electrical System (Cont'd) Figure 80-30-12 Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Disconnect the thermostat wiring connector (Item 1 [Figure 80-30-12] from the loader wiring harness. Figure 80-30-13 Check the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-13] for voltage. The voltage should be 12 volts. If there is no voltage at the wiring harness, check the harness for broken wires. If there is voltage at the wiring harness, check the thermostat (Item 2) [Figure 80-30-13] for resistance. The resistance value of the thermostat should be 10 Ohm at 20°C (68°F). If there is no resistance value, replace the thermostat. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-90-2.) If there is a resistance value, check the blower. Figure 80-30-14 Disconnect the blower wiring connector (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-14] from the loader wiring harness. Figure 80-30-15 Check the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-15] for voltage. The voltage should be 12 volts. If there is no voltage at the wiring harness, check the harness for broken wires. If there is voltage at the wiring harness, check the resistance to the blower at the blower wiring connector (Item 2) [Figure 80-30-15]. If there is no resistance value replace the blower. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-130-1.) If there is a resistance value check the climate controls at the control panel inside the loader cab. P-90363 1 P-90362 1 2 P-90363 1 P-90362 1 2 80-30-15 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Electrical System (Cont'd) Figure 80-30-16 Remove the control panel (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-16] from the left side lower panel. Figure 80-30-17 Disconnect the loader wiring harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-17] from the blower switch. Check the loader harness for voltage. The voltage should be 12 volts. If there is no voltage at the wiring harness, check the harness for broken wires. Figure 80-30-18 If there is voltage at the wiring harness, check the blower switch [Figure 80-30-18] for resistance. With the switch in the 1 position, there should be resistance between C terminal and the B terminal. And also between the C terminal and the L terminal frame [Figure 80-30-18]. With the switch in the 2 position, there should be resistance between C terminal and the B terminal. And also between the C terminal and the M terminal frame [Figure 80-30-18]. With the switch in the 3 position, there should be resistance between C terminal and the B terminal. And also between the C terminal and the H terminal frame [Figure 80-30-18]. If any of the above resistance tests fail, replace the blower switch. If the above resistance tests are good, check the A/C switch. P-90364 1 P-90365 1 N-22288 H C M B L 80-30-16 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT’D) Electrical System (Cont’d) Figure 80-30-19 At the loader cab, disconnect the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-19] from the A/C switch. Check the harness for voltage. The voltage should be 12 volts. If there is no voltage at the wiring harness, check the harness for broken wires. Figure 80-30-20 If there is voltage at the wiring harness, check the A/C switch [Figure 80-30-20] for resistance. With the switch in the OFF position there should be no resistance between any of the three terminals on the A/C switch. With the switch in the ON position there should be resistance between terminal (Item 1) and terminal (Item 2) [Figure 80-30-20]. If no resistance value is found, replace the A/C switch. If a resistance value is found, check the potentiometer. The potentiometer will effect the A/C system and also effect the operation of the heater. If heater valve does not open, or close, or the A/C does not work, check the potentiometer. Figure 80-30-21 At the loader cab, disconnect the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-21] from the potentiometer. Check the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-21] for voltage. The voltage should be 12 volts. If there is no voltage at the wiring harness, check the harness for broken wires. P-90367 1 N-22289 1 2 P-90366 1 80-30-17 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT’D) Electrical System (Cont'd) Figure 80-30-22 If there is voltage at the wiring harness, check the potentiometer [Figure 80-30-22] for resistance. The resistance should be 10K Ohm between wire pin A and wire pin C frame [Figure 80-30-22]. If no resistance is found replace the potentiometer. Figure 80-30-23 To check the resistance of the white wire, turn the potentiometer control (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-23] counterclockwise to the full A/C position. Figure 80-30-24 The resistance between the wire terminal A and wire terminal B frame [Figure 80-30-24] should be around 0 K Ohm. Check the resistance between the wire terminal C and wire terminal B frame [Figure 80-30-24] should be around 10 K Ohm. N-22290 A B C P-90368 1 N-22290 A B C 80-30-18 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT’D) Electrical System (Cont'd) Figure 80-30-25 To check the resistance of the white wire, turn the potentiometer control (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-25] clockwise to the full Heater position. Figure 80-30-26 Check the resistance between the wire terminal A and wire terminal B frame [Figure 80-30-26] should be around 10 K Ohm. Check the resistance between the wire terminal C and wire terminal B frame [Figure 80-30-26] should be around 0 K Ohm. If the resistance is not found replace the potentiometer. Engine Coolant Bypassing The Heater Valve Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Figure 80-30-27 Push the A/C switch (Item 1) to the OFF position, turn the blower switch (Item 2) to position 1, then turn the temperature control (Item 3) [Figure 80-30-27] counterclockwise to the full A/C position, with the loader ignition switch OFF. Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the remote start tool to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60- 1.) Start the loader and run at high idle, for ten minutes. Figure 80-30-28 Check the heater hose (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-28] for temperature. If the hose is hot, the heater valve is leaking by, and needs to be replace. P-90369 1 N-22290 A B C P-90364A 3 1 2 P-90371 1 80-30-19 S650 Service Manual TROUBLESHOOTING (CONT'D) Heater Valve Not Opening Or Closing Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Figure 80-30-29 Push the A/C switch (Item 1) to the OFF position, turn the blower switch (Item 2) to position 1 and turn the temperature control (Item 3) [Figure 80-30-29] to the High A/C position, with the loader ignition switch OFF. Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the remote start tool to the loader. (See REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 on Page 10-60- 1.) Figure 80-30-30 NOTE: The HVAC assembly is removed for photo clarity. Place the remote start tool on the left fender of the loader, so the heater valve can be clearly seen. Watch the valve shaft (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-30], as the key of the remote start is turned to the ON position without starting the loader. The heater valve should rotate. Place a mark on the loader shaft. Turn the remote start key to the OFF position and remove the remote start tool from fender. Lower operator cab. Turn the temperature control (Item 3) [Figure 80-30-29] to the High Heater position, with the loader ignition switch OFF. Raise the operator cab. Place the remote start tool on the left fender of the loader, so the heater valve can be clearly seen. Watch the valve shaft (Item 1) [Figure 80-30-30], as the key of the remote start is turned to the ON position without starting the loader. The heater valve should rotate. If it does not rotate, check the potentiometer for proper function. (See Electrical System on Page 80-30-12.) Replace the heater valve. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-140-1.) P-90364A 2 1 3 P-90370 1 80-30-20 S650 Service Manual 80-40-1 S650 Service Manual SYSTEM CHARGING AND RECLAMATION Refrigerant Identification WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-40-1 NOTE: It is recommended to identify the type of refrigerant that is in the A/C system and if it is pure enough to use. The tool MEL1592, Refrigerant Identifier (Item 1) [Figure 80-40-1] will determine, the kind of refrigerant and any possible harmful or dangerous substances that may be present in the system. Thus preventing mixing of dangerous material with your reclaimed R-134a in your reclaimer, and further contamination to other A/C systems that are reclaimed and charged from your MEL1581 Recovery/Recycling/Recharging Machine. NOTE: This test is run with the loader engine OFF, and the A/C switch in the OFF position. Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Connect the Refrigerant Identifier to the low pressure hose. Connect the Refrigerant Identifier to its power source. Follow the steps displayed on the refrigerant identifier screen. Allow two minutes for the refrigerant identifier to display the type of refrigerant and air content. An alarm will sound if potentially flammable hydrocarbons are present and will also indicate on the visual display. Disconnect the refrigerant identifier from the loader A/C. If the refrigerant is dangerous or flammable, it must be evacuated from the A/C system into a separate container and properly and safely disposed of. If R134a is found, evacuate the system. N-23024 1 80-40-2 S650 Service Manual SYSTEM CHARGING AND RECLAMATION (CONT'D) Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Figure 80-40-2 Locate the low pressure port (Item 1), and high pressure port (Item 2) [Figure 80-40-2]. WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-40-3 IMPORTANT: Only trained technicians should perform the reclaiming and recharging. WARNING HFC 134A refrigerant can be dangerous if not properly handled. Liquid 134A may cause blindness if it contacts the eyes and may cause serious frostbite if it contacts the skin. • Gaseous 134A becomes lethal (phosgene) gas when it contacts open flame or very hot substances. • NEVER SMOKE when there is the possibility of even small amounts of 134A in the air. Any servicing work that involves release or addition of 134A to the system must be done by a competent refrigeration dealer who has the proper equipment, knowledge, and experience to service refrigeration equipment. W-2373-0500 Use an approved recovery / charging unit [Figure 80-40- 3] to evacuate the system. P-90372 1 2 N-22291 80-40-3 S650 Service Manual SYSTEM CHARGING AND RECLAMATION (CONT'D) Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit (Cont'd) Figure 80-40-4 Figure 80-40-5 Connect the reclaimer to the loader A/C charge ports (Item 1) [Figure 80-40-4]. Connect the Blue hose (Item 2) [Figure 80-40-5] to the low pressure port and open the valve. Connect the Red hose (Item 3) [Figure 80-40-5] to the high pressure port and open the valve. Figure 80-40-6 Turn the reclaimer unit [Figure 80-40-6] to the ON position and follow the on screen instructions. NOTE: The A/C system holds 0,68 kg (1.5 lb) of refrigerant. Figure 80-40-7 NOTE: The reclaimer unit, has a complete step by step set of instructions [Figure 80-40-7] to follow for reclamation and recharging of the A/C system. A trained technician should follow these instructions as they may vary slightly depending on the model and brand of reclaimer used. P-90374 1 P-90373 2 3 N-22292 N-22381 80-40-4 S650 Service Manual 80-50-1 S650 Service Manual COMPRESSOR Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Evacuate the A/C system. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40- 2.) Open the rear door. Figure 80-50-1 Disconnect the loader harness (Item 1) [Figure 80-50-1] from the compressor clutch wire. Figure 80-50-2 Remove the compressor mount bolt (Item 1) and the belt (Item 2) [Figure 80-50-2]. Installation: Tighten the compressor mount bolt to 46 N•m (34 ft-lb) torque. WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-50-3 Remove the compressor hoses (Item 1) [Figure 80-50-3] from the compressor. Installation: Tighten the compressor hoses to 29,8 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. Cap and plug the compressor hoses and the fittings with with the proper A/C caps and plugs. Figure 80-50-4 Remove the compressor mount bolts and nuts (Item 1) [Figure 80-50-4]. Remove the compressor from the loader. P-90357 1 P-89538 1 2 P-89543 1 P-89534 1 1 80-50-2 S650 Service Manual COMPRESSOR (CONT'D) Oil Figure 80-50-5 The compressor (Item 1) [Figure 80-50-5] is factory filled with 150 - 170 cc's of PAG 100 oil (Poly Alkelene Glycol). Unlike engine oil, it is not necessary to frequently check or change the compressor oil. It is necessary to check, replenish or replace the compressor oil in the following cases: • When ever the evaporator, condenser or receiver- drier is replaced. • Whenever the refrigerant has leaked from the system. When one of the components (the evaporator, condenser or receiver-drier) is replaced, one ounce of oil should be added for each component replaced. If the A/C compressor is changed, no oil should be added to the system, because the compressor comes factory filled with oil. NOTE: Only PAG 100 oil should be used, and never mix R-12 and R-134a Oils. The compressor oil should be checked as follows when oil is being added to an in service loader. There is a close affinity between oil and refrigerant. During normal operation, part of the oil circulates with the refrigerant in the system. Therefore, when checking the amount of oil in the system or replacing any system component, the compressor must be run in advance to ensure return of oil to the compressor. If the amount of refrigerant in the system has decreased, charge the system. (See SYSTEM CHARGING AND RECLAMATION on Page 80-40-1.) Open the cab door and windows. Run the blower at maximum speed. Run the compressor for at least 20 minutes at 800 - 1200 RPM. Remove the compressor from the loader. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-50-1.) P-90486 1 80-50-3 S650 Service Manual COMPRESSOR (CONT'D) Oil Check Figure 80-50-6 Figure 80-50-7 Remove the oil drain plug (Item 1) [Figure 80-50-6] and drain the oil through the connectors and the oil drain hole [Figure 80-50-7]. Installation: Tighten the oil drain plug to 13 - 15 N•m (9.4 - 10.8 ft-lb) torque. Figure 80-50-8 NOTE: After draining the oil through the drain hole and the connectors, extract the remaining oil through the discharge-side connector by rotating the drive pulley (Item 1) [Figure 80-50- 8] several times by hand. Measure the drained oil in a measuring cylinder. Check the oil for contamination, dirt, metal shavings, or varnish color, discard the oil if contaminated. NOTE: If metal shavings are found in the compressor oil, replace the complete compressor assembly. Figure 80-50-9 Add new compressor oil through the suction side connector (Item 1) [Figure 80-50-9]. Installation: Add 150 - 170 cc's of PAG 100 oil. NOTE: The suction port on the compressor is marked with an SUC and is the larger port on the compressor. P-90487 1 P-16534A P-90486 1 P-90487 1 80-50-4 S650 Service Manual 80-60-1 S650 Service Manual CONDENSER Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Remove the rear grille. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-60-1.) Remove the refrigerant from the A/C system. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40-2.) Figure 80-60-1 Remove the two brackets (Item 1) [Figure 80-60-1]. WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-60-2 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 80-60-2] that routes from the condenser to the receiver / dryer. Cap and plug the hose and the condenser fittings with the proper A/C caps and plugs. Figure 80-60-3 Disconnect the hose (Item 1) [Figure 80-60-3] that routes from the condenser to the compressor. Cap and plug the hose and the condenser fittings with the proper A/C caps and plugs. Remove the condenser. P-85824 11 P-89546 1 P-89548 1 80-60-2 S650 Service Manual 80-70-1 S650 Service Manual RECEIVER / DRIER Receiver / Drier Removal And Installation WARNING Never work on a machine with the lift arms up unless the lift arms are secured by an approved lift arm support device. Failure to use an approved lift arm support device can allow the lift arms or attachment to fall and cause injury or death. W-2059-0598 Remove the rear grille. (See Removal And Installation on Page 50-60-1.) Remove the refrigerant from the A/C system. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40-2.) WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-70-1 NOTE: Mark the A/C hoses (Item 1) [Figure 80-70-1] for proper installation. Remove the two A/C hoses (Item 1) [Figure 80-70-1] from the receiver / drier. Both fittings on the drier are the same size, so the hoses can be hooked up incorrectly. Cap and plug the hoses and the receiver / drier fittings with the proper A/C caps and plugs. NOTE: When replacing a receiver / drier in an A/C system 30 in 3 (1 fl oz) of PAG 100 oil must be added to the system when recharging. Figure 80-70-2 Note the flow direction on the receiver / drier (Item 1) [Figure 80-70-2] for proper installation. P-90488 1 1 P-90493 1 80-70-2 S650 Service Manual RECEIVER / DRIER (CONT’D) Receiver / Drier Removal And Installation (Cont’d) Figure 80-70-3 Loosen the two clamps (Item 1) and remove the receiver / drier (Item 2) [Figure 80-70-3]. Figure 80-70-4 Remove the two mount bolts (Item 1) [Figure 80-70-4] from the receiver / drier mount bracket. Pressure Relief Valve Removal And Installation Figure 80-70-5 The pressure relief valve (Item 1) [Figure 80-70-5] is located on the receiver / drier. Figure 80-70-6 The pressure relief valve [Figure 80-70-6] is designed to open and release the A/C charge if the pressure reaches 3,7 MPa (36,9 bar) (535 psi). This will cause the A/C system to shut down, saving the compressor. The pressure relief valve is a secondary protection device in the A/C system, with the pressure switch shutting down the system at 2,6 MPa (26,5 bar) (384 psi). NOTE: If a pressure relief valve is found open, check the A/C system for problems. Replace the complete receiver / drier unit. P-92665 1 2 P-89521 1 N-22205 1 N-22206 80-70-3 S650 Service Manual RECEIVER / DRIER (CONT’D) Pressure Switch Removal And Installation Figure 80-70-7 Disconnect the loader wire harness (Item 1) [Figure 80- 70-7] from the pressure switch wire harness. NOTE: The pressure switch can be changed without evacuating the A/C system. WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-70-8 Remove the pressure switch (Item 1) [Figure 80-70-8] from the A/C high pressure hose. Remove the pressure switch from the loader. P-90361 1 P-90488 1 80-70-4 S650 Service Manual RECEIVER / DRIER (CONT’D) Schraeder Valve Removal And Installation Figure 80-70-9 The schraeder valve (Item 1) [Figure 80-70-9] is located in the A/C high pressure hose and is located under the pressure switch. Remove the refrigerant from the A/C system. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40-2.) Remove the pressure switch. With a schraeder valve removal tool, remove the valve from the hose. N-22166 1 80-80-1 S650 Service Manual EVAPORATOR / HEATER UNIT Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Evacuate the A/C system. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40- 2.) Figure 80-80-1 Disconnect the expansion / heater unit wiring (Item 1) [Figure 80-80-1]. Figure 80-80-2 NOTE: Cap the heater hoses and the heater valve with plugs to prevent coolant loss from the system. Remove the two hoses (Item 1) [Figure 80-80-2]. Figure 80-80-3 NOTE: Support the evaporator / heater unit before removing the mounting hardware. Remove the two bolts (Item 1) [Figure 80-80-3]. Remove the two nuts (Item 2) [Figure 80-80-3]. Figure 80-80-4 Disconnect the two A/C hoses (Item 1) [Figure 80-80-4]. Cap and plug the hoses and the expansion valve fittings with the proper A/C caps and plugs. Installation: Tighten the A/C hoses to 29,8 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. Remove the two bolts (Item 2) [Figure 80-80-4]. Remove the two nuts (Item 3) [Figure 80-80-4]. Remove evaporator / heater unit from the loader. P-90363 1 1 P-90423 1 P-90421 1 2 2 P-90422 3 3 2 1 80-80-2 S650 Service Manual 80-90-1 S650 Service Manual THERMOSTAT Description The Electronic De-icing Thermostat (EDT) is a micro controller based module that measures evaporator coil temperature and cycles the compressor clutch to maintain a constant evaporator pressure. Onboard circuit protection and diagnostics are also built into the module. NOTE: The EDT has a six second delay before start up to protect the compressor clutch. The EDT will turn the clutch on when the evaporator coil temperature is above 2°C (35.6°F). If the EDT does not detect any malfunction, it will continue to operate and the status LED will be lit continuously. When the evaporator temperature is below -2°C (28.4°F), the EDT will turn off the clutch and status LED. Figure 80-90-1 When the EDT detects an open or short from the temperature sensor, the status LED (Item 1) [Figure 80- 90-1] will blink once per second and the output signal to the clutch will be turned off. The status LED will flash two times per second when EDT detects an open circuit (current draw less than 200 mA), short circuit or over current (current draw greater than 7A) from the clutch output. The status LED will flash three times per second when the compressor clutch is shorted to ground. NOTE: The EDT will attempt to restart every 20 seconds until the fault is repaired. The EDT has the following protection built in: 1. Over temperature 2. Over current from clutch output 3. Voltage (Above and below operational limits or reverse voltage) 4. Short circuit protection (Output shorted to ground) 5. Temperature sensor open and short detection P-90576 1 MALFUNCTION DETECTION INTERVAL STATUS LED Temperature sensor Continuous 1x per second Temperature sensor open and short detection At A/C start up 2x per second Compressor clutch short to battery Continuous 3x per second 80-90-2 S650 Service Manual THERMOSTAT (CONT’D) Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) NOTE: The thermostat can be changed without evacuating the A/C system, or removing the evaporator / heater unit from the loader. NOTE: The evaporator / heater unit is shown removed for photo clarity. Figure 80-90-2 Remove the nine screws (Item 1) and cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-90-2]. Figure 80-90-3 Remove the three screws (Item 1) and left cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-90-3]. Figure 80-90-4 Remove the thermostat probe (Item 1) [Figure 80-90-4] from the A/C evaporator coil. Figure 80-90-5 Remove the thermostat (Item 1) from the evaporator / heater unit [Figure 80-90-5]. P-92606 1 2 P-92603 1 2 P-92613 1 P-92609 1 80-100-1 S650 Service Manual EXPANSION VALVE Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Evacuate the A/C system. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40- 2.) WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-100-1 Remove the two A/C hoses (Item 1) [Figure 80-100-1] from the expansion valve. Installation: Tighten the two A/C hose fittings to 29,8 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. Cap and plug the hoses and the expansion valve fittings with the proper A/C caps and plugs. Figure 80-100-2 NOTE: The evaporator / heater unit is removed for photo clarity. Remove the four screws (Item 1) and the cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-100-2]. Figure 80-100-3 Remove the five screws (Item 1) and the cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-100-3]. P-92659 1 P-90416 2 1 1 1 1 P-90417 2 1 1 1 1 80-100-2 S650 Service Manual EXPANSION VALVE (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 80-100-4 Remove the two evaporator fittings (Item 1) [Figure 80- 100-4] from the expansion valve. Installation: Tighten the two evaporator fittings to 29,8 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. Remove the two mount bolts (Item 2) [Figure 80-100-4]. Remove the expansion valve from the loader. Cap and plug the evaporator tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 80-100-4] and the expansion valve fittings with the proper A/C caps and plugs. Figure 80-100-5 The expansion valve [Figure 80-100-5] is replaced as a complete unit. P-90418 2 1 N-22085 80-110-1 S650 Service Manual EVAPORATOR COIL Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) Evacuate the A/C system. (See Reclamation And Charging With Recovery / Charging Unit on Page 80-40- 2.) NOTE: The evaporator / heater unit is removed for photo clarity. WARNING In the event of a leak, wear safety goggles. Escaping refrigerant can cause severe injuries to eyes. In contact with a flame, R134a refrigerant gives a toxic gas. W-2371-0500 Figure 80-110-1 NOTE: The evaporator / heater unit is removed for photo clarity. Remove the four screws (Item 1) and the cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-110-1]. Figure 80-110-2 Remove the five screws (Item 1) and the cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-110-2]. Figure 80-110-3 Disconnect the two evaporator fittings (Item 1) [Figure 80-110-3] from the expansion valve. Installation: Tighten the two evaporator fittings to 29,8 N•m (22 ft-lb) torque. Cap and plug the evaporator tubelines (Item 1) [Figure 80-110-3] and the expansion valve fittings with the proper A/C caps and plugs. P-90416 2 1 1 1 1 P-90417 2 1 1 1 1 P-90418 1 80-110-2 S650 Service Manual EVAPORATOR COIL (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 80-110-4 Remove the thermostat probe (Item 1) [Figure 80-110-4] from the evaporator coil. Remove the two retaining clips (Item 2) [Figure 80-110- 4] that connect the evaporator coil, to the heater coil. Remove the evaporator coil (Item 3) [Figure 80-110-4]. Figure 80-110-5 Inspect the evaporator coil [Figure 80-110-5] for leaks, and replace as needed. Clean with low pressure water or air. P-90420A 1 2 2 3 P-90424 80-120-1 S650 Service Manual HEATER COIL Removal And Installation Remove the evaporator coil (If equipped with A/C). (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-110-1.) Remove the heater valve. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-140-1.) NOTE: The evaporator / heater unit is removed for photo clarity. Figure 80-120-1 Remove the nine screws (Item 1) and the cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-120-1]. Figure 80-120-2 Remove the three screws (Item 1) and cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-120-2]. Remove the two screws (Item 3) [Figure 80-120-2]. Figure 80-120-3 Remove the three screws (Item 1) and cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-120-3]. Remove the tie strap and move the wire harness (Item 3) [Figure 80-120-3] off to the side. Figure 80-120-4 Remove the five screws (Item 1) and cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-120-4]. P-90419A 1 2 P-90439 3 1 2 P-90440 1 3 2 P-90445 1 1 1 1 2 80-120-2 S650 Service Manual HEATER COIL (CONT'D) Removal And Installation (Cont'd) Figure 80-120-5 Remove the bolt, spacer, and nut (Item 1) [Figure 80- 120-5]. Remove the heater coil from the unit. Figure 80-120-6 The heater coil [Figure 80-120-6] can be cleaned with low pressure air or water. P-90441 1 P-90443 80-130-1 S650 Service Manual BLOWER FAN Removal And Installation Remove the evaporator / heater unit. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-120-1.) Remove the heater coil. (See Removal And Installation on Page 80-120-1.) Figure 80-130-1 Remove the two screws (Item 1) [Figure 80-130-1]. Remove the blower fan (Item 2) [Figure 80-130-1] from the evaporator / heater unit. Disassembly And Assembly Figure 80-130-2 Remove the eight screws (Item 1) [Figure 80-130-2] from the blower wheel cover. Remove the two screws (Item 2) [Figure 80-130-2] from the resistor. Figure 80-130-3 Remove the outside rings (Item 1) and the blower wheel cover (Item 2) [Figure 80-130-3]. Repeat for other side. Inspect the outside rings and blower wheel covers for wear and replace as needed [Figure 80-130-3]. P-90457 1 1 2 P-90458 1 2 2 1 P-90465 2 1 80-130-2 S650 Service Manual BLOWER FAN (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 80-130-4 NOTE: Mark the wires for proper installation. Remove the two wires (Item 1) [Figure 80-130-4] from the blower motor. Figure 80-130-5 Remove the screw (Item 1) [Figure 80-130-5] from the bottom side of the blower motor. Remove the blower motor from the blower housing. Figure 80-130-6 Check the blower housing and blower motor mount for wear and replace as needed [Figure 80-130-6]. Figure 80-130-7 Remove the blower wheel outside clamp (Item 1) [Figure 80-130-7] from the blower wheel. P-90459 1 1 P-90460 1 P-90463 P-90461 1 80-130-3 S650 Service Manual BLOWER FAN (CONT'D) Disassembly And Assembly (Cont'd) Figure 80-130-8 Remove the blower wheel (Item 1), inside clamp (Item 2), inside ring (Item 3), and spacers (Item 4) [Figure 80-130- 8] from the blower motor shaft and inspect for wear. NOTE: The number and size of spacers (Item 4) [Figure 80-130-8] may vary. Repeat the procedure for the other blower wheel. P-90462 1 3 2 4 80-130-4 S650 Service Manual 80-140-1 S650 Service Manual HEATER VALVE Removal And Installation Raise the lift arms and install an approved lift arm support device. (See Installing on Page 10-20-1.) Raise the operator cab. (See Raising on Page 10-30-2.) NOTE: The heater valve is not serviceable and must be replaced as a complete assembly. Remove any tie-straps that hold the heater hoses. NOTE: The evaporator / heater unit is shown removed for photo clarity. Figure 80-140-1 NOTE: Cap the heater hoses and the heater valve with plugs to prevent coolant loss from the system. Remove the heater hose clamp (Item 1) [Figure 80-140- 1]. Remove the heater hose. Disconnect the loader wiring harness (Item 2) [Figure 80-140-1] from the heater valve. Remove the nut (Item 3) [Figure 80-140-1] from the heater valve mount. Figure 80-140-2 NOTE: Cap the heater hoses and the heater valve with plugs to prevent coolant loss from the system. Remove the heater hose clamp (Item 1) [Figure 80-140- 2]. Remove the heater hose from the heater valve. Remove the nut (Item 2) [Figure 80-140-2] from the heater valve mount. Remove heater hose clamp (Item 3) and the heater valve (Item 4) [Figure 80-140-2] from the evaporator / heater unit. P-90414 1 2 3 P-90415 3 1 2 4 80-140-2 S650 Service Manual SPEC-01 S650 Service Manual SPECIFICATIONS (S650) LOADER SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-1 Machine Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-1 Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-2 Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-2 Drive System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-2 Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-3 Hydraulic System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-3 Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-4 Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-4 Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-10-4 TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-20-1 Torque For General SAE Bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-20-1 Torque For General Metric Bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-20-2 HYDRAULIC CONNECTION SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-30-1 Straight Thread O-ring Fitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-30-1 Flare Fitting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-30-2 Tubelines And Hoses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-30-2 HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FLUID SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-40-1 Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-40-1 CONVERSIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-50-1 Decimal And Millimeter Equivalent Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-50-1 U.S. To Metric Conversion Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-50-1 SPEC-02 S650 Service Manual SPEC-10-1 S650 Service Manual (S650) LOADER SPECIFICATIONS Machine Dimensions • Dimensions are given for loader equipped with standard tires and 74 inch Construction & Industrial bucket and may vary with other bucket types. All dimensions are shown in millimeters. Respective imperial dimensions are given in inches enclosed by parentheses. • Where applicable, specifications conform to SAE or ISO standards and are subject to change without notice. Changes of structure or weight distribution of the loader can cause changes in control and steering response and can cause failure of the loader parts. NA-1660 (72.1 in) 1832 mm (59.3 in) 1507 mm (82.9 in) 2106 mm (74 in) 1880 mm (124 in) 3149 mm (96.3 in) 2447 mm 800 mm (31.5 in) 42° 97° 31.1° 25.2° (158.5 in) 4026 mm (81.3 in) 2065 mm (8.1 in) 207 mm (45.3 in) 1150 mm (108.4 in) 2753 mm (136.8 in) 3474 mm SPEC-10-2 S650 Service Manual (S650) LOADER SPECIFICATIONS (CONT’D) Performance Engine Drive System Rated Operating Capacity 1220 kg (2690 lb) with 200 Pound Frame Mounted Counterweight Kit 1288 kg (2840 lb) with 300 Pound Frame Mounted Counterweight Kit 1311 kg (2890 lb) Tipping Load 2440 kg (5380 lb) Operating Weight 3777 kg (8327 lb) Breakout Force - Lift 2177 kg (4800 lb) Breakout Force - Tilt 2313 kg (5100 lb) Push Force 2087 kg (4600 lb) Travel Speed - Single Speed Loader - Two-Speed Loader (Opt.) Low/High 0 - 11,4 km/h (0 - 7.1 mph) 0 - 11,4 km/h (0 - 7.1 mph) / 0 - 19,8 km/h (0 - 12.3 mph) Make / Model Kubota / V3307-DI-TE3 Interim Tier IV Fuel / Cooling Diesel / Liquid Horsepower - ISO 9249 EEC / SAE J1349 Net - ISO 14396 Gross - SAE 1995 Gross 52,4 kW (70.3 hp) @ 2400 rpm 54,6 kW (73.2 hp) @ 2400 rpm 55,4 kW (74.3 hp) @ 2400 rpm Torque - ISO 9249 EEC / SAE J1349 Net - SAE 1995 Gross 253,1 N•m (186.7 lb-ft) @ 1600 rpm 264,4 N•m (195.0 lb-ft) @ 1600 rpm Low Idle RPM 1250 - 1450 High Idle RPM 2525 - 2650 Number of Cylinders 4 Displacement 3,3 L (203 in 3 ) Bore / Stroke 94 / 120 mm (3.70 / 4.72 in) Lubrication Gear Pump Pressure System with Filter Crankcase Ventilation Closed Breathing Air Cleaner Dry replaceable paper cartridge with separate safety element Ignition Diesel - Compression Air Induction Turbo-Charged Engine Coolant Propylene Glycol / Water Mixture Starting Aid Glow Plugs - Automatically activated as needed in RUN position. Main Drive Fully hydrostatic, 4-wheel drive Transmission Infinitely variable tandem hydrostatic piston pumps, driving two fully reversing hydrostatic motors Final Drive Pre-stressed #120 HSOC endless roller chain (no master link) and sprockets in sealed chaincase with oil lubrication (Chains do not require periodic adjustments) Two chains per side with no idler sprocket Axle Size 68,6 mm (2.70 in), Heat treated Wheel Bolts Eight - 9/16 in Wheel bolts fixed to axle hubs SPEC-10-3 S650 Service Manual (S650) LOADER SPECIFICATIONS (CONT’D) Controls Hydraulic System Vehicle Steering Direction and speed controlled by two hand operated steering levers or optional joystick(s) Loader Hydraulics - Lift and Tilt - Front Auxiliary - Rear Auxiliary (Option) Controlled by separate foot pedals or optional Advanced Control System (ACS) or optional Selectable Joystick Controls (SJC) Controlled by electrical switch on Right Hand steering lever or joystick Controlled by electrical switch on Left Hand steering lever or joystick Auxiliary Pressure Release Pressure relieved through quick couplers; Push couplers in, hold for 5 seconds Engine Hand lever speed control, additional foot operated speed control pedal with SJC option, key-type start switch or optional keyless start panel or optional Deluxe Instrumentation Panel and function error shutdown. Starting Aid Glow plugs automatically activated as needed by Instrument Panel Service Brake Two independent hydrostatic systems controlled by two hand operated steering levers or optional joystick(s) Secondary Brake One of the hydrostatic transmissions Parking Brake (Standard) Mechanical disc, manually operated switch on left instrument panel Parking Brake (Two-Speed Option) Spring applied pressure release multi-disk brake activated by manually operated switch on left instrument panel Pump Type Engine driven, gear type Pump Capacity - Standard 87,1 L/min (23.0 U.S. gpm) Pump Capacity - High-Flow Option 115,5 L/min (30.5 U.S. gpm) System Relief at Quick Couplers 23,8 - 24,5 MPa (237,8 - 244,7 bar) (3450 - 3550 psi) Filter (Hydraulic / Hydrostatic) Replaceable beta 10 micron = 200, drop in element Filter (Charge) Replaceable beta 10 micron = 200, drop in element Hydraulic Cylinders Bore Diameter:Lift Cylinder (2) Tilt Cylinder (2) Rod Diameter:Lift Cylinder (2) Tilt Cylinder (2) Stroke:Lift Cylinder (2) Tilt Cylinder (2) Double-acting; tilt cylinders have cushioning feature on dump and rollback 63,5 mm (2.50 in) 76,2 mm (3.00 in) 44,5 mm (1.75 in) 41,4 mm (1.63 in) 860,3 mm (33.87 in) 354,8 mm (13.97 in) Control Valve - Standard 3-Spool, open center, manually operated with spring detent for lift float and electrically controlled auxiliary spool Control Valve - ACS and SJC 3-Spool, open center with electric actuator controlled lift with float and tilt. Electrically controlled auxiliary spool Fluid Lines SAE Standard tubelines, hoses and fittings Fluid Type BOBCAT FLUID, Hydraulic / Hydrostatic 6903117 - (Two - 2.5 U.S. gal) 6903118 - (5 U.S. gal) 6903119 - (55 U.S. gal) Hydraulic Function Time: Raise Lift Arms Lower Lift Arms Bucket Dump Bucket Rollback 3.4 Seconds 3.0 Seconds 2.3 Seconds 1.7 Seconds SPEC-10-4 S650 Service Manual (S650) LOADER SPECIFICATIONS (CONT’D) Electrical System Capacities Tires Alternator Belt driven, 90 amps, open frame Battery 12 volts, 950 cold cranking amps @ -18°C (0°F), 180 Minute reserve capacity @ 25 amps Starter 12 volts, gear type, 3,0 kW (4.02 hp) Instrumentation Gauges: Engine Coolant Temperature, Fuel Level. Warning lights: Fuel Level, Seat Belt, Engine Coolant Temperature, Engine Malfunction, Hydraulic System Malfunction, General Warning. Indicators: BICS Functions, Two-Speed, 3-Point Shoulder Belt, Turn Signals, Engine Preheat. Data Display: Operating Hours, Engine rpm, Speed Management Setting, Maintenance Clock Countdown, Battery Voltage, Service Codes, Engine Preheat Countdown, Steering Drift Compensation Setting, Drive Response Setting. Other: Audible Alarm, Lights, Option / Accessory Switches. Optional Deluxe Instrumentation Panel: *Additional displays for: Engine rpm, Coolant Temperature and Oil Pressure; System Voltage, Hydrostatic Charge Pressure and Hydraulic Oil Temperature. *Additional Features Included: Keyless Start, Digital Clock, Job Clock, Attachment Control Information, Password Lockout, Multi-language Display, Help Screens, Diagnostic Capability and Engine / Hydraulic Systems Shutdown Function. Fuel 103,1 L (27.2 U.S. gal) Engine Oil with Filter Change 11,4 L (12.0 qt.) Engine Cooling System with Heater without Heater 11,4 L (3.0 U.S. gal) 11,7 L (3.1 U.S. gal) Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Reservoir 10,2 L (2.7 U.S. gal) Hydraulic / Hydrostatic System 45,0 L (11.9 U.S. gal) Chaincase Reservoir 39,2 L (10.35 U.S. gal) Heavy Duty (Standard) 12.00 x 16.5, 12 Ply Rating Heavy Duty Offset (Option) 12.00 x 16.5, 12 Ply Rating Heavy Duty Poly Fill (Option) 12.00 x 16.5, 12 Ply Rating Severe Duty (Option) 12.00 x 16.5, 12 Ply Rating Severe Duty Poly Fill (Option) 12.00 x 16.5, 12 Ply Rating Solidflex (Option) 33 x 6 x 11 Super Float Offset (Option) 33 x 15.50 - 16.5, 12 Ply Rating Recommended Pressure Inflate tires to MAXIMUM pressure shown on the side wall of the tire. DO NOT mix brands of tires used on the same loader. SPEC-20-1 S650 Service Manual TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS Torque For General SAE Bolts The following table shows standard torque specifications for bolts with zinc phosphate coating. Bolts purchased from Bobcat that have zinc phosphate coating are specified by the letter H following the part number. Thread size sae grade 5 sae grade 8 N•m (in-lb) 0.250 9,0 - 10,2 (80 - 90) 12,4 - 13,6 (110 - 120) 0.3125 20,3 - 22,6 (180 - 200) 24,2 - 27,1 (215 - 240) N•m (ft-lb) 0.375 34 - 38 (25 - 28) 47 - 54 (35 - 40) 0.4375 54 - 61 (40 - 45) 81 - 88 (60 - 65) 0.500 88 - 95 (65 - 70) 122 - 136 (90 - 100) 0.5625 122 - 136 (90 - 100) 170 - 190 (125 - 140) 0.625 170 - 190 (125 - 140) 240 - 260 (175 - 190) 0.750 300 - 330 (220 - 245) 410 - 450 (300 - 330) 0.875 450 - 490 (330 - 360) 645 - 710 (475 - 525) 1.000 645 - 710 (475 - 525) 985 - 1085 (725 - 800) 1.125 880 - 975 (650 - 720) 1425 - 1600 (1050 - 1175) 1.250 1200 - 1360 (900 - 1000) 2000 - 2200 (1475 - 1625) 1.375 1630 - 1830 (1200 - 1350) 2720 - 2980 (2000 - 2200) 1.500 2040 - 2240 (1500 - 1650) 3530 - 3870 (2600 - 2850) 1.625 2720 - 2980 (2000 - 2800) 4680 - 5150 (3450 - 3800) 1.750 3390 - 3730 (2500 - 2750) 5830 - 6500 (4300 - 4800) 1.875 4270 - 4750 (3150 - 3500) 7450 - 8300 (5500 - 6100) 2.000 5150 - 5700 (3800 - 4200) 8800 - 9800 (6500 - 7200) SPEC-20-2 S650 Service Manual TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS (CONT'D) Torque For General Metric Bolts THREAD SIZE (DIA. X PITCH) MATERIAL HEAD MARK 4 HEAD MARK 7 HEAD MARK 10 M 5 x 0.8 4 - 5 N•m (3 - 4 ft-lb) M 6 x 1.0 8 - 9 N•m (6 - 7 ft-lb) 8 - 12 N•m (6 - 9 ft-lb) M 8 x 1.25 8 - 12 N•m (6 - 9 ft-lb) 15 - 22 N•m (11 - 16 ft-lb) 24 - 34 N•m (18 - 25 ft-lb) M 10 x 1.25 18 - 24 N•m (13 - 18 f.-lb) 30 - 41 N•m (22 - 30 ft-lb) 49 - 68 N•m (36 - 50 ft-lb) M 12 x 1.25 30 - 41 N•m (22 - 30 ft-lb) 54 - 73 N•m (40 - 54 ft-lb. 94 - 118 N•m (69 - 87 ft-lb) M 14 x 1.25 49 - 68 N•m (36 - 50 ft-lb) 79 - 108 N•m (58 - 80 ft-lb) 157 - 186 N•m (116 - 137 ft-lb) SPEC-30-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONNECTION SPECIFICATIONS Straight Thread O-ring Fitting Figure SPEC-30-1 Lubricate the O-ring before installing the fitting. Loosen the jam nut and install the fitting. Tighten the jam nut until the washer is tight against the surface [Figure SPEC-30- 1]. Figure SPEC-30-2 O-ring Boss Tightening Torque x x Thread Size TORQUE N•m (ft-lb) 7/16” - 20 18 (13) 9/16” - 18 30 (22) 3/4” -1 6 54 (40) 7/8” - 14 81 (60) 1-1/16” - 12 114 (84) 1-3/16” - 12 133 (98) 1-5/16” - 12 160 (118) 1-7/16” - 12 209 (154) 1-5/8” - 12 221 (163) A-1852 Nut Washer O-ring Nut Washer O-ring SPEC-30-2 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC CONNECTION SPECIFICATIONS (CONT’D) Flare Fitting Figure SPEC-30-3 Use the following procedure to tighten the flare fitting: Tighten the nut until it makes contact with the seat. Use the chart [Figure SPEC-30-4] to find the correct tightness needed. If the fitting leaks after tightening, disconnect it and inspect the seat area for damage. Figure SPEC-30-4 Tubelines And Hoses Replace any tubelines that are bent or flattened. They will restrict flow and cause heat. Replace hoses which show signs of wear, damage or weather cracked rubber. Always use two wrenches when loosening and tightening hose or tubeline fittings. Flare Fitting Tightening Torque Tubeline Outside Diameter x x Thread Size TORQUE N•m (ft.-lb.) 1/4” 7/16” - 20 18 (13) 5/16” 1/2” - 20 23 (17) 3/8” 9/16” - 18 30 (22) 1/2” 3/4” - 16 54 (40) 5/8” 7/8” - 14 81 (60) 3/4” 1-1/16” - 12 114 (84) 7/8” 1-3/16” - 12 133 (98) 1” 1-5/16” - 12 160 (118) 1-1/4” 1-5/8” - 12 209 (154) 1-1/2” 1-7/8” - 12 221 (163) 2” 2-1/2” - 12 342 (252) P-85926 SPEC-40-1 S650 Service Manual HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FLUID SPECIFICATIONS Specifications HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FLUID RECOMMENDED ISO VISCOSITY GRADE (VG) AND VISCOSITY INDEX (VI) TEMPERATURE RANGE ANTICIPATED DURING MACHINE USE [1] VG 100; Minimum VI 130 [2] VG 46; Minimum VI 150 [3] BOBCAT All-Season Fluid [4] BOBCAT Synthetic Fluid [5] BOBCAT Biodegradable Hydraulic / Hydrostatic Fluid (Unlike biodegradable fluids that are vegetable based, Bobcat biodegradable fluid is formulated to prevent oxidation and thermal breakdown at operating temperatures.) DO NOT use automatic transmission fluids in the loader or permanent damage to the transmission will result. WARNING AVOID INJURY OR DEATH Diesel fuel or hydraulic fluid under pressure can penetrate skin or eyes, causing serious injury or death. Fluid leaks under pressure may not be visible. Use a piece of cardboard or wood to find leaks. Do not use your bare hand. Wear safety goggles. If fluid enters skin or eyes, get immediate medical attention from a physician familiar with this injury. W-2072-0807 When temperatures below -18°C (0°F) are common, the loader must be kept in a warm building. Extra warm-up time must be used each time the loader is started during cold temperature conditions. Cold fluid will not flow easily and it makes action of the hydraulic function slower. Loss of fluid flow to the hydrostatic transmission pump (indicated by TRANS light ON) can cause transmission damage in less than 60 seconds. WARNING During cold weather (32°F [0°C] and below), do not operate machine until the engine has run for at least five minutes at less than half throttle. This warm-up period is necessary for foot pedal operation and safe stopping. Do not operate controls during warm-up period. When temperatures are below -20°F (-30°C), the hydrostatic oil must be heated or kept warm. The hydrostatic system will not get enough oil at low temperatures. Park the machine in an area where the temperature will be above 0°F (-18°C) if possible. W-2027-1285 SPEC-40-2 S650 Service Manual SPEC-50-1 S650 Service Manual CONVERSIONS Decimal And Millimeter Equivalent Chart U.S. To Metric Conversion Chart SPEC-50-2 S650 Service Manual INDEX-01 S650 Service Manual ALPHABETICAL INDEX (S650) LOADER SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SPEC-10-1 ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) (SJC) . . .50-121-1 ACCESS PANEL (INSIDE) . . . . . . . . .50-120-1 AIR CLEANER SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . .10-80-1 AIR CLEANER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-40-1 AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM FLOW .80-10-1 ALTERNATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-30-1 ARMREST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-150-1 BACK-UP ALARM SYSTEM . . . . . . .60-210-1 BATTERY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-20-1 BLOWER FAN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-130-1 BOBCAT CONTROLLER (ACS) . . . . .60-71-1 BOBCAT CONTROLLER (SJC) (DRIVE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-72-1 BOBCAT CONTROLLERS (GATEWAY AND AUXILIARY) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-70-1 BOBCAT INTERLOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (BICS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-100-1 BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) . . . . . . . .10-140-1 BOB-TACH (HAND LEVER) . . . . . . . . .50-40-1 BOB-TACH (POWER) BLOCK . . . . . .20-120-1 BOB-TACH (POWER) . . . . . . . . . . . .10-141-1 BOB-TACH (POWER) . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-41-1 BRAKE (SINGLE SPEED) . . . . . . . . . .40-10-1 BRAKE (TWO-SPEED) . . . . . . . . . . . . 40-11-1 BUCKET POSITION VALVE . . . . . . .20-100-1 CAB DOOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-140-1 CALIBRATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-160-1 CAMSHAFT AND TIMING GEARS . .70-100-1 CHAINCASE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .40-30-1 CHARGE PRESSURE . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-40-1 COMPRESSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-50-1 CONDENSER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-60-1 CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (ACS) . 50-111-1 CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER (SJC) . 50-112-1 CONTROL HANDLE / LEVER . . . . . . 50-110-1 CONTROL PANEL (SJC) . . . . . . . . . .50-101-1 CONTROL PANEL SETUP . . . . . . . .60-180-1 CONTROL PANEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-100-1 CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-91-1 CONTROL PEDALS AND LINKAGES .50-90-1 CONTROL SYSTEM (ACS) . . . . . . . .60-130-1 CONVERSIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-50-1 CRANKSHAFT AND PISTONS . . . . . .70-90-1 CYLINDER (BOB-TACH) . . . . . . . . . . .20-22-1 CYLINDER (LIFT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-20-1 CYLINDER (TILT) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-21-1 CYLINDER HEAD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-80-1 DELIVERY REPORT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15 DIAGNOSTIC SERVICE CODES . . . . .60-90-1 DRAIN MANIFOLD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-80-1 DRIVE BELT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-60-1 DRIVE COMPONENTS . . . . . . . . . . . .40-20-1 ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (ACS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-141-1 ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-142-1 ELECTRICAL / HYDRAULIC CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-140-1 ELECTRICAL SYSTEM INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-10-1 EMERGENCY EXIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-210-1 ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM . . . . . . .10-90-1 ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM . . . . . . .70-50-1 ENGINE INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . .70-10-1 ENGINE LUBRICATION SYSTEM . . .10-110-1 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12469 AND BELOW & S/N A3NW11130 AND BELOW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-21-1 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL (SJC) S/N A3NV12470 AND ABOVE & S/N A3NW11131 AND ABOVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-22-1 ENGINE SPEED CONTROL . . . . . . . .70-20-1 EVAPORATOR / HEATER UNIT . . . . . .80-80-1 EVAPORATOR COIL . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-110-1 EXHAUST GAS RECIRCULATION (EGR) SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-130-1 EXPANSION VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-100-1 FINAL DRIVE TRANSMISSION (CHAINCASE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-130-1 FIRE PREVENTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12 FLYWHEEL AND HOUSING . . . . . . .70-120-1 FLYWHEEL RPM SENSOR . . . . . . . .60-170-1 FOREWORD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7 FRONT AUXILIARY HYDRAULIC COUPLER BLOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-130-1 INDEX-02 S650 Service Manual FRONT HORN . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-220-1 FUEL SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-100-1 FUEL SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .70-70-1 FUEL TANK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-80-1 HEADLINER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-180-1 HEATER COIL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-120-1 HEATER VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-140-1 HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FILTERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-70-1 HYDRAULIC / HYDROSTATIC FLUID SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-40-1 HYDRAULIC CONNECTION SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-30-1 HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (ACS) OR (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-41-1 HYDRAULIC CONTROL VALVE (STANDARD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-40-1 HYDRAULIC FLUID RESERVOIR . . . .20-80-1 HYDRAULIC PUMP (HIGH FLOW) . . .20-61-1 HYDRAULIC PUMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-60-1 HYDRAULIC SYSTEM INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-10-1 HYDRAULIC/HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-120-1 HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR (TWO- SPEED) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-21-1 HYDROSTATIC DRIVE MOTOR . . . . .30-20-1 HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-31-1 HYDROSTATIC MOTOR CARRIER . . .30-30-1 HYDROSTATIC PUMP (SJC) . . . . . . . .30-51-1 HYDROSTATIC PUMP . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-50-1 HYDROSTATIC SYSTEM INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .30-10-1 INSTRUMENT PANELS . . . . . . . . . . . .60-50-1 LEFT SIDE LOWER PANEL . . . . . . .50-160-1 LIFT ARM BYPASS CONTROL VALVE 20-50-1 LIFT ARM SUPPORT DEVICE . . . . . .10-20-1 LIFT ARMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-50-1 LIFTING AND BLOCKING THE LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-10-1 LIGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-60-1 LOADER IDENTIFICATION . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16 LOADER STORAGE AND RETURN TO SERVICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-190-1 LUBRICATING THE LOADER . . . . . .10-150-1 LUBRICATION SYSTEM . . . . . . . . . . .70-60-1 MAIN RELIEF VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-30-1 MAINTENANCE CLOCK . . . . . . . . . 60-200-1 MAINTENANCE SAFETY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1 MUFFLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-30-1 OIL COOLER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20-90-1 OPERATOR CAB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-30-1 OPERATOR CAB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-20-1 OPERATOR SEAT (SUSPENSION) . . 50-31-1 OPERATOR SEAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-30-1 PASSWORD SETUP (DELUXE INSTRUMENTATION PANEL) . . . . . 60-190-1 PASSWORD SETUP (KEYLESS START PANEL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-191-1 PIVOT PINS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-180-1 REAR AUXILIARY DIVERTER VALVE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .20-110-1 REAR DOOR (TAILGATE) . . . . . . . . . 50-70-1 REAR GRILLE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-60-1 RECEIVER / DRIER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-70-1 REGULAR MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . 80-20-1 REMOTE START TOOL (SERVICE TOOL) KIT - 7003031 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-61-1 REMOTE START TOOL KIT-MEL1563 10-60-1 RIGHT SIDE LOWER PANEL . . . . . 50-170-1 SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10 SEAT BAR SENSOR . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-110-1 SEAT BAR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50-10-1 SEAT BELT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-220-1 SERIAL NUMBER LOCATIONS . . . . . . . . 1-14 SERVICE MANUAL REVISION . . . . . . SMR-1 SERVICE PC (LAPTOP COMPUTER) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-150-1 SERVICE SCHEDULE . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-70-1 SPARK ARRESTOR MUFFLER . . . . 10-170-1 SPEED SENSORS (SJC) . . . . . . . . . . 60-80-1 STARTER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60-40-1 STEERING DRIFT COMPENSATION 60-161-1 STOPPING THE ENGINE AND LEAVING THE LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-200-1 SYSTEM CHARGING AND RECLAMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-40-1 THERMOSTAT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80-90-1 TIRE MAINTENANCE . . . . . . . . . . . 10-160-1 TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS FOR BOLTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .SPEC-20-1 TOWING THE LOADER . . . . . . . . . . . 10-50-1 INDEX-03 S650 Service Manual TRACTION LOCK . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60-120-1 TRANSPORTING LOADER ON A TRAILER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-40-1 TROUBLESHOOTING . . . . . . . . . . . . .80-30-1 TURBOCHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70-110-1 TWO-SPEED / BRAKE VALVE . . . . . .30-70-1 WINDOW (REAR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-130-1 WINDOW (SIDE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-132-1 WINDOW (TOP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .50-131-1 INDEX-04 S650 Service Manual SMR-1 S650 Service Manual SERVICE MANUAL REVISION Revision No: S650 - 1 Date: 15 July 2009 Product: Bobcat Loader Model: S650 Manual No: 6987168 (7-09) The following Sections are a revision to the above Service Manual. ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER X SALES MANAGER COVER 70-10 Insert This Sheet With The Below Listed Manual For Future Reference . NOTICE SMR-2 S650 Service Manual SMR-3 S650 Service Manual SERVICE MANUAL REVISION Revision No: S650 - 2 Date: 15 August 2009 Product: Bobcat Loader Model: S650 Manual No: 6987168 (8-09) S630 Service Manual (P/N 6987168) Dated 8-09 contains updated service information which replaces the previous S630 Service Manual (P/N 6987168) Dated 7-09. ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER X SALES MANAGER Insert This Sheet With The Below Listed Manual For Future Reference . NOTICE SMR-4 S650 Service Manual SMR-5 S650 Service Manual SERVICE MANUAL REVISION Revision No: S650 - 3 Date: 15 September 2009 Product: Bobcat Loader Model: S650 Manual No: 6987168 (9-09) The following Sections are a revision to the above Service Manual. ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER X SALES MANAGER COVER 20-10 20-20 30-10 Insert This Sheet With The Below Listed Manual For Future Reference . NOTICE SMR-6 S650 Service Manual SMR-7 S650 Service Manual SERVICE MANUAL REVISION Revision No: S650 - 4 Date: 15 October 2009 Product: Bobcat Loader Model: S650 Manual No: 6987168 (10-09) The following Sections are a revision to the above Service Manual. ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER X SALES MANAGER COVER 60-01 FORWARD 60-50 60-90 10-30 60-130 10-150 60-140 10-200 60-141 10-210 60-142 60-150 20-80 60-160 60-190 50-01 60-191 50-20 60-200 50-80 60-220 50-150 50-160 70-40 50-170 50-180 SPEC-10 ALPHABETICAL INDEX Insert This Sheet With The Below Listed Manual For Future Reference . NOTICE SMR-8 S650 Service Manual SMR-9 S650 Service Manual SERVICE MANUAL REVISION Revision No: S650 - 5 Date: 15 December 2009 Product: Bobcat Loader Model: S650 Manual No: 6987168 (12-09) The following Sections are a revision to the above Service Manual. ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER X SALES MANAGER COVER 10-100 20-120 30-20 30-21 50-70 50-91 50-120 60-50 60-60 60-130 70-20 70-21 ADDED 70-70 SPEC-10 SPEC-40 ALPHABETICAL INDEX Insert This Sheet With The Below Listed Manual For Future Reference . NOTICE SMR-10 S650 Service Manual SMR-11 S650 Service Manual SERVICE MANUAL REVISION Revision No: S650 - 6 Date: 15 June 2010 Product: Bobcat Loader Model: S650 Manual No: 6987168 (6-10) The following Sections are a revision to the above Service Manual. ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER X SALES MANAGER FRONT COVER 10-20 60-10 10-40 60-20 10-80 60-90 10-90 10-110 70-90 10-120 10-130 SPEC-40 10-170 20-21 20-61 30-30 30-31 50-01 50-20 50-30 50-60 50-112 Insert This Sheet With The Below Listed Manual For Future Reference . NOTICE SMR-12 S650 Service Manual SMR-13 S650 Service Manual SERVICE MANUAL REVISION Revision No: S650 - 7 Date: 15 October 2010 Product: Bobcat Loader Model: S650 Manual No: 6987168 (10-10) S630 Service Manual (P/N 6987168) Dated 10-10 contains updated service information which replaces the previous S630 Service Manual (P/N 6987168) Dated 6-10. ROUTE TO ATTENTION PARTS MANAGER SERVICE MANAGER X SALES MANAGER Insert This Sheet With The Below Listed Manual For Future Reference . NOTICE SMR-14 S650 Service Manual
Техника Bobcat подходит для ежедневной и интенсивной эксплуатации. Но все же без выхода из строя и различных дефектов не обойтись. Преимущественно они связаны с поломками узлов и агрегатов техники из-за чрезмерных нагрузок или использования в течение длительного времени. Разобраться со сбоями в работе спецтехники Bobcat можно с помощью кодов ошибок, которые отображаются на панели управления.
Ниже представлен список с кодами ошибок и описанием к ним. Для того, чтобы узнать информацию по интересующей ошибке воспользуйтесь функцией быстрого поиска (комбинация клавиш CTRL+F, далее Enter) и введите код ошибки для ознакомления.
Описание ошибок соответствует моделям техники Bobcat, среди которых и популярные модели S530, S770, S650, S175 и другие.
Если вы находитесь в Красноярске, то можете обратиться в сервисный центр для устранения неполадок у техники Bobcat.
Код ошибки
Описание
01-16
Воздушный фильтр не подключен
01-17
Засорен воздушный фильтр
02-16
Фильтр гидравлического агрегата не подключен
02-17
Засорен фильтр гидравлического агрегата
03-09
Низкое напряжение батареи
03-10
Напряжение аккумулятора высокое
03-11
Напряжение аккумулятора очень высокое
03-14
Напряжение аккумулятора очень низкое
03-15
Напряжение батареи при выключении
03-22
Напряжение аккумулятора ниже допустимого диапазона
04-09
Давление моторного масла низкое
04-14
Предельно низкое давление моторного масла
04-15
Давление моторного масла при остановке
04-21
Давление моторного масла вне допустимого диапазона
04-22
Давление моторного масла ниже допустимого диапазона
05-09
Низкое давление наддува гидросистемы
05-10
Гидравлическое давление наддува высокое
05-11
Предельно высокое гидравлическое давление наддува
05-14
Предельно низкое гидравлическое давление наддува
05-15
Гидравлическое давление наддува при останове
05-21
Гидравлическое давление наддува выше допустимого диапазона
05-22
Гидравлическое давление наддува ниже допустимого диапазона
06-10
Обороты двигателя высокая
06-11
Предельно высокие обороты двигателя
06-13
Нет сигнала оборотов двигателя
06-15
Обороты двигателя при остановке
06-18
Обороты двигателя вне допустимого диапазона
07-10
Высокая температура гидравлического масла
07-11
Предельно высокая температура гидравлического масла
07-15
Температура гидравлического масла при останове
07-21
Температура гидравлического масла вне допустимого диапазона
07-22
Температура гидравлического масла вне допустимого диапазона, низкая
08-10
Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
08-11
Предельно высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
08-15
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя при остановке
08-21
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя вне допустимого диапазона
08-22
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя вне допустимого диапазона, низкая
09-09
Низкий уровень топлива
09-21
Уровень топлива выше допустимого диапазона
09-22
Уровень топлива ниже допустимого диапазона
10-16
Гидравлический заправочный фильтр не подключен
10-17
Засорен гидравлический заправочный фильтр
11-05
Замыкание датчика планки сиденья на напряжение аккумулятора
11-06
Замыкание датчика поперечной планки на массу
12-21
Передний вспомогательный подрулевой переключатель выше допустимого диапазона
12-22
Передний вспомогательный подрулевой переключатель ниже допустимого диапазона
12-23
Передний вспомогательный ШИМ-переключатель не в нейтральном положении
13-05
Замыкание катушки отключения подачи топлива на аккумулятор
13-06
Замыкание соленоида блокировки отключения подачи топлива на массу
13-07
Обрыв цепи соленоида блокировки отключения подачи топлива
14-02
Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива — ошибочное включение
14-03
Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива — ошибочное выключение
15-02
Катушка тяги блокировки — ошибочное включение
15-03
Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги — ошибочное выключение
16-05
Замыкание катушки фиксации тяги на аккумулятор
16-06
Замыкание катушки фиксации противобуксовочной системы на массу
16-07
Обрыв цепи соленоида блокировки блокировки тяги
17-05
Замыкание соленоида гидравлической блокировки на напряжение аккумулятора
17-06
Замыкание соленоида гидравлической блокировки на массу
17-07
Обрыв цепи электромагнитного клапана гидравлической блокировки
18-05
Катушка блокировки катушки: короткое замыкание на батарею
18-06
Катушка блокировки катушки: короткое замыкание на массу
18-07
Обрыв цепи катушки блокировки катушки
19-02
Соленоид положения ковша — ошибочное включение
19-03
Соленоид положения ковша — ошибочное выключение
20-02
Двухскоростной соленоид — ошибочное включение
20-03
Двухскоростной соленоид — ошибочное выключение
21-02
Свечи накаливания — ошибочное включение
21-03
Свечи накаливания — ошибочное выключение
22-02
Стартер — ошибочное включение
22-03
Стартер — ошибочное выключение
23-02
Задний базовый соленоид — ошибочное включение
23-03
Задний базовый соленоид — ошибочное выключение
24-02
Соленоид задней тяги — ошибочное включение
24-03
Соленоид задней тяги — ошибочное выключение
25-02
Задний вспомогательный предохранительный соленоид — ошибочное включение
25-03
Задний вспомогательный предохранительный соленоид — ошибочное выключение
26-02
Соленоид передней базы — ошибочное включение
26-03
Соленоид передней базы — ошибочное выключение
26-05
ШИМ передней базы, короткое замыкание на батарею
26-06
ШИМ передней базы: замыкание на массу
26-07
Обрыв цепи ШИМ передней базы
27-02
Соленоид передней тяги — ошибочное включение
27-03
Соленоид передней тяги — ошибочное выключение
27-05
ШИМ передней тяги: короткое замыкание на батарею
27-06
ШИМ передней тяги: короткое замыкание на массу
27-07
Обрыв цепи ШИМ передней тяги
28-02
Соленоид дивертора — ошибочное включение
28-03
Соленоид дивертора — ошибочное выключение
29-02
Соленоид высокого расхода — ошибочное включение
29-03
Соленоид высокого расхода — ошибочное выключение
30-28
Ошибка памяти контроллера
31-28
Прерванная мощность
32-04
Нет связи с контроллером ACS
32-23
Контроллер ACS не откалиброван
32-24
Калибровка контроллера ACS выполнена
32-25
Ошибка калибровки контроллера ACS
32-31
ACS / AHS Tilt Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода наклона ACS / AHS)
32-32
Неисправность проводки привода наклона AHS
32-33
Неисправность проводки ручки наклона AHS
32-34
Привод наклона ACS / AHS не в нейтральном положении
32-35
Ручка / педаль наклона ACS / AHS не в нейтральном положении, правый джойстик SJC Ось X не в нейтральном положении
32-36
ACS / AHS Lift Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода лифта)
32-37
Неисправность проводки привода лифта AHS
32-38
Неисправность проводки ручки подъемника AHS
32-39
Привод лифта AC / AHS не в нейтральном положении
32-40
Подъемная ручка / педаль ACS / AHS не в нейтральном положении, правый джойстик SJC, ось Y не в нейтральном положении
32-41
Контроллер AHS (нет связи)
32-49
Замыкание привода подъема ACS на массу — ошибочное выключение
32-50
Замыкание исполнительного механизма наклона ACS на массу — ошибочное выключение
32-51
Замыкание привода подъема ACS на аккумуляторную батарею — ошибочное включение
32-52
Замыкание привода наклона ACS на аккумуляторную батарею — ошибочное включение
32-53
Ручка подъема / педаль ACS короткое замыкание на массу, ось Y правого джойстика SJC замыкание на массу
32-54
Короткое замыкание ручки / педали наклона ACS на массу, короткое замыкание оси X правого джойстика SJC на массу
32-55
Короткое замыкание ручки / педали подъема ACS на аккумулятор, короткое замыкание на оси Y правого джойстика SJC на аккумуляторную батарею
32-56
Педаль наклона ACS, короткое замыкание на батарею, правый джойстик SJC, короткое замыкание на батарею, ось X
32-57
Снижение производительности привода подъема ACS
32-58
Привод наклона ACS пониженная производительность
32-59
Неправильное направление привода подъема ACS
32-60
Неправильное направление привода наклона ACS
32-61
Замыкание ручки управления ACS на массу
32-62
Замок ручки ACS от замыкания на аккумуляторную батарею
32-63
Замыкание педали акселератора на массу
32-64
Замыкание педали акселератора от замыкания на батарею
32-65
Напряжение питания датчика ACS вне допустимого диапазона
32-66
Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи переменного тока вне допустимого диапазона
32-67
Переключатель режима работы ACS перевернут во время работы
32-68
Ошибка информации о рукоятке подъемника ACS
32-70
Ось Y правого джойстика вне диапазона, низкий уровень
32-71
Ось Y правого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
32-75
Прерванная некоммутируемая мощность
32-76
Ошибка информации о джойстике
32-97
Контроллер ACS запрограммирован
33-23
Контроллер Bobcat не запрограммирован
34-04
Ошибка панели Deluxe
35-02
Ошибка гидравлического вентилятора — ошибочное включение
35-03
Гидравлический вентилятор — ошибочное выключение
35-05
Короткое замыкание вентилятора гидравлической системы на аккумуляторную батарею
35-06
Короткое замыкание вентилятора гидравлической системы на массу
36-48
Наличие нескольких Acds (несколько контроллеров)
37-02
Двухскоростной соленоид подпитки — ошибочное включение
37-03
Двухскоростная подпитка — ошибочное выключение
37-07
Обрыв цепи двухскоростного вторичного соленоида
38-01
Ошибка информации джойстика
38-02
Ошибка информации пульта дистанционного управления
38-03
Ошибка калибровки привода
38-04
Контроллер AWS / SJC (нет связи)
38-05
Левый аналоговый джойстик Ось X не в нейтральном положении
38-06
Правый аналоговый джойстик Ось X не в нейтральном положении
38-07
Левый аналоговый джойстик Ось Y не в нейтральном положении
38-08
Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-09
Замыкание переключателя рабочего режима на массу или аккумулятор
38-10
Калибровка привода выполнена
38-11
Привод подъемника AWS / SJC не в нейтральном положении
38-12
Привод наклона AWS / SJC не в нейтральном положении
38-13
Aws / SJC Lift Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода лифта)
38-14
Aws / SJC Tilt Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода наклона Aws / SJC)
38-15
Aws / SJC Ошибка скорости вращения правого колеса
38-16
Aws / SJC Ошибка скорости левого колеса
38-17
Привод наклона AWS / SJC пониженная производительность
38-18
Снижение производительности привода подъема Aws / SJC
38-19
Ось X левого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
38-20
Ось X правого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
38-21
Ось Y левого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
38-22
Ось Y правого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
38-23
Правый передний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
38-24
Левый передний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
38-25
Правый задний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
38-26
Левый задний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона сигнала
38-27
Привод подъема AWS / SJC вне допустимого диапазона
38-28
Привод наклона AWS / SJC вне допустимого диапазона
38-29
Ось X левого джойстика ниже допустимого диапазона
38-30
Ось X правого джойстика ниже допустимого диапазона
38-31
Левый джойстик по оси Y вне диапазона, низкий уровень
38-32
Ось Y правого джойстика вне диапазона, низкий уровень
38-33
Правый передний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
38-34
Левый передний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
38-35
Правый задний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
38-36
Левый задний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
38-37
Питание датчика 5 Вольт 1 ниже допустимого диапазона
38-38
Питание датчика 5 Вольт 2 ниже допустимого диапазона
38-39
Замыкание привода подъема AWS / SJC на массу
38-40
Короткое замыкание исполнительного механизма наклона AWS / SJC на массу
38-41
Неправильное направление привода наклона
38-42
Неправильное направление привода подъема
38-43
Соленоид левого переднего привода — ошибочное включение
38-44
Соленоид левого реверсивного привода — ошибочное включение
38-45
Соленоид правого переднего привода — ошибочное включение
38-46
Соленоид правого реверсивного привода — ошибочное включение
38-47
Соленоид правого переднего рулевого управления — ошибочное включение
38-48
Соленоид левого переднего рулевого управления — ошибочное включение
38-49
Соленоид правого заднего рулевого управления — ошибочное включение
38-50
Соленоид левого заднего рулевого управления — ошибочное включение
38-51
Соленоид рулевого управления с регулировкой давления — ошибочное включение
38-52
Резервное копирование — ошибочное включение
38-53
Соленоид левого переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
38-54
Соленоид левого реверсивного привода — ошибочное выключение
38-55
Соленоид правого переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
38-56
Соленоид правого реверсивного привода — ошибочное выключение
38-57
Соленоид выдвижения правого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
38-58
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
38-59
Соленоид рулевого механизма выдвижения левого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
38-60
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания левого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
38-61
Соленоид выдвижения правого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное выключение
38-62
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого заднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
38-63
Соленоид выдвижения левого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное выключение
38-64
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания заднего левого колеса — ошибочное выключение
38-65
Соленоид рулевого управления с регулировкой давления — ошибочное выключение
38-66
Замыкание резервного аварийного сигнала на массу
38-67
Нет связи с контроллером Bobcat
38-68
Датчики угла поворота колес не откалиброваны
38-69
Контроллер AWS / SJC не откалиброван
38-70
Прерванная мощность
38-71
Напряжение аккумулятора вне допустимого диапазона
38-72
Насос привода не откалиброван
38-73
Переключатель режима работы нажат во время работы
38-74
Неуправляемое движение со скоростью правого колеса
38-75
Неуправляемое движение со скоростью левого колеса
38-85
Подача питания датчика 1 на 5,0 В выше допустимого диапазона
38-86
Питание датчика 2 выше допустимого диапазона
38-87
Ошибка соленоида правого переднего рулевого механизма
38-88
Ошибка соленоида левого переднего рулевого механизма
38-89
Ошибка соленоида правого заднего рулевого механизма
38-90
Ошибка соленоида левого заднего рулевого управления
38-93
Датчик правой скорости не отвечает
38-94
Левый датчик скорости не отвечает
38-95
Левый датчик скорости заднего хода
38-96
Направление заднего хода правого датчика скорости
38-97
Контроллер AWS / SJC запрограммирован
38-98
Контроллер в режиме калибровки привода
38-99
Контроллер AWS в режиме калибровки положения колес
39-04
Неисправность переключателей левого джойстика
39-05
Левый джойстик Ось X не в нейтральном положении
39-07
Левый джойстик Ось Y не в нейтральном положении
39-12
Подрулевой переключатель левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
39-13
Левый джойстик захвата (нет связи)
39-16
Левый джойстик базы (нет связи)
39-28
Внутренняя неисправность левого джойстика
39-48
Левый джойстик несколько
40-04
Неисправность переключателей правого джойстика
40-05
Правый джойстик Ось X не в нейтральном положении
40-07
Правый джойстик ось Y не в нейтральном положении
40-12
Правый рычаг джойстика — подрулевой переключатель не в нейтральном положении
40-13
Правая ручка джойстика (нет связи)
40-16
Правая консоль джойстика (нет связи)
40-28
Внутренняя неисправность правого джойстика
40-48
Правый джойстик несколько
41-09
Низкая мощность генератора
41-10
Высокое напряжение генератора
41-11
Напряжение генератора Предельно высокое
44-02
Реле звукового сигнала — ошибочное включение
44-03
Реле звукового сигнала — ошибочное выключение
45-02
Реле правого указателя поворота — ошибочное включение
45-03
Реле правого указателя поворота — ошибочное выключение
46-02
Реле левого поворотника — ошибочное включение
46-03
Реле левого указателя поворота — ошибочное выключение
47-21
Напряжение питания датчика 8 В выше допустимого диапазона
47-22
Питание датчика 8 В ниже допустимого диапазона
48-02
Реле переднего света — ошибочное включение
48-03
Реле переднего света — ошибочное выключение
49-02
Реле заднего фонаря — ошибочное включение
49-03
Реле заднего фонаря — ошибочное выключение
50-01
Педаль движения выше допустимого диапазона
50-02
Педаль движения ниже допустимого диапазона
50-03
Педаль хода не откалибрована
50-04
Педаль тормоза выше допустимого диапазона
50-05
Педаль тормоза ниже допустимого диапазона
50-06
Педаль тормоза не откалибрована
50-07
Рычаг управления направлением движения (нет сигнала)
50-08
Рычаг управления направлением движения Несколько входов
50-09
Датчик скорости переднего колеса выше допустимого диапазона
50-10
Датчик скорости переднего колеса ниже допустимого диапазона
50-11
Датчик скорости заднего колеса выше допустимого диапазона
50-12
Датчик скорости заднего колеса ниже допустимого диапазона
50-13
Нет сигнала датчика скорости переднего колеса
50-14
Нет сигнала датчика скорости заднего колеса
50-15
Неисправность двойного датчика скорости вращения колес
50-16
Контроль подачи не откалиброван
50-19
Датчик наклонной пластины выше допустимого диапазона
50-20
Датчик наклонной пластины ниже допустимого диапазона
50-21
Низкое давление в штанге вне допустимого диапазона
50-23
Контроллер привода не запрограммирован
50-24
Повышенное напряжение аккумулятора
50-25
Напряжение аккумулятора ниже напряжения
50-26
Прерванная мощность
50-27
Подача питания датчика 1 на 5,0 В выше допустимого диапазона
50-28
Питание датчика 5,0 В 1 ниже допустимого диапазона
50-29
Подача питания датчика 2 на 5,0 В выше допустимого диапазона
50-30
Подача питания датчика 2 на 5,0 В ниже допустимого диапазона
50-31
Соленоид ШИМ переднего привода — ошибочное включение
50-32
Катушка привода переднего хода: короткое замыкание на батарею
50-33
Соленоид ШИМ переднего привода (нет сигнала)
50-34
Соленоид ШИМ переднего привода не откалиброван
50-35
Соленоид переднего привода переднего привода — ошибочное включение
50-36
Соленоид переднего привода переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
50-37
Соленоид заднего хода переднего привода — ошибочное включение
50-38
Соленоид заднего хода переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
50-39
Соленоид Pwm заднего привода — ошибочное включение
50-40
Катушка реверсивного привода: короткое замыкание на батарею
50-41
Электромагнитный ШИМ заднего привода (нет сигнала)
50-42
Соленоид ШИМ заднего привода не откалиброван
50-43
Соленоид переднего привода заднего привода — ошибочное включение
50-44
Соленоид переднего привода заднего привода — ошибочное выключение
50-45
Соленоид заднего хода — ошибочное включение
50-46
Соленоид заднего хода: — ошибочное выключение
50-47
Две скорости — ошибочное выключение
50-48
Две скорости — ошибочное включение
50-49
Соленоид тормоза — ошибочное включение
50-50
Соленоид тормоза — ошибочное выключение
50-51
Соленоид тормоза (нет сигнала)
50-52
Замыкание стоп-сигналов на аккумулятор
50-53
Замыкание стоп-сигналов на массу
50-54
Блокировка дифференциала — ошибочное включение
50-55
Блокировка дифференциала — ошибочное выключение
50-56
Возможен сбой связи
50-57
Контроллер привода не откалиброван
50-58
Возможно устаревание обеспечения RPM
50-59
Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости переднего колеса
50-60
Замыкание удаленной гидравлики на аккумулятор
50-61
Замыкание удаленной гидравлики на массу
50-63
Ошибка калибровки датчика переднего угла
50-64
Обратный ход насоса привода — ошибочное выключение
50-65
Замыкание вспомогательной базовой катушки на массу или разрыв цепи
50-66
Ошибка калибровки датчика заднего угла
50-67
Передний привод вперед (нет сигнала)
50-68
Передний привод заднего хода (нет сигнала)
50-69
Задний привод вперед (нет сигнала)
50-70
Задний ход заднего хода (нет сигнала)
50-72
Фанкойл: замыкание на массу
50-73
Штанга вспомогательной гидравлики — ошибочное выключение
50-74
Датчик дроссельной заслонки, канал A, ниже допустимого диапазона
50-75
Датчик дроссельной заслонки, канал B, выше допустимого диапазона
50-76
Датчик дроссельной заслонки, канал B, ниже допустимого диапазона
50-77
Вспомогательный переключатель — ошибочное включение
50-78
Вспомогательный переключатель — ошибочное выключение
50-79
Реле поплавка стрелы — ошибочное выключение
50-80
Датчик скорости ВОМ выше допустимого диапазона
50-81
Датчик скорости ВОМ ниже допустимого диапазона
50-82
Обрыв цепи датчика скорости ВОМ
50-99
В режиме калибровки
60-21
Задний вспомогательный элемент управления выше допустимого диапазона
60-22
Задний вспомогательный элемент управления ниже допустимого диапазона
60-23
Задний вспомогательный регулятор не в нейтральном положении
62-04
Ошибка мониторинга момента нагрузки
63-05
Замыкание переключателя консоли на аккумулятор
63-06
Замыкание переключателя консоли на массу
64-02
Переключатель реле питания — ошибочное включение
64-03
Переключатель реле питания — ошибочное выключение
64-05
Переключаемое реле питания, короткое замыкание на батарею
64-06
Короткое замыкание переключаемого силового реле на массу
64-07
Обрыв цепи переключаемого силового реле
65-05
Замыкание соленоида блокировки рабочей группы на напряжение аккумулятора
65-06
Замыкание соленоида блокировки рабочей группы на массу
65-07
Обрыв цепи соленоида блокировки рабочей группы
66-05
Замыкание давления пилота на аккумуляторную батарею
66-06
Давление управления ходом: короткое замыкание на массу
66-07
Обрыв цепи управляющего давления хода
67-05
Bobtach от короткого замыкания на батарею
67-06
Bobtach короткое замыкание на землю
69-05
Короткое замыкание реле присутствия оператора на аккумуляторную батарею
69-06
Короткое замыкание реле присутствия оператора на массу
69-07
Обрыв цепи реле присутствия оператора
70-28
Отказ тормозного давления
74-72
Главный контроллер Bobcat в загрузочном коде
75-01
Ошибка информации джойстика
75-04
Нет связи от контроллера привода
75-05
Ось X левого джойстика не в нейтральном левом положении (только в режиме ISO)
75-07
Ось Y левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
75-08
Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении (только h-образный)
75-09
Замыкание переключателя рабочего режима на массу или аккумулятор
75-13
Правое переднее колесо не отвечает
75-14
Левое переднее колесо не отвечает
75-15
Правое заднее колесо не отвечает
75-16
Левое заднее колесо не отвечает
75-17
Левая тарелка автомата перекоса не в нейтральном положении
75-18
Правая качающаяся пластина не в нейтральном положении
75-19
Ось X левого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
75-21
Ось Y левого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
75-23
Правый передний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
75-24
Левый передний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
75-25
Правый задний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
75-26
Левый задний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона сигнала
75-27
Левая наклонная пластина не на своем месте
75-28
Правая наклонная пластина не на своем месте
75-29
Ось X левого джойстика ниже допустимого диапазона
75-31
Левый джойстик по оси Y вне диапазона, низкий уровень
75-33
Правый передний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
75-34
Левый передний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
75-35
Правый задний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
75-36
Левый задний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
75-37
Питание датчика 5,0 В 1 ниже допустимого диапазона
75-38
Питание датчика 5 Вольт 2 ниже допустимого диапазона
75-39
Левый датчик наклонной пластины выше допустимого диапазона
75-40
Левый датчик наклонной пластины ниже допустимого диапазона
75-41
Датчик правой наклонной пластины выше допустимого диапазона
75-42
Датчик правой наклонной пластины ниже допустимого диапазона
75-43
Соленоид левого переднего привода — ошибочное включение
75-44
Соленоид левого реверсивного привода — ошибочное включение
75-45
Соленоид правого переднего привода — ошибочное включение
75-46
Соленоид правого реверсивного привода — ошибочное включение
75-47
Соленоид выдвижения правого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
75-48
Соленоид рулевого управления выдвижения левого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
75-49
Соленоид выдвижения правого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное включение
75-50
Соленоид выдвижения левого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное включение
75-51
Соленоид рулевого управления с регулировкой давления — ошибочное включение
75-52
Резервное копирования — ошибочное включение
75-53
Соленоид левого переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
75-54
Соленоид левого реверсивного привода — ошибочное выключение
75-55
Соленоид правого переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
75-56
Соленоид правого реверсивного привода — ошибочное выключение
75-57
Соленоид выдвижения правого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
75-58
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
75-59
Соленоид рулевого механизма выдвижения левого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
75-60
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания левого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
75-61
Соленоид выдвижения правого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное выключение
75-62
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого заднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
75-63
Соленоид выдвижения левого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное выключение
75-64
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания заднего левого колеса — ошибочное выключение
75-65
Соленоид рулевого управления с регулировкой давления — ошибочное выключение
75-66
Аварийный сигнал резервного копирования — ошибочное выключение
75-67
Нет связи с контроллером Bobcat
75-68
Датчики угла не откалиброваны
75-69
Напряжение аккумулятора выше допустимого диапазона
75-70
Прерванная мощность
75-71
Напряжение аккумулятора ниже допустимого диапазона
75-72
Приводной насос — не откалиброван
75-73
Переключатель режима работы перевернут во время работы
75-74
Неуправляемое движение со скоростью правого колеса
75-75
Неуправляемое движение со скоростью левого колеса
75-76
Нет связи с контроллером ACS
75-77
Левый датчик скорости выше допустимого диапазона
75-78
Датчик правой скорости выше допустимого диапазона
75-79
Левый датчик скорости ниже допустимого диапазона
75-80
Датчик правой скорости ниже допустимого диапазона
75-81
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
75-82
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания левого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
75-83
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого заднего колеса — ошибочное включение
75-84
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания заднего левого колеса — ошибочное включение
75-85
Подача питания датчика 1 на 5,0 В выше допустимого диапазона
75-86
Питание датчика 2 выше допустимого диапазона
75-87
Требуется обновление программного обеспечения
75-88
Переключение питания — ошибочное включение
75-91
Левый датчик наклонной пластины — перевернутый
75-92
Правый датчик наклонной пластины — перевернутый
75-93
Не отвечает правый датчик скорости
75-94
Не отвечает левый датчик скорости
75-95
Левый датчик скорости заднего хода
75-96
Направление заднего хода правого датчика скорости
75-97
Запрограммирован контроллер Drive / Drive Plus
75-98
Контроллер в режиме калибровки
75-99
Контроллер Drive Plus в режиме калибровки положения колес
76-73
Ошибка Rx системы левой панели дисплея
77-48
Ключевой переключатель несколько
78-74
Дверь / Транспортный замок открыт / Активен
80-02
Acd / racd выход «a» — ошибочное включение
80-03
Acd / racd выход «a» — ошибочное выключение
81-02
Acd / racd выход «b» — ошибочное включение
81-03
Acd / racd выход «b» — ошибочное выключение
82-02
Acd / racd выход «c» — ошибочное включение
82-03
Acd / racd выход «c» — ошибочное выключение
83-02
Acd / racd выход «d» — ошибочное включение
83-03
Acd / racd выход «d» — ошибочное выключение
84-02
Acd / racd выход «e» — ошибочное включение
84-03
Acd / racd выход «e» — ошибочное выключение
85-02
Acd / racd выход «f» — ошибочное включение
85-03
Acd / racd выход «f» — ошибочное выключение
86-02
Acd / racd выход «g» — ошибочное включение
86-03
Acd / racd выход «g» — ошибочное выключение
87-02
Acd / racd выход «h» — ошибочное включение
87-03
Acd / racd выход «h» — ошибочное выключение
90-02
Сервисный выход «c» — ошибочное включение
90-03
Сервисный выход «c» — ошибочное выключение
91-02
Сервисный выход «d» — ошибочное включение
91-03
Сервисный выход «d» — ошибочное выключение
92-02
Сервисный выход «e» — ошибочное включение
92-03
Сервисный выход «e» — ошибочное выключение
93-02
Сервисный выход «f» — ошибочное включение
93-03
Сервисный выход «F» — ошибочное выключение
A0618
Скорость вращения колеса вне допустимого диапазона
A3623
ACD (устройство управления навесным оборудованием), не запрограммировано
A4621
Напряжение питания датчика 5 В выше допустимого диапазона
A4622
Питание датчика 5 В ниже допустимого диапазона
A4721
Напряжение питания датчика 8 В выше допустимого диапазона
A4722
Питание датчика 8 В ниже допустимого диапазона
A7701
Машинный ключ активен
A7901
E-stop активен
A8002
Acd / racd выход «a» — ошибочное включение
A8003
Acd / racd выход «a» — ошибочное выключение
A8005
Acd выход ‘a’ короткое замыкание на батарею
A8006
Короткое замыкание выхода ACD на землю
A8007
Acd выход ‘a’ (обрыв цепи)
A8032
Acd выход ‘a’ (перегрузка по току)
A8102
Acd / racd выход «b» — ошибочное включение
A8103
Acd / racd выход «b» — ошибочное выключение
A8105
Короткое замыкание на выходе ACD ‘b’ на аккумуляторную батарею
A8106
Короткое замыкание выхода Acd на землю
A8107
Acd выход ‘b’ (обрыв цепи)
A8132
Acd выход ‘b’ (перегрузка по току)
A8202
Acd / racd выход «c» — ошибочное включение
A8203
Acd / racd выход «c» — ошибочное выключение
A8205
Короткое замыкание на выходе ACD ‘c’ на аккумуляторную батарею
A8206
Короткое замыкание выхода Acd на землю
A8207
Разрыв цепи выхода ACD ‘c’
A8232
Acd выход ‘c’ (перегрузка по току)
A8302
Acd выход ‘d’ — ошибочное включение
A8303
Acd / racd выход «d» — ошибочное выключение
A8305
Короткое замыкание выхода Acd на батарею
A8306
Короткое замыкание выхода ACD на землю
A8307
Разрыв цепи выхода ACD ‘d’
A8332
Acd выход ‘d’ (перегрузка по току)
A8402
Acd / racd выход «e» — ошибочное включение
A8403
Acd / racd выход «e» — ошибочное выключение
A8405
Acd выход ‘e’ короткое замыкание на батарею
A8406
Короткое замыкание выхода Acd на землю
A8407
Acd выход ‘e’ (обрыв цепи)
A8432
Acd выход ‘e’ (перегрузка по току)
A8502
Acd / racd выход «f» — ошибочное включение
A8503
Acd / racd выход «f» — ошибочное выключение
A8505
Короткое замыкание на выходе Acd ‘f’ на аккумуляторную батарею
A8506
Короткое замыкание выхода Acd на землю
A8507
Acd выход ‘f’ (обрыв цепи)
A8532
Acd выход ‘f’ (перегрузка по току)
A8602
Acd выход ‘g’ — ошибочное включение
A8603
Acd / racd выход «g» — ошибочное выключение
A8605
Замыкание выхода ACD ‘g’ на аккумуляторную батарею
A8606
Короткое замыкание выхода Acd на землю
A8607
Разрыв цепи выхода ACD ‘g’
A8702
Acd / racd выход «h» — ошибочное включение
A8703
Acd / racd выход «h» — ошибочное выключение
A8705
Acd выход ‘h’ короткое замыкание на батарею
A8706
Acd выход ‘h’: короткое замыкание на массу
A8707
Acd выход ‘h’ (обрыв цепи)
A8802
Реверсивный соленоид — ошибочное включение
A8803
Реверсивный соленоид — ошибочное выключение
C0216
Гидравлический / гидростатический фильтр не подключен
C0217
Гидравлический / гидростатический фильтр засорен
C0309
Низкое напряжение батареи
C0310
Напряжение аккумулятора высокое
C0311
Напряжение аккумулятора очень высокое
C0314
Напряжение батареи крайне низкое
C0315
Напряжение батареи при выключении
C0322
Напряжение аккумулятора ниже допустимого диапазона
C0414
Предельно низкое давление моторного масла
C0415
Давление моторного масла при остановке
C0610
Обороты двигателя высокая
C0611
Предельно высокие обороты двигателя
C0613
Нет сигнала оборотов двигателя
C0615
Обороты двигателя при остановке
C0618
Обороты двигателя вне допустимого диапазона
C0710
Высокая температура гидравлического масла
C0711
Предельно высокая температура гидравлического масла
C0715
Температура гидравлического масла при останове
C0722
Температура гидравлического масла вне допустимого диапазона, низкая
C0810
Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
C0811
Предельно высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
C0815
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя при остановке
C0821
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя вне допустимого диапазона
C0822
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя вне допустимого диапазона, низкая
C0921
Уровень топлива выше допустимого диапазона
C0922
Уровень топлива ниже допустимого диапазона
C1221
Дополнительный ШИМ-переключатель выше допустимого диапазона
C1222
Дополнительный ШИМ-переключатель ниже допустимого диапазона
C1223
Дополнительный ШИМ-переключатель не в нейтральном положении
C1305
Замыкание соленоида блокировки отключения подачи топлива на аккумуляторную батарею
C1306
Замыкание соленоида блокировки отключения подачи топлива на массу
C1307
Обрыв цепи соленоида блокировки отключения подачи топлива Код Описание
C1402
Соленоид отсечки подачи топлива — ошибочное включение
C1403
Соленоид тяги отключения подачи топлива — ошибочное выключение
C2005
Две скорости — ошибочное включение
C2006
Две скорости — ошибочное выключение
C2102
Свечи накаливания — ошибочное включение
C2103
Свечи накаливания — ошибочное выключение
C2202
Стартер — ошибочное включение
C2203
Стартер — ошибочное выключение
C2305
Электромагнитный клапан смещения базы: замыкание на аккумуляторную батарею
C2306
Замыкание базового соленоида смещения на массу
C2307
Обрыв цепи соленоида смещения основания
C2405
Замыкание соленоида штока смещения на напряжение аккумулятора
C2406
Замыкание соленоида смещающей штанги на массу
C2407
Обрыв цепи соленоида смещающей штанги
C2505
Возврат смещения: короткое замыкание на батарею
C2506
Смещение возврата: короткое замыкание на массу
C2507
Разомкнутая цепь возврата смещения
C2605
Замыкание соленоида вспомогательной базы на напряжение аккумулятора
C2606
Замыкание соленоида вспомогательной базы на массу
C2607
Обрыв цепи вспомогательного базового соленоида
C2705
Замыкание соленоида вспомогательной тяги на напряжение аккумулятора
C2706
Замыкание соленоида вспомогательной тяги на массу
C2707
Обрыв цепи соленоида вспомогательной тяги
C2802
Гидравлический обмен — ошибочное включение
C2803
Гидравлический обмен — ошибочное выключение
C3028
Ошибка памяти контроллера
C3128
Прерывистый сбой питания
C3323
Главный контроллер не запрограммирован
C3397
Главный контроллер запрограммирован
C4021
Угол управления отвалом вне допустимого диапазона, высокий
C4022
Угол управления отвалом ниже допустимого диапазона
C4023
Угловой отвал не в нейтральном положении
C4105
Электромагнитный клапан основания углового лезвия: замыкание на аккумуляторную батарею
C4106
Электромагнитный клапан основания углового отвала: замыкание на массу
C4107
Обрыв цепи соленоида основания углового лезвия
C4205
Электромагнитный клапан стержня углового ножа: замыкание на аккумуляторную батарею
C4206
Электромагнитный клапан стержня углового отвала: замыкание на массу
C4207
Обрыв цепи соленоида стержня углового ножа
C4321
Давление считывания нагрузки вне допустимого диапазона
C4322
Давление измерения нагрузки ниже допустимого диапазона
C4516
Контроллер дроссельной заслонки (нет связи)
C6021
Контроль смещения вне допустимого диапазона
C6022
Контроль смещения ниже допустимого диапазона
C6023
Управление смещением не в нейтральном положении
C6204
Ошибка мониторинга момента нагрузки
C6305
Замыкание переключателя консоли на аккумулятор
C6306
Замыкание переключателя консоли на массу
C6405
Переключаемое реле питания, короткое замыкание на батарею
C6406
Короткое замыкание переключаемого силового реле на массу
C6407
Обрыв цепи переключаемого силового реле
C6505
Замыкание соленоида блокировки рабочей группы на напряжение аккумулятора
C6506
Замыкание соленоида блокировки рабочей группы на массу
C6507
Обрыв цепи соленоида блокировки рабочей группы
D3905
Левый джойстик Ось X не в нейтральном положении
D3907
Левый джойстик Ось Y не в нейтральном положении
D4007
Правый джойстик ось Y не в нейтральном положении
D7501
Ошибка информации джойстика
D7504
Привод (нет связи) с контроллером привода
D7505
Левый джойстик привода оси X не в нейтральном положении
D7507
Левый джойстик привода оси Y не в нейтральном положении
D7508
Управляйте правым джойстиком, ось Y не в нейтральном положении
D7509
Замыкание переключателя рабочего режима на массу или аккумулятор
D7510
Установлены неправильные джойстики привода
D7511
Левый датчик скорости привода не подключен
D7512
Датчик скорости правого привода не подключен
D7513
Правое переднее колесо не отвечает
D7514
Левое переднее колесо не отвечает
D7515
Правое заднее колесо не отвечает
D7516
Левое заднее колесо не отвечает
D7517
Левая тарелка автомата перекоса не в нейтральном положении
D7518
Правая качающаяся пластина не в нейтральном положении
D7519
Ось X левого джойстика движения вне допустимого диапазона
D7521
Перемещение по оси Y левого джойстика вне допустимого диапазона
D7522
Правый джойстик движения по оси Y вне допустимого диапазона
D7523
Правый передний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
D7524
Левый передний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
D7525
Правый задний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона
D7526
Левый задний датчик рулевого управления выше допустимого диапазона сигнала
D7527
Левая наклонная пластина не на своем месте
D7528
Правая наклонная пластина не на своем месте
D7529
Левый джойстик движения по оси X ниже допустимого диапазона
D7531
Ведите левый джойстик по оси Y за пределы допустимого диапазона
D7532
Двигайтесь правым джойстиком по оси Y ниже допустимого диапазона
D7533
Правый передний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
D7534
Левый передний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
D7535
Правый задний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
D7536
Левый задний датчик рулевого управления ниже допустимого диапазона
D7537
Питание датчика 5,0 В 1 ниже допустимого диапазона
D7538
Питание датчика 5 Вольт 2 ниже допустимого диапазона
D7539
Левый датчик наклонной пластины выше допустимого диапазона
D7540
Левый датчик наклонной пластины ниже допустимого диапазона
D7541
Датчик правой наклонной пластины выше допустимого диапазона
D7542
Датчик правой наклонной пластины ниже допустимого диапазона
D7543
Соленоид левого переднего привода — ошибочное включение
D7544
Соленоид левого реверсивного привода — ошибочное включение
D7545
Соленоид правого переднего привода — ошибочное включение
D7546
Соленоид правого реверсивного привода — ошибочное включение
D7547
Соленоид выдвижения правого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
D7548
Соленоид рулевого управления выдвижения левого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
D7549
Соленоид выдвижения правого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное включение
D7550
Соленоид выдвижения левого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное включение
D7551
Соленоид рулевого управления с регулировкой давления — ошибочное включение
D7552
Резервное копирование — ошибочное включение
D7553
Соленоид левого переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
D7554
Соленоид левого реверсивного привода — ошибочное выключение
D7555
Соленоид правого переднего привода — ошибочное выключение
D7556
Соленоид правого реверсивного привода — ошибочное выключение
D7557
Соленоид выдвижения правого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
D7558
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
D7559
Соленоид рулевого механизма выдвижения левого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
D7560
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания левого переднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
D7561
Соленоид выдвижения правого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное выключение
D7562
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого заднего колеса — ошибочное выключение
D7563
Соленоид выдвижения левого заднего рулевого механизма — ошибочное выключение
D7564
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания заднего левого колеса — ошибочное выключение
D7565
Соленоид рулевого управления с регулировкой давления — ошибочное выключение
D7566
Аварийный сигнал резервного копирования — ошибочное выключение
D7567
Нет связи от контроллера шлюза
D7568
Датчики угла не откалиброваны
D7569
Напряжение аккумулятора выше допустимого диапазона
D7570
Прерванная мощность
D7571
Напряжение аккумулятора ниже допустимого диапазона
D7572
Приводной насос — не откалиброван
D7573
Переключатель режима работы перевернут во время работы
D7574
Неуправляемое движение со скоростью правого колеса
D7575
Неуправляемое движение со скоростью левого колеса
D7576
Привод отсутствует связь с контроллером ACS
D7577
Левый датчик скорости выше допустимого диапазона
D7578
Датчик правой скорости выше допустимого диапазона
D7579
Левый датчик скорости ниже допустимого диапазона
D7580
Датчик правой скорости ниже допустимого диапазона
D7581
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
D7582
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания левого переднего колеса — ошибочное включение
D7583
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания правого заднего колеса — ошибочное включение
D7584
Соленоид рулевого механизма втягивания заднего левого колеса — ошибочное включение
D7585
Подача питания датчика 1 на 5,0 В выше допустимого диапазона
D7586
Питание датчика 2 выше допустимого диапазона
D7587
Требуется обновление программного обеспечения
D7588
Переключенное питание застряло во включенном состоянии
D7589
Электропитание привода — ошибочное выключение
D7590
Калибровка привода выполнена
D7591
Левый датчик наклонной пластины — перевернутый
D7592
Правый датчик наклонной пластины — перевернутый
D7593
Не отвечает правый датчик скорости
D7594
Не отвечает левый датчик скорости
D7595
Левый датчик скорости заднего хода
D7596
Направление заднего хода правого датчика скорости
D7597
Запрограммирован контроллер Drive / Drive Plus
D7598
Контроллер Drive / Drive Plus в режиме калибровки
D7599
Контроллер Drive Plus в режиме калибровки положения колес
E00002700
Ошибка управления EGR
E00002701
Ошибка управления EGR
E00002703
EGR Ошибка положения привода
E00002704
EGR Ошибка положения привода
E00002709
EGR Ошибка положения привода
E00002710
EGR Ошибка положения привода
E00002720
Ошибка обучения позиции EGR
E00002730
Ошибка обучения позиции EGR
E00002903
Неисправность датчика положения дроссельной заслонки
E00002904
Неисправность датчика положения дроссельной заслонки
E00008100
Ошибка SCR
E00008107
Ошибка SCR
E00008111
Ошибка SCR
E00009102
Неисправность датчика положения дроссельной заслонки
E00009103
Неисправность датчика положения дроссельной заслонки
E00009104
Неисправность датчика положения дроссельной заслонки
E00009119
Неисправность датчика положения дроссельной заслонки
E00009411
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00009416
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00009418
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00009703
Неисправность датчика воды в топливе
E00009704
Неисправность датчика воды в топливе
E00009709
Неисправность датчика воды в топливе
E00009731
Обнаружена вода в топливе
E00010001
Давление моторного масла слишком низкое
E00010003
Неисправность давления моторного масла
E00010004
Неисправность давления моторного масла
E00010203
Неисправность датчика давления всасываемого воздуха
E00010204
Неисправность датчика давления всасываемого воздуха
E00010502
Ошибка температуры впускного коллектора
E00010503
Неисправность датчика температуры впускного коллектора
E00010504
Неисправность датчика температуры впускного коллектора
E00010509
Неисправность датчика температуры впускного коллектора
E00010510
Неисправность датчика температуры впускного коллектора
E00010603
Неисправность датчика давления в коллекторе
E00010604
Неисправность датчика давления в коллекторе
E00010609
Неисправность датчика давления в коллекторе
E00010803
Ошибка атмосферного давления
E00010804
Ошибка атмосферного давления
E00010809
Ошибка атмосферного давления
E00011000
Предельно высокая температура двигателя
E00011002
Ошибка температуры охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
E00011003
Неисправность датчика температуры воды
E00011004
Неисправность датчика температуры воды
E00011031
Неисправность датчика температуры охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
E00013200
Неисправность объема всасываемого воздуха
E00013201
Неисправность объема всасываемого воздуха
E00013203
Неисправность датчика Maf
E00013204
Неисправность датчика Maf
E00013209
Неисправность датчика Maf
E00013215
Ошибка давления наддува
E00013231
Неисправность датчика Maf
E00015700
Неисправность давления в рампе
E00015702
Неисправность датчика давления в рампе
E00015703
Неисправность датчика давления в рампе
E00015704
Неисправность датчика давления в рампе
E00015710
Неисправность давления в рампе
E00015711
Неисправность давления в рампе
E00015721
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00015722
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00016803
Напряжение в системе слишком высокое
E00016804
Напряжение в системе слишком низкое
E00017103
Неисправность датчика Maf
E00017104
Неисправность датчика Maf
E00017200
Слишком высокая температура всасываемого воздуха
E00017202
Неисправность датчика температуры всасываемого воздуха
E00017203
Неисправность датчика температуры всасываемого воздуха
E00017204
Неисправность датчика температуры всасываемого воздуха
E00017209
Неисправность датчика температуры всасываемого воздуха
E00017300
Ошибка перегрева выхлопных газов
E00017301
Док. Ошибка экзотермической эффективности
E00017302
Неисправность датчика температуры на впуске Scr
E00017400
Слишком высокая температура топлива
E00017402
Ошибка температуры топлива
E00017403
Неисправность датчика температуры топлива
E00017404
Неисправность датчика температуры топлива
E00017409
Неисправность датчика температуры топлива
E00017502
Ошибка температуры моторного масла
E00017531
Неисправность датчика температуры моторного масла
E00019000
Предельно высокие обороты двигателя
E00062802
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00062912
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00063011
Ошибка данных форсунки
E00063023
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00063024
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00063025
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00063031
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00063307
Неисправность давления в рампе
E00063600
Неисправность датчика положения коленчатого вала
E00063601
Неисправность датчика положения коленчатого вала
E00063602
Неисправность датчика положения коленчатого вала
E00063607
Неисправность кулачка или датчика кривошипа
E00063608
Неисправность датчика положения коленчатого вала
E00063611
Неисправность датчика положения коленчатого вала
E00063702
Ошибка сигнала кулачка
E00063708
Ошибка сигнала кулачка
E00063720
Ошибка сигнала кулачка
E00063730
Ошибка сигнала кулачка
E00063919
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E00064103
Ошибка контроля наддува
E00064104
Ошибка контроля наддува
E00065103
Неисправность форсунки №1
E00065105
Неисправность форсунки №1
E00065106
Неисправность форсунки №1
E00065120
Неисправность форсунки №1
E00065121
Неисправность форсунки №1
E00065131
Неисправность форсунки №1
E00065203
Неисправность форсунки №2
E00065205
Неисправность форсунки №2
E00065206
Неисправность форсунки №2
E00065220
Неисправность форсунки №2
E00065221
Неисправность форсунки №2
E00065231
Неисправность форсунки №2
E00065303
Неисправность форсунки №3
E00065305
Неисправность форсунки №3
E00065306
Неисправность форсунки №3
E00065320
Неисправность форсунки №3
E00065321
Неисправность форсунки №3
E00065331
Неисправность форсунки №3
E00065403
Неисправность форсунки №4
E00065405
Неисправность форсунки №4
E00065406
Неисправность форсунки №4
E00065420
Неисправность форсунки №4
E00065421
Неисправность форсунки №4
E00065431
Неисправность форсунки №4
E00067603
Неисправность реле свечей накаливания
E00067604
Неисправность реле свечей накаливания
E00067605
Неисправность реле свечей накаливания
E00072302
Неисправность датчика положения распределительного вала
E00072308
Неисправность датчика положения распределительного вала
E00073120
Неисправность акселерометра
E00073121
Неисправность акселерометра
E00107600
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107601
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107603
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107604
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107609
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107615
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107616
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107617
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107618
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107620
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107631
Неисправность управления давлением в рампе
E00107702
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00118002
Ошибка температуры турбо
E00118003
Неисправность датчика температуры турбо
E00118004
Неисправность датчика температуры турбо
E00118009
Неисправность датчика температуры турбо
E00118010
Неисправность датчика температуры турбо
E00118031
Неисправность датчика температуры турбо
E00122100
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122101
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122102
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122103
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122104
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122105
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122106
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122107
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122108
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122109
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122110
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122111
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122112
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122113
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122114
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122115
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122116
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122117
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122118
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122119
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122120
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122121
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122122
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122123
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122124
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122125
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122126
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122127
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122128
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122129
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122130
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122131
Ошибка мониторинга безопасности ЭБУ
E00122132
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122133
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122134
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122135
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122136
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122137
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122138
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122139
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122140
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122141
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122142
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122143
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122144
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122145
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122146
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122147
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122148
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122149
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122150
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122151
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122152
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122153
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122154
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122155
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122156
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122157
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122158
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122159
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122160
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122161
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122162
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122163
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122164
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122165
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122166
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122167
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122168
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122169
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122170
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122171
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122172
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122173
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122174
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122175
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122176
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122177
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122178
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122179
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122180
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122181
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122182
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122183
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122184
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122185
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122186
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122187
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122188
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122189
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122190
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122191
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122192
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122193
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122194
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122195
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122196
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122197
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122198
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00122199
Ошибка ЭБУ
E00123901
Утечка топлива под высоким давлением
E00134703
Неисправность насоса высокого давления
E00134704
Неисправность насоса высокого давления
E00134707
Неисправность насоса высокого давления
E00148502
Неисправность главного реле ЭБУ
E00148507
Неисправность главного реле ЭБУ
E00148511
Неисправность главного реле ЭБУ
E00161203
Неисправность форсунок №1 и №4
E00161204
Неисправность форсунок №1 и №4
E00161211
Неисправность форсунок №1 и №4
E00161303
Неисправность форсунок № 2 и № 3
E00161304
Неисправность форсунок № 2 и № 3
E00161311
Неисправность форсунок № 2 и № 3
E00279103
Egr Motor Fault (неисправность двигателя)
E00279104
Egr Motor Fault (неисправность двигателя)
E00279105
Egr Motor Fault (неисправность двигателя)
E00279107
Заблокированная неисправность EGR
E00279108
Ошибка положения EGR
E00324200
Предельно высокая температура выхлопных газов
E00324203
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E00324204
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E00324216
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E00324600
Предельно высокая температура выхлопных газов
E00324603
Ошибка датчика температуры EGR
E00324604
Ошибка датчика температуры EGR
E00324616
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E00325100
Неисправность датчика перепада давления
E00325101
Неисправность датчика перепада давления
E00325103
Ошибка датчика температуры EGR
E00325104
Ошибка датчика температуры EGR
E00325200
Слишком высокая температура выхлопных газов
E00350903
Сбой напряжения питания датчика
E00350904
Сбой напряжения питания датчика
E00350911
Неисправность источника питания 5-вольтного датчика №1
E00351003
Сбой напряжения питания датчика
E00351004
Сбой напряжения питания датчика
E00351011
Неисправность источника питания 5-вольтного датчика №2
E00351111
Неисправность питания 5-вольтового вспомогательного датчика №2
E00370100
Предельно высокое содержание твердых частиц
E00370115
Предупреждение о твердых частицах
E00370116
Слишком высокое содержание твердых частиц
E00408203
Неисправность впускного дозирующего клапана
E00408204
Неисправность впускного дозирующего клапана
E00408205
Неисправность впускного дозирующего клапана
E00408206
Неисправность впускного дозирующего клапана
E00425600
Неизвестная неисправность Scr
E00476500
Предельно высокая температура выхлопных газов
E00476503
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E00476504
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E00476518
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E00524600
Уровень защиты пустой
E00524615
Уровень защиты слишком низкий
E00524616
Уровень защиты Предельно низкий
E00524617
Уровень защиты слишком низкий
E00524619
Dcu может сбой связи
E00524621
Заблокированная ошибка EGR
E00524622
Прерванная ошибка дозирования
E00524623
Ошибка расхода Def
E00524624
Ошибка качества Def
E00524625
Ошибка взлома
E00524626
Ошибка расхода Def
E00532403
Ошибка сигнала свечей накаливания
E00532404
Ошибка сигнала свечей накаливания
E0105
Замыкание привода дроссельной заслонки на напряжение аккумулятора
E0106
Замыкание привода дроссельной заслонки на массу
E0107
Обрыв цепи привода дроссельной заслонки
E0123
Контроллер дроссельной заслонки не откалиброван
E0321
Напряжение питания датчика 5 В выше допустимого диапазона
E0322
Питание датчика 5 В ниже допустимого диапазона
E0421
Диск управления частотой вращения двигателя выше допустимого диапазона
E0422
Диск управления частотой вращения двигателя ниже допустимого диапазона
E0521
Обратная связь привода дроссельной заслонки вне допустимого диапазона
E0522
Обратная связь привода дроссельной заслонки ниже допустимого диапазона
E52352302
Неисправность форсунок №1 и №4
E52352303
Неисправность форсунок №1 и №4
E52352304
Неисправность форсунок №1 и №4
E52352402
Неисправность форсунок № 2 и № 3
E52352403
Неисправность форсунок № 2 и № 3
E52352404
Неисправность форсунок № 2 и № 3
E52352501
Неисправность форсунки
E52352702
Ошибка ЭБУ
E52353500
Неисправность форсунки
E52353602
Ошибка EGR
E52353702
Ошибка EGR
E52353802
Ошибка ЭБУ
E52353807
Ошибка ЭБУ
E52353902
Неисправность топливного насоса
E52354002
Неисправность топливного насоса
E52354103
Ошибка EGR
E52354104
Ошибка EGR
E52354302
Неисправность датчика положения дроссельной заслонки
E52354403
Неисправность впускного нагревателя
E52354404
Неисправность впускного нагревателя
E52354702
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52354802
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52357204
Ошибка датчика положения EGR
E52357403
Egr Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода)
E52357404
Egr Неисправность привода
E52357507
Egr Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода)
E52357602
Egr Motor Fault (Неисправность двигателя)
E52357702
Ошибка датчика температуры EGR
E52357802
Ошибка EGR
E52358002
Неисправность впускного дросселя
E52358203
Неисправность датчика подъема дроссельной заслонки на впуске
E52358204
Неисправность датчика подъема дроссельной заслонки на впуске
E52358917
Низкая температура воды при парковке регенерации
E52359016
Припаркованный тайм-аут регенерации
E52359102
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52359202
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52359302
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52359402
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52359502
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52359602
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52359800
Отказ Doc
E52359802
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52359900
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E52360000
Ошибка калибровки насоса
E52360100
Неисправность датчика температуры выхлопных газов
E52360200
Ошибка DPF
E52360315
Неисправность датчика температуры воды
E52360402
Ошибка связи ЭБУ
E52370013
Ошибка ЭБУ
H0921
Датчик наддува выше допустимого диапазона
H0922
Датчик наддува ниже допустимого диапазона
H1221
Передний вспомогательный подрулевой переключатель выше допустимого диапазона
H1222
Передний вспомогательный подрулевой переключатель ниже допустимого диапазона
H1224
Передний вспомогательный подрулевой переключатель не в нейтральном положении
H1321
Левый переключатель для большого пальца вне допустимого диапазона — высокий уровень
H1322
Левый большой переключатель ниже допустимого диапазона
H1324
Задний вспомогательный подрулевой переключатель не в нейтральном положении
H2305
Замыкание заднего базового соленоида на аккумулятор
H2306
Замыкание заднего базового соленоида на массу
H2307
Обрыв цепи заднего базового соленоида
H2332
Перегрузка заднего базового соленоида
H2405
Замыкание соленоида задней тяги на аккумулятор Код Описание
H2406
Замыкание соленоида задней тяги на массу
H2407
Обрыв цепи соленоида задней тяги
H2432
Перегрузка соленоида задней тяги
H2505
Короткое замыкание дивертора №2 на аккумуляторную батарею
H2506
Дивертер №2, замыкающий на землю
H2507
Обрыв цепи дивертора №2
H2605
Замыкание переднего базового соленоида на напряжение аккумулятора
H2606
Замыкание переднего базового соленоида на массу
H2607
Обрыв цепи переднего базового соленоида
H2632
Перегрузка переднего базового соленоида
H2705
Замыкание соленоида передней тяги на напряжение аккумулятора
H2706
Замыкание соленоида передней тяги на массу
H2707
Обрыв цепи соленоида передней тяги
H2732
Перегрузка соленоида передней тяги
H2805
Замыкание электромагнитного клапана дивертора на напряжение аккумулятора
H2806
Замыкание электромагнитного клапана дивертора на массу
H2807
Обрыв цепи электромагнитного клапана дивертора
H2905
Электромагнитный клапан высокого расхода: замыкание на аккумуляторную батарею
H2906
Замыкание соленоида высокого потока на массу
H2907
Обрыв цепи соленоида высокого расхода
H2932
Перегрузка по току соленоида с высоким расходом
H3028
Сбой памяти вспомогательного контроллера
H3128
Прерывистый сбой питания
H3648
Наличие нескольких Acds (устройство управления навесным оборудованием)
H3904
Левый джойстик неисправен
H3912
Большой палец на левом джойстике не в нейтральном положении
H3913
Левый джойстик захвата (нет связи)
H3916
Левый джойстик базы (нет связи)
H3928
Внутренняя неисправность левого джойстика
H3948
Левый джойстик несколько
H4004
Правый джойстик неисправен
H4012
Большой палец на правом джойстике не в нейтральном положении
H4013
Правая ручка джойстика (нет связи)
H4016
Правая консоль джойстика (нет связи)
H4028
Внутренняя неисправность правого джойстика
H4048
Правый джойстик несколько
H4302
Реле звукового сигнала — ошибочное включение
H4303
Реле звукового сигнала — ошибочное выключение
H4423
Вспомогательный контроллер не запрограммирован
H4497
Вспомогательный контроллер запрограммирован
H4502
Правый указатель поворота — ошибочное включение
H4503
Правый указатель поворота — ошибочное выключение
H4602
Левый поворотник — ошибочное включене
H4603
Левый поворотник — ошибочное выключение
H4721
Напряжение питания датчика 8 В выше допустимого диапазона
H4722
Питание датчика 8 В ниже допустимого диапазона
H7404
Контроллер шлюза (нет связи)
H7604
Левая панель дисплея Нет кода связи Описание
L0102
Кнопка освещения — ошибочное включение
L0202
Кнопка высокого расхода — ошибочное включение
L0302
Вспомогательная кнопка — ошибочное включение
L0402
Инфорсационная кнопка — ошибочное включение
L7404
Контроллер шлюза (нет связи)
L7672
Ошибка программирования левой панели
M0116
Воздушный фильтр не подключен
M0117
Засорен воздушный фильтр
M0216
Фильтр гидравлического агрегата не подключен
M0217
Засорен фильтр гидравлического агрегата
M0309
Низкое напряжение батареи
M0310
Напряжение аккумулятора высокое
M0311
Напряжение аккумулятора очень высокое
M0314
Напряжение батареи крайне низкое
M0322
Напряжение аккумулятора ниже допустимого диапазона
M0409
Давление моторного масла низкое
M0414
Предельно низкое давление моторного масла
M0415
Давление моторного масла при остановке
M0421
Давление моторного масла вне допустимого диапазона
M0422
Давление моторного масла ниже допустимого диапазона
M0509
Низкое давление наддува гидросистемы
M0510
Гидравлическое давление наддува высокое
M0511
Предельно высокое гидравлическое давление наддува
M0514
Предельно низкое гидравлическое давление наддува
M0515
Гидравлическое давление наддува при останове
M0521
Гидравлическое давление наддува выше допустимого диапазона
M0522
Гидравлическое давление наддува ниже допустимого диапазона
M0610
Обороты двигателя высокая
M0611
Предельно высокие обороты двигателя
M0613
Нет сигнала оборотов двигателя
M0615
Обороты двигателя при остановке
M0618
Обороты двигателя вне допустимого диапазона
M0634
Недействительная информация об оборотах двигателя от ЭБУ
M0710
Высокая температура гидравлического масла
M0711
Предельно высокая температура гидравлического масла
M0715
Температура гидравлического масла при останове
M0721
Температура гидравлического масла вне допустимого диапазона
M0722
Температура гидравлического масла вне допустимого диапазона, низкая
M0810
Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
M0811
Предельно высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
M0815
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя при остановке
M0821
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя вне допустимого диапазона
M0822
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя вне допустимого диапазона, низкая
M0826
Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя перед остановкой
M0909
Низкий уровень топлива M4110 Высокое напряжение генератора
M0921
Уровень топлива выше допустимого диапазона
M0922
Уровень топлива ниже допустимого диапазона
M1016
Гидравлический заправочный фильтр не подключен
M1017
Засорен гидравлический заправочный фильтр
M1121
Датчик дуги безопасности выше допустимого диапазона
M1122
Датчик дуги безопасности ниже допустимого диапазона
M1128
Отказ датчика подседельного штыря
M1305
Замыкание катушки отключения подачи топлива на аккумулятор
M1306
Замыкание катушки отключения подачи топлива на массу
M1307
Разрыв цепи соленоида удержания топлива
M1402
Соленоид втягивания топлива — ошибочное включение
M1403
Соленоид втягивания топлива — ошибочное включение
M1407
Разрыв цепи соленоида втягивания топлива
M1428
Сбой соленоида втягивания топлива
M1502
Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги — ошибочное включение
M1503
Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги — ошибочное выключение
M1507
Разрыв цепи выхода соленоида втягивания блокировки тяги
M1528
Сбой втягивающего соленоида блокировки тяги
M1605
Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на батарею
M1606
Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на заземление
M1607
Разрыв цепи удерживающего соленоида блокировки тяги
M1705
Гидравлический запорный клапан замкнут на батарею
M1706
Гидравлический запорный клапан замкнут на землю
M1707
Разрыв цепи гидравлического запорного клапана
M1732
Перегрузка по току гидравлического запорного клапана
M1805
Выход соленоида золотника замкнут на батарею
M1806
Выход соленоида золотника замкнут на землю
M1807
Разрыв цепи выхода соленоида золотника
M1832
Перегрузка по току выхода соленоида золотника
M2005
Двухскоростной первичный соленоид замкнут на батарею
M2006
Двухскоростной первичный соленоид замкнут на землю
M2007
Разрыв цепи двухскоростного первичного соленоида
M2032
Перегрузка по току в двухскоростном первичном соленоиде
M2102
Выход свечей накаливания — ошибочное включение
M2103
Выход свечей накаливания — ошибочное выключение
M2107
Выход свечей накаливания, разрыв цепи
M2128
Сбой на выходе свечей накаливания
M2202
Ошибочное включение выхода стартера
M2203
Ошибочное выключение выхода стартера
M2207
Обрыв цепи выхода стартера
M2228
Сбой на выходе стартера
M2302
Реле стартера — ошибочное включение
M2303
Реле стартера — ошибочное выключение
M2307
Обрыв цепи реле стартера
M2402
Реле втягивания топлива — ошибочное включение
M2403
Реле втягивания топлива — ошибочное выключение
M2407
Обрыв цепи выхода подачи топлива
M2502
Реле блокировки тягового усилия — ошибочное включение
M2503
Тяговое реле блокировки тяги — ошибочное выключение
M2507
Обрыв цепи выхода блокировки тягового усилия
M2602
Реле свечей накаливания — ошибочное включение
M2603
Реле свечей накаливания — ошибочное выключение
M2607
Обрыв цепи выхода свечи предпускового подогрева
M2721
Сигнал первичного датчика дросселя за верхней границей диапазона
M2722
Сигнал первичного датчика дросселя за нижней границей диапазона
M2805
Замыкание выхода вспомогательной блокировки на аккумулятор
M2806
Замыкание выхода вспомогательной блокировки на массу
M2807
Обрыв цепи выхода вспомогательной блокировки
M2821
Сигнал вторичного датчика дросселя за верхней границей диапазона
M2822
Сигнал вторичного датчика дросселя за нижней границей диапазона
M3028
Отказ памяти контроллера
M3128
Неисправность режима восстановления
M3204
ACS (AHC), нет сообщений контроллеру Bobcat
M3304
Нет связи с панелью Deluxe
M3323
Контроллер шлюза не запрограммирован
M3404
Панель Deluxe в состоянии ошибки
M3505
Вентилятор гидравлики замкнут на батарею
M3506
Вентилятор гидравлики замкнут на землю
M3507
Разрыв цепи вентилятора гидравлики
M3532
Перегрузка по току вентилятора гидравлики
M3648
Наличие нескольких Acds (устройство управления навесным оборудованием)
M3705
Выход двухскоростной вторичной обмотки замкнут на батарею
M3706
Выход двухскоростной вторичной обмотки замкнут на землю
M3707
Разрыв цепи выхода двухскоростной вторичной обмотки
M3732
Перегрузка по току выхода двухскоростной вторичной обмотки
M3805
Блокировка доп. гидравлики замкнута на батарею
M3806
Блокировка доп.гидравлики замкнута на землю
M3807
Разрыв цепи блокировки доп.гидравлики
M3832
Перегрузка по току блокировки доп.гидравлики
M4028
Обнаружен неправильный ЭБУ
M4109
Предельно низкая мощность генератора
M4110
Высокая скорость генератора
M4111
Предельно высокая мощность генератора
M4304
Нет связи с кнопочной панелью
M4404
Нет сигнала от доп. гидравлики
M4510
Вода в датчике топлива слишком высока
M4511
Вода в датчике топлива предельно высока
M4521
Вода в датчике топлива за верхней границей диапазона
M4522
Вода в датчике топлива за нижней границей диапазона
M4621
Питание 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
M4622
Питание 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
M4721
Питание 8-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
M4722
Питание 8-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
M4802
Реле переднего света, ошибочное включение
M4803
Реле переднего света, ошибочное выключение
M4807
Обрыв цепи выхода переднего фонаря
M4902
Реле заднего света, ошибочное включение
M4903
Реле заднего света, ошибочное выключение
M4907
Обрыв цепи выхода заднего фонаря
M5002
Выход переднего фонаря, ошибочное включение
M5003
Выход переднего фонаря, ошибочное выключение
M5007
Разрыв цепи выхода передних фар
M5028
Неисправность выхода передних фар
M5102
Выход фонарей заднего света, ошибочное включение
M5103
Выход фонарей заднего света, ошибочное выключение
M5107
Разрыв цепи выхода задних фар
M5128
Неисправность выхода задних фар
M5202
Кнопка включения погрузчика, ошибочное включение
M5221
Кнопка включения погрузчика за верхней границей диапазона
M5222
Кнопка включения погрузчика за нижней границей диапазона
M5305
Подсветка кнопки включения погрузчика замкнута на батарею
M5306
Подсветка кнопки включения погрузчика замкнута на землю
M5405
Соленоид золотника наклона замкнут на батарею
M5406
Соленоид золотника наклона замкнут на землю
M5407
Разрыв цепи соленоида золотника наклона
M5432
Перегрузка по току соленоида золотника наклона
M5810
Слишком высокая температура топлива
M5811
Предельно высокая температура топлива
M5815
Температура топлива при останове
M5826
Предварительное отключение по температуре топлива
M5902
Выключатель регенерации DPF, ошибочное включение
M6002
Выключатель регенерации при замедлении DPF, ошибочное включение
M6102
Выключатель регенерации при удаленной парковке, ошибочное включение
M6402
Ошибочное включение реле мощности
M6403
Ошибочное выключение реле мощности
M6407
Обрыв цепи коммутируемой выходной мощности
M6505
Питание ECU замкнуто на батарею
M6506
Питание ECU замкнуто на землю
M6507
Разрыв цепи питания ECU
M6604
Отсутствие связи с ECU
M6702
Ошибочное включение выхода системы HVAC
M6703
Ошибочное выключение выхода системы HVAC
M6707
Разрыв цепи выхода системы HVAC
M6728
Сбой на выходе системы HVAC
M6802
Ошибочное включение реле системы HVAC
M6803
Ошибочное выключение реле системы HVAC
M7002
Выход импульсного источника питания, ошибочное включение
M7003
Выход импульсного источника питания, ошибочное выключение
M7007
Выход импульсного источника питания, разрыв цепи
M7028
Ошибка на выходе импульсного источника питания
M7304
Дистанционное управление — отсутствует сигнал
M7316
Дистанционное управление, нет сообщений датчику
M7423
Главный контроллер не запрограммирован
M7472
Главный контроллер нуждается в программировании
M7497
Главный контроллер запрограммирован
M7504
Нет сигнала от привода
M7604
Нет связи с левой панелью дисплея
M7748
Замок зажигания, многорежимный
M7839
Значение счетчика моточасов изменено
M7974
Дверь открыта
M8541
Автоматическая регенерация DPF активна
M8542
Автоматическая регенерация DPF активна (включать погрузчик под нагрузкой)
M8543
Главный контроллер не запрограммирован
M8551
Необходима регенерация DPF – замедление активно
M8552
Необходима регенерация DPF – замедление активно (включать погрузчик под нагрузкой)
M8553
Требуется регенерация DPF при удаленной парковке (требуется комплект удаленной регенерации)
M8554
Требуется регенерация DPF при обслуживании (обратиться к дилеру Bobcat)
M8555
Требуется услуга DPF
M8560
Регенерация службы DPF активна
M8561
Регенерация службы DPF активна
M8562
Регенерация службы DPF активна
M8563
Регенерация службы DPF активна
M8564
Регенерация службы DPF активна
M8615
Снижение скорости двигателя при выключении
M8625
Обороты двигателя снижается, не отвечает
P0117
Датчик температуры охлаждающей жидкости двигателя ниже допустимого диапазона
P0118
Датчик температуры охлаждающей жидкости двигателя выше допустимого диапазона
P0119
Прерывистый сигнал датчика температуры охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
P0122
Датчик акселератора ниже допустимого диапазона
P0123
Датчик акселератора выше допустимого диапазона
P0124
Прерывистое подключение датчика акселератора
P0217
Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
P0340
Нет сигнала датчика частоты вращения двигателя
P0562
Низкое напряжение батареи
P0563
Напряжение аккумулятора высокое
P0605
E-ecu Internal Flashrom Checksum Error A (основное программное обеспечение)
P0634
Высокий уровень сигнала датчика температуры электронного блока управления
P0642
Питание датчика 5 В ниже допустимого диапазона
P0643
Напряжение питания датчика 5 В выше допустимого диапазона
P0668
Датчик температуры E-ecu ниже допустимого диапазона
P0669
Датчик температуры электронного блока управления выше допустимого диапазона
P1202
Датчик положения стойки ниже допустимого диапазона
P1203
Датчик положения стойки выше допустимого диапазона
P1211
Застрял соленоид привода стойки
P1212
Минимальный ток соленоида привода стойки
P1213
Перегрузка по току соленоида привода стойки
P1222
Реле привода стойки — ошибочное включение
P1223
Реле привода стойки — ошибочное выключение
P1224
Прерывистое соединение реле привода стойки
P1232
Реле предварительного нагрева — ошибочное включение
P1233
Реле предварительного нагрева — ошибочное выключение
P1234
Прерывистое соединение реле подогрева
P1242
Электромагнитный клапан CSD — ошибочное включение
P1243
Электромагнитный клапан CSD — ошибочное выключение
P1244
Прерывистое соединение электромагнитного клапана Csd
P1402
EGR-клапан Фаза A — ошибочное включение
P1403
EGR-клапан Фаза A — ошибочное выключение
P1412
EGR-клапан Фаза B — ошибочное включение
P1413
EGR-клапан Фаза B — ошибочное выключение
P1422
EGR-клапан Фаза C — ошибочное включение
P1423
EGR-клапан Фаза C — ошибочное выключение
P1432
EGR-клапан Фаза D — ошибочное включение
P1433
EGR-клапан Фаза D — ошибочное выключение
P1605
E-ecu Internal Flashrom Checksum Error B (основное программное обеспечение)
P1606
Ошибка контрольной суммы внутренней флеш-памяти E-ecu C (основное программное обеспечение)
P1644
Прерывистое соединение питания датчика 5 В
P1664
Прерывистое подключение датчика температуры E-ecu
R7404
Нет связи с главным контроллером
T9002
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘c’ — ошибочное включение
T9003
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘c’ — ошибочное выключение
T9102
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘d’ — ошибочное включение
T9103
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘d’ — ошибочное выключение
T9202
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘e’ — ошибочное включение
T9203
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘e’ — ошибочное выключение
T9302
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘f’ — ошибочное включение
T9303
Cервисный инструмент выход ‘f’ — ошибочное выключение
W3204
ACS (AHS) (нет связи) с контроллером Bobcat
W3223
Контроллер ACS не откалиброван
W3224
Калибровка контроллера ACS выполнена успешно
W3225
Ошибка калибровки контроллера ACS
W3231
ACS Tilt Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода наклона ACS)
W3232
Электропроводка привода наклона ACS (AHS)
W3233
Электропроводка ручки наклона ACS (AHS)
W3234
Привод наклона ACS не в нейтральном положении
W3235
Ручка / педаль наклона ACS не в нейтральном положении
W3236
ACS Lift Actuator Fault (Неисправность привода лифта ACS)
W3237
Электропроводка привода лифта ACS (AHS)
W3238
Электропроводка ручки подъемника ACS (AHS)
W3239
Привод лифта ACS не в нейтральном положении (только ACS)
W3240
Рукоятка подъема ACS (AHC)/педаль не в
нейтральном положении
W3241
Отсутствие связи с ACS (AHC)
W3249
Исполнительный механизм подъема ACS (AHC)
замкнут на землю
W3250
Исполнительный механизм наклона ACS (AHC)
замкнут на землю
W3251
Исполнительный механизм подъема ACS (AHC)
замкнут на батарею
W3252
Исполнительный механизм наклона ACS (AHC)
замкнут на батарею
W3253
Рукоятка подъема ACS (AHC) / педаль замкнута на
землю
W3254
Рукоятка наклона ACS (AHC) / педаль замкнута на
землю
W3255
Рукоятка наклона ACS (AHC) / педаль замкнута на
батарею
W3256
Рукоятка наклона ACS (AHC) / педаль замкнута на
батарею
W3257
Пониженная производительность исполнительного
механизма подъема ACS (AHC)
W3258
Пониженная производительность исполнительного
механизма наклона ACS (AHC)
W3259
Неправильное направление исполнительного
механизма подъема ACS (AHC)
W3260
Неправильное направление исполнительного
механизма наклона ACS (AHC)
W3261
Блокиратор рукоятки ACS (AHC) замкнут на землю
W3262
Блокиратор рукоятки ACS (AHC) замкнут на
батарею
W3263
Блокиратор педали ACS (AHC) замкнут на землю
W3264
Блокиратор педали ACS (AHC) замкнут на батарею
W3265
Напряжение питания датчика ACS (AHC) вне
допустимых пределов
W3266
Напряжение батареи ACS (AHC) вне допустимых
пределов
W3267
Переключатель ACS (AHC) переключился во время
работы
W3268
Информационная ошибка рукоятки подъема ACS
(AHC)
W3269
Переключатель режима управления ACS (AHS) переключается во время работы
W3270
Рукоятка правого привода ACS (AHC) замкнута на
землю
W3271
Рукоятка правого привода ACS (AHC) замкнута на
батарею
W3274
Ось X левого джойстика ACS (AHC) вне
допустимых пределов
W3275
Прерванное некоммутируемое питание ACS (AHC)
W3276
Информационная ошибка джойстика CAN, ACS
(AHC)
W3277
Информационная ошибка дистанционного
управления, ACS (AHC)
W3297
Контроллер ACS (AHC) запрограммирован
W3905
Ось Х левого джойстика не в нейтральном
положении
W4005
Ось X правого джойстика не в нейтральном
положении
W4007
Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном
положении
Коды ошибок мини погрузчиков Bobcat помогут вам идентифицировать неисправный исполнительный механизм и быстрее произвести ремонт отказавшего механизма как ДВС, так и гидравлической системы
Расшифровка кодов ошибок Bobcat
КОД | ОПИСАНИЕ |
01-16 | Не подсоединен воздушный фильтр |
01-17 | Засорен воздушный фильтр |
02-16 | Не подсоединен гидравлический нагнетательный фильтр |
02-17 | Засорен гидравлический нагнетательный фильтр |
03-09 | Низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-10 | Высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-11 | Предельно высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-14 | Предельно низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи |
03-22 | Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи ниже предельно допустимого |
04-09 | Низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе |
04-14 | Предельно низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе |
04-15 | Давление масла в двигателе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
04-21 | Давление масла в двигателе выше предельно допустимого |
04-22 | Давление масла в двигателе ниже предельно допустимого |
05-09 | Низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе |
05-14 | Предельно низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе |
05-15 | Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
05-21 | Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимого |
05-22 | Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимого |
06-10 | Высокие обороты двигателя |
06-11 | Предельно высокие обороты двигателя |
06-13 | Отсутствует сигнал оборотов двигателя |
06-15 | Обороты двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
06-18 | Обороты двигателя вне допустимых пределов |
07-10 | Высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе |
07-11 | Предельно высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе |
07-15 | Температура масла в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
07-21 | Температура масла в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимой |
07-22 | Температура масла в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимой |
08-10 | Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя |
08-11 | Предельно высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя |
08-15 | Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя |
08-21 | Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя выше предельно допустимой |
08-22 | Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя ниже предельно допустимой |
09-09 | Низкий уровень топлива |
09-21 | Уровень топлива выше предельно допустимого |
09-22 | Уровень топлива ниже предельно допустимого |
11-05 | Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на батарею |
11-06 | Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на массу |
12-21 | Сигнал ШИМ-контроллера передней доп. гидравлики за верхней границей диапазона |
12-22 | ШИМ-контроллер передней доп. гидравлики за нижней границей диапазона |
12-23 | ШИМ-контроллер передней доп. гидравлики не в нейтральном положении |
13-05 | Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на батарею |
13-06 | Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на массу |
13-07 | Разрыв цепи соленоида отсечки топлива |
14-02 | Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное включение |
14-03 | Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное выключение |
15-02 | Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное включение |
15-03 | Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное выключение |
16-05 | Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на батарею |
16-06 | Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на массу |
16-07 | Разрыв цепи удерживающего соленоида блокировки тяги |
17-05 | Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на батарею |
17-06 | Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на массу |
17-07 | Разрыв цепи соленоида гидравлического запорного клапана |
18-05 | Соленоид золотника замкнут на батарею |
18-06 | Соленоид золотника замкнут на массу |
18-07 | Разрыв цепи соленоида золотника |
19-02 | Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное включение |
19-03 | Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное выключение |
20-02 | Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное включение |
20-03 | Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное выключение |
21-02 | Свечи накаливания, ошибочное включение |
21-03 | Свечи накаливания, ошибочное выключение |
22-02 | Стартер, ошибочное включение |
22-03 | Стартер, ошибочное выключение |
23-02 | Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное включение |
23-03 | Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное выключение |
24-02 | Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное включение |
24-03 | Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное выключение |
25-02 | Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное включение |
25-03 | Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное выключение |
26-02 | Ошибочное включение переднего базового соленоида |
26-03 | Ошибочное выключение переднего базового соленоида |
27-02 | Ошибочное включение переднего штокового соленоида |
27-03 | Ошибочное выключение переднего штокового соленоида |
28-02 | Ошибочное включение соленоида дивертера |
28-03 | Ошибочное выключение соленоида дивертера |
29-02 | Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное включение |
29-03 | Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное выключение |
30-28 | Отказ памяти контроллера |
31-28 | Неисправность режима восстановления |
32-04 | Расширенное управление (ACS) не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat |
32-23 | Расширенное управление ACS не откалибровано |
32-31 | Отказ исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-32 | Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-33 | Неисправность электропроводки рукоятки наклона ковша |
32-34 | Исполнительный механизм наклона не в нейтральном положении |
32-35 | Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша не в нейтральном положении |
32-36 | Отказ исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-37 | Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-38 | Неисправность электропроводки рукоятки подъема стрелы |
32-39 | Исполнительный механизм подъема не в нейтральном положении |
32-40 | Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы не в нейтральном положении |
32-41 | Нет связи |
32-49 | Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на массу |
32-50 | Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на массу |
32-51 | Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на батарею |
32-52 | Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на батарею |
32-53 | Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на массу |
32-54 | Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша замкнута на массу |
32-55 | Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на батарею |
32-56 | Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша замкнута на батарею |
32-57 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-58 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-59 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема |
32-60 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма наклона |
32-61 | Блокиратор рукояток замкнут на массу |
32-62 | Блокиратор рукояток замкнут на батарею |
32-63 | Цепь блокиратора педалей замкнута на массу |
32-64 | Цепь блокиратора педалей замкнута на батарею |
32-65 | Напряжение питания датчика вне допустимых пределов |
32-66 | Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи вне допустимых пределов |
32-67 | Переключатель переключился во время работы |
32-68 | Информационная ошибка рукоятки подъема стрелы |
32-69 | Переключатель режимов управления переключился во время работы |
32-70 | Цепь правой рукоятки движения замкнута на массу |
32-71 | Цепь правой рукоятки движения замкнута на батарею |
33-23 | Главный контроллер (контроллер Bobcat) не запрограммирован |
34-04 | Панель с кнопочным запуском не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat |
35-02 | Двухскоростной переключатель вентилятора, ошибочное включение |
35-03 | Двухскоростной переключатель вентилятора, ошибочное выключение |
36-48 | Подключено несколько контроллеров ACD |
37-02 | Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное включение |
37-03 | Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное выключение |
38-04 | Нет связи с контроллером джойстика |
38-05 | Ось Х левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-06 | Ось X правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-07 | Ось Y левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-08 | Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении |
38-09 | Переключатель режимов управления — замыкание на батарею или на массу |
38-11 | Исполнительный механизм подъема не в нейтральном положении |
38-12 | Исполнительный механизм наклона не в нейтральном положении |
38-13 | Отказ исполнительного механизма подъема |
38-14 | Отказ исполнительного механизма наклона |
38-15 | Неисправность проводки управления скоростью правого колеса |
38-16 | Неисправность проводки для скорости левого колеса |
38-17 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона |
38-18 | Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема |
38-19 | Ось X левого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона |
38-20 | Ось X правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-21 | Ось Y левого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона |
38-22 | Ось Y правого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона |
38-23 | Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-24 | Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-25 | Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-26 | Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона |
38-27 | Сигнал исполнительного механизма подъема за верхней границей диапазона |
38-28 | Сигнал исполнительного механизма наклона за верхней границей диапазона |
38-29 | Ось X левого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-30 | Ось X правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-31 | Ось Y левого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-32 | Ось Y правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-33 | Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-34 | Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-35 | Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-36 | Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона |
38-37 | Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-38 | Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона |
38-39 | Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на массу / за нижней границей диапазона |
38-40 | Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на массу / сигнал за нижней границей диапазона |
38-41 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма наклона |
38-42 | Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема |
38-43 | Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное включение |
38-44 | Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение |
38-45 | Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное включение |
38-46 | Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение |
38-47 | Передний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-48 | Передний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-49 | Задний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-50 | Задний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение |
38-51 | Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное включение |
38-52 | Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное включение |
38-53 | Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-54 | Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-55 | Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-56 | Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение |
38-57 | Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-58 | Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-59 | Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-60 | Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-61 | Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-62 | Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-63 | Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение |
38-64 | Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение |
38-65 | Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное выключение |
38-66 | Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное выключение |
38-67 | Нет сообщений от контроллера Bobcat |
38-68 | Углы установки колес (выравнивание) не откалиброваны |
38-69 | Исполнительные механизмы подъема и наклона не откалиброваны |
38-70 | Отключение питания |
38-71 | Напряжение батареи вне допустимых пределов |
38-72 | Насос привода не откалиброван |
38-73 | Переключатель режима управления/режима движения переключился во время работы |
38-74 | Скорость неуправляемого правого колеса, ошибочное включение |
38-75 | Скорость неуправляемого левого колеса, ошибочное включение |
38-76 | Соленоид давления системы управления — недостаточный ток |
38-77 | Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-78 | Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-79 | Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-80 | Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-81 | Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-82 | Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-83 | Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток |
38-84 | Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток |
38-85 | Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона |
38-86 | Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона |
38-87 | Блокировка правого переднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления) |
38-88 | Блокировка левого переднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления) |
38-89 | Блокировка правого заднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления) |
38-90 | Ошибка заднего левого управления |
38-91 | Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости правого колеса |
38-92 | Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости левого колеса |
38-93 | Датчик скорости правого колеса не отвечает |
38-94 | Датчик скорости левого колеса не отвечает |
38-98 | Контроллер в режиме калибровки привода |
38-99 | Контроллер в режиме калибровки положения колеса |
45-03 | Правый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение |
46-02 | Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное включение |
46-03 | Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение |
47-21 | Питание 8-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона |
47-22 | Питание 8-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона |
48-02 | Реле переднего света, ошибочное включение |
48-03 | Реле переднего света, ошибочное выключение |
49-02 | Реле заднего света, ошибочное включение |
49-03 | Реле заднего света, ошибочное выключение |
60-21 | Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за верхней границей диапазона |
60-22 | Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за нижней границей диапазона |
60-23 | Рычаг управления задней доп. гидравликой не возвращается в нейтральное положение |
64-02 | Ошибочное включение реле мощности |
64-03 | Ошибочное выключение реле мощности |
74-72 | Сбой загрузочного кода контроллера Bobcat |
74-73 | Левая панель, ошибка приемного устройства |
80-02 | ACD, выход «A», ошибочное включение |
80-03 | ACD, выход «A», ошибочное выключение |
81-02 | ACD, выход «B», ошибочное включение |
81-03 | ACD, выход «B», ошибочное выключение |
82-02 | ACD, выход «C», ошибочное включение |
82-03 | ACD, выход «C», ошибочное выключение |
83-02 | ACD, выход «D», ошибочное включение |
83-03 | ACD, выход «D», ошибочное выключение |
84-02 | ACD, выход «E», ошибочное включение |
84-03 | ACD, выход «E», ошибочное выключение |
90-02 | Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное включение |
90-03 | Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное выключение |
91-02 | Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное включение |
91-03 | Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное выключение |
92-02 | Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное включение |
92-03 | Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное выключение |
93-02 | Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное включение |
93-03 | Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное выключение |
- Подробности
- Создано 22.10.2012 21:19
- Просмотров: 32628
Диагностические служебные коды (коды ошибок) Bobcat
ПРОСМОТР СЛУЖЕБНЫХ КОДОВ
ДЛЯ МОДЕЛЕЙ С ЗАМКОМ ЗАЖИГАНИЯ
Чтобы просмотреть служебные коды на ДИСПЛЕЕ СЧЕТЧИКА МОТОЧАСОВ И КОДОВ (2) (см. рисунок), нажмите кнопку «LIGHTS» (ФАРЫ) (1) и удерживайте ее нажатой в течение двух секунд.
При наличии нескольких служебных кодов они будут отображаться на ДИСПЛЕЕ СЧЕТЧИКА МОТОЧАСОВ И КОДОВ один за другим.
ПРИМЕЧАНИЕ: Пораженное коррозией или ослабленное соединение с массой может стать причиной выдачи многочисленных служебных кодов и/или появления симптомов неисправностей. Мигание всех индикаторов приборной панели, звучание сигнала тревоги, мигание передних и задних осветительных приборов могут указывать на плохое соединение с массой. Те же самые симптомы могут появиться при низком напряжении (например вследствие ослабленного крепления или коррозии проводов аккумулятора). Если Вы заметите такие симптомы, прежде всего проверьте соединение с массой и положительные провода.
ДЛЯ МОДЕЛЕЙ С КНОПОЧНЫМ ЗАПУСКОМ
Нажмите TOOL/SETUP (ИНСТРУМЕНТ/НАСТРОЙКА)
Нажмите OWNER UTILITIES (ИНСТРУМЕНТЫ ПОЛЬЗОВАТЕЛЯ)
Введите ПАРОЛЬ (системный или основной) с клавиатуры и нажмите ENTER (ВВОД) для подтверждения
Нажмите SERVICE CODES (СЛУЖЕБНЫЕ КОДЫ)
Нажмите NEXT (ДАЛЕЕ) для просмотра следующих 8 служебных кодов (всего можно сохранить до 40 кодов.)
На дисплей выводятся код (CODE), показание счетчика моточасов на момент появления неисправности (HOUR) и имя пользователя (USER), работавшего на погрузчике в момент появления неисправности.
ПЕРЕЧЕНЬ СЛУЖЕБНЫХ КОДОВ
ДАННЫЙ ТЕКСТ ДОСТУПЕН ТОЛЬКО ДЛЯ АВТОРИЗОВАННЫХ ПОЛЬЗОВАТЕЛЕЙ САЙТА
Bobcat-club, 2012
КОД ОПИСАНИЕ
01-16 Не подсоединен воздушный фильтр
01-17 Засорен воздушный фильтр
02-16 Не подсоединен гидравлический нагнетательный фильтр
02-17 Засорен гидравлический нагнетательный фильтр
03-09 Низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-10 Высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-11 Предельно высокое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-14 Предельно низкое напряжение аккумуляторной батареи
03-22 Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи ниже предельно допустимого
04-09 Низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе
04-14 Предельно низкий уровень давления масла в двигателе
04-15 Давление масла в двигателе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
04-21 Давление масла в двигателе выше предельно допустимого
04-22 Давление масла в двигателе ниже предельно допустимого
05-09 Низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе
05-14 Предельно низкое давление подпитки в гидравлической системе
05-15 Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
05-21 Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимого
05-22 Давление подпитки в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимого
06-10 Высокие обороты двигателя
06-11 Предельно высокие обороты двигателя
06-13 Отсутствует сигнал оборотов двигателя
06-15 Обороты двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
06-18 Обороты двигателя вне допустимых пределов
07-10 Высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе
07-11 Предельно высокая температура масла в гидравлической системе
07-15 Температура масла в гидравлической системе на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
07-21 Температура масла в гидравлической системе выше предельно допустимой
07-22 Температура масла в гидравлической системе ниже предельно допустимой
08-10 Высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
08-11 Предельно высокая температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя
08-15 Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя на уровне экстренного выключения двигателя
08-21 Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя выше предельно допустимой
08-22 Температура охлаждающей жидкости двигателя ниже предельно допустимой
09-09 Низкий уровень топлива
09-21 Уровень топлива выше предельно допустимого
09-22 Уровень топлива ниже предельно допустимого
11-05 Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на батарею
11-06 Датчик рамы безопасности замкнут на массу
12-21 Сигнал ШИМ-контроллера передней доп. гидравлики за верхней границей диапазона
12-22 ШИМ-контроллер передней доп. гидравлики за нижней границей диапазона
12-23 ШИМ-контроллер передней доп. гидравлики не в нейтральном положении
6691498 12V запорный остановочный соленоид для Bobcat .Бесплатная доставка. 2500 руб. КУПИТЬ
13-05 Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на батарею
13-06 Удерживающий соленоид отсечки топлива замкнут на массу
13-07 Разрыв цепи соленоида отсечки топлива
14-02 Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное включение
14-03 Втягивающий соленоид отсечки топлива, ошибочное выключение
15-02 Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное включение
15-03 Втягивающий соленоид блокировки тяги, ошибочное выключение
16-05 Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на батарею
16-06 Удерживающий соленоид блокировки тяги замкнут на массу
16-07 Разрыв цепи удерживающего соленоида блокировки тяги
17-05 Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на батарею
17-06 Соленоид гидравлического запорного клапана замкнут на массу
17-07 Разрыв цепи соленоида гидравлического запорного клапана
18-05 Соленоид золотника замкнут на батарею
18-06 Соленоид золотника замкнут на массу
18-07 Разрыв цепи соленоида золотника
19-02 Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное включение
19-03 Соленоид позиционирования ковша, ошибочное выключение
20-02 Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное включение
20-03 Соленоид переключения скоростей, ошибочное выключение
21-02 Свечи накаливания, ошибочное включение
21-03 Свечи накаливания, ошибочное выключение
22-02 Стартер, ошибочное включение
22-03 Стартер, ошибочное выключение
23-02 Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное включение
23-03 Задний базовый соленоид, ошибочное выключение
24-02 Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное включение
24-03 Задний штоковый соленоид, ошибочное выключение
25-02 Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное включение
25-03 Задний вспомогательный пропорциональный соленоид, ошибочное выключение
26-02 Ошибочное включение переднего базового соленоида
26-03 Ошибочное выключение переднего базового соленоида
27-02 Ошибочное включение переднего штокового соленоида
27-03 Ошибочное выключение переднего штокового соленоида
28-02 Ошибочное включение соленоида дивертера
28-03 Ошибочное выключение соленоида дивертера
29-02 Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное включение
29-03 Соленоид большой подачи, ошибочное выключение
30-28 Отказ памяти контроллера
31-28 Неисправность режима восстановления
32-04 Расширенное управление (ACS) не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat
32-23 Расширенное управление ACS не откалибровано
32-31 Отказ исполнительного механизма наклона
32-32 Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма наклона
32-33 Неисправность электропроводки рукоятки наклона ковша
32-34 Исполнительный механизм наклона не в нейтральном положении
32-35 Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша не в нейтральном положении
32-36 Отказ исполнительного механизма подъема
32-37 Неисправность электропроводки исполнительного механизма подъема
32-38 Неисправность электропроводки рукоятки подъема стрелы
32-39 Исполнительный механизм подъема не в нейтральном положении
32-40 Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы не в нейтральном положении
32-41 Нет связи
32-49 Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на массу
32-50 Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на массу
32-51 Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на батарею
32-52 Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на батарею
32-53 Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на массу
32-54 Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша замкнута на массу
32-55 Рукоятка / педаль подъема стрелы замкнута на батарею
32-56 Рукоятка / педаль наклона ковша замкнута на батарею
32-57 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема
32-58 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона
32-59 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема
32-60 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма наклона
32-61 Блокиратор рукояток замкнут на массу
32-62 Блокиратор рукояток замкнут на батарею
32-63 Цепь блокиратора педалей замкнута на массу
32-64 Цепь блокиратора педалей замкнута на батарею
32-65 Напряжение питания датчика вне допустимых пределов
32-66 Напряжение аккумуляторной батареи вне допустимых пределов
32-67 Переключатель переключился во время работы
32-68 Информационная ошибка рукоятки подъема стрелы
32-69 Переключатель режимов управления переключился во время работы
32-70 Цепь правой рукоятки движения замкнута на массу
32-71 Цепь правой рукоятки движения замкнута на батарею
33-23 Главный контроллер (контроллер Bobcat) не запрограммирован
34-04 Панель с кнопочным запуском не сообщается с контроллером Bobcat
Рычаг стеклоочистителя и лезвие 7188371 и 7188372 для Bobcat.БЕСПЛАТНАЯ ДОСТАВКА. 2900 руб
35-02 Двухскоростной переключатель вентилятора, ошибочное включение
35-03 Двухскоростной переключатель вентилятора, ошибочное выключение
36-48 Подключено несколько контроллеров ACD
37-02 Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное включение
37-03 Двухскоростной дополнительный переключатель скоростей, ошибочное выключение
38-04 Нет связи с контроллером джойстика
38-05 Ось Х левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-06 Ось X правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-07 Ось Y левого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-08 Ось Y правого джойстика не в нейтральном положении
38-09 Переключатель режимов управления — замыкание на батарею или на массу
38-11 Исполнительный механизм подъема не в нейтральном положении
38-12 Исполнительный механизм наклона не в нейтральном положении
38-13 Отказ исполнительного механизма подъема
38-14 Отказ исполнительного механизма наклона
38-15 Неисправность проводки управления скоростью правого колеса
38-16 Неисправность проводки для скорости левого колеса
38-17 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма наклона
38-18 Пониженная производительность исполнительного механизма подъема
38-19 Ось X левого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона
38-20 Ось X правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-21 Ось Y левого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона
38-22 Ось Y правого джойстика, за верхней границей диапазона
38-23 Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-24 Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-25 Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-26 Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за верхней границей диапазона
38-27 Сигнал исполнительного механизма подъема за верхней границей диапазона
38-28 Сигнал исполнительного механизма наклона за верхней границей диапазона
38-29 Ось X левого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-30 Ось X правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-31 Ось Y левого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-32 Ось Y правого джойстика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-33 Сигнал переднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-34 Сигнал переднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-35 Сигнал заднего правого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-36 Сигнал заднего левого датчика управления за нижней границей диапазона
38-37 Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-38 Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
38-39 Исполнительный механизм подъема замкнут на массу / за нижней границей диапазона
38-40 Исполнительный механизм наклона замкнут на массу / сигнал за нижней границей диапазона
38-41 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма наклона
38-42 Неправильное направление исполнительного механизма подъема
38-43 Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное включение
38-44 Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение
38-45 Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное включение
38-46 Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное включение
38-47 Передний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение
38-48 Передний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение
38-49 Задний правый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение
38-50 Задний левый соленоид управления, ошибочное включение
38-51 Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное включение
38-52 Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное включение
38-53 Соленоид левого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение
38-54 Соленоид левого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение
38-55 Соленоид правого переднего привода, ошибочное выключение
38-56 Соленоид правого реверсивного привода, ошибочное выключение
38-57 Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-58 Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-59 Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-60 Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-61 Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-62 Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-63 Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением, ошибочное выключение
38-64 Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием, ошибочное выключение
38-65 Соленоид давления системы управления, ошибочное выключение
38-66 Сигнал заднего хода, ошибочное выключение
38-67 Нет сообщений от контроллера Bobcat
38-68 Углы установки колес (выравнивание) не откалиброваны
38-69 Исполнительные механизмы подъема и наклона не откалиброваны
38-70 Отключение питания
38-71 Напряжение батареи вне допустимых пределов
38-72 Насос привода не откалиброван
38-73 Переключатель режима управления/режима движения переключился во время работы
38-74 Скорость неуправляемого правого колеса, ошибочное включение
38-75 Скорость неуправляемого левого колеса, ошибочное включение
38-76 Соленоид давления системы управления — недостаточный ток
38-77 Передний правый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток
38-78 Передний правый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток
38-79 Передний левый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток
38-80 Передний левый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток
38-81 Задний правый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток
38-82 Задний правый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток
38-83 Задний левый соленоид управления выдвижением — недостаточный ток
38-84 Задний левый соленоид управления втягиванием — недостаточный ток
38-85 Питание «1» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
38-86 Питание «2» 5-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
38-87 Блокировка правого переднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления)
38-88 Блокировка левого переднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления)
38-89 Блокировка правого заднего колеса (механическая неисправность управления)
38-90 Ошибка заднего левого управления
38-91 Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости правого колеса
38-92 Отсутствуют импульсы датчика скорости левого колеса
38-93 Датчик скорости правого колеса не отвечает
38-94 Датчик скорости левого колеса не отвечает
38-98 Контроллер в режиме калибровки привода
38-99 Контроллер в режиме калибровки положения колеса
45-03 Правый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение
46-02 Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное включение
46-03 Левый указатель поворота, ошибочное выключение
47-21 Питание 8-вольтового датчика за верхней границей диапазона
47-22 Питание 8-вольтового датчика, за нижней границей диапазона
48-02 Реле переднего света, ошибочное включение
48-03 Реле переднего света, ошибочное выключение
49-02 Реле заднего света, ошибочное включение
49-03 Реле заднего света, ошибочное выключение
60-21 Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за верхней границей диапазона
60-22 Сигнал рычага управления задней доп. гидравликой за нижней границей диапазона
60-23 Рычаг управления задней доп. гидравликой не возвращается в нейтральное положение
64-02 Ошибочное включение реле мощности
64-03 Ошибочное выключение реле мощности
74-72 Сбой загрузочного кода контроллера Bobcat
74-73 Левая панель, ошибка приемного устройства
80-02 ACD, выход «A», ошибочное включение
80-03 ACD, выход «A», ошибочное выключение
81-02 ACD, выход «B», ошибочное включение
81-03 ACD, выход «B», ошибочное выключение
82-02 ACD, выход «C», ошибочное включение
82-03 ACD, выход «C», ошибочное выключение
83-02 ACD, выход «D», ошибочное включение
83-03 ACD, выход «D», ошибочное выключение
84-02 ACD, выход «E», ошибочное включение
84-03 ACD, выход «E», ошибочное выключение
90-02 Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное включение
90-03 Сервисный выход «C», ошибочное выключение
91-02 Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное включение
91-03 Сервисный выход «D», ошибочное выключение
92-02 Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное включение
92-03 Сервисный выход «Е», ошибочное выключение
93-02 Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное включение
93-03 Сервисный выход «F», ошибочное выключение
Error codes of mini loaders Bobcat will help you identify the faulty actuator and quickly repair the failed mechanism of both the engine and the hydraulic
system.
Title |
File Size |
Download Links |
Bobcat All Fault Codes list [PDF] |
105.3kb |
Download |
Bobcat Error Code List [PDF] |
85.8kb |
Download |
Fault code |
Description |
01-16 |
Air filter not connected |
01-17 |
Air filter clogged |
02-16 |
Hydraulic pressure filter not connected. |
02-17 |
Hydraulic pressure filter clogged |
03-09 |
Low battery voltage |
03-10 |
High battery voltage |
03-11 |
Extremely high battery voltage |
03-14 |
Extremely low battery voltage |
03-22 |
The battery voltage is below the maximum allowable |
04-09 |
Low engine oil pressure |
04-14 |
Extremely low engine oil pressure |
04-15 |
Oil pressure in the engine at the level of emergency engine shutdown |
04-21 |
Engine oil pressure above maximum permissible |
04-22 |
Engine oil pressure below the maximum allowable |
05-09 |
Low recharge pressure in hydraulic system |
05-14 |
Extremely low make-up pressure in the hydraulic system |
05-15 |
Feed pressure in the hydraulic system at the level of emergency engine shutdown |
05-21 |
Feed pressure in the hydraulic system is higher than the maximum allowable |
05-22 |
Feed pressure in the hydraulic system is below the maximum allowable |
06-10 |
High engine speed |
06-11 |
Extremely high engine rpm |
06-13 |
No engine speed signal |
06-15 |
Engine speed at the level of emergency engine shutdown |
06-18 |
Engine speed outside permissible limits |
07-10 |
High hydraulic oil temperature |
07-11 |
Extremely high hydraulic oil temperature |
07-15 |
Oil temperature in the hydraulic system at the level of emergency engine shutdown |
07-21 |
Oil temperature in the hydraulic system is higher than the maximum allowable |
07-22 |
Oil temperature in the hydraulic system below the maximum allowable |
08-10 |
High engine coolant temperature |
08-11 |
Extremely high engine coolant temperature |
08-15 |
Engine coolant temperature at the level of emergency engine shutdown |
08-21 |
Engine coolant temperature is above the maximum allowable |
08-22 |
Engine coolant temperature below the maximum allowable |
09-09 |
Low fuel level |
09-21 |
Fuel level above the maximum allowable |
09-22 |
The fuel level is below the maximum allowable |
11-05 |
Safety frame sensor shorted to battery |
11-06 |
Safety frame sensor shorted to ground |
12-21 |
Signal PWM controller front ext. hydraulics |
12-22 |
PWM controller front ext. hydraulics |
12-23 |
PWM controller front ext. non-neutral |
13-05 |
Fuel shut-off holding solenoid shorted to battery |
13-06 |
Holding solenoid fuel cutoff shorted to ground |
13-07 |
Open circuit of fuel cut-off solenoid |
14-02 |
Fuel cut-off solenoid, erroneous switch on |
14-03 |
Fuel shut-off solenoid, erroneous shutdown |
15-02 |
Retractable solenoid locking thrust, erroneous inclusion |
15-03 |
Retractable solenoid locking thrust, erroneous shutdown |
16-05 |
Holding solenoid lockout closed on battery |
16-06 |
Holding solenoid blocking thrust closed to ground |
16-07 |
Open circuit retaining solenoid blocking traction |
17-05 |
Solenoid hydraulic shut-off valve shorted to battery |
17-06 |
Solenoid hydraulic shut-off valve shorted to ground |
17-07 |
Open circuit of the solenoid hydraulic shut-off valve |
18-05 |
The solenoid of the valve is closed to the battery |
18-06 |
Solenoid spool closed to ground |
18-07 |
Open circuit of the spool solenoid |
19-02 |
Bucket positioning solenoid, erroneous switch on |
19-03 |
Solenoid bucket positioning, erroneous shutdown |
20-02 |
Solenoid switching speeds erroneous inclusion |
20-03 |
Solenoid switching speeds erroneous shutdown |
21-02 |
Glow plugs, erroneous inclusion |
21-03 |
Glow plugs, erroneous shutdown |
22-02 |
Starter, erroneous inclusion |
22-03 |
Starter, mistaken shutdown |
23-02 |
Rear Base Solenoid, Incorrect Inclusion |
23-03 |
Rear base solenoid, faulty shutdown |
24-02 |
Rear stock solenoid, |
24-03 |
Rear stock solenoid, |
25-02 |
Rear Auxiliary Proportional Solenoid, Incorrect Inclusion |
25-03 |
Rear auxiliary proportional solenoid, erroneous shutdown |
26-02 |
Incorrect inclusion of the front base solenoid |
26-03 |
Wrong shutdown of the front base solenoid |
27-02 |
Incorrect inclusion of |
27-03 |
Wrong shutdown of |
28-02 |
Incorrect inclusion of diverter solenoid |
28-03 |
Erroneous diverter solenoid shutdown |
29-02 |
Large feed solenoid, erroneous switch on |
29-03 |
Large feed solenoid, faulty shutdown |
30-28 |
Controller memory failure |
31-28 |
Recovery Mode Malfunction |
32-04 |
Extended Control (ACS) does not communicate with the Bobcat controller |
32-23 |
Extended ACS Management Not Calibrated |
32-31 |
Tilt actuator failure |
32-32 |
Malfunctioning wiring of the tilt actuator |
32-33 |
Faulty wiring tilt bucket handle |
32-34 |
Tilt actuator not in neutral |
32-35 |
Bucket tilt lever / pedal not in neutral position |
32-36 |
Lift actuator failure |
32-37 |
Faulty wiring actuator lifting |
32-38 |
Faulty wiring of boom lift handle |
32-39 |
Actuator not in neutral |
32-40 |
Arm / boom pedal not in neutral position |
32-41 |
No connection |
32-49 |
Lifting actuator shorted to ground |
32-50 |
Tilt actuator shorted to ground |
32-51 |
Lifting actuator shorted to battery |
32-52 |
Tilt actuator shorted to battery |
32-53 |
Arm / Boom Lift Pedal Closed to Ground |
32-54 |
The handle / pedal tilt bucket closed to ground |
32-55 |
Arm / Boom Lift Pedal Closed to Battery |
32-56 |
The handle / pedal tilt bucket closed on the battery |
32-57 |
Reduced lift actuator performance |
32-58 |
Reduced tilt actuator performance |
32-59 |
Wrong direction of the lifting actuator |
32-60 |
Incorrect direction of tilt actuator |
32-61 |
Handle lock closed to ground |
32-62 |
Handle lock closed on battery |
32-63 |
The pedal lock circuit is shorted to ground |
32-64 |
The pedal lock circuit is closed to battery |
32-65 |
Sensor supply voltage outside permissible limits |
32-66 |
Battery voltage out of range |
32-67 |
Switch switched during operation |
32-68 |
Information error arm lifting boom |
32-69 |
Control switch switched during operation |
32-70 |
The chain of the right-hand grip is closed to ground |
32-71 |
The chain of the right grip movement is closed on the battery |
33-23 |
Main controller ( Bobcat controller ) not |
34-04 |
The pushbutton panel does not communicate with the Bobcat controller |
35-02 |
Two-speed fan switch, erroneous on |
35-03 |
Two-speed fan switch, erroneous shutdown |
36-48 |
Multiple ACD controllers connected |
37-02 |
Two-speed additional speed selector, erroneous start |
37-03 |
Two-speed optional speed switch, erroneous shutdown |
38-04 |
No connection to joystick controller |
38-05 |
X axis of the left joystick is not in neutral position |
38-06 |
X axis of the right joystick is not in neutral |
38-07 |
Y axis of the left joystick is not in neutral position |
38-08 |
Y axis of the right joystick is not in neutral |
38-09 |
Control mode switch — short to battery or ground |
38-11 |
Actuator not in neutral |
38-12 |
Tilt actuator not in neutral |
38-13 |
Lift actuator failure |
38-14 |
Tilt actuator failure |
38-15 |
Faulty wheel speed control wiring |
38-16 |
Fault wiring for left wheel speed |
38-17 |
Reduced tilt actuator performance |
38-18 |
Reduced lift actuator performance |
38-19 |
X axis of the left joystick, beyond the upper limit of the range |
38-20 |
X axis of the right joystick, beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-21 |
Y axis of the left joystick, beyond the upper limit of the range |
38-22 |
Y axis of the right joystick, beyond the upper limit of the range |
38-23 |
The signal of the front right sensor control for the upper limit of the range |
38-24 |
The signal of the front left sensor control for the upper limit of the range |
38-25 |
The signal of the rear right control sensor beyond the upper limit of the range |
38-26 |
The signal of the rear left sensor control for the upper limit of the range |
38-27 |
Lift actuator signal over upper range limit |
38-28 |
Tilt actuator signal above upper range limit |
38-29 |
X axis of the left joystick, beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-30 |
X axis of the right joystick, beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-31 |
Y axis of the left joystick, beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-32 |
Y axis of the right joystick, beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-33 |
The signal of the front right control sensor for the lower limit of the range |
38-34 |
The signal of the front left control sensor for the lower limit of the range |
38-35 |
The signal of the rear right control sensor for the lower limit of the range |
38-36 |
The signal of the rear left control sensor for the lower limit of the range |
38-37 |
Power supply «1» 5-volt sensor, beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-38 |
Power supply «2» 5-volt sensor, beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-39 |
Actuator lifting closed to ground / beyond the lower limit of the range |
38-40 |
Tilt actuator shorted to ground / signal beyond low range |
38-41 |
Incorrect direction of tilt actuator |
38-42 |
Wrong direction of the lifting actuator |
38-43 |
Solenoid left front drive, erroneous inclusion |
38-44 |
Solenoid of the left reversive drive, wrong inclusion |
38-45 |
Solenoid of the right front drive, erroneous inclusion |
38-46 |
Solenoid of the right reverse drive, erroneous inclusion |
38-47 |
Front right control solenoid, erroneous switch on |
38-48 |
Front left control solenoid, erroneous switch on |
38-49 |
Rear right control solenoid, erroneous switch on |
38-50 |
Rear left control solenoid, erroneous switch on |
38-51 |
Control pressure solenoid, erroneous switch on |
38-52 |
Reverse signal, erroneous activation |
38-53 |
Solenoid left front drive, erroneous shutdown |
38-54 |
Solenoid of the left reversive drive, wrong shutdown |
38-55 |
Solenoid right front drive, erroneous shutdown |
38-56 |
Solenoid of the right reversive drive, wrong shutdown |
38-57 |
Front right solenoid advance control, erroneous shutdown |
38-58 |
Front right solenoid control retract, erroneous shutdown |
38-59 |
Front left extension control solenoid, faulty shutdown |
38-60 |
Front left solenoid control retract, erroneous shutdown |
38-61 |
Rear right firing solenoid, erroneous shutdown |
38-62 |
Rear right solenoid control retract, erroneous shutdown |
38-63 |
Rear left advance control solenoid, faulty shutdown |
38-64 |
Rear left solenoid control retract, erroneous shutdown |
38-65 |
Solenoid pressure control system, erroneous shutdown |
38-66 |
Reverse signal, erroneous shutdown |
38-67 |
No messages from Bobcat controller |
38-68 |
Wheel alignment angles (alignment) not calibrated |
38-69 |
Lifting and tilting actuators not calibrated |
38-70 |
Power down |
38-71 |
Battery voltage out of range |
38-72 |
Drive Pump Not Calibrated |
38-73 |
Control mode / motion mode switch switched during operation |
38-74 |
Unmanaged right wheel speed |
38-75 |
Unmanaged left wheel speed |
38-76 |
Solenoid pressure control system — insufficient current |
38-77 |
Front Right Solenoid Extend Control — Insufficient Current |
38-78 |
Front Right Solenoid Control — Low Current |
38-79 |
Front Left Extend Control Solenoid — Insufficient Current |
38-80 |
Front Left Solenoid Control Retractor — Insufficient Current |
38-81 |
Rear Right Solenoid Extend Control — Insufficient Current |
38-82 |
Rear right solenoid inlet control — insufficient current |
38-83 |
Rear Left Extension Control Solenoid — Insufficient Current |
38-84 |
Rear Left Solenoid Control Retractor — Insufficient Current |
38-85 |
Power supply «1» 5-volt sensor beyond the upper limit of the range |
38-86 |
Power supply «2» 5-volt sensor beyond the upper limit of the range |
38-87 |
Lock the right front wheel (mechanical control failure) |
38-88 |
Lock the left front wheel (mechanical control failure) |
38-89 |
Lock the right rear wheel (mechanical control failure) |
38-90 |
Rear left control error |
38-91 |
No wheel speed sensor pulses |
38-92 |
No left wheel speed sensor pulses |
38-93 |
Right wheel speed sensor not responding |
38-94 |
Left wheel speed sensor not responding |
38-98 |
Controller in drive calibration mode |
38-99 |
Controller in wheel position calibration mode |
45-03 |
Right direction indicator, wrong shutdown |
46-02 |
Left turn signal, erroneous inclusion |
46-03 |
Left direction indicator, erroneous shutdown |
47-21 |
Power supply 8-volt sensor beyond the upper limit of the range |
47-22 |
Power supply 8-volt sensor, beyond the lower limit of the range |
48-02 |
Front light relay erroneous on |
48-03 |
Front light relay erroneous shutdown |
49-02 |
Reverse light switch |
49-03 |
Relay backlight, erroneous shutdown |
60-21 |
Signal control lever rear ext. hydraulics |
60-22 |
Signal control lever rear ext. hydraulics |
60-23 |
Control lever rear ext. hydraulically does not return to neutral |
64-02 |
Incorrect power switch on |
64-03 |
Faulty power down |
74-72 |
Bobcat controller |
74-73 |
Left panel, receiver error |
80-02 |
ACD, output «A», wrong inclusion |
80-03 |
ACD, output «A», wrong shutdown |
81-02 |
ACD, output «B», wrong switch |
81-03 |
ACD, output «B», wrong shutdown |
82-02 |
ACD, output «C», wrong inclusion |
82-03 |
ACD, output «C», wrong shutdown |
83-02 |
ACD, output «D», wrong switch |
83-03 |
ACD, output «D», wrong shutdown |
84-02 |
ACD, output «E», wrong switch |
84-03 |
ACD, output «E», wrong shutdown |
90-02 |
Service output «C», erroneous activation |
90-03 |
Service output «C», erroneous shutdown |
91-02 |
Service output «D», erroneous activation |
91-03 |
Service output «D», erroneous shutdown |
92-02 |
Service exit «E», erroneous inclusion |
92-03 |
Service output «E», erroneous shutdown |
93-02 |
Service output «F», erroneous start |
93-03 |
Service output «F», erroneous shutdown |
BOBCAT Skid Steer Loader Fault Codes DTC list
01-16 is not connected air filter
01-17 clogged air filter
02-16 Filter hydraulic / hydrostatic system is not connected
02-17 Filter hydraulic / hydrostatic system is connected
03-09 Low battery voltage
03-10 High Voltage Battery
03-11 Extremely high voltage battery
03-14 Extremely low battery voltage
03-22 Battery voltage is below the limit
04-09 Low levels of engine oil pressure
04-14 Extremely low levels of engine oil pressure
04-15 Engine oil pressure at the level of the emergency engine shutdown
04-21 Engine oil pressure above the maximum permissible
04-22 Engine oil pressure below the limit
05-09 Low supply pressure in the hydraulic system
05-10 High charge pressure in the hydraulic system
BOBCAT Error Codes DTC
05-11 Extremely high charge pressure in the hydraulic system
05-14 Extremely low supply pressure in the hydraulic system
05-15 charge pressure in the hydraulic system at the level of the emergency engine shutdown
05-21 charge pressure in the hydraulic system above the maximum permissible
05-22 charge pressure in the hydraulic system below the limit
06-10 high engine speeds
06-11 Extremely high engine speed
06-13 No engine speed signal
06-15 Engine speed at the level of the emergency engine shutdown
06-18 Engine speed is out of range
07-10 Heat the oil in the hydraulic system
07-11 Extremely high temperature hydraulic oil
07-15 The oil temperature in the hydraulic system at the level of the emergency engine shutdown
07-21 The oil temperature in the hydraulic system above the maximum allowable
07-22 The oil temperature in the hydraulic system below the limit
08-10 High engine coolant temperature
08-11 Extremely high engine coolant temperature
08-15 Engine coolant temperature at the level of the emergency engine shutdown
08-21 Engine coolant temperature is higher than the maximum permissible
08-22 Engine coolant temperature is below the limit
09-09 Low fuel level
09-21 Fuel level above the maximum permissible
09-22 Fuel level below the limit
10-17 clogged hydraulic filter discharge
11-05 frame sensor security shorted to battery
11-06 frame sensor security shorted to ground
12-21 Signal ShIMkontrollera front ext. hydraulics for the upper limit of the range
12-22 ShIMkontroller front ext. hydraulics for the lower range
12-23 ShIMkontroller front ext. Hydraulic not in the neutral range
13-05 Retaining fuel cutoff solenoid shorted to battery
13-06 Retaining fuel cutoff solenoid shorted to ground
13.7 Open circuit solenoid fuel cutoff
14-02 retracting solenoid fuel cutoff, the erroneous inclusion
14-03 retracting solenoid fuel cutoff, erroneous shutdown
15-02 retracting solenoid lock rods, erroneous inclusion
15-03 retracting solenoid lock rods, erroneous shutdown
16-05 Retaining solenoid lock rods shorted to battery
16-06 Retaining solenoid locking rod is closed to ground
17-05 hydraulic solenoid shut-off valve is closed to battery
17-06 hydraulic solenoid shut-off valve is closed to ground
17-07 Open circuit hydraulic solenoid shut-off valve
Fault Codes DTC list of BOBCAT Tractors
18-05 The solenoid slide is closed to battery
18-06 Solenoid spool is closed to ground
18-07 Open circuit solenoid spool
19-02 solenoid positioning bucket erroneous inclusion
19-03 Solenoid bucket positioning, incorrect shutdown
20-02 Solenoid switching speeds erroneous inclusion
20-03 Solenoid switching speeds, erroneous shutdown
21-02 Glow plugs the erroneous inclusion
21-03 Glow plugs, faulty shutdown
Starter 22-02, the erroneous inclusion
Starter 22-03, erroneous shutdown
23-02 Rear base solenoid erroneous inclusion
23-03 Rear base solenoid erroneous shutdown
24-02 Rear spindle solenoid erroneous inclusion
24-03 Rear spindle solenoid erroneous shutdown
25-02 Rear auxiliary proportional solenoid erroneous inclusion
25-03 Rear auxiliary proportional solenoid, faulty shutdown
27-02 erroneous inclusion of the stem of the front solenoid
28.2 Solenoid relief valve, faulty switch
28.3 Solenoid relief valve, faulty shutdown
29.2 Solenoid large supply, faulty switch
29.3 Solenoid large supply, faulty shutdown
30-28 Failure memory controller
31-28 Fault recovery mode (also appears after the software update)
32-04 Advanced Management (ACS) does not communicate with the controller Bobcat
32-23 Calibration required ACS
32-24 Calibrate ACS
32-31 Fault actuator tilt ACS
Faulty wiring 32-32 tilt actuator ACS
32-33 tilt handle the wiring ACS
32-34 ACS tilt actuator is not in the neutral position
32-35 The handle / pedal tilt bucket ACS is not in the neutral position
32-36 Fault actuator lift ACS
Faulty wiring 32-37 actuator lift ACS
32-38 the wiring arm lifting ACS
32-39 actuator lifting ACS not in the neutral position
32-40 The handle / lift pedal bucket ACS is not in the neutral position
32-41 ACS: no connection
32-49 actuator lift ASS closed to ground
32-50 tilt actuator ASS shorted to ground
32-51 actuator lift ASS shorted to battery
32-52 tilt actuator ASS shorted to battery
32-53 Handle / foot boom is closed to ground, ASS
32-54 Handle / foot slope of the boom is closed to ground, ASS
32-55 Handle / foot boom is closed to battery, ACS
32-56 Handle / foot slope of the boom is closed to battery, ACS
32-57 Reduced performance actuator lift ACS
32-58 Reduced performance actuator tilt ACS
32-59 Wrong direction of the actuator lift ACS
32-60 Wrong direction of the actuator lift ACS
32-61 Chain lock handle ACS shorted to ground
32-62 Chain lock handle ACS closed on battery
32-63 Chain lock pedals ACS is closed to ground
32-64 Chain lock pedals ACS closed on battery
32-65 Voltage sensor out of range ACS
32-66 Battery voltage ACS below the limit
32-67 Switch ACS switched during operation
32-68 Error Information Handle boom, ACS
32-70 Chain right arm movements ACS shorted to ground
32-71 Chain right arm movements ACS closed on battery
32-74 X-axis joystick left ACS is out of range
32-75 Power Off unswitched equipment ACS
32-76 Error Information joystick CAN, ACS
32-77 Error Information remote control, ACS
33-23 The main controller (controller Bobcat) is not programmed
34-04 panel with push-button starting the controller does not communicate with Bobcat
35-02 erroneous inclusion of the fan hydraulics
35-03 Mistaken off the fan hydraulics
36-48 connect multiple controllers ACD
37-02 Two-speed auxiliary switch speeds erroneous inclusion
37-03 Two-speed auxiliary switch speeds erroneous inclusion
38-01 Error Information joystick CAN
38-02 Error Information Remote Control
38-04 There is no communication with the controller joystick
38-05 X axis the left stick is not in the neutral position
38-06 X axis right stick is not in the neutral position
38-07 Y-axis of the left joystick is not in neutral
38-08 Y-axis right stick is not in the neutral position
38-09 mode switch control circuit to the battery or to ground
38-10 Calibrate actuator
38-11 lift actuator is not in the neutral position
38-12 tilt actuator is not in the neutral position
38-13 Failure of the actuator lift
38-14 Failure of the actuator tilt
38-15 Wiring Fault speed control right wheel
38-16 Wiring fault for the speed of the left wheel
38-17 Reduced performance actuator tilt
38-18 Reduced performance actuator lift
38-19 X-axis joystick for left upper range
38-20 X-axis right joystick for the upper limit of the range
38-21 Y-axis joystick for left upper range
38-22 Y-axis right joystick for the upper limit of the range
38-23 front right sensor signal controls the upper limit of the range
38-24 front left sensor signal controls the upper limit of the range
38-25 rear right sensor signal controls the upper limit of the range
38-26 rear left sensor signal controls the upper limit of the range
38-27 Signal actuator for lifting the upper range
38-28 Signal actuator for tilting the upper range
38-29 X-axis joystick left for lower range
38-30 X-axis right joystick for the lower range
38-31 Y-axis joystick left for lower range
38-32 Y-axis right joystick for the lower range
38-33 front right sensor signal controls the lower end of the range
38-34 front left sensor signal controls the lower end of the range
38-35 rear right sensor signal controls the lower end of the range
38-36 rear left sensor signal controls the lower end of the range
38-37 Power «1» 5-volt sensor for the lower range
38-38 Power «2» 5-volt sensor for the lower range
38-39 actuator lift is closed to ground / lower boundary of the range
38-40 tilt actuator is closed to ground / signal for the lower range
38-41 Wrong direction of the tilt actuator
38-42 Wrong direction of the actuator lift
38-43 left front solenoid actuator erroneous inclusion
38-44 Solenoid left reverse drive, faulty switch
38-45 right front solenoid actuator erroneous inclusion
38-46 Solenoid right reverse drive, faulty switch
38-47 Front right solenoid control switch faulty
38-48 Front left solenoid control switch faulty
38-49 Rear right solenoid control switch faulty
38-50 Rear left solenoid control off erroneous
38-51 solenoid pressure control system, the erroneous inclusion
38-52 Back-up alarm, the erroneous inclusion
38-53 Solenoid left front drive off false
38-54 Solenoid left reverse drive, faulty shutdown
38-55 right front solenoid drive off false
38-56 Solenoid right reverse drive, faulty shutdown
38-57 Front right solenoid control extension, erroneous shutdown
38-58 Front right solenoid control retraction, erroneous shutdown
38-59 Front left solenoid control extension, erroneous shutdown
38-60 Front left solenoid control retraction, erroneous shutdown
38-61 Rear right solenoid control extension, erroneous shutdown
38-62 Rear right solenoid control retraction, erroneous shutdown
38-63 Rear left solenoid control extension, erroneous shutdown
38-64 Rear left solenoid control retraction, erroneous shutdown
38-65 solenoid pressure control system, faulty shutdown
38-66 Back-up alarm, erroneous shutdown
38-67 No communication from Bobcat controller
38-68 wheel alignment (alignment) not calibrated
38-69 Fault calibration actuators lift and tilt
38-70 Fault recovery mode range
38-71 Battery voltage out of limits
38-72 Pump drive is not calibrated
38-73 Control Mode Switch switched during operation
38-74 Uncontrolled rotation speed of the right wheel
38-75 Uncontrolled rotation speed of the left wheel
38-76 solenoid pressure control system Undercurrent
38-77 Front right solenoid control extension Undercurrent
38-78 Front right solenoid control retraction Undercurrent
38-79 Front left solenoid control extension Undercurrent
38-80 Front left solenoid control retraction Undercurrent
38-81 Rear right solenoid control extension Undercurrent
38-82 Rear right solenoid control retraction Undercurrent
38-83 Rear left solenoid control extension Undercurrent
38-84 Rear left solenoid control retraction Undercurrent
38-85 Power «1» 5-volt sensor for the upper limit of the range
38-86 ° Power «2» 5-volt sensor for the upper limit of the range
38-87 Problem front right steering device for the lower range
38-88 Malfunction of the front left of the steering gear
38-89 Fault rear right of the steering gear
Error 38-90 rear left control
38-91 No speed sensor impulses of the right wheel
38-92 No speed sensor impulses left wheel
38-93 right wheel speed sensor does not respond
38-94 left wheel speed sensor does not respond
38-95 Change of direction in the left wheel speed sensor
38-96 Change of direction in the right wheel speed sensor
38-98 controller in calibration mode drive
38-99 controller in calibration mode wheel position
39-04 Left joystick has no communication with the controller Bobcat
39-05 X-axis is not in the neutral position
39-07 Y-axis is not in the neutral position
39-12 manipulator switch left stick is not in neutral
39-13 is not connected joystick handle left off
39-16 is not connected joystick left off
39-28 Internal fault of the left joystick
39-48 Left joystick, multi-mode
40-04 Right joystick has no communication with the controller Bobcat
40-05 X axis right stick is not in the neutral position
40-07 Y-axis right stick is not in the neutral position
40-12 manipulator switch right joystick is not in neutral
40-13 is not connected right stick handle
40-16 is not connected right stick
40-28 Internal fault of the right joystick
40-48 Right stick, multi-mode
41-09 Low voltage generator
41-10 High Voltage Generator
41-11 Extremely high voltage generator
44-02 Horn, the erroneous inclusion
44-03 Horn, erroneous shutdown
45-02 The right turn signal, the erroneous inclusion
45-03 The right turn signal, erroneous shutdown
46-02 left turn signal, the erroneous inclusion
46-03 left turn signal, erroneous shutdown
47-21 Power 8voltovogo sensor for upper range
47-22 Power 8voltovogo sensor for lower range
48-02 front light switch, faulty switch
48-03 front light switch, faulty shutdown
49-02 Relay rear light erroneous inclusion
49-03 Relay rear light, faulty shutdown
60-21 signal lever back ext. hydraulics for the upper limit of the range
60-22 signal lever back ext. hydraulics for the lower range
60-23 lever rear ext. Hydraulic not in the neutral position
64-02 erroneous inclusion of a power relay
64-03 Mistaken off power relay
73-04 Fault remote control
73-13 Remote control signal is missing
74-72 Fault boot code controller Bobcat
75-01 Error Information joystick CAN
75-04 There is no communication with the controller drive
75-05 X axis the left stick is not in the neutral position
75-07 Y-axis of the left joystick is not in neutral
75-08 Y-axis right stick is not in the neutral position
75-09 mode switch ISO / H circuit to battery or to ground
75-13 jammed angle sensor right front wheel
75-14 jammed angle sensor left front wheel
75-15 jammed angle sensor right rear wheel
75-16 jammed angle sensor left rear wheel
75-17 left inclined plate is not in the neutral position
75-18 right oblique plate is not in the neutral position
75-19 X-axis joystick for left upper range
75-21 Y-axis joystick for left upper range
75-22 Y-axis right joystick for the upper limit of the range
75-23 Signal angle sensor right front wheel of the upper limit of the range
75-24 Signal angle sensor left front wheel of the upper limit of the range
75-25 Signal angle sensor right rear wheel for the upper limit of the range
75-26 Signal angle sensor left rear wheel of the upper limit of the range
75-27 Offset left oblique plate
75-28 Offset right oblique plate
75-29 X-axis joystick left for lower range
75-31 Y-axis joystick left for lower range
75-32 Y-axis right joystick for the lower range
75-33 Signal angle sensor right front wheel of the lower boundary of the range
75-34 Signal angle sensor left front wheel of the lower boundary of the range
75-35 Signal angle sensor right rear wheel of the lower boundary of the range
75-36 Signal angle sensor left rear wheel of the lower boundary of the range
75-37 Power «1» 5-volt sensor for the lower range
75-38 Sensor supply 2 for the lower range
75-39 Sensor Signal Left inclined plate for the top end of the range
75-40 Sensor Signal Left inclined plate for bottom of the range
75-41 Sensor Signal Right inclined plate for the top end of the range
75-42 Sensor Signal Right inclined plate for bottom of the range
75-43 left front solenoid actuator erroneous inclusion
75-44 Solenoid left reverse drive, faulty switch
75-45 right front solenoid actuator erroneous inclusion
75-46 Solenoid right reverse drive, faulty switch
75-47 Front right solenoid control extension shorted to battery
75-48 Front left solenoid control extension shorted to battery
75-49 Rear right solenoid control extension shorted to battery
75-50 Rear left solenoid control extension shorted to battery
75-51 solenoid pressure control system is closed to battery
75-52 Back-up alarm, the erroneous inclusion
75-53 Solenoid left front drive off false
75-54 Solenoid left reverse drive, faulty shutdown
75-55 right front solenoid drive off false
75-56 Solenoid right reverse drive, faulty shutdown
75-57 Front right solenoid control extension shorted to ground
75-58 Front right solenoid control retraction shorted to ground
75-59 Front left solenoid control extension shorted to ground
75-60 Front left solenoid control retraction shorted to ground
75-61 Rear right solenoid control extension shorted to ground
75-62 Rear right solenoid control retraction shorted to ground
75-63 Rear left solenoid control extension shorted to ground
75-64 Rear left solenoid control retraction shorted to ground
75-65 solenoid pressure control system is closed to ground
75-66 Back-up alarm, erroneous shutdown
75-67 No communication from Bobcat controller
75-68 angle sensors are not calibrated
75-69 Battery voltage is above the maximum permissible
75-70 Fault recovery mode (also appears after the software update)
75-71 Battery voltage is below the limit
75-72 Pump drive is not calibrated
75-73 mode switch ISO / H switched during operation
75-74 Uncontrolled rotation speed of the right wheel
75-75 Uncontrolled rotation speed of the left wheel
75-76 There are no posts from the controller ACS
75-77 speed sensor signal of the left wheel of the upper limit of the range
75-78 speed sensor signal of the right wheel of the top of the range
75-79 speed sensor signal of the left wheel of the lower boundary of the range
75-80 speed sensor signal of the right wheel of the bottom of the range
75-81 Front right solenoid control retraction shorted to battery
75-82 Front left solenoid control retraction shorted to battery
75-83 Rear right solenoid control retraction shorted to battery
75-84 Rear left solenoid control retraction shorted to battery
75-85 Power «1» 5-volt sensor for the upper limit of the range
75-86 Sensor supply 2 for the upper limit
75-88 controller in programming mode
75-91 Changing the polarity of the left oblique sensor plate
75-92 Changing the polarity of the sensor right oblique plate
75-93 right wheel speed sensor does not respond
75-94 left wheel speed sensor does not respond
75-95 Change of direction in the left wheel speed sensor
75-96 Change of direction in the right wheel speed sensor
75-98 controller in calibration mode
76-73 left panel, the error of the receiver
77-48 Ignition Switch, multi-mode
78-74 Door / locking the lock is opened / closed
80-02 ACD, output «A», the erroneous inclusion
80-03 ACD, output «A», erroneous shutdown
81-02 ACD, exit «B», the erroneous inclusion
81-03 ACD, exit «B», erroneous shutdown
82-02 ACD, output «C», the erroneous inclusion
82-03 ACD, output «C», erroneous shutdown
83-02 ACD, exit «D», the erroneous inclusion
83-03 ACD, exit «D», erroneous shutdown
84-02 ACD, exit «E», the erroneous inclusion
84-03 ACD, exit «E», erroneous shutdown
85-02 ACD (controller attachments), exit «F», the erroneous inclusion
85-03 ACD, exit «F», erroneous shutdown
86-02 ACD, exit «G», the erroneous inclusion
86-03 ACD, exit «G», erroneous shutdown
87-02 ACD, exit «H», the erroneous inclusion
87-03 ACD, exit «H», erroneous shutdown
90-02 Service Output «C», the erroneous inclusion
90-03 Service Output «C», erroneous off wheels
91-02 Service Output «D», the erroneous inclusion
91-03 Service Output «D», erroneous shutdown
92-02 Service Output «E», the erroneous inclusion
92-03 Service Output «E» erroneous shutdown
93-02 Service Output «F», the erroneous inclusion
93-03 Service Output «F», erroneous shutdown
Let’s try this…
Bobcat Loader error codes: LOADER
XX-XX Codes Bobcat Controller Code Description
01-16 Air Filter Not Connected
01-17 Air Filter Plugged
02-16 Hydraulic Implement Filter Not Connected
02-17 Hydraulic Implement Filter Plugged
03-09 Battery Voltage Low
03-10 Battery Voltage High
03-11 Battery Voltage Extremely High
03-14 Battery Voltage Extremely Low
03-22 Battery Voltage Out of Range Low
04-09 Engine Oil Pressure Low
04-14 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low
04-15 Engine Oil Pressure In Shutdown
04-21 Engine Oil Pressure Out Of Range High
04-22 Engine Oil Pressure Out Of Range Low
05-09 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Low
05-10 Hydraulic Charge Pressure High
05-11 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Extremely High
05-14 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Extremely Low
05-15 Hydraulic Charge Pressure In Shutdown
05-21 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Out Of Range High
05-22 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Out Of Range Low
06-10 Engine Speed High
06-11 Engine Speed Extremely High
06-13 Engine Speed No Signal
06-15 Engine Speed In Shutdown
06-18 Engine Speed Out Of Range
07-10 Hydraulic Oil Temperature High
07-11 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Extremely High
07-15 Hydraulic Oil Temperature In Shutdown
07-21 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range High
07-22 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range Low
08-10 Engine Coolant Temperature High
08-11 Engine Coolant Temperature Extremely High
08-15 Engine Coolant Temperature In Shutdown
08-21 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range High
08-22 Engine Coolant Temp Out Of Range Low
09-09 Fuel Level Low
09-21 Fuel Level Out Of Range High
09-22 Fuel Level Out Of Range Low
10-16 Hydraulic Charge Filter Not Connected
10-17 Hydraulic Charge Filter Plugged
11-05 Seat Bar Sensor Short To Battery
11-06 Seat Bar Sensor Short To Ground
12-21 Front Auxiliary Thumb Paddle Switch Out Of Range High
12-22 Front Auxiliary Thumb Paddle Switch Out Of Range Low
12-23 Front Auxiliary PWM Switch Not In Neutral
13-05 Fuel Shutoff Hold Coil Short To Battery
13-06 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Ground
13-07 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Open Circuit
14-02 Fuel Shutoff Pull Coil Error On
14-03 Fuel Shutoff Pull Coil Error Off
15-02 Traction Lock Pull Coil Error On
15-03 Traction Lock Pull Coil Error Off
16-05 Traction Lock Hold Coil Short To Battery
16-06 Traction Lock Hold Coil Short To Ground
16-07 Traction Lock Hold Solenoid Open Circuit
17-05 Hydraulic Lock Solenoid Short To Battery
17-06 Hydraulic Lock Solenoid Short To Ground
17-07 Hydraulic Lock Solenoid Open Circuit
18-05 Spool Lock Coil Short To Battery
18-06 Spool Lock Coil Short To Ground
18-07 Spool Lock Coil Open Circuit
19-02 Bucket Position Solenoid Error On
19-03 Bucket Position Solenoid Error Off
20-02 Two Speed Solenoid Error On
20-03 Two Speed Solenoid Error Off
21-02 Glow Plug Error On
21-03 Glow Plug Error Off
22-02 Starter Error On
22-03 Starter Error Off
23-02 Rear Base Solenoid Error On
23-03 Rear Base Solenoid Error Off
24-02 Rear Rod Solenoid Error On Bobcat Controller (Cont’d) Code Description
24-03 Rear Rod Solenoid Error Off
25-02 Rear Auxiliary Relief Solenoid Error On
25-03 Rear Auxiliary Relief Solenoid Error Off
26-02 Front Base Solenoid Error On
26-03 Front Base Solenoid Error Off
27-02 Front Rod Solenoid Error On
27-03 Front Rod Solenoid Error Off
28-02 Diverter Solenoid Error On
28-03 Diverter Solenoid Error Off
29-02 High Flow Solenoid Error On
29-03 High Flow Solenoid Error Off
30-28 Controller Memory Failure
31-28 Interrupted Power
33-23 Bobcat Controller Not Programmed
34-04 Deluxe Panel In Error
35-02 Hydraulic Fan Error On
35-03 Hydraulic Fan Error Off
36-48 Multiple ACDs Present
37-02 Two Speed Make-up Solenoid Error On
37-03 Two Speed Make-up Error Off
37-07 Two Speed Secondary Solenoid Open Circuit
39-04 Left Joystick Switches In Error
39-12 Left CAN Joystick Thumb Paddle Switch Not In Neutral
39-13 Left CAN Joystick Grip No Communication
39-16 Left CAN Joystick Base No Communication
39-28 Left CAN Joystick Internal Failure
39-48 Left CAN Joystick Multiple
40-04 Right Joystick Switches In Error
40-12 Right CAN Joystick Thumb Paddle Switch Not In Neutral
40-13 Right CAN Joystick Grip No Communication
40-16 Right CAN Joystick Base No Communication
40-28 Right CAN Joystick Internal Failure
40-48 Right CAN Joystick Multiple
41-09 Alternator Low Output
41-10 Alternator Voltage High
41-11 Alternator Voltage Extremely High
44-02 Horn Relay Error On
44-03 Horn Relay Error Off
45-02 Right Blinker Relay Error On
45-03 Right Blinker Relay Error Off
46-02 Left Blinker Relay Error On
46-03 Left Blinker Relay Error Off
47-21 8 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range High
47-22 8 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range Low
48-02 Front Light Relay Error On
48-03 Front Light Relay Error Off
49-02 Rear Light Relay Error On
49-03 Rear Light Relay Error Off
60-21 Rear Auxiliary Control Out Of Range High
60-22 Rear Auxiliary Control Out Of Range Low
60-23 Rear Auxiliary Control Not In Neutral
64-02 Switched Power Relay Error On
64-03 Switched Power Relay Error Off
74-72 Main Bobcat Controller In Boot Code
76-73 Left Display Panel System Rx In Error
77-48 Key Switch Multiple
78-74 Door / Transport Lock Open / Active
80-02 ACD/RACD Output «A» Error On
80-03 ACD/RACD Output «A» Error Off
81-02 ACD/RACD Output «B» Error On
81-03 ACD/RACD Output «B» Error Off
82-02 ACD/RACD Output «C» Error On
82-03 ACD/RACD Output «C» Error Off
83-02 ACD/RACD Output «D» Error On
83-03 ACD/RACD Output «D» Error Off
84-02 ACD/RACD Output «E» Error On
84-03 ACD/RACD Output «E» Error Off
85-02 ACD/RACD Output «F» Error On
85-03 ACD/RACD Output «F» Error Off
86-02 ACD/RACD Output «G» Error On
86-03 ACD/RACD Output «G» Error Off
87-02 ACD/RACD Output «H» Error On
87-03 ACD/RACD Output «H» Error Off Update June 2009 LOADER
XX-XX Codes ACS Controller Code Description
32-04 No Communication From ACS Controller
32-23 ACS Controller Not Calibrated
32-24 ACS Controller Calibration Performed
32-25 ACS Controller Calibration Failure
32-31 ACS / AHC Tilt Actuator Fault
32-32 AHC Tilt Actuator Wiring Fault
32-33 AHC Tilt Handle Wiring Fault
32-34 ACS / AHC Tilt Actuator Not In Neutral
32-35 ACS / AHC Tilt Handle / Pedal Not In Neutral, SJC Right Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral
32-36 ACS / AHC Lift Actuator Fault
32-37 AHC Lift Actuator Wiring Fault
32-38 AHC Lift Handle Wiring Fault
32-39 ACS / AHC Lift Actuator Not In Neutral
32-40 ACS / AHC Lift Handle / Pedal Not In Neutral, SJC Right Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral
32-41 AHC Controller No Communication
32-49 ACS Lift Actuator Short To Ground (Error Off)
32-50 ACS Tilt Actuator Short To Ground (Error Off)
32-51 ACS Lift Actuator Short To Battery (Error On)
32-52 ACS Tilt Actuator Short To Battery (Error On)
32-53 ACS Lift Handle / Pedal Short To Ground, SJC Right Joystick Y-axis Short To Ground
32-54 ACS Tilt Handle / Pedal Short To Ground, SJC Right Joystick X-axis Short To Ground
32-55 ACS Lift Handle / Pedal Short To Battery, SJC Right Joystick Y-axis Short To Battery
32-56 ACS Tilt Handle Pedal Short To Battery, SJC Right Joystick X-axis Short To Battery
32-57 ACS Lift Actuator Reduced Performance
32-58 ACS Tilt Actuator Reduced Performance
32-59 ACS Lift Actuator Wrong Direction
32-60 ACS Tilt Actuator Wrong Direction
32-61 ACS Handle Lock Short To Ground
32-62 ACS Handle Lock Short To Battery
32-63 ACS Pedal Lock Short To Ground
32-64 ACS Pedal Lock Short To Battery
32-65 ACS Sensor Supply Voltage Out Of Range
32-66 ACS Battery Voltage Out Of Range
32-67 ACS Operating Mode Switch Flipped While Operating
32-68 ACS Lift Handle Information Error
32-70 Right Joystick Y-axis Out Of Range Low
32-71 Right Joystick Y-axis Out Of Range High
32-75 Interrupted Un-switched Power
32-76 CAN Joystick Information Error
32-97 ACS Controller Programmed
40-05 Right CAN Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral
40-07 Right CAN Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral A
WS-SJC Controller Code Description
38-01 CAN Joystick Information Error
38-02 Remote Control Information Error
38-03 Actuator Calibration Failure
38-04 AWS/SJC Controller No Communication
38-05 Left Analog Joystick X-Axis Not In Neutral
38-06 Right Analog Joystick X-Axis Not In Neutral
38-07 Left Analog Joystick Y-Axis Not In Neutral
38-08 Right Joystick Y-Axis Not In Neutral
38-09 Operating Mode Switch Short to Ground or Battery
38-10 Actuator Calibration Performed
38-11 AWS / SJC Lift Actuator Not In Neutral
38-12 AWS / SJC Tilt Actuator Not In Neutral
38-13 AWS / SJC Lift Actuator Fault
38-14 AWS / SJC Tilt Actuator Fault
38-15 AWS / SJC Right Wheel Speed Fault
38-16 AWS / SJC Left Wheel Speed Fault
38-17 AWS / SJC Tilt Actuator Reduced Performance
38-18 AWS / SJC Lift Actuator Reduced Performance
38-19 Left Joystick X-Axis Out Of Range High
38-20 Right Joystick X-Axis Out Of Range High
38-21 Left Joystick Y-Axis Out Of Range High
38-22 Right Joystick Y-Axis Out Of Range High
38-23 Right Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
38-24 Left Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
38-25 Right Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range High A
WS-SJC Controller (Cont’d) Code Description
38-26 Left Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
38-27 AWS / SJC Lift Actuator Out Of Range High
38-28 AWS / SJC Tilt Actuator Out Of Range High
38-29 Left Joystick X-Axis Out Of Range Low
38-30 Right Joystick X-axis Out Of Range Low
38-31 Left Joystick Y-Axis Out Of Range Low
38-32 Right Joystick Y-Axis Out Of Range Low
38-33 Right Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
38-34 Left Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
38-35 Right Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
38-36 Left Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
38-37 5 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range Low
38-38 5 Volt Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range Low
38-39 AWS / SJC Lift Actuator Short To Ground
38-40 AWS / SJC Tilt Actuator Short To Ground
38-41 Tilt Actuator Wrong Direction
38-42 Lift Actuator Wrong Direction
38-43 Left Forward Drive Solenoid Error On
38-44 Left Reverse Drive Solenoid Error On
38-45 Right Forward Drive Solenoid Error On
38-46 Right Reverse Drive Solenoid Error On
38-47 Right Front Steering Solenoid Error On
38-48 Left Front Steering Solenoid Error On
38-49 Right Rear Steering Solenoid Error On
38-50 Left Rear Steering Solenoid Error On
38-51 Pressure Control Steering Solenoid Error On
38-52 Backup Alarm Error On
38-53 Left Forward Drive Solenoid Error Off
38-54 Left Reverse Drive Solenoid Error Off
38-55 Right Forward Drive Solenoid Error Off
38-56 Right Reverse Drive Solenoid Error Off
38-57 Right Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-58 Right Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-59 Left Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-60 Left Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-61 Right Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-62 Right Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-63 Left Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-64 Left Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-65 Pressure Control Steering Solenoid Error Off
38-66 Backup Alarm Short To Ground
38-67 No Communication From Bobcat Controller
38-68 Wheel Angle Sensors Not Calibrated
38-69 AWS / SJC Controller Not Calibrated
38-70 Interrupted Power
38-71 Battery Voltage Out Of Range
38-72 Drive Pump Not Calibrated
38-73 Operating Mode Switch Pressed While Operating
38-74 Right Wheel Speed Uncommanded Motion
38-75 Left Wheel Speed Uncommanded Motion
38-85 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range High
38-86 Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range High
38-87 Right Front Steering Solenoid Error
38-88 Left Front Steering Solenoid Error
38-89 Right Rear Steering Solenoid Error
38-90 Left Rear Steering Solenoid Error
38-93 Right Speed Sensor Unresponsive
38-94 Left Speed Sensor Unresponsive
38-95 Left Speed Sensor Reverse Direction
38-96 Right Speed Sensor Reverse Direction
38-97 AWS/SJC Controller Programmed
38-98 Controller In Drive Calibration Mode
38-99 AWS Controller In Wheel Position Calibration Mode
39-05 Left CAN Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral
39-07 Left CAN Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral
40-05 Right CAN Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral
40-07 Right CAN Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral Update June 2009 LOADER
XX-XX Codes SSL Drive / Drive Plus Controller Code Description
39-05 Left CAN Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral
39-07 Left CAN Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral
75-01 CAN Joystick Information Error
75-04 No Communication From Drive Controller
75-05 Left Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral Left (ISO Mode Only)
75-07 Left Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral
75-08 Right Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral (H-Pattern Only)
75-09 Operating Mode Switch Short To Ground Or Battery
75-13 Right Front Wheel Unresponsive
75-14 Left Front Wheel Unresponsive
75-15 Right Rear Wheel Unresponsive
75-16 Left Rear Wheel Unresponsive
75-17 Left Swash Plate Not In Neutral
75-18 Right Swash Plate Not In Neutral
75-19 Left Joystick X-axis Out Of Range High
75-21 Left Joystick Y-axis Out Of Range High
75-23 Right Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
75-24 Left Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
75-25 Right Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
75-26 Left Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
75-27 Left Swash Plate Out Of Position
75-28 Right Swash Plate Out Of Position
75-29 Left Joystick X-axis Out Of Range Low
75-31 Left Joystick Y-axis Out Of Range Low
75-33 Right Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-34 Left Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-35 Right Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-36 Left Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-37 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range Low
75-38 5 Volt Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range Low
75-39 Left Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range High
75-40 Left Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-41 Right Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range High
75-42 Right Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-43 Left Forward Drive Solenoid Error On
75-44 Left Reverse Drive Solenoid Error On
75-45 Right Forward Drive Solenoid Error On
75-46 Right Reverse Drive Solenoid Error On
75-47 Right Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
75-48 Left Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
75-49 Right Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
75-50 Left Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
75-51 Pressure Control Steering Solenoid Error On
75-52 Backup Alarm Error On
75-53 Left Forward Drive Solenoid Error Off
75-54 Left Reverse Drive Solenoid Error Off
75-55 Right Forward Drive Solenoid Error Off
75-56 Right Reverse Drive Solenoid Error Off
75-57 Right Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-58 Right Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-59 Left Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-60 Left Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-61 Right Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-62 Right Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-63 Left Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-64 Left Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-65 Pressure Control Steering Solenoid Error Off
75-66 Backup Alarm Error Off
75-67 No Communication From Bobcat Controller
75-68 Angle Sensors Not Calibrated
75-69 Battery Voltage Out Of Range High
75-70 Interrupted Power
75-71 Battery Voltage Out Of Range Low
75-72 Drive Pump – Not Calibrated
75-73 Operating Mode Switch Flipped While Operating
75-74 Right Wheel Speed Uncommanded Motion
75-75 Left Wheel Speed Uncommanded Motion
75-76 No Communication From ACS Controller
75-77 Left Speed Sensor Out Of Range High
75-78 Right Speed Sensor Out Of Range High
75-79 Left Speed Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-80 Right Speed Sensor Out Of Range Low
75-81 Right Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error On SSL Drive / Drive Plus Controller Code Description
75-82 Left Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error On
75-83 Right Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error On
75-84 Left Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error On
75-85 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range High
75-86 Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range High
75-87 Software Update Required
75-88 Switched Power Error On
75-91 Left Swash Plate Sensor — Reversed
75-92 Right Swash Plate Sensor — Reversed
75-93 Unresponsive Right Speed Sensor
75-94 Unresponsive Left Speed Sensor
75-95 Left Speed Sensor Reverse Direction
75-96 Right Speed Sensor Reverse Direction
75-97 Drive / Drive Plus Controller Programmed
75-98 Controller In Calibration Mode
75-99 Drive Plus Controller In Wheel Position Calibration Mode Update June 2009
LOADER ALPHA-NUMERIC CODES Gateway Controller Code Description
M0116 Air Filter Not Connected
M0117 Air Filter Plugged
M0216 Hydraulic Implement Filter Not Connected
M0217 Hydraulic Implement Filter Plugged
M0309 Battery Voltage Low
M0310 Battery Voltage High
M0311 Battery Voltage Extremely High
M0314 Battery Voltage Extremely Low
M0322 Battery Voltage Out Of Range Low
M0409 Engine Oil Pressure Low
M0414 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low
M0415 Engine Oil Pressure In Shutdown
M0421 Engine Oil Pressure Out Of Range High
M0422 Engine Oil Pressure Out Of Range Low
M0509 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Low
M0510 Hydraulic Charge Pressure High
M0511 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Extremely High
M0514 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Extremely Low
M0515 Hydraulic Charge Pressure In Shutdown
M0521 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Out Of Range High
M0522 Hydraulic Charge Pressure Out Of Range Low
M0610 Engine Speed High
M0611 Engine Speed Extremely High
M0613 Engine Speed No Signal
M0615 Engine Speed In Shutdown
M0618 Engine Speed Out Of Range
M0710 Hydraulic Oil Temperature High
M0711 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Extremely High
M0715 Hydraulic Oil Temperature In Shutdown
M0721 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range High
M0722 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range Low
M0810 Engine Coolant Temperature High
M0811 Engine Coolant Temperature Extremely High
M0815 Engine Coolant Temperature In Shutdown
M0821 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range High
M0822 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range Low
M0909 Fuel Level Low
M0921 Fuel Level Out Of Range High
M0922 Fuel Level Out Of Range Low
M1016 Hydraulic Charge Filter Not Connected
M1017 Hydraulic Charge Filter Plugged
M1121 Seatbar Sensor Out Of Range High
M1122 Seatbar Sensor Out Of Range Low
M1305 Fuel Shutoff Hold Coil Short To Battery
M1306 Fuel Shutoff Hold Coil Short To Ground
M1307 Fuel Shutoff Hold Coil Open Circuit
M1402 Fuel Pull Output Error On
M1403 Fuel Pull Output Error Off
M1407 Fuel Pull Output Open Circuit
M1428 Fuel Pull Output Controller Failure
M1502 Traction Lock Pull Output Error On
M1503 Traction Lock Pull Output Error Off
M1507 Traction Lock Pull Output Open Circuit
M1528 Traction Lock Pull Output Controller Failure
M1605 Traction Lock Hold Solenoid Short To Battery
M1606 Traction Lock Hold Solenoid Short To Ground
M1607 Traction Lock Hold Solenoid Open Circuit
M1705 Hydraulic Lock Valve Solenoid Short To Battery
M1706 Hydraulic Lock Valve Solenoid Short To Ground
M1707 Hydraulic Lock Valve Solenoid Open Circuit
M1732 Hydraulic Lock Valve Solenoid Over Current
M1805 Lift Spool Lock Short To Battery
M1806 Lift Spool Lock Short To Ground
M1807 Lift Spool Lock Open Circuit
M1832 Lift Spool Lock Solenoid Over Current
M2005 Two Speed Solenoid Short To Battery
M2006 Two Speed Solenoid Short To Ground
M2007 Two Speed Solenoid Open Circuit
M2032 Two Speed Solenoid Over Current
M2102 Glow Plug Output Error On
M2103 Glow Plug Output Error Off
M2107 Glow Plug Output Open Circuit Gateway Controller (Cont’d) Code Description
M2128 Glow Plug Output Controller Failure
M2202 Starter Output Error On
M2203 Starter Output Error Off
M2207 Starter Output Open Circuit
M2228 Starter Output Controller Failure
M2302 Starter Relay Error On
M2303 Starter Relay Error Off
M2307 Starter Relay Open Circuit
M2402 Fuel Pull Relay Error On
M2403 Fuel Pull Relay Error Off
M2407 Fuel Pull Output Open Circuit
M2502 Traction Lock Relay Error On
M2503 Traction Lock Pull Relay Error Off
M2507 Traction Lock Output Open Circuit
M2602 Glow Plug Relay Error On
M2603 Glow Plug Relay Error Off
M2607 Glow Plug Output Open Circuit
M2805 Auxiliary Interlock Output Short To Battery
M2806 Auxiliary Interlock Output Short To Ground
M2807 Auxiliary Interlock Output Open Circuit
M3028 Controller Memory Failure
M3128 Interrupted Power Failure
M3204 ACS In Error
M3304 Deluxe Panel No Communication
M3323 Gateway Controller Not Programmed
M3404 Deluxe Panel No Communication
M3505 Hydraulic Fan Solenoid Error On
M3506 Hydraulic Fan Solenoid Error Off
M3507 Hydraulic Fan Solenoid Open Circuit
M3532 Hydraulic Fan Solenoid Over Current
M3648 Multiple ACDs Present (Attachment Control Device)
M3705 Two Speed Secondary Error On
M3706 Two Speed Secondary Error Off
M3707 Two Speed Secondary Solenoid Open Circuit
M3732 Two Speed Secondary Over Current
M4109 Alternator Low Output
M4110 Alternator Voltage High
M4404 Auxiliary Controller No Communication
M4621 5 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range High
M4622 5 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range Low
M4721 8 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range High
M4722 8 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range Low
M4802 Front Light Relay Error On
M4803 Front Light Relay Error Off
M4807 Front Light Output Open Circuit
M4902 Rear Light Relay Error On
M4903 Rear Light Relay Error Off
M4907 Rear Light Output Open Circuit
M5002 Front Light Output Error On
M5003 Front Light Output Error Off
M5007 Front Light Output Open Circuit
M5028 Front Light Output Controller Failure
M5102 Rear Light Output Error On
M5103 Rear Light Output Error Off
M5107 Rear Light Output Open Circuit
M5128 Front Light Output Controller Failure
M5202 PTOL (Press To Operate Loader)Switch Error On
M5221 PTOL Switch Out Of Range High
M5222 PTOL Switch Out Of Range Low
M5305 PTOL Led Short To Battery
M5306 PTOL Led Short To Ground
M5405 Tilt Spool Lock Short To Battery
M5406 Tilt Spool Lock Short To Ground
M5407 Tilt Spool Lock Open Circuit
M5432 Tilt Spool Lock Over Current
M6402 Switched Power Relay Error On
M6403 Switched Power Relay Error Off
M6407 Switched Power Output Open Circuit
M7002 Switched Power Output Error On
M7003 Switched Power Output Error Off
M7007 Switched Power Output Open Circuit
M7028 Switched Power Output Controller Failure Updated June 2009 LOADER ALP
HA-NUMERIC CODES Gateway Controller (Cont’d) Code Description
M7304 Remote Control Receiver No Communication
M7423 Gateway Controller Not Programmed
M7472 Gateway Controller In Boot Code
M7504 Drive Controller No Communication
M7604 Left Display Panel No Communication
M7748 Key Switch Multiple
M7974 Door Open Auxiliary Controller Code Description
H1221 Front Auxiliary Thumb Paddle Switch Out Of Range High
H1222 Front Auxiliary Thumb Paddle Switch Out Of Range Low
H1224 Front Auxiliary Thumb Paddle Switch Not In Neutral
H1324 Rear Auxiliary Thumb Paddle Switch Not In Neutral
H2305 Rear Base Solenoid Shorted to Battery
H2306 Rear Base Solenoid Short To Ground
H2307 Rear Base Solenoid Open Circuit
H2332 Rear Base Solenoid Over Current
H2405 Rear Rod Solenoid Short To Battery
H2406 Rear Rod Solenoid Short To Ground
H2407 Rear Rod Solenoid Open Circuit
H2432 Rear Rod Solenoid Over Current
H2605 Front Base Solenoid Short To Battery
H2606 Front Base Solenoid Short To Ground
H2607 Front Base Solenoid Open Circuit
H2632 Front Base Solenoid Over Current
H2705 Front Rod Solenoid Short To Battery
H2706 Front Rod Solenoid Short To Ground
H2707 Front Rod Solenoid Open Circuit
H2732 Front Rod Solenoid Over Current
H2805 Diverter Solenoid Short To Battery
H2806 Diverter Solenoid Short To Ground
H2807 Diverter Solenoid Open Circuit
H2905 High Flow Solenoid Short To Battery
H2906 High Flow Solenoid Short To Ground
H2907 High Flow Solenoid Open Circuit
H2932 High Flow Solenoid Over Current
H3028 Auxiliary Controller Memory Failure
H3128 Interrupted Power Failure
H3648 Multiple ACDs Present (Attachment Control Device)
H3913 Left CAN Joystick Grip No Communication
H3916 Left CAN Joystick Base No Communication
H3928 Left CAN Joystick Internal Failure
H3948 Left CAN Joystick Multiple
H4013 Right CAN Joystick Grip No Communication
H4016 Right CAN Joystick Base No Communication
H4028 Right CAN Joystick Internal Failure
H4048 Right CAN Joystick Multiple
H4302 Horn Relay Error On
H4303 Horn Relay Error Off
H4423 Auxiliary Controller Not Programmed
H4502 Right Blinker Error On
H4503 Right Blinker Error Off
H4602 Left Blinker Error On
H4603 Left Blinker Error Off
H4721 8 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range High
H4722 8 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range Low
H7404 Gateway Controller No Communication
H7604 Left Display Panel No Communication ACD Controller Code Description
A8002 ACD/RACD Output «A» Error On
A8003 ACD/RACD Output «A» Error Off
A8102 ACD/RACD Output «B» Error On
A8103 ACD/RACD Output «B» Error Off
A8202 ACD/RACD Output «C» Error On
A8203 ACD/RACD Output «C» Error Off
A8302 ACD/RACD Output «D» Error On
A8303 ACD/RACD Output «D» Error Off
A8402 ACD/RACD Output «E» Error On
A8403 ACD/RACD Output «E» Error Off
A8502 ACD/RACD Output «F» Error On
A8503 ACD/RACD Output «F» Error Off
A8602 ACD/RACD Output «G» Error On
A8603 ACD/RACD Output «G» Error Off
A8702 ACD/RACD Output «H» Error On
A8703 ACD/RACD Output «H» Error Off ACS Controller Code Description
W3223 ACS Controller Not Calibrated
W3224 ACS Controller Calibration Successful
W3225 ACS Controller Calibration Failure
W3231 ACS Tilt Actuator Fault
W3234 ACS Tilt Actuator Not In Neutral
W3235 ACS Tilt Handle/Pedal Not In Neutral
W3236 ACS Lift Actuator Fault
W3239 ACS Lift Actuator Not In Neutral (ACS Only)
W3240 ACS Lift Handle/Pedal Not In Neutral
W3249 ACS Lift Actuator Short To Ground (Error Off) (ACS Only)
W3250 ACS Tilt Actuator Short To Ground (Error Off)
W3251 ACS Lift Actuator Short To Battery (Error On) (ACS Only)
W3252 ACS Tilt Actuator Short To Battery (Error On)
W3253 ACS Lift Handle/Pedal Short To Ground
W3254 ACS Tilt Handle/Pedal Short To Ground
W3255 ACS Lift Handle/Pedal Short To Battery
W3256 ACS Tilt Handle/Pedal Short To Battery
W3257 ACS Lift Actuator Reduced Performance
W3258 ACS Tilt Actuator Reduced Performance
W3259 ACS Lift Actuator Wrong Direction (ACS Only)
W3260 ACS Tilt Actuator Wrong Direction
W3261 ACS Handle Lock Short To Ground
W3262 ACS Handle Lock Short To Battery
W3263 ACS Pedal Lock Short To Ground
W3264 ACS Pedal Lock Short To Battery
W3265 ACS Sensor Supply Voltage Out Of Range (ACS Only)
W3266 ACS Battery Voltage Out Of Range (ACS Only)
W3267 ACS Operating Mode Switch Flipped While Operating
W3275 Interrupted Un-switched Power
W3276 CAN Joystick Information Error
W3297 ACS Controller Programmed
W3905 Left CAN Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral
W4005 Right CAN Joystick X-axis Not In Neutral
W4007 Right CAN Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral Left Hand Panel Controller Code Description
L0102 Lights Button Error On
L0202 High Flow Button Error On
L0302 Auxiliary Button Error On
L0402 Information Button Error On
L7404 Gateway Controller No Communication
L7672 Left Hand Panel Programming Error Updated June 2009
LOADER ALPHA-NUMERIC CODES SSL Drive / Drive Plus Controller Code Description
D3905 Left CAN Joystick X Axis Not in Neutral
D3907 Left CAN Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral
D4007 Right CAN Joystick Y-axis Not In Neutral
D7501 CAN Joystick Information Error
D7509 Operating Mode Switch Short To Ground Or Battery
D7513 Right Front Wheel Unresponsive
D7514 Left Front Wheel Unresponsive
D7515 Right Rear Wheel Unresponsive
D7516 Left Rear Wheel Unresponsive
D7517 Left Swash Plate Not In Neutral
D7518 Right Swash Plate Not In Neutral
D7523 Right Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
D7524 Left Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
D7525 Right Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
D7526 Left Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range High
D7527 Left Swash Plate Out Of Position
D7528 Right Swash Plate Out Of Position
D7533 Right Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7534 Left Front Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7535 Right Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7536 Left Rear Steering Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7537 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range Low
D7538 5 Volt Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range Low
D7539 Left Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range High
D7540 Left Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7541 Right Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range High
D7542 Right Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7543 Left Forward Drive Solenoid Error On
D7544 Left Reverse Drive Solenoid Error On
D7545 Right Forward Drive Solenoid Error On
D7546 Right Reverse Drive Solenoid Error On
D7547 Right Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
D7548 Left Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
D7549 Right Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
D7550 Left Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error On
D7551 Pressure Control Steering Solenoid Error On
D7552 Backup Alarm Error On
D7553 Left Forward Drive Solenoid Error Off
D7554 Left Reverse Drive Solenoid Error Off
D7555 Right Forward Drive Solenoid Error Off
D7556 Right Reverse Drive Solenoid Error Off
D7557 Right Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7558 Right Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7559 Left Front Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7560 Left Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7561 Right Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7562 Right Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7563 Left Rear Extend Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7564 Left Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7565 Pressure Control Steering Solenoid Error Off
D7566 Backup Alarm Error Off
D7567 No Communication From Gateway Controller
D7568 Angle Sensors Not Calibrated
D7569 Battery Voltage Out Of Range High
D7570 Interrupted Power
D7571 Battery Voltage Out Of Range Low
D7572 Drive Pump – Not Calibrated
D7573 Operating Mode Switch Flipped While Operating
D7574 Right Wheel Speed Uncommanded Motion
D7575 Left Wheel Speed Uncommanded Motion
D7577 Left Speed Sensor Out Of Range High
D7578 Right Speed Sensor Out Of Range High
D7579 Left Speed Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7580 Right Speed Sensor Out Of Range Low
D7581 Right Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error On
D7582 Left Front Retract Steering Solenoid Error On
D7583 Right Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error On
D7584 Left Rear Retract Steering Solenoid Error On
D7585 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range High
D7586 Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range High
D7587 Software Update Required
D7588 Switched Power Stuck On SSL Drive / Drive Plus Controller (Cont’d) Code Description
D7591 Left Swash Plate Sensor — Reversed
D7592 Right Swash Plate Sensor — Reversed
D7593 Unresponsive Right Speed Sensor
D7594 Unresponsive Left Speed Sensor
D7595 Left Speed Sensor Reverse Direction
D7596 Right Speed Sensor Reverse Direction
D7597 Drive / Drive Plus Controller Programmed
D7598 Drive / Drive Plus Controller In Calibration Mode
D7599 Drive Plus Controller In Wheel Position Calibration Mode Updated June 2009 EXCAVATOR
XX-XX CODES Excavator Display Controller Code Description
02-16 Hydraulic/Hydrostatic Filter Not Connected
02-17 Hydraulic/Hydrostatic Filter Plugged
03-09 Battery Voltage Low
03-10 Battery Voltage High
03-11 Battery Voltage Extremely High
03-14 Battery Voltage Extremely Low
03-15 Battery Voltage In Shutdown
03-22 Battery Voltage Out Of Range Low
04-14 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low
04-15 Engine Oil Pressure Shutdown Level
05-09 Travel Pilot Pressure Low
05-14 Travel Pilot Pressure Extremely Low
05-15 Travel Pilot Pressure In Shutdown
05-21 Travel Pilot Pressure Out Of Range High
05-22 Travel Pilot Pressure Out Of Range Low
06-10 Engine Speed High
06-11 Engine Speed Extremely High
06-13 Engine Speed No Signal
06-15 Engine Speed In Shutdown
06-18 Engine Speed Out Of Range High
07-10 Hydraulic Oil Temperature High
07-11 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Extremely High
07-15 Hydraulic Oil Temperature In Shutdown
07-21 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range High
07-22 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range Low
08-10 Engine Coolant Temperature High
08-11 Engine Coolant Temperature Extremely High
08-15 Engine Coolant Temperature In Shutdown
08-21 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range High
08-22 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range Low
09-21 Fuel Level Out Of Range High
09-22 Fuel Level Out Of Range Low
12-21 Auxiliary PWM Switch Out Of Range High
12-22 Auxiliary PWM Switch Out Of Range Low
12-23 Auxiliary PWM Switch Not In Neutral
13-05 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Battery
13-06 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Ground
13-07 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Open Circuit
14-02 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error On
14-03 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error Off
20-02 Two Speed Error On
20-03 Two Speed Error Off
21-02 Glow Plug Error On
21-03 Glow Plug Error Off
22-02 Starter Error On
22-03 Starter Error Off
26-02 Front Base Solenoid Error On
26-03 Front Base Solenoid Error Off
26-05 Front Base PWM Short to Battery
26-06 Front Base PWM Short to Ground
26-07 Front Base PWM Open Circuit
27-02 Front Rod Solenoid Error On
27-03 Front Rod Solenoid Error Off
27-05 Front Rod PWM Short to Battery
27-06 Front Rod PWM Short to Ground Excavator Display Controller Code Description
20-03 Two Speed Error Off
21-02 Glow Plug Error On
21-03 Glow Plug Error Off
22-02 Starter Error On
22-03 Starter Error Off
26-02 Front Base Solenoid Error On
26-03 Front Base Solenoid Error Off
26-05 Front Base PWM Short to Battery
26-06 Front Base PWM Short to Ground
26-07 Front Base PWM Open Circuit
27-02 Front Rod Solenoid Error On
27-03 Front Rod Solenoid Error Off
27-05 Front Rod PWM Short to Battery
27-06 Front Rod PWM Short to Ground
27-07 Front Rod PWM Open Circuit
28-02 Diverter Solenoid Error On
28-03 Diverter Solenoid Error Off
31-28 Interrupted Power Failure
33-23 Main Controller Not Programmed
35-05 Hydraulic Fan Short To Battery
35-06 Hydraulic Fan Short To Ground
62-04 Load Moment Monitoring In Error
63-05 Console Switch Short To Battery
63-06 Console Switch Short To Ground
64-05 Switched Power Relay Short To Battery
64-06 Switched Power Relay Short To Ground
64-07 Switched Power Relay Open Circuit
65-05 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Short To Battery
65-06 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Short To Ground
65-07 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Open Circuit
66-05 Travel Pilot Pressure Short To Battery
66-06 Travel Pilot Pressure Short To Ground
66-07 Travel Pilot Pressure Open Circuit Updated June 2009 EXCAVATOR ALP
HA-NUMERIC CODES Excavator Display Controller Code Description
C0216 Hydraulic/Hydrostatic Filter Not Connected
C0217 Hydraulic/Hydrostatic Filter Plugged
C0309 Battery Voltage Low
C0310 Battery Voltage High
C0311 Battery Voltage Extremely High
C0314 Battery Voltage Extremely Low
C0315 Battery Voltage In Shutdown
C0322 Battery Voltage Out Of Range Low
C0414 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low
C0415 Engine Oil Pressure In Shutdown
C0610 Engine Speed High
C0611 Engine Speed Extremely High
C0613 Engine Speed No Signal
C0615 Engine Speed In Shutdown
C0618 Engine Speed Out Of Range High
C0710 Hydraulic Oil Temperature High
C0711 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Extremely High
C0715 Hydraulic Oil Temperature In Shutdown
C0721 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range High
C0722 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range Low
C0810 Engine Coolant Temperature High
C0811 Engine Coolant Temperature Extremely High
C0815 Engine Coolant Temperature In Shutdown
C0821 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range High
C0822 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range Low
C0921 Fuel Level Out Of Range High
C0922 Fuel Level Out Of Range Low
C1221 Auxiliary PWM Switch Out Of Range High
C1222 Auxiliary PWM Switch Out Of Range Low
C1223 Auxiliary PWM Switch Not In Neutral
C1305 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Battery
C1306 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Ground
C1307 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Open Circuit
C1402 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error On
C1403 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error Off
C2005 Two Speed Error On
C2006 Two Speed Error Off
C2102 Glow Plug Error On
C2103 Glow Plug Error Off
C2202 Starter Error On
C2203 Starter Error Off
C2305 Offset Base Solenoid Short To Battery
C2306 Offset Base Solenoid Short to Ground
C2307 Offset Base Solenoid Open Circuit
C2405 Offset Rod Solenoid Short To Battery
C2406 Offset Rod Solenoid Short to Ground
C2407 Offset Rod Solenoid Open Circuit
C2505 Offset Return Short To Battery
C2506 Offset Return Short To Ground
C2507 Offset Return Open Circuit
C2605 Auxiliary Base Solenoid Short to Battery
C2606 Auxiliary Base Solenoid Short to Ground
C2607 Auxiliary Base Solenoid Open Circuit
C2705 Auxiliary Rod Solenoid Short to Battery
C2706 Auxiliary Rod Solenoid Short to Ground
C2707 Auxiliary Rod Solenoid Open Circuit
C2802 Hydraulic Exchange Error On Excavator Display Controller (Cont’d) Code Description
C2803 Hydraulic Exchange Error Off
C3028 Controller Memory Failure
C3128 Interrupted Power Failure
C3323 Main Controller Not Programmed
C3397 Main Controller Programmed
C4021 Angle Blade Control Out Of Range High
C4022 Angle Blade Control Out Of Range Low
C4023 Angle Blade Control Not In Neutral
C4105 Angle Blade Base Solenoid Short to Battery
C4106 Angle Blade Base Solenoid Short to Ground
C4107 Angle Blade Base Solenoid Open Circuit
C4205 Angle Blade Rod Solenoid Short to Battery
C4206 Angle Blade Rod Solenoid Short to Ground
C4207 Angle Blade Rod Solenoid Open Circuit
C4321 Load Sense Pressure Out Of Range High
C4322 Load Sense Pressure Out Of Range Low
C4516 Throttle Controller No Communication
C6021 Offset Control Out Of Range High
C6022 Offset Control Out Of Range Low
C6023 Offset Control Not In Neutral
C6204 Load Moment Monitoring In Error
C6305 Console Switch Short To Battery
C6306 Console Switch Short To Ground
C6405 Switched Power Relay Short To Battery
C6406 Switched Power Relay Short To Ground
C6407 Switched Power Relay Open Circuit
C6505 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Short To Battery
C6506 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Short To Ground
C6507 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Open Circuit Engine Controller Code Description
E0105 Throttle Actuator Short To Battery
E0106 Throttle Actuator Short To Ground
E0107 Throttle Actuator Open Circuit
E0123 Throttle Controller Not Calibrated
E0321 5 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range High
E0322 5 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range Low
E0421 Engine Speed Control Dial Out Of Range High
E0422 Engine Speed Control Dial Out Of Range Low
E0521 Throttle Actuator Feedback Out Of Range High
E0522 Throttle Actuator Feedback Out Of Range Low Updated June 2009 E60/E80
E-ECU CONTROLLER CODES E60/E80
E-ECU Controller Code Description
P0117 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Out Of Range Low
P0118 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Out Of Range High
P0119 Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor Intermittent Connection
P0122 Accelerator Sensor Out Of Range Low
P0123 Accelerator Sensor Out Of Range High
P0124 Accelerator Sensor Intermittent Connection
P0217 Engine Coolant Temperature High
P0340 Engine Speed Sensor No Signal
P0562 Battery Voltage Low
P0563 Battery Voltage High
P0605 E-ECU Internal FlashROM Checksum Error A (Main Software)
P0634 E-ECU Temperature Sensor High
P0642 5 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range Low
P0643 5 Volt Sensor Supply Out Of Range High
P0668 E-ECU Temperature Sensor Out Of Range Low
P0669 E-ECU Temperature Sensor Out Of Range High
P1202 Rack Position Sensor Out Of Range Low
P1203 Rack Position Sensor Out of Range High
P1211 Rack Actuator Solenoid Stuck
P1212 Rack Actuator Solenoid Undercurrent
P1213 Rack Actuator Solenoid Overcurrent
P1222 Rack Actuator Relay Error On
P1223 Rack Actuator Relay Error Off
P1224 Rack Actuator Relay Intermittent Connection
P1232 Preheat relay Error On
P1233 Preheat relay Error Off
P1234 Preheat Relay Intermittent Connection
P1242 CSD Solenoid Valve Error On
P1243 CSD Solenoid Valve Error Off
P1244 CSD Solenoid Valve Intermittent Connection
P1402 EGR Valve Phase A Error On
P1403 EGR Valve Phase A Error Off
P1412 EGR Valve Phase B Error On
P1413 EGR Valve Phase B Error Off
P1422 EGR Valve Phase C Error On
P1423 EGR Valve Phase C Error Off
P1432 EGR Valve Phase D Error On
P1433 EGR Valve Phase D Error Off P1605
E-ECU Internal FlashROM Checksum Error B (Main Software) P1606
E-ECU Internal FlashROM Checksum Error C (Main Software)
P1644 5 Volt Sensor Supply Intermittent Connection
P1664 E-ECU Temperature Sensor Intermittent Connection TOOLCAT
XX-XX CODES Toolcat Display Controller Code Description
02-16 Hydraulic Charge Filter Not Connected
02-17 Hydraulic Charge Filter Plugged
03-09 Battery Voltage Low
03-10 Battery Voltage High
03-11 Battery Voltage Extremely High
03-14 Battery Voltage Extremely Low
03-15 Battery Voltage In Shutdown
03-22 Battery Voltage Out Of Range Low
04-14 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low
04-15 Engine Oil Pressure Shutdown Level
06-10 Engine Speed High
06-11 Engine Speed Extremely High
06-13 Engine Speed No Signal
06-15 Engine Speed In Shutdown
06-18 Engine Speed Out Of Range High
07-10 Hydraulic Oil Temperature High
07-11 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Extremely High
07-15 Hydraulic Oil Temperature In Shutdown
07-21 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range High
07-22 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range Low
08-10 Engine Coolant Temperature High
08-11 Engine Coolant Temperature Extremely High
08-15 Engine Coolant Temperature In Shutdown
08-21 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range High
08-22 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range Low
09-09 Fuel Level Low
09-21 Fuel Level Out Of Range High
09-22 Fuel Level Out Of Range Low
12-21 Auxiliary PWM Switch Out Of Range High
12-22 Auxiliary PWM Switch Out Of Range Low
12-23 Auxiliary PWM Switch Not In Neutral
13-05 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Battery
13-06 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Ground
13-07 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Open Circuit
14-02 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error On
14-03 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error Off
18-05 Spool Lock Short To Battery
18-06 Spool Lock Short To Ground
18-07 Spool Lock Open Circuit
20-02 Two Speed Error On
20-03 Two Speed Error Off
21-02 Glow Plug Error On
21-03 Glow Plug Error Off
22-02 Starter Error On
22-03 Starter Error Off
26-02 Front Base Output Error On
26-03 Front Base Output Error Off
27-02 Front Rod Solenoid Error On
27-03 Front Rod Solenoid Error Off
28-02 Diverter Solenoid Error On
28-03 Diverter Solenoid Error Off
29-02 High Flow Solenoid Error On
29-03 High Flow Solenoid Error Off
30-28 Controller Memory Failure
31-28 Interrupted Power Failure
33-23 Main Controller Not Programmed
35-05 Two Speed Fan Short To Battery
35-06 Two Speed Fan Short To Ground
36-48 ACD Multiple Controllers Present
63-05 TICS Sensor Short To Battery
63-06 TICS Switch Short To Ground
64-05 Switched Power Relay Short To Battery
64-06 Switched Power Relay Short To Ground
64-07 Switched Power Relay Open Circuit
65-05 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Short To Battery
65-06 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Short To Ground
65-07 Workgroup Lockout Solenoid Open Circuit
67-05 Bobtach Short To Battery
67-06 Bobtach Short To Ground
69-05 Operator Presence Relay Short To Battery
69-06 Operator Presence Relay Short To Ground
69-07 Operator Presence Relay Open Circuit Toolcat Drive Controller Code Description
50-01 Drive Pedal Out Of Range High
50-02 Drive Pedal Out Of Range Low
50-03 Travel Pedal Not Calibrated
50-04 Brake Pedal Out Of Range High
50-05 Brake Pedal Out Of Range Low
50-06 Brake Pedal Not Calibrated
50-07 Travel Direction Control Lever No Signal
50-08 Travel Direction Control Lever Multiple Inputs
50-09 Front Wheel Speed Sensor Out Of Range High
50-10 Front Wheel Speed Sensor Out Of Range Low
50-11 Rear Wheel Speed Sensor Out Of Range High
50-12 Rear Wheel Speed Sensor Out Of Range Low
50-13 Front Wheel Speed Sensor No Signal
50-14 Rear Wheel Speed Sensor No Signal
50-15 Dual Wheel Speed Sensor Fault
50-19 Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range High
50-20 Swash Plate Sensor Out Of Range Low
50-24 Battery Voltage Over Voltage
50-25 Battery Voltage Under Voltage
50-26 Interrupted Power
50-27 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range High
50-28 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range Low
50-29 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range High
50-30 5.0 Volt Sensor Supply 2 Out Of Range Low
50-31 Front Drive PWM Solenoid Error On
50-32 Forward Drive Coil Short To Battery
50-33 Front Drive PWM Solenoid No Signal
50-34 Front Drive PWM Solenoid Not Calibrated
50-35 Front Drive Forward Solenoid Error On
50-36 Front Drive Forward Solenoid Error Off
50-37 Front Drive Reverse Solenoid Error On
50-38 Front Drive Reverse Solenoid Error Off
50-39 Rear Drive PWM Solenoid Error On
50-40 Reverse Drive Coil Short To Battery
50-41 Rear Drive PWM Solenoid No Signal
50-42 Rear Drive PWM Solenoid Not Calibrated
50-43 Rear Drive Forward Solenoid Error On
50-44 Rear Drive Forward Solenoid Error Off
50-45 Rear Drive Reverse Solenoid Error On
50-46 Rear Drive Reverse Solenoid Error Off
50-47 Two Speed Error Off
50-48 Two Speed Error On
50-49 Brake Solenoid Error On
50-50 Brake Solenoid Error Off
50-51 Brake Solenoid No Signal
50-52 Brake Lights Short To Battery
50-53 Brake Lights Short To Ground
50-54 Differential Lock Error On
50-55 Differential Lock Error Off
50-56 CAN Communications Fault
50-57 Drive Controller Not Calibrated
50-59 Front Wheel Speed Sensor Missing Pulses
50-60 Remote Hydraulics Short To Battery
50-61 Remote Hydraulics Short To Ground
50-63 Front Angle Sensor Calibration Error
50-65 Auxiliary Base Coil Short To Ground or Open Circuit
50-66 Rear Angle Sensor Calibration Error
50-67 Front Drive Forward No Signal
50-68 Front Drive Reverse No Signal
50-69 Rear Drive Forward No Signal
50-70 Rear Drive Reverse No Signal
50-72 Fan Coil Short To Ground
50-74 Throttle Sensor Channel A Out Of Range Low
50-75 Throttle Sensor Channel B Out Of Range High
50-76 Throttle Sensor Channel B Out Of Range Low
50-77 Auxiliary Diverter Error On
50-78 Auxiliary Diverter Error Off
50-80 PTO Speed Sensor Out Of Range High
50-81 PTO Speed Sensor Out Of Range Low
50-82 PTO Speed Sensor Open Circuit
50-99 In Calibration Mode Updated June 2009 VersaHANDLER
XX-XX CODES VersaHANDLER Display Controller Code Description
02-16 Hydraulic Charge Filter Not Connected
02-17 Hydraulic Charge Filter Plugged
03-09 Battery Voltage Low
03-10 Battery Voltage High
03-11 Battery Voltage Extremely High
03-14 Battery Voltage Extremely Low
03-15 Battery Voltage in Shutdown
03-22 Battery Voltage Out of Range Low
04-14 Engine Oil Pressure Extremely Low
04-15 Engine Oil Pressure in Shutdown
06-10 Engine Speed High
06-11 Engine Speed Extremely High
06-13 Engine Speed No Signal
06-15 Engine Speed In Shutdown
06-18 Engine Speed Out of Range
07-10 Hydraulic Oil Temperature High
07-11 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Extremely High
07-15 Hydraulic Oil Temperature In Shutdown
07-21 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range High
07-22 Hydraulic Oil Temperature Out Of Range Low
08-10 Engine Coolant Temperature High
08-11 Engine Coolant Temperature Extremely High
08-15 Engine Coolant Temperature In Shutdown
08-21 Engine Coolant Temperature Out Of Range High
08-22 Engine Coolant Temperature Out of Range Low
09-21 Fuel Level Out Of Range High
09-22 Fuel Level Out Of Range Low
13-05 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Battery
13-06 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Short To Ground
13-07 Fuel Shutoff Hold Solenoid Open Circuit
14-02 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error On
14-03 Fuel Shutoff Pull Solenoid Error Off
21-02 Glow Plug Error On
21-03 Glow Plug Error Off
22-02 Starter Error On
22-03 Starter Error Off
30-28 Controller Memory Failure
31-28 Interrupted Power
33-23 Constant Data Not Calibrated
36-48 ACD (Attachment Control Device) Multiple Controllers Present
63-05 Operator Presence Sensor Short To Battery
63-06 Operator Presence Sensor Short to Ground
64-05 Switched Power Relay Short To Battery
64-06 Switched Power Relay Short To Ground
64-07 Switched Power Relay Open Circuit
65-05 Joystick Lockout Short To Battery
65-06 Joystick Lockout Short To Ground
65-07 Joystick Lockout Open Circuit
70-28 Brake Pressure Failure
77-48 Key Switch Multiple VersaHANDLER Drive Controller Code Description
50-02 Extend / Retract Control Out of Range High
50-03 Extend/Retract Control Out of Range Low
50-04 Extend/Retract Control Not In Neutral
50-05 Auxiliary Control Out of Range High
50-06 Auxiliary Control Out of Range Low
50-07 Auxiliary Control Not In Neutral
50-14 Inching Control Out of Range High
50-15 Inching Control Out of Range Low
50-16 Inching Control Not Calibrated
50-20 Boom Pressure Out Of Range High
50-21 Boom Pressure Out Of Range Low
50-23 Drive Controller Not Programmed
50-24 Stability Valve Error On
50-25 Stability Valve Error Off
50-26 Interrupted Power
50-28 FNR No Inputs Active
50-29 FNR More than One Input Active
50-30 Rear Light Relay Error On
50-31 Rear Light Relay Error Off
50-33 Passive Brake Valve Error On
50-34 Passive Brake Valve Error Off
50-36 Brake Light Relay Error On
50-37 Brake Light Relay Error Off
50-42 Secondary Auxiliary Hydraulic Valve Error On
50-43 Secondary Auxiliary Hydraulic Valve Error Off
50-45 Extend/Retract Base Error On
50-46 Extend/Retract Base Error Off
50-48 5 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range Low
50-49 5 Volt Sensor Supply 1 Out Of Range High
50-50 5 Volt Sensor Supply 2 Out of Range Low
50-51 5 Volt Sensor Supply 2 Out of Range High
50-54 Switched Battery Over Voltage
50-55 Switched Battery Under Voltage
50-56 CAN Communication Fault
50-57 Drive Controller Not Calibrated
50-58 CAN RPM Message Stale
50-60 Drive Pump Forward Error On
50-61 Drive Pump Forward Error Off
50-63 Drive Pump Reverse Error On
50-64 Drive Pump Reverse Error Off
50-66 Extend/Retract Rod Error On
50-67 Extend/Retract Rod Error Off
50-69 Auxiliary Hydraulics Base Error On
50-70 Auxiliary Hydraulics Base Error Off
50-72 Auxiliary Hydraulics Rod Error On
50-73 Auxiliary Hydraulics Rod Error Off
50-78 Boom Float Relay Error On
50-79 Boom Float Relay Error Off
50-80 Two Speed Relay Error On
50-81 Two Speed Relay Error Off
50-82 EEPROM Error